UniversityPhysicsVolume2 WEB 5eNhMSa

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 805

University Physics

Volume 2

SENIOR CONTRIBUTING AUTHORS


SAMUEL J. LING, TRUMAN STATE UNIVERSITY
JEFF SANNY, LOYOLA MARYMOUNT UNIVERSITY
WILLIAM MOEBS, FORMERLY OF LOYOLA MARYMOUNT UNIVERSITY



OpenStax
Rice University
6100 Main Street MS-375
Houston, Texas 77005

To learn more about OpenStax, visit https://openstax.org.


Individual print copies and bulk orders can be purchased through our website.

©2021 Rice University. Textbook content produced by OpenStax is licensed under a Creative Commons
Attribution 4.0 International License (CC BY 4.0). Under this license, any user of this textbook or the textbook
contents herein must provide proper attribution as follows:

- If you redistribute this textbook in a digital format (including but not limited to PDF and HTML), then you
must retain on every page the following attribution:
“Access for free at openstax.org.”
- If you redistribute this textbook in a print format, then you must include on every physical page the
following attribution:
“Access for free at openstax.org.”
- If you redistribute part of this textbook, then you must retain in every digital format page view (including
but not limited to PDF and HTML) and on every physical printed page the following attribution:
“Access for free at openstax.org.”
- If you use this textbook as a bibliographic reference, please include
https://openstax.org/details/books/university-physics-volume-2 in your citation.

For questions regarding this licensing, please contact [email protected].

Trademarks
The OpenStax name, OpenStax logo, OpenStax book covers, OpenStax CNX name, OpenStax CNX logo,
OpenStax Tutor name, Openstax Tutor logo, Connexions name, Connexions logo, Rice University name, and
Rice University logo are not subject to the license and may not be reproduced without the prior and express
written consent of Rice University.

HARDCOVER BOOK ISBN-13 978-1-938168-16-1


PAPERBACK BOOK ISBN-13 978-1-951693-06-0
B&W PAPERBACK BOOK ISBN-13 978-1-50669-816-8
DIGITAL VERSION ISBN-13 978-1-947172-21-0
ENHANCED TEXTBOOK ISBN-13 978-1-947172-27-2
ORIGINAL PUBLICATION YEAR 2016
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 JAY 21 18 16



OPENSTAX

OpenStax provides free, peer-reviewed, openly licensed textbooks for introductory college and Advanced
Placement® courses and low-cost, personalized courseware that helps students learn. A nonprofit ed tech
initiative based at Rice University, we’re committed to helping students access the tools they need to complete
their courses and meet their educational goals.

RICE UNIVERSITY

OpenStax, OpenStax CNX, and OpenStax Tutor are initiatives of Rice University. As a leading research
university with a distinctive commitment to undergraduate education, Rice University aspires to path-breaking
research, unsurpassed teaching, and contributions to the betterment of our world. It seeks to fulfill this
mission by cultivating a diverse community of learning and discovery that produces leaders across the
spectrum of human endeavor.

PHILANTHROPIC SUPPORT

OpenStax is grateful for our generous philanthropic partners, who support our vision to improve educational

opportunities for all learners.

Arnold Ventures The Maxfield Foundation

Chan Zuckerberg Initiative Burt and Deedee McMurtry

Chegg, Inc. Michelson 20MM Foundation

Arthur and Carlyse Ciocca Charitable Foundation National Science Foundation

Digital Promise The Open Society Foundations

Ann and John Doerr Jumee Yhu and David E. Park III

Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation Brian D. Patterson USA-International Foundation

Girard Foundation The Bill and Stephanie Sick Fund

Google Inc. Steven L. Smith & Diana T. Go

The William and Flora Hewlett Foundation Stand Together

The Hewlett-Packard Company Robin and Sandy Stuart Foundation

Intel Inc. The Stuart Family Foundation

Rusty and John Jaggers Tammy and Guillermo Treviño

The Calvin K. Kazanjian Economics Foundation Valhalla Charitable Foundation

Charles Koch Foundation White Star Education Foundation

Leon Lowenstein Foundation, Inc.


Study where you want, what
you want, when you want.
When you access your book in our web view, you can use our new online
highlighting and note-taking features to create your own study guides.

Our books are free and flexible, forever.


Get started at openstax.org/details/books/university-physics-volume-2

Access. The future of education.


openstax.org
Contents
Preface 1

UNIT 1 THERMODYNAMICS
CHAPTER 1
Temperature and Heat 5
Introduction 5
1.1 Temperature and Thermal Equilibrium 6
1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales 7
1.3 Thermal Expansion 10
1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry 17
1.5 Phase Changes 25
1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 33
Chapter Review 51

CHAPTER 2
The Kinetic Theory of Gases 67
Introduction 67
2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 68
2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 78
2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of Energy 88
2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds 93
Chapter Review 98

CHAPTER 3
The First Law of Thermodynamics 109
Introduction 109
3.1 Thermodynamic Systems 110
3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy 112
3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics 116
3.4 Thermodynamic Processes 122
3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas 125
3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas 127
Chapter Review 132

CHAPTER 4
The Second Law of Thermodynamics 143
Introduction 143
4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes 144
4.2 Heat Engines 146
4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps 148
4.4 Statements of the Second Law of Thermodynamics 150
4.5 The Carnot Cycle 152
4.6 Entropy 157
4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale 163
Chapter Review 168

UNIT 2 ELECTRICITY AND MAGNETISM


CHAPTER 5
Electric Charges and Fields 179
Introduction 179
5.1 Electric Charge 180
5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging by Induction 186
5.3 Coulomb's Law 190
5.4 Electric Field 195
5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions 202
5.6 Electric Field Lines 210
5.7 Electric Dipoles 213
Chapter Review 216

CHAPTER 6
Gauss's Law 229
Introduction 229
6.1 Electric Flux 230
6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law 239
6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law 245
6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium 258
Chapter Review 267

CHAPTER 7
Electric Potential 279
Introduction 279
7.1 Electric Potential Energy 280
7.2 Electric Potential and Potential Difference 287
7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential 298
7.4 Determining Field from Potential 308
7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors 311
7.6 Applications of Electrostatics 319
Chapter Review 324

CHAPTER 8
Capacitance 335
Introduction 335
8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance 336
8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel 345
8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor 351
8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric 354
8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric 357
Chapter Review 364

CHAPTER 9
Current and Resistance 373

Access for free at openstax.org.


Introduction 373
9.1 Electrical Current 374
9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals 379
9.3 Resistivity and Resistance 384
9.4 Ohm's Law 393
9.5 Electrical Energy and Power 397
9.6 Superconductors 403
Chapter Review 408

CHAPTER 10
Direct-Current Circuits 419
Introduction 419
10.1 Electromotive Force 420
10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel 427
10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules 439
10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments 451
10.5 RC Circuits 454
10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical Safety 460
Chapter Review 465

CHAPTER 11
Magnetic Forces and Fields 479
Introduction 479
11.1 Magnetism and Its Historical Discoveries 480
11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines 482
11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a Magnetic Field 486
11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor 491
11.5 Force and Torque on a Current Loop 496
11.6 The Hall Effect 499
11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and Fields 502
Chapter Review 506

CHAPTER 12
Sources of Magnetic Fields 519
Introduction 519
12.1 The Biot-Savart Law 520
12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight Wire 523
12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel Currents 527
12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop 529
12.5 Ampère’s Law 532
12.6 Solenoids and Toroids 539
12.7 Magnetism in Matter 544
Chapter Review 551

CHAPTER 13
Electromagnetic Induction 565
Introduction 565
13.1 Faraday’s Law 566
13.2 Lenz's Law 570
13.3 Motional Emf 574
13.4 Induced Electric Fields 582
13.5 Eddy Currents 586
13.6 Electric Generators and Back Emf 590
13.7 Applications of Electromagnetic Induction 596
Chapter Review 598

CHAPTER 14
Inductance 611
Introduction 611
14.1 Mutual Inductance 612
14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors 615
14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field 620
14.4 RL Circuits 623
14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit 628
14.6 RLC Series Circuits 631
Chapter Review 634

CHAPTER 15
Alternating-Current Circuits 643
Introduction 643
15.1 AC Sources 644
15.2 Simple AC Circuits 645
15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC 651
15.4 Power in an AC Circuit 656
15.5 Resonance in an AC Circuit 660
15.6 Transformers 664
Chapter Review 669

CHAPTER 16
Electromagnetic Waves 679
Introduction 679
16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves 680
16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves 686
16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic Waves 693
16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure 697
16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum 702
Chapter Review 710

Appendix A Units 723


Appendix B Conversion Factors 727
Appendix C Fundamental Constants 731
Appendix D Astronomical Data 733
Appendix E Mathematical Formulas 735
Appendix F Chemistry 739
Appendix G The Greek Alphabet 741

Access for free at openstax.org.


Answer Key 742

Index 789
Access for free at openstax.org.
Preface 1

PREFACE
Welcome to University Physics, an OpenStax are web based, we can make updates periodically
resource. This textbook was written to increase when deemed pedagogically necessary. If you have a
student access to high-quality learning materials, correction to suggest, submit it through the link on
maintaining highest standards of academic rigor at your book page on OpenStax.org. Subject matter
little to no cost. experts review all errata suggestions. OpenStax is
committed to remaining transparent about all
About OpenStax updates, so you will also find a list of past errata
OpenStax is a nonprofit based at Rice University, changes on your book page on OpenStax.org.
and it’s our mission to improve student access to
Format
education. Our first openly licensed college textbook
You can access this textbook for free in web view or
was published in 2012 and our library has since
PDF through OpenStax.org, and for a low cost in
scaled to over 25 books used by hundreds of
print.
thousands of students across the globe. OpenStax
Tutor, our low-cost personalized learning tool, is About University Physics
being used in college courses throughout the
University Physics is designed for the two- or three-
country. The OpenStax mission is made possible
semester calculus-based physics course. The text
through the generous support of philanthropic
has been developed to meet the scope and sequence
foundations. Through these partnerships and with
of most university physics courses and provides a
the help of additional low-cost resources from our
foundation for a career in mathematics, science, or
OpenStax partners, OpenStax is breaking down the
engineering. The book provides an important
most common barriers to learning and empowering
opportunity for students to learn the core concepts
students and instructors to succeed.
of physics and understand how those concepts apply
About OpenStax's resources to their lives and to the world around them.

Customization Due to the comprehensive nature of the material, we


University Physics is licensed under a Creative are offering the book in three volumes for flexibility
Commons Attribution 4.0 International (CC BY) and efficiency.
license, which means that you can distribute, remix,
Coverage and scope
and build upon the content, as long as you provide
Our University Physics textbook adheres to the
attribution to OpenStax and its content contributors.
scope and sequence of most two- and three-
Because our books are openly licensed, you are free semester physics courses nationwide. We have
to use the entire book or pick and choose the worked to make physics interesting and accessible
sections that are most relevant to the needs of your to students while maintaining the mathematical
course. Feel free to remix the content by assigning rigor inherent in the subject. With this objective in
your students certain chapters and sections in your mind, the content of this textbook has been
syllabus in the order that you prefer. You can even developed and arranged to provide a logical
provide a direct link in your syllabus to the sections progression from fundamental to more advanced
in the web view of your book. concepts, building upon what students have already
learned and emphasizing connections between
Instructors also have the option of creating a
topics and between theory and applications. The
customized version of their OpenStax book. The
goal of each section is to enable students not just to
custom version can be made available to students in
recognize concepts, but to work with them in ways
low-cost print or digital form through their campus
that will be useful in later courses and future
bookstore. Visit your book page on OpenStax.org for
careers. The organization and pedagogical features
more information.
were developed and vetted with feedback from
Errata science educators dedicated to the project.
All OpenStax textbooks undergo a rigorous review
VOLUME I
process. However, like any professional-grade
textbook, errors sometimes occur. Since our books Unit 1: Mechanics
2 Preface

• Chapter 1: Units and Measurement • Chapter 6: Photons and Matter Waves


• Chapter 2: Vectors • Chapter 7: Quantum Mechanics
• Chapter 3: Motion Along a Straight Line • Chapter 8: Atomic Structure
• Chapter 4: Motion in Two and Three Dimensions • Chapter 9: Condensed Matter Physics
• Chapter 5: Newton’s Laws of Motion • Chapter 10: Nuclear Physics
• Chapter 6: Applications of Newton’s Laws • Chapter 11: Particle Physics and Cosmology
• Chapter 7: Work and Kinetic Energy
• Chapter 8: Potential Energy and Conservation of
Pedagogical foundation
Throughout University Physics you will find
Energy
derivations of concepts that present classical ideas
• Chapter 9: Linear Momentum and Collisions
and techniques, as well as modern applications and
• Chapter 10: Fixed-Axis Rotation
methods. Most chapters start with observations or
• Chapter 11: Angular Momentum
experiments that place the material in a context of
• Chapter 12: Static Equilibrium and Elasticity
physical experience. Presentations and explanations
• Chapter 13: Gravitation
rely on years of classroom experience on the part of
• Chapter 14: Fluid Mechanics
long-time physics professors, striving for a balance
Unit 2: Waves and Acoustics of clarity and rigor that has proven successful with
their students. Throughout the text, links enable
• Chapter 15: Oscillations
students to review earlier material and then return
• Chapter 16: Waves
to the present discussion, reinforcing connections
• Chapter 17: Sound
between topics. Key historical figures and
VOLUME II experiments are discussed in the main text (rather
than in boxes or sidebars), maintaining a focus on
Unit 1: Thermodynamics
the development of physical intuition. Key ideas,
• Chapter 1: Temperature and Heat definitions, and equations are highlighted in the text
• Chapter 2: The Kinetic Theory of Gases and listed in summary form at the end of each
• Chapter 3: The First Law of Thermodynamics chapter. Examples and chapter-opening images
• Chapter 4: The Second Law of Thermodynamics often include contemporary applications from daily
life or modern science and engineering that
Unit 2: Electricity and Magnetism
students can relate to, from smart phones to the
• Chapter 5: Electric Charges and Fields internet to GPS devices.
• Chapter 6: Gauss’s Law
• Chapter 7: Electric Potential Assessments that reinforce key concepts
In-chapter Examples generally follow a three-part
• Chapter 8: Capacitance
format of Strategy, Solution, and Significance to
• Chapter 9: Current and Resistance
emphasize how to approach a problem, how to work
• Chapter 10: Direct-Current Circuits
with the equations, and how to check and generalize
• Chapter 11: Magnetic Forces and Fields
the result. Examples are often followed by Check
• Chapter 12: Sources of Magnetic Fields
• Chapter 13: Electromagnetic Induction Your Understanding questions and answers to help
reinforce for students the important ideas of the
• Chapter 14: Inductance
examples. Problem-Solving Strategies in each
• Chapter 15: Alternating-Current Circuits
chapter break down methods of approaching
• Chapter 16: Electromagnetic Waves
various types of problems into steps students can
VOLUME III follow for guidance. The book also includes
exercises at the end of each chapter so students can
Unit 1: Optics
practice what they’ve learned.
• Chapter 1: The Nature of Light
• Conceptual questions do not require
• Chapter 2: Geometric Optics and Image
calculation but test student learning of the key
Formation
concepts.
• Chapter 3: Interference
• Problems categorized by section test student
• Chapter 4: Diffraction
problem-solving skills and the ability to apply
Unit 2: Modern Physics ideas to practical situations.
• Additional Problems apply knowledge across
• Chapter 5: Relativity
the chapter, forcing students to identify what

Access for free at openstax.org.


Preface 3

concepts and equations are appropriate for Dr. Samuel Ling has taught introductory and
solving given problems. Randomly located advanced physics for over 25 years at Truman State
throughout the problems are Unreasonable University, where he is currently Professor of
Results exercises that ask students to evaluate Physics and the Department Chair. Dr. Ling has two
the answer to a problem and explain why it is PhDs from Boston University, one in Chemistry and
not reasonable and what assumptions made the other in Physics, and he was a Research Fellow at
might not be correct. the Indian Institute of Science, Bangalore, before
• Challenge Problems extend text ideas to joining Truman. Dr. Ling is also an author of A First
interesting but difficult situations. Course in Vibrations and Waves, published by
Oxford University Press. Dr. Ling has considerable
Answers for selected exercises are available in an
experience with research in Physics Education and
Answer Key at the end of the book.
has published research on collaborative learning
Additional resources methods in physics teaching. He was awarded a
Truman Fellow and a Jepson fellow in recognition of
Student and instructor resources his innovative teaching methods. Dr. Ling’s research
We’ve compiled additional resources for both publications have spanned Cosmology, Solid State
students and instructors, including Getting Started Physics, and Nonlinear Optics.
Guides, PowerPoint slides, and answer and solution
guides for instructors and students. Instructor Jeff Sanny, Loyola Marymount University
resources require a verified instructor account, Dr. Jeff Sanny earned a BS in Physics from Harvey
which you can apply for when you log in or create Mudd College in 1974 and a PhD in Solid State
your account on OpenStax.org. Take advantage of Physics from the University of California–Los
these resources to supplement your OpenStax book. Angeles in 1980. He joined the faculty at Loyola
Marymount University in the fall of 1980. During his
Community Hubs tenure, he has served as department Chair as well as
OpenStax partners with the Institute for the Study of Associate Dean. Dr. Sanny enjoys teaching
Knowledge Management in Education (ISKME) to introductory physics in particular. He is also
offer Community Hubs on OER Commons – a passionate about providing students with research
platform for instructors to share community-created experience and has directed an active
resources that support OpenStax books, free of undergraduate student research group in space
charge. Through our Community Hubs, instructors physics for many years.
can upload their own materials or download
resources to use in their own courses, including William Moebs, Formerly of Loyola Marymount
additional ancillaries, teaching material, University
multimedia, and relevant course content. We Dr. William Moebs earned a BS and PhD (1959 and
encourage instructors to join the hubs for the 1965) from the University of Michigan. He then
subjects most relevant to your teaching and joined their staff as a Research Associate for one
research as an opportunity both to enrich your year, where he continued his doctoral research in
courses and to engage with other faculty. particle physics. In 1966, he accepted an
appointment to the Physics Department of Indiana
To reach the Community Hubs, visit Purdue Fort Wayne (IPFW), where he served as
www.oercommons.org/hubs/OpenStax Department Chair from 1971 to 1979. In 1979, he
(https://www.oercommons.org/hubs/OpenStax) . moved to Loyola Marymount University (LMU),
Partner resources where he served as Chair of the Physics Department
OpenStax partners are our allies in the mission to from 1979 to 1986. He retired from LMU in 2000. He
make high-quality learning materials affordable and has published research in particle physics, chemical
accessible to students and instructors everywhere. kinetics, cell division, atomic physics, and physics
Their tools integrate seamlessly with our OpenStax teaching.
titles at a low cost. To access the partner resources Contributing authors
for your text, visit your book page on OpenStax.org. Stephen D. Druger, Northwestern University
Alice Kolakowska, University of Memphis
About the authors
David Anderson, Albion College
Senior contributing authors Daniel Bowman, Ferrum College
Samuel J. Ling, Truman State University Dedra Demaree, Georgetown University
4 Preface

Edw. S. Ginsberg, University of Massachusetts Bryan Gibbs, Dallas County Community College
Joseph Trout, Richard Stockton College Lynn Gillette, Pima Community College–West
Kevin Wheelock, Bellevue College Campus
David Smith, University of the Virgin Islands Mark Giroux, East Tennessee State University
Takashi Sato, Kwantlen Polytechnic University Matthew Griffiths, University of New Haven
Gerald Friedman, Santa Fe Community College Alfonso Hinojosa, University of Texas–Arlington
Lev Gasparov, University of North Florida Steuard Jensen, Alma College
Lee LaRue, Paris Junior College David Kagan, University of Massachusetts
Mark Lattery, University of Wisconsin Sergei Katsev, University of Minnesota–Duluth
Richard Ludlow, Daniel Webster College Gregory Lapicki, East Carolina University
Patrick Motl, Indiana University Kokomo Jill Leggett, Florida State College–Jacksonville
Tao Pang, University of Nevada, Las Vegas Alfredo Louro, University of Calgary
Kenneth Podolak, Plattsburgh State University James Maclaren, Tulane University
Ponn Maheswaranathan, Winthrop University
Reviewers Seth Major, Hamilton College
Salameh Ahmad, Rochester Institute of
Oleg Maksimov, Excelsior College
Technology–Dubai
Aristides Marcano, Delaware State University
John Aiken, University of Colorado–Boulder
James McDonald, University of Hartford
Raymond Benge, Terrant County College
Ralph McGrew, SUNY–Broome Community College
Gavin Buxton, Robert Morris University
Paul Miller, West Virginia University
Erik Christensen, South Florida State College
Tamar More, University of Portland
Clifton Clark, Fort Hays State University
Farzaneh Najmabadi, University of Phoenix
Nelson Coates, California Maritime Academy
Richard Olenick, The University of Dallas
Herve Collin, Kapi’olani Community College
Christopher Porter, Ohio State University
Carl Covatto, Arizona State University
Liza Pujji, Manakau Institute of Technology
Alejandro Cozzani, Imperial Valley College
Baishali Ray, Young Harris University
Danielle Dalafave, The College of New Jersey
Andrew Robinson, Carleton University
Nicholas Darnton, Georgia Institute of Technology
Aruvana Roy, Young Harris University
Ethan Deneault, University of Tampa
Gajendra Tulsian, Daytona State College
Kenneth DeNisco, Harrisburg Area Community
Adria Updike, Roger Williams University
College
Clark Vangilder, Central Arizona University
Robert Edmonds, Tarrant County College
Steven Wolf, Texas State University
William Falls, Erie Community College
Alexander Wurm, Western New England University
Stanley Forrester, Broward College
Lei Zhang, Winston Salem State University
Umesh Garg, University of Notre Dame
Ulrich Zurcher, Cleveland State University
Maurizio Giannotti, Barry University

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 1
Temperature and Heat

Figure 1.1 These snowshoers on Mount Hood in Oregon are enjoying the heat flow and light caused by high
temperature. All three mechanisms of heat transfer are relevant to this picture. The heat flowing out of the fire also
turns the solid snow to liquid water and vapor. (credit: modification of work by “Mt. Hood Territory”/Flickr)

Chapter Outline

1.1 Temperature and Thermal Equilibrium

1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales

1.3 Thermal Expansion

1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry

1.5 Phase Changes

1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer

INTRODUCTION Heat and temperature are important concepts for each of us, every day. How we dress in the
morning depends on whether the day is hot or cold, and most of what we do requires energy that ultimately
comes from the Sun. The study of heat and temperature is part of an area of physics known as
thermodynamics. The laws of thermodynamics govern the flow of energy throughout the universe. They are
studied in all areas of science and engineering, from chemistry to biology to environmental science.

In this chapter, we explore heat and temperature. It is not always easy to distinguish these terms. Heat is the
flow of energy from one object to another. This flow of energy is caused by a difference in temperature. The
6 1 • Temperature and Heat

transfer of heat can change temperature, as can work, another kind of energy transfer that is central to
thermodynamics. We return to these basic ideas several times throughout the next four chapters, and you will
see that they affect everything from the behavior of atoms and molecules to cooking to our weather on Earth to
the life cycles of stars.

1.1 Temperature and Thermal Equilibrium


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define temperature and describe it qualitatively
• Explain thermal equilibrium
• Explain the zeroth law of thermodynamics

Heat is familiar to all of us. We can feel heat entering our bodies from the summer Sun or from hot coffee or tea
after a winter stroll. We can also feel heat leaving our bodies as we feel the chill of night or the cooling effect of
sweat after exercise.

What is heat? How do we define it and how is it related to temperature? What are the effects of heat and how
does it flow from place to place? We will find that, in spite of the richness of the phenomena, a small set of
underlying physical principles unites these subjects and ties them to other fields. We start by examining
temperature and how to define and measure it.

Temperature
The concept of temperature has evolved from the common concepts of hot and cold. The scientific definition of
temperature explains more than our senses of hot and cold. As you may have already learned, many physical
quantities are defined solely in terms of how they are observed or measured, that is, they are defined
operationally. Temperature is operationally defined as the quantity of what we measure with a thermometer.
As we will see in detail in a later chapter on the kinetic theory of gases, temperature is proportional to the
average kinetic energy of translation, a fact that provides a more physical definition. Differences in
temperature maintain the transfer of heat, or heat transfer, throughout the universe. Heat transfer is the
movement of energy from one place or material to another as a result of a difference in temperature. (You will
learn more about heat transfer later in this chapter.)

Thermal Equilibrium
An important concept related to temperature is thermal equilibrium. Two objects are in thermal equilibrium
if they are in close contact that allows either to gain energy from the other, but nevertheless, no net energy is
transferred between them. Even when not in contact, they are in thermal equilibrium if, when they are placed
in contact, no net energy is transferred between them. If two objects remain in contact for a long time, they
typically come to equilibrium. In other words, two objects in thermal equilibrium do not exchange energy.

Experimentally, if object A is in equilibrium with object B, and object B is in equilibrium with object C, then (as
you may have already guessed) object A is in equilibrium with object C. That statement of transitivity is called
the zeroth law of thermodynamics. (The number “zeroth” was suggested by British physicist Ralph Fowler in
the 1930s. The first, second, and third laws of thermodynamics were already named and numbered then. The
zeroth law had seldom been stated, but it needs to be discussed before the others, so Fowler gave it a smaller
number.) Consider the case where A is a thermometer. The zeroth law tells us that if A reads a certain
temperature when in equilibrium with B, and it is then placed in contact with C, it will not exchange energy
with C; therefore, its temperature reading will remain the same (Figure 1.2). In other words, if two objects are
in thermal equilibrium, they have the same temperature.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.2 • Thermometers and Temperature Scales 7

Figure 1.2 If thermometer A is in thermal equilibrium with object B, and B is in thermal equilibrium with C, then A is in thermal
equilibrium with C. Therefore, the reading on A stays the same when A is moved over to make contact with C.

A thermometer measures its own temperature. It is through the concepts of thermal equilibrium and the
zeroth law of thermodynamics that we can say that a thermometer measures the temperature of something
else, and to make sense of the statement that two objects are at the same temperature.

In the rest of this chapter, we will often refer to “systems” instead of “objects.” As in the chapter on linear
momentum and collisions, a system consists of one or more objects—but in thermodynamics, we require a
system to be macroscopic, that is, to consist of a huge number (such as ) of molecules. Then we can say
that a system is in thermal equilibrium with itself if all parts of it are at the same temperature. (We will return
to the definition of a thermodynamic system in the chapter on the first law of thermodynamics.)

1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe several different types of thermometers
• Convert temperatures between the Celsius, Fahrenheit, and Kelvin scales

Any physical property that depends consistently and reproducibly on temperature can be used as the basis of a
thermometer. For example, volume increases with temperature for most substances. This property is the basis
for the common alcohol thermometer and the original mercury thermometers. Other properties used to
measure temperature include electrical resistance, color, and the emission of infrared radiation (Figure 1.3).
8 1 • Temperature and Heat

Figure 1.3 Because many physical properties depend on temperature, the variety of thermometers is remarkable. (a) In this common
type of thermometer, the alcohol, containing a red dye, expands more rapidly than the glass encasing it. When the thermometer’s
temperature increases, the liquid from the bulb is forced into the narrow tube, producing a large change in the length of the column for a
small change in temperature. (b) Each of the six squares on this plastic (liquid crystal) thermometer contains a film of a different heat-
sensitive liquid crystal material. Below , all six squares are black. When the plastic thermometer is exposed to a temperature of ,
the first liquid crystal square changes color. When the temperature reaches above , the second liquid crystal square also changes
color, and so forth. (c) A firefighter uses a pyrometer to check the temperature of an aircraft carrier’s ventilation system. The pyrometer
measures infrared radiation (whose emission varies with temperature) from the vent and quickly produces a temperature readout. Infrared
thermometers are also frequently used to measure body temperature by gently placing them in the ear canal. Such thermometers are more
accurate than the alcohol thermometers placed under the tongue or in the armpit. (credit b: modification of work by Tess Watson; credit c:
modification of work by Lamel J. Hinton, U.S. Navy)

Thermometers measure temperature according to well-defined scales of measurement. The three most
common temperature scales are Fahrenheit, Celsius, and Kelvin. Temperature scales are created by
identifying two reproducible temperatures. The freezing and boiling temperatures of water at standard
atmospheric pressure are commonly used.

On the Celsius scale, the freezing point of water is and the boiling point is The unit of
temperature on this scale is the degree Celsius . The Fahrenheit scale (still the most frequently used for
common purposes in the United States) has the freezing point of water at and the boiling point at
Its unit is the degree Fahrenheit ( ). You can see that 100 Celsius degrees span the same range as 180
Fahrenheit degrees. Thus, a temperature difference of one degree on the Celsius scale is 1.8 times as large as a
difference of one degree on the Fahrenheit scale, or

The definition of temperature in terms of molecular motion suggests that there should be a lowest possible
temperature, where the average kinetic energy of molecules is zero (or the minimum allowed by quantum
mechanics). Experiments confirm the existence of such a temperature, called absolute zero. An absolute
temperature scale is one whose zero point is absolute zero. Such scales are convenient in science because
several physical quantities, such as the volume of an ideal gas, are directly related to absolute temperature.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.2 • Thermometers and Temperature Scales 9

The Kelvin scale is the absolute temperature scale that is commonly used in science. The SI temperature unit
is the kelvin, which is abbreviated K (not accompanied by a degree sign). Thus 0 K is absolute zero. The
freezing and boiling points of water are 273.15 K and 373.15 K, respectively. Therefore, temperature
differences are the same in units of kelvins and degrees Celsius, or

The relationships between the three common temperature scales are shown in Figure 1.4. Temperatures on
these scales can be converted using the equations in Table 1.1.

Figure 1.4 Relationships between the Fahrenheit, Celsius, and Kelvin temperature scales are shown. The relative sizes of the scales are
also shown.

To convert from… Use this equation…

Celsius to Fahrenheit

Fahrenheit to Celsius

Celsius to Kelvin

Kelvin to Celsius

Fahrenheit to Kelvin

Kelvin to Fahrenheit

Table 1.1 Temperature Conversions

To convert between Fahrenheit and Kelvin, convert to Celsius as an intermediate step.

EXAMPLE 1.1

Converting between Temperature Scales: Room Temperature


“Room temperature” is generally defined in physics to be . (a) What is room temperature in ? (b) What
is it in K?

Strategy
To answer these questions, all we need to do is choose the correct conversion equations and substitute the
known values.
10 1 • Temperature and Heat

Solution
To convert from to , use the equation

Substitute the known value into the equation and solve:

Similarly, we find that .

The Kelvin scale is part of the SI system of units, so its actual definition is more complicated than the one given
above. First, it is not defined in terms of the freezing and boiling points of water, but in terms of the triple
point. The triple point is the unique combination of temperature and pressure at which ice, liquid water, and
water vapor can coexist stably. As will be discussed in the section on phase changes, the coexistence is
achieved by lowering the pressure and consequently the boiling point to reach the freezing point. The triple-
point temperature is defined as 273.16 K. This definition has the advantage that although the freezing
temperature and boiling temperature of water depend on pressure, there is only one triple-point temperature.

Second, even with two points on the scale defined, different thermometers give somewhat different results for
other temperatures. Therefore, a standard thermometer is required. Metrologists (experts in the science of
measurement) have chosen the constant-volume gas thermometer for this purpose. A vessel of constant
volume filled with gas is subjected to temperature changes, and the measured temperature is proportional to
the change in pressure. Using “TP” to represent the triple point,

The results depend somewhat on the choice of gas, but the less dense the gas in the bulb, the better the results
for different gases agree. If the results are extrapolated to zero density, the results agree quite well, with zero
pressure corresponding to a temperature of absolute zero.

Constant-volume gas thermometers are big and come to equilibrium slowly, so they are used mostly as
standards to calibrate other thermometers.

INTERACTIVE
Visit this site (https://openstax.org/l/21consvolgasth) to learn more about the constant-volume gas
thermometer.

1.3 Thermal Expansion


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Answer qualitative questions about the effects of thermal expansion
• Solve problems involving thermal expansion, including those involving thermal stress

The expansion of alcohol in a thermometer is one of many commonly encountered examples of thermal
expansion, which is the change in size or volume of a given system as its temperature changes. The most
visible example is the expansion of hot air. When air is heated, it expands and becomes less dense than the
surrounding air, which then exerts an (upward) force on the hot air and makes steam and smoke rise, hot air
balloons float, and so forth. The same behavior happens in all liquids and gases, driving natural heat transfer
upward in homes, oceans, and weather systems, as we will discuss in an upcoming section. Solids also undergo
thermal expansion. Railroad tracks and bridges, for example, have expansion joints to allow them to freely
expand and contract with temperature changes, as shown in Figure 1.5.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.3 • Thermal Expansion 11

Figure 1.5 (a) Thermal expansion joints like these in the (b) Auckland Harbour Bridge in New Zealand allow bridges to change length
without buckling. (credit: modification of works by “ŠJů”/Wikimedia Commons)

What is the underlying cause of thermal expansion? As previously mentioned, an increase in temperature
means an increase in the kinetic energy of individual atoms. In a solid, unlike in a gas, the molecules are held
in place by forces from neighboring molecules; as we saw in Oscillations, the forces can be modeled as in
harmonic springs described by the Lennard-Jones potential. Energy in Simple Harmonic Motion shows that
such potentials are asymmetrical in that the potential energy increases more steeply when the molecules get
closer to each other than when they get farther away. Thus, at a given kinetic energy, the distance moved is
greater when neighbors move away from each other than when they move toward each other. The result is that
increased kinetic energy (increased temperature) increases the average distance between molecules—the
substance expands.

For most substances under ordinary conditions, it is an excellent approximation that there is no preferred
direction (that is, the solid is “isotropic”), and an increase in temperature increases the solid’s size by a certain
fraction in each dimension. Therefore, if the solid is free to expand or contract, its proportions stay the same;
only its overall size changes.

Linear Thermal Expansion


According to experiments, the dependence of thermal expansion on temperature, substance, and original
initial length is summarized in the equation

1.1

where is the instantaneous change in length per temperature, L is the length, and is the coefficient of
linear expansion, a material property that varies slightly with temperature. As is nearly constant and
also very small, for practical purposes, we use the linear approximation:
1.2
where is the change in length and is the change in temperature.

Table 1.2 lists representative values of the coefficient of linear expansion. As noted earlier, is the same
whether it is expressed in units of degrees Celsius or kelvins; thus, may have units of or 1/K with the
same value in either case. Approximating as a constant is quite accurate for small changes in temperature
12 1 • Temperature and Heat

and sufficient for most practical purposes, even for large changes in temperature. We examine this
approximation more closely in the next example.

Coefficient of Linear Coefficient of Volume


Material
Expansion Expansion

Solids

Aluminum

Brass

Copper

Gold

Iron or steel

Invar (nickel-iron alloy)

Lead

Silver

Glass (ordinary)

Glass (Pyrex®)

Quartz

Concrete, brick

Marble (average)

Liquids

Ether

Ethyl alcohol

Gasoline

Glycerin

Mercury

Water

Gases

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.3 • Thermal Expansion 13

Coefficient of Linear Coefficient of Volume


Material
Expansion Expansion

Air and most other gases at


atmospheric pressure

Table 1.2 Thermal Expansion Coefficients

Thermal expansion is exploited in the bimetallic strip (Figure 1.6). This device can be used as a thermometer if
the curving strip is attached to a pointer on a scale. It can also be used to automatically close or open a switch
at a certain temperature, as in older or analog thermostats.

Figure 1.6 The curvature of a bimetallic strip depends on temperature. (a) The strip is straight at the starting temperature, where its two
components have the same length. (b) At a higher temperature, this strip bends to the right, because the metal on the left has expanded
more than the metal on the right. At a lower temperature, the strip would bend to the left.

EXAMPLE 1.2

Calculating Linear Thermal Expansion


The main span of San Francisco’s Golden Gate Bridge is 1275 m long at its coldest. The bridge is exposed to
temperatures ranging from to . What is its change in length between these temperatures?
Assume that the bridge is made entirely of steel.

Strategy
Use the equation for linear thermal expansion to calculate the change in length, . Use the
coefficient of linear expansion for steel from Table 1.2, and note that the change in temperature is

Solution
Substitute all of the known values into the equation to solve for :

Significance
Although not large compared with the length of the bridge, this change in length is observable. It is generally
spread over many expansion joints so that the expansion at each joint is small.

Thermal Expansion in Two and Three Dimensions


Unconstrained objects expand in all dimensions, as illustrated in Figure 1.7. That is, their areas and volumes,
as well as their lengths, increase with temperature. Because the proportions stay the same, holes and
14 1 • Temperature and Heat

container volumes also get larger with temperature. If you cut a hole in a metal plate, the remaining material
will expand exactly as it would if the piece you removed were still in place. The piece would get bigger, so the
hole must get bigger too.

Thermal Expansion in Two Dimensions


For small temperature changes, the change in area is given by
1.3
where is the change in area is the change in temperature, and is the coefficient of linear
expansion, which varies slightly with temperature. (The derivation of this equation is analogous to that of
the more important equation for three dimensions, below.)

Figure 1.7 In general, objects expand in all directions as temperature increases. In these drawings, the original boundaries of the objects
are shown with solid lines, and the expanded boundaries with dashed lines. (a) Area increases because both length and width increase. The
area of a circular plug also increases. (b) If the plug is removed, the hole it leaves becomes larger with increasing temperature, just as if the
expanding plug were still in place. (c) Volume also increases, because all three dimensions increase.

Thermal Expansion in Three Dimensions


The relationship between volume and temperature is given by , where is the coefficient of
volume expansion. As you can show in Exercise 1.60, . This equation is usually written as
1.4
Note that the values of in Table 1.2 are equal to except for rounding.

Volume expansion is defined for liquids, but linear and area expansion are not, as a liquid’s changes in linear
dimensions and area depend on the shape of its container. Thus, Table 1.2 shows liquids’ values of but not .

In general, objects expand with increasing temperature. Water is the most important exception to this rule.
Water does expand with increasing temperature (its density decreases) at temperatures greater than
. However, it is densest at and expands with decreasing temperature between and
( ), as shown in Figure 1.8. A striking effect of this phenomenon is the freezing of water in a
pond. When water near the surface cools down to it is denser than the remaining water and thus sinks to
the bottom. This “turnover” leaves a layer of warmer water near the surface, which is then cooled. However, if
the temperature in the surface layer drops below , that water is less dense than the water below, and thus
stays near the top. As a result, the pond surface can freeze over. The layer of ice insulates the liquid water
below it from low air temperatures. Fish and other aquatic life can survive in water beneath ice, due to
this unusual characteristic of water.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.3 • Thermal Expansion 15

Figure 1.8 This curve shows the density of water as a function of temperature. Note that the thermal expansion at low temperatures is
very small. The maximum density at is only greater than the density at , and greater than that at . The
decrease of density below occurs because the liquid water approachs the solid crystal form of ice, which contains more empty space
than the liquid.

EXAMPLE 1.3

Calculating Thermal Expansion


Suppose your 60.0-L -gal) steel gasoline tank is full of gas that is cool because it has just been
pumped from an underground reservoir. Now, both the tank and the gasoline have a temperature of
How much gasoline has spilled by the time they warm to ?

Strategy
The tank and gasoline increase in volume, but the gasoline increases more, so the amount spilled is the
difference in their volume changes. We can use the equation for volume expansion to calculate the change in
volume of the gasoline and of the tank. (The gasoline tank can be treated as solid steel.)

Solution

1. Use the equation for volume expansion to calculate the increase in volume of the steel tank:

2. The increase in volume of the gasoline is given by this equation:

3. Find the difference in volume to determine the amount spilled as

Alternatively, we can combine these three equations into a single equation. (Note that the original volumes are
equal.)

Significance
This amount is significant, particularly for a 60.0-L tank. The effect is so striking because the gasoline and
steel expand quickly. The rate of change in thermal properties is discussed later in this chapter.
16 1 • Temperature and Heat

If you try to cap the tank tightly to prevent overflow, you will find that it leaks anyway, either around the cap or
by bursting the tank. Tightly constricting the expanding gas is equivalent to compressing it, and both liquids
and solids resist compression with extremely large forces. To avoid rupturing rigid containers, these
containers have air gaps, which allow them to expand and contract without stressing them.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.1


Does a given reading on a gasoline gauge indicate more gasoline in cold weather or in hot weather, or does the
temperature not matter?

Thermal Stress
If you change the temperature of an object while preventing it from expanding or contracting, the object is
subjected to stress that is compressive if the object would expand in the absence of constraint and tensile if it
would contract. This stress resulting from temperature changes is known as thermal stress. It can be quite
large and can cause damage.

To avoid this stress, engineers may design components so they can expand and contract freely. For instance, in
highways, gaps are deliberately left between blocks to prevent thermal stress from developing. When no gaps
can be left, engineers must consider thermal stress in their designs. Thus, the reinforcing rods in concrete are
made of steel because steel’s coefficient of linear expansion is nearly equal to that of concrete.

To calculate the thermal stress in a rod whose ends are both fixed rigidly, we can think of the stress as
developing in two steps. First, let the ends be free to expand (or contract) and find the expansion (or
contraction). Second, find the stress necessary to compress (or extend) the rod to its original length by the
methods you studied in Static Equilibrium and Elasticity on static equilibrium and elasticity. In other words,
the of the thermal expansion equals the of the elastic distortion (except that the signs are opposite).

EXAMPLE 1.4

Calculating Thermal Stress


Concrete blocks are laid out next to each other on a highway without any space between them, so they cannot
expand. The construction crew did the work on a winter day when the temperature was . Find the stress in
the blocks on a hot summer day when the temperature is . The compressive Young’s modulus of concrete
is .

Strategy
According to the chapter on static equilibrium and elasticity, the stress F/A is given by

where Y is the Young’s modulus of the material—concrete, in this case. In thermal expansion,
We combine these two equations by noting that the two are equal, as stated above. Because we are not
given or A, we can obtain a numerical answer only if they both cancel out.

Solution
We substitute the thermal-expansion equation into the elasticity equation to get

and as we hoped, has canceled and A appears only in F/A, the notation for the quantity we are calculating.

Now we need only insert the numbers:

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.4 • Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry 17

Significance
The ultimate compressive strength of concrete is so the blocks are unlikely to break. However,
the ultimate shear strength of concrete is only so some might chip off.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.2


Two objects A and B have the same dimensions and are constrained identically. A is made of a material with a
higher thermal expansion coefficient than B. If the objects are heated identically, will A feel a greater stress
than B?

1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain phenomena involving heat as a form of energy transfer
• Solve problems involving heat transfer

We have seen in previous chapters that energy is one of the fundamental concepts of physics. Heat is a type of
energy transfer that is caused by a temperature difference, and it can change the temperature of an object. As
we learned earlier in this chapter, heat transfer is the movement of energy from one place or material to
another as a result of a difference in temperature. Heat transfer is fundamental to such everyday activities as
home heating and cooking, as well as many industrial processes. It also forms a basis for the topics in the
remainder of this chapter.

We also introduce the concept of internal energy, which can be increased or decreased by heat transfer. We
discuss another way to change the internal energy of a system, namely doing work on it. Thus, we are
beginning the study of the relationship of heat and work, which is the basis of engines and refrigerators and
the central topic (and origin of the name) of thermodynamics.

Internal Energy and Heat


A thermal system has internal energy (also called thermal energy), which is the sum of the mechanical
energies of its molecules. A system’s internal energy is proportional to its temperature. As we saw earlier in
this chapter, if two objects at different temperatures are brought into contact with each other, energy is
transferred from the hotter to the colder object until the bodies reach thermal equilibrium (that is, they are at
the same temperature). No work is done by either object because no force acts through a distance (as we
discussed in Work and Kinetic Energy). These observations reveal that heat is energy transferred
spontaneously due to a temperature difference. Figure 1.9 shows an example of heat transfer.

Figure 1.9 (a) Here, the soft drink has a higher temperature than the ice, so they are not in thermal equilibrium. (b) When the soft drink
and ice are allowed to interact, heat is transferred from the drink to the ice due to the difference in temperatures until they reach the same
18 1 • Temperature and Heat

temperature, , achieving equilibrium. In fact, since the soft drink and ice are both in contact with the surrounding air and the bench, the
ultimate equilibrium temperature will be the same as that of the surroundings.

The meaning of “heat” in physics is different from its ordinary meaning. For example, in conversation, we may
say “the heat was unbearable,” but in physics, we would say that the temperature was high. Heat is a form of
energy flow, whereas temperature is not. Incidentally, humans are sensitive to heat flow rather than to
temperature.

Since heat is a form of energy, its SI unit is the joule (J). Another common unit of energy often used for heat is
the calorie (cal), defined as the energy needed to change the temperature of 1.00 g of water by
—specifically, between and , since there is a slight temperature dependence. Also commonly
used is the kilocalorie (kcal), which is the energy needed to change the temperature of 1.00 kg of water by
. Since mass is most often specified in kilograms, the kilocalorie is convenient. Confusingly, food
calories (sometimes called “big calories,” abbreviated Cal) are actually kilocalories, a fact not easily
determined from package labeling.

Mechanical Equivalent of Heat


It is also possible to change the temperature of a substance by doing work, which transfers energy into or out
of a system. This realization helped establish that heat is a form of energy. James Prescott Joule (1818–1889)
performed many experiments to establish the mechanical equivalent of heat—the work needed to produce
the same effects as heat transfer. In the units used for these two quantities, the value for this equivalence is

We consider this equation to represent the conversion between two units of energy. (Other numbers that you
may see refer to calories defined for temperature ranges other than to .)

Figure 1.10 shows one of Joule’s most famous experimental setups for demonstrating that work and heat can
produce the same effects and measuring the mechanical equivalent of heat. It helped establish the principle of
conservation of energy. Gravitational potential energy (U) was converted into kinetic energy (K), and then
randomized by viscosity and turbulence into increased average kinetic energy of atoms and molecules in the
system, producing a temperature increase. Joule’s contributions to thermodynamics were so significant that
the SI unit of energy was named after him.

Figure 1.10 Joule’s experiment established the equivalence of heat and work. As the masses descended, they caused the paddles to do
work, , on the water. The result was a temperature increase, , measured by the thermometer. Joule found that was

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.4 • Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry 19

proportional to W and thus determined the mechanical equivalent of heat.

Increasing internal energy by heat transfer gives the same result as increasing it by doing work. Therefore,
although a system has a well-defined internal energy, we cannot say that it has a certain “heat content” or
“work content.” A well-defined quantity that depends only on the current state of the system, rather than on
the history of that system, is known as a state variable. Temperature and internal energy are state variables. To
sum up this paragraph, heat and work are not state variables.

Incidentally, increasing the internal energy of a system does not necessarily increase its temperature. As we’ll
see in the next section, the temperature does not change when a substance changes from one phase to another.
An example is the melting of ice, which can be accomplished by adding heat or by doing frictional work, as
when an ice cube is rubbed against a rough surface.

Temperature Change and Heat Capacity


We have noted that heat transfer often causes temperature change. Experiments show that with no phase
change and no work done on or by the system, the transferred heat is typically directly proportional to the
change in temperature and to the mass of the system, to a good approximation. (Below we show how to handle
situations where the approximation is not valid.) The constant of proportionality depends on the substance
and its phase, which may be gas, liquid, or solid. We omit discussion of the fourth phase, plasma, because
although it is the most common phase in the universe, it is rare and short-lived on Earth.

We can understand the experimental facts by noting that the transferred heat is the change in the internal
energy, which is the total energy of the molecules. Under typical conditions, the total kinetic energy of the
molecules is a constant fraction of the internal energy (for reasons and with exceptions that we’ll see in
the next chapter). The average kinetic energy of a molecule is proportional to the absolute temperature.
Therefore, the change in internal energy of a system is typically proportional to the change in temperature and
to the number of molecules, N. Mathematically, The dependence on the
substance results in large part from the different masses of atoms and molecules. We are considering its heat
capacity in terms of its mass, but as we will see in the next chapter, in some cases, heat capacities per molecule
are similar for different substances. The dependence on substance and phase also results from differences in
the potential energy associated with interactions between atoms and molecules.

Heat Transfer and Temperature Change


A practical approximation for the relationship between heat transfer and temperature change is:
1.5
where Q is the symbol for heat transfer (“quantity of heat”), m is the mass of the substance, and is the
change in temperature. The symbol c stands for the specific heat (also called “specific heat capacity”) and
depends on the material and phase. The specific heat is numerically equal to the amount of heat necessary
to change the temperature of kg of mass by . The SI unit for specific heat is or
. (Recall that the temperature change is the same in units of kelvin and degrees Celsius.)

Values of specific heat must generally be measured, because there is no simple way to calculate them
precisely. Table 1.3 lists representative values of specific heat for various substances. We see from this table
that the specific heat of water is five times that of glass and 10 times that of iron, which means that it takes five
times as much heat to raise the temperature of water a given amount as for glass, and 10 times as much as for
iron. In fact, water has one of the largest specific heats of any material, which is important for sustaining life
on Earth.

The specific heats of gases depend on what is maintained constant during the heating—typically either the
volume or the pressure. In the table, the first specific heat value for each gas is measured at constant volume,
and the second (in parentheses) is measured at constant pressure. We will return to this topic in the chapter on
the kinetic theory of gases.
20 1 • Temperature and Heat

Substances Specific Heat (c)

Solids

Aluminum 900 0.215

Asbestos 800 0.19

Concrete, granite (average) 840 0.20

Copper 387 0.0924

Glass 840 0.20

Gold 129 0.0308

Human body (average at ) 3500 0.83

Ice (average, ) 2090 0.50

Iron, steel 452 0.108

Lead 128 0.0305

Silver 235 0.0562

Wood 1700 0.40

Liquids

Benzene 1740 0.415

Ethanol 2450 0.586

Glycerin 2410 0.576

Mercury 139 0.0333

Water 4186 1.000

Gases[3]

Air (dry) 721 (1015) 0.172 (0.242)

Ammonia 1670 (2190) 0.399 (0.523)

Carbon dioxide 638 (833) 0.152 (0.199)

Nitrogen 739 (1040) 0.177 (0.248)

Oxygen 651 (913) 0.156 (0.218)

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.4 • Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry 21

Substances Specific Heat (c)

Steam 1520 (2020) 0.363 (0.482)

Table 1.3 Specific Heats of Various Substances[1] [1]The values for solids and liquids are at constant volume
and , except as noted. [2]These values are identical in units of [3]Specific heats at constant

volume and at except as noted, and at 1.00 atm pressure. Values in parentheses are specific heats at a
constant pressure of 1.00 atm.

In general, specific heat also depends on temperature. Thus, a precise definition of c for a substance must be
given in terms of an infinitesimal change in temperature. To do this, we note that and replace
with d:

Except for gases, the temperature and volume dependence of the specific heat of most substances is weak at
normal temperatures. Therefore, we will generally take specific heats to be constant at the values given in the
table.

EXAMPLE 1.5

Calculating the Required Heat


A 0.500-kg aluminum pan on a stove and 0.250 L of water in it are heated from to . (a) How
much heat is required? What percentage of the heat is used to raise the temperature of (b) the pan and (c) the
water?

Strategy
We can assume that the pan and the water are always at the same temperature. When you put the pan on the
stove, the temperature of the water and that of the pan are increased by the same amount. We use the equation
for the heat transfer for the given temperature change and mass of water and aluminum. The specific heat
values for water and aluminum are given in Table 1.3.

Solution

1. Calculate the temperature difference:

2. Calculate the mass of water. Because the density of water is , 1 L of water has a mass of 1 kg,
and the mass of 0.250 L of water is .
3. Calculate the heat transferred to the water. Use the specific heat of water in Table 1.3:

4. Calculate the heat transferred to the aluminum. Use the specific heat for aluminum in Table 1.3:

5. Find the total transferred heat:

Significance
In this example, the heat transferred to the water is more than the aluminum pan. Although the mass of the
pan is twice that of the water, the specific heat of water is over four times that of aluminum. Therefore, it takes
a bit more than twice as much heat to achieve the given temperature change for the water as for the aluminum
pan.

Example 1.6 illustrates a temperature rise caused by doing work. (The result is the same as if the same amount
22 1 • Temperature and Heat

of energy had been added with a blowtorch instead of mechanically.)

EXAMPLE 1.6

Calculating the Temperature Increase from the Work Done on a Substance


Truck brakes used to control speed on a downhill run do work, converting gravitational potential energy into
increased internal energy (higher temperature) of the brake material (Figure 1.11). This conversion prevents
the gravitational potential energy from being converted into kinetic energy of the truck. Since the mass of the
truck is much greater than that of the brake material absorbing the energy, the temperature increase may
occur too fast for sufficient heat to transfer from the brakes to the environment; in other words, the brakes may
overheat.

Figure 1.11 The smoking brakes on a braking truck are visible evidence of the mechanical equivalent of heat.

Calculate the temperature increase of 10 kg of brake material with an average specific heat of if
the material retains 10% of the energy from a 10,000-kg truck descending 75.0 m (in vertical displacement) at
a constant speed.

Strategy
We calculate the gravitational potential energy (Mgh) that the entire truck loses in its descent, equate it to the
increase in the brakes’ internal energy, and then find the temperature increase produced in the brake material
alone.

Solution
First we calculate the change in gravitational potential energy as the truck goes downhill:

Because the kinetic energy of the truck does not change, conservation of energy tells us the lost potential
energy is dissipated, and we assume that 10% of it is transferred to internal energy of the brakes, so take
. Then we calculate the temperature change from the heat transferred, using

where m is the mass of the brake material. Insert the given values to find

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.4 • Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry 23

Significance
If the truck had been traveling for some time, then just before the descent, the brake temperature would
probably be higher than the ambient temperature. The temperature increase in the descent would likely raise
the temperature of the brake material very high, so this technique is not practical. Instead, the truck would use
the technique of engine braking. A different idea underlies the recent technology of hybrid and electric cars,
where mechanical energy (kinetic and gravitational potential energy) is converted by the brakes into electrical
energy in the battery, a process called regenerative braking.

In a common kind of problem, objects at different temperatures are placed in contact with each other but
isolated from everything else, and they are allowed to come into equilibrium. A container that prevents heat
transfer in or out is called a calorimeter, and the use of a calorimeter to make measurements (typically of heat
or specific heat capacity) is called calorimetry.

We will use the term “calorimetry problem” to refer to any problem in which the objects concerned are
thermally isolated from their surroundings. An important idea in solving calorimetry problems is that during a
heat transfer between objects isolated from their surroundings, the heat gained by the colder object must
equal the heat lost by the hotter object, due to conservation of energy:

1.6

We express this idea by writing that the sum of the heats equals zero because the heat gained is usually
considered positive; the heat lost, negative.

EXAMPLE 1.7

Calculating the Final Temperature in Calorimetry


Suppose you pour 0.250 kg of water (about a cup) into a 0.500-kg aluminum pan off the stove with a
temperature of . Assume no heat transfer takes place to anything else: The pan is placed on an insulated
pad, and heat transfer to the air is neglected in the short time needed to reach equilibrium. Thus, this is a
calorimetry problem, even though no isolating container is specified. Also assume that a negligible amount of
water boils off. What is the temperature when the water and pan reach thermal equilibrium?

Strategy
Originally, the pan and water are not in thermal equilibrium: The pan is at a higher temperature than the
water. Heat transfer restores thermal equilibrium once the water and pan are in contact; it stops once thermal
equilibrium between the pan and the water is achieved. The heat lost by the pan is equal to the heat gained by
the water—that is the basic principle of calorimetry.

Solution

1. Use the equation for heat transfer to express the heat lost by the aluminum pan in terms of the
mass of the pan, the specific heat of aluminum, the initial temperature of the pan, and the final
temperature:

2. Express the heat gained by the water in terms of the mass of the water, the specific heat of water, the initial
temperature of the water, and the final temperature:

3. Note that and and that as stated above, they must sum to zero:

4. Bring all terms involving on the left hand side and all other terms on the right hand side. Solving for
24 1 • Temperature and Heat

and insert the numerical values:

Significance
Why is the final temperature so much closer to than to ? The reason is that water has a greater
specific heat than most common substances and thus undergoes a smaller temperature change for a given
heat transfer. A large body of water, such as a lake, requires a large amount of heat to increase its temperature
appreciably. This explains why the temperature of a lake stays relatively constant during the day even when
the temperature change of the air is large. However, the water temperature does change over longer times (e.g.,
summer to winter).

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.3


If 25 kJ is necessary to raise the temperature of a rock from how much heat is necessary to heat
the rock from ?

EXAMPLE 1.8

Temperature-Dependent Heat Capacity


At low temperatures, the specific heats of solids are typically proportional to . The first understanding of
this behavior was due to the Dutch physicist Peter Debye, who in 1912, treated atomic oscillations with the
quantum theory that Max Planck had recently used for radiation. For instance, a good approximation for the
specific heat of salt, NaCl, is The constant 321 K is called the Debye
temperature of NaCl, and the formula works well when Using this formula, how much heat is
required to raise the temperature of 24.0 g of NaCl from 5 K to 15 K?

Solution
Because the heat capacity depends on the temperature, we need to use the equation

We solve this equation for Q by integrating both sides:

Then we substitute the given values in and evaluate the integral:

Significance
If we had used the equation and the room-temperature specific heat of salt, we would
have gotten a very different value.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.5 • Phase Changes 25

1.5 Phase Changes


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe phase transitions and equilibrium between phases
• Solve problems involving latent heat
• Solve calorimetry problems involving phase changes

Phase transitions play an important theoretical and practical role in the study of heat flow. In melting (or
“fusion”), a solid turns into a liquid; the opposite process is freezing. In evaporation, a liquid turns into a gas;
the opposite process is condensation.

A substance melts or freezes at a temperature called its melting point, and boils (evaporates rapidly) or
condenses at its boiling point. These temperatures depend on pressure. High pressure favors the denser form,
so typically, high pressure raises the melting point and boiling point, and low pressure lowers them. For
example, the boiling point of water is at 1.00 atm. At higher pressure, the boiling point is higher, and at
lower pressure, it is lower. The main exception is the melting and freezing of water, discussed in the next
section.

Phase Diagrams
The phase of a given substance depends on the pressure and temperature. Thus, plots of pressure versus
temperature showing the phase in each region provide considerable insight into thermal properties of
substances. Such a pT graph is called a phase diagram.

Figure 1.12 shows the phase diagram for water. Using the graph, if you know the pressure and temperature,
you can determine the phase of water. The solid curves—boundaries between phases—indicate phase
transitions, that is, temperatures and pressures at which the phases coexist. For example, the boiling point of
water is at 1.00 atm. As the pressure increases, the boiling temperature rises gradually to at a
pressure of 218 atm. A pressure cooker (or even a covered pot) cooks food faster than an open pot, because the
water can exist as a liquid at temperatures greater than without all boiling away. (As we’ll see in the
next section, liquid water conducts heat better than steam or hot air.) The boiling point curve ends at a certain
point called the critical point—that is, a critical temperature, above which the liquid and gas phases cannot
be distinguished; the substance is called a supercritical fluid. At sufficiently high pressure above the critical
point, the gas has the density of a liquid but does not condense. Carbon dioxide, for example, is supercritical at
all temperatures above . Critical pressure is the pressure of the critical point.

Figure 1.12 The phase diagram (pT graph) for water shows solid (s), liquid (l), and vapor (v) phases. At temperatures and pressure above
26 1 • Temperature and Heat

those of the critical point, there is no distinction between liquid and vapor. Note that the axes are nonlinear and the graph is not to scale.
This graph is simplified—it omits several exotic phases of ice at higher pressures. The phase diagram of water is unusual because the
melting-point curve has a negative slope, showing that you can melt ice by increasing the pressure.

Similarly, the curve between the solid and liquid regions in Figure 1.12 gives the melting temperature at
various pressures. For example, the melting point is at 1.00 atm, as expected. Water has the unusual
property that ice is less dense than liquid water at the melting point, so at a fixed temperature, you can change
the phase from solid (ice) to liquid (water) by increasing the pressure. That is, the melting temperature of ice
falls with increased pressure, as the phase diagram shows. For example, when a car is driven over snow, the
increased pressure from the tires melts the snowflakes; afterwards, the water refreezes and forms an ice layer.

As you learned in the earlier section on thermometers and temperature scales, the triple point is the
combination of temperature and pressure at which ice, liquid water, and water vapor can coexist stably—that
is, all three phases exist in equilibrium. For water, the triple point occurs at and 611.2 Pa;
that is a more accurate calibration temperature than the melting point of water at 1.00 atm, or
.

INTERACTIVE
View this video (https://openstax.org/l/21triplepoint) to see a substance at its triple point.

At pressures below that of the triple point, there is no liquid phase; the substance can exist as either gas or
solid. For water, there is no liquid phase at pressures below 0.00600 atm. The phase change from solid to gas is
called sublimation. You may have noticed that snow can disappear into thin air without a trace of liquid water,
or that ice cubes can disappear in a freezer. Both are examples of sublimation. The reverse also happens: Frost
can form on very cold windows without going through the liquid stage. Figure 1.13 shows the result, as well as
showing a familiar example of sublimation. Carbon dioxide has no liquid phase at atmospheric pressure. Solid
is known as dry ice because instead of melting, it sublimes. Its sublimation temperature at atmospheric
pressure is . Certain air fresheners use the sublimation of a solid to spread a perfume around a room.
Some solids, such as osmium tetroxide, are so toxic that they must be kept in sealed containers to prevent
human exposure to their sublimation-produced vapors.

Figure 1.13 Direct transitions between solid and vapor are common, sometimes useful, and even beautiful. (a) Dry ice sublimes directly
to carbon dioxide gas. The visible “smoke” consists of water droplets that condensed in the air cooled by the dry ice. (b) Frost forms
patterns on a very cold window, an example of a solid formed directly from a vapor. (credit a: modification of work by Windell Oskay; credit
b: modification of work by Liz West)

Equilibrium
At the melting temperature, the solid and liquid phases are in equilibrium. If heat is added, some of the solid
will melt, and if heat is removed, some of the liquid will freeze. The situation is somewhat more complex for

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.5 • Phase Changes 27

liquid-gas equilibrium. Generally, liquid and gas are in equilibrium at any temperature. We call the gas phase a
vapor when it exists at a temperature below the boiling temperature, as it does for water at . Liquid in a
closed container at a fixed temperature evaporates until the pressure of the gas reaches a certain value, called
the vapor pressure, which depends on the gas and the temperature. At this equilibrium, if heat is added, some
of the liquid will evaporate, and if heat is removed, some of the gas will condense; molecules either join the
liquid or form suspended droplets. If there is not enough liquid for the gas to reach the vapor pressure in the
container, all the liquid eventually evaporates.

If the vapor pressure of the liquid is greater than the total ambient pressure, including that of any air (or other
gas), the liquid evaporates rapidly; in other words, it boils. Thus, the boiling point of a liquid at a given pressure
is the temperature at which its vapor pressure equals the ambient pressure. Liquid and gas phases are in
equilibrium at the boiling temperature (Figure 1.14). If a substance is in a closed container at the boiling point,
then the liquid is boiling and the gas is condensing at the same rate without net change in their amounts.

Figure 1.14 Equilibrium between liquid and gas at two different boiling points inside a closed container. (a) The rates of boiling and
condensation are equal at this combination of temperature and pressure, so the liquid and gas phases are in equilibrium. (b) At a higher
temperature, the boiling rate is faster, that is, the rate at which molecules leave the liquid and enter the gas is faster. This increases the
number of molecules in the gas, which increases the gas pressure, which in turn increases the rate at which gas molecules condense and
enter the liquid. The pressure stops increasing when it reaches the point where the boiling rate and the condensation rate are equal. The
gas and liquid are in equilibrium again at this higher temperature and pressure.

For water, is the boiling point at 1.00 atm, so water and steam should exist in equilibrium under these
conditions. Why does an open pot of water at boil completely away? The gas surrounding an open pot is
not pure water: it is mixed with air. If pure water and steam are in a closed container at and 1.00 atm,
they will coexist—but with air over the pot, there are fewer water molecules to condense, and water boils away.
Another way to see this is that at the boiling point, the vapor pressure equals the ambient pressure. However,
part of the ambient pressure is due to air, so the pressure of the steam is less than the vapor pressure at that
temperature, and evaporation continues. Incidentally, the equilibrium vapor pressure of solids is not zero, a
fact that accounts for sublimation.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.4


Explain why a cup of water (or soda) with ice cubes stays at even on a hot summer day.

Phase Change and Latent Heat


So far, we have discussed heat transfers that cause temperature change. However, in a phase transition, heat
28 1 • Temperature and Heat

transfer does not cause any temperature change.

For an example of phase changes, consider the addition of heat to a sample of ice at (Figure 1.15) and
atmospheric pressure. The temperature of the ice rises linearly, absorbing heat at a constant rate of
until it reaches Once at this temperature, the ice begins to melt and continues until it has
all melted, absorbing 333 kJ/kg of heat. The temperature remains constant at during this phase change.
Once all the ice has melted, the temperature of the liquid water rises, absorbing heat at a new constant rate of
At the water begins to boil. The temperature again remains constant during this phase
change while the water absorbs 2256 kJ/kg of heat and turns into steam. When all the liquid has become
steam, the temperature rises again, absorbing heat at a rate of . If we started with steam and
cooled it to make it condense into liquid water and freeze into ice, the process would exactly reverse, with the
temperature again constant during each phase transition.

Figure 1.15 Temperature versus heat. The system is constructed so that no vapor evaporates while ice warms to become liquid water,
and so that, when vaporization occurs, the vapor remains in the system. The long stretches of constant temperatures at and
reflect the large amounts of heat needed to cause melting and vaporization, respectively.

Where does the heat added during melting or boiling go, considering that the temperature does not change
until the transition is complete? Energy is required to melt a solid, because the attractive forces between the
molecules in the solid must be broken apart, so that in the liquid, the molecules can move around at
comparable kinetic energies; thus, there is no rise in temperature. Energy is needed to vaporize a liquid for
similar reasons. Conversely, work is done by attractive forces when molecules are brought together during
freezing and condensation. That energy must be transferred out of the system, usually in the form of heat, to
allow the molecules to stay together (Figure 1.18). Thus, condensation occurs in association with cold
objects—the glass in Figure 1.16, for example.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.5 • Phase Changes 29

Figure 1.16 Condensation forms on this glass of iced tea because the temperature of the nearby air is reduced. The air cannot hold as
much water as it did at room temperature, so water condenses. Energy is released when the water condenses, speeding the melting of the
ice in the glass. (credit: Jenny Downing)

The energy released when a liquid freezes is used by orange growers when the temperature approaches .
Growers spray water on the trees so that the water freezes and heat is released to the growing oranges. This
prevents the temperature inside the orange from dropping below freezing, which would damage the fruit
(Figure 1.17).

Figure 1.17 The ice on these trees released large amounts of energy when it froze, helping to prevent the temperature of the trees from
dropping below . Water is intentionally sprayed on orchards to help prevent hard frosts. (credit: Hermann Hammer)

The energy involved in a phase change depends on the number of bonds or force pairs and their strength. The
number of bonds is proportional to the number of molecules and thus to the mass of the sample. The energy
per unit mass required to change a substance from the solid phase to the liquid phase, or released when the
substance changes from liquid to solid, is known as the heat of fusion. The energy per unit mass required to
change a substance from the liquid phase to the vapor phase is known as the heat of vaporization. The
strength of the forces depends on the type of molecules. The heat Q absorbed or released in a phase change in
a sample of mass m is given by

1.7

1.8

where the latent heat of fusion and latent heat of vaporization are material constants that are
determined experimentally. (Latent heats are also called latent heat coefficients and heats of transformation.)
30 1 • Temperature and Heat

These constants are “latent,” or hidden, because in phase changes, energy enters or leaves a system without
causing a temperature change in the system, so in effect, the energy is hidden.

Figure 1.18 (a) Energy is required to partially overcome the attractive forces (modeled as springs) between molecules in a solid to form a
liquid. That same energy must be removed from the liquid for freezing to take place. (b) Molecules become separated by large distances
when going from liquid to vapor, requiring significant energy to completely overcome molecular attraction. The same energy must be
removed from the vapor for condensation to take place.

Table 1.4 lists representative values of and in kJ/kg, together with melting and boiling points. Note that
in general, . The table shows that the amounts of energy involved in phase changes can easily be
comparable to or greater than those involved in temperature changes, as Figure 1.15 and the accompanying
discussion also showed.

Substance Melting Point kJ/kg kcal/kg Boiling Point kJ/kg kcal/kg

Helium[2] 5.23 1.25 20.9 4.99

Hydrogen 58.6 14.0 452 108

Nitrogen 25.5 6.09 201 48.0

Oxygen 13.8 3.30 213 50.9

Ethanol –114 104 24.9 78.3 854 204

Ammonia –75 332 79.3 –33.4 1370 327

Mercury –38.9 11.8 2.82 357 272 65.0

Water 0.00 334 79.8 100.0 2256[3] 539[4]

Sulfur 119 38.1 9.10 444.6 326 77.9

Lead 327 24.5 5.85 1750 871 208

Antimony 631 165 39.4 1440 561 134

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.5 • Phase Changes 31

Aluminum 660 380 90 2450 11400 2720

Silver 961 88.3 21.1 2193 2336 558

Gold 1063 64.5 15.4 2660 1578 377

Copper 1083 134 32.0 2595 5069 1211

Uranium 1133 84 20 3900 1900 454

Tungsten 3410 184 44 5900 4810 1150

Table 1.4 Heats of Fusion and Vaporization[1] [1]Values quoted at the normal melting and boiling temperatures
at standard atmospheric pressure ( ). [2]Helium has no solid phase at atmospheric pressure. The melting
[3]
point given is at a pressure of 2.5 MPa. At (body temperature), the heat of vaporization for water is
2430 kJ/kg or 580 kcal/kg. [4]At (body temperature), the heat of vaporization, for water is 2430 kJ/
kg or 580 kcal/kg.

Phase changes can have a strong stabilizing effect on temperatures that are not near the melting and boiling
points, since evaporation and condensation occur even at temperatures below the boiling point. For example,
air temperatures in humid climates rarely go above approximately because most heat transfer goes
into evaporating water into the air. Similarly, temperatures in humid weather rarely fall below the dew
point—the temperature where condensation occurs given the concentration of water vapor in the air—because
so much heat is released when water vapor condenses.

More energy is required to evaporate water below the boiling point than at the boiling point, because the
kinetic energy of water molecules at temperatures below is less than that at , so less energy is
available from random thermal motions. For example, at body temperature, evaporation of sweat from the skin
requires a heat input of 2428 kJ/kg, which is about 10% higher than the latent heat of vaporization at .
This heat comes from the skin, and this evaporative cooling effect of sweating helps reduce the body
temperature in hot weather. However, high humidity inhibits evaporation, so that body temperature might rise,
while unevaporated sweat might be left on your brow.

EXAMPLE 1.9

Calculating Final Temperature from Phase Change


Three ice cubes are used to chill a soda at with mass . The ice is at and each ice cube
has a mass of 6.0 g. Assume that the soda is kept in a foam container so that heat loss can be ignored and that
the soda has the same specific heat as water. Find the final temperature when all ice has melted.

Strategy
The ice cubes are at the melting temperature of Heat is transferred from the soda to the ice for melting.
Melting yields water at so more heat is transferred from the soda to this water until the water plus soda
system reaches thermal equilibrium.

The heat transferred to the ice is

The heat given off by the soda is


32 1 • Temperature and Heat

Since no heat is lost, as in Example 1.7, so that

Solve for the unknown quantity :

Solution
First we identify the known quantities. The mass of ice is and the mass of soda is
Then we calculate the final temperature:

Significance
This example illustrates the large energies involved during a phase change. The mass of ice is about 7% of the
mass of the soda but leads to a noticeable change in the temperature of the soda. Although we assumed that
the ice was at the freezing temperature, this is unrealistic for ice straight out of a freezer: The typical
temperature is . However, this correction makes no significant change from the result we found. Can you
explain why?

Like solid-liquid and liquid-vapor transitions, direct solid-vapor transitions or sublimations involve heat. The
energy transferred is given by the equation , where is the heat of sublimation, analogous to
and . The heat of sublimation at a given temperature is equal to the heat of fusion plus the heat of
vaporization at that temperature.

We can now calculate any number of effects related to temperature and phase change. In each case, it is
necessary to identify which temperature and phase changes are taking place. Keep in mind that heat transfer
and work can cause both temperature and phase changes.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

The Effects of Heat Transfer


1. Examine the situation to determine that there is a change in the temperature or phase. Is there heat
transfer into or out of the system? When it is not obvious whether a phase change occurs or not, you may
wish to first solve the problem as if there were no phase changes, and examine the temperature change
obtained. If it is sufficient to take you past a boiling or melting point, you should then go back and do the
problem in steps—temperature change, phase change, subsequent temperature change, and so on.
2. Identify and list all objects that change temperature or phase.
3. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknowns). A written list is
useful.
4. Make a list of what is given or what can be inferred from the problem as stated (identify the knowns). If
there is a temperature change, the transferred heat depends on the specific heat of the substance (Heat
Transfer, Specific Heat, and Calorimetry), and if there is a phase change, the transferred heat depends on
the latent heat of the substance (Table 1.4).
5. Solve the appropriate equation for the quantity to be determined (the unknown).
6. Substitute the knowns along with their units into the appropriate equation and obtain numerical solutions
complete with units. You may need to do this in steps if there is more than one state to the process, such as
a temperature change followed by a phase change. However, in a calorimetry problem, each step
corresponds to a term in the single equation .
7. Check the answer to see if it is reasonable. Does it make sense? As an example, be certain that any
temperature change does not also cause a phase change that you have not taken into account.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 33

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.5


Why does snow often remain even when daytime temperatures are higher than the freezing temperature?

1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain some phenomena that involve conductive, convective, and radiative heat transfer
• Solve problems on the relationships between heat transfer, time, and rate of heat transfer
• Solve problems using the formulas for conduction and radiation

Just as interesting as the effects of heat transfer on a system are the methods by which it occurs. Whenever
there is a temperature difference, heat transfer occurs. It may occur rapidly, as through a cooking pan, or
slowly, as through the walls of a picnic ice chest. So many processes involve heat transfer that it is hard to
imagine a situation where no heat transfer occurs. Yet every heat transfer takes place by only three methods:

1. Conduction is heat transfer through stationary matter by physical contact. (The matter is stationary on a
macroscopic scale—we know that thermal motion of the atoms and molecules occurs at any temperature
above absolute zero.) Heat transferred from the burner of a stove through the bottom of a pan to food in the
pan is transferred by conduction.
2. Convection is the heat transfer by the macroscopic movement of a fluid. This type of transfer takes place
in a forced-air furnace and in weather systems, for example.
3. Heat transfer by radiation occurs when microwaves, infrared radiation, visible light, or another form of
electromagnetic radiation is emitted or absorbed. An obvious example is the warming of Earth by the Sun.
A less obvious example is thermal radiation from the human body.

In the illustration at the beginning of this chapter, the fire warms the snowshoers’ faces largely by radiation.
Convection carries some heat to them, but most of the air flow from the fire is upward (creating the familiar
shape of flames), carrying heat to the food being cooked and into the sky. The snowshoers wear clothes
designed with low conductivity to prevent heat flow out of their bodies.

In this section, we examine these methods in some detail. Each method has unique and interesting
characteristics, but all three have two things in common: They transfer heat solely because of a temperature
difference, and the greater the temperature difference, the faster the heat transfer (Figure 1.19).
34 1 • Temperature and Heat

Figure 1.19 In a fireplace, heat transfer occurs by all three methods: conduction, convection, and radiation. Radiation is responsible for
most of the heat transferred into the room. Heat transfer also occurs through conduction into the room, but much slower. Heat transfer by
convection also occurs through cold air entering the room around windows and hot air leaving the room by rising up the chimney.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.6


Name an example from daily life (different from the text) for each mechanism of heat transfer.

Conduction
As you walk barefoot across the living room carpet in a cold house and then step onto the kitchen tile floor,
your feet feel colder on the tile. This result is intriguing, since the carpet and tile floor are both at the same
temperature. The different sensation is explained by the different rates of heat transfer: The heat loss is faster
for skin in contact with the tiles than with the carpet, so the sensation of cold is more intense.

Some materials conduct thermal energy faster than others. Figure 1.20 shows a material that conducts heat
slowly—it is a good thermal insulator, or poor heat conductor—used to reduce heat flow into and out of a house.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 35

Figure 1.20 Insulation is used to limit the conduction of heat from the inside to the outside (in winter) and from the outside to the inside
(in summer). (credit: Giles Douglas)

A molecular picture of heat conduction will help justify the equation that describes it. Figure 1.21 shows
molecules in two bodies at different temperatures, and for “hot” and “cold.” The average kinetic energy
of a molecule in the hot body is higher than in the colder body. If two molecules collide, energy transfers from
the high-energy to the low-energy molecule. In a metal, the picture would also include free valence electrons
colliding with each other and with atoms, likewise transferring energy. The cumulative effect of all collisions is
a net flux of heat from the hotter body to the colder body. Thus, the rate of heat transfer increases with
increasing temperature difference If the temperatures are the same, the net heat transfer rate
is zero. Because the number of collisions increases with increasing area, heat conduction is proportional to the
cross-sectional area—a second factor in the equation.

Figure 1.21 Molecules in two bodies at different temperatures have different average kinetic energies. Collisions occurring at the contact
surface tend to transfer energy from high-temperature regions to low-temperature regions. In this illustration, a molecule in the lower-
temperature region (right side) has low energy before collision, but its energy increases after colliding with a high-energy molecule at the
contact surface. In contrast, a molecule in the higher-temperature region (left side) has high energy before collision, but its energy
36 1 • Temperature and Heat

decreases after colliding with a low-energy molecule at the contact surface.

A third quantity that affects the conduction rate is the thickness of the material through which heat transfers.
Figure 1.22 shows a slab of material with a higher temperature on the left than on the right. Heat transfers
from the left to the right by a series of molecular collisions. The greater the distance between hot and cold, the
more time the material takes to transfer the same amount of heat.

Figure 1.22 Heat conduction occurs through any material, represented here by a rectangular bar, whether window glass or walrus
blubber.

All four of these quantities appear in a simple equation deduced from and confirmed by experiments. The rate
of conductive heat transfer through a slab of material, such as the one in Figure 1.22, is given by

1.9

where P is the power or rate of heat transfer in watts or in kilocalories per second, A and d are its surface area
and thickness, as shown in Figure 1.22, is the temperature difference across the slab, and k is the
thermal conductivity of the material. Table 1.5 gives representative values of thermal conductivity.

More generally, we can write

where x is the coordinate in the direction of heat flow. Since in Figure 1.22, the power and area are constant,
dT/dx is constant, and the temperature decreases linearly from to

Substance Thermal Conductivity k

Diamond 2000

Silver 420

Copper 390

Gold 318

Aluminum 220

Steel iron 80

Steel (stainless) 14

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 37

Substance Thermal Conductivity k

Ice 2.2

Glass (average) 0.84

Concrete brick 0.84

Water 0.6

Fatty tissue (without blood) 0.2

Asbestos 0.16

Plasterboard 0.16

Wood 0.08–0.16

Snow (dry) 0.10

Cork 0.042

Glass wool 0.042

Wool 0.04

Down feathers 0.025

Air 0.023

Polystyrene foam 0.010

Table 1.5 Thermal Conductivities of Common Substances Values are given for temperatures near .

EXAMPLE 1.10

Calculating Heat Transfer through Conduction


A polystyrene foam icebox has a total area of and walls with an average thickness of 2.50 cm. The box
contains ice, water, and canned beverages at The inside of the box is kept cold by melting ice. How much
ice melts in one day if the icebox is kept in the trunk of a car at ?

Strategy
This question involves both heat for a phase change (melting of ice) and the transfer of heat by conduction. To
find the amount of ice melted, we must find the net heat transferred. This value can be obtained by calculating
the rate of heat transfer by conduction and multiplying by time.

Solution
First we identify the knowns.

for polystyrene foam; ; ;


38 1 • Temperature and Heat

Then we identify the unknowns. We need to solve for the mass of the ice, m. We also need to solve for the net
heat transferred to melt the ice, Q. The rate of heat transfer by conduction is given by

The heat used to melt the ice is .We insert the known values:

Multiplying the rate of heat transfer by the time we obtain

We set this equal to the heat transferred to melt the ice, and solve for the mass m:

Significance
The result of 3.44 kg, or about 7.6 lb, seems about right, based on experience. You might expect to use about a
4 kg (7–10 lb) bag of ice per day. A little extra ice is required if you add any warm food or beverages.

Table 1.5 shows that polystyrene foam is a very poor conductor and thus a good insulator. Other good
insulators include fiberglass, wool, and goosedown feathers. Like polystyrene foam, these all contain many
small pockets of air, taking advantage of air’s poor thermal conductivity.

In developing insulation, the smaller the conductivity k and the larger the thickness d, the better. Thus, the
ratio d/k, called the R factor, is large for a good insulator. The rate of conductive heat transfer is inversely
proportional to R. R factors are most commonly quoted for household insulation, refrigerators, and the like.
Unfortunately, in the United States, R is still in non-metric units of , although the unit usually
goes unstated [1 British thermal unit (Btu) is the amount of energy needed to change the temperature of 1.0 lb
of water by , which is 1055.1 J]. A couple of representative values are an R factor of 11 for 3.5-inch-thick
fiberglass batts (pieces) of insulation and an R factor of 19 for 6.5-inch-thick fiberglass batts (Figure 1.23). In
the US, walls are usually insulated with 3.5-inch batts, whereas ceilings are usually insulated with 6.5-inch
batts. In cold climates, thicker batts may be used.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 39

Figure 1.23 The fiberglass batt is used for insulation of walls and ceilings to prevent heat transfer between the inside of the building and
the outside environment. (credit: Tracey Nicholls)

Note that in Table 1.5, most of the best thermal conductors—silver, copper, gold, and aluminum—are also the
best electrical conductors, because they contain many free electrons that can transport thermal energy.
(Diamond, an electrical insulator, conducts heat by atomic vibrations.) Cooking utensils are typically made
from good conductors, but the handles of those used on the stove are made from good insulators (bad
conductors).

EXAMPLE 1.11

Two Conductors End to End


A steel rod and an aluminum rod, each of diameter 1.00 cm and length 25.0 cm, are welded end to end. One
end of the steel rod is placed in a large tank of boiling water at , while the far end of the aluminum rod is
placed in a large tank of water at . The rods are insulated so that no heat escapes from their surfaces.
What is the temperature at the joint, and what is the rate of heat conduction through this composite rod?

Strategy
The heat that enters the steel rod from the boiling water has no place to go but through the steel rod, then
through the aluminum rod, to the cold water. Therefore, we can equate the rate of conduction through the steel
to the rate of conduction through the aluminum.

We repeat the calculation with a second method, in which we use the thermal resistance R of the rod, since it
simply adds when two rods are joined end to end. (We will use a similar method in the chapter on direct-
current circuits.)

Solution

1. Identify the knowns and convert them to SI units.


The length of each rod is the cross-sectional area of each rod is
the thermal conductivity of aluminum is , the
thermal conductivity of steel is , the temperature at the hot end is , and the
temperature at the cold end is .
40 1 • Temperature and Heat

2. Calculate the heat-conduction rate through the steel rod and the heat-conduction rate through the
aluminum rod in terms of the unknown temperature T at the joint:

3. Set the two rates equal and solve for the unknown temperature:

4. Calculate either rate:

5. If desired, check your answer by calculating the other rate.

Solution

1. Recall that . Now


2. We know that . We also know that and we denote
that rate of heat flow by P. Combine the equations:

Thus, we can simply add R factors. Now, .

3. Find the from the known quantities:

and

4. Substitute these values in to find as before.


5. Determine for the aluminum rod (or for the steel rod) and use it to find T at the joint.

so , as in Solution .
6. If desired, check by determining for the other rod.

Significance
In practice, adding R values is common, as in calculating the R value of an insulated wall. In the analogous
situation in electronics, the resistance corresponds to AR in this problem and is additive even when the areas
are unequal, as is common in electronics. Our equation for heat conduction can be used only when the areas
are equal; otherwise, we would have a problem in three-dimensional heat flow, which is beyond our scope.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.7


How does the rate of heat transfer by conduction change when all spatial dimensions are doubled?

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 41

Conduction is caused by the random motion of atoms and molecules. As such, it is an ineffective mechanism
for heat transport over macroscopic distances and short times. For example, the temperature on Earth would
be unbearably cold during the night and extremely hot during the day if heat transport in the atmosphere were
only through conduction. Also, car engines would overheat unless there was a more efficient way to remove
excess heat from the pistons. The next module discusses the important heat-transfer mechanism in such
situations.

Convection
In convection, thermal energy is carried by the large-scale flow of matter. It can be divided into two types. In
forced convection, the flow is driven by fans, pumps, and the like. A simple example is a fan that blows air past
you in hot surroundings and cools you by replacing the air heated by your body with cooler air. A more
complicated example is the cooling system of a typical car, in which a pump moves coolant through the
radiator and engine to cool the engine and a fan blows air to cool the radiator.

In free or natural convection, the flow is driven by buoyant forces: hot fluid rises and cold fluid sinks because
density decreases as temperature increases. The house in Figure 1.24 is kept warm by natural convection, as is
the pot of water on the stove in Figure 1.25. Ocean currents and large-scale atmospheric circulation, which
result from the buoyancy of warm air and water, transfer hot air from the tropics toward the poles and cold air
from the poles toward the tropics. (Earth’s rotation interacts with those flows, causing the observed eastward
flow of air in the temperate zones.)

Figure 1.24 Air heated by a so-called gravity furnace expands and rises, forming a convective loop that transfers energy to other parts of
the room. As the air is cooled at the ceiling and outside walls, it contracts, eventually becoming denser than room air and sinking to the
floor. A properly designed heating system using natural convection, like this one, can heat a home quite efficiently.

Figure 1.25 Natural convection plays an important role in heat transfer inside this pot of water. Once conducted to the inside, heat
42 1 • Temperature and Heat

transfer to other parts of the pot is mostly by convection. The hotter water expands, decreases in density, and rises to transfer heat to other
regions of the water, while colder water sinks to the bottom. This process keeps repeating.

INTERACTIVE
Natural convection like that of Figure 1.24 and Figure 1.25, but acting on rock in Earth’s mantle, drives plate
tectonics (https://openstax.org/l/21platetecton) that are the motions that have shaped Earth’s surface.

Convection is usually more complicated than conduction. Beyond noting that the convection rate is often
approximately proportional to the temperature difference, we will not do any quantitative work comparable to
the formula for conduction. However, we can describe convection qualitatively and relate convection rates to
heat and time. Air is a poor conductor, so convection dominates heat transfer by air. Therefore, the amount of
available space for airflow determines whether air transfers heat rapidly or slowly. There is little heat transfer
in a space filled with air with a small amount of other material that prevents flow. The space between the inside
and outside walls of a typical American house, for example, is about 9 cm (3.5 in.)—large enough for convection
to work effectively. The addition of wall insulation prevents airflow, so heat loss (or gain) is decreased. On the
other hand, the gap between the two panes of a double-paned window is about 1 cm, which largely prevents
convection and takes advantage of air’s low conductivity reduce heat loss. Fur, cloth, and fiberglass also take
advantage of the low conductivity of air by trapping it in spaces too small to support convection (Figure 1.26).

Figure 1.26 Fur is filled with air, breaking it up into many small pockets. Convection is very slow here, because the loops are so small. The
low conductivity of air makes fur a very good lightweight insulator.

Some interesting phenomena happen when convection is accompanied by a phase change. The combination
allows us to cool off by sweating even if the temperature of the surrounding air exceeds body temperature.
Heat from the skin is required for sweat to evaporate from the skin, but without air flow, the air becomes
saturated and evaporation stops. Air flow caused by convection replaces the saturated air by dry air and
evaporation continues.

EXAMPLE 1.12

Calculating the Flow of Mass during Convection


The average person produces heat at the rate of about 120 W when at rest. At what rate must water evaporate
from the body to get rid of all this energy? (For simplicity, we assume this evaporation occurs when a person is
sitting in the shade and surrounding temperatures are the same as skin temperature, eliminating heat transfer
by other methods.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 43

Strategy
Energy is needed for this phase change ( ). Thus, the energy loss per unit time is

We divide both sides of the equation by to find that the mass evaporated per unit time is

Solution
Insert the value of the latent heat from Table 1.4, . This yields

Significance
Evaporating about 3 g/min seems reasonable. This would be about 180 g (about 7 oz.) per hour. If the air is very
dry, the sweat may evaporate without even being noticed. A significant amount of evaporation also takes place
in the lungs and breathing passages.

Another important example of the combination of phase change and convection occurs when water evaporates
from the oceans. Heat is removed from the ocean when water evaporates. If the water vapor condenses in
liquid droplets as clouds form, possibly far from the ocean, heat is released in the atmosphere. Thus, there is
an overall transfer of heat from the ocean to the atmosphere. This process is the driving power behind
thunderheads, those great cumulus clouds that rise as much as 20.0 km into the stratosphere (Figure 1.27).
Water vapor carried in by convection condenses, releasing tremendous amounts of energy. This energy causes
the air to expand and rise to colder altitudes. More condensation occurs in these regions, which in turn drives
the cloud even higher. This mechanism is an example of positive feedback, since the process reinforces and
accelerates itself. It sometimes produces violent storms, with lightning and hail. The same mechanism drives
hurricanes.

INTERACTIVE
This time-lapse video (https://openstax.org/l/21convthuncurr) shows convection currents in a thunderstorm,
including “rolling” motion similar to that of boiling water.

Figure 1.27 Cumulus clouds are caused by water vapor that rises because of convection. The rise of clouds is driven by a positive
feedback mechanism. (credit: “Amada44”/Wikimedia Commons)

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.8


44 1 • Temperature and Heat

Explain why using a fan in the summer feels refreshing.

Radiation
You can feel the heat transfer from the Sun. The space between Earth and the Sun is largely empty, so the Sun
warms us without any possibility of heat transfer by convection or conduction. Similarly, you can sometimes
tell that the oven is hot without touching its door or looking inside—it may just warm you as you walk by. In
these examples, heat is transferred by radiation (Figure 1.28). That is, the hot body emits electromagnetic
waves that are absorbed by the skin. No medium is required for electromagnetic waves to propagate. Different
names are used for electromagnetic waves of different wavelengths: radio waves, microwaves, infrared
radiation, visible light, ultraviolet radiation, X-rays, and gamma rays.

Figure 1.28 Most of the heat transfer from this fire to the observers occurs through infrared radiation. The visible light, although dramatic,
transfers relatively little thermal energy. Convection transfers energy away from the observers as hot air rises, while conduction is negligibly
slow here. Skin is very sensitive to infrared radiation, so you can sense the presence of a fire without looking at it directly. (credit: Daniel
O’Neil)

The energy of electromagnetic radiation varies over a wide range, depending on the wavelength: A shorter
wavelength (or higher frequency) corresponds to a higher energy. Because more heat is radiated at higher
temperatures, higher temperatures produce more intensity at every wavelength but especially at shorter
wavelengths. In visible light, wavelength determines color—red has the longest wavelength and violet the
shortest—so a temperature change is accompanied by a color change. For example, an electric heating element
on a stove glows from red to orange, while the higher-temperature steel in a blast furnace glows from yellow to
white. Infrared radiation is the predominant form radiated by objects cooler than the electric element and the
steel. The radiated energy as a function of wavelength depends on its intensity, which is represented in Figure
1.29 by the height of the distribution. (Electromagnetic Waves explains more about the electromagnetic
spectrum, and Photons and Matter Waves discusses why the decrease in wavelength corresponds to an
increase in energy.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 45

Figure 1.29 (a) A graph of the spectrum of electromagnetic waves emitted from an ideal radiator at three different temperatures. The
intensity or rate of radiation emission increases dramatically with temperature, and the spectrum shifts down in wavelength toward the
visible and ultraviolet parts of the spectrum. The shaded portion denotes the visible part of the spectrum. It is apparent that the shift
toward the ultraviolet with temperature makes the visible appearance shift from red to white to blue as temperature increases. (b) Note the
variations in color corresponding to variations in flame temperature.

The rate of heat transfer by radiation also depends on the object’s color. Black is the most effective, and white
is the least effective. On a clear summer day, black asphalt in a parking lot is hotter than adjacent gray
sidewalk, because black absorbs better than gray (Figure 1.30). The reverse is also true—black radiates better
than gray. Thus, on a clear summer night, the asphalt is colder than the gray sidewalk, because black radiates
the energy more rapidly than gray. A perfectly black object would be an ideal radiator and an ideal absorber, as
it would capture all the radiation that falls on it. In contrast, a perfectly white object or a perfect mirror would
reflect all radiation, and a perfectly transparent object would transmit it all (Figure 1.31). Such objects would
not emit any radiation. Mathematically, the color is represented by the emissivity e. A “blackbody” radiator
would have an , whereas a perfect reflector or transmitter would have . For real examples, tungsten
light bulb filaments have an e of about 0.5, and carbon black (a material used in printer toner) has an
emissivity of about 0.95.
46 1 • Temperature and Heat

Figure 1.30 The darker pavement is hotter than the lighter pavement (much more of the ice on the right has melted), although both have
been in the sunlight for the same time. The thermal conductivities of the pavements are the same.

Figure 1.31 A black object is a good absorber and a good radiator, whereas a white, clear, or silver object is a poor absorber and a poor
radiator.

To see that, consider a silver object and a black object that can exchange heat by radiation and are in thermal
equilibrium. We know from experience that they will stay in equilibrium (the result of a principle that will be
discussed at length in Second Law of Thermodynamics). For the black object’s temperature to stay constant, it
must emit as much radiation as it absorbs, so it must be as good at radiating as absorbing. Similar
considerations show that the silver object must radiate as little as it absorbs. Thus, one property, emissivity,
controls both radiation and absorption.

Finally, the radiated heat is proportional to the object’s surface area, since every part of the surface radiates. If
you knock apart the coals of a fire, the radiation increases noticeably due to an increase in radiating surface
area.

The rate of heat transfer by emitted radiation is described by the Stefan-Boltzmann law of radiation:

where is the Stefan-Boltzmann constant, a combination of fundamental


constants of nature; A is the surface area of the object; and T is its temperature in kelvins.

The proportionality to the fourth power of the absolute temperature is a remarkably strong temperature
dependence. It allows the detection of even small temperature variations. Images called thermographs can be
used medically to detect regions of abnormally high temperature in the body, perhaps indicative of disease.
Similar techniques can be used to detect heat leaks in homes (Figure 1.32), optimize performance of blast
furnaces, improve comfort levels in work environments, and even remotely map Earth’s temperature profile.

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 47

Figure 1.32 A thermograph of part of a building shows temperature variations, indicating where heat transfer to the outside is most
severe. Windows are a major region of heat transfer to the outside of homes. (credit: US Army)

The Stefan-Boltzmann equation needs only slight refinement to deal with a simple case of an object’s
absorption of radiation from its surroundings. Assuming that an object with a temperature is surrounded
by an environment with uniform temperature , the net rate of heat transfer by radiation is

1.10

where e is the emissivity of the object alone. In other words, it does not matter whether the surroundings are
white, gray, or black: The balance of radiation into and out of the object depends on how well it emits and
absorbs radiation. When the quantity is positive, that is, the net heat transfer is from hot to cold.

Before doing an example, we have a complication to discuss: different emissivities at different wavelengths. If
the fraction of incident radiation an object reflects is the same at all visible wavelengths, the object is gray; if
the fraction depends on the wavelength, the object has some other color. For instance, a red or reddish object
reflects red light more strongly than other visible wavelengths. Because it absorbs less red, it radiates less red
when hot. Differential reflection and absorption of wavelengths outside the visible range have no effect on what
we see, but they may have physically important effects. Skin is a very good absorber and emitter of infrared
radiation, having an emissivity of 0.97 in the infrared spectrum. Thus, in spite of the obvious variations in skin
color, we are all nearly black in the infrared. This high infrared emissivity is why we can so easily feel radiation
on our skin. It is also the basis for the effectiveness of night-vision scopes used by law enforcement and the
military to detect human beings.

EXAMPLE 1.13

Calculating the Net Heat Transfer of a Person


What is the rate of heat transfer by radiation of an unclothed person standing in a dark room whose ambient
temperature is ? The person has a normal skin temperature of and a surface area of
The emissivity of skin is 0.97 in the infrared, the part of the spectrum where the radiation takes place.

Strategy
We can solve this by using the equation for the rate of radiative heat transfer.

Solution
Insert the temperature values and , so that
48 1 • Temperature and Heat

Significance
This value is a significant rate of heat transfer to the environment (note the minus sign), considering that a
person at rest may produce energy at the rate of 125 W and that conduction and convection are also
transferring energy to the environment. Indeed, we would probably expect this person to feel cold. Clothing
significantly reduces heat transfer to the environment by all mechanisms, because clothing slows down both
conduction and convection, and has a lower emissivity (especially if it is light-colored) than skin.

The average temperature of Earth is the subject of much current discussion. Earth is in radiative contact with
both the Sun and dark space, so we cannot use the equation for an environment at a uniform temperature.
Earth receives almost all its energy from radiation of the Sun and reflects some of it back into outer space.
Conversely, dark space is very cold, about 3 K, so that Earth radiates energy into the dark sky. The rate of heat
transfer from soil and grasses can be so rapid that frost may occur on clear summer evenings, even in warm
latitudes.

The average temperature of Earth is determined by its energy balance. To a first approximation, it is the
temperature at which Earth radiates heat to space as fast as it receives energy from the Sun.

An important parameter in calculating the temperature of Earth is its emissivity (e). On average, it is about
0.65, but calculation of this value is complicated by the great day-to-day variation in the highly reflective cloud
coverage. Because clouds have lower emissivity than either oceans or land masses, they emit some of the
radiation back to the surface, greatly reducing heat transfer into dark space, just as they greatly reduce heat
transfer into the atmosphere during the day. There is negative feedback (in which a change produces an effect
that opposes that change) between clouds and heat transfer; higher temperatures evaporate more water to
form more clouds, which reflect more radiation back into space, reducing the temperature.

The often-mentioned greenhouse effect is directly related to the variation of Earth’s emissivity with
wavelength (Figure 1.33). The greenhouse effect is a natural phenomenon responsible for providing
temperatures suitable for life on Earth and for making Venus unsuitable for human life. Most of the infrared
radiation emitted from Earth is absorbed by carbon dioxide ( ) and water ( ) in the atmosphere and
then re-radiated into outer space or back to Earth. Re-radiation back to Earth maintains its surface
temperature about higher than it would be if there were no atmosphere. (The glass walls and roof of a
greenhouse increase the temperature inside by blocking convective heat losses, not radiative losses.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


1.6 • Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 49

Figure 1.33 The greenhouse effect is the name given to the increase of Earth’s temperature due to absorption of radiation in the
atmosphere. The atmosphere is transparent to incoming visible radiation and most of the Sun’s infrared. The Earth absorbs that energy and
re-emits it. Since Earth’s temperature is much lower than the Sun’s, it re-emits the energy at much longer wavelengths, in the infrared. The
atmosphere absorbs much of that infrared radiation and radiates about half of the energy back down, keeping Earth warmer than it would
otherwise be. The amount of trapping depends on concentrations of trace gases such as carbon dioxide, and an increase in the
concentration of these gases increases Earth’s surface temperature.

The greenhouse effect is central to the discussion of global warming due to emission of carbon dioxide and
methane (and other greenhouse gases) into Earth’s atmosphere from industry, transportation, and farming.
Changes in global climate could lead to more intense storms, precipitation changes (affecting agriculture),
reduction in rain forest biodiversity, and rising sea levels.

INTERACTIVE
You can explore a simulation of the greenhouse effect (https://openstax.org/l/21simgreeneff) that takes the
point of view that the atmosphere scatters (redirects) infrared radiation rather than absorbing it and
reradiating it. You may want to run the simulation first with no greenhouse gases in the atmosphere and then
look at how adding greenhouse gases affects the infrared radiation from the Earth and the Earth’s temperature.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Effects of Heat Transfer


1. Examine the situation to determine what type of heat transfer is involved.
2. Identify the type(s) of heat transfer—conduction, convection, or radiation.
3. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknowns). A written list is
useful.
4. Make a list of what is given or what can be inferred from the problem as stated (identify the knowns).
5. Solve the appropriate equation for the quantity to be determined (the unknown).
6. For conduction, use the equation . Table 1.5 lists thermal conductivities. For convection,
determine the amount of matter moved and the equation , along with or if
50 1 • Temperature and Heat

a substance changes phase. For radiation, the equation gives the net heat transfer
rate.
7. Substitute the knowns along with their units into the appropriate equation and obtain numerical solutions
complete with units.
8. Check the answer to see if it is reasonable. Does it make sense?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 1.9


How much greater is the rate of heat radiation when a body is at the temperature than when it is at the
temperature ?

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 51

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
absolute temperature scale scale, such as Kelvin, change a substance from the solid phase to the
with a zero point that is absolute zero liquid phase, or released when the substance
absolute zero temperature at which the average changes from liquid to solid
kinetic energy of molecules is zero heat of sublimation energy per unit mass required
calorie (cal) energy needed to change the to change a substance from the solid phase to the
temperature of 1.00 g of water by vapor phase
calorimeter container that prevents heat transfer heat of vaporization energy per unit mass
in or out required to change a substance from the liquid
calorimetry study of heat transfer inside a phase to the vapor phase
container impervious to heat heat transfer movement of energy from one place
Celsius scale temperature scale in which the or material to another as a result of a difference in
freezing point of water is and the boiling temperature
point of water is Kelvin scale (K) temperature scale in which 0 K is
coefficient of linear expansion ( ) material the lowest possible temperature, representing
property that gives the change in length, per unit absolute zero
length, per change in temperature; a kilocalorie (kcal) energy needed to change the
constant used in the calculation of linear temperature of 1.00 kg of water between
expansion; the coefficient of linear expansion and
depends to some degree on the temperature of latent heat coefficient general term for the heats
the material of fusion, vaporization, and sublimation
coefficient of volume expansion ( ) similar to mechanical equivalent of heat work needed to
but gives the change in volume, per unit volume, produce the same effects as heat transfer
per change in temperature net rate of heat transfer by radiation
conduction heat transfer through stationary
matter by physical contact phase diagram graph of pressure vs. temperature
convection heat transfer by the macroscopic of a particular substance, showing at which
movement of fluid pressures and temperatures the phases of the
critical point for a given substance, the substance occur
combination of temperature and pressure above radiation energy transferred by electromagnetic
which the liquid and gas phases are waves directly as a result of a temperature
indistinguishable difference
critical pressure pressure at the critical point rate of conductive heat transfer rate of heat
critical temperature temperature at the critical transfer from one material to another
point specific heat amount of heat necessary to change
degree Celsius ( ) unit on the Celsius the temperature of 1.00 kg of a substance by
temperature scale ; also called “specific heat capacity”
degree Fahrenheit ( ) unit on the Fahrenheit Stefan-Boltzmann law of radiation
temperature scale where is the
emissivity measure of how well an object radiates Stefan-Boltzmann constant, A is the surface area
Fahrenheit scale temperature scale in which the of the object, T is the absolute temperature, and e
freezing point of water is and the boiling is the emissivity
point of water is sublimation phase change from solid to gas
greenhouse effect warming of the earth that is due temperature quantity measured by a
to gases such as carbon dioxide and methane that thermometer, which reflects the mechanical
absorb infrared radiation from Earth’s surface energy of molecules in a system
and reradiate it in all directions, thus sending thermal conductivity property of a material
some of it back toward Earth describing its ability to conduct heat
heat energy transferred solely due to a thermal equilibrium condition in which heat no
temperature difference longer flows between two objects that are in
heat of fusion energy per unit mass required to contact; the two objects have the same
52 1 • Chapter Review

temperature temperature
thermal expansion change in size or volume of an vapor pressure pressure at which a gas coexists
object with change in temperature with its solid or liquid phase
thermal stress stress caused by thermal zeroth law of thermodynamics law that states that
expansion or contraction if two objects are in thermal equilibrium, and a
triple point pressure and temperature at which a third object is in thermal equilibrium with one of
substance exists in equilibrium as a solid, liquid, those objects, it is also in thermal equilibrium
and gas with the other object
vapor gas at a temperature below the boiling

Key Equations
Linear thermal expansion

Thermal expansion in two dimensions

Thermal expansion in three dimensions

Heat transfer

Transfer of heat in a calorimeter

Heat due to phase change (melting and freezing)

Heat due to phase change (evaporation and condensation)

Rate of conductive heat transfer

Net rate of heat transfer by radiation

Summary
1.1 Temperature and Thermal Equilibrium • The three main temperature scales are Celsius,
Fahrenheit, and Kelvin. Temperatures can be
• Temperature is operationally defined as the
converted from one scale to another using
quantity measured by a thermometer. It is
temperature conversion equations.
proportional to the average kinetic energy of
• The three phases of water (ice, liquid water, and
atoms and molecules in a system.
water vapor) can coexist at a single pressure and
• Thermal equilibrium occurs when two bodies
temperature known as the triple point.
are in contact with each other and can freely
exchange energy. Systems are in thermal 1.3 Thermal Expansion
equilibrium when they have the same
• Thermal expansion is the increase of the size
temperature.
(length, area, or volume) of a body due to a
• The zeroth law of thermodynamics states that
change in temperature, usually a rise. Thermal
when two systems, A and B, are in thermal
contraction is the decrease in size due to a
equilibrium with each other, and B is in thermal
change in temperature, usually a fall in
equilibrium with a third system C, then A is also
temperature.
in thermal equilibrium with C.
• Thermal stress is created when thermal
1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales expansion or contraction is constrained.

• Three types of thermometers are alcohol, liquid


crystal, and infrared radiation (pyrometer).

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 53

1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and proportional to the distance d between the
Calorimetry objects.
• Convection is heat transfer by the macroscopic
• Heat and work are the two distinct methods of movement of mass. Convection can be natural
energy transfer. or forced, and generally transfers thermal
• Heat transfer to an object when its temperature energy faster than conduction. Convection that
changes is often approximated well by occurs along with a phase change can transfer
where m is the object’s mass and c energy from cold regions to warm ones.
is the specific heat of the substance. • Radiation is heat transfer through the emission
1.5 Phase Changes or absorption of electromagnetic waves.
• The rate of radiative heat transfer is
• Most substances have three distinct phases proportional to the emissivity e. For a perfect
(under ordinary conditions on Earth), and they blackbody, , whereas a perfectly white,
depend on temperature and pressure. clear, or reflective body has , with real
• Two phases coexist (i.e., they are in thermal objects having values of e between 1 and 0.
equilibrium) at a set of pressures and • The rate of heat transfer depends on the surface
temperatures. area and the fourth power of the absolute
• Phase changes occur at fixed temperatures for a temperature:
given substance at a given pressure, and these
temperatures are called boiling, freezing (or
melting), and sublimation points. where is the
Stefan-Boltzmann constant and e is the
1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer emissivity of the body. The net rate of heat
• Heat is transferred by three different methods: transfer from an object by radiation is
conduction, convection, and radiation.
• Heat conduction is the transfer of heat between
two objects in direct contact with each other. where is the temperature of the object
• The rate of heat transfer P (energy per unit time) surrounded by an environment with uniform
is proportional to the temperature difference temperature and e is the emissivity of the
and the contact area A and inversely object.

Conceptual Questions
1.1 Temperature and Thermal Equilibrium 1.3 Thermal Expansion
1. What does it mean to say that two systems are in 5. Pouring cold water into hot glass or ceramic
thermal equilibrium? cookware can easily break it. What causes the
2. Give an example in which A has some kind of breaking? Explain why Pyrex®, a glass with a
non-thermal equilibrium relationship with B, small coefficient of linear expansion, is less
and B has the same relationship with C, but A susceptible.
does not have that relationship with C. 6. One method of getting a tight fit, say of a metal
peg in a hole in a metal block, is to manufacture
1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales the peg slightly larger than the hole. The peg is
then inserted when at a different temperature
3. If a thermometer is allowed to come to
than the block. Should the block be hotter or
equilibrium with the air, and a glass of water is
colder than the peg during insertion? Explain
not in equilibrium with the air, what will happen
your answer.
to the thermometer reading when it is placed in
7. Does it really help to run hot water over a tight
the water?
metal lid on a glass jar before trying to open it?
4. Give an example of a physical property that
Explain your answer.
varies with temperature and describe how it is
8. When a cold alcohol thermometer is placed in a
used to measure temperature.
hot liquid, the column of alcohol goes down
slightly before going up. Explain why.
9. Calculate the length of a 1-meter rod of a material
54 1 • Chapter Review

with thermal expansion coefficient when the


temperature is raised from 300 K to 600 K.
Taking your answer as the new initial length, find
the length after the rod is cooled back down to
300 K. Is your answer 1 meter? Should it be? How
can you account for the result you got?
10. Noting the large stresses that can be caused by
thermal expansion, an amateur weapon
inventor decides to use it to make a new kind of
gun. He plans to jam a bullet against an
aluminum rod inside a closed invar tube. When
he heats the tube, the rod will expand more than
the tube and a very strong force will build up.
Then, by a method yet to be determined, he will
open the tube in a split second and let the force
of the rod launch the bullet at very high speed.
What is he overlooking?

1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and


17. Can carbon dioxide be liquefied at room
Calorimetry
temperature ( )? If so, how? If not, why not?
11. How is heat transfer related to temperature? (See the phase diagram in the preceding
12. Describe a situation in which heat transfer problem.)
occurs. 18. What is the distinction between gas and vapor?
13. When heat transfers into a system, is the energy 19. Heat transfer can cause temperature and phase
stored as heat? Explain briefly. changes. What else can cause these changes?
14. The brakes in a car increase in temperature by 20. How does the latent heat of fusion of water help
when bringing the car to rest from a speed slow the decrease of air temperatures, perhaps
v. How much greater would be if the car preventing temperatures from falling
initially had twice the speed? You may assume significantly below in the vicinity of large
the car stops fast enough that no heat transfers bodies of water?
out of the brakes. 21. What is the temperature of ice right after it is
formed by freezing water?
1.5 Phase Changes 22. If you place ice into water in an
insulated container, what will the net result be?
15. A pressure cooker contains water and steam in
Will there be less ice and more liquid water, or
equilibrium at a pressure greater than
more ice and less liquid water, or will the
atmospheric pressure. How does this greater
amounts stay the same?
pressure increase cooking speed?
23. What effect does condensation on a glass of ice
16. As shown below, which is the phase diagram for
water have on the rate at which the ice melts?
carbon dioxide, what is the vapor pressure of solid
Will the condensation speed up the melting
carbon dioxide (dry ice) at (Note that the
process or slow it down?
axes in the figure are nonlinear and the graph is not
24. In Miami, Florida, which has a very humid
to scale.)
climate and numerous bodies of water nearby, it
is unusual for temperatures to rise above about
( ). In the desert climate of Phoenix,
Arizona, however, temperatures rise above that
almost every day in July and August. Explain
how the evaporation of water helps limit high
temperatures in humid climates.
25. In winter, it is often warmer in San Francisco
than in Sacramento, 150 km inland. In summer,
it is nearly always hotter in Sacramento. Explain
how the bodies of water surrounding San

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 55

Francisco moderate its extreme temperatures.


26. Freeze-dried foods have been dehydrated in a
vacuum. During the process, the food freezes
and must be heated to facilitate dehydration.
Explain both how the vacuum speeds up
dehydration and why the food freezes as a
result.
27. In a physics classroom demonstration, an
instructor inflates a balloon by mouth and then
cools it in liquid nitrogen. When cold, the
shrunken balloon has a small amount of light
blue liquid in it, as well as some snow-like
crystals. As it warms up, the liquid boils, and
part of the crystals sublime, with some crystals
lingering for a while and then producing a
liquid. Identify the blue liquid and the two solids
in the cold balloon. Justify your identifications
using data from Table 1.4.

1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer 31. Some electric stoves have a flat ceramic surface
28. What are the main methods of heat transfer with heating elements hidden beneath. A pot
from the hot core of Earth to its surface? From placed over a heating element will be heated,
Earth’s surface to outer space? while the surface only a few centimeters away is
29. When our bodies get too warm, they respond by safe to touch. Why is ceramic, with a
sweating and increasing blood circulation to the conductivity less than that of a metal but greater
surface to transfer thermal energy away from than that of a good insulator, an ideal choice for
the core. What effect will those processes have the stove top?
on a person in a hot tub? 32. Loose-fitting white clothing covering most of the
30. Shown below is a cut-away drawing of a body, shown below, is ideal for desert dwellers, both
thermos bottle (also known as a Dewar flask), in the hot Sun and during cold evenings. Explain
which is a device designed specifically to slow how such clothing is advantageous during both day
down all forms of heat transfer. Explain the and night.
functions of the various parts, such as the
vacuum, the silvering of the walls, the thin-
walled long glass neck, the rubber support, the
air layer, and the stopper.
56 1 • Chapter Review

33. One way to make a fireplace more energy- money. Should you turn the thermostat down to
efficient is to have room air circulate around the the lowest level that will protect the house from
outside of the fire box and back into the room. damage such as freezing pipes, or leave it at the
Detail the methods of heat transfer involved. normal temperature? (If you don’t like coming
34. On cold, clear nights horses will sleep under the back to a cold house, imagine that a timer
cover of large trees. How does this help them controls the heating system so the house will be
keep warm? warm when you get back.) Explain your answer.
35. When watching a circus during the day in a 40. You pour coffee into an unlidded cup, intending
large, dark-colored tent, you sense significant to drink it 5 minutes later. You can add cream
heat transfer from the tent. Explain why this when you pour the cup or right before you drink
occurs. it. (The cream is at the same temperature either
36. Satellites designed to observe the radiation way. Assume that the cream and coffee come
from cold (3 K) dark space have sensors that are into thermal equilibrium with each other very
shaded from the Sun, Earth, and the Moon and quickly.) Which way will give you hotter coffee?
are cooled to very low temperatures. Why must What feature of this question is different from
the sensors be at low temperature? the previous one?
37. Why are thermometers that are used in weather 41. Broiling is a method of cooking by radiation,
stations shielded from the sunshine? What does which produces somewhat different results
a thermometer measure if it is shielded from from cooking by conduction or convection. A
the sunshine? What does it measure if it is not? gas flame or electric heating element produces
38. Putting a lid on a boiling pot greatly reduces the a very high temperature close to the food and
heat transfer necessary to keep it boiling. above it. Why is radiation the dominant heat-
Explain why. transfer method in this situation?
39. Your house will be empty for a while in cold 42. On a cold winter morning, why does the metal of
weather, and you want to save energy and a bike feel colder than the wood of a porch?

Problems
1.2 Thermometers and Temperature Scales probably during times when the planet was 36
degrees Fahrenheit (2 degrees Celsius) to 37
43. While traveling outside the United States, you
degrees Fahrenheit (3 degrees Celsius) warmer
feel sick. A companion gets you a thermometer,
than it is today.” What mistake did the reporter
which says your temperature is 39. What scale
make?
is that on? What is your Fahrenheit
47. (a) At what temperature do the Fahrenheit and
temperature? Should you seek medical help?
Celsius scales have the same numerical value?
44. What are the following temperatures on the
(b) At what temperature do the Fahrenheit and
Kelvin scale?
Kelvin scales have the same numerical value?
(a) an indoor temperature sometimes
48. A person taking a reading of the temperature in
recommended for energy conservation in
a freezer in Celsius makes two mistakes: first
winter
omitting the negative sign and then thinking the
(b) one of the highest atmospheric
temperature is Fahrenheit. That is, the person
temperatures ever recorded on Earth (Death
reads as . Oddly enough, the result is
Valley, California, 1913)
the correct Fahrenheit temperature. What is the
(c) the temperature of the surface of
original Celsius reading? Round your answer to
the Sun
three significant figures.
45. (a) Suppose a cold front blows into your locale
and drops the temperature by 40.0 Fahrenheit
1.3 Thermal Expansion
degrees. How many degrees Celsius does the
temperature decrease when it decreases by 49. The height of the Washington Monument is
? (b) Show that any change in measured to be 170.00 m on a day when the
temperature in Fahrenheit degrees is nine- temperature is What will its height be
fifths the change in Celsius degrees on a day when the temperature falls to
46. An Associated Press article on climate change ? Although the monument is made of
said, “Some of the ice shelf’s disappearance was limestone, assume that its coefficient of thermal

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 57

expansion is the same as that of marble. Give 57. Most cars have a coolant reservoir to catch
your answer to five significant figures. radiator fluid that may overflow when the
50. How much taller does the Eiffel Tower become engine is hot. A radiator is made of copper and
at the end of a day when the temperature has is filled to its 16.0-L capacity when at .
increased by Its original height is 321 m What volume of radiator fluid will overflow
and you can assume it is made of steel. when the radiator and fluid reach a temperature
51. What is the change in length of a 3.00-cm-long of given that the fluid’s volume
column of mercury if its temperature changes coefficient of expansion is ?
from to , assuming the mercury (Your answer will be a conservative estimate, as
is constrained to a cylinder but unconstrained most car radiators have operating temperatures
in length? Your answer will show why greater than ).
thermometers contain bulbs at the bottom 58. A physicist makes a cup of instant coffee and
instead of simple columns of liquid. notices that, as the coffee cools, its level drops
52. How large an expansion gap should be left 3.00 mm in the glass cup. Show that this
between steel railroad rails if they may reach a decrease cannot be due to thermal contraction
maximum temperature greater than by calculating the decrease in level if the
when they were laid? Their original length is of coffee is in a 7.00-cm-diameter cup
10.0 m. and decreases in temperature from to
53. You are looking to buy a small piece of land in . (Most of the drop in level is actually due
Hong Kong. The price is “only” $60,000 per to escaping bubbles of air.)
square meter. The land title says the 59. The density of water at is very nearly
dimensions are . By how much (it is actually ),
would the total price change if you measured whereas the density of ice at is
the parcel with a steel tape measure on a day Calculate the pressure necessary to keep ice
when the temperature was above the from expanding when it freezes, neglecting the
temperature that the tape measure was effect such a large pressure would have on the
designed for? The dimensions of the land do not freezing temperature. (This problem gives you
change. only an indication of how large the forces
54. Global warming will produce rising sea levels associated with freezing water might be.)
partly due to melting ice caps and partly due to 60. Show that by calculating the
the expansion of water as average ocean infinitesimal change in volume dV of a cube
temperatures rise. To get some idea of the size with sides of length L when the temperature
of this effect, calculate the change in length of a changes by dT.
column of water 1.00 km high for a temperature
increase of . Assume the column is not 1.4 Heat Transfer, Specific Heat, and
free to expand sideways. As a model of the Calorimetry
ocean, that is a reasonable approximation, as
only parts of the ocean very close to the surface 61. On a hot day, the temperature of an 80,000-L
can expand sideways onto land, and only to a swimming pool increases by . What is
limited degree. As another approximation, the net heat transfer during this heating? Ignore
neglect the fact that ocean warming is not any complications, such as loss of water by
uniform with depth. evaporation.
55. (a) Suppose a meter stick made of steel and one 62. To sterilize a 50.0-g glass baby bottle, we must
made of aluminum are the same length at . raise its temperature from to .
What is their difference in length at ? (b) How much heat transfer is required?
Repeat the calculation for two 30.0-m-long 63. The same heat transfer into identical masses of
surveyor’s tapes. different substances produces different
56. (a) If a 500-mL glass beaker is filled to the brim temperature changes. Calculate the final
with ethyl alcohol at a temperature of , temperature when 1.00 kcal of heat transfers
how much will overflow when the alcohol’s into 1.00 kg of the following, originally at
temperature reaches the room temperature of : (a) water; (b) concrete; (c) steel; and (d)
? (b) How much less water would mercury.
overflow under the same conditions? 64. Rubbing your hands together warms them by
58 1 • Chapter Review

converting work into thermal energy. If a assumptions that any steam produced
woman rubs her hands back and forth for a total condenses into liquid water during the process
of 20 rubs, at a distance of 7.50 cm per rub, and of equilibration and that the evaporation and
with an average frictional force of 40.0 N, what condensation don’t affect the outcome, as we’ll
is the temperature increase? The mass of see in the next section.)
tissues warmed is only 0.100 kg, mostly in the 71. Repeat the preceding problem, assuming the
palms and fingers. water is in a glass beaker with a mass of 0.200
65. A block of a pure material is heated kg, which in turn is in a calorimeter. The beaker
from to by the addition of 4.35 is initially at the same temperature as the water.
kJ of energy. Calculate its specific heat and Before doing the problem, should the answer be
identify the substance of which it is most likely higher or lower than the preceding answer?
composed. Comparing the mass and specific heat of the
66. Suppose identical amounts of heat transfer into beaker to those of the water, do you think the
different masses of copper and water, causing beaker will make much difference?
identical changes in temperature. What is the
ratio of the mass of copper to water? 1.5 Phase Changes
67. (a) The number of kilocalories in food is
72. How much heat transfer (in kilocalories) is
determined by calorimetry techniques in which
required to thaw a 0.450-kg package of frozen
the food is burned and the amount of heat
vegetables originally at if their heat of
transfer is measured. How many kilocalories
fusion is the same as that of water?
per gram are there in a 5.00-g peanut if the
73. A bag containing ice is much more
energy from burning it is transferred to 0.500
effective in absorbing energy than one
kg of water held in a 0.100-kg aluminum cup,
containing the same amount of water. (a)
causing a temperature increase?
How much heat transfer is necessary to raise
Assume the process takes place in an ideal
the temperature of 0.800 kg of water from
calorimeter, in other words a perfectly insulated
to ? (b) How much heat transfer is
container. (b) Compare your answer to the
required to first melt 0.800 kg of ice and
following labeling information found on a
then raise its temperature? (c) Explain how your
package of dry roasted peanuts: a serving of 33
answer supports the contention that the ice is
g contains 200 calories. Comment on whether
more effective.
the values are consistent.
74. (a) How much heat transfer is required to raise
68. Following vigorous exercise, the body
the temperature of a 0.750-kg aluminum pot
temperature of an 80.0 kg person is . At
containing 2.50 kg of water from to the
what rate in watts must the person transfer
boiling point and then boil away 0.750 kg of
thermal energy to reduce the body temperature
water? (b) How long does this take if the rate of
to in 30.0 min, assuming the body
heat transfer is 500 W?
continues to produce energy at the rate of 150
75. Condensation on a glass of ice water causes the
W?
1 ice to melt faster than it would otherwise. If 8.00
69. In a study of healthy young men , doing 20
g of vapor condense on a glass containing both
push-ups in 1 minute burned an amount of
water and 200 g of ice, how many grams of the
energy per kg that for a 70.0-kg man
ice will melt as a result? Assume no other heat
corresponds to 8.06 calories (kcal). How much
transfer occurs. Use for water at as a
would a 70.0-kg man’s temperature rise if he
better approximation than for water at
did not lose any heat during that time?
.)
76. On a trip, you notice that a 3.50-kg bag of ice
70. A 1.28-kg sample of water at is in a
lasts an average of one day in your cooler. What
calorimeter. You drop a piece of steel with a
is the average power in watts entering the ice if
mass of 0.385 kg at into it. After the
it starts at and completely melts to
sizzling subsides, what is the final equilibrium
water in exactly one day?
temperature? (Make the reasonable
77. On a certain dry sunny day, a swimming pool’s

1 JW Vezina, “An examination of the differences between two methods of estimating energy expenditure in resistance training
activities,” Journal of Strength and Conditioning Research, April 28, 2014, http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed/24402448

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 59

temperature would rise by if not for 200-kg tree decrease if this amount of heat
evaporation. What fraction of the water must transferred from the tree? Take the specific heat
evaporate to carry away precisely enough to be , and assume that no phase
energy to keep the temperature constant? change occurs in the tree.
78. (a) How much heat transfer is necessary to raise 84. A 0.250-kg aluminum bowl holding of
the temperature of a 0.200-kg piece of ice from soup at is placed in a freezer. What is
to , including the energy the final temperature if 388 kJ of energy is
needed for phase changes? (b) How much time transferred from the bowl and soup, assuming
is required for each stage, assuming a constant the soup’s thermal properties are the same as
20.0 kJ/s rate of heat transfer? (c) Make a graph that of water?
of temperature versus time for this process. 85. A 0.0500-kg ice cube at is placed in
79. In 1986, an enormous iceberg broke away from 0.400 kg of water in a very well-
the Ross Ice Shelf in Antarctica. It was an insulated container. What is the final
approximately rectangular prism 160 km long, temperature?
40.0 km wide, and 250 m thick. (a) What is the 86. If you pour 0.0100 kg of water onto a
mass of this iceberg, given that the density of 1.20-kg block of ice (which is initially at
ice is ? (b) How much heat transfer ), what is the final temperature? You
(in joules) is needed to melt it? (c) How many may assume that the water cools so rapidly that
years would it take sunlight alone to melt ice effects of the surroundings are negligible.
this thick, if the ice absorbs an average of 87. Indigenous people sometimes cook in
, 12.00 h per day? watertight baskets by placing hot rocks into
80. How many grams of coffee must evaporate from water to bring it to a boil. What mass of
350 g of coffee in a 100-g glass cup to cool the granite must be placed in 4.00 kg of
coffee and the cup from to ? water to bring its temperature to , if
Assume the coffee has the same thermal 0.0250 kg of water escapes as vapor from the
properties as water and that the average heat of initial sizzle? You may neglect the effects of the
vaporization is 2340 kJ/kg (560 kcal/g). Neglect surroundings.
heat losses through processes other than 88. What would the final temperature of the pan
evaporation, as well as the change in mass of and water be in Example 1.7 if 0.260 kg of water
the coffee as it cools. Do the latter two were placed in the pan and 0.0100 kg of the
assumptions cause your answer to be higher or water evaporated immediately, leaving the
lower than the true answer? remainder to come to a common temperature
81. (a) It is difficult to extinguish a fire on a crude with the pan?
oil tanker, because each liter of crude oil
releases of energy when burned. 1.6 Mechanisms of Heat Transfer
To illustrate this difficulty, calculate the number
89. (a) Calculate the rate of heat conduction through
of liters of water that must be expended to
house walls that are 13.0 cm thick and have an
absorb the energy released by burning 1.00 L of
average thermal conductivity twice that of glass
crude oil, if the water’s temperature rises from
wool. Assume there are no windows or doors.
to , it boils, and the resulting
The walls’ surface area is and their
steam’s temperature rises to at constant
inside surface is at , while their outside
pressure. (b) Discuss additional complications
surface is at . (b) How many 1-kW room
caused by the fact that crude oil is less dense
heaters would be needed to balance the heat
than water.
transfer due to conduction?
82. The energy released from condensation in
90. The rate of heat conduction out of a window on
thunderstorms can be very large. Calculate the
a winter day is rapid enough to chill the air next
energy released into the atmosphere for a small
to it. To see just how rapidly the windows
storm of radius 1 km, assuming that 1.0 cm of
transfer heat by conduction, calculate the rate
rain is precipitated uniformly over this area.
of conduction in watts through a
83. To help prevent frost damage, 4.00 kg of water
window that is 0.634 cm thick (1/4 in.) if the
at is sprayed onto a fruit tree. (a) How
temperatures of the inner and outer surfaces
much heat transfer occurs as the water freezes?
are and , respectively. (This
(b) How much would the temperature of the
rapid rate will not be maintained—the inner
60 1 • Chapter Review

surface will cool, even to the point of frost 97. Compare the rate of heat conduction through a
formation.) 13.0-cm-thick wall that has an area of
91. Calculate the rate of heat conduction out of the and a thermal conductivity twice that of glass
human body, assuming that the core internal wool with the rate of heat conduction through a
temperature is , the skin temperature is 0.750-cm-thick window that has an area of
, the thickness of the fatty tissues , assuming the same temperature
between the core and the skin averages 1.00 difference across each.
cm, and the surface area is . 98. Suppose a person is covered head to foot by
92. Suppose you stand with one foot on ceramic wool clothing with average thickness of 2.00 cm
flooring and one foot on a wool carpet, making and is transferring energy by conduction
contact over an area of with each foot. through the clothing at the rate of 50.0 W. What
Both the ceramic and the carpet are 2.00 cm is the temperature difference across the
thick and are on their bottom sides. At clothing, given the surface area is ?
what rate must heat transfer occur from each 99. Some stove tops are smooth ceramic for easy
foot to keep the top of the ceramic and carpet at cleaning. If the ceramic is 0.600 cm thick and
? heat conduction occurs through the same area
93. A man consumes 3000 kcal of food in one day, and at the same rate as computed in Example
converting most of it to thermal energy to 1.11, what is the temperature difference across
maintain body temperature. If he loses half this it? Ceramic has the same thermal conductivity
energy by evaporating water (through breathing as glass and brick.
and sweating), how many kilograms of water 100. One easy way to reduce heating (and cooling)
evaporate? costs is to add extra insulation in the attic of a
94. A firewalker runs across a bed of hot coals house. Suppose a single-story cubical house
without sustaining burns. Calculate the heat already had 15 cm of fiberglass insulation in
transferred by conduction into the sole of one the attic and in all the exterior surfaces. If you
foot of a firewalker given that the bottom of the added an extra 8.0 cm of fiberglass to the attic,
foot is a 3.00-mm-thick callus with a by what percentage would the heating cost of
conductivity at the low end of the range for the house drop? Take the house to have
wood and its density is . The area of dimensions 10 m by 15 m by 3.0 m. Ignore air
contact is the temperature of the infiltration and heat loss through windows and
coals is , and the time in contact is 1.00 s. doors, and assume that the interior is
Ignore the evaporative cooling of sweat. uniformly at one temperature and the exterior
95. (a) What is the rate of heat conduction through is uniformly at another.
the 3.00-cm-thick fur of a large animal having a 101. Many decisions are made on the basis of the
surface area? Assume that the animal’s payback period: the time it will take through
skin temperature is , that the air savings to equal the capital cost of an
temperature is , and that fur has the investment. Acceptable payback times depend
same thermal conductivity as air. (b) What food upon the business or philosophy one has. (For
intake will the animal need in one day to replace some industries, a payback period is as small
this heat transfer? as 2 years.) Suppose you wish to install the
96. A walrus transfers energy by conduction extra insulation in the preceding problem. If
through its blubber at the rate of 150 W when energy cost per million joules and the
immersed in water. The walrus’s insulation was $4.00 per square meter, then
internal core temperature is , and it has calculate the simple payback time. Take the
a surface area of . What is the average average for the 120-day heating season to
thickness of its blubber, which has the be
conductivity of fatty tissues without blood?

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 61

Additional Problems
102. In 1701, the Danish astronomer Ole Rømer 108. Even when shut down after a period of normal
proposed a temperature scale with two fixed use, a large commercial nuclear reactor
points, freezing water at 7.5 degrees, and transfers thermal energy at the rate of 150 MW
boiling water at 60.0 degrees. What is the by the radioactive decay of fission products.
boiling point of oxygen, 90.2 K, on the Rømer This heat transfer causes a rapid increase in
scale? temperature if the cooling system fails
103. What is the percent error of thinking the or and
melting point of tungsten is instead of (a) Calculate the rate of
the correct value of 3695 K? temperature increase in degrees Celsius per
104. An engineer wants to design a structure in second if the mass of the reactor core is
which the difference in length between a steel and it has an average specific
beam and an aluminum beam remains at heat of . (b) How long would it
0.500 m regardless of temperature, for take to obtain a temperature increase of
ordinary temperatures. What must the lengths , which could cause some metals
of the beams be? holding the radioactive materials to melt? (The
105. How much stress is created in a steel beam if initial rate of temperature increase would be
its temperature changes from to greater than that calculated here because the
but it cannot expand? For steel, the Young’s heat transfer is concentrated in a smaller
modulus from Stress, mass. Later, however, the temperature
Strain, and Elastic Modulus. (Ignore the increase would slow down because the
change in area resulting from the expansion.) 500,000-kg steel containment vessel would
106. A brass rod with a also begin to heat up.)
diameter of 0.800 cm and a length of 1.20 m 109. You leave a pastry in the refrigerator on a plate
when the temperature is , is fixed at both and ask your roommate to take it out before
ends. At what temperature is the force in it at you get home so you can eat it at room
36,000 N? temperature, the way you like it. Instead, your
107. A mercury thermometer still in use for roommate plays video games for hours. When
meteorology has a bulb with a volume of you return, you notice that the pastry is still
and a tube for the mercury to cold, but the game console has become hot.
expand into of inside diameter 0.130 mm. (a) Annoyed, and knowing that the pastry will not
Neglecting the thermal expansion of the glass, be good if it is microwaved, you warm up the
what is the spacing between marks apart? pastry by unplugging the console and putting
(b) If the thermometer is made of ordinary it in a clean trash bag (which acts as a perfect
glass (not a good idea), what is the spacing? calorimeter) with the pastry on the plate. After
a while, you find that the equilibrium
temperature is a nice, warm . You know
that the game console has a mass of 2.1 kg.
Approximate it as having a uniform initial
temperature of . The pastry has a mass of
0.16 kg and a specific heat of
and is at a uniform initial temperature of
. The plate is at the same temperature
and has a mass of 0.24 kg and a specific heat of
. What is the specific heat of
the console?
110. Two solid spheres, A and B, made of the same
material, are at temperatures of and
, respectively. The spheres are placed in
thermal contact in an ideal calorimeter, and
they reach an equilibrium temperature of
. Which is the bigger sphere? What is the
ratio of their diameters?
62 1 • Chapter Review

111. In some countries, liquid nitrogen is used on 118. (a) An exterior wall of a house is 3 m tall and
dairy trucks instead of mechanical 10 m wide. It consists of a layer of drywall with
refrigerators. A 3.00-hour delivery trip an R factor of 0.56, a layer 3.5 inches thick
requires 200 L of liquid nitrogen, which has a filled with fiberglass batts, and a layer of
density of (a) Calculate the heat insulated siding with an R factor of 2.6. The
transfer necessary to evaporate this amount of wall is built so well that there are no leaks of
liquid nitrogen and raise its temperature to air through it. When the inside of the wall is at
. (Use and assume it is constant over and the outside is at , what is the
the temperature range.) This value is the rate of heat flow through the wall? (b) More
amount of cooling the liquid nitrogen supplies. realistically, the 3.5-inch space also contains
(b) What is this heat transfer rate in kilowatt- 2-by-4 studs—wooden boards 1.5 inches by 3.5
hours? (c) Compare the amount of cooling inches oriented so that 3.5-inch dimension
obtained from melting an identical mass of extends from the drywall to the siding. They
ice with that from evaporating the liquid are “on 16-inch centers,” that is, the centers of
nitrogen. the studs are 16 inches apart. What is the heat
112. Some gun fanciers make their own bullets, current in this situation? Don’t worry about
which involves melting lead and casting it into one stud more or less.
lead slugs. How much heat transfer is needed 119. For the human body, what is the rate of heat
to raise the temperature and melt 0.500 kg of transfer by conduction through the body’s
lead, starting from ? tissue with the following conditions: the tissue
113. A 0.800-kg iron cylinder at a temperature of thickness is 3.00 cm, the difference in
is dropped into an insulated temperature is , and the skin area is
chest of 1.00 kg of ice at its melting point. . How does this compare with the
What is the final temperature, and how much average heat transfer rate to the body resulting
ice has melted? from an energy intake of about 2400 kcal per
114. Repeat the preceding problem with 2.00 kg of day? (No exercise is included.)
ice instead of 1.00 kg.
115. Repeat the preceding problem with 0.500 kg of
ice, assuming that the ice is initially in a
copper container of mass 1.50 kg in
equilibrium with the ice.
116. A 30.0-g ice cube at its melting point is
dropped into an aluminum calorimeter of
mass 100.0 g in equilibrium at with
300.0 g of an unknown liquid. The final
temperature is . What is the heat
capacity of the liquid?
117. (a) Calculate the rate of heat conduction
through a double-paned window that has a
area and is made of two panes of
0.800-cm-thick glass separated by a 1.00-cm
air gap. The inside surface temperature is
while that on the outside is
(Hint: There are identical temperature drops
across the two glass panes. First find these and
then the temperature drop across the air gap.
This problem ignores the increased heat
transfer in the air gap due to convection.) (b)
Calculate the rate of heat conduction through a
1.60-cm-thick window of the same area and
with the same temperatures. Compare your
answer with that for part (a).

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 63

120. You have a Dewar flask (a laboratory vacuum 121. An infrared heater for a sauna has a surface
flask) that has an open top and straight sides, area of and an emissivity of 0.84.
as shown below. You fill it with water and put it What temperature must it run at if the
into the freezer. It is effectively a perfect required power is 360 W? Neglect the
insulator, blocking all heat transfer, except on temperature of the environment.
the top. After a time, ice forms on the surface 122. (a) Determine the power of radiation from the
of the water. The liquid water and the bottom Sun by noting that the intensity of the
surface of the ice, in contact with the liquid radiation at the distance of Earth is
water, are at . The top surface of the ice is . Hint: That intensity will be found
at the same temperature as the air in the everywhere on a spherical surface with radius
freezer, Set the rate of heat flow equal to that of Earth’s orbit. (b) Assuming that
through the ice equal to the rate of loss of heat the Sun’s temperature is 5780 K and that its
of fusion as the water freezes. When the ice emissivity is 1, find its radius.
layer is 0.700 cm thick, find the rate in m/s at
which the ice is thickening.

Challenge Problems
123. A pendulum is made of a rod of length L and 125. In a calorimeter of negligible heat capacity,
negligible mass, but capable of thermal 200 g of steam at and 100 g of ice at
expansion, and a weight of negligible size. (a) are mixed. The pressure is maintained
Show that when the temperature increases by at 1 atm. What is the final temperature, and
dT, the period of the pendulum increases by a how much steam, ice, and water are present?
fraction . (b) A clock controlled by a
brass pendulum keeps time correctly at .
If the room temperature is , does the
clock run faster or slower? What is its error in
seconds per day?
124. At temperatures of a few hundred kelvins the
specific heat capacity of copper approximately
follows the empirical formula
where
and
How much heat is
needed to raise the temperature of a 2.00-kg
piece of copper from to ?
64 1 • Chapter Review

126. An astronaut performing an extra-vehicular 128. As the very first rudiment of climatology,
activity (space walk) shaded from the Sun is estimate the temperature of Earth. Assume it
wearing a spacesuit that can be approximated is a perfect sphere and its temperature is
as perfectly white except for a uniform. Ignore the greenhouse effect.
patch in the form of the Thermal radiation from the Sun has an
astronaut’s national flag. The patch has intensity (the “solar constant” S) of about
emissivity 0.300. The spacesuit under the at the radius of Earth’s orbit. (a)
patch is 0.500 cm thick, with a thermal Assuming the Sun’s rays are parallel, what
conductivity , and its inner area must S be multiplied by to get the total
surface is at a temperature of . What is radiation intercepted by Earth? It will be
the temperature of the patch, and what is the easiest to answer in terms of Earth’s radius, R.
rate of heat loss through it? Assume the patch (b) Assume that Earth reflects about 30% of
is so thin that its outer surface is at the same the solar energy it intercepts. In other words,
temperature as the outer surface of the Earth has an albedo with a value of . In
spacesuit under it. Also assume the terms of S, A, and R, what is the rate at which
temperature of outer space is 0 K. You will get Earth absorbs energy from the Sun? (c) Find
an equation that is very hard to solve in closed the temperature at which Earth radiates
form, so you can solve it numerically with a energy at the same rate. Assume that at the
graphing calculator, with software, or even by infrared wavelengths where it radiates, the
trial and error with a calculator. emissivity e is 1. Does your result show that
127. Find the growth of an ice layer as a function of the greenhouse effect is important? (d) How
time in a Dewar flask as seen in Exercise does your answer depend on the the area of
1.120. Call the thickness of the ice layer L. (a) Earth?
Derive an equation for dL/dt in terms of L , the
temperature T above the ice, and the
properties of ice (which you can leave in
symbolic form instead of substituting the
numbers). (b) Solve this differential equation
assuming that at , you have If you
have studied differential equations, you will
know a technique for solving equations of this
type: manipulate the equation to get dL/dt
multiplied by a (very simple) function of L on
one side, and integrate both sides with respect
to time. Alternatively, you may be able to use
your knowledge of the derivatives of various
functions to guess the solution, which has a
simple dependence on t. (c) Will the water
eventually freeze to the bottom of the flask?

Access for free at openstax.org.


1 • Chapter Review 65

129. Let’s stop ignoring the greenhouse effect and (https://openstax.org/l/21paulgormlec) by


incorporate it into the previous problem in a Paul O’Gorman.
very rough way. Assume the atmosphere is a
single layer, a spherical shell around Earth,
with an emissivity (chosen simply to
give the right answer) at infrared wavelengths
emitted by Earth and by the atmosphere.
However, the atmosphere is transparent to the
Sun’s radiation (that is, assume the radiation is
at visible wavelengths with no infrared), so the
Sun’s radiation reaches the surface. The
greenhouse effect comes from the difference
between the atmosphere’s transmission of
visible light and its rather strong absorption of
infrared. Note that the atmosphere’s radius is
not significantly different from Earth’s, but
since the atmosphere is a layer above Earth, it
emits radiation both upward and downward,
so it has twice Earth’s area. There are three
radiative energy transfers in this problem:
solar radiation absorbed by Earth’s surface;
infrared radiation from the surface, which is
absorbed by the atmosphere according to its
emissivity; and infrared radiation from the
atmosphere, half of which is absorbed by Earth
and half of which goes out into space. Apply
the method of the previous problem to get an
equation for Earth’s surface and one for the
atmosphere, and solve them for the two
unknown temperatures, surface and
atmosphere.
a. In terms of Earth’s radius, the constant ,
and the unknown temperature of the
surface, what is the power of the infrared
radiation from the surface?
b. What is the power of Earth’s radiation
absorbed by the atmosphere?
c. In terms of the unknown temperature
of the atmosphere, what is the power
radiated from the atmosphere?
d. Write an equation that says the power of
the radiation the atmosphere absorbs
from Earth equals the power of the
radiation it emits.
e. Half of the power radiated by the
atmosphere hits Earth. Write an equation
that says that the power Earth absorbs
from the atmosphere and the Sun equals
the power that it emits.
f. Solve your two equations for the unknown
temperature of Earth.
For steps that make this model less crude,
see for example the lectures
66 1 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 2
The Kinetic Theory of Gases

Figure 2.1 A volcanic eruption releases tons of gas and dust into the atmosphere. Most of the gas is water vapor,
but several other gases are common, including greenhouse gases such as carbon dioxide and acidic pollutants such
as sulfur dioxide. However, the emission of volcanic gas is not all bad: Many geologists believe that in the earliest
stages of Earth’s formation, volcanic emissions formed the early atmosphere. (credit: modification of work by
“Boaworm”/Wikimedia Commons)

Chapter Outline

2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas

2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed

2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of Energy

2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds

INTRODUCTION Gases are literally all around us—the air that we breathe is a mixture of gases. Other gases
include those that make breads and cakes soft, those that make drinks fizzy, and those that burn to heat many
homes. Engines and refrigerators depend on the behaviors of gases, as we will see in later chapters.

As we discussed in the preceding chapter, the study of heat and temperature is part of an area of physics
known as thermodynamics, in which we require a system to be macroscopic, that is, to consist of a huge
number (such as ) of molecules. We begin by considering some macroscopic properties of gases: volume,
pressure, and temperature. The simple model of a hypothetical “ideal gas” describes these properties of a gas
very accurately under many conditions. We move from the ideal gas model to a more widely applicable
approximation, called the Van der Waals model.
68 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

To understand gases even better, we must also look at them on the microscopic scale of molecules. In gases,
the molecules interact weakly, so the microscopic behavior of gases is relatively simple, and they serve as a
good introduction to systems of many molecules. The molecular model of gases is called the kinetic theory of
gases and is one of the classic examples of a molecular model that explains everyday behavior.

2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Apply the ideal gas law to situations involving the pressure, volume, temperature, and the number of
molecules of a gas
• Use the unit of moles in relation to numbers of molecules, and molecular and macroscopic masses
• Explain the ideal gas law in terms of moles rather than numbers of molecules
• Apply the van der Waals gas law to situations where the ideal gas law is inadequate

In this section, we explore the thermal behavior of gases. Our word “gas” comes from the Flemish word
meaning “chaos,” first used for vapors by the seventeenth-century chemist J. B. van Helmont. The term was
more appropriate than he knew, because gases consist of molecules moving and colliding with each other at
random. This randomness makes the connection between the microscopic and macroscopic domains simpler
for gases than for liquids or solids.

How do gases differ from solids and liquids? Under ordinary conditions, such as those of the air around us, the
difference is that the molecules of gases are much farther apart than those of solids and liquids. Because the
typical distances between molecules are large compared to the size of a molecule, as illustrated in Figure 2.2,
the forces between them are considered negligible, except when they come into contact with each other during
collisions. Also, at temperatures well above the boiling temperature, the motion of molecules is fast, and the
gases expand rapidly to occupy all of the accessible volume. In contrast, in liquids and solids, molecules are
closer together, and the behavior of molecules in liquids and solids is highly constrained by the molecules’
interactions with one another. The macroscopic properties of such substances depend strongly on the forces
between the molecules, and since many molecules are interacting, the resulting “many-body problems” can be
extremely complicated (see Condensed Matter Physics).

Figure 2.2 Atoms and molecules in a gas are typically widely separated. Because the forces between them are quite weak at these
distances, the properties of a gas depend more on the number of atoms per unit volume and on temperature than on the type of atom.

The Gas Laws


In the previous chapter, we saw one consequence of the large intermolecular spacing in gases: Gases are easily
compressed. Table 1.2 shows that gases have larger coefficients of volume expansion than either solids or
liquids. These large coefficients mean that gases expand and contract very rapidly with temperature changes.
We also saw (in the section on thermal expansion) that most gases expand at the same rate or have the same
coefficient of volume expansion, . This raises a question: Why do all gases act in nearly the same way, when
all the various liquids and solids have widely varying expansion rates?

To study how the pressure, temperature, and volume of a gas relate to one another, consider what happens
when you pump air into a deflated car tire. The tire’s volume first increases in direct proportion to the amount
of air injected, without much increase in the tire pressure. Once the tire has expanded to nearly its full size, the
tire’s walls limit its volume expansion. If we continue to pump air into the tire, the pressure increases. When

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.1 • Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 69

the car is driven and the tires flex, their temperature increases, and therefore the pressure increases even
further (Figure 2.3).

Figure 2.3 (a) When air is pumped into a deflated tire, its volume first increases without much increase in pressure. (b) When the tire is
filled to a certain point, the tire walls resist further expansion, and the pressure increases with more air. (c) Once the tire is inflated, its
pressure increases with temperature.

Figure 2.4 shows data from the experiments of Robert Boyle (1627–1691), illustrating what is now called
Boyle’s law: At constant temperature and number of molecules, the absolute pressure of a gas and its volume
are inversely proportional. (Recall from Fluid Mechanics that the absolute pressure is the true pressure and
the gauge pressure is the absolute pressure minus the ambient pressure, typically atmospheric pressure.) The
graph in Figure 2.4 displays this relationship as an inverse proportionality of volume to pressure.

Figure 2.4 Robert Boyle and his assistant found that volume and pressure are inversely proportional. Here their data are plotted as V
versus 1/p; the linearity of the graph shows the inverse proportionality. The number shown as the volume is actually the height in inches of
air in a cylindrical glass tube. The actual volume was that height multiplied by the cross-sectional area of the tube, which Boyle did not
1
publish. The data are from Boyle’s book A Defence of the Doctrine Touching the Spring and Weight of the Air…, p. 60.

Figure 2.5 shows experimental data illustrating what is called Charles’s law, after Jacques Charles
(1746–1823). Charles’s law states that at constant pressure and number of molecules, the volume of a gas is
proportional to its absolute temperature.

1 http://bvpb.mcu.es/en/consulta/registro.cmd?id=406806
70 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

Figure 2.5 Experimental data showing that at constant pressure, volume is approximately proportional to temperature. The best-fit line
2
passes approximately through the origin.

Similar is Amonton’s or Gay-Lussac’s law, which states that at constant volume and number of molecules, the
pressure is proportional to the temperature. That law is the basis of the constant-volume gas thermometer,
discussed in the previous chapter. (The histories of these laws and the appropriate credit for them are more
complicated than can be discussed here.)

It is known experimentally that for gases at low density (such that their molecules occupy a negligible fraction
of the total volume) and at temperatures well above the boiling point, these proportionalities hold to a good
approximation. Not surprisingly, with the other quantities held constant, either pressure or volume is
proportional to the number of molecules. More surprisingly, when the proportionalities are combined into a
single equation, the constant of proportionality is independent of the composition of the gas. The resulting
equation for all gases applies in the limit of low density and high temperature; it’s the same for oxygen as for
helium or uranium hexafluoride. A gas at that limit is called an ideal gas; it obeys the ideal gas law, which is
also called the equation of state of an ideal gas.

Ideal Gas Law


The ideal gas law states that
2.1
where p is the absolute pressure of a gas, V is the volume it occupies, N is the number of molecules in the
gas, and T is its absolute temperature.

The constant is called the Boltzmann constant in honor of the Austrian physicist Ludwig Boltzmann
(1844–1906) and has the value

The ideal gas law describes the behavior of any real gas when its density is low enough or its temperature high
enough that it is far from liquefaction. This encompasses many practical situations. In the next section, we’ll
see why it’s independent of the type of gas.

2 http://chemed.chem.purdue.edu/genchem/history/charles.html

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.1 • Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 71

In many situations, the ideal gas law is applied to a sample of gas with a constant number of molecules; for
instance, the gas may be in a sealed container. If N is constant, then solving for N shows that pV /T is constant.
We can write that fact in a convenient form:

2.2

where the subscripts 1 and 2 refer to any two states of the gas at different times. Again, the temperature must
be expressed in kelvin and the pressure must be absolute pressure, which is the sum of gauge pressure and
atmospheric pressure.

EXAMPLE 2.1

Calculating Pressure Changes Due to Temperature Changes


Suppose your bicycle tire is fully inflated, with an absolute pressure of (a gauge pressure of just
under ) at a temperature of What is the pressure after its temperature has risen to
on a hot day? Assume there are no appreciable leaks or changes in volume.

Strategy
The pressure in the tire is changing only because of changes in temperature. We know the initial pressure
the initial temperature and the final temperature We must
find the final pressure Since the number of molecules is constant, we can use the equation

Since the volume is constant, and are the same and they divide out. Therefore,

We can then rearrange this to solve for

where the temperature must be in kelvin.

Solution

1. Convert temperatures from degrees Celsius to kelvin

2. Substitute the known values into the equation,

Significance
The final temperature is about greater than the original temperature, so the final pressure is about
greater as well. Note that absolute pressure (see Fluid Mechanics) and absolute temperature (see Temperature
and Heat) must be used in the ideal gas law.
72 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

EXAMPLE 2.2

Calculating the Number of Molecules in a Cubic Meter of Gas


How many molecules are in a typical object, such as gas in a tire or water in a glass? This calculation can give
us an idea of how large N typically is. Let’s calculate the number of molecules in the air that a typical healthy
young adult inhales in one breath, with a volume of 500 mL, at standard temperature and pressure (STP),
which is defined as and atmospheric pressure. (Our young adult is apparently outside in winter.)

Strategy
Because pressure, volume, and temperature are all specified, we can use the ideal gas law, to find
N.

Solution

1. Identify the knowns.

2. Substitute the known values into the equation and solve for N.

Significance
N is huge, even in small volumes. For example, of a gas at STP contains molecules. Once
again, note that our result for N is the same for all types of gases, including mixtures.

As we observed in the chapter on fluid mechanics, pascals are , so Thus, our result
for N is dimensionless, a pure number that could be obtained by counting (in principle) rather than measuring.
As it is the number of molecules, we put “molecules” after the number, keeping in mind that it is an aid to
communication rather than a unit.

Moles and Avogadro’s Number


It is often convenient to measure the amount of substance with a unit on a more human scale than molecules.
The SI unit for this purpose was developed by the Italian scientist Amedeo Avogadro (1776–1856). (He worked
from the hypothesis that equal volumes of gas at equal pressure and temperature contain equal numbers of
molecules, independent of the type of gas. As mentioned above, this hypothesis has been confirmed when the
ideal gas approximation applies.) A mole (abbreviated mol) is defined as the amount of any substance that
contains as many molecules as there are atoms. (Technically, we should say “formula units,” not “molecules,”
but this distinction is irrelevant for our purposes.) The number of molecules in one mole is called Avogadro’s
number and the value of Avogadro’s number is now known to be

We can now write , where n represents the number of moles of a substance.

Avogadro’s number relates the mass of an amount of substance in grams to the number of protons and
neutrons in an atom or molecule (12 for a carbon-12 atom), which roughly determine its mass. It’s natural to
define a unit of mass such that the mass of an atom is approximately equal to its number of neutrons and
protons. The unit of that kind accepted for use with the SI is the unified atomic mass unit (u), also called the
dalton. Specifically, a carbon-12 atom has a mass of exactly 12 u, so that its molar mass M in grams per mole is
numerically equal to the mass of one carbon-12 atom in u. That equality holds for any substance. In other
words, is not only the conversion from numbers of molecules to moles, but it is also the conversion from u
to grams: See Figure 2.6.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.1 • Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 73

Figure 2.6 How big is a mole? On a macroscopic level, Avogadro’s number of table tennis balls would cover Earth to a depth of about 40
km.

Now letting stand for the mass of a sample of a substance, we have Letting m stand for the mass
of a molecule, we have

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.1


The recommended daily amount of vitamin or niacin, for women who are not pregnant or
nursing, is 14 mg. Find the number of molecules of niacin in that amount.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.2


The density of air in a classroom and is . At what pressure is the density
if the temperature is kept constant?

The Ideal Gas Law Restated using Moles


A very common expression of the ideal gas law uses the number of moles in a sample, n, rather than the
number of molecules, N. We start from the ideal gas law,

and multiply and divide the right-hand side of the equation by Avogadro’s number This gives us

Note that is the number of moles. We define the universal gas constant as and obtain
the ideal gas law in terms of moles.

Ideal Gas Law (in terms of moles)


In terms of number of moles n, the ideal gas law is written as
2.3
In SI units,

In other units,

You can use whichever value of R is most convenient for a particular problem.
74 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

EXAMPLE 2.3

Density of Air at STP and in a Hot Air Balloon


Calculate the density of dry air (a) under standard conditions and (b) in a hot air balloon at a temperature of
. Dry air is approximately and .

Strategy and Solution

a. We are asked to find the density, or mass per cubic meter. We can begin by finding the molar mass. If we
have a hundred molecules, of which 78 are nitrogen, 21 are oxygen, and 1 is argon, the average molecular

mass is , or the mass of each constituent multiplied by its percentage. The same
applies to the molar mass, which therefore is

Now we can find the number of moles per cubic meter. We use the ideal gas law in terms of moles,
with , , , and . The most convenient choice
for R in this case is because the known quantities are in SI units:

Then, the mass of that air is

Finally the density of air at STP is

b. The air pressure inside the balloon is still 1 atm because the bottom of the balloon is open to the
atmosphere. The calculation is the same except that we use a temperature of , which is 393 K. We
can repeat the calculation in (a), or simply observe that the density is proportional to the number of moles,
which is inversely proportional to the temperature. Then using the subscripts 1 for air at STP and 2 for the
hot air, we have

Significance

Using the methods of Archimedes’ Principle and Buoyancy, we can find that the net force on of air at
is or enough to lift about 867 kg. The mass
density and molar density of air at STP, found above, are often useful numbers. From the molar density, we can
easily determine another useful number, the volume of a mole of any ideal gas at STP, which is 22.4 L.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.3


Liquids and solids have densities on the order of 1000 times greater than gases. Explain how this implies that
the distances between molecules in gases are on the order of 10 times greater than the size of their molecules.

The ideal gas law is closely related to energy: The units on both sides of the equation are joules. The right-hand
side of the ideal gas law equation is This term is roughly the total translational kinetic energy (which,
when discussing gases, refers to the energy of translation of a molecule, not that of vibration of its atoms or
rotation) of N molecules at an absolute temperature T, as we will see formally in the next section. The left-hand
side of the ideal gas law equation is pV. As mentioned in the example on the number of molecules in an ideal
gas, pressure multiplied by volume has units of energy. The energy of a gas can be changed when the gas does
work as it increases in volume, something we explored in the preceding chapter, and the amount of work is
related to the pressure. This is the process that occurs in gasoline or steam engines and turbines, as we’ll see

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.1 • Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 75

in the next chapter.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

The Ideal Gas Law


Step 1. Examine the situation to determine that an ideal gas is involved. Most gases are nearly ideal unless
they are close to the boiling point or at pressures far above atmospheric pressure.

Step 2. Make a list of what quantities are given or can be inferred from the problem as stated (identify the
known quantities).

Step 3. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknown quantities). A
written list is useful.

Step 4. Determine whether the number of molecules or the number of moles is known or asked for to decide
whether to use the ideal gas law as where N is the number of molecules, or where n
is the number of moles.

Step 5. Convert known values into proper SI units (K for temperature, Pa for pressure, for volume,
molecules for N, and moles for n). If the units of the knowns are consistent with one of the non-SI values of R,
you can leave them in those units. Be sure to use absolute temperature and absolute pressure.

Step 6. Solve the ideal gas law for the quantity to be determined (the unknown quantity). You may need to take
a ratio of final states to initial states to eliminate the unknown quantities that are kept fixed.

Step 7. Substitute the known quantities, along with their units, into the appropriate equation and obtain
numerical solutions complete with units.

Step 8. Check the answer to see if it is reasonable: Does it make sense?

The Van der Waals Equation of State


We have repeatedly noted that the ideal gas law is an approximation. How can it be improved upon? The van
der Waals equation of state (named after the Dutch physicist Johannes van der Waals, 1837−1923) improves
it by taking into account two factors. First, the attractive forces between molecules, which are stronger at
higher density and reduce the pressure, are taken into account by adding to the pressure a term equal to the
square of the molar density multiplied by a positive coefficient a. Second, the volume of the molecules is
represented by a positive constant b, which can be thought of as the volume of a mole of molecules. This is
subtracted from the total volume to give the remaining volume that the molecules can move in. The constants
a and b are determined experimentally for each gas. The resulting equation is

2.4

In the limit of low density (small n), the a and b terms are negligible, and we have the ideal gas law, as we
should for low density. On the other hand, if is small, meaning that the molecules are very close
together, the pressure must be higher to give the same nRT, as we would expect in the situation of a highly
compressed gas. However, the increase in pressure is less than that argument would suggest, because at high
density the term is significant. Since it’s positive, it causes a lower pressure to give the same nRT.

The van der Waals equation of state works well for most gases under a wide variety of conditions. As we’ll see
in the next module, it even predicts the gas-liquid transition.

pV Diagrams
We can examine aspects of the behavior of a substance by plotting a pV diagram, which is a graph of pressure
versus volume. When the substance behaves like an ideal gas, the ideal gas law describes the
76 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

relationship between its pressure and volume. On a pV diagram, it’s common to plot an isotherm, which is a
curve showing p as a function of V with the number of molecules and the temperature fixed. Then, for an ideal
gas, For example, the volume of the gas decreases as the pressure increases. The resulting
graph is a hyperbola.

However, if we assume the van der Waals equation of state, the isotherms become more interesting, as shown
in Figure 2.7. At high temperatures, the curves are approximately hyperbolas, representing approximately
ideal behavior at various fixed temperatures. At lower temperatures, the curves look less and less like
hyperbolas—that is, the gas is not behaving ideally. There is a critical temperature at which the curve has a
point with zero slope. Below that temperature, the curves do not decrease monotonically; instead, they each
have a “hump,” meaning that for a certain range of volume, increasing the volume increases the pressure.

Figure 2.7 pV diagram for a Van der Waals gas at various temperatures. The red curves are calculated at temperatures above the critical
temperature and the blue curves at temperatures below it. The blue curves have an oscillation in which volume (V) increases with
increasing pressure (P), an impossible situation, so they must be corrected as in Figure 2.8. (credit: “Eman”/Wikimedia Commons)

Such behavior would be completely unphysical. Instead, the curves are understood as describing a liquid-gas
phase transition. The oscillating part of the curve is replaced by a horizontal line, showing that as the volume
increases at constant temperature, the pressure stays constant. That behavior corresponds to boiling and
condensation; when a substance is at its boiling temperature for a particular pressure, it can increase in
volume as some of the liquid turns to gas, or decrease as some of the gas turns to liquid, without any change in
temperature or pressure.

Figure 2.8 shows similar isotherms that are more realistic than those based on the van der Waals equation.
The steep parts of the curves to the left of the transition region show the liquid phase, which is almost
incompressible—a slight decrease in volume requires a large increase in pressure. The flat parts show the
liquid-gas transition; the blue regions that they define represent combinations of pressure and volume where
liquid and gas can coexist.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.1 • Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 77

Figure 2.8 pV diagrams. (a) Each curve (isotherm) represents the relationship between p and V at a fixed temperature; the upper curves
are at higher temperatures. The lower curves are not hyperbolas because the gas is no longer an ideal gas. (b) An expanded portion of the
pV diagram for low temperatures, where the phase can change from a gas to a liquid. The term “vapor” refers to the gas phase when it
exists at a temperature below the boiling temperature.

The isotherms above do not go through the liquid-gas transition. Therefore, liquid cannot exist above that
temperature, which is the critical temperature (described in the chapter on temperature and heat). At
sufficiently low pressure above that temperature, the gas has the density of a liquid but will not condense; the
gas is said to be supercritical. At higher pressure, it is solid. Carbon dioxide, for example, has no liquid phase
at a temperature above . The critical pressure is the maximum pressure at which the liquid can exist.
The point on the pV diagram at the critical pressure and temperature is the critical point (which you learned
about in the chapter on temperature and heat). Table 2.1 lists representative critical temperatures and
pressures.

Substance Critical temperature Critical pressure

K Pa atm

Water 647.4 374.3 219.0

Sulfur dioxide 430.7 157.6 78.0

Ammonia 405.5 132.4 111.7

Carbon dioxide 304.2 31.1 73.2

Oxygen 154.8 –118.4 50.3

Nitrogen 126.2 –146.9 33.6

Hydrogen 33.3 –239.9 12.9

Helium 5.3 –267.9 2.27

Table 2.1 Critical Temperatures and Pressures for Various Substances


78 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the relations between microscopic and macroscopic quantities in a gas
• Solve problems involving mixtures of gases
• Solve problems involving the distance and time between a gas molecule’s collisions

We have examined pressure and temperature based on their macroscopic definitions. Pressure is the force
divided by the area on which the force is exerted, and temperature is measured with a thermometer. We can
gain a better understanding of pressure and temperature from the kinetic theory of gases, the theory that
relates the macroscopic properties of gases to the motion of the molecules they consist of. First, we make two
assumptions about molecules in an ideal gas.

1. There is a very large number N of molecules, all identical and each having mass m.
2. The molecules obey Newton’s laws and are in continuous motion, which is random and isotropic, that is,
the same in all directions.

To derive the ideal gas law and the connection between microscopic quantities such as the energy of a typical
molecule and macroscopic quantities such as temperature, we analyze a sample of an ideal gas in a rigid
container, about which we make two further assumptions:

3. The molecules are much smaller than the average distance between them, so their total volume is much
less than that of their container (which has volume V). In other words, we take the Van der Waals constant
b, the volume of a mole of gas molecules, to be negligible compared to the volume of a mole of gas in the
container.
4. The molecules make perfectly elastic collisions with the walls of the container and with each other. Other
forces on them, including gravity and the attractions represented by the Van der Waals constant a, are
negligible (as is necessary for the assumption of isotropy).

The collisions between molecules do not appear in the derivation of the ideal gas law. They do not disturb the
derivation either, since collisions between molecules moving with random velocities give new random
velocities. Furthermore, if the velocities of gas molecules in a container are initially not random and isotropic,
molecular collisions are what make them random and isotropic.

We make still further assumptions that simplify the calculations but do not affect the result. First, we let the
container be a rectangular box. Second, we begin by considering monatomic gases, those whose molecules
consist of single atoms, such as helium. Then, we can assume that the atoms have no energy except their
translational kinetic energy; for instance, they have neither rotational nor vibrational energy. (Later, we discuss
the validity of this assumption for real monatomic gases and dispense with it to consider diatomic and
polyatomic gases.)

Figure 2.9 shows a collision of a gas molecule with the wall of a container, so that it exerts a force on the wall
(by Newton’s third law). These collisions are the source of pressure in a gas. As the number of molecules
increases, the number of collisions, and thus the pressure, increases. Similarly, if the average velocity of the
molecules is higher, the gas pressure is higher.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.2 • Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 79

Figure 2.9 When a molecule collides with a rigid wall, the component of its momentum perpendicular to the wall is reversed. A force is
thus exerted on the wall, creating pressure.

In a sample of gas in a container, the randomness of the molecular motion causes the number of collisions of
molecules with any part of the wall in a given time to fluctuate. However, because a huge number of molecules
collide with the wall in a short time, the number of collisions on the scales of time and space we measure
fluctuates by only a tiny, usually unobservable fraction from the average. We can compare this situation to that
of a casino, where the outcomes of the bets are random and the casino’s takings fluctuate by the minute and
the hour. However, over long times such as a year, the casino’s takings are very close to the averages expected
from the odds. A tank of gas has enormously more molecules than a casino has bettors in a year, and the
molecules make enormously more collisions in a second than a casino has bets.

A calculation of the average force exerted by molecules on the walls of the box leads us to the ideal gas law and
to the connection between temperature and molecular kinetic energy. (In fact, we will take two averages: one
over time to get the average force exerted by one molecule with a given velocity, and then another average over
molecules with different velocities.) This approach was developed by Daniel Bernoulli (1700–1782), who is
best known in physics for his work on fluid flow (hydrodynamics). Remarkably, Bernoulli did this work before
Dalton established the view of matter as consisting of atoms.

Figure 2.10 shows a container full of gas and an expanded view of an elastic collision of a gas molecule with a
wall of the container, broken down into components. We have assumed that a molecule is small compared with
the separation of molecules in the gas, and that its interaction with other molecules can be ignored. Under
these conditions, the ideal gas law is experimentally valid. Because we have also assumed the wall is rigid and
the particles are points, the collision is elastic (by conservation of energy—there’s nowhere for a particle’s
kinetic energy to go). Therefore, the molecule’s kinetic energy remains constant, and hence, its speed and the
magnitude of its momentum remain constant as well. This assumption is not always valid, but the results in
the rest of this module are also obtained in models that let the molecules exchange energy and momentum
with the wall.
80 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

Figure 2.10 Gas in a box exerts an outward pressure on its walls. A molecule colliding with a rigid wall has its velocity and momentum in
the x-direction reversed. This direction is perpendicular to the wall. The components of its velocity momentum in the y- and z-directions
are not changed, which means there is no force parallel to the wall.

If the molecule’s velocity changes in the x-direction, its momentum changes from to Thus, its
change in momentum is According to the impulse-momentum theorem
given in the chapter on linear momentum and collisions, the force exerted on the ith molecule, where i labels
the molecules from 1 to N, is given by

(In this equation alone, p represents momentum, not pressure.) There is no force between the wall and the
molecule except while the molecule is touching the wall. During the short time of the collision, the force
between the molecule and wall is relatively large, but that is not the force we are looking for. We are looking for
the average force, so we take to be the average time between collisions of the given molecule with this wall,
which is the time in which we expect to find one collision. Let l represent the length of the box in the
x-direction. Then is the time the molecule would take to go across the box and back, a distance 2l, at a
speed of Thus and the expression for the force becomes

This force is due to one molecule. To find the total force on the wall, F, we need to add the contributions of all N
molecules:

We now use the definition of the average, which we denote with a bar, to find the force:

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.2 • Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 81

We want the force in terms of the speed v, rather than the x-component of the velocity. Note that the total
velocity squared is the sum of the squares of its components, so that

With the assumption of isotropy, the three averages on the right side are equal, so

Substituting this into the expression for F gives

The pressure is F/A, so we obtain

where we used for the volume. This gives the important result

2.5

Combining this equation with gives

We can get the average kinetic energy of a molecule, , from the left-hand side of the equation by dividing
out N and multiplying by 3/2.

Average Kinetic Energy per Molecule


The average kinetic energy of a molecule is directly proportional to its absolute temperature:

2.6

The equation is the average kinetic energy per molecule. Note in particular that nothing in this
equation depends on the molecular mass (or any other property) of the gas, the pressure, or anything but the
temperature. If samples of helium and xenon gas, with very different molecular masses, are at the same
temperature, the molecules have the same average kinetic energy.

The internal energy of a thermodynamic system is the sum of the mechanical energies of all of the molecules
in it. We can now give an equation for the internal energy of a monatomic ideal gas. In such a gas, the
molecules’ only energy is their translational kinetic energy. Therefore, denoting the internal energy by we
simply have or

2.7

Often we would like to use this equation in terms of moles:

We can solve for a typical speed of a molecule in an ideal gas in terms of temperature to
determine what is known as the root-mean-square (rms) speed of a molecule.
82 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

RMS Speed of a Molecule


The root-mean-square (rms) speed of a molecule, or the square root of the average of the square of the
speed , is

2.8

The rms speed is not the average or the most likely speed of molecules, as we will see in Distribution of
Molecular Speeds, but it provides an easily calculated estimate of the molecules’ speed that is related to their
kinetic energy. Again we can write this equation in terms of the gas constant R and the molar mass M in kg/
mol:

2.9

We digress for a moment to answer a question that may have occurred to you: When we apply the model to
atoms instead of theoretical point particles, does rotational kinetic energy change our results? To answer this
question, we have to appeal to quantum mechanics. In quantum mechanics, rotational kinetic energy cannot
take on just any value; it’s limited to a discrete set of values, and the smallest value is inversely proportional to
the rotational inertia. The rotational inertia of an atom is tiny because almost all of its mass is in the nucleus,
which typically has a radius less than . Thus the minimum rotational energy of an atom is much more
than for any attainable temperature, and the energy available is not enough to make an atom rotate. We
will return to this point when discussing diatomic and polyatomic gases in the next section.

EXAMPLE 2.4

Calculating Kinetic Energy and Speed of a Gas Molecule


(a) What is the average kinetic energy of a gas molecule at (room temperature)? (b) Find the rms speed
of a nitrogen molecule at this temperature.

Strategy
(a) The known in the equation for the average kinetic energy is the temperature:

Before substituting values into this equation, we must convert the given temperature into kelvin:
We can find the rms speed of a nitrogen molecule by using the equation

but we must first find the mass of a nitrogen molecule. Obtaining the molar mass of nitrogen from the
periodic table, we find

Solution

a. The temperature alone is sufficient for us to find the average translational kinetic energy. Substituting the
temperature into the translational kinetic energy equation gives

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.2 • Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 83

b. Substituting this mass and the value for into the equation for yields

Significance
Note that the average kinetic energy of the molecule is independent of the type of molecule. The average
translational kinetic energy depends only on absolute temperature. The kinetic energy is very small compared
to macroscopic energies, so that we do not feel when an air molecule is hitting our skin. On the other hand, it is
much greater than the typical difference in gravitational potential energy when a molecule moves from, say,
the top to the bottom of a room, so our neglect of gravitation is justified in typical real-world situations. The
rms speed of the nitrogen molecule is surprisingly large. These large molecular velocities do not yield
macroscopic movement of air, since the molecules move in all directions with equal likelihood. The mean free
path (the distance a molecule moves on average between collisions, discussed a bit later in this section) of
molecules in air is very small, so the molecules move rapidly but do not get very far in a second. The high value
for rms speed is reflected in the speed of sound, which is about 340 m/s at room temperature. The higher the
rms speed of air molecules, the faster sound vibrations can be transferred through the air. The speed of sound
increases with temperature and is greater in gases with small molecular masses, such as helium (see Figure
2.11).

Figure 2.11 (a) In an ordinary gas, so many molecules move so fast that they collide billions of times every second. (b) Individual
molecules do not move very far in a small amount of time, but disturbances like sound waves are transmitted at speeds related to the
molecular speeds.

EXAMPLE 2.5

Calculating Temperature: Escape Velocity of Helium Atoms


To escape Earth’s gravity, an object near the top of the atmosphere (at an altitude of 100 km) must travel away
from Earth at 11.1 km/s. This speed is called the escape velocity. At what temperature would helium atoms
have an rms speed equal to the escape velocity?

Strategy
Identify the knowns and unknowns and determine which equations to use to solve the problem.

Solution

1. Identify the knowns: v is the escape velocity, 11.1 km/s.


84 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

2. Identify the unknowns: We need to solve for temperature, T. We also need to solve for the mass m of the
helium atom.
3. Determine which equations are needed.
◦ To get the mass m of the helium atom, we can use information from the periodic table:

◦ To solve for temperature T, we can rearrange

to yield

4. Substitute the known values into the equations and solve for the unknowns,

and

Significance
This temperature is much higher than atmospheric temperature, which is approximately 250 K
at high elevation. Very few helium atoms are left in the atmosphere, but many were
present when the atmosphere was formed, and more are always being created by radioactive decay (see the
chapter on nuclear physics). The reason for the loss of helium atoms is that a small number of helium atoms
have speeds higher than Earth’s escape velocity even at normal temperatures. The speed of a helium atom
changes from one collision to the next, so that at any instant, there is a small but nonzero chance that the
atom’s speed is greater than the escape velocity. The chance is high enough that over the lifetime of Earth,
almost all the helium atoms that have been in the atmosphere have reached escape velocity at high altitudes
and escaped from Earth’s gravitational pull. Heavier molecules, such as oxygen, nitrogen, and water, have
smaller rms speeds, and so it is much less likely that any of them will have speeds greater than the escape
velocity. In fact, the likelihood is so small that billions of years are required to lose significant amounts of
heavier molecules from the atmosphere. Figure 2.12 shows the effect of a lack of an atmosphere on the Moon.
Because the gravitational pull of the Moon is much weaker, it has lost almost its entire atmosphere. The
atmospheres of Earth and other bodies are compared in this chapter’s exercises.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.2 • Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 85

Figure 2.12 This photograph of Apollo 17 Commander Eugene Cernan driving the lunar rover on the Moon in 1972 looks as though it was
taken at night with a large spotlight. In fact, the light is coming from the Sun. Because the acceleration due to gravity on the Moon is so low
(about 1/6 that of Earth), the Moon’s escape velocity is much smaller. As a result, gas molecules escape very easily from the Moon, leaving
it with virtually no atmosphere. Even during the daytime, the sky is black because there is no gas to scatter sunlight. (credit: Harrison H.
Schmitt/NASA)

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.4


If you consider a very small object, such as a grain of pollen, in a gas, then the number of molecules striking its
surface would also be relatively small. Would you expect the grain of pollen to experience any fluctuations in
pressure due to statistical fluctuations in the number of gas molecules striking it in a given amount of time?

Vapor Pressure, Partial Pressure, and Dalton’s Law


The pressure a gas would create if it occupied the total volume available is called the gas’s partial pressure. If
two or more gases are mixed, they will come to thermal equilibrium as a result of collisions between
molecules; the process is analogous to heat conduction as described in the chapter on temperature and heat.
As we have seen from kinetic theory, when the gases have the same temperature, their molecules have the
same average kinetic energy. Thus, each gas obeys the ideal gas law separately and exerts the same pressure
on the walls of a container that it would if it were alone. Therefore, in a mixture of gases, the total pressure is
the sum of partial pressures of the component gases, assuming ideal gas behavior and no chemical reactions
between the components. This law is known as Dalton’s law of partial pressures, after the English scientist
John Dalton (1766–1844) who proposed it. Dalton’s law is consistent with the fact that pressures add according
to Pascal’s principle.

In a mixture of ideal gases in thermal equilibrium, the number of molecules of each gas is proportional to its
partial pressure. This result follows from applying the ideal gas law to each in the form Because
the right-hand side is the same for any gas at a given temperature in a container of a given volume, the left-
hand side is the same as well.

• Partial pressure is the pressure a gas would create if it existed alone.


• Dalton’s law states that the total pressure is the sum of the partial pressures of all of the gases present.
• For any two gases (labeled 1 and 2) in equilibrium in a container,

An important application of partial pressure is that, in chemistry, it functions as the concentration of a gas in
86 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

determining the rate of a reaction. Here, we mention only that the partial pressure of oxygen in a person’s
lungs is crucial to life and health. Breathing air that has a partial pressure of oxygen below 0.16 atm can impair
coordination and judgment, particularly in people not acclimated to a high elevation. Lower partial pressures
of have more serious effects; partial pressures below 0.06 atm can be quickly fatal, and permanent damage
is likely even if the person is rescued. However, the sensation of needing to breathe, as when holding one’s
breath, is caused much more by high concentrations of carbon dioxide in the blood than by low concentrations
of oxygen. Thus, if a small room or closet is filled with air having a low concentration of oxygen, perhaps
because a leaking cylinder of some compressed gas is stored there, a person will not feel any “choking”
sensation and may go into convulsions or lose consciousness without noticing anything wrong. Safety
engineers give considerable attention to this danger.

Another important application of partial pressure is vapor pressure, which is the partial pressure of a vapor at
which it is in equilibrium with the liquid (or solid, in the case of sublimation) phase of the same substance. At
any temperature, the partial pressure of the water in the air cannot exceed the vapor pressure of the water at
that temperature, because whenever the partial pressure reaches the vapor pressure, water condenses out of
the air. Dew is an example of this condensation. The temperature at which condensation occurs for a sample of
air is called the dew point. It is easily measured by slowly cooling a metal ball; the dew point is the temperature
at which condensation first appears on the ball.

The vapor pressures of water at some temperatures of interest for meteorology are given in Table 2.2.

T Vapor Pressure (Pa)

0 610.5

3 757.9

5 872.3

8 1073

10 1228

13 1497

15 1705

18 2063

20 2338

23 2809

25 3167

30 4243

35 5623

40 7376

Table 2.2 Vapor Pressure of Water at Various Temperatures

The relative humidity (R.H.) at a temperature T is defined by

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.2 • Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed 87

A relative humidity of means that the partial pressure of water is equal to the vapor pressure; in other
words, the air is saturated with water.

EXAMPLE 2.6

Calculating Relative Humidity


What is the relative humidity when the air temperature is and the dew point is ?

Strategy
We simply look up the vapor pressure at the given temperature and that at the dew point and find the ratio.

Solution

Significance
R.H. is important to our comfort. The value of is within the range of recommended for
comfort indoors.

As noted in the chapter on temperature and heat, the temperature seldom falls below the dew point, because
when it reaches the dew point or frost point, water condenses and releases a relatively large amount of latent
heat of vaporization.

Mean Free Path and Mean Free Time


We now consider collisions explicitly. The usual first step (which is all we’ll take) is to calculate the mean free
path, the average distance a molecule travels between collisions with other molecules, and the mean free
time , the average time between the collisions of a molecule. If we assume all the molecules are spheres with a
radius r, then a molecule will collide with another if their centers are within a distance 2r of each other. For a
given particle, we say that the area of a circle with that radius, , is the “cross-section” for collisions. As the
particle moves, it traces a cylinder with that cross-sectional area. The mean free path is the length such that
the expected number of other molecules in a cylinder of length and cross-section is 1. If we temporarily
ignore the motion of the molecules other than the one we’re looking at, the expected number is the number
density of molecules, N/V, times the volume, and the volume is , so we have or

Taking the motion of all the molecules into account makes the calculation much harder, but the only change is
a factor of The result is

2.10

In an ideal gas, we can substitute to obtain

2.11

The mean free time is simply the mean free path divided by a typical speed, and the usual choice is the rms
speed. Then
88 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

2.12

EXAMPLE 2.7

Calculating Mean Free Time


Find the mean free time for argon atoms at a temperature of and a pressure of 1.00
atm. Take the radius of an argon atom to be

Solution

1. Identify the knowns and convert into SI units. We know the molar mass is 0.0399 kg/mol, the temperature
is 273 K, the pressure is and the radius is
2. Find the rms speed: .
3. Substitute into the equation for the mean free time:

Significance
We can hardly compare this result with our intuition about gas molecules, but it gives us a picture of molecules
colliding with extremely high frequency.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.5


Which has a longer mean free path, liquid water or water vapor in the air?

2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of Energy


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Solve problems involving heat transfer to and from ideal monatomic gases whose volumes are held constant
• Solve similar problems for non-monatomic ideal gases based on the number of degrees of freedom of a
molecule
• Estimate the heat capacities of metals using a model based on degrees of freedom

In the chapter on temperature and heat, we defined the specific heat capacity with the equation or
. However, the properties of an ideal gas depend directly on the number of moles in a sample,
so here we define specific heat capacity in terms of the number of moles, not the mass. Furthermore, when
talking about solids and liquids, we ignored any changes in volume and pressure with changes in
temperature—a good approximation for solids and liquids, but for gases, we have to make some condition on
volume or pressure changes. Here, we focus on the heat capacity with the volume held constant. We can
calculate it for an ideal gas.

Heat Capacity of an Ideal Monatomic Gas at Constant Volume


We define the molar heat capacity at constant volume as

This is often expressed in the form

2.13

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.3 • Heat Capacity and Equipartition of Energy 89

If the volume does not change, there is no overall displacement, so no work is done, and the only change in
internal energy is due to the heat flow (This statement is discussed further in the next chapter.) We
use the equation to write and substitute for Q to find ,
which gives the following simple result for an ideal monatomic gas:

It is independent of temperature, which justifies our use of finite differences instead of a derivative. This
formula agrees well with experimental results.

In the next chapter we discuss the molar specific heat at constant pressure which is always greater than

EXAMPLE 2.8

Calculating Temperature
A sample of 0.125 kg of xenon is contained in a rigid metal cylinder, big enough that the xenon can be modeled
as an ideal gas, at a temperature of . The cylinder is moved outside on a hot summer day. As the xenon
comes into equilibrium by reaching the temperature of its surroundings, 180 J of heat are conducted to it
through the cylinder walls. What is the equilibrium temperature? Ignore the expansion of the metal cylinder.

Solution

1. Identify the knowns: We know the initial temperature is , the heat Q is 180 J, and the mass m of
the xenon is 0.125 kg.
2. Identify the unknown. We need the final temperature, so we’ll need .
3. Determine which equations are needed. Because xenon gas is monatomic, we can use
Then we need the number of moles,
4. Substitute the known values into the equations and solve for the unknowns.
The molar mass of xenon is 131.3 g, so we obtain

Therefore, the final temperature is . The problem could equally well be solved in kelvin; as a kelvin
is the same size as a degree Celsius of temperature change, you would get

Significance
The heating of an ideal or almost ideal gas at constant volume is important in car engines and many other
practical systems.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 2.6


Suppose 2 moles of helium gas at 200 K are mixed with 2 moles of krypton gas at 400 K in a calorimeter. What
is the final temperature?

We would like to generalize our results to ideal gases with more than one atom per molecule. In such systems,
the molecules can have other forms of energy beside translational kinetic energy, such as rotational kinetic
energy and vibrational kinetic and potential energies. We will see that a simple rule lets us determine the
average energies present in these forms and solve problems in much the same way as we have for monatomic
gases.
90 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

Degrees of Freedom
In the previous section, we found that and , from which it follows that
. The same equation holds for and for . Thus, we can look at our energy of as the
sum of contributions of from each of the three dimensions of translational motion. Shifting to the gas as
a whole, we see that the 3 in the formula also reflects those three dimensions. We define a degree of
freedom as an independent possible motion of a molecule, such as each of the three dimensions of
translation. Then, letting d represent the number of degrees of freedom, the molar heat capacity at constant
volume of a monatomic ideal gas is where .

The branch of physics called statistical mechanics tells us, and experiment confirms, that of any ideal gas
is given by this equation, regardless of the number of degrees of freedom. This fact follows from a more
general result, the equipartition theorem, which holds in classical (non-quantum) thermodynamics for
systems in thermal equilibrium under technical conditions that are beyond our scope. Here, we mention only
that in a system, the energy is shared among the degrees of freedom by collisions.

Equipartition Theorem
The energy of a thermodynamic system in equilibrium is partitioned equally among its degrees of
freedom. Accordingly, the molar heat capacity of an ideal gas is proportional to its number of degrees of
freedom, d:

2.14

This result is due to the Scottish physicist James Clerk Maxwell (1831−1871), whose name will appear several
more times in this book.

For example, consider a diatomic ideal gas (a good model for nitrogen, and oxygen, Such a gas has
more degrees of freedom than a monatomic gas. In addition to the three degrees of freedom for translation, it
has two degrees of freedom for rotation perpendicular to its axis. Furthermore, the molecule can vibrate along
its axis. This motion is often modeled by imagining a spring connecting the two atoms, and we know from
simple harmonic motion that such motion has both kinetic and potential energy. Each of these forms of energy
corresponds to a degree of freedom, giving two more.

We might expect that for a diatomic gas, we should use 7 as the number of degrees of freedom; classically, if
the molecules of a gas had only translational kinetic energy, collisions between molecules would soon make
them rotate and vibrate. However, as explained in the previous module, quantum mechanics controls which
degrees of freedom are active. The result is shown in Figure 2.13. Both rotational and vibrational energies are
limited to discrete values. For temperatures below about 60 K, the energies of hydrogen molecules are too low
for a collision to bring the rotational state or vibrational state of a molecule from the lowest energy to the
second lowest, so the only form of energy is translational kinetic energy, and or as in a
monatomic gas. Above that temperature, the two rotational degrees of freedom begin to contribute, that is,
some molecules are excited to the rotational state with the second-lowest energy. (This temperature is much
lower than that where rotations of monatomic gases contribute, because diatomic molecules have much higher
rotational inertias and hence much lower rotational energies.) From about room temperature (a bit less than
300 K) to about 600 K, the rotational degrees of freedom are fully active, but the vibrational ones are not, and
. Then, finally, above about 3000 K, the vibrational degrees of freedom are fully active, and as the
classical theory predicted.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.3 • Heat Capacity and Equipartition of Energy 91

Figure 2.13 The molar heat capacity of hydrogen as a function of temperature (on a logarithmic scale). The three “steps” or “plateaus”
show different numbers of degrees of freedom that the typical energies of molecules must achieve to activate. Translational kinetic energy
corresponds to three degrees of freedom, rotational to another two, and vibrational to yet another two.

Polyatomic molecules typically have one additional rotational degree of freedom at room temperature, since
they have comparable moments of inertia around any axis. Thus, at room temperature, they have and at
high temperature, We usually assume that gases have the theoretical room-temperature values of d.

As shown in Table 2.3, the results agree well with experiments for many monatomic and diatomic gases, but
the agreement for triatomic gases is only fair. The differences arise from interactions that we have ignored
between and within molecules.

Gas at and 1 atm

Ar 1.50

He 1.50

Ne 1.50

CO 2.50

2.47

2.50

2.53

2.8

3.48

3.13

3.66

Table 2.3 for Various Monatomic, Diatomic, and Triatomic Gases


92 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

What about internal energy for diatomic and polyatomic gases? For such gases, is a function of
temperature (Figure 2.13), so we do not have the kind of simple result we have for monatomic ideal gases.

Molar Heat Capacity of Solid Elements


The idea of equipartition leads to an estimate of the molar heat capacity of solid elements at ordinary
temperatures. We can model the atoms of a solid as attached to neighboring atoms by springs (Figure 2.14).

Figure 2.14 In a simple model of a solid element, each atom is attached to others by six springs, two for each possible motion: x, y, and z.
Each of the three motions corresponds to two degrees of freedom, one for kinetic energy and one for potential energy. Thus

Analogously to the discussion of vibration in the previous module, each atom has six degrees of freedom: one
kinetic and one potential for each of the x-, y-, and z-directions. Accordingly, the molar specific heat of a metal
should be 3R. This result, known as the Law of Dulong and Petit, works fairly well experimentally at room
temperature. (For every element, it fails at low temperatures for quantum-mechanical reasons. Since quantum
effects are particularly important for low-mass particles, the Law of Dulong and Petit already fails at room
temperature for some light elements, such as beryllium and carbon. It also fails for some heavier elements for
various reasons beyond what we can cover.)

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Heat Capacity and Equipartition


The strategy for solving these problems is the same as the one in Phase Changes for the effects of heat transfer.
The only new feature is that you should determine whether the case just presented—ideal gases at constant
volume—applies to the problem. (For solid elements, looking up the specific heat capacity is generally better
than estimating it from the Law of Dulong and Petit.) In the case of an ideal gas, determine the number d of
degrees of freedom from the number of atoms in the gas molecule and use it to calculate (or use to
solve for d).

EXAMPLE 2.9

Calculating Temperature: Calorimetry with an Ideal Gas


A 300-g piece of solid gallium (a metal used in semiconductor devices) at its melting point of only is in
contact with 12.0 moles of air (assumed diatomic) at in an insulated container. When the air reaches
equilibrium with the gallium, 202 g of the gallium have melted. Based on those data, what is the heat of fusion

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.4 • Distribution of Molecular Speeds 93

of gallium? Assume the volume of the air does not change and there are no other heat transfers.

Strategy
We’ll use the equation As some of the gallium doesn’t melt, we know the final temperature is
still the melting point. Then the only is the heat lost as the air cools, where
The only is the latent heat of fusion of the gallium, It is positive because
heat flows into the gallium.

Solution

1. Set up the equation:

2. Substitute the known values and solve:

We solve to find that the heat of fusion of gallium is 80.2 kJ/kg.

2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the distribution of molecular speeds in an ideal gas
• Find the average and most probable molecular speeds in an ideal gas

Particles in an ideal gas all travel at relatively high speeds, but they do not travel at the same speed. The rms
speed is one kind of average, but many particles move faster and many move slower. The actual distribution of
speeds has several interesting implications for other areas of physics, as we will see in later chapters.

The Maxwell-Boltzmann Distribution


The motion of molecules in a gas is random in magnitude and direction for individual molecules, but a gas of
many molecules has a predictable distribution of molecular speeds. This predictable distribution of molecular
speeds is known as the Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution, after its originators, who calculated it based on
kinetic theory, and it has since been confirmed experimentally (Figure 2.15).

To understand this figure, we must define a distribution function of molecular speeds, since with a finite
number of molecules, the probability that a molecule will have exactly a given speed is 0.

Figure 2.15 The Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution of molecular speeds in an ideal gas. The most likely speed is less than the rms speed
94 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

. Although very high speeds are possible, only a tiny fraction of the molecules have speeds that are an order of magnitude greater than

We define the distribution function by saying that the expected number of particles with speeds
between and is given by

[Since N is dimensionless, the unit of f(v) is seconds per meter.] We can write this equation conveniently in
differential form:

In this form, we can understand the equation as saying that the number of molecules with speeds between v
and is the total number of molecules in the sample times f(v) times dv. That is, the probability that a
molecule’s speed is between v and is f(v)dv.

We can now quote Maxwell’s result, although the proof is beyond our scope.

Maxwell-Boltzmann Distribution of Speeds


The distribution function for speeds of particles in an ideal gas at temperature T is

2.15

The factors before the are a normalization constant; they make sure that ∞ by making sure that

Let’s focus on the dependence on v. The factor of means that and for small v, the

curve looks like a parabola. The factor of means that and the graph has an

exponential tail, which indicates that a few molecules may move at several times the rms speed. The
interaction of these factors gives the function the single-peaked shape shown in the figure.

EXAMPLE 2.10

Calculating the Ratio of Numbers of Molecules Near Given Speeds


In a sample of nitrogen with a molar mass of 28.0 g/mol) at a temperature of , find the ratio of the
number of molecules with a speed very close to 300 m/s to the number with a speed very close to 100 m/s.

Strategy
Since we’re looking at a small range, we can approximate the number of molecules near 100 m/s as
Then the ratio we want is

All we have to do is take the ratio of the two f values.

Solution

1. Identify the knowns and convert to SI units if necessary.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.4 • Distribution of Molecular Speeds 95

2. Substitute the values and solve.

Figure 2.16 shows that the curve is shifted to higher speeds at higher temperatures, with a broader range of
speeds.

Figure 2.16 The Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution is shifted to higher speeds and broadened at higher temperatures.

INTERACTIVE
With only a relatively small number of molecules, the distribution of speeds fluctuates around the Maxwell-
Boltzmann distribution. However, you can view this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21maxboltzdisim) to see
the essential features that more massive molecules move slower and have a narrower distribution. Use the set-
up “2 Gases, Random Speeds”. Note the display at the bottom comparing histograms of the speed distributions
with the theoretical curves.

We can use a probability distribution to calculate average values by multiplying the distribution function by the
quantity to be averaged and integrating the product over all possible speeds. (This is analogous to calculating
averages of discrete distributions, where you multiply each value by the number of times it occurs, add the
results, and divide by the number of values. The integral is analogous to the first two steps, and the
normalization is analogous to dividing by the number of values.) Thus the average velocity is


2.16

Similarly,


96 2 • The Kinetic Theory of Gases

as in Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed. The most probable speed, also called the peak speed is the
speed at the peak of the velocity distribution. (In statistics it would be called the mode.) It is less than the rms
speed The most probable speed can be calculated by the more familiar method of setting the derivative of
the distribution function, with respect to v, equal to 0. The result is

2.17

which is less than In fact, the rms speed is greater than both the most probable speed and the average
speed.

The peak speed provides a sometimes more convenient way to write the Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution
function:

2.18

In the factor , it is easy to recognize the translational kinetic energy. Thus, that expression is equal
to The distribution f(v) can be transformed into a kinetic energy distribution by requiring that
Boltzmann showed that the resulting formula is much more generally applicable if we
replace the kinetic energy of translation with the total mechanical energy E. Boltzmann’s result is

The first part of this equation, with the negative exponential, is the usual way to write it. We give the second
part only to remark that in the denominator is ubiquitous in quantum as well as classical statistical
mechanics.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Speed Distribution
Step 1. Examine the situation to determine that it relates to the distribution of molecular speeds.

Step 2. Make a list of what quantities are given or can be inferred from the problem as stated (identify the
known quantities).

Step 3. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknown quantities). A
written list is useful.

Step 4. Convert known values into proper SI units (K for temperature, Pa for pressure, for volume,
molecules for N, and moles for n). In many cases, though, using R and the molar mass will be more convenient
than using and the molecular mass.

Step 5. Determine whether you need the distribution function for velocity or the one for energy, and whether
you are using a formula for one of the characteristic speeds (average, most probably, or rms), finding a ratio of
values of the distribution function, or approximating an integral.

Step 6. Solve the appropriate equation for the ideal gas law for the quantity to be determined (the unknown
quantity). Note that if you are taking a ratio of values of the distribution function, the normalization factors
divide out. Or if approximating an integral, use the method asked for in the problem.

Step 7. Substitute the known quantities, along with their units, into the appropriate equation and obtain
numerical solutions complete with units.

We can now gain a qualitative understanding of a puzzle about the composition of Earth’s atmosphere.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2.4 • Distribution of Molecular Speeds 97

Hydrogen is by far the most common element in the universe, and helium is by far the second-most common.
Moreover, helium is constantly produced on Earth by radioactive decay. Why are those elements so rare in our
atmosphere? The answer is that gas molecules that reach speeds above Earth’s escape velocity, about 11 km/s,
can escape from the atmosphere into space. Because of the lower mass of hydrogen and helium molecules,
they move at higher speeds than other gas molecules, such as nitrogen and oxygen. Only a few exceed escape
velocity, but far fewer heavier molecules do. Thus, over the billions of years that Earth has existed, far more
hydrogen and helium molecules have escaped from the atmosphere than other molecules, and hardly any of
either is now present.

We can also now take another look at evaporative cooling, which we discussed in the chapter on temperature
and heat. Liquids, like gases, have a distribution of molecular energies. The highest-energy molecules are
those that can escape from the intermolecular attractions of the liquid. Thus, when some liquid evaporates, the
molecules left behind have a lower average energy, and the liquid has a lower temperature.
98 2 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
Avogadro’s number the number of molecules between the limits of integration
in one mole of a substance; mean free path average distance between
particles/mole collisions of a particle
Boltzmann constant a physical constant that mean free time average time between collisions of
relates energy to temperature and appears in the a particle
ideal gas law; mole quantity of a substance whose mass (in
critical temperature at which the isotherm has grams) is equal to its molecular mass
a point with zero slope most probable speed speed near which the speeds
Dalton’s law of partial pressures physical law that of most molecules are found, the peak of the
states that the total pressure of a gas is the sum of speed distribution function
partial pressures of the component gases partial pressure pressure a gas would create if it
degree of freedom independent kind of motion occupied the total volume of space available
possessing energy, such as the kinetic energy of peak speed same as “most probable speed”
motion in one of the three orthogonal spatial pV diagram graph of pressure vs. volume
directions root-mean-square (rms) speed square root of the
equipartition theorem theorem that the energy of average of the square (of a quantity)
a classical thermodynamic system is shared supercritical condition of a fluid being at such a
equally among its degrees of freedom high temperature and pressure that the liquid
ideal gas gas at the limit of low density and high phase cannot exist
temperature universal gas constant R, the constant that
ideal gas law physical law that relates the pressure appears in the ideal gas law expressed in terms of
and volume of a gas, far from liquefaction, to the moles, given by
number of gas molecules or number of moles of van der Waals equation of state equation,
gas and the temperature of the gas typically approximate, which relates the pressure
internal energy sum of the mechanical energies of and volume of a gas to the number of gas
all of the molecules in it molecules or number of moles of gas and the
kinetic theory of gases theory that derives the temperature of the gas
macroscopic properties of gases from the motion vapor pressure partial pressure of a vapor at
of the molecules they consist of which it is in equilibrium with the liquid (or solid,
Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution function that in the case of sublimation) phase of the same
can be integrated to give the probability of finding substance
ideal gas molecules with speeds in the range

Key Equations
Ideal gas law in terms of molecules

Ideal gas law ratios if the amount of gas is constant

Ideal gas law in terms of moles

Van der Waals equation

Pressure, volume, and molecular speed

Root-mean-square speed

Access for free at openstax.org.


2 • Chapter Review 99

Mean free path

Mean free time

The following two equations apply only to a monatomic ideal gas:

Average kinetic energy of a molecule

Internal energy

Heat in terms of molar heat capacity at constant volume

Molar heat capacity at constant volume for an ideal gas with d


degrees of freedom

Maxwell–Boltzmann speed distribution

Average velocity of a molecule

Peak velocity of a molecule

Summary
2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas temperature.
• The van der Waals equation of state for gases is
• The ideal gas law relates the pressure and
valid closer to the boiling point than the ideal
volume of a gas to the number of gas molecules
gas law.
and the temperature of the gas.
• Above the critical temperature and pressure for
• A mole of any substance has a number of
a given substance, the liquid phase does not
molecules equal to the number of atoms in a
exist, and the sample is “supercritical.”
12-g sample of carbon-12. The number of
molecules in a mole is called Avogadro’s 2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed
number
• Kinetic theory is the atomic description of gases
as well as liquids and solids. It models the
• A mole of any substance has a mass in grams properties of matter in terms of continuous
numerically equal to its molecular mass in random motion of molecules.
unified mass units, which can be determined • The ideal gas law can be expressed in terms of
from the periodic table of elements. The ideal the mass of the gas’s molecules and the
gas law can also be written and solved in terms average of the molecular speed squared, instead
of the number of moles of gas: of the temperature.
• The temperature of gases is proportional to the
where n is the number of moles and R is the average translational kinetic energy of
universal gas constant, molecules. Hence, the typical speed of gas
molecules is proportional to the square
root of the temperature and inversely
• The ideal gas law is generally valid at
proportional to the square root of the molecular
temperatures well above the boiling
mass.
100 2 • Chapter Review

• In a mixture of gases, each gas exerts a pressure temperature is too low to excite the minimum
equal to the total pressure times the fraction of energy of the degree of freedom as given by
the mixture that the gas makes up. quantum mechanics. Therefore, at ordinary
• The mean free path (the average distance temperatures, for monatomic gases,
between collisions) and the mean free time of for diatomic gases, and for polyatomic
gas molecules are proportional to the gases.
temperature and inversely proportional to the
molar density and the molecules’ cross-
2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds
sectional area. • The motion of individual molecules in a gas is
random in magnitude and direction. However, a
2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of
gas of many molecules has a predictable
Energy distribution of molecular speeds, known as the
• Every degree of freedom of an ideal gas Maxwell-Boltzmann distribution.
contributes per atom or molecule to its • The average and most probable velocities of
changes in internal energy. molecules having the Maxwell-Boltzmann speed
distribution, as well as the rms velocity, can be
• Every degree of freedom contributes to its
calculated from the temperature and molecular
molar heat capacity at constant volume
mass.
• Degrees of freedom do not contribute if the

Conceptual Questions
2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas Uranus, and Neptune, which are much more
massive and farther from the Sun than Earth is,
1. Two molecules can react with one
contain large amounts of hydrogen and helium?
molecule to produce two molecules. How
10. Statistical mechanics says that in a gas
many moles of hydrogen molecules are needed to
maintained at a constant temperature through
react with one mole of oxygen molecules?
thermal contact with a bigger system (a
2. Under what circumstances would you expect a
“reservoir”) at that temperature, the
gas to behave significantly differently than
fluctuations in internal energy are typically a
predicted by the ideal gas law?
fraction of the internal energy. As a
3. A constant-volume gas thermometer contains a
fraction of the total internal energy of a mole of
fixed amount of gas. What property of the gas is
gas, how big are the fluctuations in the internal
measured to indicate its temperature?
energy? Are we justified in ignoring them?
4. Inflate a balloon at room temperature. Leave the
11. Which is more dangerous, a closet where tanks
inflated balloon in the refrigerator overnight.
of nitrogen are stored, or one where tanks of
What happens to the balloon, and why?
carbon dioxide are stored?
5. In the last chapter, free convection was explained
as the result of buoyant forces on hot fluids.
Explain the upward motion of air in flames based 2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of
on the ideal gas law. Energy
12. Experimentally it appears that many
2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed polyatomic molecules’ vibrational degrees of
6. How is momentum related to the pressure freedom can contribute to some extent to their
exerted by a gas? Explain on the molecular level, energy at room temperature. Would you expect
considering the behavior of molecules. that fact to increase or decrease their heat
7. If one kind of molecule has double the radius of capacity from the value R? Explain.
another and eight times the mass, how do their 13. One might think that the internal energy of
mean free paths under the same conditions diatomic gases is given by Do
compare? How do their mean free times diatomic gases near room temperature have
compare? more or less internal energy than that? Hint:
8. What is the average velocity of the air molecules Their internal energy includes the total energy
in the room where you are right now? added in raising the temperature from the
9. Why do the atmospheres of Jupiter, Saturn, boiling point (very low) to room temperature.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2 • Chapter Review 101

14. You mix 5 moles of at 300 K with 5 moles of two gases are the same. (b) The average kinetic
He at 360 K in a perfectly insulated calorimeter. energies of atoms in the two gases are the same.
Is the final temperature higher or lower than (c) The internal energies of 1 mole of gas in each
330 K? cylinder are the same. (d) The pressures in the
two cylinders are the same.
2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds 16. Repeat the previous question if one gas is still
helium but the other is changed to fluorine, .
15. One cylinder contains helium gas and another
17. An ideal gas is at a temperature of 300 K. To
contains krypton gas at the same temperature.
double the average speed of its molecules, what
Mark each of these statements true, false, or
does the temperature need to be changed to?
impossible to determine from the given
information. (a) The rms speeds of atoms in the

Problems
2.1 Molecular Model of an Ideal Gas 23. Calculate the number of moles in the 2.00-L
volume of air in the lungs of the average person.
18. The gauge pressure in your car tires is
Note that the air is at (body
at a temperature of
temperature) and that the total volume in the
when you drive it onto a ship in Los Angeles to
lungs is several times the amount inhaled in a
be sent to Alaska. What is their gauge pressure
typical breath as given in Example 2.2.
on a night in Alaska when their temperature has
24. An airplane passenger has of air in his
dropped to ? Assume the tires have
stomach just before the plane takes off from a
not gained or lost any air.
sea-level airport. What volume will the air have
19. Suppose a gas-filled incandescent light bulb is
at cruising altitude if cabin pressure drops to
manufactured so that the gas inside the bulb is
?
at atmospheric pressure when the bulb has a
25. A company advertises that it delivers helium at
temperature of . (a) Find the gauge
a gauge pressure of in a cylinder
pressure inside such a bulb when it is hot,
of volume 43.8 L. How many balloons can be
assuming its average temperature is (an
inflated to a volume of 4.00 L with that amount
approximation) and neglecting any change in
of helium? Assume the pressure inside the
volume due to thermal expansion or gas leaks.
balloons is and the temperature
(b) The actual final pressure for the light bulb
in the cylinder and the balloons is .
will be less than calculated in part (a) because
26. According to http://hyperphysics.phy-
the glass bulb will expand. Is this effect
astr.gsu.edu/hbase/solar/venusenv.html, the
significant?
atmosphere of Venus is approximately
20. People buying food in sealed bags at high
and by volume. On the
elevations often notice that the bags are puffed
surface, where the temperature is about 750 K
up because the air inside has expanded. A bag
and the pressure is about 90 atm, what is the
of pretzels was packed at a pressure of 1.00 atm
density of the atmosphere?
and a temperature of When opened at a
27. An expensive vacuum system can achieve a
summer picnic in Santa Fe, New Mexico, at a
pressure as low as at
temperature of the volume of the air in
How many molecules are there in a
the bag is 1.38 times its original volume. What is
cubic centimeter at this pressure and
the pressure of the air?
temperature?
21. How many moles are there in (a) 0.0500 g of
28. The number density N/V of gas molecules at a
gas (b) 10.0 g of gas
certain location in the space above our planet is
(c) How many molecules are
about and the pressure is
present in each case?
in this space. What is the
22. A cubic container of volume 2.00 L holds 0.500
temperature there?
mol of nitrogen gas at a temperature of
29. A bicycle tire contains 2.00 L of gas at an
What is the net force due to the nitrogen on one
wall of the container? Compare that force to the absolute pressure of and a
sample’s weight. temperature of . What will its pressure
be if you let out an amount of air that has a
102 2 • Chapter Review

volume of at atmospheric pressure? 35. A person hits a tennis ball with a mass of 0.058
Assume tire temperature and volume remain kg against a wall. The average component of the
constant. ball’s velocity perpendicular to the wall is 11 m/
30. In a common demonstration, a bottle is heated s, and the ball hits the wall every 2.1 s on
and stoppered with a hard-boiled egg that’s a average, rebounding with the opposite
little bigger than the bottle’s neck. When the perpendicular velocity component. (a) What is
bottle is cooled, the pressure difference the average force exerted on the wall? (b) If the
between inside and outside forces the egg into part of the wall the person hits has an area of
the bottle. Suppose the bottle has a volume of what is the average pressure on that
0.500 L and the temperature inside it is raised area?
to while the pressure remains constant 36. A person is in a closed room (a racquetball
at 1.00 atm because the bottle is open. (a) How court) with hitting a ball
many moles of air are inside? (b) Now the egg is around at random without any
put in place, sealing the bottle. What is the pauses. The average kinetic energy of the ball is
gauge pressure inside after the air cools back to 2.30 J. (a) What is the average value of Does
the ambient temperature of but before the it matter which direction you take to be x? (b)
egg is forced into the bottle? Applying the methods of this chapter, find the
31. A high-pressure gas cylinder contains 50.0 L of average pressure on the walls? (c) Aside from
toxic gas at a pressure of and the presence of only one “molecule” in this
a temperature of . The cylinder is cooled problem, what is the main assumption in
to dry ice temperature to reduce the Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed that
leak rate and pressure so that it can be safely does not apply here?
repaired. (a) What is the final pressure in the 37. Five bicyclists are riding at the following
tank, assuming a negligible amount of gas leaks speeds: 5.4 m/s, 5.7 m/s, 5.8 m/s, 6.0 m/s, and
while being cooled and that there is no phase 6.5 m/s. (a) What is their average speed? (b)
change? (b) What is the final pressure if one- What is their rms speed?
tenth of the gas escapes? (c) To what 38. Some incandescent light bulbs are filled with
temperature must the tank be cooled to reduce argon gas. What is for argon atoms near
the pressure to 1.00 atm (assuming the gas does the filament, assuming their temperature is
not change phase and that there is no leakage 2500 K?
during cooling)? (d) Does cooling the tank as in 39. Typical molecular speeds are large, even
part (c) appear to be a practical solution? at low temperatures. What is for helium
32. Find the number of moles in 2.00 L of gas at atoms at 5.00 K, less than one degree above
and under of helium’s liquefaction temperature?
pressure. 40. What is the average kinetic energy in joules of
33. Calculate the depth to which Avogadro’s hydrogen atoms on the surface of the
number of table tennis balls would cover Earth. Sun? (b) What is the average kinetic energy of
Each ball has a diameter of 3.75 cm. Assume the helium atoms in a region of the solar corona
space between balls adds an extra to where the temperature is ?
their volume and assume they are not crushed 41. What is the ratio of the average translational
by their own weight. kinetic energy of a nitrogen molecule at a
34. (a) What is the gauge pressure in a car temperature of 300 K to the gravitational
tire containing 3.60 mol of gas in a 30.0-L potential energy of a nitrogen-molecule−Earth
volume? (b) What will its gauge pressure be if system at the ceiling of a 3-m-tall room with
you add 1.00 L of gas originally at atmospheric respect to the same system with the molecule at
pressure and ? Assume the temperature the floor?
remains at and the volume remains 42. What is the total translational kinetic energy of
constant. the air molecules in a room of volume if
the pressure is (the room is at
2.2 Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed fairly high elevation) and the temperature is
? Is any item of data unnecessary for the
In the problems in this section, assume all gases are
solution?
ideal.
43. The product of the pressure and volume of a

Access for free at openstax.org.


2 • Chapter Review 103

sample of hydrogen gas at is 80.0 J. (a) techniques for enrichment, gas diffusion, is
How many moles of hydrogen are present? (b) based on the different molecular speeds of
What is the average translational kinetic energy uranium hexafluoride gas, . (a) The molar
of the hydrogen molecules? (c) What is the value masses of and are 349.0 g/mol
of the product of pressure and volume at and 352.0 g/mol, respectively. What is the ratio
of their typical speeds ? (b) At what
44. What is the gauge pressure inside a tank of temperature would their typical speeds differ by
of compressed nitrogen with a 1.00 m/s? (c) Do your answers in this problem
volume of if the rms speed is 514 m/s? imply that this technique may be difficult?
45. If the rms speed of oxygen molecules inside a 52. The partial pressure of carbon dioxide in the
refrigerator of volume is 465 m/s, what lungs is about 470 Pa when the total pressure in
is the partial pressure of the oxygen? There are the lungs is 1.0 atm. What percentage of the air
5.71 moles of oxygen in the refrigerator, and the molecules in the lungs is carbon dioxide?
molar mass of oxygen is 32.0 g/mol. Compare your result to the percentage of
46. The escape velocity of any object from Earth is carbon dioxide in the atmosphere, about
11.1 km/s. At what temperature would oxygen 0.033%.
molecules (molar mass is equal to 32.0 g/mol) 53. Dry air consists of approximately
have root-mean-square velocity equal to by
Earth’s escape velocity of 11.1 km/s? mole, with trace amounts of other gases. A tank
47. The escape velocity from the Moon is much of compressed dry air has a volume of 1.76
smaller than that from the Earth, only 2.38 km/ cubic feet at a gauge pressure of 2200 pounds
s. At what temperature would hydrogen per square inch and a temperature of 293 K.
molecules (molar mass is equal to 2.016 g/mol) How much oxygen does it contain in moles?
have a root-mean-square velocity equal to 54. (a) Using data from the previous problem, find
the Moon’s escape velocity? the mass of nitrogen, oxygen, and argon in 1
48. Nuclear fusion, the energy source of the Sun, mol of dry air. The molar mass of is 28.0 g/
hydrogen bombs, and fusion reactors, occurs mol, that of is 32.0 g/mol, and that of argon
much more readily when the average kinetic is 39.9 g/mol. (b) Dry air is mixed with pentane
energy of the atoms is high—that is, at high molar mass 72.2 g/mol), an important
temperatures. Suppose you want the atoms in constituent of gasoline, in an air-fuel ratio of
your fusion experiment to have average kinetic 15:1 by mass (roughly typical for car engines).
energies of . What temperature Find the partial pressure of pentane in this
is needed? mixture at an overall pressure of 1.00 atm.
49. Suppose that the typical speed of carbon 55. (a) Given that air is oxygen, find the
dioxide molecules (molar mass is 44.0 g/mol) in minimum atmospheric pressure that gives a
a flame is found to be 1350 m/s. What relatively safe partial pressure of oxygen of 0.16
temperature does this indicate? atm. (b) What is the minimum pressure that
50. (a) Hydrogen molecules (molar mass is equal to gives a partial pressure of oxygen above the
2.016 g/mol) have equal to 193 m/s. What quickly fatal level of 0.06 atm? (c) The air
is the temperature? (b) Much of the gas near the pressure at the summit of Mount Everest (8848
Sun is atomic hydrogen (H rather than Its m) is 0.334 atm. Why have a few people climbed
temperature would have to be for it without oxygen, while some who have tried,
the rms speed to equal the escape velocity even though they had trained at high elevation,
from the Sun. What is that velocity? had to turn back?
51. There are two important isotopes of uranium, 56. (a) If the partial pressure of water vapor is 8.05
and ; these isotopes are nearly torr, what is the dew point?
identical chemically but have different atomic (b) On a warm
masses. Only is very useful in nuclear day when the air temperature is and the
reactors. Separating the isotopes is called dew point is , what are the partial pressure
uranium enrichment (and is often in the news of the water in the air and the relative humidity?
as of this writing, because of concerns that
some countries are enriching uranium with the
goal of making nuclear weapons.) One of the
104 2 • Chapter Review

2.3 Heat Capacity and Equipartition of at to make a mixture that is helium


Energy by mole. What is the final temperature? Ignore
any heat flow to or from the surroundings, and
57. To give a helium atom nonzero angular assume the final volume is the sum of the initial
momentum requires about 21.2 eV of energy volumes.
(that is, 21.2 eV is the difference between the 64. Professional divers sometimes use heliox,
energies of the lowest-energy or ground state consisting of helium and oxygen by
and the lowest-energy state with angular mole. Suppose a perfectly rigid scuba tank with
momentum). The electron-volt or eV is defined a volume of 11 L contains heliox at an absolute
as Find the temperature T pressure of at a temperature of
where this amount of energy equals . (a) How many moles of helium and how
Does this explain why we can ignore the many moles of oxygen are in the tank? (b) The
rotational energy of helium for most purposes? diver goes down to a point where the sea
(The results for other monatomic gases, and for temperature is while using a negligible
diatomic gases rotating around the axis amount of the mixture. As the gas in the tank
connecting the two atoms, have comparable reaches this new temperature, how much heat
orders of magnitude.) is removed from it?
58. (a) How much heat must be added to raise the 65. In car racing, one advantage of mixing liquid
temperature of 1.5 mol of air from to nitrous oxide with air is that the boiling
at constant volume? Assume air is of the “nitrous” absorbs latent heat of
completely diatomic. (b) Repeat the problem for vaporization and thus cools the air and
the same number of moles of xenon, Xe. ultimately the fuel-air mixture, allowing more
59. A sealed, rigid container of 0.560 mol of an fuel-air mixture to go into each cylinder. As a
unknown ideal gas at a temperature of very rough look at this process, suppose 1.0 mol
is cooled to . In the process, 980 J of of nitrous oxide gas at its boiling point, ,
heat are removed from the gas. Is the gas is mixed with 4.0 mol of air (assumed diatomic)
monatomic, diatomic, or polyatomic? at . What is the final temperature of the
60. A sample of neon gas (Ne, molar mass mixture? Use the measured heat capacity of
at a temperature of is at , which is . (The
put into a steel container of mass 47.2 g that’s at primary advantage of nitrous oxide is that it
a temperature of . The final consists of 1/3 oxygen, which is more than air
temperature is . (No heat is exchanged contains, so it supplies more oxygen to burn the
with the surroundings, and you can neglect any fuel. Another advantage is that its
change in the volume of the container.) What is decomposition into nitrogen and oxygen
the mass of the sample of neon? releases energy in the cylinder.)
61. A steel container of mass 135 g contains 24.0 g
of ammonia, , which has a molar mass of
2.4 Distribution of Molecular Speeds
17.0 g/mol. The container and gas are in
equilibrium at . How much heat has to 66. In a sample of hydrogen sulfide
be removed to reach a temperature of at a temperature of
? Ignore the change in volume of the steel. estimate the ratio of the number
62. A sealed room has a volume of . It’s filled of molecules that have speeds very close to
with air, which may be assumed to be diatomic, to the number that have speeds very close to
at a temperature of and a pressure of
A 1.00-kg block of ice at its 67. Using the approximation
melting point is placed in the room. Assume the
for small ,
walls of the room transfer no heat. What is the
equilibrium temperature? estimate the fraction of nitrogen molecules at a
63. Heliox, a mixture of helium and oxygen, is temperature of that have speeds
sometimes given to hospital patients who have between 290 m/s and 291 m/s.
trouble breathing, because the low mass of 68. Using the method of the preceding problem,
helium makes it easier to breathe than air. estimate the fraction of nitric oxide (NO)
Suppose helium at is mixed with oxygen molecules at a temperature of 250 K that have

Access for free at openstax.org.


2 • Chapter Review 105

energies between a sample of oxygen gas at a temperature of 250


and . K that have speeds between 100 m/s and 150 m/
69. By counting squares in the following figure, estimate s. The molar mass of oxygen is 32.0 g/mol.
the fraction of argon atoms at that have A precision to two significant digits is enough.
speeds between 600 m/s and 800 m/s. The curve is 71. Find (a) the most probable speed, (b) the
correctly normalized. The value of a square is its average speed, and (c) the rms speed for
length as measured on the x-axis times its height as nitrogen molecules at 295 K.
measured on the y-axis, with the units given on 72. Repeat the preceding problem for nitrogen
those axes. molecules at 2950 K.
73. At what temperature is the average speed of
carbon dioxide molecules
510 m/s?
74. The most probable speed for molecules of a gas
at 296 K is 263 m/s. What is the molar mass of
the gas? (You might like to figure out what the
gas is likely to be.)
75. a) At what temperature do oxygen molecules
have the same average speed as helium atoms
have at 300 K? b) What is the
answer to the same question about most
70. Using a numerical integration method such as probable speeds? c) What is the answer to the
Simpson’s rule, find the fraction of molecules in same question about rms speeds?

Additional Problems
76. In the deep space between galaxies, the density 80. (a) Use the ideal gas equation to estimate the
of molecules (which are mostly single atoms) temperature at which 1.00 kg of steam (molar
can be as low as and the mass ) at a pressure of
temperature is a frigid 2.7 K. What is the occupies a volume of .
pressure? (b) What volume (in ) is occupied (b) The van der Waals constants for water are
by 1 mol of gas? (c) If this volume is a cube, what and
is the length of its sides in kilometers? . Use the Van der
77. (a) Find the density in SI units of air at a Waals equation of state to estimate the
pressure of 1.00 atm and a temperature of temperature under the same conditions. (c) The
, assuming that air is actual temperature is 779 K. Which estimate is
, (b) Find the better?
density of the atmosphere on Venus, assuming 81. One process for decaffeinating coffee uses
that it’s , with a carbon dioxide at a molar
temperature of 737 K and a pressure of 92.0 density of about and a
atm. temperature of about . (a) Is CO2 a solid,
78. The air inside a hot-air balloon has a liquid, gas, or supercritical fluid under those
temperature of 370 K and a pressure of 101.3 conditions? (b) The van der Waals constants for
kPa, the same as that of the air outside. Using carbon dioxide are
the composition of air as and Using the van
, find the density of der Waals equation, estimate the pressure of
the air inside the balloon. at that temperature and density.
79. When an air bubble rises from the bottom to the 82. On a winter day when the air temperature is
top of a freshwater lake, its volume increases by the relative humidity is . Outside air
. If the temperatures at the bottom and the comes inside and is heated to a room
top of the lake are 4.0 and 10 , respectively, temperature of . What is the relative
how deep is the lake? humidity of the air inside the room. (Does this
problem show why inside air is so dry in
winter?)
106 2 • Chapter Review

83. On a warm day when the air temperature is 88. Find the total number of collisions between
, a metal can is slowly cooled by adding molecules in 1.00 s in 1.00 L of nitrogen gas at
bits of ice to liquid water in it. Condensation standard temperature and pressure ( , 1.00
first appears when the can reaches . What atm). Use as the effective
is the relative humidity of the air? radius of a nitrogen molecule. (The number of
84. (a) People often think of humid air as “heavy.” collisions per second is the reciprocal of the
Compare the densities of air with relative collision time.) Keep in mind that each collision
humidity and relative humidity when involves two molecules, so if one molecule
both are at 1 atm and . Assume that the collides once in a certain period of time, the
dry air is an ideal gas composed of molecules collision of the molecule it hit cannot be
with a molar mass of 29.0 g/mol and the moist counted.
air is the same gas mixed with water vapor. (b) 89. (a) Estimate the specific heat capacity of sodium
As discussed in the chapter on the applications from the Law of Dulong and Petit. The molar
of Newton’s laws, the air resistance felt by mass of sodium is 23.0 g/mol. (b) What is the
projectiles such as baseballs and golf balls is percent error of your estimate from the known
approximately , where is the value, ?
mass density of the air, A is the cross-sectional 90. A sealed, perfectly insulated container contains
area of the projectile, and C is the projectile’s 0.630 mol of air at and an iron stirring
drag coefficient. For a fixed air pressure, bar of mass 40.0 g. The stirring bar is
describe qualitatively how the range of a magnetically driven to a kinetic energy of 50.0 J
projectile changes with the relative humidity. (c) and allowed to slow down by air resistance.
When a thunderstorm is coming, usually the What is the equilibrium temperature?
humidity is high and the air pressure is low. Do 91. Find the ratio for hydrogen gas
those conditions give an advantage or at a temperature of 77.0 K.
disadvantage to home-run hitters? 92. Unreasonable results. (a) Find the temperature
85. The mean free path for helium at a certain of 0.360 kg of water, modeled as an ideal gas, at
temperature and pressure is a pressure of if it has a volume of
The radius of a helium atom can be taken as . (b) What is unreasonable about this
. What is the measure of the answer? How could you get a better answer?
density of helium under those conditions (a) in 93. Unreasonable results. (a) Find the average
molecules per cubic meter and (b) in moles per speed of hydrogen sulfide, , molecules at a
cubic meter? temperature of 250 K. Its molar mass is 31.4 g/
86. The mean free path for methane at a mol (b) The result isn’t very unreasonable, but
temperature of 269 K and a pressure of why is it less reliable than those for, say, neon or
is Find the nitrogen?
effective radius r of the methane molecule.
87. In the chapter on fluid mechanics, Bernoulli’s
equation for the flow of incompressible fluids
was explained in terms of changes affecting a
small volume dV of fluid. Such volumes are a
fundamental idea in the study of the flow of
compressible fluids such as gases as well. For
the equations of hydrodynamics to apply, the
mean free path must be much less than the
linear size of such a volume, For air
in the stratosphere at a temperature of 220 K
and a pressure of 5.8 kPa, how big should a be
for it to be 100 times the mean free path? Take
the effective radius of air molecules to be
which is roughly correct for
.

Access for free at openstax.org.


2 • Chapter Review 107

Challenge Problems
94. An airtight dispenser for drinking water is
96. Verify that .
in horizontal dimensions and
20 cm tall. It has a tap of negligible volume that 97. Verify the normalization equation
opens at the level of the bottom of the dispenser. ∞
In doing the integral, first
Initially, it contains water to a level 3.0 cm from
the top and air at the ambient pressure, 1.00 make the substitution This
atm, from there to the top. When the tap is
opened, water will flow out until the gauge “scaling” transformation gives you all features
pressure at the bottom of the dispenser, and of the answer except for the integral, which is a
thus at the opening of the tap, is 0. What volume dimensionless numerical factor. You’ll need the
of water flows out? Assume the temperature is formula
constant, the dispenser is perfectly rigid, and ∞
the water has a constant density of .
95. Eight bumper cars, each with a mass of 322 kg, to find the numerical factor and verify the
are running in a room 21.0 m long and 13.0 m normalization.
wide. They have no drivers, so they just bounce
around on their own. The rms speed of the cars 98. Verify that Make the same
is 2.50 m/s. Repeating the arguments of scaling transformation as in the preceding
Pressure, Temperature, and RMS Speed, find problem.
the average force per unit length (analogous to
99. Verify that .
pressure) that the cars exert on the walls.
108 2 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 3
The First Law of
Thermodynamics

Figure 3.1 A weak cold front of air pushes all the smog in northeastern China into a giant smog blanket over the
Yellow Sea, as captured by NASA’s Terra satellite in 2012. To understand changes in weather and climate, such as
the event shown here, you need a thorough knowledge of thermodynamics. (credit: modification of work by NASA)

Chapter Outline

3.1 Thermodynamic Systems

3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy

3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics

3.4 Thermodynamic Processes

3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas

3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas

INTRODUCTION Heat is the transfer of energy due to a temperature difference between two systems. Heat
describes the process of converting from one form of energy into another. A car engine, for example, burns
gasoline. Heat is produced when the burned fuel is chemically transformed into mostly and which
are gases at the combustion temperature. These gases exert a force on a piston through a displacement, doing
work and converting the piston’s kinetic energy into a variety of other forms—into the car’s kinetic energy; into
electrical energy to run the spark plugs, radio, and lights; and back into stored energy in the car’s battery.
110 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Energy is conserved in all processes, including those associated with thermodynamic systems. The roles of
heat transfer and internal energy change vary from process to process and affect how work is done by the
system in that process. We will see that the first law of thermodynamics explains that a change in the internal
energy of a system comes from changes in heat or work. Understanding the laws that govern thermodynamic
processes and the relationship between the system and its surroundings is therefore paramount in gaining
scientific knowledge of energy and energy consumption.

3.1 Thermodynamic Systems


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define a thermodynamic system, its boundary, and its surroundings
• Explain the roles of all the components involved in thermodynamics
• Define thermal equilibrium and thermodynamic temperature
• Link an equation of state to a system

A thermodynamic system includes anything whose thermodynamic properties are of interest. It is embedded
in its surroundings or environment; it can exchange heat with, and do work on, its environment through a
boundary, which is the imagined wall that separates the system and the environment (Figure 3.2). In reality,
the immediate surroundings of the system are interacting with it directly and therefore have a much stronger
influence on its behavior and properties. For example, if we are studying a car engine, the burning gasoline
inside the cylinder of the engine is the thermodynamic system; the piston, exhaust system, radiator, and air
outside form the surroundings of the system. The boundary then consists of the inner surfaces of the cylinder
and piston.

Figure 3.2 (a) A system, which can include any relevant process or value, is self-contained in an area. The surroundings may also have
relevant information; however, the surroundings are important to study only if the situation is an open system. (b) The burning gasoline in
the cylinder of a car engine is an example of a thermodynamic system.

Normally, a system must have some interactions with its surroundings. A system is called an isolated and
closed system if it is completely separated from its environment—for example, a gas that is surrounded by
immovable and thermally insulating walls. In reality, a closed system does not exist unless the entire universe
is treated as the system, or it is used as a model for an actual system that has minimal interactions with its
environment. Most systems are known as an open system, which can exchange energy and/or matter with its
surroundings (Figure 3.3).

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.1 • Thermodynamic Systems 111

Figure 3.3 (a) This boiling tea kettle is an open thermodynamic system. It transfers heat and matter (steam) to its surroundings. (b) A
pressure cooker is a good approximation to a closed system. A little steam escapes through the top valve to prevent explosion. (credit a:
modification of work by Gina Hamilton; credit b: modification of work by Jane Whitney)

When we examine a thermodynamic system, we ignore the difference in behavior from place to place inside
the system for a given moment. In other words, we concentrate on the macroscopic properties of the system,
which are the averages of the microscopic properties of all the molecules or entities in the system. Any
thermodynamic system is therefore treated as a continuum that has the same behavior everywhere inside. We
assume the system is in equilibrium. You could have, for example, a temperature gradient across the system.
However, when we discuss a thermodynamic system in this chapter, we study those that have uniform
properties throughout the system.

Before we can carry out any study on a thermodynamic system, we need a fundamental characterization of the
system. When we studied a mechanical system, we focused on the forces and torques on the system, and their
balances dictated the mechanical equilibrium of the system. In a similar way, we should examine the heat
transfer between a thermodynamic system and its environment or between the different parts of the system,
and its balance should dictate the thermal equilibrium of the system. Intuitively, such a balance is reached if
the temperature becomes the same for different objects or parts of the system in thermal contact, and the net
heat transfer over time becomes zero.

Thus, when we say two objects (a thermodynamic system and its environment, for example) are in thermal
equilibrium, we mean that they are at the same temperature, as we discussed in Temperature and Heat. Let us
consider three objects at temperatures and respectively. How do we know whether they are in
thermal equilibrium? The governing principle here is the zeroth law of thermodynamics, as described in
Temperature and Heat on temperature and heat:

If object 1 is in thermal equilibrium with objects 2 and 3, respectively, then objects 2 and 3 must also be in
thermal equilibrium.

Mathematically, we can simply write the zeroth law of thermodynamics as


3.1
This is the most fundamental way of defining temperature: Two objects must be at the same temperature
thermodynamically if the net heat transfer between them is zero when they are put in thermal contact and
have reached a thermal equilibrium.

The zeroth law of thermodynamics is equally applicable to the different parts of a closed system and requires
that the temperature everywhere inside the system be the same if the system has reached a thermal
equilibrium. To simplify our discussion, we assume the system is uniform with only one type of material—for
example, water in a tank. The measurable properties of the system at least include its volume, pressure, and
temperature. The range of specific relevant variables depends upon the system. For example, for a stretched
112 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

rubber band, the relevant variables would be length, tension, and temperature. The relationship between these
three basic properties of the system is called the equation of state of the system and is written symbolically for
a closed system as

3.2

where V, p, and T are the volume, pressure, and temperature of the system at a given condition.

In principle, this equation of state exists for any thermodynamic system but is not always readily available. The
forms of for many materials have been determined either experimentally or theoretically. In the
preceding chapter, we saw an example of an equation of state for an ideal gas,

We have so far introduced several physical properties that are relevant to the thermodynamics of a
thermodynamic system, such as its volume, pressure, and temperature. We can separate these quantities into
two generic categories. The quantity associated with an amount of matter is an extensive variable, such as the
volume and the number of moles. The other properties of a system are intensive variables, such as the
pressure and temperature. An extensive variable doubles its value if the amount of matter in the system
doubles, provided all the intensive variables remain the same. For example, the volume or total energy of the
system doubles if we double the amount of matter in the system while holding the temperature and pressure of
the system unchanged.

3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the work done by a system, heat transfer between objects, and internal energy change of a system
• Calculate the work, heat transfer, and internal energy change in a simple process

We discussed the concepts of work and energy earlier in mechanics. Examples and related issues of heat
transfer between different objects have also been discussed in the preceding chapters. Here, we want to
expand these concepts to a thermodynamic system and its environment. Specifically, we elaborated on the
concepts of heat and heat transfer in the previous two chapters. Here, we want to understand how work is done
by or to a thermodynamic system; how heat is transferred between a system and its environment; and how the
total energy of the system changes under the influence of the work done and heat transfer.

Work Done by a System


A force created from any source can do work by moving an object through a displacement. Then how does a
thermodynamic system do work? Figure 3.4 shows a gas confined to a cylinder that has a movable piston at
one end. If the gas expands against the piston, it exerts a force through a distance and does work on the piston.
If the piston compresses the gas as it is moved inward, work is also done—in this case, on the gas. The work
associated with such volume changes can be determined as follows: Let the gas pressure on the piston face be
p. Then the force on the piston due to the gas is pA, where A is the area of the face. When the piston is pushed
outward an infinitesimal distance dx, the magnitude of the work done by the gas is

Since the change in volume of the gas is this becomes


3.3
For a finite change in volume from we can integrate this equation from to find the net work:

3.4

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.2 • Work, Heat, and Internal Energy 113

Figure 3.4 The work done by a confined gas in moving a piston a distance dx is given by

This integral is only meaningful for a quasi-static process, which means a process that takes place in
infinitesimally small steps, keeping the system at thermal equilibrium. (We examine this idea in more detail
later in this chapter.) Only then does a well-defined mathematical relationship (the equation of state) exist
between the pressure and volume. This relationship can be plotted on a pV diagram of pressure versus volume,
where the curve is the change of state. We can approximate such a process as one that occurs slowly, through a
series of equilibrium states. The integral is interpreted graphically as the area under the pV curve (the shaded
area of Figure 3.5). Work done by the gas is positive for expansion and negative for compression.

Figure 3.5 When a gas expands slowly from the work done by the system is represented by the shaded area under the pV curve.

Consider the two processes involving an ideal gas that are represented by paths AC and ABC in Figure 3.6. The
first process is an isothermal expansion, with the volume of the gas changing its volume from . This
isothermal process is represented by the curve between points A and C. The gas is kept at a constant
temperature T by keeping it in thermal equilibrium with a heat reservoir at that temperature. From Equation
3.4 and the ideal gas law,
114 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 3.6 The paths ABC, AC, and ADC represent three different quasi-static transitions between the equilibrium states A and C.

The expansion is isothermal, so T remains constant over the entire process. Since n and R are also constant,
the only variable in the integrand is V, so the work done by an ideal gas in an isothermal process is

Notice that if (expansion), W is positive, as expected.

The straight lines from A to B and then from B to C represent a different process. Here, a gas at a pressure
first expands isobarically (constant pressure) and quasi-statically from , after which it cools quasi-
statically at the constant volume until its pressure drops to . From A to B, the pressure is constant at p, so
the work over this part of the path is

From B to C, there is no change in volume and therefore no work is done. The net work over the path ABC is
then

A comparison of the expressions for the work done by the gas in the two processes of Figure 3.6 shows that
they are quite different. This illustrates a very important property of thermodynamic work: It is path
dependent. We cannot determine the work done by a system as it goes from one equilibrium state to another
unless we know its thermodynamic path. Different values of the work are associated with different paths.

EXAMPLE 3.1

Isothermal Expansion of a van der Waals Gas


Studies of a van der Waals gas require an adjustment to the ideal gas law that takes into consideration that gas
molecules have a definite volume (see The Kinetic Theory of Gases). One mole of a van der Waals gas has an
equation of state

where a and b are two parameters for a specific gas. Suppose the gas expands isothermally and quasi-statically
from volume to volume How much work is done by the gas during the expansion?

Strategy
Because the equation of state is given, we can use Equation 3.4 to express the pressure in terms of V and T.
Furthermore, temperature T is a constant under the isothermal condition, so V becomes the only changing

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.2 • Work, Heat, and Internal Energy 115

variable under the integral.

Solution
To evaluate this integral, we must express p as a function of V. From the given equation of state, the gas
pressure is

Because T is constant under the isothermal condition, the work done by 1 mol of a van der Waals gas in
expanding from a volume to a volume is thus

Significance
By taking into account the volume of molecules, the expression for work is much more complex. If, however,
we set and we see that the expression for work matches exactly the work done by an isothermal
process for one mole of an ideal gas.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 3.1


How much work is done by the gas, as given in Figure 3.6, when it expands quasi-statically along the path ADC?

Internal Energy
The internal energy of a thermodynamic system is, by definition, the sum of the mechanical energies of
all the molecules or entities in the system. If the kinetic and potential energies of molecule i are and
respectively, then the internal energy of the system is the average of the total mechanical energy of all the
entities:

3.5

where the summation is over all the molecules of the system, and the bars over K and U indicate average
values. The kinetic energy of an individual molecule includes contributions due to its rotation and
vibration, as well as its translational energy where is the molecule’s speed measured relative to the
center of mass of the system. The potential energy is associated only with the interactions between
molecule i and the other molecules of the system. In fact, neither the system’s location nor its motion is of any
consequence as far as the internal energy is concerned. The internal energy of the system is not affected by
moving it from the basement to the roof of a 100-story building or by placing it on a moving train.

In an ideal monatomic gas, each molecule is a single atom. Consequently, there is no rotational or vibrational
kinetic energy and . Furthermore, there are no interatomic interactions (collisions
notwithstanding), so , which we set to zero. The internal energy is therefore due to translational
kinetic energy only and

From the discussion in the preceding chapter, we know that the average kinetic energy of a molecule in an
ideal monatomic gas is
116 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

where T is the Kelvin temperature of the gas. Consequently, the average mechanical energy per molecule of an
ideal monatomic gas is also that is,

The internal energy is just the number of molecules multiplied by the average mechanical energy per
molecule. Thus for n moles of an ideal monatomic gas,

3.6

Notice that the internal energy of a given quantity of an ideal monatomic gas depends on just the temperature
and is completely independent of the pressure and volume of the gas. For other systems, the internal energy
cannot be expressed so simply. However, an increase in internal energy can often be associated with an
increase in temperature.

We know from the zeroth law of thermodynamics that when two systems are placed in thermal contact, they
eventually reach thermal equilibrium, at which point they are at the same temperature. As an example,
suppose we mix two monatomic ideal gases. Now, the energy per molecule of an ideal monatomic gas is
proportional to its temperature. Thus, when the two gases are mixed, the molecules of the hotter gas must lose
energy and the molecules of the colder gas must gain energy. This continues until thermal equilibrium is
reached, at which point, the temperature, and therefore the average translational kinetic energy per molecule,
is the same for both gases. The approach to equilibrium for real systems is somewhat more complicated than
for an ideal monatomic gas. Nevertheless, we can still say that energy is exchanged between the systems until
their temperatures are the same.

3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• State the first law of thermodynamics and explain how it is applied
• Explain how heat transfer, work done, and internal energy change are related in any thermodynamic process

Now that we have seen how to calculate internal energy, heat, and work done for a thermodynamic system
undergoing change during some process, we can see how these quantities interact to affect the amount of
change that can occur. This interaction is given by the first law of thermodynamics. British scientist and
novelist C. P. Snow (1905–1980) is credited with a joke about the four laws of thermodynamics. His humorous
statement of the first law of thermodynamics is stated “you can’t win,” or in other words, you cannot get more
energy out of a system than you put into it. We will see in this chapter how internal energy, heat, and work all
play a role in the first law of thermodynamics.

Suppose Q represents the heat exchanged between a system and the environment, and W is the work done by
or on the system. The first law states that the change in internal energy of that system is given by . Since
added heat increases the internal energy of a system, Q is positive when it is added to the system and negative
when it is removed from the system.

When a gas expands, it does work and its internal energy decreases. Thus, W is positive when work is done by
the system and negative when work is done on the system. This sign convention is summarized in Table 3.1.
The first law of thermodynamics is stated as follows:

First Law of Thermodynamics


Associated with every equilibrium state of a system is its internal energy The change in for any

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.3 • First Law of Thermodynamics 117

transition between two equilibrium states is


3.7
where Q and W represent, respectively, the heat exchanged by the system and the work done by or on the
system.

Thermodynamic Sign Conventions for Heat and Work

Process Convention

Heat added to system

Heat removed from system

Work done by system

Work done on system

Table 3.1

The first law is a statement of energy conservation. It tells us that a system can exchange energy with its
surroundings by the transmission of heat and by the performance of work. The net energy exchanged is then
equal to the change in the total mechanical energy of the molecules of the system (i.e., the system’s internal
energy). Thus, if a system is isolated, its internal energy must remain constant.

Although Q and W both depend on the thermodynamic path taken between two equilibrium states, their
difference does not. Figure 3.7 shows the pV diagram of a system that is making the transition from A
to B repeatedly along different thermodynamic paths. Along path 1, the system absorbs heat and does work
along path 2, it absorbs heat and does work and so on. The values of and may vary from
path to path, but we have

or

That is, the change in the internal energy of the system between A and B is path independent. In the chapter on
potential energy and the conservation of energy, we encountered another path-independent quantity: the
change in potential energy between two arbitrary points in space. This change represents the negative of the
work done by a conservative force between the two points. The potential energy is a function of spatial
coordinates, whereas the internal energy is a function of thermodynamic variables. For example, we might
write for the internal energy. Functions such as internal energy and potential energy are known as
state functions because their values depend solely on the state of the system.
118 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 3.7 Different thermodynamic paths taken by a system in going from state A to state B. For all transitions, the change in the internal
energy of the system is the same.

Often the first law is used in its differential form, which is


3.8
Here is an infinitesimal change in internal energy when an infinitesimal amount of heat dQ is exchanged
with the system and an infinitesimal amount of work dW is done by (positive in sign) or on (negative in sign)
the system.

EXAMPLE 3.2

Changes of State and the First Law


During a thermodynamic process, a system moves from state A to state B, it is supplied with 400 J of heat and
does 100 J of work. (a) For this transition, what is the system’s change in internal energy? (b) If the system then
moves from state B back to state A, what is its change in internal energy? (c) If in moving from A to B along a
different path, of work is done on the system, how much heat does it absorb?

Strategy
The first law of thermodynamics relates the internal energy change, work done by the system, and the heat
transferred to the system in a simple equation. The internal energy is a function of state and is therefore fixed
at any given point regardless of how the system reaches the state.

Solution

a. From the first law, the change in the system’s internal energy is

b. Consider a closed path that passes through the states A and B. Internal energy is a state function, so
is zero for a closed path. Thus

and

This yields

c. The change in internal energy is the same for any path, so

and the heat exchanged is

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.3 • First Law of Thermodynamics 119

The negative sign indicates that the system loses heat in this transition.

Significance
When a closed cycle is considered for the first law of thermodynamics, the change in internal energy around
the whole path is equal to zero. If friction were to play a role in this example, less work would result from this
heat added. Example 3.3 takes into consideration what happens if friction plays a role.

Notice that in Example 3.2, we did not assume that the transitions were quasi-static. This is because the first
law is not subject to such a restriction. It describes transitions between equilibrium states but is not concerned
with the intermediate states. The system does not have to pass through only equilibrium states. For example, if
a gas in a steel container at a well-defined temperature and pressure is made to explode by means of a spark,
some of the gas may condense, different gas molecules may combine to form new compounds, and there may
be all sorts of turbulence in the container—but eventually, the system will settle down to a new equilibrium
state. This system is clearly not in equilibrium during its transition; however, its behavior is still governed by
the first law because the process starts and ends with the system in equilibrium states.

EXAMPLE 3.3

Polishing a Fitting
A machinist polishes a 0.50-kg copper fitting with a piece of emery cloth for 2.0 min. He moves the cloth across
the fitting at a constant speed of 1.0 m/s by applying a force of 20 N, tangent to the surface of the fitting. (a)
What is the total work done on the fitting by the machinist? (b) What is the increase in the internal energy of
the fitting? Assume that the change in the internal energy of the cloth is negligible and that no heat is
exchanged between the fitting and its environment. (c) What is the increase in the temperature of the fitting?

Strategy
The machinist’s force over a distance that can be calculated from the speed and time given is the work done on
the system. The work, in turn, increases the internal energy of the system. This energy can be interpreted as
the heat that raises the temperature of the system via its heat capacity. Be careful with the sign of each
quantity.

Solution

a. The power created by a force on an object or the rate at which the machinist does frictional work on the
fitting is . Thus, in an elapsed time (2.0 min), the work done on the fitting is

b. By assumption, no heat is exchanged between the fitting and its environment, so the first law gives for the
change in the internal energy of the fitting:

c. Since is path independent, the effect of the of work is the same as if it were supplied at
atmospheric pressure by a transfer of heat. Thus,

and the increase in the temperature of the fitting is

where we have used the value for the specific heat of copper, .

Significance
If heat were released, the change in internal energy would be less and cause less of a temperature change than
what was calculated in the problem.
120 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 3.2


The quantities below represent four different transitions between the same initial and final state. Fill in the
blanks.

Q (J) W (J)

–80 –120

90

40

–40

Table 3.2

EXAMPLE 3.4

An Ideal Gas Making Transitions between Two States


Consider the quasi-static expansions of an ideal gas between the equilibrium states A and C of Figure 3.6. If
515 J of heat are added to the gas as it traverses the path ABC, how much heat is required for the transition
along ADC? Assume that and

Strategy
The difference in work done between process ABC and process ADC is the area enclosed by ABCD. Because the
change of the internal energy (a function of state) is the same for both processes, the difference in work is thus
the same as the difference in heat transferred to the system.

Solution
For path ABC, the heat added is and the work done by the gas is the area under the path on the
pV diagram, which is

Along ADC, the work done by the gas is again the area under the path:

Then using the strategy we just described, we have

which leads to

Significance
The work calculations in this problem are made simple since no work is done along AD and BC and along AB
and DC; the pressure is constant over the volume change, so the work done is simply . An isothermal line
could also have been used, as we have derived the work for an isothermal process as .

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.3 • First Law of Thermodynamics 121

EXAMPLE 3.5

Isothermal Expansion of an Ideal Gas


Heat is added to 1 mol of an ideal monatomic gas confined to a cylinder with a movable piston at one end. The
gas expands quasi-statically at a constant temperature of 300 K until its volume increases from V to 3V. (a)
What is the change in internal energy of the gas? (b) How much work does the gas do? (c) How much heat is
added to the gas?

Strategy
(a) Because the system is an ideal gas, the internal energy only changes when the temperature changes. (b) The
heat added to the system is therefore purely used to do work that has been calculated in Work, Heat, and
Internal Energy. (c) Lastly, the first law of thermodynamics can be used to calculate the heat added to the gas.

Solution

a. We saw in the preceding section that the internal energy of an ideal monatomic gas is a function only of
temperature. Since , for this process,
b. The quasi-static isothermal expansion of an ideal gas was considered in the preceding section and was
found to be

c. With the results of parts (a) and (b), we can use the first law to determine the heat added:

which leads to

Significance
An isothermal process has no change in the internal energy. Based on that, the first law of thermodynamics
reduces to .

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 3.3


Why was it necessary to state that the process of Example 3.5 is quasi-static?

EXAMPLE 3.6

Vaporizing Water
When 1.00 g of water at changes from the liquid to the gas phase at atmospheric pressure, its change in
volume is (a) How much heat must be added to vaporize the water? (b) How much work is
done by the water against the atmosphere in its expansion? (c) What is the change in the internal energy of the
water?

Strategy
We can first figure out how much heat is needed from the latent heat of vaporization of the water. From the
volume change, we can calculate the work done from because the pressure is constant. Then, the
first law of thermodynamics provides us with the change in the internal energy.

Solution

a. With representing the latent heat of vaporization, the heat required to vaporize the water is
122 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

b. Since the pressure on the system is constant at , the work done by the water
as it is vaporized is

c. From the first law, the thermal energy of the water during its vaporization changes by

Significance
We note that in part (c), we see a change in internal energy, yet there is no change in temperature. Ideal gases
that are not undergoing phase changes have the internal energy proportional to temperature. Internal energy
in general is the sum of all energy in the system.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 3.4


When 1.00 g of ammonia boils at atmospheric pressure and its volume changes from 1.47 to
. Its heat of vaporization at this pressure is What is the change in the internal
energy of the ammonia when it vaporizes?

INTERACTIVE
View this site (https://openstax.org/l/211stlawthermo) to learn about how the first law of thermodynamics.
First, pump some heavy species molecules into the chamber. Then, play around by doing work (pushing the
wall to the right where the person is located) to see how the internal energy changes (as seen by temperature).
Then, look at how heat added changes the internal energy. Finally, you can set a parameter constant such as
temperature and see what happens when you do work to keep the temperature constant (Note: You might see a
change in these variables initially if you are moving around quickly in the simulation, but ultimately, this value
will return to its equilibrium value).

3.4 Thermodynamic Processes


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define a thermodynamic process
• Distinguish between quasi-static and non-quasi-static processes
• Calculate physical quantities, such as the heat transferred, work done, and internal energy change for
isothermal, adiabatic, and cyclical thermodynamic processes

In solving mechanics problems, we isolate the body under consideration, analyze the external forces acting on
it, and then use Newton’s laws to predict its behavior. In thermodynamics, we take a similar approach. We start
by identifying the part of the universe we wish to study; it is also known as our system. (We defined a system at
the beginning of this chapter as anything whose properties are of interest to us; it can be a single atom or the
entire Earth.) Once our system is selected, we determine how the environment, or surroundings, interact with
the system. Finally, with the interaction understood, we study the thermal behavior of the system with the help
of the laws of thermodynamics.

The thermal behavior of a system is described in terms of thermodynamic variables. For an ideal gas, these
variables are pressure, volume, temperature, and the number of molecules or moles of the gas. Different types
of systems are generally characterized by different sets of variables. For example, the thermodynamic
variables for a stretched rubber band are tension, length, temperature, and mass.

The state of a system can change as a result of its interaction with the environment. The change in a system
can be fast or slow and large or small. The manner in which a state of a system can change from an initial state
to a final state is called a thermodynamic process. For analytical purposes in thermodynamics, it is helpful to
divide up processes as either quasi-static or non-quasi-static, as we now explain.

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.4 • Thermodynamic Processes 123

Quasi-static and Non-quasi-static Processes


A quasi-static process refers to an idealized or imagined process where the change in state is made
infinitesimally slowly so that at each instant, the system can be assumed to be at a thermodynamic
equilibrium with itself and with the environment. For instance, imagine heating 1 kg of water from a
temperature to at a constant pressure of 1 atmosphere. To heat the water very slowly, we may
imagine placing the container with water in a large bath that can be slowly heated such that the temperature of
the bath can rise infinitesimally slowly from to . If we put 1 kg of water at directly into a bath
at , the temperature of the water will rise rapidly to in a non-quasi-static way.

Quasi-static processes are done slowly enough that the system remains at thermodynamic equilibrium at each
instant, despite the fact that the system changes over time. The thermodynamic equilibrium of the system is
necessary for the system to have well-defined values of macroscopic properties such as the temperature and
the pressure of the system at each instant of the process. Therefore, quasi-static processes can be shown as
well-defined paths in state space of the system.

Since quasi-static processes cannot be completely realized for any finite change of the system, all processes in
nature are non-quasi-static. Examples of quasi-static and non-quasi-static processes are shown in Figure 3.8.
Despite the fact that all finite changes must occur essentially non-quasi-statically at some stage of the change,
we can imagine performing infinitely many quasi-static process corresponding to every quasi-static process.
Since quasi-static processes can be analyzed analytically, we mostly study quasi-static processes in this book.
We have already seen that in a quasi-static process the work by a gas is given by pdV.

Figure 3.8 Quasi-static and non-quasi-static processes between states A and B of a gas. In a quasi-static process, the path of the process
between A and B can be drawn in a state diagram since all the states that the system goes through are known. In a non-quasi-static
process, the states between A and B are not known, and hence no path can be drawn. It may follow the dashed line as shown in the figure
or take a very different path.

Isothermal Processes
An isothermal process is a change in the state of the system at a constant temperature. This process is
accomplished by keeping the system in thermal equilibrium with a large heat bath during the process. Recall
that a heat bath is an idealized “infinitely” large system whose temperature does not change. In practice, the
temperature of a finite bath is controlled by either adding or removing a finite amount of energy as the case
may be.

As an illustration of an isothermal process, consider a cylinder of gas with a movable piston immersed in a
large water tank whose temperature is maintained constant. Since the piston is freely movable, the pressure
inside is balanced by the pressure outside by some weights on the piston, as in Figure 3.9.
124 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 3.9 Expanding a system at a constant temperature. Removing weights on the piston leads to an imbalance of forces on the piston,
which causes the piston to move up. As the piston moves up, the temperature is lowered momentarily, which causes heat to flow from the
heat bath to the system. The energy to move the piston eventually comes from the heat bath.

As weights on the piston are removed, an imbalance of forces on the piston develops. The net nonzero force on
the piston would cause the piston to accelerate, resulting in an increase in volume. The expansion of the gas
cools the gas to a lower temperature, which makes it possible for the heat to enter from the heat bath into the
system until the temperature of the gas is reset to the temperature of the heat bath. If weights are removed in
infinitesimal steps, the pressure in the system decreases infinitesimally slowly. This way, an isothermal
process can be conducted quasi-statically. An isothermal line on a (p, V) diagram is represented by a curved
line from starting point A to finishing point B, as seen in Figure 3.10. For an ideal gas, an isothermal process is
hyperbolic, since for an ideal gas at constant temperature, .

Figure 3.10 An isothermal expansion from a state labeled A to another state labeled B on a pV diagram. The curve represents the relation
between pressure and volume in an ideal gas at constant temperature.

An isothermal process studied in this chapter is quasi-statically performed, since to be isothermal throughout
the change of volume, you must be able to state the temperature of the system at each step, which is possible
only if the system is in thermal equilibrium continuously. The system must go out of equilibrium for the state
to change, but for quasi-static processes, we imagine that the process is conducted in infinitesimal steps such
that these departures from equilibrium can be made as brief and as small as we like.

Other quasi-static processes of interest for gases are isobaric and isochoric processes. An isobaric process is a
process where the pressure of the system does not change, whereas an isochoric process is a process where
the volume of the system does not change.

Adiabatic Processes
In an adiabatic process, the system is insulated from its environment so that although the state of the system
changes, no heat is allowed to enter or leave the system, as seen in Figure 3.11. An adiabatic process can be
conducted either quasi-statically or non-quasi-statically. When a system expands adiabatically, it must do
work against the outside world, and therefore its energy goes down, which is reflected in the lowering of the
temperature of the system. An adiabatic expansion leads to a lowering of temperature, and an adiabatic
compression leads to an increase of temperature. We discuss adiabatic expansion again in Adiabatic Processes
for an ideal Gas.

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.5 • Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas 125

Figure 3.11 An insulated piston with a hot, compressed gas is released. The piston moves up, the volume expands, and the pressure and
temperature decrease. The internal energy goes into work. If the expansion occurs within a time frame in which negligible heat can enter
the system, then the process is called adiabatic. Ideally, during an adiabatic process no heat enters or exits the system.

Cyclic Processes
We say that a system goes through a cyclic process if the state of the system at the end is same as the state at
the beginning. Therefore, state properties such as temperature, pressure, volume, and internal energy of the
system do not change over a complete cycle:

When the first law of thermodynamics is applied to a cyclic process, we obtain a simple relation between heat
into the system and the work done by the system over the cycle:

Thermodynamic processes are also distinguished by whether or not they are reversible. A reversible process
is one that can be made to retrace its path by differential changes in the environment. Such a process must
therefore also be quasi-static. Note, however, that a quasi-static process is not necessarily reversible, since
there may be dissipative forces involved. For example, if friction occurred between the piston and the walls of
the cylinder containing the gas, the energy lost to friction would prevent us from reproducing the original
states of the system.

We considered several thermodynamic processes:

1. An isothermal process, during which the system’s temperature remains constant


2. An adiabatic process, during which no heat is transferred to or from the system
3. An isobaric process, during which the system’s pressure does not change
4. An isochoric process, during which the system’s volume does not change

Many other processes also occur that do not fit into any of these four categories.

INTERACTIVE
View this site (https://openstax.org/l/21idegaspvdiag) to set up your own process in a pV diagram. See if you
can calculate the values predicted by the simulation for heat, work, and change in internal energy.

3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define heat capacity of an ideal gas for a specific process
• Calculate the specific heat of an ideal gas for either an isobaric or isochoric process
• Explain the difference between the heat capacities of an ideal gas and a real gas
• Estimate the change in specific heat of a gas over temperature ranges
126 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

We learned about specific heat and molar heat capacity in Temperature and Heat; however, we have not
considered a process in which heat is added. We do that in this section. First, we examine a process where the
system has a constant volume, then contrast it with a system at constant pressure and show how their specific
heats are related.

Let’s start with looking at Figure 3.12, which shows two vessels A and B, each containing 1 mol of the same
type of ideal gas at a temperature T and a volume V. The only difference between the two vessels is that the
piston at the top of A is fixed, whereas the one at the top of B is free to move against a constant external
pressure p. We now consider what happens when the temperature of the gas in each vessel is slowly increased
to with the addition of heat.

Figure 3.12 Two vessels are identical except that the piston at the top of A is fixed, whereas that atop B is free to move against a constant
external pressure p.

Since the piston of vessel A is fixed, the volume of the enclosed gas does not change. Consequently, the gas
does no work, and we have from the first law

We represent the fact that the heat is exchanged at constant volume by writing

where is the molar heat capacity at constant volume of the gas. In addition, since for this
particular process,
3.9
We obtained this equation assuming the volume of the gas was fixed. However, internal energy is a state
function that depends on only the temperature of an ideal gas. Therefore, gives the change in
internal energy of an ideal gas for any process involving a temperature change dT.

When the gas in vessel B is heated, it expands against the movable piston and does work In this
case, the heat is added at constant pressure, and we write

where is the molar heat capacity at constant pressure of the gas. Furthermore, since the ideal gas
expands against a constant pressure,

becomes

Finally, inserting the expressions for dQ and pdV into the first law, we obtain

We have found for both an isochoric and an isobaric process. Because the internal energy of an ideal gas
depends only on the temperature, must be the same for both processes. Thus,

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.6 • Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas 127

and

3.10

The derivation of Equation 3.10 was based only on the ideal gas law. Consequently, this relationship is
approximately valid for all dilute gases, whether monatomic like He, diatomic like or polyatomic like

In the preceding chapter, we found the molar heat capacity of an ideal gas under constant volume to be

where d is the number of degrees of freedom of a molecule in the system. Table 3.3 shows the molar heat
capacities of some dilute ideal gases at room temperature. The heat capacities of real gases are somewhat
higher than those predicted by the expressions of and given in Equation 3.10. This indicates that
vibrational motion in polyatomic molecules is significant, even at room temperature. Nevertheless, the
difference in the molar heat capacities, is very close to R, even for the polyatomic gases.

Molar Heat Capacities of Dilute Ideal Gases at Room Temperature

Type of Molecule Gas


(J/mol K) (J/mol K) (J/mol K)

Monatomic Ideal

Diatomic Ideal

Polyatomic Ideal

Table 3.3

3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define adiabatic expansion of an ideal gas
• Demonstrate the qualitative difference between adiabatic and isothermal expansions

When an ideal gas is compressed adiabatically work is done on it and its temperature increases; in an
adiabatic expansion, the gas does work and its temperature drops. Adiabatic compressions actually occur in
the cylinders of a car, where the compressions of the gas-air mixture take place so quickly that there is no time
for the mixture to exchange heat with its environment. Nevertheless, because work is done on the mixture
during the compression, its temperature does rise significantly. In fact, the temperature increases can be so
large that the mixture can explode without the addition of a spark. Such explosions, since they are not timed,
make a car run poorly—it usually “knocks.” Because ignition temperature rises with the octane of gasoline, one
way to overcome this problem is to use a higher-octane gasoline.

Another interesting adiabatic process is the free expansion of a gas. Figure 3.13 shows a gas confined by a
membrane to one side of a two-compartment, thermally insulated container. When the membrane is
punctured, gas rushes into the empty side of the container, thereby expanding freely. Because the gas expands
“against a vacuum” , it does no work, and because the vessel is thermally insulated, the expansion is
adiabatic. With and in the first law, so for the free expansion.
128 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 3.13 The gas in the left chamber expands freely into the right chamber when the membrane is punctured.

If the gas is ideal, the internal energy depends only on the temperature. Therefore, when an ideal gas expands
freely, its temperature does not change.

A quasi-static, adiabatic expansion of an ideal gas is represented in Figure 3.14, which shows an insulated
cylinder that contains 1 mol of an ideal gas. The gas is made to expand quasi-statically by removing one grain
of sand at a time from the top of the piston. When the gas expands by dV, the change in its temperature is dT.
The work done by the gas in the expansion is because the cylinder is insulated; and the
change in the internal energy of the gas is, from Equation 3.9, Therefore, from the first law,

so

Figure 3.14 When sand is removed from the piston one grain at a time, the gas expands adiabatically and quasi-statically in the insulated
vessel.

Also, for 1 mol of an ideal gas,

so

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.6 • Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas 129

and

We now have two equations for dT. Upon equating them, we find that

Now, we divide this equation by npV and use . We are then left with

which becomes

where we define as the ratio of the molar heat capacities:

3.11

Thus,

and

Finally, using , we can write this in the form

3.12

This equation is the condition that must be obeyed by an ideal gas in a quasi-static adiabatic process. For
example, if an ideal gas makes a quasi-static adiabatic transition from a state with pressure and volume and
to a state with and then it must be true that

The adiabatic condition of Equation 3.12 can be written in terms of other pairs of thermodynamic variables by
combining it with the ideal gas law. In doing this, we find that

3.13

and

3.14

A reversible adiabatic expansion of an ideal gas is represented on the pV diagram of Figure 3.15. The slope of
the curve at any point is
130 3 • The First Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 3.15 Quasi-static adiabatic and isothermal expansions of an ideal gas.

The dashed curve shown on this pV diagram represents an isothermal expansion where T (and therefore pV) is
constant. The slope of this curve is useful when we consider the second law of thermodynamics in the next
chapter. This slope is

Because the isothermal curve is not as steep as that for the adiabatic expansion.

EXAMPLE 3.7

Compression of an Ideal Gas in an Automobile Engine


Gasoline vapor is injected into the cylinder of an automobile engine when the piston is in its expanded
position. The temperature, pressure, and volume of the resulting gas-air mixture are ,
and , respectively. The mixture is then compressed adiabatically to a volume of . Note that in
the actual operation of an automobile engine, the compression is not quasi-static, although we are making that
assumption here. (a) What are the pressure and temperature of the mixture after the compression? (b) How
much work is done by the mixture during the compression?

Strategy
Because we are modeling the process as a quasi-static adiabatic compression of an ideal gas, we have

and . The work needed can then be evaluated with .

Solution

a. For an adiabatic compression we have

so after the compression, the pressure of the mixture is

From the ideal gas law, the temperature of the mixture after the compression is

Access for free at openstax.org.


3.6 • Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas 131

b. The work done by the mixture during the compression is

With the adiabatic condition of Equation 3.12, we may write p as where The
work is therefore

Significance
The negative sign on the work done indicates that the piston does work on the gas-air mixture. The engine
would not work if the gas-air mixture did work on the piston.
132 3 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
adiabatic process process during which no heat is system’s volume does not change
transferred to or from the system isothermal process process during which the
boundary imagined walls that separate the system system’s temperature remains constant
and its surroundings molar heat capacity at constant pressure
closed system system that is mechanically and quantifies the ratio of the amount of heat added
thermally isolated from its environment removed to the temperature while measuring at
cyclic process process in which the state of the constant pressure
system at the end is same as the state at the molar heat capacity at constant volume
beginning quantifies the ratio of the amount of heat added
environment outside of the system being studied removed to the temperature while measuring at
equation of state describes properties of matter constant volume
under given physical conditions open system system that can exchange energy
equilibrium thermal balance established between and/or matter with its surroundings
two objects or parts within a system quasi-static process evolution of a system that
extensive variable variable that is proportional to goes so slowly that the system involved is always
the amount of matter in the system in thermodynamic equilibrium
first law of thermodynamics the change in reversible process process that can be reverted to
internal energy for any transition between two restore both the system and its environment back
equilibrium states is to their original states together
intensive variable variable that is independent of surroundings environment that interacts with an
the amount of matter in the system open system
internal energy average of the total mechanical thermodynamic process manner in which a state
energy of all the molecules or entities in the of a system can change from initial state to final
system state
isobaric process process during which the thermodynamic system object and focus of
system’s pressure does not change thermodynamic study
isochoric process process during which the

Key Equations
Equation of state for a closed system

Net work for a finite change in volume

Internal energy of a system (average total energy)

Internal energy of a monatomic ideal gas

First law of thermodynamics

Molar heat capacity at constant pressure

Ratio of molar heat capacities

Condition for an ideal gas in a quasi-static adiabatic process

Access for free at openstax.org.


3 • Chapter Review 133

Summary
3.1 Thermodynamic Systems • A heat reservoir is so large that when it
exchanges heat with other systems, its
• A thermodynamic system, its boundary, and its
temperature does not change.
surroundings must be defined with all the roles
• A quasi-static process takes place so slowly that
of the components fully explained before we can
the system involved is always in thermodynamic
analyze a situation.
equilibrium.
• Thermal equilibrium is reached with two
• A reversible process is one that can be made to
objects if a third object is in thermal equilibrium
retrace its path and both the temperature and
with the other two separately.
pressure are uniform throughout the system.
• A general equation of state for a closed system
• There are several types of thermodynamic
has the form with an ideal gas as
processes, including (a) isothermal, where the
an illustrative example.
system’s temperature is constant; (b) adiabatic,
3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy where no heat is exchanged by the system; (c)
isobaric, where the system’s pressure is
• Positive (negative) work is done by a constant; and (d) isochoric, where the system’s
thermodynamic system when it expands volume is constant.
(contracts) under an external pressure. • As a consequence of the first law of
• Heat is the energy transferred between two thermodymanics, here is a summary of the
objects (or two parts of a system) because of a thermodymaic processes: (a) isothermal:
temperature difference. (b) adiabatic:
• Internal energy of a thermodynamic system is (c) isobaric:
its total mechanical energy. and (d) isochoric:
3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics
• The internal energy of a thermodynamic system 3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas
is a function of state and thus is unique for every • For an ideal gas, the molar capacity at constant
equilibrium state of the system. pressure is given by
• The increase in the internal energy of the
, where d is the
thermodynamic system is given by the heat
number of degrees of freedom of each molecule/
added to the system less the work done by the
entity in the system.
system in any thermodynamics process.
• A real gas has a specific heat close to but a little
3.4 Thermodynamic Processes bit higher than that of the corresponding ideal
gas with
• The thermal behavior of a system is described in
terms of thermodynamic variables. For an ideal 3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas
gas, these variables are pressure, volume,
• A quasi-static adiabatic expansion of an ideal
temperature, and number of molecules or moles
gas produces a steeper pV curve than that of the
of the gas.
corresponding isotherm.
• For systems in thermodynamic equilibrium, the
• A realistic expansion can be adiabatic but rarely
thermodynamic variables are related by an
quasi-static.
equation of state.

Conceptual Questions
3.1 Thermodynamic Systems 3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy
1. Consider these scenarios and state whether work 2. Is it possible to determine whether a change in
is done by the system on the environment (SE) or internal energy is caused by heat transferred, by
by the environment on the system (ES): (a) work performed, or by a combination of the two?
opening a carbonated beverage; (b) filling a flat 3. When a liquid is vaporized, its change in internal
tire; (c) a sealed empty gas can expands on a hot energy is not equal to the heat added. Why?
day, bowing out the walls. 4. Why does a bicycle pump feel warm as you inflate
your tire?
134 3 • Chapter Review

5. Is it possible for the temperature of a system to processes? Explain your answer.


remain constant when heat flows into or out of it?
If so, give examples. 3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas
12. How can an object transfer heat if the object
3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics
does not possess a discrete quantity of heat?
6. What does the first law of thermodynamics tell us 13. Most materials expand when heated. One
about the energy of the universe? notable exception is water between and
7. Does adding heat to a system always increase its which actually decreases in volume with
internal energy? the increase in temperature. Which is greater
8. A great deal of effort, time, and money has been for water in this temperature region, or ?
spent in the quest for a so-called perpetual- 14. Why are there two specific heats for gases
motion machine, which is defined as a and , yet only one given for solid?
hypothetical machine that operates or produces
useful work indefinitely and/or a hypothetical 3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas
machine that produces more work or energy
than it consumes. Explain, in terms of the first 15. Is it possible for to be smaller than unity?
law of thermodynamics, why or why not such a 16. Would you expect to be larger for a gas or a
machine is likely to be constructed. solid? Explain.
17. There is no change in the internal energy of an
ideal gas undergoing an isothermal process
3.4 Thermodynamic Processes
since the internal energy depends only on the
9. When a gas expands isothermally, it does work. temperature. Is it therefore correct to say that
What is the source of energy needed to do this an isothermal process is the same as an
work? adiabatic process for an ideal gas? Explain your
10. If the pressure and volume of a system are answer.
given, is the temperature always uniquely 18. Does a gas do any work when it expands
determined? adiabatically? If so, what is the source of the
11. It is unlikely that a process can be isothermal energy needed to do this work?
unless it is a very slow process. Explain why. Is
the same true for isobaric and isochoric

Problems
3.1 Thermodynamic Systems 3.2 Work, Heat, and Internal Energy
19. A gas follows on an isothermal 22. A gas at a pressure of 2.00 atm undergoes a
curve, where p is the pressure, V is the volume, quasi-static isobaric expansion from 3.00 to
b is a constant, and c is a function of 5.00 L. How much work is done by the gas?
temperature. Show that a temperature scale 23. It takes 500 J of work to compress quasi-
under an isochoric process can be established statically 0.50 mol of an ideal gas to one-fifth its
with this gas and is identical to that of an ideal original volume. Calculate the temperature of
gas. the gas, assuming it remains constant during
20. A mole of gas has isobaric expansion coefficient the compression.
and isochoric pressure- 24. It is found that, when a dilute gas expands
temperature coefficient . Find the quasi-statically from 0.50 to 4.0 L, it does 250 J
equation of state of the gas. of work. Assuming that the gas temperature
21. Find the equation of state of a solid that has an remains constant at 300 K, how many moles of
isobaric expansion gas are present?
coefficient and an 25. In a quasi-static isobaric expansion, 500 J of
isothermal pressure-volume coefficient work are done by the gas. If the gas pressure is
0.80 atm, what is the fractional increase in the
volume of the gas, assuming it was originally at
20.0 L?
26. When a gas undergoes a quasi-static isobaric

Access for free at openstax.org.


3 • Chapter Review 135

change in volume from 10.0 to 2.0 L, 15 J of at a temperature of


work from an external source are required. 35. Two monatomic ideal gases A and B are at the
What is the pressure of the gas? same temperature. If 1.0 g of gas A has the same
27. An ideal gas expands quasi-statically and internal energy as 0.10 g of gas B, what are (a)
isothermally from a state with pressure p and the ratio of the number of moles of each gas and
volume V to a state with volume 4V. Show that (b) the ration of the atomic masses of the two
the work done by the gas in the expansion is gases?
pV(ln 4). 36. The van der Waals coefficients for oxygen are
28. As shown below, calculate the work done by the and
gas in the quasi-static processes represented by . Use these values to
the paths (a) AB; (b) ADB; (c) ACB; and (d) ADCB. draw a van der Waals isotherm of oxygen at 100
K. On the same graph, draw isotherms of one
mole of an ideal gas.
37. Find the work done in the quasi-static processes
shown below. The states are given as (p, V)
values for the points in the pV plane: 1 (3 atm, 4
L), 2 (3 atm, 6 L), 3 (5 atm, 4 L), 4 (2 atm, 6 L), 5
(4 atm, 2 L), 6 (5 atm, 5 L), and 7 (2 atm, 5 L).

29. (a) Calculate the work done on the gas along the
closed path shown below. The curved section
between R and S is semicircular. (b) If the
process is carried out in the opposite direction,
what is the work done on the gas?

30. An ideal gas expands quasi-statically to three


times its original volume. Which process
requires more work from the gas, an isothermal
process or an isobaric one? Determine the ratio
of the work done in these processes.
31. A dilute gas at a pressure of 2.0 atm and a
volume of 4.0 L is taken through the following
quasi-static steps: (a) an isobaric expansion to a
volume of 10.0 L, (b) an isochoric change to a
pressure of 0.50 atm, (c) an isobaric
compression to a volume of 4.0 L, and (d) an
isochoric change to a pressure of 2.0 atm. Show
these steps on a pV diagram and determine 3.3 First Law of Thermodynamics
from your graph the net work done by the gas.
32. What is the average mechanical energy of the 38. When a dilute gas expands quasi-statically from
atoms of an ideal monatomic gas at 300 K? 0.50 to 4.0 L, it does 250 J of work. Assuming
33. What is the internal energy of 6.00 mol of an that the gas temperature remains constant at
ideal monatomic gas at ? 300 K, (a) what is the change in the internal
34. Calculate the internal energy of 15 mg of helium energy of the gas? (b) How much heat is
136 3 • Chapter Review

absorbed by the gas in this process? correct? (b) Give the correct answer from part
39. In an expansion of gas, 500 J of work are done (a), how much work is done by the gas along
by the gas. If the internal energy of the gas ABC? (c) Along CD, the internal energy of the gas
increased by 80 J in the expansion, how much decreases by 50 J. How much heat is exchanged
heat does the gas absorb? by the gas along this path?
40. An ideal gas expands quasi-statically and
isothermally from a state with pressure p and
volume V to a state with volume 4V. How much
heat is added to the expanding gas?
41. As shown below, if the heat absorbed by the gas
along AB is 400 J, determine the quantities of
heat absorbed along (a) ADB; (b) ACB; and (c)
ADCB.

45. When a gas expands along AB (see below), it


does 20 J of work and absorbs 30 J of heat.
When the gas expands along AC, it does 40 J of
work and absorbs 70 J of heat. (a) How much
heat does the gas exchange along BC? (b) When
the gas makes the transition from C to A along
CDA, 60 J of work are done on it from C to D.
How much heat does it exchange along CDA?
42. During the isobaric expansion from A to B
represented below, 3,100 J of heat are added to
the gas. What is the change in its internal
energy?

46. A dilute gas is stored in the left chamber of a


43. (a) What is the change in internal energy for the
container whose walls are perfectly insulating (see
process represented by the closed path shown
below), and the right chamber is evacuated. When
below? (b) How much heat is exchanged? (c) If
the partition is removed, the gas expands and fills
the path is traversed in the opposite direction,
the entire container. Calculate the work done by the
how much heat is exchanged?
gas. Does the internal energy of the gas change in
this process?

44. When a gas expands along path AC shown


below, it does 400 J of work and absorbs either 47. Ideal gases A and B are stored in the left and right
200 or 400 J of heat. (a) Suppose you are told chambers of an insulated container, as shown
that along path ABC, the gas absorbs either 200 below. The partition is removed and the gases mix.
or 400 J of heat. Which of these values is Is any work done in this process? If the
temperatures of A and B are initially equal, what

Access for free at openstax.org.


3 • Chapter Review 137

happens to their common temperature after they change in internal energy of the gas. (c) Find the
are mixed? heat input to the gas during the change. (d)
What are initial and final temperatures?
52. A metallic container of fixed volume of
immersed in a large tank of
temperature contains two compartments
separated by a freely movable wall. Initially, the
wall is kept in place by a stopper so that there
are 0.02 mol of the nitrogen gas on one side and
0.03 mol of the oxygen gas on the other side,
each occupying half the volume. When the
48. An ideal monatomic gas at a pressure of
stopper is removed, the wall moves and comes
and a temperature of 300 K
to a final position. The movement of the wall is
undergoes a quasi-static isobaric expansion
controlled so that the wall moves in
from (a) What is
infinitesimal quasi-static steps. (a) Find the final
the work done by the gas? (b) What is the
volumes of the two sides assuming the ideal gas
temperature of the gas after the expansion? (c)
behavior for the two gases. (b) How much work
How many moles of gas are there? (d) What is
does each gas do on the other? (c) What is the
the change in internal energy of the gas? (e)
change in the internal energy of each gas? (d)
How much heat is added to the gas?
Find the amount of heat that enters or leaves
49. Consider the process for steam in a cylinder
each gas.
shown below. Suppose the change in the
53. A gas in a cylindrical closed container is
internal energy in this process is 30 kJ. Find the
adiabatically and quasi-statically expanded
heat entering the system.
from a state A (3 MPa, 2 L) to a state B with
volume of 6 L along the path
(a) Plot the path in the pV plane. (b) Find the
amount of work done by the gas and the change
in the internal energy of the gas during the
process.

3.4 Thermodynamic Processes


54. Two moles of a monatomic ideal gas at (5 MPa, 5
L) is expanded isothermally until the volume is
doubled (step 1). Then it is cooled isochorically
50. The state of 30 moles of steam in a cylinder is until the pressure is 1 MPa (step 2). The
changed in a cyclic manner from a-b-c-a, where temperature drops in this process. The gas is
the pressure and volume of the states are: a (30 now compressed isothermally until its volume
atm, 20 L), b (50 atm, 20 L), and c (50 atm, 45 L). is back to 5 L, but its pressure is now 2 MPa
Assume each change takes place along the line (step 3). Finally, the gas is heated isochorically
connecting the initial and final states in the pV to return to the initial state (step 4). (a) Draw the
plane. (a) Display the cycle in the pV plane. (b) four processes in the pV plane. (b) Find the total
Find the net work done by the steam in one work done by the gas.
cycle. (c) Find the net amount of heat flow in the 55. Consider a transformation from point A to B in a
steam over the course of one cycle. two-step process. First, the pressure is lowered
51. A monatomic ideal gas undergoes a quasi-static from 3 MPa at point A to a pressure of 1 MPa,
process that is described by the function while keeping the volume at 2 L by cooling the
, where the starting state system. The state reached is labeled C. Then the
is and the final state . Assume system is heated at a constant pressure to reach
the system consists of n moles of the gas in a a volume of 6 L in the state B. (a) Find the
container that can exchange heat with the amount of work done on the ACB path. (b) Find
environment and whose volume can change the amount of heat exchanged by the system
freely. (a) Evaluate the work done by the gas when it goes from A to B on the ACB path. (c)
during the change in the state. (b) Find the Compare the change in the internal energy
138 3 • Chapter Review

when the AB process occurs adiabatically with cylindrical container with a piston. The gas is at
the AB change through the two-step process on room temperature and under a pressure
the ACB path. of When the pressure from the
56. Consider a cylinder with a movable piston outside is decreased while keeping the
containing n moles of an ideal gas. The entire temperature the same as the room temperature,
apparatus is immersed in a constant the volume of the gas doubles. (a) Find the work
temperature bath of temperature T kelvin. The the external agent does on the gas in the
piston is then pushed slowly so that the process. (b) Find the heat exchanged by the gas
pressure of the gas changes quasi-statically and indicate whether the gas takes in or gives
from to at constant temperature T. Find up heat. Assume ideal gas behavior.
the work done by the gas in terms of n, R, T, 60. An amount of n moles of a monatomic ideal gas
and in a conducting container with a movable piston
57. An ideal gas expands isothermally along AB and is placed in a large thermal heat bath at
does 700 J of work (see below). (a) How much temperature and the gas is allowed to come
heat does the gas exchange along AB? (b) The to equilibrium. After the equilibrium is reached,
gas then expands adiabatically along BC and the pressure on the piston is lowered so that the
does 400 J of work. When the gas returns to A gas expands at constant temperature. The
along CA, it exhausts 100 J of heat to its process is continued quasi-statically until the
surroundings. How much work is done on the final pressure is 4/3 of the initial pressure
gas along this path? (a) Find the change in the internal energy of the
gas. (b) Find the work done by the gas. (c) Find
the heat exchanged by the gas, and indicate,
whether the gas takes in or gives up heat.

3.5 Heat Capacities of an Ideal Gas


61. The temperature of an ideal monatomic gas
rises by 8.0 K. What is the change in the internal
energy of 1 mol of the gas at constant volume?
62. For a temperature increase of at constant
volume, what is the heat absorbed by (a) 3.0 mol
of a dilute monatomic gas; (b) 0.50 mol of a
dilute diatomic gas; and (c) 15 mol of a dilute
58. Consider the processes shown below for a
polyatomic gas?
monatomic gas. (a) Find the work done in each
63. If the gases of the preceding problem are
of the processes AB, BC, AD, and DC. (b) Find the
initially at 300 K, what are their internal
internal energy change in processes AB and BC.
energies after they absorb the heat?
(c) Find the internal energy difference between
64. Consider 0.40 mol of dilute carbon dioxide at a
states C and A. (d) Find the total heat added in
pressure of 0.50 atm and a volume of 50 L. What
the ADC process. (e) From the information
is the internal energy of the gas?
given, can you find the heat added in process
65. When 400 J of heat are slowly added to 10 mol
AD? Why or why not?
of an ideal monatomic gas, its temperature rises
by . What is the work done on the gas?
66. One mole of a dilute diatomic gas occupying a
volume of 10.00 L expands against a constant
pressure of 2.000 atm when it is slowly heated.
If 400.0 J of heat are added in the process, what
is its final volume?

3.6 Adiabatic Processes for an Ideal Gas


67. A monatomic ideal gas undergoes a quasi-static
adiabatic expansion in which its volume is
59. Two moles of helium gas are placed in a doubled. How is the pressure of the gas

Access for free at openstax.org.


3 • Chapter Review 139

changed? 74. The temperature of n moles of an ideal gas


68. An ideal gas has a pressure of 0.50 atm and a changes from to in a quasi-static
volume of 10 L. It is compressed adiabatically adiabatic transition. Show that the work done by
and quasi-statically until its pressure is 3.0 atm the gas is given by
and its volume is 2.8 L. Is the gas monatomic,
diatomic, or polyatomic? 75. A dilute gas expands quasi-statically to three
69. Pressure and volume measurements of a dilute times its initial volume. Is the final gas pressure
gas undergoing a quasi-static adiabatic greater for an isothermal or an adiabatic
expansion are shown below. Plot ln p vs. V and expansion? Does your answer depend on
determine for this gas from your graph. whether the gas is monatomic, diatomic, or
P (atm) V (L) polyatomic?
76. (a) An ideal gas expands adiabatically from a
20.0 1.0 volume of to . If
the initial pressure and temperature were
17.0 1.1 and 300 K, respectively, what are
the final pressure and temperature of the gas?
14.0 1.3 Use for the gas. (b) In an isothermal
process, an ideal gas expands from a volume of
11.0 1.5 to . If the initial
pressure and temperature were
8.0 2.0 and 300 K, respectively, what are the final
pressure and temperature of the gas?
5.0 2.6 77. On an adiabatic process of an ideal gas
pressure, volume and temperature change such
2.0 5.2 that is constant with for
monatomic gas such as helium and for
1.0 8.4 diatomic gas such as hydrogen at room
temperature. Use numerical values to plot two
isotherms of 1 mol of helium gas using ideal gas
70. An ideal monatomic gas at 300 K expands law and two adiabatic processes mediating
adiabatically and reversibly to twice its volume. between them. Use
What is its final temperature? for your
71. An ideal diatomic gas at 80 K is slowly plot.
compressed adiabatically and reversibly to half 78. Two moles of a monatomic ideal gas such as
its volume. What is its final temperature? helium is compressed adiabatically and
72. An ideal diatomic gas at 80 K is slowly reversibly from a state (3 atm, 5 L) to a state
compressed adiabatically to one-third its with pressure 4 atm. (a) Find the volume and
original volume. What is its final temperature? temperature of the final state. (b) Find the
73. Compare the charge in internal energy of an temperature of the initial state of the gas. (c)
ideal gas for a quasi-static adiabatic expansion Find the work done by the gas in the process. (d)
with that for a quasi-static isothermal Find the change in internal energy of the gas in
expansion. What happens to the temperature of the process.
an ideal gas in an adiabatic expansion?
140 3 • Chapter Review

Additional Problems
79. Consider the process shown below. During steps 84. Calculate the net work output of a heat engine
AB and BC, 3600 J and 2400 J of heat, following path ABCDA as shown below.
respectively, are added to the system. (a) Find
the work done in each of the processes AB, BC,
AD, and DC. (b) Find the internal energy change
in processes AB and BC. (c) Find the internal
energy difference between states C and A. (d)
Find the total heat added in the ADC process. (e)
From the information given, can you find the
heat added in process AD? Why or why not?

85. What is the net work output of a heat engine


that follows path ABDA in the preceding
problem with a straight line from B to D? Why is
the work output less than for path ABCDA?
86. Five moles of a monatomic ideal gas in a
cylinder at is expanded isothermally from
a volume of 5 L to 10 L. (a) What is the change in
internal energy? (b) How much work was done
80. A car tire contains of air at a on the gas in the process? (c) How much heat
pressure of (about 32 psi). How was transferred to the gas?
much more internal energy does this gas have 87. Four moles of a monatomic ideal gas in a
than the same volume has at zero gauge cylinder at is expanded at constant
pressure (which is equivalent to normal pressure equal to 1 atm until its volume
atmospheric pressure)? doubles. (a) What is the change in internal
81. A helium-filled toy balloon has a gauge pressure energy? (b) How much work was done by the gas
of 0.200 atm and a volume of 10.0 L. How much in the process? (c) How much heat was
greater is the internal energy of the helium in transferred to the gas?
the balloon than it would be at zero gauge 88. Helium gas is cooled from to by
pressure? expanding from 40 atm to 1 atm. If there is 1.4
82. Steam to drive an old-fashioned steam mol of helium, (a) What is the final volume of
locomotive is supplied at a constant gauge helium? (b) What is the change in internal
pressure of (about 250 psi) to energy?
a piston with a 0.200-m radius. (a) By 89. In an adiabatic process, oxygen gas in a
calculating , find the work done by the container is compressed along a path that can
steam when the piston moves 0.800 m. Note be described by the following pressure in atm as
that this is the net work output, since gauge a function of volume V, with :
pressure is used. (b) Now find the amount of . The initial and final
work by calculating the force exerted times the volumes during the process were 2 L and 1.5 L,
distance traveled. Is the answer the same as in respectively. Find the amount of work done on
part (a)? the gas.
83. A hand-driven tire pump has a piston with a 90. A cylinder containing three moles of a
2.50-cm diameter and a maximum stroke of monatomic ideal gas is heated at a constant
30.0 cm. (a) How much work do you do in one pressure of 2 atm. The temperature of the gas
stroke if the average gauge pressure is changes from 300 K to 350 K as a result of the
(about 35 psi)? (b) What expansion. Find work done (a) on the gas; and
average force do you exert on the piston, (b) by the gas.
neglecting friction and gravitational force?

Access for free at openstax.org.


3 • Chapter Review 141

91. A cylinder containing three moles of nitrogen 93. An insulated vessel contains 1.5 moles of argon
gas is heated at a constant pressure of 2 atm. at 2 atm. The gas initially occupies a volume of 5
The temperature of the gas changes from 300 K L. As a result of the adiabatic expansion the
to 350 K as a result of the expansion. Find work pressure of the gas is reduced to 1 atm. (a) Find
done (a) on the gas, and (b) by the gas by using the volume and temperature of the final state.
van der Waals equation of state instead of ideal (b) Find the temperature of the gas in the initial
gas law. state. (c) Find the work done by the gas in the
92. Two moles of a monatomic ideal gas such as process. (d) Find the change in the internal
helium is compressed adiabatically and energy of the gas in the process.
reversibly from a state (3 atm, 5 L) to a state
with a pressure of 4 atm. (a) Find the volume
and temperature of the final state. (b) Find the
temperature of the initial state. (c) Find work
done by the gas in the process. (d) Find the
change in internal energy in the process.
Assume and for the
diatomic ideal gas in the conditions given.

Challenge Problems
94. One mole of an ideal monatomic gas occupies a 97. The insulated cylinder shown below is closed at
volume of at a pressure of both ends and contains an insulating piston that is
(a) What is the temperature of free to move on frictionless bearings. The piston
the gas? (b) The gas undergoes a quasi-static divides the chamber into two compartments
adiabatic compression until its volume is containing gases A and B. Originally, each
decreased to What is the new compartment has a volume of and
gas temperature? (c) How much work is done on contains a monatomic ideal gas at a temperature of
the gas during the compression? (d) What is the and a pressure of 1.0 atm. (a) How many moles
change in the internal energy of the gas? of gas are in each compartment? (b) Heat Q is
95. One mole of an ideal gas is initially in a slowly added to A so that it expands and B is
chamber of volume and at a compressed until the pressure of both gases is 3.0
temperature of . (a) How much heat is atm. Use the fact that the compression of B is
absorbed by the gas when it slowly expands adiabatic to determine the final volume of both
isothermally to twice its initial volume? (b) gases. (c) What are their final temperatures? (d)
Suppose the gas is slowly transformed to the What is the value of Q?
same final state by first decreasing the pressure
at constant volume and then expanding it
isobarically. What is the heat transferred for this
case? (c) Calculate the heat transferred when
the gas is transformed quasi-statically to the
same final state by expanding it isobarically,
then decreasing its pressure at constant
volume.
96. A bullet of mass 10 g is traveling horizontally at
200 m/s when it strikes and embeds in a
pendulum bob of mass 2.0 kg. (a) How much
mechanical energy is dissipated in the
collision? (b) Assuming that for the bob plus
bullet is 3R, calculate the temperature increase
of the system due to the collision. Take the
molecular mass of the system to be 200 g/mol.
142 3 • Chapter Review

98. In a diesel engine, the fuel is ignited without a


spark plug. Instead, air in a cylinder is
compressed adiabatically to a temperature
above the ignition temperature of the fuel; at the
point of maximum compression, the fuel is
injected into the cylinder. Suppose that air at
is taken into the cylinder at a volume
and then compressed adiabatically and quasi-
statically to a temperature of and a
volume If what is the ratio
(Note: In an operating diesel engine, the
compression is not quasi-static.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 4
The Second Law of
Thermodynamics

Figure 4.1 A xenon ion engine from the Jet Propulsion Laboratory shows the faint blue glow of charged atoms
emitted from the engine. The ion propulsion engine is the first nonchemical propulsion to be used as the primary
means of propelling a spacecraft. (credit: modification of work by NASA/JPL)

Chapter Outline

4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes

4.2 Heat Engines

4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps

4.4 Statements of the Second Law of Thermodynamics

4.5 The Carnot Cycle

4.6 Entropy

4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale

INTRODUCTION According to the first law of thermodynamics, the only processes that can occur are those
that conserve energy. But this cannot be the only restriction imposed by nature, because many seemingly
possible thermodynamic processes that would conserve energy do not occur. For example, when two bodies
are in thermal contact, heat never flows from the colder body to the warmer one, even though this is not
144 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

forbidden by the first law. So some other thermodynamic principles must be controlling the behavior of
physical systems.

One such principle is the second law of thermodynamics, which limits the use of energy within a source.
Energy cannot arbitrarily pass from one object to another, just as we cannot transfer heat from a cold object to
a hot one without doing any work. We cannot unmix cream from coffee without a chemical process that
changes the physical characteristics of the system or its environment. We cannot use internal energy stored in
the air to propel a car, or use the energy of the ocean to run a ship, without disturbing something around that
object.

In the chapter covering the first law of thermodynamics, we started our discussion with a joke by C. P. Snow
stating that the first law means “you can’t win.” He paraphrased the second law as “you can’t break even,
except on a very cold day.” Unless you are at zero kelvin, you cannot convert 100% of thermal energy into work.
We start by discussing spontaneous processes and explain why some processes require work to occur even if
energy would have been conserved.

4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define reversible and irreversible processes
• State the second law of thermodynamics via an irreversible process

Consider an ideal gas that is held in half of a thermally insulated container by a wall in the middle of the
container. The other half of the container is under vacuum with no molecules inside. Now, if we remove the
wall in the middle quickly, the gas expands and fills up the entire container immediately, as shown in Figure
4.2.

Figure 4.2 A gas expanding from half of a container to the entire container (a) before and (b) after the wall in the middle is removed.

Because half of the container is under vacuum before the gas expands there, we do not expect any work to be
done by the system—that is, —because no force from the vacuum is exerted on the gas during the
expansion. If the container is thermally insulated from the rest of the environment, we do not expect any heat
transfer to the system either, so . Then the first law of thermodynamics leads to the change of the
internal energy of the system,

For an ideal gas, if the internal energy doesn’t change, then the temperature stays the same. Thus, the equation
of state of the ideal gas gives us the final pressure of the gas, where is the pressure of
the gas before the expansion. The volume is doubled and the pressure is halved, but nothing else seems to
have changed during the expansion.

All of this discussion is based on what we have learned so far and makes sense. Here is what puzzles us: Can all
the molecules go backward to the original half of the container in some future time? Our intuition tells us that
this is going to be very unlikely, even though nothing we have learned so far prevents such an event from

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.1 • Reversible and Irreversible Processes 145

happening, regardless of how small the probability is. What we are really asking is whether the expansion into
the vacuum half of the container is reversible.

A reversible process is a process in which the system and environment can be restored to exactly the same
initial states that they were in before the process occurred, if we go backward along the path of the process.
The necessary condition for a reversible process is therefore the quasi-static requirement. Note that it is quite
easy to restore a system to its original state; the hard part is to have its environment restored to its original
state at the same time. For example, in the example of an ideal gas expanding into vacuum to twice its original
volume, we can easily push it back with a piston and restore its temperature and pressure by removing some
heat from the gas. The problem is that we cannot do it without changing something in its surroundings, such
as dumping some heat there.

A reversible process is truly an ideal process that rarely happens. We can make certain processes close to
reversible and therefore use the consequences of the corresponding reversible processes as a starting point or
reference. In reality, almost all processes are irreversible, and some properties of the environment are altered
when the properties of the system are restored. The expansion of an ideal gas, as we have just outlined, is
irreversible because the process is not even quasi-static, that is, not in an equilibrium state at any moment of
the expansion.

From the microscopic point of view, a particle described by Newton’s second law can go backward if we flip the
direction of time. But this is not the case, in practical terms, in a macroscopic system with more than
particles or molecules, where numerous collisions between these molecules tend to erase any trace of memory
of the initial trajectory of each of the particles. For example, we can actually estimate the chance for all the
particles in the expanded gas to go back to the original half of the container, but the current age of the universe
is still not long enough for it to happen even once.

An irreversible process is what we encounter in reality almost all the time. The system and its environment
cannot be restored to their original states at the same time. Because this is what happens in nature, it is also
called a natural process. The sign of an irreversible process comes from the finite gradient between the states
occurring in the actual process. For example, when heat flows from one object to another, there is a finite
temperature difference (gradient) between the two objects. More importantly, at any given moment of the
process, the system most likely is not at equilibrium or in a well-defined state. This phenomenon is called
irreversibility.

Let us see another example of irreversibility in thermal processes. Consider two objects in thermal contact:
one at temperature and the other at temperature , as shown in Figure 4.3.

Figure 4.3 Spontaneous heat flow from an object at higher temperature to another at lower temperature

We know from common personal experience that heat flows from a hotter object to a colder one. For example,
when we hold a few pieces of ice in our hands, we feel cold because heat has left our hands into the ice. The
opposite is true when we hold one end of a metal rod while keeping the other end over a fire. Based on all of the
experiments that have been done on spontaneous heat transfer, the following statement summarizes the
governing principle:

Second Law of Thermodynamics (Clausius statement)


Heat never flows spontaneously from a colder object to a hotter object.
146 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

This statement turns out to be one of several different ways of stating the second law of thermodynamics. The
form of this statement is credited to German physicist Rudolf Clausius (1822−1888) and is referred to as the
Clausius statement of the second law of thermodynamics. The word “spontaneously” here means no other
effort has been made by a third party, or one that is neither the hotter nor colder object. We will introduce
some other major statements of the second law and show that they imply each other. In fact, all the different
statements of the second law of thermodynamics can be shown to be equivalent, and all lead to the
irreversibility of spontaneous heat flow between macroscopic objects of a very large number of molecules or
particles.

Both isothermal and adiabatic processes sketched on a pV graph (discussed in The First Law of
Thermodynamics) are reversible in principle because the system is always at an equilibrium state at any point
of the processes and can go forward or backward along the given curves. Other idealized processes can be
represented by pV curves; Table 4.1 summarizes the most common reversible processes.

Process Constant Quantity and Resulting Fact

Isobaric Constant pressure

Isochoric Constant volume

Isothermal Constant temperature

Adiabatic No heat transfer

Table 4.1 Summary of Simple Thermodynamic Processes

4.2 Heat Engines


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the function and components of a heat engine
• Explain the efficiency of an engine
• Calculate the efficiency of an engine for a given cycle of an ideal gas

A heat engine is a device used to extract heat from a source and then convert it into mechanical work that is
used for all sorts of applications. For example, a steam engine on an old-style train can produce the work
needed for driving the train. Several questions emerge from the construction and application of heat engines.
For example, what is the maximum percentage of the heat extracted that can be used to do work? This turns
out to be a question that can only be answered through the second law of thermodynamics.

The second law of thermodynamics can be formally stated in several ways. One statement presented so far is
about the direction of spontaneous heat flow, known as the Clausius statement. A couple of other statements
are based on heat engines. Whenever we consider heat engines and associated devices such as refrigerators
and heat pumps, we do not use the normal sign convention for heat and work. For convenience, we assume
that the symbols and W represent only the amounts of heat transferred and work delivered, regardless
what the givers or receivers are. Whether heat is entering or leaving a system and work is done to or by a
system are indicated by proper signs in front of the symbols and by the directions of arrows in diagrams.

It turns out that we need more than one heat source/sink to construct a heat engine. We will come back to this
point later in the chapter, when we compare different statements of the second law of thermodynamics. For the
moment, we assume that a heat engine is constructed between a heat source (high-temperature reservoir or
hot reservoir) and a heat sink (low-temperature reservoir or cold reservoir), represented schematically in
Figure 4.4. The engine absorbs heat from a heat source (hot reservoir) of Kelvin temperature uses
some of that energy to produce useful work W, and then discards the remaining energy as heat into a heat
sink (cold reservoir) of Kelvin temperature Power plants and internal combustion engines are examples of

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.2 • Heat Engines 147

heat engines. Power plants use steam produced at high temperature to drive electric generators, while
exhausting heat to the atmosphere or a nearby body of water in the role of the heat sink. In an internal
combustion engine, a hot gas-air mixture is used to push a piston, and heat is exhausted to the nearby
atmosphere in a similar manner.

Figure 4.4 A schematic representation of a heat engine. Energy flows from the hot reservoir to the cold reservoir while doing work.

Actual heat engines have many different designs. Examples include internal combustion engines, such as
those used in most cars today, and external combustion engines, such as the steam engines used in old steam-
engine trains. Figure 4.5 shows a photo of a nuclear power plant in operation. The atmosphere around the
reactors acts as the cold reservoir, and the heat generated from the nuclear reaction provides the heat from the
hot reservoir.

Figure 4.5 The heat exhausted from a nuclear power plant goes to the cooling towers, where it is released into the atmosphere.

Heat engines operate by carrying a working substance through a cycle. In a steam power plant, the working
substance is water, which starts as a liquid, becomes vaporized, is then used to drive a turbine, and is finally
condensed back into the liquid state. As is the case for all working substances in cyclic processes, once the
water returns to its initial state, it repeats the same sequence.

For now, we assume that the cycles of heat engines are reversible, so there is no energy loss to friction or other
irreversible effects. Suppose that the engine of Figure 4.4 goes through one complete cycle and that
and W represent the heats exchanged and the work done for that cycle. Since the initial and final states of the
system are the same, for the cycle. We therefore have from the first law of thermodynamics,

so that

4.1

The most important measure of a heat engine is its efficiency (e), which is simply “what we get out” divided by
“what we put in” during each cycle, as defined by

With a heat engine working between two heat reservoirs, we get out W and put in so the efficiency of the
engine is
148 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

4.2

Here, we used Equation 4.1, in the final step of this expression for the efficiency.

EXAMPLE 4.1

A Lawn Mower
A lawn mower is rated to have an efficiency of and an average power of 3.00 kW. What are (a) the average
work and (b) the minimum heat discharge into the air by the lawn mower in one minute of use?

Strategy
From the average power—that is, the rate of work production—we can figure out the work done in the given
elapsed time. Then, from the efficiency given, we can figure out the minimum heat discharge
with

Solution

a. The average work delivered by the lawn mower is

b. The minimum heat discharged into the air is given by

which leads to

Significance
As the efficiency rises, the minimum heat discharged falls. This helps our environment and atmosphere by not
having as much waste heat expelled.

4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe a refrigerator and a heat pump and list their differences
• Calculate the performance coefficients of simple refrigerators and heat pumps

The cycles we used to describe the engine in the preceding section are all reversible, so each sequence of steps
can just as easily be performed in the opposite direction. In this case, the engine is known as a refrigerator or a
heat pump, depending on what is the focus: the heat removed from the cold reservoir or the heat dumped to
the hot reservoir. Either a refrigerator or a heat pump is an engine running in reverse. For a refrigerator, the
focus is on removing heat from a specific area. For a heat pump, the focus is on dumping heat to a specific
area.

We first consider a refrigerator (Figure 4.6). The purpose of this engine is to remove heat from the cold
reservoir, which is the space inside the refrigerator for an actual household refrigerator or the space inside a
building for an air-conditioning unit.

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.3 • Refrigerators and Heat Pumps 149

Figure 4.6 A schematic representation of a refrigerator (or a heat pump). The arrow next to work (W) indicates work being put into the
system.

A refrigerator (or heat pump) absorbs heat from the cold reservoir at Kelvin temperature and discards
heat to the hot reservoir at Kelvin temperature while work W is done on the engine’s working
substance, as shown by the arrow pointing toward the system in the figure. A household refrigerator removes
heat from the food within it while exhausting heat to the surrounding air. The required work, for which we pay
in our electricity bill, is performed by the motor that moves a coolant through the coils. A schematic sketch of a
household refrigerator is given in Figure 4.7.

Figure 4.7 A schematic diagram of a household refrigerator. A coolant with a boiling temperature below the freezing point of water is sent
through the cycle (clockwise in this diagram). The coolant extracts heat from the refrigerator at the evaporator, causing coolant to vaporize.
It is then compressed and sent through the condenser, where it exhausts heat to the outside.

The effectiveness or coefficient of performance of a refrigerator is measured by the heat removed from
150 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

the cold reservoir divided by the work done by the working substance cycle by cycle:

4.3

Note that we have used the condition of energy conservation, in the final step of this
expression.

The effectiveness or coefficient of performance of a heat pump is measured by the heat dumped to the hot
reservoir divided by the work done to the engine on the working substance cycle by cycle:

4.4

Once again, we use the energy conservation condition to obtain the final step of this expression.

4.4 Statements of the Second Law of Thermodynamics


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Contrast the second law of thermodynamics statements according to Kelvin and Clausius formulations
• Interpret the second of thermodynamics via irreversibility

Earlier in this chapter, we introduced the Clausius statement of the second law of thermodynamics, which is
based on the irreversibility of spontaneous heat flow. As we remarked then, the second law of thermodynamics
can be stated in several different ways, and all of them can be shown to imply the others. In terms of heat
engines, the second law of thermodynamics may be stated as follows:

Second Law of Thermodynamics (Kelvin statement)


It is impossible to convert the heat from a single source into work without any other effect.

This is known as the Kelvin statement of the second law of thermodynamics. This statement describes an
unattainable “perfect engine,” as represented schematically in Figure 4.8(a). Note that “without any other
effect” is a very strong restriction. For example, an engine can absorb heat and turn it all into work, but not if it
completes a cycle. Without completing a cycle, the substance in the engine is not in its original state and
therefore an “other effect” has occurred. Another example is a chamber of gas that can absorb heat from a heat
reservoir and do work isothermally against a piston as it expands. However, if the gas were returned to its
initial state (that is, made to complete a cycle), it would have to be compressed and heat would have to be
extracted from it.

The Kelvin statement is a manifestation of a well-known engineering problem. Despite advancing technology,
we are not able to build a heat engine that is efficient. The first law does not exclude the possibility of
constructing a perfect engine, but the second law forbids it.

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.4 • Statements of the Second Law of Thermodynamics 151

Figure 4.8 (a) A “perfect heat engine” converts all input heat into work. (b) A “perfect refrigerator” transports heat from a cold reservoir
to a hot reservoir without work input. Neither of these devices is achievable in reality.

We can show that the Kelvin statement is equivalent to the Clausius statement if we view the two objects in the
Clausius statement as a cold reservoir and a hot reservoir. Thus, the Clausius statement becomes: It is
impossible to construct a refrigerator that transfers heat from a cold reservoir to a hot reservoir without aid
from an external source. The Clausius statement is related to the everyday observation that heat never flows
spontaneously from a cold object to a hot object. Heat transfer in the direction of increasing temperature
always requires some energy input. A “perfect refrigerator,” shown in Figure 4.8(b), which works without
such external aid, is impossible to construct.

To prove the equivalence of the Kelvin and Clausius statements, we show that if one statement is false, it
necessarily follows that the other statement is also false. Let us first assume that the Clausius statement is
false, so that the perfect refrigerator of Figure 4.8(b) does exist. The refrigerator removes heat Q from a cold
reservoir at a temperature and transfers all of it to a hot reservoir at a temperature Now consider a real
heat engine working in the same temperature range. It extracts heat from the hot reservoir, does work
W, and discards heat Q to the cold reservoir. From the first law, these quantities are related by
.

Suppose these two devices are combined as shown in Figure 4.9. The net heat removed from the hot reservoir
is , no net heat transfer occurs to or from the cold reservoir, and work W is done on some external body.
Since , the combination of a perfect refrigerator and a real heat engine is itself a perfect heat engine,
thereby contradicting the Kelvin statement. Thus, if the Clausius statement is false, the Kelvin statement must
also be false.

Figure 4.9 Combining a perfect refrigerator and a real heat engine yields a perfect heat engine because

Using the second law of thermodynamics, we now prove two important properties of heat engines operating
between two heat reservoirs. The first property is that any reversible engine operating between two reservoirs
has a greater efficiency than any irreversible engine operating between the same two reservoirs.

The second property to be demonstrated is that all reversible engines operating between the same two
152 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

reservoirs have the same efficiency. To show this, we start with the two engines D and E of Figure 4.10(a),
which are operating between two common heat reservoirs at temperatures First, we assume that D
is a reversible engine and that E is a hypothetical irreversible engine that has a higher efficiency than D. If both
engines perform the same amount of work per cycle, it follows from Equation 4.2 that . It then
follows from the first law that

Figure 4.10 (a) Two uncoupled engines D and E working between the same reservoirs. (b) The coupled engines, with D working in reverse.

Suppose the cycle of D is reversed so that it operates as a refrigerator, and the two engines are coupled such
that the work output of E is used to drive D, as shown in Figure 4.10(b). Since and the net
result of each cycle is equivalent to a spontaneous transfer of heat from the cold reservoir to the hot reservoir,
a process the second law does not allow. The original assumption must therefore be wrong, and it is impossible
to construct an irreversible engine such that E is more efficient than the reversible engine D.

Now it is quite easy to demonstrate that the efficiencies of all reversible engines operating between the same
reservoirs are equal. Suppose that D and E are both reversible engines. If they are coupled as shown in Figure
4.10(b), the efficiency of E cannot be greater than the efficiency of D, or the second law would be violated. If
both engines are then reversed, the same reasoning implies that the efficiency of D cannot be greater than the
efficiency of E. Combining these results leads to the conclusion that all reversible engines working between the
same two reservoirs have the same efficiency.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.1


What is the efficiency of a perfect heat engine? What is the coefficient of performance of a perfect refrigerator?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.2


Show that for the hypothetical engine of Figure 4.10(b).

4.5 The Carnot Cycle


Learning Objectives
• Describe the Carnot cycle with the roles of all four processes involved
• Outline the Carnot principle and its implications
• Demonstrate the equivalence of the Carnot principle and the second law of thermodynamics

In the early 1820s, Sadi Carnot (1786−1832), a French engineer, became interested in improving the
efficiencies of practical heat engines. In 1824, his studies led him to propose a hypothetical working cycle with
the highest possible efficiency between the same two reservoirs, known now as the Carnot cycle. An engine
operating in this cycle is called a Carnot engine. The Carnot cycle is of special importance for a variety of
reasons. At a practical level, this cycle represents a reversible model for the steam power plant and the
refrigerator or heat pump. Yet, it is also very important theoretically, for it plays a major role in the

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.5 • The Carnot Cycle 153

development of another important statement of the second law of thermodynamics. Finally, because only two
reservoirs are involved in its operation, it can be used along with the second law of thermodynamics to define
an absolute temperature scale that is truly independent of any substance used for temperature measurement.

With an ideal gas as the working substance, the steps of the Carnot cycle, as represented by Figure 4.11, are as
follows.

1. Isothermal expansion. The gas is placed in thermal contact with a heat reservoir at a temperature The
gas absorbs heat from the heat reservoir and is allowed to expand isothermally, doing work
Because the internal energy of an ideal gas is a function of the temperature only, the change of the
internal energy is zero, that is, during this isothermal expansion. With the first law of
thermodynamics, we find that the heat absorbed by the gas is

Figure 4.11 The four processes of the Carnot cycle. The working substance is assumed to be an ideal gas whose thermodynamic
path MNOP is represented in Figure 4.12.

Figure 4.12 The total work done by the gas in the Carnot cycle is shown and given by the area enclosed by the loop MNOPM.

2. Adiabatic expansion. The gas is thermally isolated and allowed to expand further, doing work Because
this expansion is adiabatic, the temperature of the gas falls—in this case, from From
and the equation of state for an ideal gas, , we have
154 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

so that

3. Isothermal compression. The gas is placed in thermal contact with a cold reservoir at temperature and
compressed isothermally. During this process, work is done on the gas and it gives up heat to the
cold reservoir. The reasoning used in step 1 now yields

where is the heat dumped to the cold reservoir by the gas.


4. Adiabatic compression. The gas is thermally isolated and returned to its initial state by compression. In
this process, work is done on the gas. Because the compression is adiabatic, the temperature of the gas
rises—from in this particular case. The reasoning of step 2 now gives

The total work done by the gas in the Carnot cycle is given by

This work is equal to the area enclosed by the loop shown in the pV diagram of Figure 4.12. Because the initial
and final states of the system are the same, the change of the internal energy of the gas in the cycle must be
zero, that is, . The first law of thermodynamics then gives

and

To find the efficiency of this engine, we first divide

When the adiabatic constant from step 2 is divided by that of step 4, we find

Substituting this into the equation for we obtain

Finally, with Equation 4.2, we find that the efficiency of this ideal gas Carnot engine is given by

4.5

An engine does not necessarily have to follow a Carnot engine cycle. All engines, however, have the same net
effect, namely the absorption of heat from a hot reservoir, the production of work, and the discarding of heat to
a cold reservoir. This leads us to ask: Do all reversible cycles operating between the same two reservoirs have
the same efficiency? The answer to this question comes from the second law of thermodynamics discussed
earlier: All reversible engine cycles produce exactly the same efficiency. Also, as you might expect, all real
engines operating between two reservoirs are less efficient than reversible engines operating between the
same two reservoirs. This too is a consequence of the second law of thermodynamics shown earlier.

The cycle of an ideal gas Carnot refrigerator is represented by the pV diagram of Figure 4.13. It is a Carnot
engine operating in reverse. The refrigerator extracts heat from a cold-temperature reservoir at when
the ideal gas expands isothermally. The gas is then compressed adiabatically until its temperature reaches
after which an isothermal compression of the gas results in heat being discarded to a high-temperature
reservoir at Finally, the cycle is completed by an adiabatic expansion of the gas, causing its temperature to
drop to

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.5 • The Carnot Cycle 155

Figure 4.13 The work done on the gas in one cycle of the Carnot refrigerator is shown and given by the area enclosed by the loop MPONM.

The work done on the ideal gas is equal to the area enclosed by the path of the pV diagram. From the first law,
this work is given by

An analysis just like the analysis done for the Carnot engine gives

When combined with Equation 4.3, this yields

4.6

for the coefficient of performance of the ideal-gas Carnot refrigerator. Similarly, we can work out the coefficient
of performance for a Carnot heat pump as

4.7

We have just found equations representing the efficiency of a Carnot engine and the coefficient of performance
of a Carnot refrigerator or a Carnot heat pump, assuming an ideal gas for the working substance in both
devices. However, these equations are more general than their derivations imply. We will soon show that they
are both valid no matter what the working substance is.

Carnot summarized his study of the Carnot engine and Carnot cycle into what is now known as Carnot’s
principle:

Carnot’s Principle
No engine working between two reservoirs at constant temperatures can have a greater efficiency than a
reversible engine.

This principle can be viewed as another statement of the second law of thermodynamics and can be shown to
be equivalent to the Kelvin statement and the Clausius statement.
156 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

EXAMPLE 4.2

The Carnot Engine


A Carnot engine has an efficiency of 0.60 and the temperature of its cold reservoir is 300 K. (a) What is the
temperature of the hot reservoir? (b) If the engine does 300 J of work per cycle, how much heat is removed
from the high-temperature reservoir per cycle? (c) How much heat is exhausted to the low-temperature
reservoir per cycle?

Strategy
From the temperature dependence of the thermal efficiency of the Carnot engine, we can find the temperature
of the hot reservoir. Then, from the definition of the efficiency, we can find the heat removed when the work
done by the engine is given. Finally, energy conservation will lead to how much heat must be dumped to the
cold reservoir.

Solution

a. From we have

so that the temperature of the hot reservoir is

b. By definition, the efficiency of the engine is , so that the heat removed from the high-temperature
reservoir per cycle is

c. From the first law, the heat exhausted to the low-temperature reservoir per cycle by the engine is

Significance
A Carnot engine has the maximum possible efficiency of converting heat into work between two reservoirs, but
this does not necessarily mean it is efficient. As the difference in temperatures of the hot and cold
reservoir increases, the efficiency of a Carnot engine increases.

EXAMPLE 4.3

A Carnot Heat Pump


Imagine a Carnot heat pump operates between an outside temperature of and an inside temperature of
. What is the work needed if the heat delivered to the inside of the house is 30.0 kJ?

Strategy
Because the heat pump is assumed to be a Carnot pump, its performance coefficient is given by
Thus, we can find the work W from the heat delivered

Solution
The work needed is obtained from

Significance
We note that this work depends not only on the heat delivered to the house but also on the temperatures
outside and inside. The dependence on the temperature outside makes them impractical to use in areas where

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.6 • Entropy 157

the temperature is much colder outside than room temperature.

In terms of energy costs, the heat pump is a very economical means for heating buildings (Figure 4.14).
Contrast this method with turning electrical energy directly into heat with resistive heating elements. In this
case, one unit of electrical energy furnishes at most only one unit of heat. Unfortunately, heat pumps have
problems that do limit their usefulness. They are quite expensive to purchase compared to resistive heating
elements, and, as the performance coefficient for a Carnot heat pump shows, they become less effective as the
outside temperature decreases. In fact, below about , the heat they furnish is less than the energy used
to operate them.

Figure 4.14 A photograph of a heat pump (large box) located outside a house. This heat pump is located in a warm climate area, like the
southern United States, since it would be far too inefficient located in the northern half of the United States. (credit: modification of work by
Peter Stevens)

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.3


A Carnot engine operates between reservoirs at and . (a) What is the efficiency of the engine? (b) If
the engine does 5.0 J of work per cycle, how much heat per cycle does it absorb from the high-temperature
reservoir? (c) How much heat per cycle does it exhaust to the cold-temperature reservoir? (d) What
temperatures at the cold reservoir would give the minimum and maximum efficiency?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.4


A Carnot refrigerator operates between two heat reservoirs whose temperatures are and . (a) What is
the coefficient of performance of the refrigerator? (b) If 200 J of work are done on the working substance per
cycle, how much heat per cycle is extracted from the cold reservoir? (c) How much heat per cycle is discarded
to the hot reservoir?

4.6 Entropy
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section you will be able to:
• Describe the meaning of entropy
• Calculate the change of entropy for some simple processes

The second law of thermodynamics is best expressed in terms of a change in the thermodynamic variable
known as entropy, which is represented by the symbol S. Entropy, like internal energy, is a state function. This
means that when a system makes a transition from one state into another, the change in entropy is
independent of path and depends only on the thermodynamic variables of the two states.
158 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

We first consider for a system undergoing a reversible process at a constant temperature. In this case, the
change in entropy of the system is given by

4.8

where Q is the heat exchanged by the system kept at a temperature T (in kelvin). If the system absorbs
heat—that is, with —the entropy of the system increases. As an example, suppose a gas is kept at a
constant temperature of 300 K while it absorbs 10 J of heat in a reversible process. Then from Equation 4.8, the
entropy change of the gas is

Similarly, if the gas loses 5.0 J of heat; that is, , at temperature , we have the entropy
change of the system given by

EXAMPLE 4.4

Entropy Change of Melting Ice


Heat is slowly added to a 50-g chunk of ice at until it completely melts into water at the same temperature.
What is the entropy change of the ice?

Strategy
Because the process is slow, we can approximate it as a reversible process. The temperature is a constant, and
we can therefore use Equation 4.8 in the calculation.

Solution
The ice is melted by the addition of heat:

In this reversible process, the temperature of the ice-water mixture is fixed at or 273 K. Now from
, the entropy change of the ice is

when it melts to water at .

Significance
During a phase change, the temperature is constant, allowing us to use Equation 4.8 to solve this problem. The
same equation could also be used if we changed from a liquid to a gas phase, since the temperature does not
change during that process either.

The change in entropy of a system for an arbitrary, reversible transition for which the temperature is not
necessarily constant is defined by modifying . Imagine a system making a transition from state A to
B in small, discrete steps. The temperatures associated with these states are and respectively. During
each step of the transition, the system exchanges heat reversibly at a temperature This can be
accomplished experimentally by placing the system in thermal contact with a large number of heat reservoirs
of varying temperatures , as illustrated in Figure 4.15. The change in entropy for each step is
The net change in entropy of the system for the transition is

4.9

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.6 • Entropy 159

We now take the limit as , and the number of steps approaches infinity. Then, replacing the
summation by an integral, we obtain

4.10

where the integral is taken between the initial state A and the final state B. This equation is valid only if the
transition from A to B is reversible.

Figure 4.15 The gas expands at constant pressure as its temperature is increased in small steps through the use of a series of heat
reservoirs.

As an example, let us determine the net entropy change of a reversible engine while it undergoes a single
Carnot cycle. In the adiabatic steps 2 and 4 of the cycle shown in Figure 4.11, no heat exchange takes place, so
In step 1, the engine absorbs heat at a temperature so its entropy change

is Similarly, in step 3, The net entropy change of the engine in one cycle of
operation is then

However, we know that for a Carnot engine,

so

There is no net change in the entropy of the Carnot engine over a complete cycle. Although this result was
obtained for a particular case, its validity can be shown to be far more general: There is no net change in the
entropy of a system undergoing any complete reversible cyclic process. Mathematically, we write this
statement as

4.11

where represents the integral over a closed reversible path.

We can use Equation 4.11 to show that the entropy change of a system undergoing a reversible process
between two given states is path independent. An arbitrary, closed path for a reversible cycle that passes
through the states A and B is shown in Figure 4.16. From Equation 4.11, for this closed path. We

may split this integral into two segments, one along I, which leads from A to B, the other along II, which leads
160 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

from B to A. Then

Since the process is reversible,

Figure 4.16 The closed loop passing through states A and B represents a reversible cycle.

Hence, the entropy change in going from A to B is the same for paths I and II. Since paths I and II are arbitrary,
reversible paths, the entropy change in a transition between two equilibrium states is the same for all the
reversible processes joining these states. Entropy, like internal energy, is therefore a state function.

What happens if the process is irreversible? When the process is irreversible, we expect the entropy of a closed
system, or the system and its environment (the universe), to increase. Therefore we can rewrite this
expression as

4.12

where S is the total entropy of the closed system or the entire universe, and the equal sign is for a reversible
process. The fact is the entropy statement of the second law of thermodynamics:

Second Law of Thermodynamics (Entropy statement)


The entropy of a closed system and the entire universe never decreases.

We can show that this statement is consistent with the Kelvin statement, the Clausius statement, and the
Carnot principle.

EXAMPLE 4.5

Entropy Change of a System during an Isobaric Process


Determine the entropy change of an object of mass m and specific heat c that is cooled rapidly (and
irreversibly) at constant pressure from to

Strategy
The process is clearly stated as an irreversible process; therefore, we cannot simply calculate the entropy
change from the actual process. However, because entropy of a system is a function of state, we can imagine a

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.6 • Entropy 161

reversible process that starts from the same initial state and ends at the given final state. Then, the entropy

change of the system is given by Equation 4.10,

Solution
To replace this rapid cooling with a process that proceeds reversibly, we imagine that the hot object is put into
thermal contact with successively cooler heat reservoirs whose temperatures range from to Throughout
the substitute transition, the object loses infinitesimal amounts of heat dQ, so we have

From the definition of heat capacity, an infinitesimal exchange dQ for the object is related to its temperature
change dT by

Substituting this dQ into the expression for , we obtain the entropy change of the object as it is cooled at
constant pressure from

Note that here because In other words, the object has lost some entropy. But if we count
whatever is used to remove the heat from the object, we would still end up with because the
process is irreversible.

Significance
If the temperature changes during the heat flow, you must keep it inside the integral to solve for the change in
entropy. If, however, the temperature is constant, you can simply calculate the entropy change as the heat flow
divided by the temperature.

EXAMPLE 4.6

Stirling Engine
The steps of a reversible Stirling engine are as follows. For this problem, we will use 0.0010 mol of a
monatomic gas that starts at a temperature of and a volume of , which will be called point A.
Then it goes through the following steps:

1. Step AB: isothermal expansion at from to


2. Step BC: isochoric cooling to
3. Step CD: isothermal compression at from to
4. Step DA: isochoric heating back to and

(a) Draw the pV diagram for the Stirling engine with proper labels.

(b) Fill in the following table.

Step W (J) Q (J) (J/K)

Step AB

Step BC
162 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

Step W (J) Q (J) (J/K)

Step CD

Step DA

Complete cycle

(c) How does the efficiency of the Stirling engine compare to the Carnot engine working within the same two
heat reservoirs?

Strategy
Using the ideal gas law, calculate the pressure at each point so that they can be labeled on the pV diagram.
Isothermal work is calculated using and an isochoric process has no work done. The heat

flow is calculated from the first law of thermodynamics, where for


monatomic gasses. Isothermal steps have a change in entropy of Q/T, whereas isochoric steps have
The efficiency of a heat engine is calculated by using

Solution

a. The graph is shown below.

b. The completed table is shown below.

Step W (J) Q (J) (J/K)

Step AB Isotherm 2.3 2.3 0.0057

Step BC Isochoric 0 –1.2 0.0035

Step CD Isotherm –1.8 –1.8 –0.0059

Step DA Isochoric 0 1.2 –0.0035

Complete cycle 0.5 0.5 ~0

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.7 • Entropy on a Microscopic Scale 163

c. The efficiency of the Stirling heat engine is

If this were a Carnot engine operating between the same heat reservoirs, its efficiency would be

Therefore, the Carnot engine would have a greater efficiency than the Stirling engine.

Significance
In the early days of steam engines, accidents would occur due to the high pressure of the steam in the boiler.
Robert Stirling developed an engine in 1816 that did not use steam and therefore was safer. The Stirling engine
was commonly used in the nineteenth century, but developments in steam and internal combustion engines
have made it difficult to broaden the use of the Stirling engine.

The Stirling engine uses compressed air as the working substance, which passes back and forth between two
chambers with a porous plug, called the regenerator, which is made of material that does not conduct heat as
well. In two of the steps, pistons in the two chambers move in phase.

4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Interpret the meaning of entropy at a microscopic scale
• Calculate a change in entropy for an irreversible process of a system and contrast with the change in
entropy of the universe
• Explain the third law of thermodynamics

We have seen how entropy is related to heat exchange at a particular temperature. In this section, we consider
entropy from a statistical viewpoint. Although the details of the argument are beyond the scope of this
textbook, it turns out that entropy can be related to how disordered or randomized a system is—the more it is
disordered, the higher is its entropy. For example, a new deck of cards is very ordered, as the cards are
arranged numerically by suit. In shuffling this new deck, we randomize the arrangement of the cards and
therefore increase its entropy (Figure 4.17). Thus, by picking one card off the top of the deck, there would be no
indication of what the next selected card will be.

Figure 4.17 The entropy of a new deck of cards goes up after the dealer shuffles them. (credit: “Rommel SK”/YouTube)

The second law of thermodynamics requires that the entropy of the universe increase in any irreversible
process. Thus, in terms of order, the second law may be stated as follows:

In any irreversible process, the universe becomes more disordered. For example, the irreversible free
expansion of an ideal gas, shown in Figure 4.2, results in a larger volume for the gas molecules to occupy. A
larger volume means more possible arrangements for the same number of atoms, so disorder is also
increased. As a result, the entropy of the gas has gone up. The gas in this case is a closed system, and the
164 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

process is irreversible. Changes in phase also illustrate the connection between entropy and disorder.

EXAMPLE 4.7

Entropy Change of the Universe


Suppose we place 50 g of ice at in contact with a heat reservoir at . Heat spontaneously flows from
the reservoir to the ice, which melts and eventually reaches a temperature of . Find the change in entropy
of (a) the ice and (b) the universe.

Strategy
Because the entropy of a system is a function of its state, we can imagine two reversible processes for the ice:
(1) ice is melted at and (2) melted ice (water) is warmed up from to under constant
pressure. Then, we add the change in entropy of the reservoir when we calculate the change in entropy of the
universe.

Solution

a. From Equation 4.10, the increase in entropy of the ice is

b. During this transition, the reservoir gives the ice an amount of heat equal to

This leads to a change (decrease) in entropy of the reservoir:

The increase in entropy of the universe is therefore

Significance
The entropy of the universe therefore is greater than zero since the ice gains more entropy than the reservoir
loses. If we considered only the phase change of the ice into water and not the temperature increase, the
entropy change of the ice and reservoir would be the same, resulting in the universe gaining no entropy.

This process also results in a more disordered universe. The ice changes from a solid with molecules located at
specific sites to a liquid whose molecules are much freer to move. The molecular arrangement has therefore
become more randomized. Although the change in average kinetic energy of the molecules of the heat
reservoir is negligible, there is nevertheless a significant decrease in the entropy of the reservoir because it
has many more molecules than the melted ice cube. However, the reservoir’s decrease in entropy is still not as
large as the increase in entropy of the ice. The increased disorder of the ice more than compensates for the
increased order of the reservoir, and the entropy of the universe increases by 4.6 J/K.

You might suspect that the growth of different forms of life might be a net ordering process and therefore a
violation of the second law. After all, a single cell gathers molecules and eventually becomes a highly
structured organism, such as a human being. However, this ordering process is more than compensated for by
the disordering of the rest of the universe. The net result is an increase in entropy and an increase in the

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.7 • Entropy on a Microscopic Scale 165

disorder of the universe.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.5


In Example 4.7, the spontaneous flow of heat from a hot object to a cold object results in a net increase in
entropy of the universe. Discuss how this result can be related to an increase in disorder of the system.

The second law of thermodynamics makes clear that the entropy of the universe never decreases during any
thermodynamic process. For any other thermodynamic system, when the process is reversible, the change of
the entropy is given by . But what happens if the temperature goes to zero, ? It turns out this
is not a question that can be answered by the second law.

A fundamental issue still remains: Is it possible to cool a system all the way down to zero kelvin? We
understand that the system must be at its lowest energy state because lowering temperature reduces the
kinetic energy of the constituents in the system. What happens to the entropy of a system at the absolute zero
temperature? It turns out the absolute zero temperature is not reachable—at least, not though a finite number
of cooling steps. This is a statement of the third law of thermodynamics, whose proof requires quantum
mechanics that we do not present here. In actual experiments, physicists have continuously pushed that limit
downward, with the lowest temperature achieved at about in a low-temperature lab at the
Helsinki University of Technology in 2008.

Like the second law of thermodynamics, the third law of thermodynamics can be stated in different ways. One
of the common statements of the third law of thermodynamics is: The absolute zero temperature cannot be
reached through any finite number of cooling steps.

In other words, the temperature of any given physical system must be finite, that is, . This produces a
very interesting question in physics: Do we know how a system would behave if it were at the absolute zero
temperature?

The reason a system is unable to reach 0 K is fundamental and requires quantum mechanics to fully
understand its origin. But we can certainly ask what happens to the entropy of a system when we try to cool it
down to 0 K. Because the amount of heat that can be removed from the system becomes vanishingly small, we
expect that the change in entropy of the system along an isotherm approaches zero, that is,

4.13

This can be viewed as another statement of the third law, with all the isotherms becoming isentropic, or into a
reversible ideal adiabat. We can put this expression in words: A system becomes perfectly ordered when its
temperature approaches absolute zero and its entropy approaches its absolute minimum.

The third law of thermodynamics puts another limit on what can be done when we look for energy resources. If
there could be a reservoir at the absolute zero temperature, we could have engines with efficiency of ,
which would, of course, violate the second law of thermodynamics.

EXAMPLE 4.8

Entropy Change of an Ideal Gas in Free Expansion


An ideal gas occupies a partitioned volume inside a box whose walls are thermally insulating, as shown in
Figure 4.18(a). When the partition is removed, the gas expands and fills the entire volume of the box, as
shown in part (b). What is the entropy change of the universe (the system plus its environment)?
166 4 • The Second Law of Thermodynamics

Figure 4.18 The adiabatic free expansion of an ideal gas from volume to volume .

Strategy
The adiabatic free expansion of an ideal gas is an irreversible process. There is no change in the internal
energy (and hence temperature) of the gas in such an expansion because no work or heat transfer has
happened. Thus, a convenient reversible path connecting the same two equilibrium states is a slow, isothermal
expansion from to . In this process, the gas could be expanding against a piston while in thermal contact
with a heat reservoir, as in step 1 of the Carnot cycle.

Solution
Since the temperature is constant, the entropy change is given by where

because Now, with the help of the ideal gas law, we have

so the change in entropy of the gas is

Because , is positive, and the entropy of the gas has gone up during the free expansion.

Significance
What about the environment? The walls of the container are thermally insulating, so no heat exchange takes
place between the gas and its surroundings. The entropy of the environment is therefore constant during the
expansion. The net entropy change of the universe is then simply the entropy change of the gas. Since this is
positive, the entropy of the universe increases in the free expansion of the gas.

EXAMPLE 4.9

Entropy Change during Heat Transfer


Heat flows from a steel object of mass 4.00 kg whose temperature is 400 K to an identical object at 300 K.
Assuming that the objects are thermally isolated from the environment, what is the net entropy change of the
universe after thermal equilibrium has been reached?

Strategy
Since the objects are identical, their common temperature at equilibrium is 350 K. To calculate the entropy
changes associated with their transitions, we substitute the irreversible process of the heat transfer by two
isobaric, reversible processes, one for each of the two objects. The entropy change for each object is then given

Access for free at openstax.org.


4.7 • Entropy on a Microscopic Scale 167

by

Solution
Using , the specific heat of steel, we have for the hotter object

Similarly, the entropy change of the cooler object is

The net entropy change of the two objects during the heat transfer is then

Significance
The objects are thermally isolated from the environment, so its entropy must remain constant. Thus, the
entropy of the universe also increases by 37 J/K.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.6


A quantity of heat Q is absorbed from a reservoir at a temperature by a cooler reservoir at a temperature
What is the entropy change of the hot reservoir, the cold reservoir, and the universe?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 4.7


A 50-g copper piece at a temperature of is placed into a large insulated vat of water at . (a) What is
the entropy change of the copper piece when it reaches thermal equilibrium with the water? (b) What is the
entropy change of the water? (c) What is the entropy change of the universe?

INTERACTIVE
View this site (https://openstax.org/l/21reversereact) to learn about entropy and microstates. Start with a large
barrier in the middle and 1000 molecules in only the left chamber. What is the total entropy of the system?
Now remove the barrier and let the molecules travel from the left to the right hand side? What is the total
entropy of the system now? Lastly, add heat and note what happens to the temperature. Did this increase
entropy of the system?
168 4 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
Carnot cycle cycle that consists of two isotherms at heat engine device that converts heat into work
the temperatures of two reservoirs and two heat pump device that delivers heat to a hot
adiabatic processes connecting the isotherms reservoir
Carnot engine Carnot heat engine, refrigerator, or hot reservoir source of heat used by a heat engine
heat pump that operates on a Carnot cycle irreversibility phenomenon associated with a
Carnot principle principle governing the efficiency natural process
or performance of a heat device operating on a irreversible process process in which neither the
Carnot cycle: any reversible heat device working system nor its environment can be restored to
between two reservoirs must have the same their original states at the same time
efficiency or performance coefficient, greater isentropic reversible adiabatic process where the
than that of an irreversible heat device operating process is frictionless and no heat is transferred
between the same two reservoirs Kelvin statement of the second law of
Clausius statement of the second law of thermodynamics it is impossible to convert the
thermodynamics heat never flows heat from a single source into work without any
spontaneously from a colder object to a hotter other effect
object perfect engine engine that can convert heat into
coefficient of performance measure of work with efficiency
effectiveness of a refrigerator or heat pump perfect refrigerator (heat pump) refrigerator
cold reservoir sink of heat used by a heat engine (heat pump) that can remove (dump) heat without
disorder measure of order in a system; the greater any input of work
the disorder is, the higher the entropy refrigerator device that removes heat from a cold
efficiency (e) output work from the engine over the reservoir
input heat to the engine from the hot reservoir reversible process process in which both the
entropy state function of the system that changes system and the external environment
when heat is transferred between the system and theoretically can be returned to their original
the environment states
entropy statement of the second law of third law of thermodynamics absolute zero
thermodynamics entropy of a closed system or temperature cannot be reached through any
the entire universe never decreases finite number of cooling steps

Key Equations
Result of energy conservation

Efficiency of a heat engine

Coefficient of performance of a refrigerator

Coefficient of performance of a heat pump

Resulting efficiency of a Carnot cycle

Performance coefficient of a reversible refrigerator

Performance coefficient of a reversible heat pump

Access for free at openstax.org.


4 • Chapter Review 169

Entropy of a system undergoing a reversible process at a constant


temperature

Change of entropy of a system under a reversible process

Entropy of a system undergoing any complete reversible cyclic process

Change of entropy of a closed system under an irreversible process

Change in entropy of the system along an isotherm

Summary
4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes thermodynamics: It is impossible to convert the
heat from a single source into work without any
• A reversible process is one in which both the
other effect.
system and its environment can return to
• The Kelvin statement and Clausius statement of
exactly the states they were in by following the
the second law of thermodynamics are
reverse path.
equivalent.
• An irreversible process is one in which the
system and its environment cannot return 4.5 The Carnot Cycle
together to exactly the states that they were in.
• The Carnot cycle is the most efficient engine for
• The irreversibility of any natural process results
a reversible cycle designed between two
from the second law of thermodynamics.
reservoirs.
4.2 Heat Engines • The Carnot principle is another way of stating
the second law of thermodynamics.
• The work done by a heat engine is the difference
between the heat absorbed from the hot 4.6 Entropy
reservoir and the heat discharged to the cold
• The change in entropy for a reversible process
reservoir, that is,
at constant temperature is equal to the heat
• The ratio of the work done by the engine and the
divided by the temperature. The entropy change
heat absorbed from the hot reservoir provides
of a system under a reversible process is given
the efficiency of the engine, that is,
by .

4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps • A system’s change in entropy between two states
is independent of the reversible thermodynamic
• A refrigerator or a heat pump is a heat engine
path taken by the system when it makes a
run in reverse.
transition between the states.
• The focus of a refrigerator is on removing heat
from the cold reservoir with a coefficient of 4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale
performance
• The focus of a heat pump is on dumping heat to • Entropy can be related to how disordered a
the hot reservoir with a coefficient of system is—the more it is disordered, the higher
performance is its entropy. In any irreversible process, the
universe becomes more disordered.
4.4 Statements of the Second Law of • According to the third law of thermodynamics,
Thermodynamics absolute zero temperature is unreachable.

• The Kelvin statement of the second law of


170 4 • Chapter Review

Conceptual Questions
4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes temperature arguments.
10. An ideal gas goes from state to state
1. State an example of a process that occurs in
when it is allowed to expand freely. Is it
nature that is as close to reversible as it can be.
possible to represent the actual process on a pV
diagram? Explain.
4.2 Heat Engines
2. Explain in practical terms why efficiency is 4.5 The Carnot Cycle
defined as
11. To increase the efficiency of a Carnot engine,
should the temperature of the hot reservoir be
4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps raised or lowered? What about the cold
3. If the refrigerator door is left open, what happens reservoir?
to the temperature of the kitchen? 12. How could you design a Carnot engine with
4. Is it possible for the efficiency of a reversible efficiency?
engine to be greater than 1.0? Is it possible for 13. What type of processes occur in a Carnot cycle?
the coefficient of performance of a reversible
refrigerator to be less than 1.0? 4.6 Entropy
14. Does the entropy increase for a Carnot engine
4.4 Statements of the Second Law of for each cycle?
Thermodynamics 15. Is it possible for a system to have an entropy
5. In the text, we showed that if the Clausius change if it neither absorbs nor emits heat
statement is false, the Kelvin statement must also during a reversible transition? What happens if
be false. Now show the reverse, such that if the the process is irreversible?
Kelvin statement is false, it follows that the
Clausius statement is false. 4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale
6. Why don’t we operate ocean liners by extracting 16. Are the entropy changes of the systems in the
heat from the ocean or operate airplanes by following processes positive or negative? (a)
extracting heat from the atmosphere? water vapor that condenses on a cold surface;
7. Discuss the practical advantages and (b) gas in a container that leaks into the
disadvantages of heat pumps and electric surrounding atmosphere; (c) an ice cube that
heating. melts in a glass of lukewarm water; (d) the
8. The energy output of a heat pump is greater than lukewarm water of part (c); (e) a real heat engine
the energy used to operate the pump. Why performing a cycle; (f) food cooled in a
doesn’t this statement violate the first law of refrigerator.
thermodynamics? 17. Discuss the entropy changes in the systems of
9. Speculate as to why nuclear power plants are less Question 21.10 in terms of disorder.
efficient than fossil-fuel plants based on

Problems
4.1 Reversible and Irreversible Processes 19. A mole of ideal monatomic gas at and 1.00
atm is warmed up to expand isobarically to
18. A tank contains 111.0 g chlorine gas
triple its volume. How much heat is transferred
which is at temperature and absolute
during the process?
pressure The temperature of the
20. A mole of an ideal gas at pressure 4.00 atm and
air outside the tank is . The molar mass
temperature 298 K expands isothermally to
of is 70.9 g/mol. (a) What is the volume of
double its volume. What is the work done by the
the tank? (b) What is the internal energy of the
gas?
gas? (c) What is the work done by the gas if the
21. After a free expansion to quadruple its volume,
temperature and pressure inside the tank drop
a mole of ideal diatomic gas is compressed back
to and , respectively, due to its original volume adiabatically and then
to a leak? cooled down to its original temperature. What is

Access for free at openstax.org.


4 • Chapter Review 171

the minimum heat removed from the gas in the how much heat per cycle does it remove the
final step to restoring its state? cold reservoir? (b) How much heat per cycle is
discarded to the hot reservoir?
4.2 Heat Engines
4.5 The Carnot Cycle
22. An engine is found to have an efficiency of 0.40.
If it does 200 J of work per cycle, what are the 33. The temperature of the cold and hot reservoirs
corresponding quantities of heat absorbed and between which a Carnot refrigerator operates
discharged? are and , respectively. Which is
23. In performing 100.0 J of work, an engine its coefficient of performance?
discharges 50.0 J of heat. What is the efficiency 34. Suppose a Carnot refrigerator operates between
of the engine? Calculate the amount of work
24. An engine with an efficiency of 0.30 absorbs required to extract 1.0 J of heat from the cold
500 J of heat per cycle. (a) How much work does reservoir if (a) , ; (b)
it perform per cycle? (b) How much heat does it , (c) ,
discharge per cycle? ; and (d) , .
25. It is found that an engine discharges 100.0 J 35. A Carnot engine operates between reservoirs at
while absorbing 125.0 J each cycle of operation. 600 and 300 K. If the engine absorbs 100 J per
(a) What is the efficiency of the engine? (b) How cycle at the hot reservoir, what is its work output
much work does it perform per cycle? per cycle?
26. The temperature of the cold reservoir of the 36. A 500-W motor operates a Carnot refrigerator
engine is 300 K. It has an efficiency of 0.30 and between and . (a) What is the
absorbs 500 J of heat per cycle. (a) How much amount of heat per second extracted from the
work does it perform per cycle? (b) How much inside of the refrigerator? (b) How much heat is
heat does it discharge per cycle? exhausted to the outside air per second?
27. An engine absorbs three times as much heat as 37. Sketch a Carnot cycle on a temperature-volume
it discharges. The work done by the engine per diagram.
cycle is 50 J. Calculate (a) the efficiency of the 38. A Carnot heat pump operates between and
engine, (b) the heat absorbed per cycle, and (c) . How much heat is exhausted into the
the heat discharged per cycle. interior of a house for every 1.0 J of work done
28. A coal power plant consumes 100,000 kg of coal by the pump?
per hour and produces 500 MW of power. If the 39. An engine operating between heat reservoirs at
heat of combustion of coal is 30 MJ/kg, what is and extracts 1000 J per cycle from
the efficiency of the power plant? the hot reservoir. (a) What is the maximum
possible work that engine can do per cycle? (b)
4.3 Refrigerators and Heat Pumps For this maximum work, how much heat is
exhausted to the cold reservoir per cycle?
29. A refrigerator has a coefficient of performance
40. Suppose a Carnot engine can be operated
of 3.0. (a) If it requires 200 J of work per cycle,
between two reservoirs as either a heat engine
how much heat per cycle does it remove the
or a refrigerator. How is the coefficient of
cold reservoir? (b) How much heat per cycle is
performance of the refrigerator related to the
discarded to the hot reservoir?
efficiency of the heat engine?
30. During one cycle, a refrigerator removes 500 J
41. A Carnot engine is used to measure the
from a cold reservoir and discharges 800 J to its
temperature of a heat reservoir. The engine
hot reservoir. (a) What is its coefficient of
operates between the heat reservoir and a
performance? (b) How much work per cycle
reservoir consisting of water at its triple point.
does it require to operate?
(a) If 400 J per cycle are removed from the heat
31. If a refrigerator discards 80 J of heat per cycle
reservoir while 200 J per cycle are deposited in
and its coefficient of performance is 6.0, what
the triple-point reservoir, what is the
are (a) the quantity off heat it removes per cycle
temperature of the heat reservoir? (b) If 400 J
from a cold reservoir and (b) the amount of
per cycle are removed from the triple-point
work per cycle required for its operation?
reservoir while 200 J per cycle are deposited in
32. A refrigerator has a coefficient of performance
the heat reservoir, what is the temperature of
of 3.0. (a) If it requires 200 J of work per cycle,
the heat reservoir?
172 4 • Chapter Review

42. What is the minimum work required of a 4.7 Entropy on a Microscopic Scale
refrigerator if it is to extract 50 J per cycle from
53. A copper rod of cross-sectional area
the inside of a freezer at and exhaust
and length 5.0 m conducts heat from a heat
heat to the air at ?
reservoir at 373 K to one at 273 K. What is the
time rate of change of the universe’s entropy for
4.6 Entropy
this process?
43. Two hundred joules of heat are removed from a 54. Fifty grams of water at is heated until it
heat reservoir at a temperature of 200 K. What becomes vapor at . Calculate the change
is the entropy change of the reservoir? in entropy of the water in this process.
44. In an isothermal reversible expansion at , 55. Fifty grams of water at are changed into
an ideal gas does 20 J of work. What is the vapor at . What is the change in entropy
entropy change of the gas? of the water in this process?
45. An ideal gas at 300 K is compressed 56. In an isochoric process, heat is added to 10 mol
isothermally to one-fifth its original volume. of monoatomic ideal gas whose temperature
Determine the entropy change per mole of the increases from 273 to 373 K. What is the
gas. entropy change of the gas?
46. What is the entropy change of 10 g of steam at 57. Two hundred grams of water at is brought
when it condenses to water at the same into contact with a heat reservoir at . After
temperature? thermal equilibrium is reached, what is the
47. A metal rod is used to conduct heat between two temperature of the water? Of the reservoir? How
reservoirs at temperatures much heat has been transferred in the process?
respectively. When an amount of heat Q flows What is the entropy change of the water? Of the
through the rod from the hot to the cold reservoir? What is the entropy change of the
reservoir, what is the net entropy change of the universe?
rod, the hot reservoir, the cold reservoir, and the 58. Suppose that the temperature of the water in
universe? the previous problem is raised by first bringing
48. For the Carnot cycle of Figure 4.12, what is the it to thermal equilibrium with a reservoir at a
entropy change of the hot reservoir, the cold temperature of and then with a reservoir
reservoir, and the universe? at . Calculate the entropy changes of (a)
49. A 5.0-kg piece of lead at a temperature of each reservoir, (b) of the water, and (c) of the
is placed in a lake whose temperature is . universe.
Determine the entropy change of (a) the lead 59. Two hundred grams of water at is brought
piece, (b) the lake, and (c) the universe. into contact into thermal equilibrium
50. One mole of an ideal gas doubles its volume in a successively with reservoirs at , ,
reversible isothermal expansion. (a) What is the , and . (a) What is the entropy change
change in entropy of the gas? (b) If 1500 J of of the water? (b) Of the reservoir? (c) What is the
heat are added in this process, what is the entropy change of the universe?
temperature of the gas? 60. (a) Ten grams of starts as ice at . The
51. One mole of an ideal monatomic gas is confined ice absorbs heat from the air (just above )
to a rigid container. When heat is added until all of it melts. Calculate the entropy change
reversibly to the gas, its temperature changes of the , of the air, and of the universe. (b)
from (a) How much heat is added? (b) Suppose that the air in part (a) is at rather
What is the change in entropy of the gas? than and that the ice absorbs heat until it
52. (a) A 5.0-kg rock at a temperature of is becomes water at . Calculate the entropy
dropped into a shallow lake also at from a change of the , of the air, and of the
height of . What is the resulting universe. (c) Is either of these processes
change in entropy of the universe? (b) If the reversible?
temperature of the rock is when it is 61. The Carnot cycle is represented by the
dropped, what is the change of entropy of the temperature-entropy diagram shown below. (a)
universe? Assume that air friction is negligible How much heat is absorbed per cycle at the
(not a good assumption) and that high-temperature reservoir? (b) How much heat
is the specific heat of the rock. is exhausted per cycle at the low-temperature
reservoir? (c) How much work is done per cycle

Access for free at openstax.org.


4 • Chapter Review 173

by the engine? (d) What is the efficiency of the


engine?

64. A Carnot engine has an efficiency of 0.60. When


the temperature of its cold reservoir changes,
62. A Carnot engine operating between heat the efficiency drops to 0.55. If initially
reservoirs at 500 and 300 K absorbs 1500 J per , determine (a) the constant value of
cycle at the high-temperature reservoir. (a) and (b) the final value of .
Represent the engine’s cycle on a temperature- 65. A Carnot engine performs 100 J of work while
entropy diagram. (b) How much work per cycle discharging 200 J of heat each cycle. After the
is done by the engine? temperature of the hot reservoir only is
63. A monoatomic ideal gas (n moles) goes through adjusted, it is found that the engine now does
a cyclic process shown below. Find the change 130 J of work while discarding the same
in entropy of the gas in each step and the total quantity of heat. (a) What are the initial and
entropy change over the entire cycle. final efficiencies of the engine? (b) What is the
fractional change in the temperature of the hot
reservoir?
66. A Carnot refrigerator exhausts heat to the air,
which is at a temperature of . How much
power is used by the refrigerator if it freezes 1.5
g of water per second? Assume the water is at
.

Additional Problems
67. A 300-W heat pump operates between the
ground, whose temperature is , and the
interior of a house at . What is the
maximum amount of heat per hour that the
heat pump can supply to the house?
68. An engineer must design a refrigerator that
does 300 J of work per cycle to extract 2100 J of
heat per cycle from a freezer whose
temperature is . What is the maximum
air temperature for which this condition can be
met? Is this a reasonable condition to impose on
the design?
174 4 • Chapter Review

69. A Carnot engine employs 1.5 mol of nitrogen 74. An ideal gas at temperature T is stored in the left
gas as a working substance, which is considered half of an insulating container of volume V using a
as an ideal diatomic gas with at the partition of negligible volume (see below). What is
working temperatures of the engine. The Carnot the entropy change per mole of the gas in each of
cycle goes in the cycle ABCDA with AB being an the following cases? (a) The partition is suddenly
isothermal expansion. The volume at points A removed and the gas quickly fills the entire
and C of the cycle are and 0.15 container. (b) A tiny hole is punctured in the
L, respectively. The engine operates between partition and after a long period, the gas reaches an
two thermal baths of temperature 500 K and equilibrium state such that there is no net flow
300 K. (a) Find the values of volume at B and D. through the hole. (c) The partition is moved very
(b) How much heat is absorbed by the gas in the slowly and adiabatically all the way to the right wall
AB isothermal expansion? (c) How much work is so that the gas finally fills the entire container.
done by the gas in the AB isothermal
expansion? (d) How much heat is given up by
the gas in the CD isothermal expansion? (e) How
much work is done by the gas in the CD
isothermal compression? (f) How much work is
done by the gas in the BC adiabatic expansion?
(g) How much work is done by the gas in the DA
adiabatic compression? (h) Find the value of
efficiency of the engine based on the net work
75. A 0.50-kg piece of aluminum at is
and heat input. Compare this value to the
dropped into 1.0 kg of water at . After
efficiency of a Carnot engine based on the
equilibrium is reached, what is the net entropy
temperatures of the two baths.
change of the system?
70. A 5.0-kg wood block starts with an initial speed
76. Suppose 20 g of ice at is added to 300 g of
of 8.0 m/s and slides across the floor until
water at . What is the total change in
friction stops it. Estimate the resulting change
entropy of the mixture after it reaches thermal
in entropy of the universe. Assume that
equilibrium?
everything stays at a room temperature of
77. A heat engine operates between two
.
temperatures such that the working substance
71. A system consisting of 20.0 mol of a
of the engine absorbs 5000 J of heat from the
monoatomic ideal gas is cooled at constant
high-temperature bath and discharges 3000 J to
pressure from a volume of 50.0 L to 10.0 L. The
the low-temperature bath. The rest of the
initial temperature was 300 K. What is the
energy is converted into mechanical energy of
change in entropy of the gas?
the turbine. Find (a) the amount of work
72. A glass beaker of mass 400 g contains 500 g of
produced by the engine and (b) the efficiency of
water at . The beaker is heated reversibly
the engine.
so that the temperature of the beaker and water
78. A thermal engine produces 4 MJ of electrical
rise gradually to . Find the change in
energy while operating between two thermal
entropy of the beaker and water together.
baths of different temperatures. The working
73. A Carnot engine operates between and
substance of the engine discharges 5 MJ of heat
baths and produces 300 kJ of energy in
to the cold temperature bath. What is the
each cycle. Find the change in entropy of the (a)
efficiency of the engine?
hot bath and (b) cold bath, in each Carnot cycle?
79. A coal power plant consumes 100,000 kg of coal
per hour and produces 500 MW of power. If the
heat of combustion of coal is 30 MJ/kg, what is
the efficiency of the power plant?
80. A Carnot engine operates in a Carnot cycle
between a heat source at and a heat sink
at Find the efficiency of the Carnot
engine.

Access for free at openstax.org.


4 • Chapter Review 175

81. A Carnot engine working between two heat 82. A Carnot cycle working between and
baths of temperatures 600 K and 273 K is used to drive a refrigerator between
completes each cycle in 5 sec. In each cycle, the and How much energy must the
engine absorbs 10 kJ of heat. Find the power of Carnot engine produce per second so that the
the engine. refrigerator is able to discard 10 J of energy per
second?

Challenge Problems
83. (a) An infinitesimal amount of heat is added
reversibly to a system. By combining the first
and second laws, show that .
(b) When heat is added to an ideal gas, its
temperature and volume change from
. Show that the entropy
change of n moles of the gas is given by
.
84. Using the result of the preceding problem, show
that for an ideal gas undergoing an adiabatic
process, is constant.
85. With the help of the two preceding problems,
show that between states 1 and 2 of n moles
an ideal gas is given by
.
86. A cylinder contains 500 g of helium at 120 atm
and . The valve is leaky, and all the gas
slowly escapes isothermally into the
atmosphere. Use the results of the preceding
problem to determine the resulting change in
entropy of the universe.
87. A diatomic ideal gas is brought from an initial
equilibrium state at and
to a final stage with
and Use the results of the previous
problem to determine the entropy change per
mole of the gas.
176 4 • Chapter Review

88. The gasoline internal combustion engine where . The quantity r is called the
operates in a cycle consisting of six parts. Four compression ratio of the engine.
of these parts involve, among other things, (c) In practice, r is kept less than around 7. For
friction, heat exchange through finite larger values, the gasoline-air mixture is
temperature differences, and accelerations of compressed to temperatures so high that it
the piston; it is irreversible. Nevertheless, it is explodes before the finely timed spark is
represented by the ideal reversible Otto cycle, delivered. This preignition causes engine knock
which is illustrated below. The working and loss of power. Show that for and
substance of the cycle is assumed to be air. The (the value for air), , or an
six steps of the Otto cycle are as follows: efficiency of Because of the many
i. Isobaric intake stroke (OA). A mixture of irreversible processes, an actual internal
gasoline and air is drawn into the combustion engine has an efficiency much less
combustion chamber at atmospheric than this ideal value. A typical efficiency for a
pressure as the piston expands, tuned engine is about .
increasing the volume of the cylinder from
zero to .
ii. Adiabatic compression stroke (AB). The
temperature of the mixture rises as the
piston compresses it adiabatically from a
volume .
iii. Ignition at constant volume (BC). The
mixture is ignited by a spark. The
combustion happens so fast that there is
essentially no motion of the piston. During
this process, the added heat causes the
pressure to increase from at the
constant volume .
iv. Adiabatic expansion (CD). The heated
mixture of gasoline and air expands against
the piston, increasing the volume from
. This is called the power stroke, as
it is the part of the cycle that delivers most
of the power to the crankshaft.
v. Constant-volume exhaust (DA). When the
exhaust valve opens, some of the
combustion products escape. There is
almost no movement of the piston during
this part of the cycle, so the volume remains
constant at . Most of the available
energy is lost here, as represented by the
heat exhaust .
vi. Isobaric compression (AO). The exhaust
valve remains open, and the compression
from to zero drives out the remaining
combustion products.

(a) Using (i) ; (ii) ; and


(iii) , ,
show that
.
(b) Use the fact that steps (ii) and (iv) are
adiabatic to show that
,

Access for free at openstax.org.


4 • Chapter Review 177

89. An ideal diesel cycle is shown below. This cycle 90. Consider an ideal gas Joule cycle, also called the
consists of five strokes. In this case, only air is Brayton cycle, shown below. Find the formula
drawn into the chamber during the intake for efficiency of the engine using this cycle in
stroke OA. The air is then compressed terms of , , and .
adiabatically from state A to state B, raising its
temperature high enough so that when fuel is
added during the power stroke BC, it ignites.
After ignition ends at C, there is a further
adiabatic power stroke CD. Finally, there is an
exhaust at constant volume as the pressure
drops from to , followed by a further
exhaust when the piston compresses the
chamber volume to zero.
(a) Use , ,
91. Derive a formula for the coefficient of
and to show that
performance of a refrigerator using an ideal gas
. as a working substance operating in the cycle
(b) Use the fact that and are shown below in terms of the properties of the
adiabatic to show that three states labeled 1, 2, and 3.

(c) Since there is no preignition (remember, the


chamber does not contain any fuel during the
compression), the compression ratio can be
larger than that for a gasoline engine. Typically,
. For these values
and show that , or an efficiency
of . Diesel engines actually operate at an
efficiency of about compared with
92. Two moles of nitrogen gas, with for ideal
for gasoline engines.
diatomic gases, occupies a volume of in
an insulated cylinder at temperature 300 K. The
gas is adiabatically and reversibly compressed
to a volume of 5 L. The piston of the cylinder is
locked in its place, and the insulation around
the cylinder is removed. The heat-conducting
cylinder is then placed in a 300-K bath. Heat
from the compressed gas leaves the gas, and the
temperature of the gas becomes 300 K again.
The gas is then slowly expanded at the fixed
temperature 300 K until the volume of the gas
becomes , thus making a complete
cycle for the gas. For the entire cycle, calculate
(a) the work done by the gas, (b) the heat into or
out of the gas, (c) the change in the internal
energy of the gas, and (d) the change in entropy
of the gas.
93. A Carnot refrigerator, working between and
is used to cool a bucket of water
containing of water at to in
2 hours. Find the total amount of work needed.
178 4 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 5
Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.1 Electric charges exist all around us. They can cause objects to be repelled from each other or to be
attracted to each other. (credit: modification of work by Sean McGrath)

Chapter Outline

5.1 Electric Charge

5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging by Induction

5.3 Coulomb's Law

5.4 Electric Field

5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions

5.6 Electric Field Lines

5.7 Electric Dipoles

INTRODUCTION Back when we were studying Newton’s laws, we identified several physical phenomena as
forces. We did so based on the effect they had on a physical object: Specifically, they caused the object to
accelerate. Later, when we studied impulse and momentum, we expanded this idea to identify a force as any
180 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

physical phenomenon that changed the momentum of an object. In either case, the result is the same: We
recognize a force by the effect that it has on an object.

In Gravitation, we examined the force of gravity, which acts on all objects with mass. In this chapter, we begin
the study of the electric force, which acts on all objects with a property called charge. The electric force is much
stronger than gravity (in most systems where both appear), but it can be a force of attraction or a force of
repulsion, which leads to very different effects on objects. The electric force helps keep atoms together, so it is
of fundamental importance in matter. But it also governs most everyday interactions we deal with, from
chemical interactions to biological processes.

5.1 Electric Charge


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the concept of electric charge
• Explain qualitatively the force electric charge creates

You are certainly familiar with electronic devices that you activate with the click of a switch, from computers to
cell phones to television. And you have certainly seen electricity in a flash of lightning during a heavy
thunderstorm. But you have also most likely experienced electrical effects in other ways, maybe without
realizing that an electric force was involved. Let’s take a look at some of these activities and see what we can
learn from them about electric charges and forces.

Discoveries
You have probably experienced the phenomenon of static electricity: When you first take clothes out of a
dryer, many (not all) of them tend to stick together; for some fabrics, they can be very difficult to separate.
Another example occurs if you take a woolen sweater off quickly—you can feel (and hear) the static electricity
pulling on your clothes, and perhaps even your hair. If you comb your hair on a dry day and then put the comb
close to a thin stream of water coming out of a faucet, you will find that the water stream bends toward (is
attracted to) the comb (Figure 5.2).

Figure 5.2 An electrically charged comb attracts a stream of water from a distance. Note that the water is not touching the comb. (credit:
Jane Whitney)

Suppose you bring the comb close to some small strips of paper; the strips of paper are attracted to the comb
and even cling to it (Figure 5.3). In the kitchen, quickly pull a length of plastic cling wrap off the roll; it will tend
to cling to most any nonmetallic material (such as plastic, glass, or food). If you rub a balloon on a wall for a few
seconds, it will stick to the wall. Probably the most annoying effect of static electricity is getting shocked by a
doorknob (or a friend) after shuffling your feet on some types of carpeting.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.1 • Electric Charge 181

Figure 5.3 After being used to comb hair, this comb attracts small strips of paper from a distance, without physical contact. Investigation
of this behavior helped lead to the concept of the electric force. (credit: Jane Whitney)

Many of these phenomena have been known for centuries. The ancient Greek philosopher Thales of Miletus
(624–546 BCE) recorded that when amber (a hard, translucent, fossilized resin from extinct trees) was
vigorously rubbed with a piece of fur, a force was created that caused the fur and the amber to be attracted to
each other (Figure 5.4). Additionally, he found that the rubbed amber would not only attract the fur, and the fur
attract the amber, but they both could affect other (nonmetallic) objects, even if not in contact with those
objects (Figure 5.5).

Figure 5.4 Borneo amber is mined in Sabah, Malaysia, from shale-sandstone-mudstone veins. When a piece of amber is rubbed with a
piece of fur, the amber gains more electrons, giving it a net negative charge. At the same time, the fur, having lost electrons, becomes
positively charged. (credit: “Sebakoamber”/Wikimedia Commons)
182 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.5 When materials are rubbed together, charges can be separated, particularly if one material has a greater affinity for electrons
than another. (a) Both the amber and cloth are originally neutral, with equal positive and negative charges. Only a tiny fraction of the
charges are involved, and only a few of them are shown here. (b) When rubbed together, some negative charge is transferred to the amber,
leaving the cloth with a net positive charge. (c) When separated, the amber and cloth now have net charges, but the absolute value of the
net positive and negative charges will be equal.

The English physicist William Gilbert (1544–1603) also studied this attractive force, using various substances.
He worked with amber, and, in addition, he experimented with rock crystal and various precious and semi-
precious gemstones. He also experimented with several metals. He found that the metals never exhibited this
force, whereas the minerals did. Moreover, although an electrified amber rod would attract a piece of fur, it
would repel another electrified amber rod; similarly, two electrified pieces of fur would repel each other.

This suggested there were two types of an electric property; this property eventually came to be called electric
charge. The difference between the two types of electric charge is in the directions of the electric forces that
each type of charge causes: These forces are repulsive when the same type of charge exists on two interacting
objects and attractive when the charges are of opposite types. The SI unit of electric charge is the coulomb (C),
after the French physicist Charles-Augustin de Coulomb (1736–1806).

The most peculiar aspect of this new force is that it does not require physical contact between the two objects
in order to cause an acceleration. This is an example of a so-called “long-range” force. (Or, as James Clerk
Maxwell later phrased it, “action at a distance.”) With the exception of gravity, all other forces we have
discussed so far act only when the two interacting objects actually touch.

The American physicist and statesman Benjamin Franklin found that he could concentrate charge in a
“Leyden jar,” which was essentially a glass jar with two sheets of metal foil, one inside and one outside, with
the glass between them (Figure 5.6). This created a large electric force between the two foil sheets.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.1 • Electric Charge 183

Figure 5.6 A Leyden jar (an early version of what is now called a capacitor) allowed experimenters to store large amounts of electric
charge. Benjamin Franklin used such a jar to demonstrate that lightning behaved exactly like the electricity he got from the equipment in his
laboratory.

Franklin pointed out that the observed behavior could be explained by supposing that one of the two types of
charge remained motionless, while the other type of charge flowed from one piece of foil to the other. He
further suggested that an excess of what he called this “electrical fluid” be called “positive electricity” and the
deficiency of it be called “negative electricity.” His suggestion, with some minor modifications, is the model we
use today. (With the experiments that he was able to do, this was a pure guess; he had no way of actually
determining the sign of the moving charge. Unfortunately, he guessed wrong; we now know that the charges
that flow are the ones Franklin labeled negative, and the positive charges remain largely motionless.
Fortunately, as we’ll see, it makes no practical or theoretical difference which choice we make, as long as we
stay consistent with our choice.)

Let’s list the specific observations that we have of this electric force:

• The force acts without physical contact between the two objects.
• The force can be either attractive or repulsive: If two interacting objects carry the same sign of charge, the
force is repulsive; if the charges are of opposite sign, the force is attractive. These interactions are referred
to as electrostatic repulsion and electrostatic attraction, respectively.
• Not all objects are affected by this force.
• The magnitude of the force decreases (rapidly) with increasing separation distance between the objects.

To be more precise, we find experimentally that the magnitude of the force decreases as the square of the
distance between the two interacting objects increases. Thus, for example, when the distance between two
interacting objects is doubled, the force between them decreases to one fourth what it was in the original
system. We can also observe that the surroundings of the charged objects affect the magnitude of the force.
However, we will explore this issue in a later chapter.
184 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Properties of Electric Charge


In addition to the existence of two types of charge, several other properties of charge have been discovered.

• Charge is quantized. This means that electric charge comes in discrete amounts, and there is a smallest
possible amount of charge that an object can have. In the SI system, this smallest amount is
. No free particle can have less charge than this, and, therefore, the charge on any
object—the charge on all objects—must be an integer multiple of this amount. All macroscopic, charged
objects have charge because electrons have either been added or taken away from them, resulting in a net
charge.
• The magnitude of the charge is independent of the type. Phrased another way, the smallest possible
positive charge (to four significant figures) is , and the smallest possible negative
charge is ; these values are exactly equal. This is simply how the laws of physics in our
universe turned out.
• Charge is conserved. Charge can neither be created nor destroyed; it can only be transferred from place
to place, from one object to another. Frequently, we speak of two charges “canceling”; this is verbal
shorthand. It means that if two objects that have equal and opposite charges are physically close to each
other, then the (oppositely directed) forces they apply on some other charged object cancel, for a net force
of zero. It is important that you understand that the charges on the objects by no means disappear,
however. The net charge of the universe is constant.
• Charge is conserved in closed systems. In principle, if a negative charge disappeared from your lab
bench and reappeared on the Moon, conservation of charge would still hold. However, this never happens.
If the total charge you have in your local system on your lab bench is changing, there will be a measurable
flow of charge into or out of the system. Again, charges can and do move around, and their effects can and
do cancel, but the net charge in your local environment (if closed) is conserved. The last two items are both
referred to as the law of conservation of charge.

The Source of Charges: The Structure of the Atom


Once it became clear that all matter was composed of particles that came to be called atoms, it also quickly
became clear that the constituents of the atom included both positively charged particles and negatively
charged particles. The next question was, what are the physical properties of those electrically charged
particles?

The negatively charged particle was the first one to be discovered. In 1897, the English physicist J. J. Thomson
was studying what was then known as cathode rays. Some years before, the English physicist William Crookes
had shown that these “rays” were negatively charged, but his experiments were unable to tell any more than
that. (The fact that they carried a negative electric charge was strong evidence that these were not rays at all,
but particles.) Thomson prepared a pure beam of these particles and sent them through crossed electric and
magnetic fields, and adjusted the various field strengths until the net deflection of the beam was zero. With this
experiment, he was able to determine the charge-to-mass ratio of the particle. This ratio showed that the mass
of the particle was much smaller than that of any other previously known particle—1837 times smaller, in fact.
Eventually, this particle came to be called the electron.

Since the atom as a whole is electrically neutral, the next question was to determine how the positive and
negative charges are distributed within the atom. Thomson himself imagined that his electrons were
embedded within a sort of positively charged paste, smeared out throughout the volume of the atom. However,
in 1908, the New Zealand physicist Ernest Rutherford showed that the positive charges of the atom existed
within a tiny core—called a nucleus—that took up only a very tiny fraction of the overall volume of the atom, but
held over 99% of the mass. (See Linear Momentum and Collisions.) In addition, he showed that the negatively
charged electrons perpetually orbited about this nucleus, forming a sort of electrically charged cloud that
surrounds the nucleus (Figure 5.7). Rutherford concluded that the nucleus was constructed of small, massive
particles that he named protons.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.1 • Electric Charge 185

Figure 5.7 This simplified model of a hydrogen atom shows a positively charged nucleus (consisting, in the case of hydrogen, of a single
proton), surrounded by an electron “cloud.” The charge of the electron cloud is equal (and opposite in sign) to the charge of the nucleus, but
the electron does not have a definite location in space; hence, its representation here is as a cloud. Normal macroscopic amounts of matter
contain immense numbers of atoms and molecules, and, hence, even greater numbers of individual negative and positive charges.

Since it was known that different atoms have different masses, and that ordinarily atoms are electrically
neutral, it was natural to suppose that different atoms have different numbers of protons in their nucleus, with
an equal number of negatively charged electrons orbiting about the positively charged nucleus, thus making
the atoms overall electrically neutral. However, it was soon discovered that although the lightest atom,
hydrogen, did indeed have a single proton as its nucleus, the next heaviest atom—helium—has twice the
number of protons (two), but four times the mass of hydrogen.

This mystery was resolved in 1932 by the English physicist James Chadwick, with the discovery of the
neutron. The neutron is, essentially, an electrically neutral twin of the proton, with no electric charge, but
(nearly) identical mass to the proton. The helium nucleus therefore has two neutrons along with its two
protons. (Later experiments were to show that although the neutron is electrically neutral overall, it does have
an internal charge structure. Furthermore, although the masses of the neutron and the proton are nearly
equal, they aren’t exactly equal: The neutron’s mass is very slightly larger than the mass of the proton. That
slight mass excess turned out to be of great importance. That, however, is a story that will have to wait until our
study of modern physics in Nuclear Physics.)

Thus, in 1932, the picture of the atom was of a small, massive nucleus constructed of a combination of protons
and neutrons, surrounded by a collection of electrons whose combined motion formed a sort of negatively
charged “cloud” around the nucleus (Figure 5.8). In an electrically neutral atom, the total negative charge of
the collection of electrons is equal to the total positive charge in the nucleus. The very low-mass electrons can
be more or less easily removed or added to an atom, changing the net charge on the atom (though without
changing its type). An atom that has had the charge altered in this way is called an ion. Positive ions have had
electrons removed, whereas negative ions have had excess electrons added. We also use this term to describe
molecules that are not electrically neutral.
186 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.8 The nucleus of a carbon atom is composed of six protons and six neutrons. As in hydrogen, the surrounding six electrons do
not have definite locations and so can be considered to be a sort of cloud surrounding the nucleus.

The story of the atom does not stop there, however. In the latter part of the twentieth century, many more
subatomic particles were discovered in the nucleus of the atom: pions, neutrinos, and quarks, among others.
With the exception of the photon, none of these particles are directly relevant to the study of
electromagnetism, so we defer further discussion of them until the chapter on particle physics (Particle
Physics and Cosmology).

A Note on Terminology
As noted previously, electric charge is a property that an object can have. This is similar to how an object can
have a property that we call mass, a property that we call density, a property that we call temperature, and so
on. Technically, we should always say something like, “Suppose we have a particle that carries a charge of
” However, it is very common to say instead, “Suppose we have a charge.” Similarly, we often say
something like, “Six charges are located at the vertices of a regular hexagon.” A charge is not a particle; rather,
it is a property of a particle. Nevertheless, this terminology is extremely common (and is frequently used in
this book, as it is everywhere else). So, keep in the back of your mind what we really mean when we refer to a
“charge.”

5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging by Induction


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain what a conductor is
• Explain what an insulator is
• List the differences and similarities between conductors and insulators
• Describe the process of charging by induction

In the preceding section, we said that scientists were able to create electric charge only on nonmetallic
materials and never on metals. To understand why this is the case, you have to understand more about the
nature and structure of atoms. In this section, we discuss how and why electric charges do—or do not—move
through materials (Figure 5.9). A more complete description is given in a later chapter.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.2 • Conductors, Insulators, and Charging by Induction 187

Figure 5.9 This power adapter uses metal wires and connectors to conduct electricity from the wall socket to a laptop computer. The
conducting wires allow electrons to move freely through the cables, which are shielded by rubber and plastic. These materials act as
insulators that don’t allow electric charge to escape outward. (credit: modification of work by “Evan-Amos”/Wikimedia Commons)

Conductors and Insulators


As discussed in the previous section, electrons surround the tiny nucleus in the form of a (comparatively) vast
cloud of negative charge. However, this cloud does have a definite structure to it. Let’s consider an atom of the
most commonly used conductor, copper.

For reasons that will become clear in Atomic Structure, there is an outermost electron that is only loosely
bound to the atom’s nucleus. It can be easily dislodged; it then moves to a neighboring atom. In a large mass of
copper atoms (such as a copper wire or a sheet of copper), these vast numbers of outermost electrons (one per
atom) wander from atom to atom, and are the electrons that do the moving when electricity flows. These
wandering, or “free,” electrons are called conduction electrons, and copper is therefore an excellent
conductor (of electric charge). All conducting elements have a similar arrangement of their electrons, with one
or two conduction electrons. This includes most metals.

Insulators, in contrast, are made from materials that lack conduction electrons; charge flows only with great
difficulty, if at all. Even if excess charge is added to an insulating material, it cannot move, remaining
indefinitely in place. This is why insulating materials exhibit the electrical attraction and repulsion forces
described earlier, whereas conductors do not; any excess charge placed on a conductor would instantly flow
away (due to mutual repulsion from existing charges), leaving no excess charge around to create forces. Charge
cannot flow along or through an insulator, so its electric forces remain for long periods of time. (Charge will
dissipate from an insulator, given enough time.) As it happens, amber, fur, and most semi-precious gems are
insulators, as are materials like wood, glass, and plastic.

Charging by Induction
Let’s examine in more detail what happens in a conductor when an electrically charged object is brought close
to it. As mentioned, the conduction electrons in the conductor are able to move with nearly complete freedom.
As a result, when a charged insulator (such as a positively charged glass rod) is brought close to the conductor,
the (total) charge on the insulator exerts an electric force on the conduction electrons. Since the rod is
positively charged, the conduction electrons (which themselves are negatively charged) are attracted, flowing
toward the insulator to the near side of the conductor (Figure 5.10).

Now, the conductor is still overall electrically neutral; the conduction electrons have changed position, but they
are still in the conducting material. However, the conductor now has a charge distribution; the near end (the
portion of the conductor closest to the insulator) now has more negative charge than positive charge, and the
reverse is true of the end farthest from the insulator. The relocation of negative charges to the near side of the
conductor results in an overall positive charge in the part of the conductor farthest from the insulator. We have
thus created an electric charge distribution where one did not exist before. This process is referred to as
inducing polarization—in this case, polarizing the conductor. The resulting separation of positive and negative
188 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

charge is called polarization, and a material, or even a molecule, that exhibits polarization is said to be
polarized. A similar situation occurs with a negatively charged insulator, but the resulting polarization is in the
opposite direction.

Figure 5.10 Induced polarization. A positively charged glass rod is brought near the left side of the conducting sphere, attracting negative
charge and leaving the other side of the sphere positively charged. Although the sphere is overall still electrically neutral, it now has a
charge distribution, so it can exert an electric force on other nearby charges. Furthermore, the distribution is such that it will be attracted to
the glass rod.

The result is the formation of what is called an electric dipole, from a Latin phrase meaning “two ends.” The
presence of electric charges on the insulator—and the electric forces they apply to the conduction
electrons—creates, or “induces,” the dipole in the conductor.

Neutral objects can be attracted to any charged object. The pieces of straw attracted to polished amber are
neutral, for example. If you run a plastic comb through your hair, the charged comb can pick up neutral pieces
of paper. Figure 5.11 shows how the polarization of atoms and molecules in neutral objects results in their
attraction to a charged object.

Figure 5.11 Both positive and negative objects attract a neutral object by polarizing its molecules. (a) A positive object brought near a
neutral insulator polarizes its molecules. There is a slight shift in the distribution of the electrons orbiting the molecule, with unlike charges
being brought nearer and like charges moved away. Since the electrostatic force decreases with distance, there is a net attraction. (b) A
negative object produces the opposite polarization, but again attracts the neutral object. (c) The same effect occurs for a conductor; since
the unlike charges are closer, there is a net attraction.

When a charged rod is brought near a neutral substance, an insulator in this case, the distribution of charge in
atoms and molecules is shifted slightly. Opposite charge is attracted nearer the external charged rod, while like
charge is repelled. Since the electrostatic force decreases with distance, the repulsion of like charges is weaker
than the attraction of unlike charges, and so there is a net attraction. Thus, a positively charged glass rod
attracts neutral pieces of paper, as will a negatively charged rubber rod. Some molecules, like water, are polar
molecules. Polar molecules have a natural or inherent separation of charge, although they are neutral overall.
Polar molecules are particularly affected by other charged objects and show greater polarization effects than
molecules with naturally uniform charge distributions.

When the two ends of a dipole can be separated, this method of charging by induction may be used to create
charged objects without transferring charge. In Figure 5.12, we see two neutral metal spheres in contact with
one another but insulated from the rest of the world. A positively charged rod is brought near one of them,
attracting negative charge to that side, leaving the other sphere positively charged.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.2 • Conductors, Insulators, and Charging by Induction 189

Figure 5.12 Charging by induction. (a) Two uncharged or neutral metal spheres are in contact with each other but insulated from the rest
of the world. (b) A positively charged glass rod is brought near the sphere on the left, attracting negative charge and leaving the other
sphere positively charged. (c) The spheres are separated before the rod is removed, thus separating negative and positive charges. (d) The
spheres retain net charges after the inducing rod is removed—without ever having been touched by a charged object.

Another method of charging by induction is shown in Figure 5.13. The neutral metal sphere is polarized when
a charged rod is brought near it. The sphere is then grounded, meaning that a conducting wire is run from the
sphere to the ground. Since Earth is large and most of the ground is a good conductor, it can supply or accept
excess charge easily. In this case, electrons are attracted to the sphere through a wire called the ground wire,
because it supplies a conducting path to the ground. The ground connection is broken before the charged rod
is removed, leaving the sphere with an excess charge opposite to that of the rod. Again, an opposite charge is
achieved when charging by induction, and the charged rod loses none of its excess charge.
190 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.13 Charging by induction using a ground connection. (a) A positively charged rod is brought near a neutral metal sphere,
polarizing it. (b) The sphere is grounded, allowing electrons to be attracted from Earth’s ample supply. (c) The ground connection is broken.
(d) The positive rod is removed, leaving the sphere with an induced negative charge.

5.3 Coulomb's Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the electric force, both qualitatively and quantitatively
• Calculate the force that charges exert on each other
• Determine the direction of the electric force for different source charges
• Correctly describe and apply the superposition principle for multiple source charges

Experiments with electric charges have shown that if two objects each have electric charge, then they exert an
electric force on each other. The magnitude of the force is linearly proportional to the net charge on each
object and inversely proportional to the square of the distance between them. (Interestingly, the force does not
depend on the mass of the objects.) The direction of the force vector is along the imaginary line joining the two
objects and is dictated by the signs of the charges involved.

Let

• the net electric charges of the two objects;


• the vector displacement from to .

The electric force on one of the charges is proportional to the magnitude of its own charge and the
magnitude of the other charge, and is inversely proportional to the square of the distance between them:

This proportionality becomes an equality with the introduction of a proportionality constant. For reasons that
will become clear in a later chapter, the proportionality constant that we use is actually a collection of
constants. (We discuss this constant shortly.)

Coulomb’s Law
The magnitude of the electric force (or Coulomb force) between two electrically charged particles is equal
to

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.3 • Coulomb's Law 191

5.1

The unit vector has a magnitude of 1 and points along the axis as the charges. If the charges have the
same sign, the force is in the same direction as showing a repelling force. If the charges have different
signs, the force is in the opposite direction of showing an attracting force. (Figure 5.14).

Figure 5.14 The electrostatic force between point charges and separated by a distance r is given by Coulomb’s law. Note that
Newton’s third law (every force exerted creates an equal and opposite force) applies as usual—the force on is equal in magnitude and
opposite in direction to the force it exerts on . (a) Like charges; (b) unlike charges.

It is important to note that the electric force is not constant; it is a function of the separation distance between
the two charges. If either the test charge or the source charge (or both) move, then changes, and therefore so
does the force. An immediate consequence of this is that direct application of Newton’s laws with this force can
be mathematically difficult, depending on the specific problem at hand. It can (usually) be done, but we almost
always look for easier methods of calculating whatever physical quantity we are interested in. (Conservation of
energy is the most common choice.)

Finally, the new constant in Coulomb’s law is called the permittivity of free space, or (better) the
permittivity of vacuum. It has a very important physical meaning that we will discuss in a later chapter; for
now, it is simply an empirical proportionality constant. Its numerical value (to three significant figures) turns
out to be

These units are required to give the force in Coulomb’s law the correct units of newtons. Note that in Coulomb’s
law, the permittivity of vacuum is only part of the proportionality constant. For convenience, we often define a
Coulomb’s constant:

EXAMPLE 5.1

The Force on the Electron in Hydrogen


A hydrogen atom consists of a single proton and a single electron. The proton has a charge of and the
electron has . In the “ground state” of the atom, the electron orbits the proton at most probable distance of
(Figure 5.15). Calculate the electric force on the electron due to the proton.
192 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.15 A schematic depiction of a hydrogen atom, showing the force on the electron. This depiction is only to enable us to calculate
the force; the hydrogen atom does not really look like this. Recall Figure 5.7.

Strategy
For the purposes of this example, we are treating the electron and proton as two point particles, each with an
electric charge, and we are told the distance between them; we are asked to calculate the force on the electron.
We thus use Coulomb’s law.

Solution
Our two charges and the distance between them are,

The magnitude of the force on the electron is

As for the direction, since the charges on the two particles are opposite, the force is attractive; the force on the
electron points radially directly toward the proton, everywhere in the electron’s orbit. The force is thus
expressed as

Significance
This is a three-dimensional system, so the electron (and therefore the force on it) can be anywhere in an
imaginary spherical shell around the proton. In this “classical” model of the hydrogen atom, the electrostatic
force on the electron points in the inward centripetal direction, thus maintaining the electron’s orbit. But note
that the quantum mechanical model of hydrogen (discussed in Quantum Mechanics) is utterly different.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.1


What would be different if the electron also had a positive charge?

Multiple Source Charges


The analysis that we have done for two particles can be extended to an arbitrary number of particles; we
simply repeat the analysis, two charges at a time. Specifically, we ask the question: Given N charges (which we

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.3 • Coulomb's Law 193

refer to as source charge), what is the net electric force that they exert on some other point charge (which we
call the test charge)? Note that we use these terms because we can think of the test charge being used to test
the strength of the force provided by the source charges.

Like all forces that we have seen up to now, the net electric force on our test charge is simply the vector sum of
each individual electric force exerted on it by each of the individual source charges. Thus, we can calculate the
net force on the test charge Q by calculating the force on it from each source charge, taken one at a time, and
then adding all those forces together (as vectors). This ability to simply add up individual forces in this way is
referred to as the principle of superposition, and is one of the more important features of the electric force. In
mathematical form, this becomes

5.2

In this expression, Q represents the charge of the particle that is experiencing the electric force , and is
located at from the origin; the are the N source charges, and the vectors are the displacements
from the position of the ith charge to the position of Q. Each of the N unit vectors points directly from its
associated source charge toward the test charge. All of this is depicted in Figure 5.16. Please note that there is
no physical difference between Q and ; the difference in labels is merely to allow clear discussion, with Q
being the charge we are determining the force on.

Figure 5.16 The eight source charges each apply a force on the single test charge Q. Each force can be calculated independently of the
other seven forces. This is the essence of the superposition principle.

(Note that the force vector does not necessarily point in the same direction as the unit vector ; it may
point in the opposite direction, . The signs of the source charge and test charge determine the direction of
the force on the test charge.)

There is a complication, however. Just as the source charges each exert a force on the test charge, so too (by
Newton’s third law) does the test charge exert an equal and opposite force on each of the source charges. As a
consequence, each source charge would change position. However, by Equation 5.2, the force on the test
charge is a function of position; thus, as the positions of the source charges change, the net force on the test
charge necessarily changes, which changes the force, which again changes the positions. Thus, the entire
mathematical analysis quickly becomes intractable. Later, we will learn techniques for handling this situation,
but for now, we make the simplifying assumption that the source charges are fixed in place somehow, so that
their positions are constant in time. (The test charge is allowed to move.) With this restriction in place, the
analysis of charges is known as electrostatics, where “statics” refers to the constant (that is, static) positions of
the source charges and the force is referred to as an electrostatic force.
194 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

EXAMPLE 5.2

The Net Force from Two Source Charges


Three different, small charged objects are placed as shown in Figure 5.17. The charges and are fixed in
place; is free to move. Given , , and , and that , what is the net
force on the middle charge ?

Figure 5.17 Source charges and each apply a force on .

Strategy
We use Coulomb’s law again. The way the question is phrased indicates that is our test charge, so that
and are source charges. The principle of superposition says that the force on from each of the other
charges is unaffected by the presence of the other charge. Therefore, we write down the force on from each
and add them together as vectors.

Solution
We have two source charges and a test charge distances and and we are asked to find a
force. This calls for Coulomb’s law and superposition of forces. There are two forces:

We can’t add these forces directly because they don’t point in the same direction: points only in the
−x-direction, while points only in the +y-direction. The net force is obtained from applying the
Pythagorean theorem to its x- and y-components:

where

and

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.4 • Electric Field 195

We find that

at an angle of

that is, above the −x-axis, as shown in the diagram.

Significance
Notice that when we substituted the numerical values of the charges, we did not include the negative sign of
either or . Recall that negative signs on vector quantities indicate a reversal of direction of the vector in
question. But for electric forces, the direction of the force is determined by the types (signs) of both interacting
charges; we determine the force directions by considering whether the signs of the two charges are the same
or are opposite. If you also include negative signs from negative charges when you substitute numbers, you run
the risk of mathematically reversing the direction of the force you are calculating. Thus, the safest thing to do
is to calculate just the magnitude of the force, using the absolute values of the charges, and determine the
directions physically.

It’s also worth noting that the only new concept in this example is how to calculate the electric forces;
everything else (getting the net force from its components, breaking the forces into their components, finding
the direction of the net force) is the same as force problems you have done earlier.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.2


What would be different if were negative?

5.4 Electric Field


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the purpose of the electric field concept
• Describe the properties of the electric field
• Calculate the field of a collection of source charges of either sign

As we showed in the preceding section, the net electric force on a test charge is the vector sum of all the
electric forces acting on it, from all of the various source charges, located at their various positions. But what if
we use a different test charge, one with a different magnitude, or sign, or both? Or suppose we have a dozen
different test charges we wish to try at the same location? We would have to calculate the sum of the forces
from scratch. Fortunately, it is possible to define a quantity, called the electric field, which is independent of
the test charge. It only depends on the configuration of the source charges, and once found, allows us to
calculate the force on any test charge.

Defining a Field
Suppose we have N source charges located at positions , applying N
electrostatic forces on a test charge Q. The net force on Q is (see Equation 5.2)
196 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

We can rewrite this as

5.3

where

or, more compactly,

5.4

This expression is called the electric field at position of the N source charges. Here, P is the
location of the point in space where you are calculating the field and is relative to the positions of the source
charges (Figure 5.18). Note that we have to impose a coordinate system to solve actual problems.

Figure 5.18 Each of these eight source charges creates its own electric field at every point in space; shown here are the field vectors at an
arbitrary point P. Like the electric force, the net electric field obeys the superposition principle.

Notice that the calculation of the electric field makes no reference to the test charge. Thus, the physically
useful approach is to calculate the electric field and then use it to calculate the force on some test charge later,
if needed. Different test charges experience different forces Equation 5.3, but it is the same electric field
Equation 5.4. That being said, recall that there is no fundamental difference between a test charge and a
source charge; these are merely convenient labels for the system of interest. Any charge produces an electric
field; however, just as Earth’s orbit is not affected by Earth’s own gravity, a charge is not subject to a force due to
the electric field it generates. Charges are only subject to forces from the electric fields of other charges.

In this respect, the electric field of a point charge is similar to the gravitational field of Earth; once we have
calculated the gravitational field at some point in space, we can use it any time we want to calculate the

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.4 • Electric Field 197

resulting force on any mass we choose to place at that point. In fact, this is exactly what we do when we say the
gravitational field of Earth (near Earth’s surface) has a value of and then we calculate the resulting
force (i.e., weight) on different masses. Also, the general expression for calculating at arbitrary distances
from the center of Earth (i.e., not just near Earth’s surface) is very similar to the expression for : ,

where G is a proportionality constant, playing the same role for as does for . The value of is
calculated once and is then used in an endless number of problems.

To push the analogy further, notice the units of the electric field: From , the units of E are newtons per
coulomb, N/C, that is, the electric field applies a force on each unit charge. Now notice the units of g: From
, the units of g are newtons per kilogram, N/kg, that is, the gravitational field applies a force on each
unit mass. We could say that the gravitational field of Earth, near Earth’s surface, has a value of 9.81 N/kg.

The Meaning of “Field”


Recall from your studies of gravity that the word “field” in this context has a precise meaning. A field, in
physics, is a physical quantity whose value depends on (is a function of) position, relative to the source of the
field. In the case of the electric field, Equation 5.4 shows that the value of (both the magnitude and the
direction) depends on where in space the point P is located, measured from the locations of the source
charges .

In addition, since the electric field is a vector quantity, the electric field is referred to as a vector field. (The
gravitational field is also a vector field.) In contrast, a field that has only a magnitude at every point is a scalar
field. The temperature in a room is an example of a scalar field. It is a field because the temperature, in
general, is different at different locations in the room, and it is a scalar field because temperature is a scalar
quantity.

Also, as you did with the gravitational field of an object with mass, you should picture the electric field of a
charge-bearing object (the source charge) as a continuous, immaterial substance that surrounds the source
charge, filling all of space—in principle, to ∞ in all directions. The field exists at every physical point in space.
To put it another way, the electric charge on an object alters the space around the charged object in such a way
that all other electrically charged objects in space experience an electric force as a result of being in that field.
The electric field, then, is the mechanism by which the electric properties of the source charge are transmitted
to and through the rest of the universe. (Again, the range of the electric force is infinite.)

We will see in subsequent chapters that the speed at which electrical phenomena travel is the same as the
speed of light. There is a deep connection between the electric field and light.

Superposition
Yet another experimental fact about the field is that it obeys the superposition principle. In this context, that
means that we can (in principle) calculate the total electric field of many source charges by calculating the
electric field of only at position P, then calculate the field of at P, while—and this is the crucial
idea—ignoring the field of, and indeed even the existence of, We can repeat this process, calculating the
field of each individual source charge, independently of the existence of any of the other charges. The total
electric field, then, is the vector sum of all these fields. That, in essence, is what Equation 5.4 says.

In the next section, we describe how to determine the shape of an electric field of a source charge distribution
and how to sketch it.

The Direction of the Field


Equation 5.4 enables us to determine the magnitude of the electric field, but we need the direction also. We use
the convention that the direction of any electric field vector is the same as the direction of the electric force
vector that the field would apply to a positive test charge placed in that field. Such a charge would be repelled
by positive source charges (the force on it would point away from the positive source charge) but attracted to
negative charges (the force points toward the negative source).
198 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Direction of the Electric Field


By convention, all electric fields point away from positive source charges and point toward negative
source charges.

INTERACTIVE
Add charges to the Electric Field of Dreams (https://openstax.org/l/21elefiedream) and see how they react to
the electric field. Turn on a background electric field and adjust the direction and magnitude.

EXAMPLE 5.3

The E-field of an Atom


In an ionized helium atom, the most probable distance between the nucleus and the electron is
. What is the electric field due to the nucleus at the location of the electron?

Strategy
Note that although the electron is mentioned, it is not used in any calculation. The problem asks for an electric
field, not a force; hence, there is only one charge involved, and the problem specifically asks for the field due to
the nucleus. Thus, the electron is a red herring; only its distance matters. Also, since the distance between the
two protons in the nucleus is much, much smaller than the distance of the electron from the nucleus, we can
treat the two protons as a single charge +2e (Figure 5.19).

Figure 5.19 A schematic representation of a helium atom. Again, helium physically looks nothing like this, but this sort of diagram is
helpful for calculating the electric field of the nucleus.

Solution
The electric field is calculated by

Since there is only one source charge (the nucleus), this expression simplifies to

Here (since there are two protons) and r is given; substituting gives

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.4 • Electric Field 199

The direction of is radially away from the nucleus in all directions. Why? Because a positive test charge
placed in this field would accelerate radially away from the nucleus (since it is also positively charged), and
again, the convention is that the direction of the electric field vector is defined in terms of the direction of the
force it would apply to positive test charges.

EXAMPLE 5.4

The E-Field above Two Equal Charges


(a) Find the electric field (magnitude and direction) a distance z above the midpoint between two equal charges
that are a distance d apart (Figure 5.20). Check that your result is consistent with what you’d expect when
.

(b) The same as part (a), only this time make the right-hand charge instead of .

Figure 5.20 Finding the field of two identical source charges at the point P. Due to the symmetry, the net field at P is entirely vertical.
(Notice that this is not true away from the midline between the charges.)

Strategy
We add the two fields as vectors, per Equation 5.4. Notice that the system (and therefore the field) is
symmetrical about the vertical axis; as a result, the horizontal components of the field vectors cancel. This
simplifies the math. Also, we take care to express our final answer in terms of only quantities that are given in
the original statement of the problem: q, z, d, and constants

Solution

a. By symmetry, the horizontal (x)-components of cancel (Figure 5.21);


.
200 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Figure 5.21 Note that the horizontal components of the electric fields from the two charges cancel each other out, while the vertical
components add together.

The vertical (z)-component is given by

Since none of the other components survive, this is the entire electric field, and it points in the direction.
Notice that this calculation uses the principle of superposition; we calculate the fields of the two charges
independently and then add them together.
What we want to do now is replace the quantities in this expression that we don’t know (such as r), or can’t
easily measure (such as with quantities that we do know, or can measure. In this case, by geometry,

and

Thus, substituting,

Simplifying, the desired answer is

5.5

b. If the source charges are equal and opposite, the vertical components cancel because

and we get, for the horizontal component of ,

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.4 • Electric Field 201

This becomes

5.6

Significance
It is a very common and very useful technique in physics to check whether your answer is reasonable by
evaluating it at extreme cases. In this example, we should evaluate the field expressions for the cases ,
, and ∞ , and confirm that the resulting expressions match our physical expectations. Let’s do so:
Let’s start with Equation 5.5, the field of two identical charges. From far away (i.e., the two source
charges should “merge” and we should then “see” the field of just one charge, of size 2q. So, let then we
can neglect in Equation 5.5 to obtain

which is the correct expression for a field at a distance z away from a charge 2q.

Next, we consider the field of equal and opposite charges, Equation 5.6. It can be shown (via a Taylor
expansion) that for ∞ , this becomes

5.7

which is the field of a dipole, a system that we will study in more detail later. (Note that the units of are still
correct in this expression, since the units of d in the numerator cancel the unit of the “extra” z in the
denominator.) If z is very large ∞ , then , as it should; the two charges “merge” and so cancel out.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.3


What is the electric field due to a single point particle?

INTERACTIVE
Try this simulation of electric field hockey (https://openstax.org/l/21elefielhocke) to get the charge in the goal
by placing other charges on the field.
202 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain what a continuous source charge distribution is and how it is related to the concept of quantization
of charge
• Describe line charges, surface charges, and volume charges
• Calculate the field of a continuous source charge distribution of either sign

The charge distributions we have seen so far have been discrete: made up of individual point particles. This is
in contrast with a continuous charge distribution, which has at least one nonzero dimension. If a charge
distribution is continuous rather than discrete, we can generalize the definition of the electric field. We simply
divide the charge into infinitesimal pieces and treat each piece as a point charge.

Note that because charge is quantized, there is no such thing as a “truly” continuous charge distribution.
However, in most practical cases, the total charge creating the field involves such a huge number of discrete
charges that we can safely ignore the discrete nature of the charge and consider it to be continuous. This is
exactly the kind of approximation we make when we deal with a bucket of water as a continuous fluid, rather
than a collection of molecules.

Our first step is to define a charge density for a charge distribution along a line, across a surface, or within a
volume, as shown in Figure 5.22.

Figure 5.22 The configuration of charge differential elements for a (a) line charge, (b) sheet of charge, and (c) a volume of charge. Also
note that (d) some of the components of the total electric field cancel out, with the remainder resulting in a net electric field.

Definitions of charge density:

• charge per unit length (linear charge density); units are coulombs per meter (C/m)
• charge per unit area (surface charge density); units are coulombs per square meter
• charge per unit volume (volume charge density); units are coulombs per cubic meter

Then, for a line charge, a surface charge, and a volume charge, the summation in Equation 5.4 becomes an
integral and is replaced by , , or , respectively:

5.8

5.9

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.5 • Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions 203

5.10

5.11

The integrals are generalizations of the expression for the field of a point charge. They implicitly include and
assume the principle of superposition. The “trick” to using them is almost always in coming up with correct
expressions for dl, dA, or dV, as the case may be, expressed in terms of r, and also expressing the charge
density function appropriately. It may be constant; it might be dependent on location.

Note carefully the meaning of r in these equations: It is the distance from the charge element
to the location of interest, (the point in space where you want to determine the
field). However, don’t confuse this with the meaning of ; we are using it and the vector notation to write
three integrals at once. That is, Equation 5.9 is actually

EXAMPLE 5.5

Electric Field of a Line Segment


Find the electric field a distance z above the midpoint of a straight line segment of length L that carries a
uniform line charge density .

Strategy
Since this is a continuous charge distribution, we conceptually break the wire segment into differential pieces
of length dl, each of which carries a differential amount of charge . Then, we calculate the differential
field created by two symmetrically placed pieces of the wire, using the symmetry of the setup to simplify the
calculation (Figure 5.23). Finally, we integrate this differential field expression over the length of the wire (half
of it, actually, as we explain below) to obtain the complete electric field expression.

Figure 5.23 A uniformly charged segment of wire. The electric field at point P can be found by applying the superposition principle to
symmetrically placed charge elements and integrating.

Solution
Before we jump into it, what do we expect the field to “look like” from far away? Since it is a finite line segment,
from far away, it should look like a point charge. We will check the expression we get to see if it meets this
expectation.

The electric field for a line charge is given by the general expression
204 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

The symmetry of the situation (our choice of the two identical differential pieces of charge) implies the
horizontal (x)-components of the field cancel, so that the net field points in the z-direction. Let’s check this
formally.

The total field is the vector sum of the fields from each of the two charge elements (call them and ,
for now):

Because the two charge elements are identical and are the same distance away from the point P where we want
to calculate the field, so those components cancel. This leaves

These components are also equal, so we have

where our differential line element dl is dx, in this example, since we are integrating along a line of charge that
lies on the x-axis. (The limits of integration are 0 to , not to , because we have constructed the net
field from two differential pieces of charge dq. If we integrated along the entire length, we would pick up an
erroneous factor of 2.)

In principle, this is complete. However, to actually calculate this integral, we need to eliminate all the variables
that are not given. In this case, both r and change as we integrate outward to the end of the line charge, so
those are the variables to get rid of. We can do that the same way we did for the two point charges: by noticing
that

and

Substituting, we obtain

which simplifies to

5.12

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.5 • Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions 205

Significance
Notice, once again, the use of symmetry to simplify the problem. This is a very common strategy for
calculating electric fields. The fields of nonsymmetrical charge distributions have to be handled with multiple
integrals and may need to be calculated numerically by a computer.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.4


How would the strategy used above change to calculate the electric field at a point a distance z above one end of
the finite line segment?

EXAMPLE 5.6

Electric Field of an Infinite Line of Charge


Find the electric field a distance z above the midpoint of an infinite line of charge that carries a uniform line
charge density .

Strategy
This is exactly like the preceding example, except the limits of integration will be ∞ to ∞ .
Solution
Again, the horizontal components cancel out, so we wind up with

where our differential line element dl is dx, in this example, since we are integrating along a line of charge that
lies on the x-axis. Again,

Substituting, we obtain


which simplifies to

Significance
Our strategy for working with continuous charge distributions also gives useful results for charges with infinite
dimension.

In the case of a finite line of charge, note that for , dominates the L in the denominator, so that
206 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

Equation 5.12 simplifies to

If you recall that , the total charge on the wire, we have retrieved the expression for the field of a point
charge, as expected.

In the limit ∞ , on the other hand, we get the field of an infinite straight wire, which is a straight wire
whose length is much, much greater than either of its other dimensions, and also much, much greater than the
distance at which the field is to be calculated:

5.13

An interesting artifact of this infinite limit is that we have lost the usual dependence that we are used to.
This will become even more intriguing in the case of an infinite plane.

EXAMPLE 5.7

Electric Field due to a Ring of Charge


A ring has a uniform charge density , with units of coulomb per unit meter of arc. Find the electric field at a
point on the axis passing through the center of the ring.

Strategy
We use the same procedure as for the charged wire. The difference here is that the charge is distributed on a
circle. We divide the circle into infinitesimal elements shaped as arcs on the circle and use polar coordinates
shown in Figure 5.24.

Figure 5.24 The system and variable for calculating the electric field due to a ring of charge.

Solution
The electric field for a line charge is given by the general expression

A general element of the arc between and is of length and therefore contains a charge equal to
The element is at a distance of from P, the angle is , and therefore the

electric field is

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.5 • Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions 207

Significance
As usual, symmetry simplified this problem, in this particular case resulting in a trivial integral. Also, when we
take the limit of , we find that

as we expect.

EXAMPLE 5.8

The Field of a Disk


Find the electric field of a circular thin disk of radius R and uniform charge density at a distance z above the
center of the disk (Figure 5.25)

Figure 5.25 A uniformly charged disk. As in the line charge example, the field above the center of this disk can be calculated by taking
advantage of the symmetry of the charge distribution.

Strategy
The electric field for a surface charge is given by

To solve surface charge problems, we break the surface into symmetrical differential “stripes” that match the
shape of the surface; here, we’ll use rings, as shown in the figure. Again, by symmetry, the horizontal
components cancel and the field is entirely in the vertical direction. The vertical component of the electric
field is extracted by multiplying by , so
208 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

As before, we need to rewrite the unknown factors in the integrand in terms of the given quantities. In this
case,

(Please take note of the two different “r’s” here; r is the distance from the differential ring of charge to the point
P where we wish to determine the field, whereas is the distance from the center of the disk to the differential
ring of charge.) Also, we already performed the polar angle integral in writing down dA.

Solution
Substituting all this in, we get

or, more simply,

5.14

Significance
Again, it can be shown (via a Taylor expansion) that when , this reduces to

which is the expression for a point charge

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.5


How would the above limit change with a uniformly charged rectangle instead of a disk?

As ∞ , Equation 5.14 reduces to the field of an infinite plane, which is a flat sheet whose area is much,
much greater than its thickness, and also much, much greater than the distance at which the field is to be
calculated:

5.15

Note that this field is constant. This surprising result is, again, an artifact of our limit, although one that we will
make use of repeatedly in the future. To understand why this happens, imagine being placed above an infinite
plane of constant charge. Does the plane look any different if you vary your altitude? No—you still see the plane
going off to infinity, no matter how far you are from it. It is important to note that Equation 5.15 is because we
are above the plane. If we were below, the field would point in the direction.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.5 • Calculating Electric Fields of Charge Distributions 209

EXAMPLE 5.9

The Field of Two Infinite Planes


Find the electric field everywhere resulting from two infinite planes with equal but opposite charge densities
(Figure 5.26).

Figure 5.26 Two charged infinite planes. Note the direction of the electric field.

Strategy
We already know the electric field resulting from a single infinite plane, so we may use the principle of
superposition to find the field from two.

Solution
The electric field points away from the positively charged plane and toward the negatively charged plane. Since
the are equal and opposite, this means that in the region outside of the two planes, the electric fields cancel
each other out to zero.

However, in the region between the planes, the electric fields add, and we get

for the electric field. The is because in the figure, the field is pointing in the +x-direction.

Significance
Systems that may be approximated as two infinite planes of this sort provide a useful means of creating
uniform electric fields.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 5.6


What would the electric field look like in a system with two parallel positively charged planes with equal charge
densities?
210 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

5.6 Electric Field Lines


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the purpose of an electric field diagram
• Describe the relationship between a vector diagram and a field line diagram
• Explain the rules for creating a field diagram and why these rules make physical sense
• Sketch the field of an arbitrary source charge

Now that we have some experience calculating electric fields, let’s try to gain some insight into the geometry of
electric fields. As mentioned earlier, our model is that the charge on an object (the source charge) alters space
in the region around it in such a way that when another charged object (the test charge) is placed in that region
of space, that test charge experiences an electric force. The concept of electric field lines, and of electric field
line diagrams, enables us to visualize the way in which the space is altered, allowing us to visualize the field.
The purpose of this section is to enable you to create sketches of this geometry, so we will list the specific steps
and rules involved in creating an accurate and useful sketch of an electric field.

It is important to remember that electric fields are three-dimensional. Although in this book we include some
pseudo-three-dimensional images, several of the diagrams that you’ll see (both here, and in subsequent
chapters) will be two-dimensional projections, or cross-sections. Always keep in mind that in fact, you’re
looking at a three-dimensional phenomenon.

Our starting point is the physical fact that the electric field of the source charge causes a test charge in that
field to experience a force. By definition, electric field vectors point in the same direction as the electric force
that a (hypothetical) positive test charge would experience, if placed in the field (Figure 5.27)

Figure 5.27 The electric field of a positive point charge. A large number of field vectors are shown. Like all vector arrows, the length of
each vector is proportional to the magnitude of the field at each point. (a) Field in two dimensions; (b) field in three dimensions.

We’ve plotted many field vectors in the figure, which are distributed uniformly around the source charge. Since
the electric field is a vector, the arrows that we draw correspond at every point in space to both the magnitude
and the direction of the field at that point. As always, the length of the arrow that we draw corresponds to the
magnitude of the field vector at that point. For a point source charge, the length decreases by the square of the
distance from the source charge. In addition, the direction of the field vector is radially away from the source
charge, because the direction of the electric field is defined by the direction of the force that a positive test

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.6 • Electric Field Lines 211

charge would experience in that field. (Again, keep in mind that the actual field is three-dimensional; there are
also field lines pointing out of and into the page.)

This diagram is correct, but it becomes less useful as the source charge distribution becomes more
complicated. For example, consider the vector field diagram of a dipole (Figure 5.28).

Figure 5.28 The vector field of a dipole. Even with just two identical charges, the vector field diagram becomes difficult to understand.

There is a more useful way to present the same information. Rather than drawing a large number of
increasingly smaller vector arrows, we instead connect all of them together, forming continuous lines and
curves, as shown in Figure 5.29.

Figure 5.29 (a) The electric field line diagram of a positive point charge. (b) The field line diagram of a dipole. In both diagrams, the
magnitude of the field is indicated by the field line density. The field vectors (not shown here) are everywhere tangent to the field lines.

Although it may not be obvious at first glance, these field diagrams convey the same information about the
electric field as do the vector diagrams. First, the direction of the field at every point is simply the direction of
the field vector at that same point. In other words, at any point in space, the field vector at each point is tangent
212 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

to the field line at that same point. The arrowhead placed on a field line indicates its direction.

As for the magnitude of the field, that is indicated by the field line density—that is, the number of field lines
per unit area passing through a small cross-sectional area perpendicular to the electric field. This field line
density is drawn to be proportional to the magnitude of the field at that cross-section. As a result, if the field
lines are close together (that is, the field line density is greater), this indicates that the magnitude of the field is
large at that point. If the field lines are far apart at the cross-section, this indicates the magnitude of the field is
small. Figure 5.30 shows the idea.

Figure 5.30 Electric field lines passing through imaginary areas. Since the number of lines passing through each area is the same, but the
areas themselves are different, the field line density is different. This indicates different magnitudes of the electric field at these points.

In Figure 5.30, the same number of field lines passes through both surfaces (S and but the surface S is
larger than surface . Therefore, the density of field lines (number of lines per unit area) is larger at the
location of , indicating that the electric field is stronger at the location of than at S. The rules for creating
an electric field diagram are as follows.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Drawing Electric Field Lines


1. Electric field lines either originate on positive charges or come in from infinity, and either terminate on
negative charges or extend out to infinity.
2. The number of field lines originating or terminating at a charge is proportional to the magnitude of that
charge. A charge of 2q will have twice as many lines as a charge of q.
3. At every point in space, the field vector at that point is tangent to the field line at that same point.
4. The field line density at any point in space is proportional to (and therefore is representative of) the
magnitude of the field at that point in space.
5. Field lines can never cross. Since a field line represents the direction of the field at a given point, if two
field lines crossed at some point, that would imply that the electric field was pointing in two different

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.7 • Electric Dipoles 213

directions at a single point. This in turn would suggest that the (net) force on a test charge placed at that
point would point in two different directions. Since this is obviously impossible, it follows that field lines
must never cross.

Always keep in mind that field lines serve only as a convenient way to visualize the electric field; they are not
physical entities. Although the direction and relative intensity of the electric field can be deduced from a set of
field lines, the lines can also be misleading. For example, the field lines drawn to represent the electric field in
a region must, by necessity, be discrete. However, the actual electric field in that region exists at every point in
space.

Field lines for three groups of discrete charges are shown in Figure 5.31. Since the charges in parts (a) and (b)
have the same magnitude, the same number of field lines are shown starting from or terminating on each
charge. In (c), however, we draw three times as many field lines leaving the charge as entering the . The
field lines that do not terminate at emanate outward from the charge configuration, to infinity.

Figure 5.31 Three typical electric field diagrams. (a) A dipole. (b) Two identical charges. (c) Two charges with opposite signs and different
magnitudes. Can you tell from the diagram which charge has the larger magnitude?

The ability to construct an accurate electric field diagram is an important, useful skill; it makes it much easier
to estimate, predict, and therefore calculate the electric field of a source charge. The best way to develop this
skill is with software that allows you to place source charges and then will draw the net field upon request. We
strongly urge you to search the Internet for a program. Once you’ve found one you like, run several simulations
to get the essential ideas of field diagram construction. Then practice drawing field diagrams, and checking
your predictions with the computer-drawn diagrams.

INTERACTIVE
One example of a field-line drawing program (https://openstax.org/l/21fieldlindrapr) is from the PhET
“Charges and Fields” simulation.

5.7 Electric Dipoles


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe a permanent dipole
• Describe an induced dipole
• Define and calculate an electric dipole moment
• Explain the physical meaning of the dipole moment

Earlier we discussed, and calculated, the electric field of a dipole: two equal and opposite charges that are
“close” to each other. (In this context, “close” means that the distance d between the two charges is much,
214 5 • Electric Charges and Fields

much less than the distance of the field point P, the location where you are calculating the field.) Let’s now
consider what happens to a dipole when it is placed in an external field . We assume that the dipole is a
permanent dipole; it exists without the field, and does not break apart in the external field.

Rotation of a Dipole due to an Electric Field


For now, we deal with only the simplest case: The external field is uniform in space. Suppose we have the
situation depicted in Figure 5.32, where we denote the distance between the charges as the vector pointing
from the negative charge to the positive charge. The forces on the two charges are equal and opposite, so there
is no net force on the dipole. However, there is a torque:

Figure 5.32 A dipole in an external electric field. (a) The net force on the dipole is zero, but the net torque is not. As a result, the dipole
rotates, becoming aligned with the external field. (b) The dipole moment is a convenient way to characterize this effect. The points in the
same direction as .

The quantity (the magnitude of each charge multiplied by the vector distance between them) is a property
of the dipole; its value, as you can see, determines the torque that the dipole experiences in the external field. It
is useful, therefore, to define this product as the so-called dipole moment of the dipole:

5.16

We can therefore write

5.17

Recall that a torque changes the angular velocity of an object, the dipole, in this case. In this situation, the
effect is to rotate the dipole (that is, align the direction of so that it is parallel to the direction of the external
field.

Induced Dipoles
Neutral atoms are, by definition, electrically neutral; they have equal amounts of positive and negative charge.
Furthermore, since they are spherically symmetrical, they do not have a “built-in” dipole moment the way
most asymmetrical molecules do. They obtain one, however, when placed in an external electric field, because
the external field causes oppositely directed forces on the positive nucleus of the atom versus the negative
electrons that surround the nucleus. The result is a new charge distribution of the atom, and therefore, an
induced dipole moment (Figure 5.33).

Access for free at openstax.org.


5.7 • Electric Dipoles 215

Figure 5.33 A dipole is induced in a neutral atom by an external electric field. The induced dipole moment is aligned with the external
field.

An important fact here is that, just as for a rotated polar molecule, the result is that the dipole moment ends up
aligned parallel to the external electric field. Generally, the magnitude of an induced dipole is much smaller
than that of an inherent dipole. For both kinds of dipoles, notice that once the alignment of the dipole (rotated
or induced) is complete, the net effect is to decrease the total electric field in the
regions inside the dipole charges (Figure 5.34). By “inside” we mean in between the charges. This effect is
crucial for capacitors, as you will see in Capacitance.

Figure 5.34 The net electric field is the vector sum of the field of the dipole plus the external field.

Recall that we found the electric field of a dipole in Equation 5.7. If we rewrite it in terms of the dipole moment
we get:

The form of this field is shown in Figure 5.34. Notice that along the plane perpendicular to the axis of the
dipole and midway between the charges, the direction of the electric field is opposite that of the dipole and gets
weaker the further from the axis one goes. Similarly, on the axis of the dipole (but outside it), the field points in
the same direction as the dipole, again getting weaker the further one gets from the charges.
216 5 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
charging by induction process by which an indicates the direction of the electric field
electrically charged object brought near a neutral field line density number of field lines per square
object creates a charge separation in that object meter passing through an imaginary area; its
conduction electron electron that is free to move purpose is to indicate the field strength at
away from its atomic orbit different points in space
conductor material that allows electrons to move induced dipole typically an atom, or a spherically
separately from their atomic orbits; object with symmetric molecule; a dipole created due to
properties that allow charges to move about freely opposite forces displacing the positive and
within it negative charges
continuous charge distribution total source infinite plane flat sheet in which the dimensions
charge composed of so large a number of making up the area are much, much greater than
elementary charges that it must be treated as its thickness, and also much, much greater than
continuous, rather than discrete the distance at which the field is to be calculated;
coulomb SI unit of electric charge its field is constant
Coulomb force another term for the electrostatic infinite straight wire straight wire whose length is
force much, much greater than either of its other
Coulomb’s law mathematical equation calculating dimensions, and also much, much greater than
the electrostatic force vector between two the distance at which the field is to be calculated
charged particles insulator material that holds electrons securely
dipole two equal and opposite charges that are within their atomic orbits
fixed close to each other ion atom or molecule with more or fewer electrons
dipole moment property of a dipole; it than protons
characterizes the combination of distance law of conservation of charge net electric charge
between the opposite charges, and the magnitude of a closed system is constant
of the charges linear charge density amount of charge in an
electric charge physical property of an object that element of a charge distribution that is essentially
causes it to be attracted toward or repelled from one-dimensional (the width and height are much,
another charged object; each charged object much smaller than its length); its units are C/m
generates and is influenced by a force called an neutron neutral particle in the nucleus of an atom,
electric force with (nearly) the same mass as a proton
electric field physical phenomenon created by a permanent dipole typically a molecule; a dipole
charge; it “transmits” a force between a two created by the arrangement of the charged
charges particles from which the dipole is created
electric force noncontact force observed between permittivity of vacuum also called the permittivity
electrically charged objects of free space, and constant describing the
electron particle surrounding the nucleus of an strength of the electric force in a vacuum
atom and carrying the smallest unit of negative polarization slight shifting of positive and negative
charge charges to opposite sides of an object
electrostatic attraction phenomenon of two principle of superposition useful fact that we can
objects with opposite charges attracting each simply add up all of the forces due to charges
other acting on an object
electrostatic force amount and direction of proton particle in the nucleus of an atom and
attraction or repulsion between two charged carrying a positive charge equal in magnitude to
bodies; the assumption is that the source charges the amount of negative charge carried by an
have no acceleration electron
electrostatic repulsion phenomenon of two static electricity buildup of electric charge on the
objects with like charges repelling each other surface of an object; the arrangement of the
electrostatics study of charged objects which are charge remains constant (“static”)
not in motion superposition concept that states that the net
field line smooth, usually curved line that electric field of multiple source charges is the

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 217

vector sum of the field of each source charge (the thickness is small); its units are
calculated individually volume charge density amount of charge in an
surface charge density amount of charge in an element of a three-dimensional charge
element of a two-dimensional charge distribution distribution; its units are

Key Equations

Coulomb’s law

Superposition of electric forces

Electric force due to an electric field

Electric field at point P

Field of an infinite wire

Field of an infinite plane

Dipole moment

Torque on dipole in external E-field

Summary
5.1 Electric Charge neutral objects and can be separated by
bringing the two objects into physical contact;
• There are only two types of charge, which we
rubbing the objects together can remove
call positive and negative. Like charges repel,
electrons from the bonds in one object and
unlike charges attract, and the force between
place them on the other object, increasing the
charges decreases with the square of the
charge separation.
distance.
• For macroscopic objects, negatively charged
• The vast majority of positive charge in nature is
means an excess of electrons and positively
carried by protons, whereas the vast majority of
charged means a depletion of electrons.
negative charge is carried by electrons. The
• The law of conservation of charge states that the
electric charge of one electron is equal in
net charge of a closed system is constant.
magnitude and opposite in sign to the charge of
one proton. 5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging
• An ion is an atom or molecule that has nonzero by Induction
total charge due to having unequal numbers of
• A conductor is a substance that allows charge to
electrons and protons.
flow freely through its atomic structure.
• The SI unit for charge is the coulomb (C), with
• An insulator holds charge fixed in place.
protons and electrons having charges of
• Polarization is the separation of positive and
opposite sign but equal magnitude; the
negative charges in a neutral object. Polarized
magnitude of this basic charge is
objects have their positive and negative charges
concentrated in different areas, giving them a
• Both positive and negative charges exist in
218 5 • Chapter Review

charge distribution. charge density


◦ three-dimensional (metal sphere); uses
5.3 Coulomb's Law volume charge density
• Coulomb’s law gives the magnitude of the force
• The “source charge” is a differential amount of
vector between point charges. It is
charge dq. Calculating dq depends on the type of
source charge distribution:

where and are two point charges • Symmetry of the charge distribution is usually
separated by a distance r. This Coulomb force is key.
extremely basic, since most charges are due to • Important special cases are the field of an
point-like particles. It is responsible for all “infinite” wire and the field of an “infinite”
electrostatic effects and underlies most plane.
macroscopic forces.
5.6 Electric Field Lines
5.4 Electric Field
• Electric field diagrams assist in visualizing the
• The electric field is an alteration of space caused field of a source charge.
by the presence of an electric charge. The • The magnitude of the field is proportional to the
electric field mediates the electric force between field line density.
a source charge and a test charge. • Field vectors are everywhere tangent to field
• The electric field, like the electric force, obeys lines.
the superposition principle
• The field is a vector; by definition, it points away
5.7 Electric Dipoles
from positive charges and toward negative • If a permanent dipole is placed in an external
charges. electric field, it results in a torque that aligns it
with the external field.
5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge
• If a nonpolar atom (or molecule) is placed in an
Distributions
external field, it gains an induced dipole that is
• A very large number of charges can be treated aligned with the external field.
as a continuous charge distribution, where the • The net field is the vector sum of the external
calculation of the field requires integration. field plus the field of the dipole (physical or
Common cases are: induced).
◦ one-dimensional (like a wire); uses a line • The strength of the polarization is described by
charge density the dipole moment of the dipole, .
◦ two-dimensional (metal plate); uses surface

Conceptual Questions
5.1 Electric Charge a particular rod is positive or negative?

1. There are very large numbers of charged


5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging
particles in most objects. Why, then, don’t most
objects exhibit static electricity?
by Induction
2. Why do most objects tend to contain nearly equal 6. An eccentric inventor attempts to levitate a cork
numbers of positive and negative charges? ball by wrapping it with foil and placing a large
3. A positively charged rod attracts a small piece of negative charge on the ball and then putting a
cork. (a) Can we conclude that the cork is large positive charge on the ceiling of his
negatively charged? (b) The rod repels another workshop. Instead, while attempting to place a
small piece of cork. Can we conclude that this large negative charge on the ball, the foil flies off.
piece is positively charged? Explain.
4. Two bodies attract each other electrically. Do 7. When a glass rod is rubbed with silk, it becomes
they both have to be charged? Answer the same positive and the silk becomes negative—yet both
question if the bodies repel one another. attract dust. Does the dust have a third type of
5. How would you determine whether the charge on charge that is attracted to both positive and

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 219

negative? Explain. necessarily charged? (b) If q is repelled by the


8. Why does a car always attract dust right after it is plate, is the plate necessarily charged?
polished? (Note that car wax and car tires are
insulators.) 5.3 Coulomb's Law
9. Does the uncharged conductor shown below
20. Would defining the charge on an electron to be
experience a net electric force?
positive have any effect on Coulomb’s law?
21. An atomic nucleus contains positively charged
protons and uncharged neutrons. Since nuclei
do stay together, what must we conclude about
the forces between these nuclear particles?
22. Is the force between two fixed charges
influenced by the presence of other charges?

5.4 Electric Field


23. When measuring an electric field, could we use
a negative rather than a positive test charge?
24. During fair weather, the electric field due to the
net charge on Earth points downward. Is Earth
charged positively or negatively?
25. If the electric field at a point on the line between
two charges is zero, what do you know about the
10. While walking on a rug, a person frequently charges?
becomes charged because of the rubbing 26. Two charges lie along the x-axis. Is it true that
between his shoes and the rug. This charge then the net electric field always vanishes at some
causes a spark and a slight shock when the point (other than infinity) along the x-axis?
person gets close to a metal object. Why are
these shocks so much more common on a dry 5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge
day? Distributions
11. Compare charging by conduction to charging by
induction. 27. Give a plausible argument as to why the electric
12. Small pieces of tissue are attracted to a charged field outside an infinite charged sheet is
comb. Soon after sticking to the comb, the constant.
pieces of tissue are repelled from it. Explain. 28. Compare the electric fields of an infinite sheet
13. Trucks that carry gasoline often have chains of charge, an infinite, charged conducting plate,
dangling from their undercarriages and and infinite, oppositely charged parallel plates.
brushing the ground. Why? 29. Describe the electric fields of an infinite
14. Why do electrostatic experiments work so charged plate and of two infinite, charged
poorly in humid weather? parallel plates in terms of the electric field of an
15. Why do some clothes cling together after being infinite sheet of charge.
removed from the clothes dryer? Does this 30. A negative charge is placed at the center of a
happen if they’re still damp? ring of uniform positive charge. What is the
16. Can induction be used to produce charge on an motion (if any) of the charge? What if the charge
insulator? were placed at a point on the axis of the ring
17. Suppose someone tells you that rubbing quartz other than the center?
with cotton cloth produces a third kind of
charge on the quartz. Describe what you might 5.6 Electric Field Lines
do to test this claim. 31. If a point charge is released from rest in a
18. A handheld copper rod does not acquire a uniform electric field, will it follow a field line?
charge when you rub it with a cloth. Explain Will it do so if the electric field is not uniform?
why. 32. Under what conditions, if any, will the trajectory
19. Suppose you place a charge q near a large metal of a charged particle not follow a field line?
plate. (a) If q is attracted to the plate, is the plate 33. How would you experimentally distinguish an
220 5 • Chapter Review

electric field from a gravitational field? 5.7 Electric Dipoles


34. A representation of an electric field shows 10
36. What are the stable orientation(s) for a dipole in
field lines perpendicular to a square plate. How
an external electric field? What happens if the
many field lines should pass perpendicularly
dipole is slightly perturbed from these
through the plate to depict a field with twice the
orientations?
magnitude?
35. What is the ratio of the number of electric field
lines leaving a charge 10q and a charge q?

Problems
5.1 Electric Charge has been removed? (Each copper atom has 29
protons, and copper has an atomic mass of
37. Common static electricity involves charges
63.5.)
ranging from nanocoulombs to microcoulombs.
46. What net charge would you place on a 100-g
(a) How many electrons are needed to form a
piece of sulfur if you put an extra electron on 1
charge of −2.00 nC? (b) How many electrons
in of its atoms? (Sulfur has an atomic mass
must be removed from a neutral object to leave
of 32.1 u.)
a net charge of ?
47. How many coulombs of positive charge are
38. If electrons move through a pocket
there in 4.00 kg of plutonium, given its atomic
calculator during a full day’s operation, how
mass is 244 and that each plutonium atom has
many coulombs of charge moved through it?
94 protons?
39. To start a car engine, the car battery moves
electrons through the starter
5.3 Coulomb's Law
motor. How many coulombs of charge were
moved? 48. Two point particles with charges and
40. A certain lightning bolt moves 40.0 C of charge. are held in place by 3-N forces on each
How many fundamental units of charge is this? charge in appropriate directions. (a) Draw a
41. A 2.5-g copper penny is given a charge of free-body diagram for each particle. (b) Find the
. (a) How many excess electrons distance between the charges.
are on the penny? (b) By what percent do the 49. Two charges and are fixed 1 m
excess electrons change the mass of the penny? apart, with the second one to the right. Find the
42. A 2.5-g copper penny is given a charge of magnitude and direction of the net force on a
. (a) How many electrons are −2-nC charge when placed at the following
removed from the penny? (b) If no more than locations: (a) halfway between the two (b) half a
one electron is removed from an atom, what meter to the left of the charge (c) half a
percent of the atoms are ionized by this meter above the charge in a direction
charging process? perpendicular to the line joining the two fixed
charges
5.2 Conductors, Insulators, and Charging 50. In a salt crystal, the distance between adjacent
by Induction sodium and chloride ions is
What is the force of attraction between the two
43. Suppose a speck of dust in an electrostatic singly charged ions?
precipitator has protons in it 51. Protons in an atomic nucleus are typically
and has a net charge of −5.00 nC (a very large apart. What is the electric force of
charge for a small speck). How many electrons repulsion between nuclear protons?
does it have? 52. Suppose Earth and the Moon each carried a net
44. An amoeba has protons and a net negative charge −Q. Approximate both bodies as
charge of 0.300 pC. (a) How many fewer point masses and point charges.
electrons are there than protons? (b) If you (a) What value of Q is required to balance the
paired them up, what fraction of the protons gravitational attraction between Earth and the
would have no electrons? Moon?
45. A 50.0-g ball of copper has a net charge of (b) Does the distance between Earth and the
. What fraction of the copper’s electrons Moon affect your answer? Explain.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 221

(c) How many electrons would be needed to removed, they repel each other with a force of
produce this charge? 0.060 N. What is the original charge on each
53. Point charges and are sphere?
placed 1.0 m apart. What is the force on a third 59. A charge is placed at the point P
charge placed midway between shown below. What is the force on q?
and ?
54. Where must of the preceding problem be
placed so that the net force on it is zero? 60. What is the net electric force on the charge
55. Two small balls, each of mass 5.0 g, are attached located at the lower right-hand corner of the
to silk threads 50 cm long, which are in turn triangle shown here?
tied to the same point on the ceiling, as shown
below. When the balls are given the same
charge Q, the threads hang at to the
vertical, as shown below. What is the magnitude
of Q? What are the signs of the two charges?

61. Two fixed particles, each of charge


are 24 cm apart. What force do
they exert on a third particle of charge
that is 13 cm from each of
them?
62. The charges
and
are placed at the corners
of the triangle shown below. What is the force on

56. Point charges and


are located at and
. What is the force of
on ? 63. What is the force on the charge q at the lower-
57. The net excess charge on two small spheres right-hand corner of the square shown here?
(small enough to be treated as point charges) is
Q. Show that the force of repulsion between the
spheres is greatest when each sphere has an
excess charge Q/2. Assume that the distance
between the spheres is so large compared with
their radii that the spheres can be treated as
point charges.
58. Two small, identical conducting spheres repel
each other with a force of 0.050 N when they are
0.25 m apart. After a conducting wire is
connected between the spheres and then
222 5 • Chapter Review

64. Point charges and are


fixed at and
What is the force of
? 69. What is the electric field at a point where the
force on a charge is
5.4 Electric Field
70. A proton is suspended in the air by an electric
65. A particle of charge experiences field at the surface of Earth. What is the strength
an upward force of magnitude of this electric field?
when it is placed in a particular point in an 71. The electric field in a particular thundercloud is
electric field. (a) What is the electric field at that What is the acceleration of an
point? (b) If a charge is electron in this field?
placed there, what is the force on it? 72. A small piece of cork whose mass is 2.0 g is
66. On a typical clear day, the atmospheric electric given a charge of What electric
field points downward and has a magnitude of field is needed to place the cork in equilibrium
approximately 100 N/C. Compare the under the combined electric and gravitational
gravitational and electric forces on a small dust forces?
particle of mass that carries a 73. If the electric field is at a distance of 50
single electron charge. What is the acceleration cm from a point charge q, what is the value of q?
(both magnitude and direction) of the dust 74. What is the electric field of a proton at the first
particle? Bohr orbit for hydrogen
67. Consider an electron that is from an What is the force on the electron in that orbit?
alpha particle (a) What is 75. (a) What is the electric field of an oxygen
the electric field due to the alpha particle at the nucleus at a point that is from the
location of the electron? (b) What is the electric nucleus? (b) What is the force this electric field
field due to the electron at the location of the exerts on a second oxygen nucleus placed at
alpha particle? (c) What is the electric force on that point?
the alpha particle? On the electron? 76. Two point charges, and
68. Each the balls shown below carries a charge q are held 25.0 cm apart.
and has a mass m. The length of each thread is (a) What is the electric field at a point 5.0 cm
l, and at equilibrium, the balls are separated by from the negative charge and along the line
an angle . How does vary with q and l? Show between the two charges? (b)What is the force
that satisfies on an electron placed at that point?
. 77. Point charges and are
placed 1.0 m apart. (a) What is the electric field
at a point midway between them? (b) What is
the force on a charge situated there?
78. Can you arrange the two point charges
and
along the x-axis so that at the origin?
79. Point charges are fixed

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 223

on the x-axis at and 2,0 cm above the plate, how much work is done
What charge q must be placed at the origin so on it by the electric field?
that the electric field vanishes at 87. A total charge q is distributed uniformly along a thin,
straight rod of length L (see below). What is the
electric field at
5.5 Calculating Electric Fields of Charge
Distributions
80. A thin conducting plate 1.0 m on the side is
given a charge of . An electron is
placed 1.0 cm above the center of the plate.
What is the acceleration of the electron? 88. Charge is distributed along the entire x-axis
81. Calculate the magnitude and direction of the with uniform density How much work does
electric field 2.0 m from a long wire that is the electric field of this charge distribution do
charged uniformly at on an electron that moves along the y-axis from
82. Two thin conducting plates, each 25.0 cm on a
side, are situated parallel to one another and 5.0 89. Charge is distributed along the entire x-axis
mm apart. If electrons are moved from one with uniform density and along the entire
plate to the other, what is the electric field y-axis with uniform density Calculate the
between the plates? resulting electric field at (a) and (b)
83. The charge per unit length on the thin rod shown
below is . What is the electric field at the point P? 90. A rod bent into the arc of a circle subtends an
(Hint: Solve this problem by first considering the angle at the center P of the circle (see below).
electric field at P due to a small segment dx of the If the rod is charged uniformly with a total
rod, which contains charge . Then find the charge Q, what is the electric field at P?
net field by integrating over the length of the
rod.)

84. The charge per unit length on the thin


semicircular wire shown below is . What is the
electric field at the point P?
91. A proton moves in the electric field
(a) What are the force on and the
acceleration of the proton? (b) Do the same
calculation for an electron moving in this field.
92. An electron and a proton, each starting from
rest, are accelerated by the same uniform
electric field of 200 N/C. Determine the distance
85. Two thin parallel conducting plates are placed and time for each particle to acquire a kinetic
2.0 cm apart. Each plate is 2.0 cm on a side; one energy of
plate carries a net charge of and the 93. A spherical water droplet of radius
other plate carries a net charge of carries an excess 250 electrons. What vertical
What is the charge density on the inside surface electric field is needed to balance the
of each plate? What is the electric field between gravitational force on the droplet at the surface
the plates? of the earth?
86. A thin conducting plate 2.0 m on a side is given 94. A proton enters the uniform electric field produced
a total charge of . (a) What is the by the two charged plates shown below. The
electric field above the plate? (b) What is magnitude of the electric field is and
the force on an electron at this point? (c) Repeat the speed of the proton when it enters is
these calculations for a point 2.0 cm above the What distance d has the proton been
plate. (d) When the electron moves from 1.0 to
224 5 • Chapter Review

deflected downward when it leaves the plates?

95. Shown below is a small sphere of mass 0.25 g


that carries a charge of The
sphere is attached to one end of a very thin silk
string 5.0 cm long. The other end of the string is
attached to a large vertical conducting plate that
has a charge density of What
98. From a distance of 10 cm, a proton is projected
is the angle that the string makes with the
with a speed of directly at a
vertical?
large, positively charged plate whose charge
density is (See below.)
(a) Does the proton reach the plate? (b) If not,
how far from the plate does it turn around?

96. Two infinite rods, each carrying a uniform charge


density are parallel to one another and
perpendicular to the plane of the page. (See
below.) What is the electrical field at
99. A particle of mass m and charge moves
along a straight line away from a fixed particle
of charge Q. When the distance between the two
particles is is moving with a speed (a)
Use the work-energy theorem to calculate the
maximum separation of the charges. (b) What
do you have to assume about to make this
calculation? (c) What is the minimum value of
97. Positive charge is distributed with a uniform
such that escapes from Q?
density along the positive x-axis from ∞
along the positive y-axis from ∞ and along 5.6 Electric Field Lines
a arc of a circle of radius r, as shown below.
100. Which of the following electric field lines are
What is the electric field at O?
incorrect for point charges? Explain why.

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 225

consists of two electric dipoles that are placed


anti-parallel at two edges of a square as shown.

Draw the electric field of the charge


distribution.
104. Suppose the electric field of an isolated point
charge decreased with distance as
rather than as . Show that it is then
impossible to draw continous field lines so that
their number per unit area is proportional to
E.

5.7 Electric Dipoles


105. Consider the equal and opposite charges
shown below. (a) Show that at all points on the
x-axis for which (b)
Show that at all points on the y-axis for which

101. In this exercise, you will practice drawing


electric field lines. Make sure you represent
both the magnitude and direction of the
electric field adequately. Note that the number
of lines into or out of charges is proportional to
the charges.
(a) Draw the electric field lines map for two
106. (a) What is the dipole moment of the
charges and situated 5 cm
configuration shown above? If , (b)
from each other.
what is the torque on this dipole with an
(b) Draw the electric field lines map for two
electric field of ? (c) What is the
charges and situated 5 cm
torque on this dipole with an electric field of
from each other.
? (d) What is the torque on
(c) Draw the electric field lines map for two
this dipole with an electric field of
charges and situated 5 cm
?
from each other.
107. A water molecule consists of two hydrogen
102. Draw the electric field for a system of three
atoms bonded with one oxygen atom. The
particles of charges and
bond angle between the two hydrogen atoms is
fixed at the corners of an equilateral triangle of
(see below). Calculate the net dipole
side 2 cm.
moment of a hypothetical water molecule
103. Two charges of equal magnitude but opposite
where the charge at the oxygen molecule is
sign make up an electric dipole. A quadrupole
226 5 • Chapter Review

−2e and at each hydrogen atom is +e. The net


dipole moment of the molecule is the vector
sum of the individual dipole moment between
the two O-Hs. The separation O-H is 0.9578
angstroms.

Additional Problems
108. Point charges and are 111. Four charged particles are positioned at the corners
located at and of a parallelogram as shown below. If and
. What is the force what is the net force on q?

of
109. What is the force on the charge shown
below?

112. A charge Q is fixed at the origin and a second


charge q moves along the x-axis, as shown
below. How much work is done on q by the
electric force when q moves from

110. What is the force on the charge placed


at the center of the square shown below?

113. A charge is released from rest


when it is 2.0 m from a fixed charge
What is the kinetic energy of q
when it is 1.0 m from Q?
114. What is the electric field at the midpoint M of
the hypotenuse of the triangle shown below?

Access for free at openstax.org.


5 • Chapter Review 227

115. Find the electric field at P for the charge 117. Point charges are placed at the four corners of
configurations shown below. a rectangle as shown below:

and
What is the electric field at P?

118. Three charges are positioned at the corners of


a parallelogram as shown below. (a) If
what is the electric field at the
unoccupied corner? (b) What is the force on a
charge placed at this corner?

119. A positive charge q is released from rest at the


origin of a rectangular coordinate system and
moves under the influence of the electric field
What is the kinetic energy
of q when it passes through
120. A particle of charge and mass m is placed
116. (a) What is the electric field at the lower-right- at the center of a uniformaly charged ring of
hand corner of the square shown below? (b) total charge Q and radius R. The particle is
What is the force on a charge q placed at that displaced a small distance along the axis
point? perpendicular to the plane of the ring and
released. Assuming that the particle is
constrained to move along the axis, show that
the particle oscillates in simple harmonic
motion with a frequency

121. Charge is distributed uniformly along the


entire y-axis with a density and along the
positive x-axis from with a
density What is the force between the two
distributions?
228 5 • Chapter Review

122. The circular arc shown below carries a charge 125. The charge per unit length on the thin rod
per unit length where is shown here is What is the electric force on
measured from the x-axis. What is the electric the point charge q? (See the preceding
field at the origin? problem.)

126. The charge per unit length on the thin


semicircular wire shown below is What is
the electric force on the point charge q? (See
the preceding problems.)
123. Calculate the electric field due to a uniformly
charged rod of length L, aligned with the x-axis
with one end at the origin; at a point P on the
z-axis.
124. The charge per unit length on the thin rod
shown below is What is the electric force on
the point charge q? Solve this problem by first
considering the electric force on q due to a
small segment of the rod, which contains
charge Then, find the net force by
integrating over the length of the rod.

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 6
Gauss's Law

Figure 6.1 This chapter introduces the concept of flux, which relates a physical quantity and the area through
which it is flowing. Although we introduce this concept with the electric field, the concept may be used for many
other quantities, such as fluid flow. (credit: modification of work by “Alessandro”/Flickr)

Chapter Outline

6.1 Electric Flux

6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law

6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law

6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium

INTRODUCTION Flux is a general and broadly applicable concept in physics. However, in this chapter, we
concentrate on the flux of the electric field. This allows us to introduce Gauss’s law, which is particularly useful
for finding the electric fields of charge distributions exhibiting spatial symmetry. The main topics discussed
here are

1. Electric flux. We define electric flux for both open and closed surfaces.
2. Gauss’s law. We derive Gauss’s law for an arbitrary charge distribution and examine the role of electric
flux in Gauss’s law.
3. Calculating electric fields with Gauss’s law. The main focus of this chapter is to explain how to use
Gauss’s law to find the electric fields of spatially symmetrical charge distributions. We discuss the
importance of choosing a Gaussian surface and provide examples involving the applications of Gauss’s
law.
230 6 • Gauss's Law

4. Electric fields in conductors. Gauss’s law provides useful insight into the absence of electric fields in
conducting materials.

So far, we have found that the electrostatic field begins and ends at point charges and that the field of a point
charge varies inversely with the square of the distance from that charge. These characteristics of the
electrostatic field lead to an important mathematical relationship known as Gauss’s law. This law is named in
honor of the extraordinary German mathematician and scientist Karl Friedrich Gauss (Figure 6.2). Gauss’s law
gives us an elegantly simple way of finding the electric field, and, as you will see, it can be much easier to use
than the integration method described in the previous chapter. However, there is a catch—Gauss’s law has a
limitation in that, while always true, it can be readily applied only for charge distributions with certain
symmetries.

Figure 6.2 Karl Friedrich Gauss (1777–1855) was a legendary mathematician of the nineteenth century. Although his major contributions
were to the field of mathematics, he also did important work in physics and astronomy.

6.1 Electric Flux


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define the concept of flux
• Describe electric flux
• Calculate electric flux for a given situation

The concept of flux describes how much of something goes through a given area. More formally, it is the dot
product of a vector field (in this chapter, the electric field) with an area. You may conceptualize the flux of an
electric field as a measure of the number of electric field lines passing through an area (Figure 6.3). The larger
the area, the more field lines go through it and, hence, the greater the flux; similarly, the stronger the electric
field is (represented by a greater density of lines), the greater the flux. On the other hand, if the area rotated so
that the plane is aligned with the field lines, none will pass through and there will be no flux.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.1 • Electric Flux 231

Figure 6.3 The flux of an electric field through the shaded area captures information about the “number” of electric field lines passing
through the area. The numerical value of the electric flux depends on the magnitudes of the electric field and the area, as well as the
relative orientation of the area with respect to the direction of the electric field.

A macroscopic analogy that might help you imagine this is to put a hula hoop in a flowing river. As you change
the angle of the hoop relative to the direction of the current, more or less of the flow will go through the hoop.
Similarly, the amount of flow through the hoop depends on the strength of the current and the size of the hoop.
Again, flux is a general concept; we can also use it to describe the amount of sunlight hitting a solar panel or
the amount of energy a telescope receives from a distant star, for example.

To quantify this idea, Figure 6.4(a) shows a planar surface of area that is perpendicular to the uniform
electric field If N field lines pass through , then we know from the definition of electric field lines
(Electric Charges and Fields) that or

The quantity is the electric flux through . We represent the electric flux through an open surface like
by the symbol . Electric flux is a scalar quantity and has an SI unit of newton-meters squared per coulomb
( ). Notice that may also be written as , demonstrating that electric flux is a measure
of the number of field lines crossing a surface.

Figure 6.4 (a) A planar surface of area is perpendicular to the electric field . N field lines cross surface . (b) A surface of
area whose projection onto the xz-plane is .The same number of field lines cross each surface.

Now consider a planar surface that is not perpendicular to the field. How would we represent the electric flux?
Figure 6.4(b) shows a surface of area that is inclined at an angle to the xz-plane and whose projection
in that plane is (area ). The areas are related by Because the same number of field lines
crosses both and , the fluxes through both surfaces must be the same. The flux through is therefore
Designating as a unit vector normal to (see Figure 6.4(b)), we obtain

INTERACTIVE
Check out this video (https://openstax.org/l/21fluxsizeangl) to observe what happens to the flux as the area
changes in size and angle, or the electric field changes in strength.
232 6 • Gauss's Law

Area Vector
For discussing the flux of a vector field, it is helpful to introduce an area vector This allows us to write the
last equation in a more compact form. What should the magnitude of the area vector be? What should the
direction of the area vector be? What are the implications of how you answer the previous question?

The area vector of a flat surface of area A has the following magnitude and direction:

• Magnitude is equal to area (A)


• Direction is along the normal to the surface ( ); that is, perpendicular to the surface.

Since the normal to a flat surface can point in either direction from the surface, the direction of the area vector
of an open surface needs to be chosen, as shown in Figure 6.5.

Figure 6.5 The direction of the area vector of an open surface needs to be chosen; it could be either of the two cases displayed here. The
area vector of a part of a closed surface is defined to point from the inside of the closed space to the outside. This rule gives a unique
direction.

Since is a unit normal to a surface, it has two possible directions at every point on that surface (Figure 6.6(a)).
For an open surface, we can use either direction, as long as we are consistent over the entire surface. Part (c) of
the figure shows several cases.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.1 • Electric Flux 233

Figure 6.6 (a) Two potential normal vectors arise at every point on a surface. (b) The outward normal is used to calculate the flux through
a closed surface. (c) Only has been given a consistent set of normal vectors that allows us to define the flux through the surface.

However, if a surface is closed, then the surface encloses a volume. In that case, the direction of the normal
vector at any point on the surface points from the inside to the outside. On a closed surface such as that of
Figure 6.6(b), is chosen to be the outward normal at every point, to be consistent with the sign convention for
electric charge.

Electric Flux
Now that we have defined the area vector of a surface, we can define the electric flux of a uniform electric field
through a flat area as the scalar product of the electric field and the area vector, as defined in Products of
Vectors:

6.1

Figure 6.7 shows the electric field of an oppositely charged, parallel-plate system and an imaginary box
between the plates. The electric field between the plates is uniform and points from the positive plate toward
the negative plate. A calculation of the flux of this field through various faces of the box shows that the net flux
through the box is zero. Why does the flux cancel out here?
234 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.7 Electric flux through a cube, placed between two charged plates. Electric flux through the bottom face (ABCD) is negative,
because is in the opposite direction to the normal to the surface. The electric flux through the top face (FGHK) is positive, because the
electric field and the normal are in the same direction. The electric flux through the other faces is zero, since the electric field is
perpendicular to the normal vectors of those faces. The net electric flux through the cube is the sum of fluxes through the six faces. Here,
the net flux through the cube is equal to zero. The magnitude of the flux through rectangle BCKF is equal to the magnitudes of the flux
through both the top and bottom faces.

The reason is that the sources of the electric field are outside the box. Therefore, if any electric field line enters
the volume of the box, it must also exit somewhere on the surface because there is no charge inside for the
lines to land on. Therefore, quite generally, electric flux through a closed surface is zero if there are no sources
of electric field, whether positive or negative charges, inside the enclosed volume. In general, when field lines
leave (or “flow out of”) a closed surface, is positive; when they enter (or “flow into”) the surface, is
negative.

Any smooth, non-flat surface can be replaced by a collection of tiny, approximately flat surfaces, as shown in
Figure 6.8. If we divide a surface S into small patches, then we notice that, as the patches become smaller, they
can be approximated by flat surfaces. This is similar to the way we treat the surface of Earth as locally flat, even
though we know that globally, it is approximately spherical.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.1 • Electric Flux 235

Figure 6.8 A surface is divided into patches to find the flux.

To keep track of the patches, we can number them from 1 through N . Now, we define the area vector for each
patch as the area of the patch pointed in the direction of the normal. Let us denote the area vector for the ith
patch by (We have used the symbol to remind us that the area is of an arbitrarily small patch.) With
sufficiently small patches, we may approximate the electric field over any given patch as uniform. Let us
denote the average electric field at the location of the ith patch by

Therefore, we can write the electric flux through the area of the ith patch as

The flux through each of the individual patches can be constructed in this manner and then added to give us
an estimate of the net flux through the entire surface S, which we denote simply as .

This estimate of the flux gets better as we decrease the size of the patches. However, when you use smaller
patches, you need more of them to cover the same surface. In the limit of infinitesimally small patches, they
may be considered to have area dA and unit normal . Since the elements are infinitesimal, they may be
assumed to be planar, and may be taken as constant over any element. Then the flux through an area
dA is given by It is positive when the angle between and is less than and negative
when the angle is greater than . The net flux is the sum of the infinitesimal flux elements over the entire
surface. With infinitesimally small patches, you need infinitely many patches, and the limit of the sum
becomes a surface integral. With representing the integral over S,

6.2

In practical terms, surface integrals are computed by taking the antiderivatives of both dimensions defining
the area, with the edges of the surface in question being the bounds of the integral.

To distinguish between the flux through an open surface like that of Figure 6.4 and the flux through a closed
236 6 • Gauss's Law

surface (one that completely bounds some volume), we represent flux through a closed surface by

6.3

where the circle through the integral symbol simply means that the surface is closed, and we are integrating
over the entire thing. If you only integrate over a portion of a closed surface, that means you are treating a
subset of it as an open surface.

EXAMPLE 6.1

Flux of a Uniform Electric Field


A constant electric field of magnitude points in the direction of the positive z-axis (Figure 6.9). What is the
electric flux through a rectangle with sides a and b in the (a) xy-plane and in the (b) xz-plane?

Figure 6.9 Calculating the flux of through a rectangular surface.

Strategy
Apply the definition of flux: , where the definition of dot product is crucial.

Solution

a. In this case,
b. Here, the direction of the area vector is either along the positive y-axis or toward the negative y-axis.
Therefore, the scalar product of the electric field with the area vector is zero, giving zero flux.

Significance
The relative directions of the electric field and area can cause the flux through the area to be zero.

EXAMPLE 6.2

Flux of a Uniform Electric Field through a Closed Surface


A constant electric field of magnitude points in the direction of the positive z-axis (Figure 6.10). What is the
net electric flux through a cube?

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.1 • Electric Flux 237

Figure 6.10 Calculating the flux of through a closed cubic surface.

Strategy
Apply the definition of flux: , noting that a closed surface eliminates the ambiguity in
the direction of the area vector.

Solution
Through the top face of the cube,

Through the bottom face of the cube, because the area vector here points downward.

Along the other four sides, the direction of the area vector is perpendicular to the direction of the electric field.
Therefore, the scalar product of the electric field with the area vector is zero, giving zero flux.

The net flux is .

Significance
The net flux of a uniform electric field through a closed surface is zero.

EXAMPLE 6.3

Electric Flux through a Plane, Integral Method


A uniform electric field of magnitude 10 N/C is directed parallel to the yz-plane at above the xy-plane, as
shown in Figure 6.11. What is the electric flux through the plane surface of area located in the
xz-plane? Assume that points in the positive y-direction.
238 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.11 The electric field produces a net electric flux through the surface S.

Strategy

Apply , where the direction and magnitude of the electric field are constant.

Solution
The angle between the uniform electric field and the unit normal to the planar surface is . Since both
the direction and magnitude are constant, E comes outside the integral. All that is left is a surface integral over
dA, which is A. Therefore, using the open-surface equation, we find that the electric flux through the surface is

Significance
Again, the relative directions of the field and the area matter, and the general equation with the integral will
simplify to the simple dot product of area and electric field.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.1


What angle should there be between the electric field and the surface shown in Figure 6.11 in the previous
example so that no electric flux passes through the surface?

EXAMPLE 6.4

Inhomogeneous Electric Field


What is the total flux of the electric field through the rectangular surface shown in Figure 6.12?

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.2 • Explaining Gauss’s Law 239

Figure 6.12 Since the electric field is not constant over the surface, an integration is necessary to determine the flux.

Strategy

Apply . We assume that the unit normal to the given surface points in the positive

z-direction, so Since the electric field is not uniform over the surface, it is necessary to divide the
surface into infinitesimal strips along which is essentially constant. As shown in Figure 6.12, these strips
are parallel to the x-axis, and each strip has an area

Solution
From the open surface integral, we find that the net flux through the rectangular surface is

Significance
For a non-constant electric field, the integral method is required.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.2


If the electric field in Example 6.4 is what is the flux through the rectangular area?

6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• State Gauss’s law
• Explain the conditions under which Gauss’s law may be used
• Apply Gauss’s law in appropriate systems

We can now determine the electric flux through an arbitrary closed surface due to an arbitrary charge
distribution. We found that if a closed surface does not have any charge inside where an electric field line can
terminate, then any electric field line entering the surface at one point must necessarily exit at some other
point of the surface. Therefore, if a closed surface does not have any charges inside the enclosed volume, then
the electric flux through the surface is zero. Now, what happens to the electric flux if there are some charges
inside the enclosed volume? Gauss’s law gives a quantitative answer to this question.
240 6 • Gauss's Law

To get a feel for what to expect, let’s calculate the electric flux through a spherical surface around a positive
point charge q, since we already know the electric field in such a situation. Recall that when we place the point
charge at the origin of a coordinate system, the electric field at a point P that is at a distance r from the charge
at the origin is given by

where is the radial vector from the charge at the origin to the point P. We can use this electric field to find the
flux through the spherical surface of radius r, as shown in Figure 6.13.

Figure 6.13 A closed spherical surface surrounding a point charge q.

Then we apply to this system and substitute known values. On the sphere, and ,

so for an infinitesimal area dA,

We now find the net flux by integrating this flux over the surface of the sphere:

where the total surface area of the spherical surface is This gives the flux through the closed spherical
surface at radius r as

6.4

A remarkable fact about this equation is that the flux is independent of the size of the spherical surface. This
can be directly attributed to the fact that the electric field of a point charge decreases as with distance,
which just cancels the rate of increase of the surface area.

Electric Field Lines Picture


An alternative way to see why the flux through a closed spherical surface is independent of the radius of the
surface is to look at the electric field lines. Note that every field line from q that pierces the surface at radius
also pierces the surface at (Figure 6.14).

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.2 • Explaining Gauss’s Law 241

Figure 6.14 Flux through spherical surfaces of radii and enclosing a charge q are equal, independent of the size of the surface,
since all E-field lines that pierce one surface from the inside to outside direction also pierce the other surface in the same direction.

Therefore, the net number of electric field lines passing through the two surfaces from the inside to outside
direction is equal. This net number of electric field lines, which is obtained by subtracting the number of lines
in the direction from outside to inside from the number of lines in the direction from inside to outside gives a
visual measure of the electric flux through the surfaces.

You can see that if no charges are included within a closed surface, then the electric flux through it must be
zero. A typical field line enters the surface at and leaves at Every line that enters the surface must
also leave that surface. Hence the net “flow” of the field lines into or out of the surface is zero (Figure 6.15(a)).
The same thing happens if charges of equal and opposite sign are included inside the closed surface, so that
the total charge included is zero (part (b)). A surface that includes the same amount of charge has the same
number of field lines crossing it, regardless of the shape or size of the surface, as long as the surface encloses
the same amount of charge (part (c)).

Figure 6.15 Understanding the flux in terms of field lines. (a) The electric flux through a closed surface due to a charge outside that
surface is zero. (b) Charges are enclosed, but because the net charge included is zero, the net flux through the closed surface is also zero.
(c) The shape and size of the surfaces that enclose a charge does not matter because all surfaces enclosing the same charge have the same
flux.

Statement of Gauss’s Law


Gauss’s law generalizes this result to the case of any number of charges and any location of the charges in the
space inside the closed surface. According to Gauss’s law, the flux of the electric field through any closed
242 6 • Gauss's Law

surface, also called a Gaussian surface, is equal to the net charge enclosed divided by the permittivity of
free space :

This equation holds for charges of either sign, because we define the area vector of a closed surface to point
outward. If the enclosed charge is negative (see Figure 6.16(b)), then the flux through either is negative.

Figure 6.16 The electric flux through any closed surface surrounding a point charge q is given by Gauss’s law. (a) Enclosed charge is
positive. (b) Enclosed charge is negative.

The Gaussian surface does not need to correspond to a real, physical object; indeed, it rarely will. It is a
mathematical construct that may be of any shape, provided that it is closed. However, since our goal is to
integrate the flux over it, we tend to choose shapes that are highly symmetrical.

If the charges are discrete point charges, then we just add them. If the charge is described by a continuous
distribution, then we need to integrate appropriately to find the total charge that resides inside the enclosed
volume. For example, the flux through the Gaussian surface S of Figure 6.17 is Note
that is simply the sum of the point charges. If the charge distribution were continuous, we would need to
integrate appropriately to compute the total charge within the Gaussian surface.

Figure 6.17 The flux through the Gaussian surface shown, due to the charge distribution, is

Recall that the principle of superposition holds for the electric field. Therefore, the total electric field at any
point, including those on the chosen Gaussian surface, is the sum of all the electric fields present at this point.
This allows us to write Gauss’s law in terms of the total electric field.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.2 • Explaining Gauss’s Law 243

Gauss’s Law
The flux of the electric field through any closed surface S (a Gaussian surface) is equal to the net
charge enclosed divided by the permittivity of free space

6.5

To use Gauss’s law effectively, you must have a clear understanding of what each term in the equation
represents. The field is the total electric field at every point on the Gaussian surface. This total field includes
contributions from charges both inside and outside the Gaussian surface. However, is just the charge
inside the Gaussian surface. Finally, the Gaussian surface is any closed surface in space. That surface can
coincide with the actual surface of a conductor, or it can be an imaginary geometric surface. The only
requirement imposed on a Gaussian surface is that it be closed (Figure 6.18).

Figure 6.18 A Klein bottle partially filled with a liquid. Could the Klein bottle be used as a Gaussian surface?

EXAMPLE 6.5

Electric Flux through Gaussian Surfaces


Calculate the electric flux through each Gaussian surface shown in Figure 6.19.
244 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.19 Various Gaussian surfaces and charges.

Strategy
From Gauss’s law, the flux through each surface is given by where is the charge enclosed by that
surface.

Solution
For the surfaces and charges shown, we find

a.

b.

c.

d.

e.

Significance
In the special case of a closed surface, the flux calculations become a sum of charges. In the next section, this
will allow us to work with more complex systems.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.3


Calculate the electric flux through the closed cubical surface for each charge distribution shown in Figure 6.20.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 245

Figure 6.20 A cubical Gaussian surface with various charge distributions.

INTERACTIVE
Use this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21gaussimulat) to adjust the magnitude of the charge and the
radius of the Gaussian surface around it. See how this affects the total flux and the magnitude of the electric
field at the Gaussian surface.

6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain what spherical, cylindrical, and planar symmetry are
• Recognize whether or not a given system possesses one of these symmetries
• Apply Gauss’s law to determine the electric field of a system with one of these symmetries

Gauss’s law is very helpful in determining expressions for the electric field, even though the law is not directly
about the electric field; it is about the electric flux. It turns out that in situations that have certain symmetries
(spherical, cylindrical, or planar) in the charge distribution, we can deduce the electric field based on
knowledge of the electric flux. In these systems, we can find a Gaussian surface S over which the electric field
has constant magnitude. Furthermore, if is parallel to everywhere on the surface, then (If
and are antiparallel everywhere on the surface, then ) Gauss’s law then simplifies to
246 6 • Gauss's Law

6.6

where A is the area of the surface. Note that these symmetries lead to the transformation of the flux integral
into a product of the magnitude of the electric field and an appropriate area. When you use this flux in the
expression for Gauss’s law, you obtain an algebraic equation that you can solve for the magnitude of the
electric field, which looks like

The direction of the electric field at point P is obtained from the symmetry of the charge distribution and the
type of charge in the distribution. Therefore, Gauss’s law can be used to determine Here is a summary of
the steps we will follow:

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Gauss’s Law
1. Identify the spatial symmetry of the charge distribution. This is an important first step that allows us to
choose the appropriate Gaussian surface. As examples, an isolated point charge has spherical symmetry,
and an infinite line of charge has cylindrical symmetry.
2. Choose a Gaussian surface with the same symmetry as the charge distribution and identify its
consequences. With this choice, is easily determined over the Gaussian surface.
3. Evaluate the integral over the Gaussian surface, that is, calculate the flux through the surface.

The symmetry of the Gaussian surface allows us to factor outside the integral.
4. Determine the amount of charge enclosed by the Gaussian surface. This is an evaluation of the right-hand
side of the equation representing Gauss’s law. It is often necessary to perform an integration to obtain the
net enclosed charge.
5. Evaluate the electric field of the charge distribution. The field may now be found using the results of steps
3 and 4.

Basically, there are only three types of symmetry that allow Gauss’s law to be used to deduce the electric field.
They are

• A charge distribution with spherical symmetry


• A charge distribution with cylindrical symmetry
• A charge distribution with planar symmetry

To exploit the symmetry, we perform the calculations in appropriate coordinate systems and use the right kind
of Gaussian surface for that symmetry, applying the remaining four steps.

Charge Distribution with Spherical Symmetry


A charge distribution has spherical symmetry if the density of charge depends only on the distance from a
point in space and not on the direction. In other words, if you rotate the system, it doesn’t look different. For
instance, if a sphere of radius R is uniformly charged with charge density then the distribution has
spherical symmetry (Figure 6.21(a)). On the other hand, if a sphere of radius R is charged so that the top half of
the sphere has uniform charge density and the bottom half has a uniform charge density then the
sphere does not have spherical symmetry because the charge density depends on the direction (Figure
6.21(b)). Thus, it is not the shape of the object but rather the shape of the charge distribution that determines
whether or not a system has spherical symmetry.

Figure 6.21(c) shows a sphere with four different shells, each with its own uniform charge density. Although
this is a situation where charge density in the full sphere is not uniform, the charge density function depends

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 247

only on the distance from the center and not on the direction. Therefore, this charge distribution does have
spherical symmetry.

Figure 6.21 Illustrations of spherically symmetrical and nonsymmetrical systems. Different shadings indicate different charge densities.
Charges on spherically shaped objects do not necessarily mean the charges are distributed with spherical symmetry. The spherical
symmetry occurs only when the charge density does not depend on the direction. In (a), charges are distributed uniformly in a sphere. In
(b), the upper half of the sphere has a different charge density from the lower half; therefore, (b) does not have spherical symmetry. In (c),
the charges are in spherical shells of different charge densities, which means that charge density is only a function of the radial distance
from the center; therefore, the system has spherical symmetry.

One good way to determine whether or not your problem has spherical symmetry is to look at the charge
density function in spherical coordinates, . If the charge density is only a function of r, that is
, then you have spherical symmetry. If the density depends on or , you could change it by rotation;
hence, you would not have spherical symmetry.

Consequences of symmetry
In all spherically symmetrical cases, the electric field at any point must be radially directed, because the
charge and, hence, the field must be invariant under rotation. Therefore, using spherical coordinates with their
origins at the center of the spherical charge distribution, we can write down the expected form of the electric
field at a point P located at a distance r from the center:

6.7

where is the unit vector pointed in the direction from the origin to the field point P. The radial component
of the electric field can be positive or negative. When the electric field at P points away from the
origin, and when the electric field at P points toward the origin.

Gaussian surface and flux calculations


We can now use this form of the electric field to obtain the flux of the electric field through the Gaussian
surface. For spherical symmetry, the Gaussian surface is a closed spherical surface that has the same center as
the center of the charge distribution. Thus, the direction of the area vector of an area element on the Gaussian
surface at any point is parallel to the direction of the electric field at that point, since they are both radially
directed outward (Figure 6.22).
248 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.22 The electric field at any point of the spherical Gaussian surface for a spherically symmetrical charge distribution is parallel to
the area element vector at that point, giving flux as the product of the magnitude of electric field and the value of the area. Note that the
radius R of the charge distribution and the radius r of the Gaussian surface are different quantities.

The magnitude of the electric field must be the same everywhere on a spherical Gaussian surface
concentric with the distribution. For a spherical surface of radius r,

Using Gauss’s law


According to Gauss’s law, the flux through a closed surface is equal to the total charge enclosed within the
closed surface divided by the permittivity of vacuum . Let be the total charge enclosed inside the
distance r from the origin, which is the space inside the Gaussian spherical surface of radius r. This gives the
following relation for Gauss’s law:

Hence, the electric field at point P that is a distance r from the center of a spherically symmetrical charge
distribution has the following magnitude and direction:

6.8

Direction: radial from O to P or from P to O.

The direction of the field at point P depends on whether the charge in the sphere is positive or negative. For a
net positive charge enclosed within the Gaussian surface, the direction is from O to P, and for a net negative
charge, the direction is from P to O. This is all we need for a point charge, and you will notice that the result
above is identical to that for a point charge. However, Gauss’s law becomes truly useful in cases where the
charge occupies a finite volume.

Computing enclosed charge


The more interesting case is when a spherical charge distribution occupies a volume, and asking what the
electric field inside the charge distribution is thus becomes relevant. In this case, the charge enclosed depends
on the distance r of the field point relative to the radius of the charge distribution R, such as that shown in
Figure 6.23.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 249

Figure 6.23 A spherically symmetrical charge distribution and the Gaussian surface used for finding the field (a) inside and (b) outside the
distribution.

If point P is located outside the charge distribution—that is, if —then the Gaussian surface containing P
encloses all charges in the sphere. In this case, equals the total charge in the sphere. On the other hand, if
point P is within the spherical charge distribution, that is, if then the Gaussian surface encloses a
smaller sphere than the sphere of charge distribution. In this case, is less than the total charge present in
the sphere. Referring to Figure 6.23, we can write as

The field at a point outside the charge distribution is also called , and the field at a point inside the charge
distribution is called Focusing on the two types of field points, either inside or outside the charge
distribution, we can now write the magnitude of the electric field as

6.9

6.10

Note that the electric field outside a spherically symmetrical charge distribution is identical to that of a point
charge at the center that has a charge equal to the total charge of the spherical charge distribution. This is
remarkable since the charges are not located at the center only. We now work out specific examples of
spherical charge distributions, starting with the case of a uniformly charged sphere.

EXAMPLE 6.6

Uniformly Charged Sphere


A sphere of radius R, such as that shown in Figure 6.23, has a uniform volume charge density . Find the
electric field at a point outside the sphere and at a point inside the sphere.

Strategy
Apply the Gauss’s law problem-solving strategy, where we have already worked out the flux calculation.

Solution
The charge enclosed by the Gaussian surface is given by
250 6 • Gauss's Law

The answer for electric field amplitude can then be written down immediately for a point outside the sphere,
labeled and a point inside the sphere, labeled

It is interesting to note that the magnitude of the electric field increases inside the material as you go out, since
the amount of charge enclosed by the Gaussian surface increases with the volume. Specifically, the charge
enclosed grows , whereas the field from each infinitesimal element of charge drops off with the net
result that the electric field within the distribution increases in strength linearly with the radius. The
magnitude of the electric field outside the sphere decreases as you go away from the charges, because the
included charge remains the same but the distance increases. Figure 6.24 displays the variation of the
magnitude of the electric field with distance from the center of a uniformly charged sphere.

Figure 6.24 Electric field of a uniformly charged, non-conducting sphere increases inside the sphere to a maximum at the surface and
then decreases as . Here, . The electric field is due to a spherical charge distribution of uniform charge density and total

charge Q as a function of distance from the center of the distribution.

The direction of the electric field at any point P is radially outward from the origin if is positive, and inward
(i.e., toward the center) if is negative. The electric field at some representative space points are displayed in
Figure 6.25 whose radial coordinates r are , , and .

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 251

Figure 6.25 Electric field vectors inside and outside a uniformly charged sphere.

Significance
Notice that has the same form as the equation of the electric field of an isolated point charge. In
determining the electric field of a uniform spherical charge distribution, we can therefore assume that all of
the charge inside the appropriate spherical Gaussian surface is located at the center of the distribution.

EXAMPLE 6.7

Non-Uniformly Charged Sphere


A non-conducting sphere of radius R has a non-uniform charge density that varies with the distance from its
center as given by

where a is a constant. We require so that the charge density is not undefined at . Find the electric
field at a point outside the sphere and at a point inside the sphere.

Strategy
Apply the Gauss’s law strategy given above, where we work out the enclosed charge integrals separately for
cases inside and outside the sphere.

Solution
Since the given charge density function has only a radial dependence and no dependence on direction, we
have a spherically symmetrical situation. Therefore, the magnitude of the electric field at any point is given
above and the direction is radial. We just need to find the enclosed charge which depends on the location
of the field point.

A note about symbols: We use for locating charges in the charge distribution and r for locating the field
point(s) at the Gaussian surface(s). The letter R is used for the radius of the charge distribution.
252 6 • Gauss's Law

As charge density is not constant here, we need to integrate the charge density function over the volume
enclosed by the Gaussian surface. Therefore, we set up the problem for charges in one spherical shell, say
between and as shown in Figure 6.26. The volume of charges in the shell of infinitesimal width is
equal to the product of the area of surface and the thickness . Multiplying the volume with the density
at this location, which is , gives the charge in the shell:

Figure 6.26 Spherical symmetry with non-uniform charge distribution. In this type of problem, we need four radii: R is the radius of the
charge distribution, r is the radius of the Gaussian surface, is the inner radius of the spherical shell, and is the outer radius of the
spherical shell. The spherical shell is used to calculate the charge enclosed within the Gaussian surface. The range for is from 0 to r for
the field at a point inside the charge distribution and from 0 to R for the field at a point outside the charge distribution. If , then the
Gaussian surface encloses more volume than the charge distribution, but the additional volume does not contribute to .

(a) Field at a point outside the charge distribution. In this case, the Gaussian surface, which contains the field
point P, has a radius r that is greater than the radius R of the charge distribution, . Therefore, all charges
of the charge distribution are enclosed within the Gaussian surface. Note that the space between and
is empty of charges and therefore does not contribute to the integral over the volume enclosed by the
Gaussian surface:

This is used in the general result for above to obtain the electric field at a point outside the charge
distribution as

where is a unit vector in the direction from the origin to the field point at the Gaussian surface.

(b) Field at a point inside the charge distribution. The Gaussian surface is now buried inside the charge
distribution, with . Therefore, only those charges in the distribution that are within a distance r of the
center of the spherical charge distribution count in :

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 253

Now, using the general result above for we find the electric field at a point that is a distance r from the
center and lies within the charge distribution as

where the direction information is included by using the unit radial vector.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.4


Check that the electric fields for the sphere reduce to the correct values for a point charge.

Charge Distribution with Cylindrical Symmetry


A charge distribution has cylindrical symmetry if the charge density depends only upon the distance r from
the axis of a cylinder and must not vary along the axis or with direction about the axis. In other words, if your
system varies if you rotate it around the axis, or shift it along the axis, you do not have cylindrical symmetry.

Figure 6.27 shows four situations in which charges are distributed in a cylinder. A uniform charge density
in an infinite straight wire has a cylindrical symmetry, and so does an infinitely long cylinder with constant
charge density An infinitely long cylinder that has different charge densities along its length, such as a
charge density for and for , does not have a usable cylindrical symmetry for this course.
Neither does a cylinder in which charge density varies with the direction, such as a charge density for
and for . A system with concentric cylindrical shells, each with uniform charge
densities, albeit different in different shells, as in Figure 6.27(d), does have cylindrical symmetry if they are
infinitely long. The infinite length requirement is due to the charge density changing along the axis of a finite
cylinder. In real systems, we don’t have infinite cylinders; however, if the cylindrical object is considerably
longer than the radius from it that we are interested in, then the approximation of an infinite cylinder becomes
useful.

Figure 6.27 To determine whether a given charge distribution has cylindrical symmetry, look at the cross-section of an “infinitely long”
cylinder. If the charge density does not depend on the polar angle of the cross-section or along the axis, then you have cylindrical
symmetry. (a) Charge density is constant in the cylinder; (b) upper half of the cylinder has a different charge density from the lower half; (c)
left half of the cylinder has a different charge density from the right half; (d) charges are constant in different cylindrical rings, but the
density does not depend on the polar angle. Cases (a) and (d) have cylindrical symmetry, whereas (b) and (c) do not.

Consequences of symmetry
In all cylindrically symmetrical cases, the electric field at any point P must also display cylindrical
symmetry.

Cylindrical symmetry: ,
254 6 • Gauss's Law

where r is the distance from the axis and is a unit vector directed perpendicularly away from the axis (Figure
6.28).

Figure 6.28 The electric field in a cylindrically symmetrical situation depends only on the distance from the axis. The direction of the
electric field is pointed away from the axis for positive charges and toward the axis for negative charges.

Gaussian surface and flux calculation


To make use of the direction and functional dependence of the electric field, we choose a closed Gaussian
surface in the shape of a cylinder with the same axis as the axis of the charge distribution. The flux through
this surface of radius s and height L is easy to compute if we divide our task into two parts: (a) a flux through
the flat ends and (b) a flux through the curved surface (Figure 6.29).

Figure 6.29 The Gaussian surface in the case of cylindrical symmetry. The electric field at a patch is either parallel or perpendicular to the
normal to the patch of the Gaussian surface.

The electric field is perpendicular to the cylindrical side and parallel to the planar end caps of the surface. The
flux through the cylindrical part is

whereas the flux through the end caps is zero because there. Thus, the flux is

Using Gauss’s law


According to Gauss’s law, the flux must equal the amount of charge within the volume enclosed by this surface,
divided by the permittivity of free space. When you do the calculation for a cylinder of length L, you find that
of Gauss’s law is directly proportional to L. Let us write it as charge per unit length times length L:

Hence, Gauss’s law for any cylindrically symmetrical charge distribution yields the following magnitude of the
electric field a distance s away from the axis:

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 255

The charge per unit length depends on whether the field point is inside or outside the cylinder of charge
distribution, just as we have seen for the spherical distribution.

Computing enclosed charge


Let R be the radius of the cylinder within which charges are distributed in a cylindrically symmetrical way. Let
the field point P be at a distance s from the axis. (The side of the Gaussian surface includes the field point P.)
When (that is, when P is outside the charge distribution), the Gaussian surface includes all the charge in
the cylinder of radius R and length L. When (P is located inside the charge distribution), then only the
charge within a cylinder of radius s and length L is enclosed by the Gaussian surface:

EXAMPLE 6.8

Uniformly Charged Cylindrical Shell


A very long non-conducting cylindrical shell of radius R has a uniform surface charge density Find the
electric field (a) at a point outside the shell and (b) at a point inside the shell.

Strategy
Apply the Gauss’s law strategy given earlier, where we treat the cases inside and outside the shell separately.

Solution

a. Electric field at a point outside the shell. For a point outside the cylindrical shell, the Gaussian surface is
the surface of a cylinder of radius and length L, as shown in Figure 6.30. The charge enclosed by the
Gaussian cylinder is equal to the charge on the cylindrical shell of length L. Therefore, is given by

Figure 6.30 A Gaussian surface surrounding a cylindrical shell.

Hence, the electric field at a point P outside the shell at a distance r away from the axis is

where is a unit vector, perpendicular to the axis and pointing away from it, as shown in the figure. The
electric field at P points in the direction of given in Figure 6.30 if and in the opposite direction to
if .
256 6 • Gauss's Law

b. Electric field at a point inside the shell. For a point inside the cylindrical shell, the Gaussian surface is a
cylinder whose radius r is less than R (Figure 6.31). This means no charges are included inside the
Gaussian surface:

Figure 6.31 A Gaussian surface within a cylindrical shell.

This gives the following equation for the magnitude of the electric field at a point whose r is less than R
of the shell of charges.

This gives us

Significance
Notice that the result inside the shell is exactly what we should expect: No enclosed charge means zero electric
field. Outside the shell, the result becomes identical to a wire with uniform charge

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.5


A thin straight wire has a uniform linear charge density Find the electric field at a distance d from the wire,
where d is much less than the length of the wire.

Charge Distribution with Planar Symmetry


A planar symmetry of charge density is obtained when charges are uniformly spread over a large flat surface.
In planar symmetry, all points in a plane parallel to the plane of charge are identical with respect to the
charges.

Consequences of symmetry
We take the plane of the charge distribution to be the xy-plane and we find the electric field at a space point P
with coordinates (x, y, z). Since the charge density is the same at all (x, y)-coordinates in the plane, by
symmetry, the electric field at P cannot depend on the x- or y-coordinates of point P, as shown in Figure 6.32.
Therefore, the electric field at P can only depend on the distance from the plane and has a direction either
toward the plane or away from the plane. That is, the electric field at P has only a nonzero z-component.

Uniform charges in xy plane:

where z is the distance from the plane and is the unit vector normal to the plane. Note that in this system,
although of course they point in opposite directions.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.3 • Applying Gauss’s Law 257

Figure 6.32 The components of the electric field parallel to a plane of charges cancel out the two charges located symmetrically from the
field point P. Therefore, the field at any point is pointed vertically from the plane of charges. For any point P and charge we can always
find a with this effect.

Gaussian surface and flux calculation


In the present case, a convenient Gaussian surface is a box, since the expected electric field points in one
direction only. To keep the Gaussian box symmetrical about the plane of charges, we take it to straddle the
plane of the charges, such that one face containing the field point P is taken parallel to the plane of the charges.
In Figure 6.33, sides I and II of the Gaussian surface (the box) that are parallel to the infinite plane have been
shaded. They are the only surfaces that give rise to nonzero flux because the electric field and the area vectors
of the other faces are perpendicular to each other.

Figure 6.33 A thin charged sheet and the Gaussian box for finding the electric field at the field point P. The normal to each face of the box
is from inside the box to outside. On two faces of the box, the electric fields are parallel to the area vectors, and on the other four faces, the
electric fields are perpendicular to the area vectors.

Let A be the area of the shaded surface on each side of the plane and be the magnitude of the electric field
at point P. Since sides I and II are at the same distance from the plane, the electric field has the same
magnitude at points in these planes, although the directions of the electric field at these points in the two
planes are opposite to each other.

Magnitude at I or II:

If the charge on the plane is positive, then the direction of the electric field and the area vectors are as shown in
Figure 6.33. Therefore, we find for the flux of electric field through the box

6.11

where the zeros are for the flux through the other sides of the box. Note that if the charge on the plane is
negative, the directions of electric field and area vectors for planes I and II are opposite to each other, and we
get a negative sign for the flux. According to Gauss’s law, the flux must equal . From Figure 6.33, we see
that the charges inside the volume enclosed by the Gaussian box reside on an area A of the xy-plane. Hence,
6.12
258 6 • Gauss's Law

Using the equations for the flux and enclosed charge in Gauss’s law, we can immediately determine the electric
field at a point at height z from a uniformly charged plane in the xy-plane:

The direction of the field depends on the sign of the charge on the plane and the side of the plane where the
field point P is located. Note that above the plane, , while below the plane, .

You may be surprised to note that the electric field does not actually depend on the distance from the plane;
this is an effect of the assumption that the plane is infinite. In practical terms, the result given above is still a
useful approximation for finite planes near the center.

6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the electric field within a conductor at equilibrium
• Describe the electric field immediately outside the surface of a charged conductor at equilibrium
• Explain why if the field is not as described in the first two objectives, the conductor is not at equilibrium

So far, we have generally been working with charges occupying a volume within an insulator. We now study
what happens when free charges are placed on a conductor. Generally, in the presence of a (generally external)
electric field, the free charge in a conductor redistributes and very quickly reaches electrostatic equilibrium.
The resulting charge distribution and its electric field have many interesting properties, which we can
investigate with the help of Gauss’s law and the concept of electric potential.

The Electric Field inside a Conductor Vanishes


If an electric field is present inside a conductor, it exerts forces on the free electrons (also called conduction
electrons), which are electrons in the material that are not bound to an atom. These free electrons then
accelerate. However, moving charges by definition means nonstatic conditions, contrary to our assumption.
Therefore, when electrostatic equilibrium is reached, the charge is distributed in such a way that the electric
field inside the conductor vanishes.

If you place a piece of a metal near a positive charge, the free electrons in the metal are attracted to the
external positive charge and migrate freely toward that region. The region the electrons move to then has an
excess of electrons over the protons in the atoms and the region from where the electrons have migrated has
more protons than electrons. Consequently, the metal develops a negative region near the charge and a
positive region at the far end (Figure 6.34). As we saw in the preceding chapter, this separation of equal
magnitude and opposite type of electric charge is called polarization. If you remove the external charge, the
electrons migrate back and neutralize the positive region.

Figure 6.34 Polarization of a metallic sphere by an external point charge . The near side of the metal has an opposite surface charge
compared to the far side of the metal. The sphere is said to be polarized. When you remove the external charge, the polarization of the
metal also disappears.

The polarization of the metal happens only in the presence of external charges. You can think of this in terms
of electric fields. The external charge creates an external electric field. When the metal is placed in the region
of this electric field, the electrons and protons of the metal experience electric forces due to this external

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.4 • Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium 259

electric field, but only the conduction electrons are free to move in the metal over macroscopic distances. The
movement of the conduction electrons leads to the polarization, which creates an induced electric field in
addition to the external electric field (Figure 6.35). The net electric field is a vector sum of the fields of and
the surface charge densities and This means that the net field inside the conductor is different from
the field outside the conductor.

Figure 6.35 In the presence of an external charge q, the charges in a metal redistribute. The electric field at any point has three
contributions, from and the induced charges and Note that the surface charge distribution will not be uniform in this case.

The redistribution of charges is such that the sum of the three contributions at any point P inside the
conductor is

Now, thanks to Gauss’s law, we know that there is no net charge enclosed by a Gaussian surface that is solely
within the volume of the conductor at equilibrium. That is, and hence

6.13

Charge on a Conductor
An interesting property of a conductor in static equilibrium is that extra charges on the conductor end up on
the outer surface of the conductor, regardless of where they originate. Figure 6.36 illustrates a system in which
we bring an external positive charge inside the cavity of a metal and then touch it to the inside surface.
Initially, the inside surface of the cavity is negatively charged and the outside surface of the conductor is
positively charged. When we touch the inside surface of the cavity, the induced charge is neutralized, leaving
the outside surface and the whole metal charged with a net positive charge.

Figure 6.36 Electric charges on a conductor migrate to the outside surface no matter where you put them initially.

To see why this happens, note that the Gaussian surface in Figure 6.37 (the dashed line) follows the contour of
the actual surface of the conductor and is located an infinitesimal distance within it. Since everywhere
inside a conductor,

Thus, from Gauss’s law, there is no net charge inside the Gaussian surface. But the Gaussian surface lies just
260 6 • Gauss's Law

below the actual surface of the conductor; consequently, there is no net charge inside the conductor. Any
excess charge must lie on its surface.

Figure 6.37 The dashed line represents a Gaussian surface that is just beneath the actual surface of the conductor.

This particular property of conductors is the basis for an extremely accurate method developed by Plimpton
and Lawton in 1936 to verify Gauss’s law and, correspondingly, Coulomb’s law. A sketch of their apparatus is
shown in Figure 6.38. Two spherical shells are connected to one another through an electrometer E, a device
that can detect a very slight amount of charge flowing from one shell to the other. When switch S is thrown to
the left, charge is placed on the outer shell by the battery B. Will charge flow through the electrometer to the
inner shell?

No. Doing so would mean a violation of Gauss’s law. Plimpton and Lawton did not detect any flow and, knowing
the sensitivity of their electrometer, concluded that if the radial dependence in Coulomb’s law were ,
1 2
would be less than . More recent measurements place at less than , a number so small
that the validity of Coulomb’s law seems indisputable.

Figure 6.38 A representation of the apparatus used by Plimpton and Lawton. Any transfer of charge between the spheres is detected by

1 S. Plimpton and W. Lawton. 1936. “A Very Accurate Test of Coulomb’s Law of Force between Charges.” Physical Review 50, No. 11:
1066, doi:10.1103/PhysRev.50.1066
2 E. Williams, J. Faller, and H. Hill. 1971. “New Experimental Test of Coulomb’s Law: A Laboratory Upper Limit on the Photon Rest
Mass.” Physical Review Letters 26 , No. 12: 721, doi:10.1103/PhysRevLett.26.721

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.4 • Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium 261

the electrometer E.

The Electric Field at the Surface of a Conductor


If the electric field had a component parallel to the surface of a conductor, free charges on the surface would
move, a situation contrary to the assumption of electrostatic equilibrium. Therefore, the electric field is always
perpendicular to the surface of a conductor.

At any point just above the surface of a conductor, the surface charge density and the magnitude of the
electric field E are related by

6.14

To see this, consider an infinitesimally small Gaussian cylinder that surrounds a point on the surface of the
conductor, as in Figure 6.39. The cylinder has one end face inside and one end face outside the surface. The
height and cross-sectional area of the cylinder are and , respectively. The cylinder’s sides are
perpendicular to the surface of the conductor, and its end faces are parallel to the surface. Because the cylinder
is infinitesimally small, the charge density is essentially constant over the surface enclosed, so the total
charge inside the Gaussian cylinder is . Now E is perpendicular to the surface of the conductor outside the
conductor and vanishes within it, because otherwise, the charges would accelerate, and we would not be in
equilibrium. Electric flux therefore crosses only the outer end face of the Gaussian surface and may be written
as , since the cylinder is assumed to be small enough that E is approximately constant over that area.
From Gauss’ law,

Thus,

Figure 6.39 An infinitesimally small cylindrical Gaussian surface surrounds point P, which is on the surface of the conductor. The field is
perpendicular to the surface of the conductor outside the conductor and vanishes within it.

EXAMPLE 6.9

Electric Field of a Conducting Plate


The infinite conducting plate in Figure 6.40 has a uniform surface charge density . Use Gauss’ law to find the
electric field outside the plate. Compare this result with that previously calculated directly.
262 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.40 A side view of an infinite conducting plate and Gaussian cylinder with cross-sectional area A.

Strategy
For this case, we use a cylindrical Gaussian surface, a side view of which is shown.

Solution
The flux calculation is similar to that for an infinite sheet of charge from the previous chapter with one major
exception: The left face of the Gaussian surface is inside the conductor where so the total flux through
the Gaussian surface is EA rather than 2EA. Then from Gauss’ law,

and the electric field outside the plate is

Significance
This result is in agreement with the result from the previous section, and consistent with the rule stated above.

EXAMPLE 6.10

Electric Field between Oppositely Charged Parallel Plates


Two large conducting plates carry equal and opposite charges, with a surface charge density of magnitude
as shown in Figure 6.41. The separation between the plates is . What is the
electric field between the plates?

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.4 • Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium 263

Figure 6.41 The electric field between oppositely charged parallel plates. A test charge is released at the positive plate.

Strategy
Note that the electric field at the surface of one plate only depends on the charge on that plate. Thus, apply
with the given values.

Solution
The electric field is directed from the positive to the negative plate, as shown in the figure, and its magnitude is
given by

Significance
This formula is applicable to more than just a plate. Furthermore, two-plate systems will be important later.

EXAMPLE 6.11

A Conducting Sphere
The isolated conducting sphere (Figure 6.42) has a radius R and an excess charge q. What is the electric field
both inside and outside the sphere?
264 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.42 An isolated conducting sphere.

Strategy
The sphere is isolated, so its surface change distribution and the electric field of that distribution are
spherically symmetrical. We can therefore represent the field as . To calculate E(r), we apply
Gauss’s law over a closed spherical surface S of radius r that is concentric with the conducting sphere.

Solution
Since r is constant and on the sphere,

For , S is within the conductor, so and Gauss’s law gives

as expected inside a conductor. If , S encloses the conductor so From Gauss’s law,

The electric field of the sphere may therefore be written as

Significance
Notice that in the region , the electric field due to a charge q placed on an isolated conducting sphere of
radius R is identical to the electric field of a point charge q located at the center of the sphere. The difference
between the charged metal and a point charge occurs only at the space points inside the conductor. For a point
charge placed at the center of the sphere, the electric field is not zero at points of space occupied by the sphere,
but a conductor with the same amount of charge has a zero electric field at those points (Figure 6.43). However,
there is no distinction at the outside points in space where , and we can replace the isolated charged
spherical conductor by a point charge at its center with impunity.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6.4 • Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium 265

Figure 6.43 Electric field of a positively charged metal sphere. The electric field inside is zero, and the electric field outside is same as the
electric field of a point charge at the center, although the charge on the metal sphere is at the surface.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 6.6


How will the system above change if there are charged objects external to the sphere?

For a conductor with a cavity, if we put a charge inside the cavity, then the charge separation takes place in
the conductor, with amount of charge on the inside surface and a amount of charge at the outside
surface (Figure 6.44(a)). For the same conductor with a charge outside it, there is no excess charge on the
inside surface; both the positive and negative induced charges reside on the outside surface (Figure 6.44(b)).

Figure 6.44 (a) A charge inside a cavity in a metal. The distribution of charges at the outer surface does not depend on how the charges
are distributed at the inner surface, since the E-field inside the body of the metal is zero. That magnitude of the charge on the outer surface
does depend on the magnitude of the charge inside, however. (b) A charge outside a conductor containing an inner cavity. The cavity
remains free of charge. The polarization of charges on the conductor happens at the surface.

If a conductor has two cavities, one of them having a charge inside it and the other a charge the
polarization of the conductor results in on the inside surface of the cavity a, on the inside surface of
the cavity b, and on the outside surface (Figure 6.45). The charges on the surfaces may not be
uniformly spread out; their spread depends upon the geometry. The only rule obeyed is that when the
equilibrium has been reached, the charge distribution in a conductor is such that the electric field by the
charge distribution in the conductor cancels the electric field of the external charges at all space points inside
the body of the conductor.
266 6 • Gauss's Law

Figure 6.45 The charges induced by two equal and opposite charges in two separate cavities of a conductor. If the net charge on the
cavity is nonzero, the external surface becomes charged to the amount of the net charge.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 267

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
area vector vector with magnitude equal to the these are the electrons in a conductor that are not
area of a surface and direction perpendicular to bound to any particular atom, and hence are free
the surface to move around
cylindrical symmetry system only varies with Gaussian surface any enclosed (usually
distance from the axis, not direction imaginary) surface
electric flux dot product of the electric field and planar symmetry system only varies with distance
the area through which it is passing from a plane
flux quantity of something passing through a given spherical symmetry system only varies with the
area distance from the origin, not in direction
free electrons also called conduction electrons,

Key Equations

Definition of electric flux, for uniform electric field

Electric flux through an open surface

Electric flux through a closed surface

Gauss’s law

Gauss’s Law for systems with symmetry

The magnitude of the electric field just outside the surface


of a conductor

Summary
6.1 Electric Flux surface,

• The electric flux through a surface is


proportional to the number of field lines
crossing that surface. Note that this means the where is the total charge inside the
magnitude is proportional to the portion of the Gaussian surface S.
field perpendicular to the area. • All surfaces that include the same amount of
• The electric flux is obtained by evaluating the charge have the same number of field lines
surface integral crossing it, regardless of the shape or size of the
surface, as long as the surfaces enclose the
same amount of charge.

where the notation used here is for a closed 6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law
surface S.
• For a charge distribution with certain spatial
6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law symmetries (spherical, cylindrical, and planar),
we can find a Gaussian surface over which
• Gauss’s law relates the electric flux through a
closed surface to the net charge within that , where E is constant over the surface.
268 6 • Chapter Review

The electric field is then determined with perpendicular, resulting in Gauss’s law being
Gauss’s law. .
• For spherical symmetry, the Gaussian surface is
also a sphere, and Gauss’s law simplifies to 6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium
.
• The electric field inside a conductor vanishes.
• For cylindrical symmetry, we use a cylindrical • Any excess charge placed on a conductor
Gaussian surface, and find that Gauss’s law resides entirely on the surface of the conductor.
simplifies to . • The electric field is perpendicular to the surface
• For planar symmetry, a convenient Gaussian of a conductor everywhere on that surface.
surface is a box penetrating the plane, with two • The magnitude of the electric field just above
faces parallel to the plane and the remainder the surface of a conductor is given by .

Conceptual Questions
6.1 Electric Flux normal of the Gaussian surface to be the one
directed inward.
1. Discuss how to orient a planar surface of area A
in a uniform electric field of magnitude to
6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law
obtain (a) the maximum flux and (b) the
minimum flux through the area. 13. Would Gauss’s law be helpful for determining
2. What are the maximum and minimum values of the electric field of two equal but opposite
the flux in the preceding question? charges a fixed distance apart?
3. The net electric flux crossing a closed surface is 14. Discuss the role that symmetry plays in the
always zero. True or false? application of Gauss’s law. Give examples of
4. The net electric flux crossing an open surface is continuous charge distributions in which
never zero. True or false? Gauss’s law is useful and not useful in
determining the electric field.
6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law 15. Discuss the restrictions on the Gaussian surface
used to discuss planar symmetry. For example,
5. Two concentric spherical surfaces enclose a
is its length important? Does the cross-section
point charge q. The radius of the outer sphere is
have to be square? Must the end faces be on
twice that of the inner one. Compare the electric
opposite sides of the sheet?
fluxes crossing the two surfaces.
6. Compare the electric flux through the surface of a
6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium
cube of side length a that has a charge q at its
center to the flux through a spherical surface of 16. Is the electric field inside a metal always zero?
radius a with a charge q at its center. 17. Under electrostatic conditions, the excess
7. (a) If the electric flux through a closed surface is charge on a conductor resides on its surface.
zero, is the electric field necessarily zero at all Does this mean that all the conduction electrons
points on the surface? (b) What is the net charge in a conductor are on the surface?
inside the surface? 18. A charge q is placed in the cavity of a conductor
8. Discuss how Gauss’s law would be affected if the as shown below. Will a charge outside the
electric field of a point charge did not vary as conductor experience an electric field due to the
presence of q?
9. Discuss the similarities and differences between
the gravitational field of a point mass m and the
electric field of a point charge q.
10. Discuss whether Gauss’s law can be applied to
other forces, and if so, which ones.
11. Is the term in Gauss’s law the electric field
produced by just the charge inside the Gaussian
surface?
12. Reformulate Gauss’s law by choosing the unit

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 269

19. The conductor in the preceding figure has an


excess charge of . If a point
charge is placed in the cavity, what is the net
charge on the surface of the cavity and on the
outer surface of the conductor?

Problems
6.1 Electric Flux the square is oriented relative to the direction of
the electric field. Find the electric flux through
20. A uniform electric field of magnitude
the square, when the normal to it makes the
is perpendicular to a square
following angles with electric field: (a) , (b)
sheet with sides 2.0 m long. What is the electric
, and (c) . Note that these angles can also
flux through the sheet?
be given as .
21. Calculate the flux through the sheet of the
26. A vector field is pointed along the z-axis,
previous problem if the plane of the sheet is at
(a) Find the flux of the vector field
an angle of to the field. Find the flux for both
directions of the unit normal to the sheet. through a rectangle in the xy-plane between
22. Find the electric flux through a rectangular area and . (b) Do the same
between two parallel plates where through a rectangle in the yz-plane between
there is a constant electric field of 30 N/C for the and . (Leave your answer as
following orientations of the area: (a) parallel to an integral.)
the plates, (b) perpendicular to the plates, and 27. Consider the uniform electric field
(c) the normal to the area making a angle What is its
with the direction of the electric field. Note that electric flux through a circular area of radius
this angle can also be given as 2.0 m that lies in the xy-plane?
23. The electric flux through a square-shaped area 28. Repeat the previous problem, given that the
of side 5 cm near a large charged sheet is found circular area is (a) in the yz-plane and (b)
to be when the area is above the xy-plane.
parallel to the plate. Find the charge density on 29. An infinite charged wire with charge per unit
the sheet. length lies along the central axis of a
24. Two large rectangular aluminum plates of area cylindrical surface of radius r and length l. What
face each other with a separation of 3 is the flux through the surface due to the
mm between them. The plates are charged with electric field of the charged wire?
equal amount of opposite charges, . The
charges on the plates face each other. Find the 6.2 Explaining Gauss’s Law
flux through a circle of radius 3 cm between the
30. Determine the electric flux through each closed
plates when the normal to the circle makes an
surface where the cross-section inside the surface is
angle of with a line perpendicular to the
shown below.
plates. Note that this angle can also be given as

25. A square surface of area is in a space of


uniform electric field of magnitude .
The amount of flux through it depends on how
270 6 • Chapter Review

31. Find the electric flux through the closed surface


whose cross-sections are shown below.

32. A point charge q is located at the center of a


cube whose sides are of length a. If there are no
other charges in this system, what is the electric
flux through one face of the cube?
33. A point charge of is at an unspecified
location inside a cube of side 2 cm. Find the net
electric flux though the surfaces of the cube.

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 271

34. A net flux of passes inward Obtain expressions for the electric field both
through the surface of a sphere of radius 5 cm. inside and outside the distribution.
(a) How much charge is inside the sphere? (b) 43. A very long, thin wire has a uniform linear
How precisely can we determine the location of charge density of What is the electric
the charge from this information? field at a distance 2.0 cm from the wire?
35. A charge q is placed at one of the corners of a 44. A charge of is distributed uniformly
cube of side a, as shown below. Find the throughout a spherical volume of radius 10.0
magnitude of the electric flux through the cm. Determine the electric field due to this
shaded face due to q. Assume . charge at a distance of (a) 2.0 cm, (b) 5.0 cm,
and (c) 20.0 cm from the center of the sphere.
45. Repeat your calculations for the preceding
problem, given that the charge is distributed
uniformly over the surface of a spherical
conductor of radius 10.0 cm.
46. A total charge Q is distributed uniformly
throughout a spherical shell of inner and outer
radii respectively. Show that the
electric field due to the charge is

36. The electric flux through a cubical box 8.0 cm


on a side is What is the
total charge enclosed by the box?
37. The electric flux through a spherical surface is
What is the net charge 47. When a charge is placed on a metal sphere, it
enclosed by the surface? ends up in equilibrium at the outer surface. Use
38. A cube whose sides are of length d is placed in a this information to determine the electric field
uniform electric field of magnitude of charge put on a 5.0-cm aluminum
so that the field is spherical ball at the following two points in
perpendicular to two opposite faces of the cube. space: (a) a point 1.0 cm from the center of the
What is the net flux through the cube? ball (an inside point) and (b) a point 10 cm from
39. Repeat the previous problem, assuming that the the center of the ball (an outside point).
electric field is directed along a body diagonal of 48. A large sheet of charge has a uniform charge
the cube. density of What is the electric field
40. A total charge is distributed due to this charge at a point just above the
uniformly throughout a cubical volume whose surface of the sheet?
edges are 8.0 cm long. (a) What is the charge 49. Determine if approximate cylindrical symmetry
density in the cube? (b) What is the electric flux holds for the following situations. State why or
through a cube with 12.0-cm edges that is why not. (a) A 300-cm long copper rod of radius
concentric with the charge distribution? (c) Do 1 cm is charged with +500 nC of charge and we
the same calculation for cubes whose edges are seek electric field at a point 5 cm from the
10.0 cm long and 5.0 cm long. (d) What is the center of the rod. (b) A 10-cm long copper rod of
electric flux through a spherical surface of radius 1 cm is charged with +500 nC of charge
radius 3.0 cm that is also concentric with the and we seek electric field at a point 5 cm from
charge distribution? the center of the rod. (c) A 150-cm wooden rod
is glued to a 150-cm plastic rod to make a
6.3 Applying Gauss’s Law 300-cm long rod, which is then painted with a
charged paint so that one obtains a uniform
41. Recall that in the example of a uniform charged
charge density. The radius of each rod is 1 cm,
sphere, Rewrite the answers
and we seek an electric field at a point that is 4
in terms of the total charge Q on the sphere. cm from the center of the rod. (d) Same rod as
42. Suppose that the charge density of the spherical (c), but we seek electric field at a point that is
charge distribution shown in Figure 6.23 is 500 cm from the center of the rod.
for and zero for 50. A long silver rod of radius 3 cm has a charge of
272 6 • Chapter Review

on its surface. (a) Find the electric the ball’s center and has magnitude
field at a point 5 cm from the center of the rod How much charge is on the
(an outside point). (b) Find the electric field at a surface of the ball?
point 2 cm from the center of the rod (an inside 56. Charge is distributed throughout a spherical
point). shell of inner radius and outer radius with
51. The electric field at 2 cm from the center of long a volume density given by where
copper rod of radius 1 cm has a magnitude 3 N/ is a constant. Determine the electric field due to
C and directed outward from the axis of the rod. this charge as a function of r, the distance from
(a) How much charge per unit length exists on the center of the shell.
the copper rod? (b) What would be the electric 57. Charge is distributed throughout a spherical
flux through a cube of side 5 cm situated such volume of radius R with a density
that the rod passes through opposite sides of where is a constant. Determine the electric
the cube perpendicularly? field due to the charge at points both inside and
52. A long copper cylindrical shell of inner radius 2 outside the sphere.
cm and outer radius 3 cm surrounds 58. Consider a uranium nucleus to be sphere of
concentrically a charged long aluminum rod of radius with a charge of 92e
radius 1 cm with a charge density of 4 pC/m. All distributed uniformly throughout its volume. (a)
charges on the aluminum rod reside at its What is the electric force exerted on an electron
surface. The inner surface of the copper shell when it is from the center of the
has exactly opposite charge to that of the nucleus? (b) What is the acceleration of the
aluminum rod while the outer surface of the electron at this point?
copper shell has the same charge as the 59. The volume charge density of a spherical charge
aluminum rod. Find the magnitude and distribution is given by where
direction of the electric field at points that are at and are constants. What is the electric field
the following distances from the center of the produced by this charge distribution?
aluminum rod: (a) 0.5 cm, (b) 1.5 cm, (c) 2.5 cm,
(d) 3.5 cm, and (e) 7 cm. 6.4 Conductors in Electrostatic Equilibrium
53. Charge is distributed uniformly with a density
throughout an infinitely long cylindrical volume 60. An uncharged conductor with an internal cavity
of radius R. Show that the field of this charge is shown in the following figure. Use the closed
distribution is directed radially with respect to surface S along with Gauss’ law to show that
the cylinder and that when a charge q is placed in the cavity a total
charge –q is induced on the inner surface of the
conductor. What is the charge on the outer
surface of the conductor?

54. Charge is distributed throughout a very long


cylindrical volume of radius R such that the
charge density increases with the distance r
from the central axis of the cylinder according
to where is a constant. Show that the
field of this charge distribution is directed
radially with respect to the cylinder and that Figure 6.46 A charge inside a cavity of a metal. Charges at
the outer surface do not depend on how the charges are
distributed at the inner surface since E field inside the body
of the metal is zero.

61. An uncharged spherical conductor S of radius R


has two spherical cavities A and B of radii a and
55. The electric field 10.0 cm from the surface of a b, respectively as shown below. Two point
copper ball of radius 5.0 cm is directed toward charges and are placed at the center of

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 273

the two cavities by using non-conducting the center of the rod.


supports. In addition, a point charge is 66. At the surface of any conductor in electrostatic
placed outside at a distance r from the center of equilibrium, Show that this equation
the sphere. (a) Draw approximate charge is consistent with the fact that at the
distributions in the metal although metal surface of a spherical conductor.
sphere has no net charge. (b) Draw electric field 67. Two parallel plates 10 cm on a side are given
lines. Draw enough lines to represent all equal and opposite charges of magnitude
distinctly different places. The plates are 1.5 mm apart.
What is the electric field at the center of the
region between the plates?
68. Two parallel conducting plates, each of cross-
sectional area , are 2.0 cm apart and
uncharged. If electrons are
transferred from one plate to the other, what are
(a) the charge density on each plate? (b) The
electric field between the plates?
69. The surface charge density on a long straight
metallic pipe is . What is the electric field
62. A positive point charge is placed at the angle
outside and inside the pipe? Assume the pipe
bisector of two uncharged plane conductors
has a diameter of 2a.
that make an angle of See below. Draw the
electric field lines.

63. A long cylinder of copper of radius 3 cm is


charged so that it has a uniform charge per unit
length on its surface of 3 C/m. (a) Find the
electric field inside and outside the cylinder. (b)
Draw electric field lines in a plane
perpendicular to the rod.
64. An aluminum spherical ball of radius 4 cm is
charged with of charge. A copper spherical
shell of inner radius 6 cm and outer radius 8 cm
surrounds it. A total charge of is put on
the copper shell. (a) Find the electric field at all
70. A point charge is placed at
points in space, including points inside the
the center of a spherical conducting shell of
aluminum and copper shell when copper shell
inner radius 3.5 cm and outer radius 4.0 cm.
and aluminum sphere are concentric. (b) Find
The electric field just above the surface of the
the electric field at all points in space, including
conductor is directed radially outward and has
points inside the aluminum and copper shell
magnitude 8.0 N/C. (a) What is the charge
when the centers of copper shell and aluminum
density on the inner surface of the shell? (b)
sphere are 1 cm apart.
What is the charge density on the outer surface
65. A long cylinder of aluminum of radius R meters
of the shell? (c) What is the net charge on the
is charged so that it has a uniform charge per
conductor?
unit length on its surface of . (a) Find the
71. A solid cylindrical conductor of radius a is
electric field inside and outside the cylinder. (b)
surrounded by a concentric cylindrical shell of
Plot electric field as a function of distance from
inner radius b. The solid cylinder and the shell
274 6 • Chapter Review

carry charges +Q and –Q, respectively. electric field as a function of r, the distance from
Assuming that the length L of both conductors the common central axis of the cylinders, for (a)
is much greater than a or b, determine the (b) and (c)

Additional Problems
72. A vector field (not necessarily an electric field; 77. The electric field in a region is given by
note units) is given by Calculate where
and What is
where S is the area shown below.
the net charge enclosed by the shaded volume
Assume that shown below?

73. Repeat the preceding problem, with 78. Two equal and opposite charges of magnitude Q
are located on the x-axis at the points +a and –a,
74. A circular area S is concentric with the origin, as shown below. What is the net flux due to
has radius a, and lies in the yz-plane. Calculate these charges through a square surface of side
2a that lies in the yz-plane and is centered at
for the origin? (Hint: Determine the flux due to each
75. (a) Calculate the electric flux through the open charge separately, then use the principle of
hemispherical surface due to the electric field superposition. You may be able to make a
symmetry argument.)
(see below). (b) If the hemisphere is
rotated by around the x-axis, what is the
flux through it?

76. Suppose that the electric field of an isolated


79. A fellow student calculated the flux through the
point charge were proportional to rather
square for the system in the preceding problem
than Determine the flux that passes
and got 0. What went wrong?
through the surface of a sphere of radius R
centered at the charge. Would Gauss’s law
remain valid?

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 275

80. A piece of aluminum foil of 0.1 84. A total charge Q is distributed uniformly
mm thickness has a charge of that throughout a spherical volume that is centered
spreads on both wide side surfaces evenly. You at and has a radius R. Without disturbing the
may ignore the charges on the thin sides of the charge remaining, charge is removed from the
edges. (a) Find the charge density. (b) Find the spherical volume that is centered at (see
electric field 1 cm from the center, assuming below). Show that the electric field everywhere
approximate planar symmetry. in the empty region is given by
81. Two pieces of aluminum foil of
thickness 0.1 mm face each other with a
separation of 5 mm. One of the foils has a where is the displacement vector directed
charge of and the other has . (a) from
Find the charge density at all surfaces, i.e., on
those facing each other and those facing away.
(b) Find the electric field between the plates
near the center assuming planar symmetry.
82. Two large copper plates facing each other have
charge densities on the surface
facing the other plate, and zero in between the
plates. Find the electric flux through a
rectangular area between the
plates, as shown below, for the following
85. A non-conducting spherical shell of inner
orientations of the area. (a) If the area is parallel
radius and outer radius is uniformly
to the plates, and (b) if the area is tilted
charged with charged density inside another
from the parallel direction. Note, this angle can
non-conducting spherical shell of inner radius
also be
and outer radius that is also uniformly
charged with charge density . See below. Find
the electric field at space point P at a distance r
from the common center such that (a)
(b) (c) (d)
and (e) .

83. The infinite slab between the planes defined by


and contains a uniform
volume charge density (see below). What is the
electric field produced by this charge
distribution, both inside and outside the
distribution?
276 6 • Chapter Review

86. Two non-conducting spheres of radii and 89. Shown below are two concentric conducting
are uniformly charged with charge densities spherical shells of radii and , each of
and respectively. They are separated at finite thickness much less than either radius.
center-to-center distance a (see below). Find the The inner and outer shell carry net charges
electric field at point P located at a distance r and respectively, where both and are
from the center of sphere 1 and is in the positive. What is the electric field for (a)
direction from the line joining the two spheres (b) and (c) (d) What is the
assuming their charge densities are not affected net charge on the inner surface of the inner
by the presence of the other sphere. (Hint: Work shell, the outer surface of the inner shell, the
one sphere at a time and use the superposition inner surface of the outer shell, and the outer
principle.) surface of the outer shell?

87. A disk of radius R is cut in a non-conducting large


plate that is uniformly charged with charge density
(coulomb per square meter). See below. Find the
electric field at a height h above the center of the
disk. (Hint: Fill the hole
with

90. A point charge of is placed at


the center of an uncharged spherical
conducting shell of inner radius 6.0 cm and
outer radius 9.0 cm. Find the electric field at (a)
, (b) , and (c) .
(d) What are the charges induced on the inner
88. Concentric conducting spherical shells carry
and outer surfaces of the shell?
charges Q and –Q, respectively (see below). The
inner shell has negligible thickness. Determine
the electric field for (a) (b) (c)
and (d)

Access for free at openstax.org.


6 • Chapter Review 277

Challenge Problems
91. The Hubble Space Telescope can measure the 94. A spherical rubber balloon carries a total charge
energy flux from distant objects such as Q distributed uniformly over its surface. At
supernovae and stars. Scientists then use this , the radius of the balloon is R. The balloon
data to calculate the energy emitted by that is then slowly inflated until its radius reaches
object. Choose an interstellar object which 2R at the time Determine the electric field
scientists have observed the flux at the Hubble due to this charge as a function of time (a) at the
3
with (for example, Vega ), find the distance to surface of the balloon, (b) at the surface of
that object and the size of Hubble’s primary radius R, and (c) at the surface of radius 2R.
mirror, and calculate the total energy flux. (Hint: Ignore any effect on the electric field due to the
The Hubble intercepts only a small part of the material of the balloon and assume that the
total flux.) radius increases uniformly with time.
95. Find the electric field of a large conducting plate
92. Re-derive Gauss’s law for the gravitational field, containing a net charge q. Let A be area of one
with directed positively outward. side of the plate and h the thickness of the plate
93. An infinite plate sheet of charge of surface charge (see below). The charge on the metal plate will
density is shown below. What is the electric field at distribute mostly on the two planar sides and
a distance x from the sheet? Compare the result of very little on the edges if the plate is thin.
this calculation with that of worked out in the text.

3 http://adsabs.harvard.edu/abs/2004AJ....127.3508B
278 6 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 7
Electric Potential

Figure 7.1 The energy released in a lightning strike is an excellent illustration of the vast quantities of energy that
may be stored and released by an electric potential difference. In this chapter, we calculate just how much energy
can be released in a lightning strike and how this varies with the height of the clouds from the ground. (credit:
modification of work by Anthony Quintano)

Chapter Outline

7.1 Electric Potential Energy

7.2 Electric Potential and Potential Difference

7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential

7.4 Determining Field from Potential

7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors

7.6 Applications of Electrostatics

INTRODUCTION In Electric Charges and Fields, we just scratched the surface (or at least rubbed it) of
electrical phenomena. Two terms commonly used to describe electricity are its energy and voltage, which we
show in this chapter is directly related to the potential energy in a system.

We know, for example, that great amounts of electrical energy can be stored in batteries, are transmitted cross-
country via currents through power lines, and may jump from clouds to explode the sap of trees. In a similar
manner, at the molecular level, ions cross cell membranes and transfer information.
280 7 • Electric Potential

We also know about voltages associated with electricity. Batteries are typically a few volts, the outlets in your
home frequently produce 120 volts, and power lines can be as high as hundreds of thousands of volts. But
energy and voltage are not the same thing. A motorcycle battery, for example, is small and would not be very
successful in replacing a much larger car battery, yet each has the same voltage. In this chapter, we examine
the relationship between voltage and electrical energy, and begin to explore some of the many applications of
electricity.

7.1 Electric Potential Energy


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define the work done by an electric force
• Define electric potential energy
• Apply work and potential energy in systems with electric charges

When a free positive charge q is accelerated by an electric field, it is given kinetic energy (Figure 7.2). The
process is analogous to an object being accelerated by a gravitational field, as if the charge were going down an
electrical hill where its electric potential energy is converted into kinetic energy, although of course the
sources of the forces are very different. Let us explore the work done on a charge q by the electric field in this
process, so that we may develop a definition of electric potential energy.

Figure 7.2 A charge accelerated by an electric field is analogous to a mass going down a hill. In both cases, potential energy decreases as
kinetic energy increases, . Work is done by a force, but since this force is conservative, we can write .

The electrostatic or Coulomb force is conservative, which means that the work done on q is independent of the
path taken, as we will demonstrate later. This is exactly analogous to the gravitational force. When a force is
conservative, it is possible to define a potential energy associated with the force. It is usually easier to work
with the potential energy (because it depends only on position) than to calculate the work directly.

To show this explicitly, consider an electric charge fixed at the origin and move another charge toward
q in such a manner that, at each instant, the applied force exactly balances the electric force on Q (Figure
7.3). The work done by the applied force on the charge Q changes the potential energy of Q. We call this
potential energy the electrical potential energy of Q.

Figure 7.3 Displacement of “test” charge Q in the presence of fixed “source” charge q.

The work done by the applied force when the particle moves from to may be calculated by

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.1 • Electric Potential Energy 281

Since the applied force balances the electric force on Q, the two forces have equal magnitude and
opposite directions. Therefore, the applied force is

where we have defined positive to be pointing away from the origin and r is the distance from the origin. The
directions of both the displacement and the applied force in the system in Figure 7.3 are parallel, and thus the
work done on the system is positive.

We use the letter U to denote electric potential energy, which has units of joules (J). When a conservative force
does negative work, the system gains potential energy. When a conservative force does positive work, the
system loses potential energy, In the system in Figure 7.3, the Coulomb force acts in the opposite
direction to the displacement; therefore, the work is negative. However, we have increased the potential energy
in the two-charge system.

EXAMPLE 7.1

Kinetic Energy of a Charged Particle


A charge Q is initially at rest a distance of 10 cm ( ) from a charge q fixed at the origin
(Figure 7.4). Naturally, the Coulomb force accelerates Q away from q, eventually reaching 15 cm ( ).

Figure 7.4 The charge Q is repelled by q, thus having work done on it and gaining kinetic energy.

a. What is the work done by the electric field between and ?


b. How much kinetic energy does Q have at ?

Strategy
Calculate the work with the usual definition. Since Q started from rest, this is the same as the kinetic energy.

Solution
Integrating force over distance, we obtain

This is also the value of the kinetic energy at

Significance
Charge Q was initially at rest; the electric field of q did work on Q, so now Q has kinetic energy equal to the
work done by the electric field.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.1


If Q has a mass of what is the speed of Q at
282 7 • Electric Potential

In this example, the work W done to accelerate a positive charge from rest is positive and results from a loss in
U, or a negative . A value for U can be found at any point by taking one point as a reference and calculating
the work needed to move a charge to the other point.

Electric Potential Energy


Work W done to accelerate a positive charge from rest is positive and results from a loss in U, or a negative
. Mathematically,
7.1

Gravitational potential energy and electric potential energy are quite analogous. Potential energy accounts for
work done by a conservative force and gives added insight regarding energy and energy transformation
without the necessity of dealing with the force directly. It is much more common, for example, to use the
concept of electric potential energy than to deal with the Coulomb force directly in real-world applications.

In polar coordinates with q at the origin and Q located at r, the displacement element vector is and
thus the work becomes

Notice that this result only depends on the endpoints and is otherwise independent of the path taken. To
explore this further, compare path to with path in Figure 7.5.

Figure 7.5 Two paths for displacement to The work on segments and are zero due to the electrical force being
perpendicular to the displacement along these paths. Therefore, work on paths and are equal.

The segments and are arcs of circles centered at q. Since the force on Q points either toward or
away from q, no work is done by a force balancing the electric force, because it is perpendicular to the
displacement along these arcs. Therefore, the only work done is along segment which is identical to

One implication of this work calculation is that if we were to go around the path the net work
would be zero (Figure 7.6). Recall that this is how we determine whether a force is conservative or not. Hence,
because the electric force is related to the electric field by , the electric field is itself conservative. That
is,

Note that Q is a constant.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.1 • Electric Potential Energy 283

Figure 7.6 A closed path in an electric field. The net work around this path is zero.

Another implication is that we may define an electric potential energy. Recall that the work done by a
conservative force is also expressed as the difference in the potential energy corresponding to that force.
Therefore, the work to bring a charge from a reference point to a point of interest may be written as

and, by Equation 7.1, the difference in potential energy of the test charge Q between the two points
is

Therefore, we can write a general expression for the potential energy of two point charges (in spherical
coordinates):

We may take the second term to be an arbitrary constant reference level, which serves as the zero reference:

A convenient choice of reference that relies on our common sense is that when the two charges are infinitely
far apart, there is no interaction between them. (Recall the discussion of reference potential energy in
Potential Energy and Conservation of Energy.) Taking the potential energy of this state to be zero removes the
term from the equation (just like when we say the ground is zero potential energy in a gravitational
potential energy problem), and the potential energy of Q when it is separated from q by a distance r assumes
the form

∞ 7.2

This formula is symmetrical with respect to q and Q, so it is best described as the potential energy of the two-
charge system.

EXAMPLE 7.2

Potential Energy of a Charged Particle


A charge Q is initially at rest a distance of 10 cm ( ) from a charge q fixed at the origin
(Figure 7.7). Naturally, the Coulomb force accelerates Q away from q, eventually reaching 15 cm ( ).
284 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.7 The charge Q is repelled by q, thus having work done on it and losing potential energy.

What is the change in the potential energy of the two-charge system from to

Strategy

Calculate the potential energy with the definition given above: Since Q started from

rest, this is the same as the kinetic energy.

Solution
We have

Significance
The change in the potential energy is negative, as expected, and equal in magnitude to the change in kinetic
energy in this system. Recall from Example 7.1 that the change in kinetic energy was positive.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.2


What is the potential energy of Q relative to the zero reference at infinity at in the above example?

Due to Coulomb’s law, the forces due to multiple charges on a test charge Q superimpose; they may be
calculated individually and then added. This implies that the work integrals and hence the resulting potential
energies exhibit the same behavior. To demonstrate this, we consider an example of assembling a system of
four charges.

EXAMPLE 7.3

Assembling Four Positive Charges


Find the amount of work an external agent must do in assembling four charges
and at the vertices of a square of side 1.0 cm, starting each charge from infinity (Figure 7.8).

Figure 7.8 How much work is needed to assemble this charge configuration?

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.1 • Electric Potential Energy 285

Strategy
We bring in the charges one at a time, giving them starting locations at infinity and calculating the work to
bring them in from infinity to their final location. We do this in order of increasing charge.

Solution
Step 1. First bring the charge to the origin. Since there are no other charges at a finite distance from
this charge yet, no work is done in bringing it from infinity,

Step 2. While keeping the charge fixed at the origin, bring the charge to
(Figure 7.9). Now, the applied force must do work against the force exerted by the
charge fixed at the origin. The work done equals the change in the potential energy of the
charge:

Figure 7.9 Step 2. Work to bring the charge from infinity.

Step 3. While keeping the charges of and fixed in their places, bring in the charge to
(Figure 7.10). The work done in this step is

Figure 7.10 Step 3. The work to bring the charge from infinity.

Step 4. Finally, while keeping the first three charges in their places, bring the charge to
(Figure 7.11). The work done here is
286 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.11 Step 4. The work to bring the charge from infinity.

Hence, the total work done by the applied force in assembling the four charges is equal to the sum of the work
in bringing each charge from infinity to its final position:

Significance
The work on each charge depends only on its pairwise interactions with the other charges. No more
complicated interactions need to be considered; the work on the third charge only depends on its interaction
with the first and second charges, the interaction between the first and second charge does not affect the third.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.3


Is the electrical potential energy of two point charges positive or negative if the charges are of the same sign?
Opposite signs? How does this relate to the work necessary to bring the charges into proximity from infinity?

Note that the electrical potential energy is positive if the two charges are of the same type, either positive or
negative, and negative if the two charges are of opposite types. This makes sense if you think of the change in
the potential energy as you bring the two charges closer or move them farther apart. Depending on the
relative types of charges, you may have to work on the system or the system would do work on you, that is, your
work is either positive or negative. If you have to do positive work on the system (actually push the charges
closer), then the energy of the system should increase. If you bring two positive charges or two negative
charges closer, you have to do positive work on the system, which raises their potential energy. Since potential
energy is proportional to 1/r, the potential energy goes up when r goes down between two positive or two
negative charges.

On the other hand, if you bring a positive and a negative charge nearer, you have to do negative work on the
system (the charges are pulling you), which means that you take energy away from the system. This reduces
the potential energy. Since potential energy is negative in the case of a positive and a negative charge pair, the
increase in 1/r makes the potential energy more negative, which is the same as a reduction in potential energy.

The result from Example 7.1 may be extended to systems with any arbitrary number of charges. In this case, it
is most convenient to write the formula as

7.3

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 287

The factor of 1/2 accounts for adding each pair of charges twice.

7.2 Electric Potential and Potential Difference


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define electric potential, voltage, and potential difference
• Define the electron-volt
• Calculate electric potential and potential difference from potential energy and electric field
• Describe systems in which the electron-volt is a useful unit
• Apply conservation of energy to electric systems

Recall that earlier we defined electric field to be a quantity independent of the test charge in a given system,
which would nonetheless allow us to calculate the force that would result on an arbitrary test charge. (The
default assumption in the absence of other information is that the test charge is positive.) We briefly defined a
field for gravity, but gravity is always attractive, whereas the electric force can be either attractive or repulsive.
Therefore, although potential energy is perfectly adequate in a gravitational system, it is convenient to define a
quantity that allows us to calculate the work on a charge independent of the magnitude of the charge.
Calculating the work directly may be difficult, since and the direction and magnitude of can be
complex for multiple charges, for odd-shaped objects, and along arbitrary paths. But we do know that because
, the work, and hence is proportional to the test charge q. To have a physical quantity that is
independent of test charge, we define electric potential V (or simply potential, since electric is understood) to
be the potential energy per unit charge:

Electric Potential
The electric potential energy per unit charge is

7.4

Since U is proportional to q, the dependence on q cancels. Thus, V does not depend on q. The change in
potential energy is crucial, so we are concerned with the difference in potential or potential difference
between two points, where

Electric Potential Difference


The electric potential difference between points A and B, is defined to be the change in
potential energy of a charge q moved from A to B, divided by the charge. Units of potential difference are
joules per coulomb, given the name volt (V) after Alessandro Volta.

The familiar term voltage is the common name for electric potential difference. Keep in mind that whenever a
voltage is quoted, it is understood to be the potential difference between two points. For example, every battery
has two terminals, and its voltage is the potential difference between them. More fundamentally, the point you
choose to be zero volts is arbitrary. This is analogous to the fact that gravitational potential energy has an
arbitrary zero, such as sea level or perhaps a lecture hall floor. It is worthwhile to emphasize the distinction
between potential difference and electrical potential energy.
288 7 • Electric Potential

Potential Difference and Electrical Potential Energy


The relationship between potential difference (or voltage) and electrical potential energy is given by

7.5

Voltage is not the same as energy. Voltage is the energy per unit charge. Thus, a motorcycle battery and a car
battery can both have the same voltage (more precisely, the same potential difference between battery
terminals), yet one stores much more energy than the other because The car battery can move
more charge than the motorcycle battery, although both are 12-V batteries.

EXAMPLE 7.4

Calculating Energy
You have a 12.0-V motorcycle battery that can move 5000 C of charge, and a 12.0-V car battery that can move
60,000 C of charge. How much energy does each deliver? (Assume that the numerical value of each charge is
accurate to three significant figures.)

Strategy
To say we have a 12.0-V battery means that its terminals have a 12.0-V potential difference. When such a
battery moves charge, it puts the charge through a potential difference of 12.0 V, and the charge is given a
change in potential energy equal to To find the energy output, we multiply the charge moved by
the potential difference.

Solution
For the motorcycle battery, and . The total energy delivered by the motorcycle battery
is

Similarly, for the car battery, and

Significance
Voltage and energy are related, but they are not the same thing. The voltages of the batteries are identical, but
the energy supplied by each is quite different. A car battery has a much larger engine to start than a
motorcycle. Note also that as a battery is discharged, some of its energy is used internally and its terminal
voltage drops, such as when headlights dim because of a depleted car battery. The energy supplied by the
battery is still calculated as in this example, but not all of the energy is available for external use.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.4


How much energy does a 1.5-V AAA battery have that can move 100 C?

Note that the energies calculated in the previous example are absolute values. The change in potential energy
for the battery is negative, since it loses energy. These batteries, like many electrical systems, actually move
negative charge—electrons in particular. The batteries repel electrons from their negative terminals (A)
through whatever circuitry is involved and attract them to their positive terminals (B), as shown in Figure 7.12.
The change in potential is and the charge q is negative, so that is
negative, meaning the potential energy of the battery has decreased when q has moved from A to B.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 289

Figure 7.12 A battery moves negative charge from its negative terminal through a headlight to its positive terminal. Appropriate
combinations of chemicals in the battery separate charges so that the negative terminal has an excess of negative charge, which is repelled
by it and attracted to the excess positive charge on the other terminal. In terms of potential, the positive terminal is at a higher voltage than
the negative terminal. Inside the battery, both positive and negative charges move.

EXAMPLE 7.5

How Many Electrons Move through a Headlight Each Second?


When a 12.0-V car battery powers a single 30.0-W headlight, how many electrons pass through it each second?

Strategy
To find the number of electrons, we must first find the charge that moves in 1.00 s. The charge moved is related
to voltage and energy through the equations A 30.0-W lamp uses 30.0 joules per second. Since the
battery loses energy, we have and, since the electrons are going from the negative terminal to the
positive, we see that

Solution
To find the charge q moved, we solve the equation

Entering the values for and , we get

The number of electrons is the total charge divided by the charge per electron. That is,

Significance
This is a very large number. It is no wonder that we do not ordinarily observe individual electrons with so
many being present in ordinary systems. In fact, electricity had been in use for many decades before it was
determined that the moving charges in many circumstances were negative. Positive charge moving in the
opposite direction of negative charge often produces identical effects; this makes it difficult to determine
which is moving or whether both are moving.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.5


How many electrons would go through a 24.0-W lamp?
290 7 • Electric Potential

The Electron-Volt
The energy per electron is very small in macroscopic situations like that in the previous example—a tiny
fraction of a joule. But on a submicroscopic scale, such energy per particle (electron, proton, or ion) can be of
great importance. For example, even a tiny fraction of a joule can be great enough for these particles to destroy
organic molecules and harm living tissue. The particle may do its damage by direct collision, or it may create
harmful X-rays, which can also inflict damage. It is useful to have an energy unit related to submicroscopic
effects.

Figure 7.13 shows a situation related to the definition of such an energy unit. An electron is accelerated
between two charged metal plates, as it might be in an old-model television tube or oscilloscope. The electron
gains kinetic energy that is later converted into another form—light in the television tube, for example. (Note
that in terms of energy, “downhill” for the electron is “uphill” for a positive charge.) Since energy is related to
voltage by , we can think of the joule as a coulomb-volt.

Figure 7.13 A typical electron gun accelerates electrons using a potential difference between two separated metal plates. By
conservation of energy, the kinetic energy has to equal the change in potential energy, so . The energy of the electron in electron-
volts is numerically the same as the voltage between the plates. For example, a 5000-V potential difference produces 5000-eV electrons.
The conceptual construct, namely two parallel plates with a hole in one, is shown in (a), while a real electron gun is shown in (b).

Electron-Volt
On the submicroscopic scale, it is more convenient to define an energy unit called the electron-volt (eV),
which is the energy given to a fundamental charge accelerated through a potential difference of 1 V. In
equation form,

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 291

An electron accelerated through a potential difference of 1 V is given an energy of 1 eV. It follows that an
electron accelerated through 50 V gains 50 eV. A potential difference of 100,000 V (100 kV) gives an electron an
energy of 100,000 eV (100 keV), and so on. Similarly, an ion with a double positive charge accelerated through
100 V gains 200 eV of energy. These simple relationships between accelerating voltage and particle charges
make the electron-volt a simple and convenient energy unit in such circumstances.

The electron-volt is commonly employed in submicroscopic processes—chemical valence energies and


molecular and nuclear binding energies are among the quantities often expressed in electron-volts. For
example, about 5 eV of energy is required to break up certain organic molecules. If a proton is accelerated from
rest through a potential difference of 30 kV, it acquires an energy of 30 keV (30,000 eV) and can break up as
many as 6000 of these molecules Nuclear decay energies
are on the order of 1 MeV (1,000,000 eV) per event and can thus produce significant biological damage.

Conservation of Energy
The total energy of a system is conserved if there is no net addition (or subtraction) due to work or heat
transfer. For conservative forces, such as the electrostatic force, conservation of energy states that mechanical
energy is a constant.

Mechanical energy is the sum of the kinetic energy and potential energy of a system; that is,
A loss of U for a charged particle becomes an increase in its K. Conservation of energy is stated in equation
form as

or

where i and f stand for initial and final conditions. As we have found many times before, considering energy
can give us insights and facilitate problem solving.

EXAMPLE 7.6

Electrical Potential Energy Converted into Kinetic Energy


Calculate the final speed of a free electron accelerated from rest through a potential difference of 100 V.
(Assume that this numerical value is accurate to three significant figures.)

Strategy
We have a system with only conservative forces. Assuming the electron is accelerated in a vacuum, and
neglecting the gravitational force (we will check on this assumption later), all of the electrical potential energy
is converted into kinetic energy. We can identify the initial and final forms of energy to be

Solution
Conservation of energy states that

Entering the forms identified above, we obtain

We solve this for v:

Entering values for q, V, and m gives


292 7 • Electric Potential

Significance
Note that both the charge and the initial voltage are negative, as in Figure 7.13. From the discussion of electric
charge and electric field, we know that electrostatic forces on small particles are generally very large
compared with the gravitational force. The large final speed confirms that the gravitational force is indeed
negligible here. The large speed also indicates how easy it is to accelerate electrons with small voltages
because of their very small mass. Voltages much higher than the 100 V in this problem are typically used in
electron guns. These higher voltages produce electron speeds so great that effects from special relativity must
be taken into account and hence are reserved for a later chapter (Relativity). That is why we consider a low
voltage (accurately) in this example.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.6


How would this example change with a positron? A positron is identical to an electron except the charge is
positive.

Voltage and Electric Field


So far, we have explored the relationship between voltage and energy. Now we want to explore the relationship
between voltage and electric field. We will start with the general case for a non-uniform field. Recall that our
general formula for the potential energy of a test charge q at point P relative to reference point R is

When we substitute in the definition of electric field this becomes

Applying our definition of potential to this potential energy, we find that, in general,

7.6

From our previous discussion of the potential energy of a charge in an electric field, the result is independent
of the path chosen, and hence we can pick the integral path that is most convenient.

Consider the special case of a positive point charge q at the origin. To calculate the potential caused by q at a
distance r from the origin relative to a reference of 0 at infinity (recall that we did the same for potential
energy), let and ∞ with and use When we evaluate the integral

for this system, we have

which simplifies to

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 293

∞ ∞
This result,

is the standard form of the potential of a point charge. This will be explored further in the next section.

To examine another interesting special case, suppose a uniform electric field is produced by placing a
potential difference (or voltage) across two parallel metal plates, labeled A and B (Figure 7.14). Examining
this situation will tell us what voltage is needed to produce a certain electric field strength. It will also reveal a
more fundamental relationship between electric potential and electric field.

Figure 7.14 The relationship between V and E for parallel conducting plates is . (Note that in magnitude. For a
charge that is moved from plate A at higher potential to plate B at lower potential, a minus sign needs to be included as follows:
)

From a physicist’s point of view, either or can be used to describe any interaction between charges.
However, is a scalar quantity and has no direction, whereas is a vector quantity, having both magnitude
and direction. (Note that the magnitude of the electric field, a scalar quantity, is represented by E.) The
relationship between and is revealed by calculating the work done by the electric force in moving a
charge from point A to point B. But, as noted earlier, arbitrary charge distributions require calculus. We
therefore look at a uniform electric field as an interesting special case.

The work done by the electric field in Figure 7.14 to move a positive charge q from A, the positive plate, higher
potential, to B, the negative plate, lower potential, is

The potential difference between points A and B is

Entering this into the expression for work yields


294 7 • Electric Potential

Work is ; here , since the path is parallel to the field. Thus, . Since
, we see that .

Substituting this expression for work into the previous equation gives

The charge cancels, so we obtain for the voltage between points A and B

where d is the distance from A to B, or the distance between the plates in Figure 7.14. Note that this equation
implies that the units for electric field are volts per meter. We already know the units for electric field are
newtons per coulomb; thus, the following relation among units is valid:

Furthermore, we may extend this to the integral form. Substituting Equation 7.5 into our definition for the
potential difference between points A and B, we obtain

which simplifies to

As a demonstration, from this we may calculate the potential difference between two points (A and B)
equidistant from a point charge q at the origin, as shown in Figure 7.15.

Figure 7.15 The arc for calculating the potential difference between two points that are equidistant from a point charge at the origin.

To do this, we integrate around an arc of the circle of constant radius r between A and B, which means we let
while using . Thus,

7.7

for this system becomes

However, and therefore

This result, that there is no difference in potential along a constant radius from a point charge, will come in

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 295

handy when we map potentials.

EXAMPLE 7.7

What Is the Highest Voltage Possible between Two Plates?


Dry air can support a maximum electric field strength of about Above that value, the field
creates enough ionization in the air to make the air a conductor. This allows a discharge or spark that reduces
the field. What, then, is the maximum voltage between two parallel conducting plates separated by 2.5 cm of
dry air?

Strategy
We are given the maximum electric field E between the plates and the distance d between them. We can use
the equation to calculate the maximum voltage.

Solution
The potential difference or voltage between the plates is

Entering the given values for E and d gives

or

(The answer is quoted to only two digits, since the maximum field strength is approximate.)

Significance
One of the implications of this result is that it takes about 75 kV to make a spark jump across a 2.5-cm (1-in.)
gap, or 150 kV for a 5-cm spark. This limits the voltages that can exist between conductors, perhaps on a
power transmission line. A smaller voltage can cause a spark if there are spines on the surface, since sharp
points have larger field strengths than smooth surfaces. Humid air breaks down at a lower field strength,
meaning that a smaller voltage will make a spark jump through humid air. The largest voltages can be built up
with static electricity on dry days (Figure 7.16).

Figure 7.16 A spark chamber is used to trace the paths of high-energy particles. Ionization created by the particles as they pass through
the gas between the plates allows a spark to jump. The sparks are perpendicular to the plates, following electric field lines between them.
The potential difference between adjacent plates is not high enough to cause sparks without the ionization produced by particles from
accelerator experiments (or cosmic rays). This form of detector is now archaic and no longer in use except for demonstration purposes.
(credit b: modification of work by Jack Collins)
296 7 • Electric Potential

EXAMPLE 7.8

Field and Force inside an Electron Gun


An electron gun (Figure 7.13) has parallel plates separated by 4.00 cm and gives electrons 25.0 keV of energy.
(a) What is the electric field strength between the plates? (b) What force would this field exert on a piece of
plastic with a charge that gets between the plates?

Strategy
Since the voltage and plate separation are given, the electric field strength can be calculated directly from the
expression . Once we know the electric field strength, we can find the force on a charge by using
Since the electric field is in only one direction, we can write this equation in terms of the magnitudes,
.

Solution

a. The expression for the magnitude of the electric field between two uniform metal plates is

Since the electron is a single charge and is given 25.0 keV of energy, the potential difference must be 25.0
kV. Entering this value for and the plate separation of 0.0400 m, we obtain

b. The magnitude of the force on a charge in an electric field is obtained from the equation

Substituting known values gives

Significance
Note that the units are newtons, since . Because the electric field is uniform between the plates,
the force on the charge is the same no matter where the charge is located between the plates.

EXAMPLE 7.9

Calculating Potential of a Point Charge


Given a point charge at the origin, calculate the potential difference between point a distance
from q, and a distance from q, where the two points have an angle of
between them (Figure 7.17).

Figure 7.17 Find the difference in potential between and .

Strategy

Do this in two steps. The first step is to use and let and

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.2 • Electric Potential and Potential Difference 297

with and Then perform the integral. The second step is to

integrate around an arc of constant radius r, which means we let with

limits still using . Then add the two results together.

Solution

For the first part, for this system becomes which

computes to

For the second step, becomes , but and

therefore Adding the two parts together, we get 300 V.

Significance
We have demonstrated the use of the integral form of the potential difference to obtain a numerical result.
Notice that, in this particular system, we could have also used the formula for the potential due to a point
charge at the two points and simply taken the difference.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.7


From the examples, how does the energy of a lightning strike vary with the height of the clouds from the
ground? Consider the cloud-ground system to be two parallel plates.

Before presenting problems involving electrostatics, we suggest a problem-solving strategy to follow for this
topic.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Electrostatics
1. Examine the situation to determine if static electricity is involved; this may concern separated stationary
charges, the forces among them, and the electric fields they create.
2. Identify the system of interest. This includes noting the number, locations, and types of charges involved.
3. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknowns). A written list is
useful. Determine whether the Coulomb force is to be considered directly—if so, it may be useful to draw a
free-body diagram, using electric field lines.
4. Make a list of what is given or can be inferred from the problem as stated (identify the knowns). It is
important to distinguish the Coulomb force F from the electric field E, for example.
5. Solve the appropriate equation for the quantity to be determined (the unknown) or draw the field lines as
requested.
6. Examine the answer to see if it is reasonable: Does it make sense? Are units correct and the numbers
involved reasonable?
298 7 • Electric Potential

7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Calculate the potential due to a point charge
• Calculate the potential of a system of multiple point charges
• Describe an electric dipole
• Define dipole moment
• Calculate the potential of a continuous charge distribution

Point charges, such as electrons, are among the fundamental building blocks of matter. Furthermore, spherical
charge distributions (such as charge on a metal sphere) create external electric fields exactly like a point
charge. The electric potential due to a point charge is, thus, a case we need to consider.

We can use calculus to find the work needed to move a test charge q from a large distance away to a distance of
r from a point charge q. Noting the connection between work and potential as in the last section,
we can obtain the following result.

Electric Potential V of a Point Charge


The electric potential V of a point charge is given by

7.8

where k is a constant equal to

The potential at infinity is chosen to be zero. Thus, V for a point charge decreases with distance, whereas for
a point charge decreases with distance squared:

Recall that the electric potential V is a scalar and has no direction, whereas the electric field is a vector. To
find the voltage due to a combination of point charges, you add the individual voltages as numbers. To find the
total electric field, you must add the individual fields as vectors, taking magnitude and direction into account.
This is consistent with the fact that V is closely associated with energy, a scalar, whereas is closely
associated with force, a vector.

EXAMPLE 7.10

What Voltage Is Produced by a Small Charge on a Metal Sphere?


Charges in static electricity are typically in the nanocoulomb (nC) to microcoulomb range. What is the
voltage 5.00 cm away from the center of a 1-cm-diameter solid metal sphere that has a –3.00-nC static charge?

Strategy
As we discussed in Electric Charges and Fields, charge on a metal sphere spreads out uniformly and produces
a field like that of a point charge located at its center. Thus, we can find the voltage using the equation

Solution
Entering known values into the expression for the potential of a point charge, we obtain

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.3 • Calculations of Electric Potential 299

Significance
The negative value for voltage means a positive charge would be attracted from a larger distance, since the
potential is lower (more negative) than at larger distances. Conversely, a negative charge would be repelled, as
expected.

EXAMPLE 7.11

What Is the Excess Charge on a Van de Graaff Generator?


A demonstration Van de Graaff generator has a 25.0-cm-diameter metal sphere that produces a voltage of 100
kV near its surface (Figure 7.18). What excess charge resides on the sphere? (Assume that each numerical
value here is shown with three significant figures.)

Figure 7.18 The voltage of this demonstration Van de Graaff generator is measured between the charged sphere and ground. Earth’s
potential is taken to be zero as a reference. The potential of the charged conducting sphere is the same as that of an equal point charge at
its center.

Strategy
The potential on the surface is the same as that of a point charge at the center of the sphere, 12.5 cm away.
(The radius of the sphere is 12.5 cm.) We can thus determine the excess charge using the equation

Solution
Solving for q and entering known values gives

Significance
This is a relatively small charge, but it produces a rather large voltage. We have another indication here that it
is difficult to store isolated charges.
300 7 • Electric Potential

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.8


What is the potential inside the metal sphere in Example 7.10?

The voltages in both of these examples could be measured with a meter that compares the measured potential
with ground potential. Ground potential is often taken to be zero (instead of taking the potential at infinity to
be zero). It is the potential difference between two points that is of importance, and very often there is a tacit
assumption that some reference point, such as Earth or a very distant point, is at zero potential. As noted
earlier, this is analogous to taking sea level as when considering gravitational potential energy
.

Systems of Multiple Point Charges


Just as the electric field obeys a superposition principle, so does the electric potential. Consider a system
consisting of N charges What is the net electric potential V at a space point P from these
charges? Each of these charges is a source charge that produces its own electric potential at point P,
independent of whatever other changes may be doing. Let be the electric potentials at P
produced by the charges respectively. Then, the net electric potential at that point is equal to
the sum of these individual electric potentials. You can easily show this by calculating the potential energy of a
test charge when you bring the test charge from the reference point at infinity to point P:

Note that electric potential follows the same principle of superposition as electric field and electric potential
energy. To show this more explicitly, note that a test charge at the point P in space has distances of
from the N charges fixed in space above, as shown in Figure 7.19. Using our formula for the
potential of a point charge for each of these (assumed to be point) charges, we find that

7.9

Therefore, the electric potential energy of the test charge is

which is the same as the work to bring the test charge into the system, as found in the first section of the
chapter.

Figure 7.19 Notation for direct distances from charges to a space point P.

The Electric Dipole


An electric dipole is a system of two equal but opposite charges a fixed distance apart. This system is used to
model many real-world systems, including atomic and molecular interactions. One of these systems is the
water molecule, under certain circumstances. These circumstances are met inside a microwave oven, where

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.3 • Calculations of Electric Potential 301

electric fields with alternating directions make the water molecules change orientation. This vibration is the
same as heat at the molecular level.

EXAMPLE 7.12

Electric Potential of a Dipole


Consider the dipole in Figure 7.20 with the charge magnitude of and separation distance
What is the potential at the following locations in space? (a) (0, 0, 1.0 cm); (b) (0, 0, –5.0 cm); (c)
(3.0 cm, 0, 2.0 cm).

Figure 7.20 A general diagram of an electric dipole, and the notation for the distances from the individual charges to a point P in space.

Strategy

Apply to each of these three points.

Solution

a.

b.

c.

Significance
Note that evaluating potential is significantly simpler than electric field, due to potential being a scalar instead
of a vector.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.9


302 7 • Electric Potential

What is the potential on the x-axis? The z-axis?

Now let us consider the special case when the distance of the point P from the dipole is much greater than the
distance between the charges in the dipole, for example, when we are interested in the electric potential
due to a polarized molecule such as a water molecule. This is not so far (infinity) that we can simply treat the
potential as zero, but the distance is great enough that we can simplify our calculations relative to the previous
example.

We start by noting that in Figure 7.21 the potential is given by

where

Figure 7.21 A general diagram of an electric dipole, and the notation for the distances from the individual charges to a point P in space.

This is still the exact formula. To take advantage of the fact that we rewrite the radii in terms of polar
coordinates, with and . This gives us

We can simplify this expression by pulling r out of the root,

and then multiplying out the parentheses

The last term in the root is small enough to be negligible (remember and hence is extremely
small, effectively zero to the level we will probably be measuring), leaving us with

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.3 • Calculations of Electric Potential 303

Using the binomial approximation (a standard result from the mathematics of series, when is small)

and substituting this into our formula for , we get

This may be written more conveniently if we define a new quantity, the electric dipole moment,

7.10

where these vectors point from the negative to the positive charge. Note that this has magnitude qd. This
quantity allows us to write the potential at point P due to a dipole at the origin as

7.11

A diagram of the application of this formula is shown in Figure 7.22.

Figure 7.22 The geometry for the application of the potential of a dipole.

There are also higher-order moments, for quadrupoles, octupoles, and so on. You will see these in future
classes.

Potential of Continuous Charge Distributions


We have been working with point charges a great deal, but what about continuous charge distributions? Recall
from Equation 7.9 that

We may treat a continuous charge distribution as a collection of infinitesimally separated individual points.
This yields the integral

7.12

for the potential at a point P. Note that r is the distance from each individual point in the charge distribution to
the point P. As we saw in Electric Charges and Fields, the infinitesimal charges are given by
304 7 • Electric Potential

where is linear charge density, is the charge per unit area, and is the charge per unit volume.

EXAMPLE 7.13

Potential of a Line of Charge


Find the electric potential of a uniformly charged, nonconducting wire with linear density (coulomb/meter)
and length L at a point that lies on a line that divides the wire into two equal parts.

Strategy
To set up the problem, we choose Cartesian coordinates in such a way as to exploit the symmetry in the
problem as much as possible. We place the origin at the center of the wire and orient the y-axis along the wire
so that the ends of the wire are at . The field point P is in the xy-plane and since the choice of axes is
up to us, we choose the x-axis to pass through the field point P, as shown in Figure 7.23.

Figure 7.23 We want to calculate the electric potential due to a line of charge.

Solution
Consider a small element of the charge distribution between y and . The charge in this cell is
and the distance from the cell to the field point P is Therefore, the potential becomes

Significance
Note that this was simpler than the equivalent problem for electric field, due to the use of scalar quantities.
Recall that we expect the zero level of the potential to be at infinity, when we have a finite charge. To examine
this, we take the limit of the above potential as x approaches infinity; in this case, the terms inside the natural
log approach one, and hence the potential approaches zero in this limit. Note that we could have done this
problem equivalently in cylindrical coordinates; the only effect would be to substitute r for x and z for y.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.3 • Calculations of Electric Potential 305

EXAMPLE 7.14

Potential Due to a Ring of Charge


A ring has a uniform charge density , with units of coulomb per unit meter of arc. Find the electric potential at
a point on the axis passing through the center of the ring.

Strategy
We use the same procedure as for the charged wire. The difference here is that the charge is distributed on a
circle. We divide the circle into infinitesimal elements shaped as arcs on the circle and use cylindrical
coordinates shown in Figure 7.24.

Figure 7.24 We want to calculate the electric potential due to a ring of charge.

Solution
A general element of the arc between and is of length and therefore contains a charge equal to
The element is at a distance of from P, and therefore the potential is

Significance
This result is expected because every element of the ring is at the same distance from point P. The net
potential at P is that of the total charge placed at the common distance, .

EXAMPLE 7.15

Potential Due to a Uniform Disk of Charge


A disk of radius R has a uniform charge density , with units of coulomb meter squared. Find the electric
potential at any point on the axis passing through the center of the disk.

Strategy
We divide the disk into ring-shaped cells, and make use of the result for a ring worked out in the previous
example, then integrate over r in addition to . This is shown in Figure 7.25.
306 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.25 We want to calculate the electric potential due to a disk of charge.

Solution
An infinitesimal width cell between cylindrical coordinates r and shown in Figure 7.25 will be a ring of
charges whose electric potential at the field point has the following expression

where

The superposition of potential of all the infinitesimal rings that make up the disk gives the net potential at
point P. This is accomplished by integrating from to :

Significance
The basic procedure for a disk is to first integrate around and then over r. This has been demonstrated for
uniform (constant) charge density. Often, the charge density will vary with r, and then the last integral will give
different results.

EXAMPLE 7.16

Potential Due to an Infinite Charged Wire


Find the electric potential due to an infinitely long uniformly charged wire.

Strategy
Since we have already worked out the potential of a finite wire of length L in Example 7.7, we might wonder if
taking ∞ in our previous result will work:

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.3 • Calculations of Electric Potential 307

However, this limit does not exist because the argument of the logarithm becomes [2/0] as ∞ , so this way
of finding V of an infinite wire does not work. The reason for this problem may be traced to the fact that the
charges are not localized in some space but continue to infinity in the direction of the wire. Hence, our
(unspoken) assumption that zero potential must be an infinite distance from the wire is no longer valid.

To avoid this difficulty in calculating limits, let us use the definition of potential by integrating over the electric
field from the previous section, and the value of the electric field from this charge configuration from the
previous chapter.

Solution
We use the integral

where R is a finite distance from the line of charge, as shown in Figure 7.26.

Figure 7.26 Points of interest for calculating the potential of an infinite line of charge.

With this setup, we use and to obtain

Now, if we define the reference potential at this simplifies to

Note that this form of the potential is quite usable; it is 0 at 1 m and is undefined at infinity, which is why we
could not use the latter as a reference.

Significance
Although calculating potential directly can be quite convenient, we just found a system for which this strategy
does not work well. In such cases, going back to the definition of potential in terms of the electric field may
offer a way forward.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.10


What is the potential on the axis of a nonuniform ring of charge, where the charge density is ?
308 7 • Electric Potential

7.4 Determining Field from Potential


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how to calculate the electric field in a system from the given potential
• Calculate the electric field in a given direction from a given potential
• Calculate the electric field throughout space from a given potential

Recall that we were able, in certain systems, to calculate the potential by integrating over the electric field. As
you may already suspect, this means that we may calculate the electric field by taking derivatives of the
potential, although going from a scalar to a vector quantity introduces some interesting wrinkles. We
frequently need to calculate the force in a system; since it is often simpler to calculate the potential directly,
there are systems in which it is useful to calculate V and then derive from it.

In general, regardless of whether the electric field is uniform, it points in the direction of decreasing potential,
because the force on a positive charge is in the direction of and also in the direction of lower potential V.
Furthermore, the magnitude of equals the rate of decrease of V with distance. The faster V decreases over
distance, the greater the electric field. This gives us the following result.

Relationship between Voltage and Uniform Electric Field


In equation form, the relationship between voltage and uniform electric field is

where is the distance over which the change in potential takes place. The minus sign tells us that E
points in the direction of decreasing potential. The electric field is said to be the gradient (as in grade or
slope) of the electric potential.

For continually changing potentials, and become infinitesimals, and we need differential calculus to
determine the electric field. As shown in Figure 7.27, if we treat the distance as very small so that the
electric field is essentially constant over it, we find that

Figure 7.27 The electric field component along the displacement is given by . Note that A and B are assumed to be so close
together that the field is constant along .

Therefore, the electric field components in the Cartesian directions are given by

7.13

This allows us to define the “grad” or “del” vector operator, which allows us to compute the gradient in one
step. In Cartesian coordinates, it takes the form

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.4 • Determining Field from Potential 309

7.14

With this notation, we can calculate the electric field from the potential with

7.15

a process we call calculating the gradient of the potential.

If we have a system with either cylindrical or spherical symmetry, we only need to use the del operator in the
appropriate coordinates:

7.16

7.17

EXAMPLE 7.17

Electric Field of a Point Charge


Calculate the electric field of a point charge from the potential.

Strategy
The potential is known to be , which has a spherical symmetry. Therefore, we use the spherical del
operator in the formula .

Solution
Performing this calculation gives us

This equation simplifies to

as expected.

Significance
We not only obtained the equation for the electric field of a point particle that we’ve seen before, we also have a
demonstration that points in the direction of decreasing potential, as shown in Figure 7.28.
310 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.28 Electric field vectors inside and outside a uniformly charged sphere.

EXAMPLE 7.18

Electric Field of a Ring of Charge


Use the potential found in Example 7.8 to calculate the electric field along the axis of a ring of charge (Figure
7.29).

Figure 7.29 We want to calculate the electric field from the electric potential due to a ring charge.

Strategy
In this case, we are only interested in one dimension, the z-axis. Therefore, we use

with the potential found previously.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.5 • Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors 311

Solution
Taking the derivative of the potential yields

Significance
Again, this matches the equation for the electric field found previously. It also demonstrates a system in which
using the full del operator is not necessary.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.11


Which coordinate system would you use to calculate the electric field of a dipole?

7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define equipotential surfaces and equipotential lines
• Explain the relationship between equipotential lines and electric field lines
• Map equipotential lines for one or two point charges
• Describe the potential of a conductor
• Compare and contrast equipotential lines and elevation lines on topographic maps

We can represent electric potentials (voltages) pictorially, just as we drew pictures to illustrate electric fields.
This is not surprising, since the two concepts are related. Consider Figure 7.30, which shows an isolated
positive point charge and its electric field lines, which radiate out from a positive charge and terminate on
negative charges. We use red arrows to represent the magnitude and direction of the electric field, and we use
black lines to represent places where the electric potential is constant. These are called equipotential
surfaces in three dimensions, or equipotential lines in two dimensions. The term equipotential is also used
as a noun, referring to an equipotential line or surface. The potential for a point charge is the same anywhere
on an imaginary sphere of radius r surrounding the charge. This is true because the potential for a point
charge is given by and thus has the same value at any point that is a given distance r from the charge.
An equipotential sphere is a circle in the two-dimensional view of Figure 7.30. Because the electric field lines
point radially away from the charge, they are perpendicular to the equipotential lines.

Figure 7.30 An isolated point charge Q with its electric field lines in red and equipotential lines in black. The potential is the same along
each equipotential line, meaning that no work is required to move a charge anywhere along one of those lines. Work is needed to move a
charge from one equipotential line to another. Equipotential lines are perpendicular to electric field lines in every case. For a three-
312 7 • Electric Potential

dimensional version, explore the first media link.

It is important to note that equipotential lines are always perpendicular to electric field lines. No work is
required to move a charge along an equipotential, since . Thus, the work is

Work is zero if the direction of the force is perpendicular to the displacement. Force is in the same direction as
E, so motion along an equipotential must be perpendicular to E. More precisely, work is related to the electric
field by

Note that in this equation, E and F symbolize the magnitudes of the electric field and force, respectively.
Neither q nor E is zero; d is also not zero. So must be 0, meaning must be . In other words, motion
along an equipotential is perpendicular to E.

One of the rules for static electric fields and conductors is that the electric field must be perpendicular to the
surface of any conductor. This implies that a conductor is an equipotential surface in static situations. There
can be no voltage difference across the surface of a conductor, or charges will flow. One of the uses of this fact
is that a conductor can be fixed at what we consider zero volts by connecting it to the earth with a good
conductor—a process called grounding. Grounding can be a useful safety tool. For example, grounding the
metal case of an electrical appliance ensures that it is at zero volts relative to Earth.

Because a conductor is an equipotential, it can replace any equipotential surface. For example, in Figure 7.30,
a charged spherical conductor can replace the point charge, and the electric field and potential surfaces
outside of it will be unchanged, confirming the contention that a spherical charge distribution is equivalent to
a point charge at its center.

Figure 7.31 shows the electric field and equipotential lines for two equal and opposite charges. Given the
electric field lines, the equipotential lines can be drawn simply by making them perpendicular to the electric
field lines. Conversely, given the equipotential lines, as in Figure 7.32(a), the electric field lines can be drawn
by making them perpendicular to the equipotentials, as in Figure 7.32(b).

Figure 7.31 The electric field lines and equipotential lines for two equal but opposite charges. The equipotential lines can be drawn by
making them perpendicular to the electric field lines, if those are known. Note that the potential is greatest (most positive) near the positive
charge and least (most negative) near the negative charge. For a three-dimensional version, explore the first media link.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.5 • Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors 313

Figure 7.32 (a) These equipotential lines might be measured with a voltmeter in a laboratory experiment. (b) The corresponding electric
field lines are found by drawing them perpendicular to the equipotentials. Note that these fields are consistent with two equal negative
charges. For a three-dimensional version, play with the first media link.

To improve your intuition, we show a three-dimensional variant of the potential in a system with two opposing
charges. Figure 7.33 displays a three-dimensional map of electric potential, where lines on the map are for
equipotential surfaces. The hill is at the positive charge, and the trough is at the negative charge. The potential
is zero far away from the charges. Note that the cut off at a particular potential implies that the charges are on
conducting spheres with a finite radius.

Figure 7.33 Electric potential map of two opposite charges of equal magnitude on conducting spheres. The potential is negative near the
negative charge and positive near the positive charge.

A two-dimensional map of the cross-sectional plane that contains both charges is shown in Figure 7.34. The
line that is equidistant from the two opposite charges corresponds to zero potential, since at the points on the
line, the positive potential from the positive charge cancels the negative potential from the negative charge.
Equipotential lines in the cross-sectional plane are closed loops, which are not necessarily circles, since at
each point, the net potential is the sum of the potentials from each charge.
314 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.34 A cross-section of the electric potential map of two opposite charges of equal magnitude. The potential is negative near the
negative charge and positive near the positive charge.

INTERACTIVE
View this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21equipsurelec) to observe and modify the equipotential surfaces
and electric fields for many standard charge configurations. There’s a lot to explore.

One of the most important cases is that of the familiar parallel conducting plates shown in Figure 7.35.
Between the plates, the equipotentials are evenly spaced and parallel. The same field could be maintained by
placing conducting plates at the equipotential lines at the potentials shown.

Figure 7.35 The electric field and equipotential lines between two metal plates. Note that the electric field is perpendicular to the
equipotentials and hence normal to the plates at their surface as well as in the center of the region between them.

Consider the parallel plates in Figure 7.2. These have equipotential lines that are parallel to the plates in the
space between and evenly spaced. An example of this (with sample values) is given in Figure 7.35. We could
draw a similar set of equipotential isolines for gravity on the hill shown in Figure 7.2. If the hill has any extent
at the same slope, the isolines along that extent would be parallel to each other. Furthermore, in regions of

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.5 • Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors 315

constant slope, the isolines would be evenly spaced. An example of real topographic lines is shown in Figure
7.36.

Figure 7.36 A topographical map along a ridge has roughly parallel elevation lines, similar to the equipotential lines in Figure 7.35. (a) A
topographical map of Devil’s Tower, Wyoming. Lines that are close together indicate very steep terrain. (b) A perspective photo of Devil’s
Tower shows just how steep its sides are. Notice the top of the tower has the same shape as the center of the topographical map.

EXAMPLE 7.19

Calculating Equipotential Lines


You have seen the equipotential lines of a point charge in Figure 7.30. How do we calculate them? For example,
if we have a charge at the origin, what are the equipotential surfaces at which the potential is (a) 100 V,
(b) 50 V, (c) 20 V, and (d) 10 V?

Strategy
Set the equation for the potential of a point charge equal to a constant and solve for the remaining variable(s).
Then calculate values as needed.

Solution
In , let V be a constant. The only remaining variable is r; hence, . Thus, the
equipotential surfaces are spheres about the origin. Their locations are:

a. ;

b. ;

c. ;

d. .

Significance
This means that equipotential surfaces around a point charge are spheres of constant radius, as shown earlier,
316 7 • Electric Potential

with well-defined locations.

EXAMPLE 7.20

Potential Difference between Oppositely Charged Parallel Plates


Two large conducting plates carry equal and opposite charges, with a surface charge density of magnitude
as shown in Figure 7.37. The separation between the plates is . (a) What is the
electric field between the plates? (b) What is the potential difference between the plates? (c) What is the
distance between equipotential planes which differ by 100 V?

Figure 7.37 The electric field between oppositely charged parallel plates. A portion is released at the positive plate.

Strategy
(a) Since the plates are described as “large” and the distance between them is not, we will approximate each of
them as an infinite plane, and apply the result from Gauss’s law in the previous chapter.

(b) Use .

(c) Since the electric field is constant, find the ratio of 100 V to the total potential difference; then calculate this
fraction of the distance.

Solution

a. The electric field is directed from the positive to the negative plate as shown in the figure, and its
magnitude is given by

b. To find the potential difference between the plates, we use a path from the negative to the positive
plate that is directed against the field. The displacement vector and the electric field are antiparallel
so The potential difference between the positive plate and the negative plate is then

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.5 • Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors 317

c. The total potential difference is 500 V, so 1/5 of the distance between the plates will be the distance
between 100-V potential differences. The distance between the plates is 6.5 mm, so there will be 1.3 mm
between 100-V potential differences.

Significance
You have now seen a numerical calculation of the locations of equipotentials between two charged parallel
plates.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 7.12


What are the equipotential surfaces for an infinite line charge?

Distribution of Charges on Conductors


In Example 7.19 with a point charge, we found that the equipotential surfaces were in the form of spheres, with
the point charge at the center. Given that a conducting sphere in electrostatic equilibrium is a spherical
equipotential surface, we should expect that we could replace one of the surfaces in Example 7.19 with a
conducting sphere and have an identical solution outside the sphere. Inside will be rather different, however.

Figure 7.38 An isolated conducting sphere.

To investigate this, consider the isolated conducting sphere of Figure 7.38 that has a radius R and an excess
charge q. To find the electric field both inside and outside the sphere, note that the sphere is isolated, so its
surface change distribution and the electric field of that distribution are spherically symmetric. We can
therefore represent the field as To calculate E(r), we apply Gauss’s law over a closed spherical
surface S of radius r that is concentric with the conducting sphere. Since r is constant and on the sphere,

For , S is within the conductor, so recall from our previous study of Gauss’s law that and Gauss’s
law gives , as expected inside a conductor at equilibrium. If , S encloses the conductor so
From Gauss’s law,

The electric field of the sphere may therefore be written as


318 7 • Electric Potential

As expected, in the region the electric field due to a charge q placed on an isolated conducting sphere of
radius R is identical to the electric field of a point charge q located at the center of the sphere.

To find the electric potential inside and outside the sphere, note that for the potential must be the same
as that of an isolated point charge q located at ,

simply due to the similarity of the electric field.

For so V(r) is constant in this region. Since

We will use this result to show that

for two conducting spheres of radii , with surface charge densities respectively, that are
connected by a thin wire, as shown in Figure 7.39. The spheres are sufficiently separated so that each can be
treated as if it were isolated (aside from the wire). Note that the connection by the wire means that this entire
system must be an equipotential.

Figure 7.39 Two conducting spheres are connected by a thin conducting wire.

We have just seen that the electrical potential at the surface of an isolated, charged conducting sphere of
radius R is

Now, the spheres are connected by a conductor and are therefore at the same potential; hence

and

The net charge on a conducting sphere and its surface charge density are related by Substituting
this equation into the previous one, we find

Obviously, two spheres connected by a thin wire do not constitute a typical conductor with a variable radius of
curvature. Nevertheless, this result does at least provide a qualitative idea of how charge density varies over
the surface of a conductor. The equation indicates that where the radius of curvature is large (points B and D in

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.6 • Applications of Electrostatics 319

Figure 7.40), and E are small.

Similarly, the charges tend to be denser where the curvature of the surface is greater, as demonstrated by the
charge distribution on oddly shaped metal (Figure 7.40). The surface charge density is higher at locations with
a small radius of curvature than at locations with a large radius of curvature.

Figure 7.40 The surface charge density and the electric field of a conductor are greater at regions with smaller radii of curvature.

A practical application of this phenomenon is the lightning rod, which is simply a grounded metal rod with a
sharp end pointing upward. As positive charge accumulates in the ground due to a negatively charged cloud
overhead, the electric field around the sharp point gets very large. When the field reaches a value of
approximately (the dielectric strength of the air), the free ions in the air are accelerated to such
high energies that their collisions with air molecules actually ionize the molecules. The resulting free electrons
in the air then flow through the rod to Earth, thereby neutralizing some of the positive charge. This keeps the
electric field between the cloud and the ground from getting large enough to produce a lightning bolt in the
region around the rod.

An important application of electric fields and equipotential lines involves the heart. The heart relies on
electrical signals to maintain its rhythm. The movement of electrical signals causes the chambers of the heart
to contract and relax. When a person has a heart attack, the movement of these electrical signals may be
disturbed. An artificial pacemaker and a defibrillator can be used to initiate the rhythm of electrical signals.
The equipotential lines around the heart, the thoracic region, and the axis of the heart are useful ways of
monitoring the structure and functions of the heart. An electrocardiogram (ECG) measures the small electric
signals being generated during the activity of the heart.

INTERACTIVE
Play around with this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21pointcharsim) to move point charges around on the
playing field and then view the electric field, voltages, equipotential lines, and more.

7.6 Applications of Electrostatics


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe some of the many practical applications of electrostatics, including several printing technologies
• Relate these applications to Newton’s second law and the electric force
320 7 • Electric Potential

The study of electrostatics has proven useful in many areas. This module covers just a few of the many
applications of electrostatics.

The Van de Graaff Generator


Van de Graaff generators (or Van de Graaffs) are not only spectacular devices used to demonstrate high
voltage due to static electricity—they are also used for serious research. The first was built by Robert Van de
Graaff in 1931 (based on original suggestions by Lord Kelvin) for use in nuclear physics research. Figure 7.41
shows a schematic of a large research version. Van de Graaffs use both smooth and pointed surfaces, and
conductors and insulators to generate large static charges and, hence, large voltages.

A very large excess charge can be deposited on the sphere because it moves quickly to the outer surface.
Practical limits arise because the large electric fields polarize and eventually ionize surrounding materials,
creating free charges that neutralize excess charge or allow it to escape. Nevertheless, voltages of 15 million
volts are well within practical limits.

Figure 7.41 Schematic of Van de Graaff generator. A battery (A) supplies excess positive charge to a pointed conductor, the points of
which spray the charge onto a moving insulating belt near the bottom. The pointed conductor (B) on top in the large sphere picks up the
charge. (The induced electric field at the points is so large that it removes the charge from the belt.) This can be done because the charge
does not remain inside the conducting sphere but moves to its outside surface. An ion source inside the sphere produces positive ions,
which are accelerated away from the positive sphere to high velocities.

Xerography
Most copy machines use an electrostatic process called xerography—a word coined from the Greek words
xeros for dry and graphos for writing. The heart of the process is shown in simplified form in Figure 7.42.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.6 • Applications of Electrostatics 321

Figure 7.42 Xerography is a dry copying process based on electrostatics. The major steps in the process are the charging of the
photoconducting drum, transfer of an image, creating a positive charge duplicate, attraction of toner to the charged parts of the drum, and
transfer of toner to the paper. Not shown are heat treatment of the paper and cleansing of the drum for the next copy.

A selenium-coated aluminum drum is sprayed with positive charge from points on a device called a corotron.
Selenium is a substance with an interesting property—it is a photoconductor. That is, selenium is an insulator
when in the dark and a conductor when exposed to light.

In the first stage of the xerography process, the conducting aluminum drum is grounded so that a negative
charge is induced under the thin layer of uniformly positively charged selenium. In the second stage, the
surface of the drum is exposed to the image of whatever is to be copied. In locations where the image is light,
the selenium becomes conducting, and the positive charge is neutralized. In dark areas, the positive charge
remains, so the image has been transferred to the drum.

The third stage takes a dry black powder, called toner, and sprays it with a negative charge so that it is attracted
to the positive regions of the drum. Next, a blank piece of paper is given a greater positive charge than on the
drum so that it will pull the toner from the drum. Finally, the paper and electrostatically held toner are passed
through heated pressure rollers, which melt and permanently adhere the toner to the fibers of the paper.

Laser Printers
Laser printers use the xerographic process to make high-quality images on paper, employing a laser to
produce an image on the photoconducting drum as shown in Figure 7.43. In its most common application, the
laser printer receives output from a computer, and it can achieve high-quality output because of the precision
with which laser light can be controlled. Many laser printers do significant information processing, such as
making sophisticated letters or fonts, and in the past may have contained a computer more powerful than the
one giving them the raw data to be printed.
322 7 • Electric Potential

Figure 7.43 In a laser printer, a laser beam is scanned across a photoconducting drum, leaving a positively charged image. The other
steps for charging the drum and transferring the image to paper are the same as in xerography. Laser light can be very precisely controlled,
enabling laser printers to produce high-quality images.

Ink Jet Printers and Electrostatic Painting


The ink jet printer, commonly used to print computer-generated text and graphics, also employs
electrostatics. A nozzle makes a fine spray of tiny ink droplets, which are then given an electrostatic charge
(Figure 7.44).

Once charged, the droplets can be directed, using pairs of charged plates, with great precision to form letters
and images on paper. Ink jet printers can produce color images by using a black jet and three other jets with
primary colors, usually cyan, magenta, and yellow, much as a color television produces color. (This is more
difficult with xerography, requiring multiple drums and toners.)

Figure 7.44 The nozzle of an ink-jet printer produces small ink droplets, which are sprayed with electrostatic charge. Various computer-
driven devices are then used to direct the droplets to the correct positions on a page.

Electrostatic painting employs electrostatic charge to spray paint onto oddly shaped surfaces. Mutual
repulsion of like charges causes the paint to fly away from its source. Surface tension forms drops, which are
then attracted by unlike charges to the surface to be painted. Electrostatic painting can reach hard-to-get-to
places, applying an even coat in a controlled manner. If the object is a conductor, the electric field is
perpendicular to the surface, tending to bring the drops in perpendicularly. Corners and points on conductors
will receive extra paint. Felt can similarly be applied.

Smoke Precipitators and Electrostatic Air Cleaning


Another important application of electrostatics is found in air cleaners, both large and small. The electrostatic
part of the process places excess (usually positive) charge on smoke, dust, pollen, and other particles in the air
and then passes the air through an oppositely charged grid that attracts and retains the charged particles
(Figure 7.45)

Access for free at openstax.org.


7.6 • Applications of Electrostatics 323

Large electrostatic precipitators are used industrially to remove over of the particles from stack gas
emissions associated with the burning of coal and oil. Home precipitators, often in conjunction with the home
heating and air conditioning system, are very effective in removing polluting particles, irritants, and allergens.

Figure 7.45 (a) Schematic of an electrostatic precipitator. Air is passed through grids of opposite charge. The first grid charges airborne
particles, while the second attracts and collects them. (b) The dramatic effect of electrostatic precipitators is seen by the absence of smoke
from this power plant. (credit b: modification of work by “Cmdalgleish”/Wikimedia Commons)
324 7 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
electric dipole system of two equal but opposite dimensions) on which all points are at the same
charges a fixed distance apart potential
electric dipole moment quantity defined as grounding process of attaching a conductor to the
for all dipoles, where the vector points earth to ensure that there is no potential
from the negative to positive charge difference between it and Earth
electric potential potential energy per unit charge ink jet printer small ink droplets sprayed with an
electric potential difference the change in electric charge are controlled by electrostatic
potential energy of a charge q moved between two plates to create images on paper
points, divided by the charge. photoconductor substance that is an insulator
electric potential energy potential energy stored until it is exposed to light, when it becomes a
in a system of charged objects due to the charges conductor
electron-volt energy given to a fundamental Van de Graaff generator machine that produces a
charge accelerated through a potential difference large amount of excess charge, used for
of one volt experiments with high voltage
electrostatic precipitators filters that apply voltage change in potential energy of a charge
charges to particles in the air, then attract those moved from one point to another, divided by the
charges to a filter, removing them from the charge; units of potential difference are joules per
airstream coulomb, known as volt
equipotential line two-dimensional xerography dry copying process based on
representation of an equipotential surface electrostatics
equipotential surface surface (usually in three

Key Equations

Potential energy of a two-charge system

Work done to assemble a system of charges

Potential difference

Electric potential

Potential difference between two points

Electric potential of a point charge

Electric potential of a system of point charges

Electric dipole moment

Electric potential due to a dipole

Access for free at openstax.org.


7 • Chapter Review 323

Electric potential of a continuous charge distribution

Electric field components

Del operator in Cartesian coordinates

Electric field as gradient of potential

Del operator in cylindrical coordinates

Del operator in spherical coordinates

Summary
7.1 Electric Potential Energy field is a vector.
• Addition of voltages as numbers gives the
• The work done to move a charge from point A to
voltage due to a combination of point charges,
B in an electric field is path independent, and
allowing us to use the principle of
the work around a closed path is zero.
Therefore, the electric field and electric force superposition: .
are conservative.
• We can define an electric potential energy, • An electric dipole consists of two equal and
which between point charges is , opposite charges a fixed distance apart, with a
with the zero reference taken to be at infinity. dipole moment .
• The superposition principle holds for electric • Continuous charge distributions may be
potential energy; the potential energy of a
calculated with .
system of multiple charges is the sum of the
potential energies of the individual pairs.
7.4 Determining Field from Potential
7.2 Electric Potential and Potential
• Just as we may integrate over the electric field to
Difference calculate the potential, we may take the
• Electric potential is potential energy per unit derivative of the potential to calculate the
charge. electric field.
• The potential difference between points A and • This may be done for individual components of
B, that is, the change in potential of a the electric field, or we may calculate the entire
charge q moved from A to B, is equal to the electric field vector with the gradient operator.
change in potential energy divided by the
7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors
charge.
• Potential difference is commonly called voltage, • An equipotential surface is the collection of
represented by the symbol : points in space that are all at the same potential.
Equipotential lines are the two-dimensional
• An electron-volt is the energy given to a representation of equipotential surfaces.
fundamental charge accelerated through a • Equipotential surfaces are always perpendicular
potential difference of 1 V. In equation form, to electric field lines.
• Conductors in static equilibrium are
equipotential surfaces.
• Topographic maps may be thought of as
7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential showing gravitational equipotential lines.

• Electric potential is a scalar whereas electric


326 7 • Chapter Review

7.6 Applications of Electrostatics a Van de Graaff generator, many practical


applications of electrostatics exist, including
• Electrostatics is the study of electric fields in
photocopiers, laser printers, ink jet printers,
static equilibrium.
and electrostatic air filters.
• In addition to research using equipment such as

Conceptual Questions
7.1 Electric Potential Energy 15. In what region of space is the potential due to a
uniformly charged sphere the same as that of a
1. Would electric potential energy be meaningful if
point charge? In what region does it differ from
the electric field were not conservative?
that of a point charge?
2. Why do we need to be careful about work done on
16. Can the potential of a nonuniformly charged
the system versus work done by the system in
sphere be the same as that of a point charge?
calculations?
Explain.
3. Does the order in which we assemble a system of
point charges affect the total work done?
7.4 Determining Field from Potential
7.2 Electric Potential and Potential 17. If the electric field is zero throughout a region,
Difference must the electric potential also be zero in that
region?
4. Discuss how potential difference and electric
18. Explain why knowledge of is not
field strength are related. Give an example.
sufficient to determine V(x,y,z). What about the
5. What is the strength of the electric field in a
other way around?
region where the electric potential is constant?
6. If a proton is released from rest in an electric
field, will it move in the direction of increasing or
7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors
decreasing potential? Also answer this question 19. If two points are at the same potential, are there
for an electron and a neutron. Explain why. any electric field lines connecting them?
7. Voltage is the common word for potential 20. Suppose you have a map of equipotential
difference. Which term is more descriptive, surfaces spaced 1.0 V apart. What do the
voltage or potential difference? distances between the surfaces in a particular
8. If the voltage between two points is zero, can a region tell you about the strength of the in
test charge be moved between them with zero net that region?
work being done? Can this necessarily be done 21. Is the electric potential necessarily constant
without exerting a force? Explain. over the surface of a conductor?
9. What is the relationship between voltage and 22. Under electrostatic conditions, the excess
energy? More precisely, what is the relationship charge on a conductor resides on its surface.
between potential difference and electric Does this mean that all of the conduction
potential energy? electrons in a conductor are on the surface?
10. Voltages are always measured between two 23. Can a positively charged conductor be at a
points. Why? negative potential? Explain.
11. How are units of volts and electron-volts 24. Can equipotential surfaces intersect?
related? How do they differ?
12. Can a particle move in a direction of increasing 7.6 Applications of Electrostatics
electric potential, yet have its electric potential
energy decrease? Explain 25. Why are the metal support rods for satellite
network dishes generally grounded?
7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential 26. (a) Why are fish reasonably safe in an electrical
storm? (b) Why are swimmers nonetheless
13. Compare the electric dipole moments of ordered to get out of the water in the same
charges separated by a distance d and circumstance?
charges separated by a distance d/2. 27. What are the similarities and differences
14. Would Gauss’s law be helpful for determining between the processes in a photocopier and an
the electric field of a dipole? Why? electrostatic precipitator?

Access for free at openstax.org.


7 • Chapter Review 327

28. About what magnitude of potential is used to web search for “xerography” may be of use.
charge the drum of a photocopy machine? A

Problems
7.1 Electric Potential Energy . (a) What is the potential
difference between the plates? (b) The plate
29. Consider a charge fixed at a site
with the lowest potential is taken to be zero
with another charge (charge , mass
volts. What is the potential 1.00 cm from that
moving in the neighboring space. (a)
plate and 3.00 cm from the other?
Evaluate the potential energy of when it is
38. The voltage across a membrane forming a cell
4.0 cm from (b) If starts from rest from a
wall is 80.0 mV and the membrane is 9.00 nm
point 4.0 cm from what will be its speed
thick. What is the electric field strength? (The
when it is 8.0 cm from ? (Note: is held
value is surprisingly large, but correct.) You may
fixed in its place.)
assume a uniform electric field.
30. Two charges and
39. Two parallel conducting plates are separated by
are placed symmetrically along the x-axis at
10.0 cm, and one of them is taken to be at zero
. Consider a charge of charge
volts. (a) What is the electric field strength
and mass 10.0 mg moving along the
between them, if the potential 8.00 cm from the
y-axis. If starts from rest at
zero volt plate (and 2.00 cm from the other) is
what is its speed when it reaches
450 V? (b) What is the voltage between the
31. To form a hydrogen atom, a proton is fixed at a
plates?
point and an electron is brought from far away
40. Find the maximum potential difference
to a distance of the average
between two parallel conducting plates
distance between proton and electron in a
separated by 0.500 cm of air, given the
hydrogen atom. How much work is done?
maximum sustainable electric field strength in
32. (a) What is the average power output of a heart
air to be .
defibrillator that dissipates 400 J of energy in
41. An electron is to be accelerated in a uniform
10.0 ms? (b) Considering the high-power
electric field having a strength of
output, why doesn’t the defibrillator produce
(a) What energy in keV is
serious burns?
given to the electron if it is accelerated through
0.400 m? (b) Over what distance would it have to
7.2 Electric Potential and Potential be accelerated to increase its energy by 50.0
Difference GeV?
33. Find the ratio of speeds of an electron and a 42. Use the definition of potential difference in
negative hydrogen ion (one having an extra terms of electric field to deduce the formula for
electron) accelerated through the same voltage, potential difference between and
assuming non-relativistic final speeds. Take the for a point charge located at the origin. Here r is
mass of the hydrogen ion to be the spherical radial coordinate.
43. The electric field in a region is pointed away
34. An evacuated tube uses an accelerating voltage from the z-axis and the magnitude depends
of 40 kV to accelerate electrons to hit a copper upon the distance s from the axis. The
plate and produce X-rays. Non-relativistically, magnitude of the electric field is given as
what would be the maximum speed of these where is a constant. Find the potential
electrons? difference between points , explicitly
35. Show that units of V/m and N/C for electric field stating the path over which you conduct the
strength are indeed equivalent. integration for the line integral.
36. What is the strength of the electric field between
two parallel conducting plates separated by
1.00 cm and having a potential difference
(voltage) between them of ?
37. The electric field strength between two parallel
conducting plates separated by 4.00 cm is
328 7 • Chapter Review

52. Find the potential at points in


the diagram due to the two given charges.

44. Singly charged gas ions are accelerated from


rest through a voltage of 13.0 V. At what
temperature will the average kinetic energy of
gas molecules be the same as that given these
ions?

7.3 Calculations of Electric Potential 53. Two charges are separated


by 4.0 cm on the z-axis symmetrically about
45. A 0.500-cm-diameter plastic sphere, used in a
origin, with the positive one uppermost. Two
static electricity demonstration, has a uniformly
space points of interest are located
distributed 40.0-pC charge on its surface. What
3.0 cm and 30 cm from origin at an angle
is the potential near its surface?
with respect to the z-axis. Evaluate electric
46. How far from a point charge is the
potentials at in two ways: (a) Using
potential 100 V? At what distance is it
the exact formula for point charges, and (b)
using the approximate dipole potential formula.
47. If the potential due to a point charge is
54. (a) Plot the potential of a uniformly charged 1-m
at a distance of 15.0 m, what are
rod with 1 C/m charge as a function of the
the sign and magnitude of the charge?
perpendicular distance from the center. Draw
48. In nuclear fission, a nucleus splits roughly in
your graph from . (b) On
half. (a) What is the potential the same graph, plot the potential of a point
from a fragment that has 46 protons in it? (b) charge with a 1-C charge at the origin. (c) Which
What is the potential energy in MeV of a potential is stronger near the rod? (d) What
similarly charged fragment at this distance? happens to the difference as the distance
49. A research Van de Graaff generator has a increases? Interpret your result.
2.00-m-diameter metal sphere with a charge of
5.00 mC on it. Assume the potential energy is
7.4 Determining Field from Potential
zero at a reference point infinitely far away from
the Van de Graaff. (a) What is the potential near 55. Throughout a region, equipotential surfaces are
its surface? (b) At what distance from its center given by . The surfaces are equally
is the potential 1.00 MV? (c) An oxygen atom spaced with for
with three missing electrons is released near for
the Van de Graaff generator. What is its kinetic for What is
energy in MeV when the atom is at the distance the electric field in this region?
found in part b? 56. In a particular region, the electric potential is
50. An electrostatic paint sprayer has a 0.200-m- given by What is the electric
diameter metal sphere at a potential of 25.0 kV field in this region?
that repels paint droplets onto a grounded 57. Calculate the electric field of an infinite line
object. charge, throughout space.
(a) What charge is on the sphere? (b) What
charge must a 0.100-mg drop of paint have to 7.5 Equipotential Surfaces and Conductors
arrive at the object with a speed of 10.0 m/s?
58. Two very large metal plates are placed 2.0 cm
51. (a) What is the potential between two points
apart, with a potential difference of 12 V
situated 10 cm and 20 cm from a point
between them. Consider one plate to be at 12 V,
charge? (b) To what location should the point at
and the other at 0 V. (a) Sketch the equipotential
20 cm be moved to increase this potential
surfaces for 0, 4, 8, and 12 V. (b) Next sketch in
difference by a factor of two?
some electric field lines, and confirm that they

Access for free at openstax.org.


7 • Chapter Review 329

are perpendicular to the equipotential lines. from the center of the rod.
59. A very large sheet of insulating material has had 63. Two parallel plates 10 cm on a side are given
an excess of electrons placed on it to a surface equal and opposite charges of magnitude
charge density of . (a) As the The plates are 1.5 mm apart.
distance from the sheet increases, does the What is the potential difference between the
potential increase or decrease? Can you explain plates?
why without any calculations? Does the location 64. The surface charge density on a long straight
of your reference point matter? (b) What is the metallic pipe is . What is the electric potential
shape of the equipotential surfaces? (c) What is outside and inside the pipe? Assume the pipe
the spacing between surfaces that differ by 1.00 has a diameter of 2a.
V?
60. A metallic sphere of radius 2.0 cm is charged
with charge, which spreads on the
surface of the sphere uniformly. The metallic
sphere stands on an insulated stand and is
surrounded by a larger metallic spherical shell,
of inner radius 5.0 cm and outer radius 6.0 cm.
Now, a charge of is placed on the
inside of the spherical shell, which spreads out
uniformly on the inside surface of the shell. If
potential is zero at infinity, what is the potential
of (a) the spherical shell, (b) the sphere, (c) the
space between the two, (d) inside the sphere,
and (e) outside the shell?

65. Concentric conducting spherical shells carry


charges Q and –Q, respectively. The inner shell
has negligible thickness. What is the potential
difference between the shells?

61. Two large charged plates of charge density


face each other at a separation of
5.0 mm. (a) Find the electric potential
everywhere. (b) An electron is released from
rest at the negative plate; with what speed will it
strike the positive plate?
62. A long cylinder of aluminum of radius R meters
is charged so that it has a uniform charge per
unit length on its surface of .
66. Shown below are two concentric spherical
(a) Find the electric field inside and outside the
shells of negligible thicknesses and radii
cylinder. (b) Find the electric potential inside
and The inner and outer shell carry net
and outside the cylinder. (c) Plot electric field
charges and respectively, where both
and electric potential as a function of distance
330 7 • Chapter Review

and are positive. What is the electric


potential in the regions (a) (b)
and (c)

Figure 7.46 Parallel conducting plates with opposite


67. A solid cylindrical conductor of radius a is charges on them create a relatively uniform electric field
surrounded by a concentric cylindrical shell of used to accelerate electrons to the right. Those that go
inner radius b. The solid cylinder and the shell through the hole can be used to make a TV or computer
carry charges Q and –Q, respectively. Assuming screen glow or to produce X- rays.
that the length L of both conductors is much
greater than a or b, what is the potential 71. In a Geiger counter, a thin metallic wire at the
difference between the two conductors? center of a metallic tube is kept at a high voltage
with respect to the metal tube. Ionizing
radiation entering the tube knocks electrons off
7.6 Applications of Electrostatics
gas molecules or sides of the tube that then
68. (a) What is the electric field 5.00 m from the accelerate towards the center wire, knocking off
center of the terminal of a Van de Graaff with a even more electrons. This process eventually
3.00-mC charge, noting that the field is leads to an avalanche that is detectable as a
equivalent to that of a point charge at the center current. A particular Geiger counter has a tube
of the terminal? (b) At this distance, what force of radius R and the inner wire of radius a is at a
does the field exert on a charge on the potential of volts with respect to the outer
Van de Graaff’s belt? metal tube. Consider a point P at a distance s
69. (a) What is the direction and magnitude of an from the center wire and far away from the
electric field that supports the weight of a free ends. (a) Find a formula for the electric field at a
electron near the surface of Earth? (b) Discuss point P inside using the infinite wire
what the small value for this field implies approximation. (b) Find a formula for the
regarding the relative strength of the electric potential at a point P inside. (c) Use
gravitational and electrostatic forces. and
70. A simple and common technique for find the value of the electric field at a point 1.00
accelerating electrons is shown in Figure 7.46, cm from the center.
where there is a uniform electric field between
two plates. Electrons are released, usually from
a hot filament, near the negative plate, and
there is a small hole in the positive plate that
allows the electrons to continue moving. (a)
Calculate the acceleration of the electron if the
field strength is . (b) Explain
why the electron will not be pulled back to the
positive plate once it moves through the hole.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7 • Chapter Review 331

76. A bare helium nucleus has two positive charges


and a mass of . (a) Calculate its
kinetic energy in joules at of the speed of
light. (b) What is this in electron-volts? (c) What
voltage would be needed to obtain this energy?
77. An electron enters a region between two large
parallel plates made of aluminum separated by
a distance of 2.0 cm and kept at a potential
difference of 200 V. The electron enters through
a small hole in the negative plate and moves
toward the positive plate. At the time the
electron is near the negative plate, its speed is
Assume the electric field
between the plates to be uniform, and find the
speed of electron at (a) 0.10 cm, (b) 0.50 cm, (c)
72. The practical limit to an electric field in air is 1.0 cm, and (d) 1.5 cm from the negative plate,
about . Above this strength, and (e) immediately before it hits the positive
sparking takes place because air begins to plate.
ionize. (a) At this electric field strength, how far
would a proton travel before hitting the speed of
light (ignore relativistic effects)? (b) Is it
practical to leave air in particle accelerators?
73. To form a helium atom, an alpha particle that
contains two protons and two neutrons is fixed
at one location, and two electrons are brought in
from far away, one at a time. The first electron is
placed at from the alpha
particle and held there while the second
electron is brought to from
the alpha particle on the other side from the
first electron. See the final configuration below.
(a) How much work is done in each step? (b)
What is the electrostatic energy of the alpha 78. How far apart are two conducting plates that
particle and two electrons in the final have an electric field strength of
configuration? between them, if their
potential difference is 15.0 kV?
79. (a) Will the electric field strength between two
parallel conducting plates exceed the
breakdown strength of dry air, which is
74. Find the electrostatic energy of eight equal , if the plates are separated by
charges each fixed at the corners of a 2.00 mm and a potential difference of
cube of side 2 cm. is applied? (b) How close together
75. The probability of fusion occurring is greatly can the plates be with this applied voltage?
enhanced when appropriate nuclei are brought 80. Membrane walls of living cells have surprisingly
close together, but mutual Coulomb repulsion large electric fields across them due to
must be overcome. This can be done using the separation of ions. What is the voltage across an
kinetic energy of high-temperature gas ions or 8.00-nm-thick membrane if the electric field
by accelerating the nuclei toward one another. strength across it is 5.50 MV/m? You may
(a) Calculate the potential energy of two singly assume a uniform electric field.
charged nuclei separated by 81. A double charged ion is accelerated to an
(b) At what temperature will atoms of a gas have energy of 32.0 keV by the electric field between
an average kinetic energy equal to this needed two parallel conducting plates separated by
electrical potential energy? 2.00 cm. What is the electric field strength
332 7 • Chapter Review

between the plates? 85. (a) A sphere has a surface uniformly charged
82. The temperature near the center of the Sun is with 1.00 C. At what distance from its center is
thought to be 15 million degrees Celsius the potential 5.00 MV? (b) What does your
(or kelvin). Through what answer imply about the practical aspect of
voltage must a singly charged ion be accelerated isolating such a large charge?
to have the same energy as the average kinetic 86. What are the sign and magnitude of a point
energy of ions at this temperature? charge that produces a potential of –2.00 V at a
83. A lightning bolt strikes a tree, moving 20.0 C of distance of 1.00 mm?
charge through a potential difference of 87. In one of the classic nuclear physics
(a) What energy was experiments at the beginning of the twentieth
dissipated? (b) What mass of water could be century, an alpha particle was accelerated
raised from to the boiling point and then toward a gold nucleus, and its path was
boiled by this energy? (c) Discuss the damage substantially deflected by the Coulomb
that could be caused to the tree by the interaction. If the energy of the doubly charged
expansion of the boiling steam. alpha nucleus was 5.00 MeV, how close to the
84. What is the potential from a gold nucleus (79 protons) could it come before
proton (the average distance between the being deflected?
proton and electron in a hydrogen atom)?

Additional Problems
88. A 12.0-V battery-operated bottle warmer heats 93. A CD disk of radius ( ) is sprayed with
50.0 g of glass, of baby formula, a charged paint so that the charge varies
and of aluminum from to continually with radial distance r from the
. (a) How much charge is moved by the center in the following manner:
battery? (b) How many electrons per second .
flow if it takes 5.00 min to warm the formula? Find the potential at a point 4 cm above the
(Hint: Assume that the specific heat of baby center.
formula is about the same as the specific heat of 94. (a) What is the final speed of an electron
water.) accelerated from rest through a voltage of 25.0
89. A battery-operated car uses a 12.0-V system. MV by a negatively charged Van de Graff
Find the charge the batteries must be able to terminal? (b) What is unreasonable about this
move in order to accelerate the 750 kg car from result? (c) Which assumptions are responsible?
rest to 25.0 m/s, make it climb a 95. A large metal plate is charged uniformly to a
high hill, and finally cause it to travel at a density of . How far apart
constant 25.0 m/s while climbing with are the equipotential surfaces that represent a
force for an hour. potential difference of 25 V?
90. (a) Find the voltage near a 10.0 cm diameter 96. Your friend gets really excited by the idea of
metal sphere that has 8.00 C of excess positive making a lightning rod or maybe just a sparking
charge on it. (b) What is unreasonable about toy by connecting two spheres as shown in
this result? (c) Which assumptions are Figure 7.39, and making so small that the
responsible? electric field is greater than the dielectric
91. A uniformly charged half-ring of radius 10 cm is strength of air, just from the usual 150 V/m
placed on a nonconducting table. It is found that electric field near the surface of the Earth. If
3.0 cm above the center of the half-ring the is 10 cm, how small does need to be, and
potential is –3.0 V with respect to zero potential does this seem practical? (Hint: recall the
at infinity. How much charge is in the half-ring? calculation for electric field at the surface of a
92. A glass ring of radius 5.0 cm is painted with a conductor from Gauss’s Law.)
charged paint such that the charge density 97. (a) Find limit of the potential of a finite
around the ring varies continuously given by uniformly charged rod and show that it
the following function of the polar angle coincides with that of a point charge formula.
Find the (b) Why would you expect this result?
potential at a point 15 cm above the center.

Access for free at openstax.org.


7 • Chapter Review 333

98. A small spherical pith ball of radius 0.50 cm is 102. Point charges of are
painted with a silver paint and then of placed 0.500 m apart.
charge is placed on it. The charged pith ball is (a) At what point along the line between them
put at the center of a gold spherical shell of is the electric field zero?
inner radius 2.0 cm and outer radius 2.2 cm. (a) (b) What is the electric field halfway between
Find the electric potential of the gold shell with them?
respect to zero potential at infinity. (b) How 103. What can you say about two charges ,
much charge should you put on the gold shell if if the electric field one-fourth of the way from
you want to make its potential 100 V? is zero?
99. Two parallel conducting plates, each of cross- 104. Calculate the angular velocity of an electron
sectional area , are 2.0 cm apart and orbiting a proton in the hydrogen atom, given
uncharged. If electrons are the radius of the orbit is . You
transferred from one plate to the other, (a) what may assume that the proton is stationary and
is the potential difference between the plates? the centripetal force is supplied by Coulomb
(b) What is the potential difference between the attraction.
positive plate and a point 1.25 cm from it that is 105. An electron has an initial velocity of
between the plates? in a uniform
100. A point charge of is placed electric field. The field accelerates the electron
at the center of an uncharged spherical in the direction opposite to its initial velocity.
conducting shell of inner radius 6.0 cm and (a) What is the direction of the electric field?
outer radius 9.0 cm. Find the electric potential (b) How far does the electron travel before
at (a) (b) (c) coming to rest? (c) How long does it take the
electron to come to rest? (d) What is the
101. Earth has a net charge that produces an electron’s velocity when it returns to its
electric field of approximately 150 N/C starting point?
downward at its surface. (a) What is the
magnitude and sign of the excess charge,
noting the electric field of a conducting sphere
is equivalent to a point charge at its center? (b)
What acceleration will the field produce on a
free electron near Earth’s surface? (c) What
mass object with a single extra electron will
have its weight supported by this field?

Challenge Problems
106. Three and three ions are placed 108. Use the electric field of a finite sphere with
alternately and equally spaced around a circle constant volume charge density to calculate
of radius 50 nm. Find the electrostatic energy the electric potential, throughout space. Then
stored. check your results by calculating the electric
107. Look up (presumably online, or by dismantling field from the potential.
an old device and making measurements) the 109. Calculate the electric field of a dipole
magnitude of the potential deflection plates throughout space from the potential.
(and the space between them) in an ink jet
printer. Then look up the speed with which the
ink comes out the nozzle. Can you calculate the
typical mass of an ink drop?
334 7 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 8
Capacitance

Figure 8.1 The tree-like branch patterns in this clear Plexiglas® block are known as a Lichtenberg figure, named for
the German physicist Georg Christof Lichtenberg (1742–1799), who was the first to study these patterns. The
“branches” are created by the dielectric breakdown produced by a strong electric field. (credit: modification of work
by Bert Hickman)

Chapter Outline

8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance

8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel

8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor

8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric

8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric

INTRODUCTION Capacitors are important components of electrical circuits in many electronic devices,
including pacemakers, cell phones, and computers. In this chapter, we study their properties, and, over the
next few chapters, we examine their function in combination with other circuit elements. By themselves,
capacitors are often used to store electrical energy and release it when needed; with other circuit components,
capacitors often act as part of a filter that allows some electrical signals to pass while blocking others. You can
see why capacitors are considered one of the fundamental components of electrical circuits.
336 8 • Capacitance

8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the concepts of a capacitor and its capacitance
• Describe how to evaluate the capacitance of a system of conductors

A capacitor is a device used to store electrical charge and electrical energy. Capacitors are generally with two
electrical conductors separated by a distance. (Note that such electrical conductors are sometimes referred to
as “electrodes,” but more correctly, they are “capacitor plates.”) The space between capacitors may simply be a
vacuum, and, in that case, a capacitor is then known as a “vacuum capacitor.” However, the space is usually
filled with an insulating material known as a dielectric. (You will learn more about dielectrics in the sections
on dielectrics later in this chapter.) The amount of storage in a capacitor is determined by a property called
capacitance, which you will learn more about a bit later in this section.

Capacitors have applications ranging from filtering static from radio reception to energy storage in heart
defibrillators. Typically, commercial capacitors have two conducting parts close to one another but not
touching, such as those in Figure 8.2. Most of the time, a dielectric is used between the two plates. When
battery terminals are connected to an initially uncharged capacitor, the battery potential moves a small
amount of charge of magnitude Q from the positive plate to the negative plate. The capacitor remains neutral
overall, but with charges and residing on opposite plates.

Figure 8.2 Both capacitors shown here were initially uncharged before being connected to a battery. They now have charges of and
(respectively) on their plates. (a) A parallel-plate capacitor consists of two plates of opposite charge with area A separated by distance
d. (b) A rolled capacitor has a dielectric material between its two conducting sheets (plates).

A system composed of two identical parallel-conducting plates separated by a distance is called a parallel-
plate capacitor (Figure 8.3). The magnitude of the electrical field in the space between the parallel plates is
, where denotes the surface charge density on one plate (recall that is the charge Q per the surface
area A). Thus, the magnitude of the field is directly proportional to Q.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.1 • Capacitors and Capacitance 337

Figure 8.3 The charge separation in a capacitor shows that the charges remain on the surfaces of the capacitor plates. Electrical field
lines in a parallel-plate capacitor begin with positive charges and end with negative charges. The magnitude of the electrical field in the
space between the plates is in direct proportion to the amount of charge on the capacitor.

Capacitors with different physical characteristics (such as shape and size of their plates) store different
amounts of charge for the same applied voltage V across their plates. The capacitance C of a capacitor is
defined as the ratio of the maximum charge Q that can be stored in a capacitor to the applied voltage V across
its plates. In other words, capacitance is the largest amount of charge per volt that can be stored on the device:

8.1

The SI unit of capacitance is the farad (F), named after Michael Faraday (1791–1867). Since capacitance is the
charge per unit voltage, one farad is one coulomb per one volt, or

By definition, a 1.0-F capacitor is able to store 1.0 C of charge (a very large amount of charge) when the
potential difference between its plates is only 1.0 V. One farad is therefore a very large capacitance. Typical
capacitance values range from picofarads to millifarads , which also
includes microfarads ( ). Capacitors can be produced in various shapes and sizes (Figure 8.4).
338 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.4 These are some typical capacitors used in electronic devices. A capacitor’s size is not necessarily related to its capacitance
value. (credit: Windell Oskay)

Calculation of Capacitance
We can calculate the capacitance of a pair of conductors with the standard approach that follows.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Calculating Capacitance
1. Assume that the capacitor has a charge Q.
2. Determine the electrical field between the conductors. If symmetry is present in the arrangement of
conductors, you may be able to use Gauss’s law for this calculation.
3. Find the potential difference between the conductors from

8.2

where the path of integration leads from one conductor to the other. The magnitude of the potential
difference is then .
4. With V known, obtain the capacitance directly from Equation 8.1.

To show how this procedure works, we now calculate the capacitances of parallel-plate, spherical, and
cylindrical capacitors. In all cases, we assume vacuum capacitors (empty capacitors) with no dielectric
substance in the space between conductors.

Parallel-Plate Capacitor
The parallel-plate capacitor (Figure 8.5) has two identical conducting plates, each having a surface area A,
separated by a distance d. When a voltage V is applied to the capacitor, it stores a charge Q, as shown. We can
see how its capacitance may depend on A and d by considering characteristics of the Coulomb force. We know
that force between the charges increases with charge values and decreases with the distance between them.
We should expect that the bigger the plates are, the more charge they can store. Thus, C should be greater for a
larger value of A. Similarly, the closer the plates are together, the greater the attraction of the opposite charges
on them. Therefore, C should be greater for a smaller d.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.1 • Capacitors and Capacitance 339

Figure 8.5 In a parallel-plate capacitor with plates separated by a distance d, each plate has the same surface area A.

We define the surface charge density on the plates as

We know from previous chapters that when d is small, the electrical field between the plates is fairly uniform
(ignoring edge effects) and that its magnitude is given by

where the constant is the permittivity of free space, The SI unit of F/m is
equivalent to Since the electrical field between the plates is uniform, the potential difference
between the plates is

Therefore Equation 8.1 gives the capacitance of a parallel-plate capacitor as

8.3

Notice from this equation that capacitance is a function only of the geometry and what material fills the space
between the plates (in this case, vacuum) of this capacitor. In fact, this is true not only for a parallel-plate
capacitor, but for all capacitors: The capacitance is independent of Q or V. If the charge changes, the potential
changes correspondingly so that Q/V remains constant.

EXAMPLE 8.1

Capacitance and Charge Stored in a Parallel-Plate Capacitor


(a) What is the capacitance of an empty parallel-plate capacitor with metal plates that each have an area of
, separated by 1.00 mm? (b) How much charge is stored in this capacitor if a voltage of is
340 8 • Capacitance

applied to it?

Strategy
Finding the capacitance C is a straightforward application of Equation 8.3. Once we find C, we can find the
charge stored by using Equation 8.1.

Solution

a. Entering the given values into Equation 8.3 yields

This small capacitance value indicates how difficult it is to make a device with a large capacitance.
b. Inverting Equation 8.1 and entering the known values into this equation gives

Significance
This charge is only slightly greater than those found in typical static electricity applications. Since air breaks
down (becomes conductive) at an electrical field strength of about 3.0 MV/m, no more charge can be stored on
this capacitor by increasing the voltage.

EXAMPLE 8.2

A 1-F Parallel-Plate Capacitor


Suppose you wish to construct a parallel-plate capacitor with a capacitance of 1.0 F. What area must you use
for each plate if the plates are separated by 1.0 mm?

Solution
Rearranging Equation 8.3, we obtain

Each square plate would have to be 10 km across. It used to be a common prank to ask a student to go to the
laboratory stockroom and request a 1-F parallel-plate capacitor, until stockroom attendants got tired of the
joke.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.1


The capacitance of a parallel-plate capacitor is 2.0 pF. If the area of each plate is , what is the plate
separation?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.2


Verify that and have the same physical units.

Spherical Capacitor
A spherical capacitor is another set of conductors whose capacitance can be easily determined (Figure 8.6). It
consists of two concentric conducting spherical shells of radii (inner shell) and (outer shell). The shells
are given equal and opposite charges and , respectively. From symmetry, the electrical field between
the shells is directed radially outward. We can obtain the magnitude of the field by applying Gauss’s law over a
spherical Gaussian surface of radius r concentric with the shells. The enclosed charge is ; therefore we
have

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.1 • Capacitors and Capacitance 341

Thus, the electrical field between the conductors is

We substitute this into Equation 8.2 and integrate along a radial path between the shells:

In this equation, the potential difference between the plates is . We substitute this
result into Equation 8.1 to find the capacitance of a spherical capacitor:

8.4

Figure 8.6 A spherical capacitor consists of two concentric conducting spheres. Note that the charges on a conductor reside on its
surface.

EXAMPLE 8.3

Capacitance of an Isolated Sphere


Calculate the capacitance of a single isolated conducting sphere of radius and compare it with Equation 8.4
in the limit as ∞.
Strategy
We assume that the charge on the sphere is Q, and so we follow the four steps outlined earlier. We also assume
the other conductor to be a concentric hollow sphere of infinite radius.

Solution
On the outside of an isolated conducting sphere, the electrical field is given by Equation 8.2. The magnitude of
the potential difference between the surface of an isolated sphere and infinity is

∞ ∞ ∞
342 8 • Capacitance

The capacitance of an isolated sphere is therefore

Significance
The same result can be obtained by taking the limit of Equation 8.4 as ∞ . A single isolated sphere is
therefore equivalent to a spherical capacitor whose outer shell has an infinitely large radius.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.3


The radius of the outer sphere of a spherical capacitor is five times the radius of its inner shell. What are the
dimensions of this capacitor if its capacitance is 5.00 pF?

Cylindrical Capacitor
A cylindrical capacitor consists of two concentric, conducting cylinders (Figure 8.7). The inner cylinder, of
radius , may either be a shell or be completely solid. The outer cylinder is a shell of inner radius . We
assume that the length of each cylinder is l and that the excess charges and reside on the inner and
outer cylinders, respectively.

Figure 8.7 A cylindrical capacitor consists of two concentric, conducting cylinders. Here, the charge on the outer surface of the inner
cylinder is positive (indicated by ) and the charge on the inner surface of the outer cylinder is negative (indicated by ).

With edge effects ignored, the electrical field between the conductors is directed radially outward from the
common axis of the cylinders. Using the Gaussian surface shown in Figure 8.7, we have

Therefore, the electrical field between the cylinders is

8.5

Here is the unit radial vector along the radius of the cylinder. We can substitute into Equation 8.2 and find
the potential difference between the cylinders:

Thus, the capacitance of a cylindrical capacitor is

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.1 • Capacitors and Capacitance 343

8.6

As in other cases, this capacitance depends only on the geometry of the conductor arrangement. An important
application of Equation 8.6 is the determination of the capacitance per unit length of a coaxial cable, which is
commonly used to transmit time-varying electrical signals. A coaxial cable consists of two concentric,
cylindrical conductors separated by an insulating material. (Here, we assume a vacuum between the
conductors, but the physics is qualitatively almost the same when the space between the conductors is filled by
a dielectric.) This configuration shields the electrical signal propagating down the inner conductor from stray
electrical fields external to the cable. Current flows in opposite directions in the inner and the outer
conductors, with the outer conductor usually grounded. Now, from Equation 8.6, the capacitance per unit
length of the coaxial cable is given by

In practical applications, it is important to select specific values of C/l. This can be accomplished with
appropriate choices of radii of the conductors and of the insulating material between them.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.4


When a cylindrical capacitor is given a charge of 0.500 nC, a potential difference of 20.0 V is measured
between the cylinders. (a) What is the capacitance of this system? (b) If the cylinders are 1.0 m long, what is the
ratio of their radii?

Several types of practical capacitors are shown in Figure 8.4. Common capacitors are often made of two small
pieces of metal foil separated by two small pieces of insulation (see Figure 8.2(b)). The metal foil and insulation
are encased in a protective coating, and two metal leads are used for connecting the foils to an external circuit.
Some common insulating materials are mica, ceramic, paper, and Teflon™ non-stick coating.

Another popular type of capacitor is an electrolytic capacitor. It consists of an oxidized metal in a conducting
paste. The main advantage of an electrolytic capacitor is its high capacitance relative to other common types of
capacitors. For example, capacitance of one type of aluminum electrolytic capacitor can be as high as 1.0 F.
However, you must be careful when using an electrolytic capacitor in a circuit, because it only functions
correctly when the metal foil is at a higher potential than the conducting paste. When reverse polarization
occurs, electrolytic action destroys the oxide film. This type of capacitor cannot be connected across an
alternating current source, because half of the time, ac voltage would have the wrong polarity, as an alternating
current reverses its polarity (see Alternating-Current Circuts on alternating-current circuits).

A variable air capacitor (Figure 8.8) has two sets of parallel plates. One set of plates is fixed (indicated as
“stator”), and the other set of plates is attached to a shaft that can be rotated (indicated as “rotor”). By turning
the shaft, the cross-sectional area in the overlap of the plates can be changed; therefore, the capacitance of this
system can be tuned to a desired value. Capacitor tuning has applications in any type of radio transmission
and in receiving radio signals from electronic devices. Any time you tune your car radio to your favorite
station, think of capacitance.
344 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.8 In a variable air capacitor, capacitance can be tuned by changing the effective area of the plates. (credit: modification of work
by Robbie Sproule)

The symbols shown in Figure 8.9 are circuit representations of various types of capacitors. We generally use
the symbol shown in Figure 8.9(a). The symbol in Figure 8.9(c) represents a variable-capacitance capacitor.
Notice the similarity of these symbols to the symmetry of a parallel-plate capacitor. An electrolytic capacitor is
represented by the symbol in part Figure 8.9(b), where the curved plate indicates the negative terminal.

Figure 8.9 This shows three different circuit representations of capacitors. The symbol in (a) is the most commonly used one. The symbol
in (b) represents an electrolytic capacitor. The symbol in (c) represents a variable-capacitance capacitor.

An interesting applied example of a capacitor model comes from cell biology and deals with the electrical
potential in the plasma membrane of a living cell (Figure 8.10). Cell membranes separate cells from their
surroundings but allow some selected ions to pass in or out of the cell. The potential difference across a
membrane is about 70 mV. The cell membrane may be 7 to 10 nm thick. Treating the cell membrane as a
nano-sized capacitor, the estimate of the smallest electrical field strength across its ‘plates’ yields the value
.

This magnitude of electrical field is great enough to create an electrical spark in the air.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.2 • Capacitors in Series and in Parallel 345

Figure 8.10 The semipermeable membrane of a biological cell has different concentrations of ions on its interior surface than on its
exterior. Diffusion moves the (potassium) and (chloride) ions in the directions shown, until the Coulomb force halts further transfer.
In this way, the exterior of the membrane acquires a positive charge and its interior surface acquires a negative charge, creating a potential
difference across the membrane. The membrane is normally impermeable to Na+ (sodium ions).

INTERACTIVE
Visit the PhET Explorations: Capacitor Lab (https://openstax.org/l/21phetcapacitor) to explore how a capacitor
works. Change the size of the plates and add a dielectric to see the effect on capacitance. Change the voltage
and see charges built up on the plates. Observe the electrical field in the capacitor. Measure the voltage and the
electrical field.

8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how to determine the equivalent capacitance of capacitors in series and in parallel combinations
• Compute the potential difference across the plates and the charge on the plates for a capacitor in a network
and determine the net capacitance of a network of capacitors

Several capacitors can be connected together to be used in a variety of applications. Multiple connections of
capacitors behave as a single equivalent capacitor. The total capacitance of this equivalent single capacitor
depends both on the individual capacitors and how they are connected. Capacitors can be arranged in two
simple and common types of connections, known as series and parallel, for which we can easily calculate the
total capacitance. These two basic combinations, series and parallel, can also be used as part of more complex
connections.

The Series Combination of Capacitors


Figure 8.11 illustrates a series combination of three capacitors, arranged in a row within the circuit. As for any
capacitor, the capacitance of the combination is related to the charge and voltage by using Equation 8.1. When
this series combination is connected to a battery with voltage V, each of the capacitors acquires an identical
charge Q. To explain, first note that the charge on the plate connected to the positive terminal of the battery is
and the charge on the plate connected to the negative terminal is . Charges are then induced on the
other plates so that the sum of the charges on all plates, and the sum of charges on any pair of capacitor plates,
is zero. However, the potential drop on one capacitor may be different from the potential drop
on another capacitor, because, generally, the capacitors may have different capacitances. The
series combination of two or three capacitors resembles a single capacitor with a smaller capacitance.
346 8 • Capacitance

Generally, any number of capacitors connected in series is equivalent to one capacitor whose capacitance
(called the equivalent capacitance) is smaller than the smallest of the capacitances in the series combination.
Charge on this equivalent capacitor is the same as the charge on any capacitor in a series combination: That is,
all capacitors of a series combination have the same charge. This occurs due to the conservation of charge in
the circuit. When a charge Q in a series circuit is removed from a plate of the first capacitor (which we denote
as ), it must be placed on a plate of the second capacitor (which we denote as and so on.

Figure 8.11 (a) Three capacitors are connected in series. The magnitude of the charge on each plate is Q. (b) The network of capacitors in
(a) is equivalent to one capacitor that has a smaller capacitance than any of the individual capacitances in (a), and the charge on its plates is
Q.

We can find an expression for the total (equivalent) capacitance by considering the voltages across the
individual capacitors. The potentials across capacitors 1, 2, and 3 are, respectively, , ,
and . These potentials must sum up to the voltage of the battery, giving the following potential
balance:

Potential V is measured across an equivalent capacitor that holds charge Q and has an equivalent capacitance
. Entering the expressions for , , and , we get

Canceling the charge Q, we obtain an expression containing the equivalent capacitance, , of three capacitors
connected in series:

This expression can be generalized to any number of capacitors in a series network.

Series Combination
For capacitors connected in a series combination, the reciprocal of the equivalent capacitance is the sum
of reciprocals of individual capacitances:

8.7

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.2 • Capacitors in Series and in Parallel 347

EXAMPLE 8.4

Equivalent Capacitance of a Series Network


Find the total capacitance for three capacitors connected in series, given their individual capacitances are
, , and .

Strategy
Because there are only three capacitors in this network, we can find the equivalent capacitance by using
Equation 8.7 with three terms.

Solution
We enter the given capacitances into Equation 8.7:

Now we invert this result and obtain

Significance
Note that in a series network of capacitors, the equivalent capacitance is always less than the smallest
individual capacitance in the network.

The Parallel Combination of Capacitors


A parallel combination of three capacitors, with one plate of each capacitor connected to one side of the circuit
and the other plate connected to the other side, is illustrated in Figure 8.12(a). Since the capacitors are
connected in parallel, they all have the same voltage V across their plates. However, each capacitor in the
parallel network may store a different charge. To find the equivalent capacitance of the parallel network,
we note that the total charge Q stored by the network is the sum of all the individual charges:

On the left-hand side of this equation, we use the relation , which holds for the entire network. On the
right-hand side of the equation, we use the relations and for the three
capacitors in the network. In this way we obtain

This equation, when simplified, is the expression for the equivalent capacitance of the parallel network of
three capacitors:

This expression is easily generalized to any number of capacitors connected in parallel in the network.

Parallel Combination
For capacitors connected in a parallel combination, the equivalent (net) capacitance is the sum of all
individual capacitances in the network,
8.8
348 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.12 (a) Three capacitors are connected in parallel. Each capacitor is connected directly to the battery. (b) The charge on the
equivalent capacitor is the sum of the charges on the individual capacitors.

EXAMPLE 8.5

Equivalent Capacitance of a Parallel Network


Find the net capacitance for three capacitors connected in parallel, given their individual capacitances are

Strategy
Because there are only three capacitors in this network, we can find the equivalent capacitance by using
Equation 8.8 with three terms.

Solution
Entering the given capacitances into Equation 8.8 yields

Significance
Note that in a parallel network of capacitors, the equivalent capacitance is always larger than any of the
individual capacitances in the network.

Capacitor networks are usually some combination of series and parallel connections, as shown in Figure 8.13.
To find the net capacitance of such combinations, we identify parts that contain only series or only parallel
connections, and find their equivalent capacitances. We repeat this process until we can determine the
equivalent capacitance of the entire network. The following example illustrates this process.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.2 • Capacitors in Series and in Parallel 349

Figure 8.13 (a) This circuit contains both series and parallel connections of capacitors. (b) and are in series; their equivalent
capacitance is (c) The equivalent capacitance is connected in parallel with Thus, the equivalent capacitance of the entire
network is the sum of and

EXAMPLE 8.6

Equivalent Capacitance of a Network


Find the total capacitance of the combination of capacitors shown in Figure 8.13. Assume the capacitances are
known to three decimal places Round your answer to three
decimal places.

Strategy
We first identify which capacitors are in series and which are in parallel. Capacitors and are in series.
Their combination, labeled is in parallel with

Solution
Since are in series, their equivalent capacitance is obtained with Equation 8.7:

Capacitance is connected in parallel with the third capacitance , so we use Equation 8.8 to find the
equivalent capacitance C of the entire network:

EXAMPLE 8.7

Network of Capacitors
Determine the net capacitance C of the capacitor combination shown in Figure 8.14 when the capacitances are
and . When a 12.0-V potential difference is maintained across the
combination, find the charge and the voltage across each capacitor.
350 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.14 (a) A capacitor combination. (b) An equivalent two-capacitor combination.

Strategy
We first compute the net capacitance of the parallel connection and . Then C is the net capacitance
of the series connection and . We use the relation to find the charges , , and , and the
voltages , , and , across capacitors 1, 2, and 3, respectively.

Solution
The equivalent capacitance for and is

The entire three-capacitor combination is equivalent to two capacitors in series,

Consider the equivalent two-capacitor combination in Figure 8.14(b). Since the capacitors are in series, they
have the same charge, . Also, the capacitors share the 12.0-V potential difference, so

Now the potential difference across capacitor 1 is

Because capacitors 2 and 3 are connected in parallel, they are at the same potential difference:

Hence, the charges on these two capacitors are, respectively,

Significance
As expected, the net charge on the parallel combination of and is

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.5


Determine the net capacitance C of each network of capacitors shown below. Assume that ,
, , and . Find the charge on each capacitor, assuming there is a potential
difference of 12.0 V across each network.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.3 • Energy Stored in a Capacitor 351

8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how energy is stored in a capacitor
• Use energy relations to determine the energy stored in a capacitor network

Most of us have seen dramatizations of medical personnel using a defibrillator to pass an electrical current
through a patient’s heart to get it to beat normally. Often realistic in detail, the person applying the shock
directs another person to “make it 400 joules this time.” The energy delivered by the defibrillator is stored in a
capacitor and can be adjusted to fit the situation. SI units of joules are often employed. Less dramatic is the use
of capacitors in microelectronics to supply energy when batteries are charged (Figure 8.15). Capacitors are
also used to supply energy for flash lamps on cameras.
352 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.15 The capacitors on the circuit board for an electronic device follow a labeling convention that identifies each one with a code
that begins with the letter “C.” (credit: Windell Oskay)

The energy stored in a capacitor is electrostatic potential energy and is thus related to the charge Q and
voltage V between the capacitor plates. A charged capacitor stores energy in the electrical field between its
plates. As the capacitor is being charged, the electrical field builds up. When a charged capacitor is
disconnected from a battery, its energy remains in the field in the space between its plates.

To gain insight into how this energy may be expressed (in terms of Q and V), consider a charged, empty,
parallel-plate capacitor; that is, a capacitor without a dielectric but with a vacuum between its plates. The
space between its plates has a volume Ad, and it is filled with a uniform electrostatic field E. The total energy
of the capacitor is contained within this space. The energy density in this space is simply divided
by the volume Ad. If we know the energy density, the energy can be found as . We will learn in
Electromagnetic Waves (after completing the study of Maxwell’s equations) that the energy density in a
region of free space occupied by an electrical field E depends only on the magnitude of the field and is

8.9

If we multiply the energy density by the volume between the plates, we obtain the amount of energy stored
between the plates of a parallel-plate
capacitor: .

In this derivation, we used the fact that the electrical field between the plates is uniform so that and
Because , we can express this result in other equivalent forms:

8.10

The expression in Equation 8.10 for the energy stored in a parallel-plate capacitor is generally valid for all
types of capacitors. To see this, consider any uncharged capacitor (not necessarily a parallel-plate type). At
some instant, we connect it across a battery, giving it a potential difference between its plates.
Initially, the charge on the plates is As the capacitor is being charged, the charge gradually builds up on
its plates, and after some time, it reaches the value Q. To move an infinitesimal charge dq from the negative
plate to the positive plate (from a lower to a higher potential), the amount of work dW that must be done on dq
is .

This work becomes the energy stored in the electrical field of the capacitor. In order to charge the capacitor to
a charge Q, the total work required is

Since the geometry of the capacitor has not been specified, this equation holds for any type of capacitor. The

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.3 • Energy Stored in a Capacitor 353

total work W needed to charge a capacitor is the electrical potential energy stored in it, or . When
the charge is expressed in coulombs, potential is expressed in volts, and the capacitance is expressed in
farads, this relation gives the energy in joules.

Knowing that the energy stored in a capacitor is , we can now find the energy density stored
in a vacuum between the plates of a charged parallel-plate capacitor. We just have to divide by the volume
Ad of space between its plates and take into account that for a parallel-plate capacitor, we have and
. Therefore, we obtain

We see that this expression for the density of energy stored in a parallel-plate capacitor is in accordance with
the general relation expressed in Equation 8.9. We could repeat this calculation for either a spherical capacitor
or a cylindrical capacitor—or other capacitors—and in all cases, we would end up with the general relation
given by Equation 8.9.

EXAMPLE 8.8

Energy Stored in a Capacitor


Calculate the energy stored in the capacitor network in Figure 8.14(a) when the capacitors are fully charged
and when the capacitances are and respectively.

Strategy
We use Equation 8.10 to find the energy , , and stored in capacitors 1, 2, and 3, respectively. The total
energy is the sum of all these energies.

Solution
We identify and , and , and The
energies stored in these capacitors are

The total energy stored in this network is

Significance
We can verify this result by calculating the energy stored in the single capacitor, which is found to be
equivalent to the entire network. The voltage across the network is 12.0 V. The total energy obtained in this
way agrees with our previously obtained result, .

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.6


The potential difference across a 5.0-pF capacitor is 0.40 V. (a) What is the energy stored in this capacitor? (b)
The potential difference is now increased to 1.20 V. By what factor is the stored energy increased?

In a cardiac emergency, a portable electronic device known as an automated external defibrillator (AED) can be
a lifesaver. A defibrillator (Figure 8.16) delivers a large charge in a short burst, or a shock, to a person’s heart
to correct abnormal heart rhythm (an arrhythmia). A heart attack can arise from the onset of fast, irregular
beating of the heart—called cardiac or ventricular fibrillation. Applying a large shock of electrical energy can
terminate the arrhythmia and allow the body’s natural pacemaker to resume its normal rhythm. Today, it is
354 8 • Capacitance

common for ambulances to carry AEDs. AEDs are also found in many public places. These are designed to be
used by lay persons. The device automatically diagnoses the patient’s heart rhythm and then applies the shock
with appropriate energy and waveform. CPR (cardiopulmonary resuscitation) is recommended in many cases
before using a defibrillator.

Figure 8.16 Automated external defibrillators are found in many public places. These portable units provide verbal instructions for use in
the important first few minutes for a person suffering a cardiac attack. (credit: Owain Davies)

EXAMPLE 8.9

Capacitance of a Heart Defibrillator


A heart defibrillator delivers of energy by discharging a capacitor initially at What
is its capacitance?

Strategy
We are given and V, and we are asked to find the capacitance C. We solve Equation 8.10 for C and
substitute.

Solution

Solving this expression for C and entering the given values yields

8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the effects a dielectric in a capacitor has on capacitance and other properties
• Calculate the capacitance of a capacitor containing a dielectric

As we discussed earlier, an insulating material placed between the plates of a capacitor is called a dielectric.
Inserting a dielectric between the plates of a capacitor affects its capacitance. To see why, let’s consider an
experiment described in Figure 8.17. Initially, a capacitor with capacitance when there is air between its

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.4 • Capacitor with a Dielectric 355

plates is charged by a battery to voltage . When the capacitor is fully charged, the battery is disconnected. A
charge then resides on the plates, and the potential difference between the plates is measured to be .
Now, suppose we insert a dielectric that totally fills the gap between the plates. If we monitor the voltage, we
find that the voltmeter reading has dropped to a smaller value V. We write this new voltage value as a fraction
of the original voltage , with a positive number , :

The constant in this equation is called the dielectric constant of the material between the plates, and its
value is characteristic for the material. A detailed explanation for why the dielectric reduces the voltage is
given in the next section. Different materials have different dielectric constants (a table of values for typical
materials is provided in the next section). Once the battery becomes disconnected, there is no path for a
charge to flow to the battery from the capacitor plates. Hence, the insertion of the dielectric has no effect on the
charge on the plate, which remains at a value of . Therefore, we find that the capacitance of the capacitor
with a dielectric is

8.11

This equation tells us that the capacitance of an empty (vacuum) capacitor can be increased by a factor of
when we insert a dielectric material to completely fill the space between its plates. Note that Equation 8.11 can
also be used for an empty capacitor by setting . In other words, we can say that the dielectric constant of
the vacuum is 1, which is a reference value.

Figure 8.17 (a) When fully charged, a vacuum capacitor has a voltage and charge (the charges remain on plate’s inner surfaces; the
schematic indicates the sign of charge on each plate). (b) In step 1, the battery is disconnected. Then, in step 2, a dielectric (that is
electrically neutral) is inserted into the charged capacitor. When the voltage across the capacitor is now measured, it is found that the
voltage value has decreased to . The schematic indicates the sign of the induced charge that is now present on the surfaces of the
dielectric material between the plates.

The principle expressed by Equation 8.11 is widely used in the construction industry (Figure 8.18). Metal
plates in an electronic stud finder act effectively as a capacitor. You place a stud finder with its flat side on the
wall and move it continually in the horizontal direction. When the finder moves over a wooden stud, the
capacitance of its plates changes, because wood has a different dielectric constant than a gypsum wall. This
change triggers a signal in a circuit, and thus the stud is detected.
356 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.18 An electronic stud finder is used to detect wooden studs behind drywall. (credit top: modification of work by Jane Whitney)

The electrical energy stored by a capacitor is also affected by the presence of a dielectric. When the energy
stored in an empty capacitor is , the energy U stored in a capacitor with a dielectric is smaller by a factor of
,

8.12

As a dielectric material sample is brought near an empty charged capacitor, the sample reacts to the electrical
field of the charges on the capacitor plates. Just as we learned in Electric Charges and Fields on electrostatics,
there will be the induced charges on the surface of the sample; however, they are not free charges like in a
conductor, because a perfect insulator does not have freely moving charges. These induced charges on the
dielectric surface are of an opposite sign to the free charges on the plates of the capacitor, and so they are
attracted by the free charges on the plates. Consequently, the dielectric is “pulled” into the gap, and the work to
polarize the dielectric material between the plates is done at the expense of the stored electrical energy, which
is reduced, in accordance with Equation 8.12.

EXAMPLE 8.10

Inserting a Dielectric into an Isolated Capacitor


An empty 20.0-pF capacitor is charged to a potential difference of 40.0 V. The charging battery is then
disconnected, and a piece of Teflon™ with a dielectric constant of 2.1 is inserted to completely fill the space
between the capacitor plates (see Figure 8.17). What are the values of (a) the capacitance, (b) the charge of the
plate, (c) the potential difference between the plates, and (d) the energy stored in the capacitor with and
without dielectric?

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.5 • Molecular Model of a Dielectric 357

Strategy
We identify the original capacitance and the original potential difference between
the plates. We combine Equation 8.11 with other relations involving capacitance and substitute.

Solution

a. The capacitance increases to

b. Without dielectric, the charge on the plates is

Since the battery is disconnected before the dielectric is inserted, the plate charge is unaffected by the
dielectric and remains at 0.8 nC.
c. With the dielectric, the potential difference becomes

d. The stored energy without the dielectric is

With the dielectric inserted, we use Equation 8.12 to find that the stored energy decreases to

Significance
Notice that the effect of a dielectric on the capacitance of a capacitor is a drastic increase of its capacitance.
This effect is far more profound than a mere change in the geometry of a capacitor.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.7


When a dielectric is inserted into an isolated and charged capacitor, the stored energy decreases to 33% of its
original value. (a) What is the dielectric constant? (b) How does the capacitance change?

8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the polarization of a dielectric in a uniform electrical field
• Describe the effect of a polarized dielectric on the electrical field between capacitor plates
• Explain dielectric breakdown

We can understand the effect of a dielectric on capacitance by looking at its behavior at the molecular level. As
we have seen in earlier chapters, in general, all molecules can be classified as either polar or nonpolar. There
is a net separation of positive and negative charges in an isolated polar molecule, whereas there is no charge
separation in an isolated nonpolar molecule (Figure 8.19). In other words, polar molecules have permanent
electric-dipole moments and nonpolar molecules do not. For example, a molecule of water is polar, and a
molecule of oxygen is nonpolar. Nonpolar molecules can become polar in the presence of an external electrical
field, which is called induced polarization.
358 8 • Capacitance

Figure 8.19 The concept of polarization: In an unpolarized atom or molecule, a negatively charged electron cloud is evenly distributed
around positively charged centers, whereas a polarized atom or molecule has an excess of negative charge at one side so that the other
side has an excess of positive charge. However, the entire system remains electrically neutral. The charge polarization may be caused by an
external electrical field. Some molecules and atoms are permanently polarized (electric dipoles) even in the absence of an external
electrical field (polar molecules and atoms).

Let’s first consider a dielectric composed of polar molecules. In the absence of any external electrical field, the
electric dipoles are oriented randomly, as illustrated in Figure 8.20(a). However, if the dielectric is placed in an
external electrical field , the polar molecules align with the external field, as shown in part (b) of the figure.
Opposite charges on adjacent dipoles within the volume of dielectric neutralize each other, so there is no net
charge within the dielectric (see the dashed circles in part (b)). However, this is not the case very close to the
upper and lower surfaces that border the dielectric (the region enclosed by the dashed rectangles in part (b)),
where the alignment does produce a net charge. Since the external electrical field merely aligns the dipoles,
the dielectric as a whole is neutral, and the surface charges induced on its opposite faces are equal and
opposite. These induced surface charges and produce an additional electrical field (an induced
electrical field), which opposes the external field , as illustrated in part (c).

Figure 8.20 A dielectric with polar molecules: (a) In the absence of an external electrical field; (b) in the presence of an external electrical

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.5 • Molecular Model of a Dielectric 359

field . The dashed lines indicate the regions immediately adjacent to the capacitor plates. (c) The induced electrical field inside the
dielectric produced by the induced surface charge of the dielectric. Note that, in reality, the individual molecules are not perfectly
aligned with an external field because of thermal fluctuations; however, the average alignment is along the field lines as shown.

The same effect is produced when the molecules of a dielectric are nonpolar. In this case, a nonpolar molecule
acquires an induced electric-dipole moment because the external field causes a separation between its
positive and negative charges. The induced dipoles of the nonpolar molecules align with in the same way as
the permanent dipoles of the polar molecules are aligned (shown in part (b)). Hence, the electrical field within
the dielectric is weakened regardless of whether its molecules are polar or nonpolar.

Therefore, when the region between the parallel plates of a charged capacitor, such as that shown in Figure
8.21(a), is filled with a dielectric, within the dielectric there is an electrical field due to the free charge
on the capacitor plates and an electrical field due to the induced charge on the surfaces of the dielectric.
Their vector sum gives the net electrical field within the dielectric between the capacitor plates (shown in
part (b) of the figure):

8.13

This net field can be considered to be the field produced by an effective charge on the capacitor.

Figure 8.21 Electrical field: (a) In an empty capacitor, electrical field . (b) In a dielectric-filled capacitor, electrical field .

In most dielectrics, the net electrical field is proportional to the field produced by the free charge. In
terms of these two electrical fields, the dielectric constant of the material is defined as

8.14

Since and point in opposite directions, the magnitude E is smaller than the magnitude and therefore
Combining Equation 8.14 with Equation 8.13, and rearranging the terms, yields the following
expression for the induced electrical field in a dielectric:

8.15

When the magnitude of an external electrical field becomes too large, the molecules of dielectric material start
360 8 • Capacitance

to become ionized. A molecule or an atom is ionized when one or more electrons are removed from it and
become free electrons, no longer bound to the molecular or atomic structure. When this happens, the material
can conduct, thereby allowing charge to move through the dielectric from one capacitor plate to the other. This
phenomenon is called dielectric breakdown. (Figure 8.1 shows typical random-path patterns of electrical
discharge during dielectric breakdown.) The critical value, , of the electrical field at which the molecules of
an insulator become ionized is called the dielectric strength of the material. The dielectric strength imposes a
limit on the voltage that can be applied for a given plate separation in a capacitor. For example, the dielectric
strength of air is , so for an air-filled capacitor with a plate separation of the limit
on the potential difference that can be safely applied across its plates without causing dielectric breakdown is
  .

However, this limit becomes 60.0 kV when the same capacitor is filled with Teflon™, whose dielectric strength
is about . Because of this limit imposed by the dielectric strength, the amount of charge that an air-
filled capacitor can store is only and the charge stored on the same Teflon™-filled
capacitor can be as much as

which is about 42 times greater than a charge stored on an air-filled capacitor. Typical values of dielectric
constants and dielectric strengths for various materials are given in Table 8.1. Notice that the dielectric
constant is exactly 1.0 for a vacuum (the empty space serves as a reference condition) and very close to 1.0
for air under normal conditions (normal pressure at room temperature). These two values are so close that, in
fact, the properties of an air-filled capacitor are essentially the same as those of an empty capacitor.

Material Dielectric constant Dielectric strength

Vacuum 1 ∞

Dry air (1 atm) 1.00059 3.0

Teflon™ 2.1 60 to 173

Paraffin 2.3 11

Silicon oil 2.5 10 to 15

Polystyrene 2.56 19.7

Nylon 3.4 14

Paper 3.7 16

Fused quartz 3.78 8

Glass 4 to 6 9.8 to 13.8

Concrete 4.5 –

Bakelite 4.9 24

Diamond 5.5 2,000

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.5 • Molecular Model of a Dielectric 361

Material Dielectric constant Dielectric strength

Pyrex glass 5.6 14

Mica 6.0 118

Neoprene rubber 6.7 15.7 to 26.7

Water 80

Sulfuric acid 84 to 100

Titanium dioxide 86 to 173 –

Strontium titanate 310 8

Barium titanate 1,200 to 10,000 –

Calcium copper titanate > 250,000 –

Table 8.1 Representative Values of Dielectric Constants and Dielectric Strengths of Various Materials at Room
Temperature

Not all substances listed in the table are good insulators, despite their high dielectric constants. Water, for
example, consists of polar molecules and has a large dielectric constant of about 80. In a water molecule,
electrons are more likely found around the oxygen nucleus than around the hydrogen nuclei. This makes the
oxygen end of the molecule slightly negative and leaves the hydrogens end slightly positive, which makes the
molecule easy to align along an external electrical field, and thus water has a large dielectric constant.
However, the polar nature of water molecules also makes water a good solvent for many substances, which
produces undesirable effects, because any concentration of free ions in water conducts electricity.

EXAMPLE 8.11

Electrical Field and Induced Surface Charge


Suppose that the distance between the plates of the capacitor in Example 8.10 is 2.0 mm and the area of each
plate is . Determine: (a) the electrical field between the plates before and after the Teflon™ is
inserted, and (b) the surface charge induced on the Teflon™ surfaces.

Strategy
In part (a), we know that the voltage across the empty capacitor is , so to find the electrical fields we
use the relation and Equation 8.14. In part (b), knowing the magnitude of the electrical field, we use
the expression for the magnitude of electrical field near a charged plate , where is a uniform surface
charge density caused by the surface charge. We use the value of free charge obtained in
Example 8.10.

Solution

a. The electrical field between the plates of an empty capacitor is

The electrical field E with the Teflon™ in place is


362 8 • Capacitance

b. The effective charge on the capacitor is the difference between the free charge and the induced charge
. The electrical field in the Teflon™ is caused by this effective charge. Thus

We invert this equation to obtain , which yields

EXAMPLE 8.12

Inserting a Dielectric into a Capacitor Connected to a Battery


When a battery of voltage is connected across an empty capacitor of capacitance , the charge on its
plates is , and the electrical field between its plates is . A dielectric of dielectric constant is inserted
between the plates while the battery remains in place, as shown in Figure 8.22. (a) Find the capacitance C, the
voltage V across the capacitor, and the electrical field E between the plates after the dielectric is inserted. (b)
Obtain an expression for the free charge Q on the plates of the filled capacitor and the induced charge on
the dielectric surface in terms of the original plate charge .

Figure 8.22 A dielectric is inserted into the charged capacitor while the capacitor remains connected to the battery.

Strategy
We identify the known values: , , , , and . Our task is to express the unknown values in terms of
these known values.

Solution
(a) The capacitance of the filled capacitor is . Since the battery is always connected to the capacitor
plates, the potential difference between them does not change; hence, . Because of that, the electrical
field in the filled capacitor is the same as the field in the empty capacitor, so we can obtain directly that

Access for free at openstax.org.


8.5 • Molecular Model of a Dielectric 363

(b) For the filled capacitor, the free charge on the plates is

The electrical field E in the filled capacitor is due to the effective charge (Figure 8.22(b)). Since ,
we have

Solving this equation for , we obtain for the induced charge

Significance
Notice that for materials with dielectric constants larger than 2 (see Table 8.1), the induced charge on the
surface of dielectric is larger than the charge on the plates of a vacuum capacitor. The opposite is true for
gasses like air whose dielectric constant is smaller than 2.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.8


Continuing with Example 8.12, show that when the battery is connected across the plates the energy stored in
dielectric-filled capacitor is (larger than the energy of an empty capacitor kept at the same
voltage). Compare this result with the result found previously for an isolated, charged capacitor.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 8.9


Repeat the calculations of Example 8.10 for the case in which the battery remains connected while the
dielectric is placed in the capacitor.
364 8 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
capacitance amount of charge stored per unit volt induced electric-dipole moment dipole moment
capacitor device that stores electrical charge and that a nonpolar molecule may acquire when it is
electrical energy placed in an electrical field
dielectric insulating material used to fill the space induced electrical field electrical field in the
between two plates dielectric due to the presence of induced charges
dielectric breakdown phenomenon that occurs induced surface charges charges that occur on a
when an insulator becomes a conductor in a dielectric surface due to its polarization
strong electrical field parallel combination components in a circuit
dielectric constant factor by which capacitance arranged with one side of each component
increases when a dielectric is inserted between connected to one side of the circuit and the other
the plates of a capacitor sides of the components connected to the other
dielectric strength critical electrical field strength side of the circuit
above which molecules in insulator begin to parallel-plate capacitor system of two identical
break down and the insulator starts to conduct parallel conducting plates separated by a distance
energy density energy stored in a capacitor series combination components in a circuit
divided by the volume between the plates arranged in a row one after the other in a circuit

Key Equations

Capacitance

Capacitance of a parallel-plate capacitor

Capacitance of a vacuum spherical capacitor

Capacitance of a vacuum cylindrical capacitor

Capacitance of a series combination

Capacitance of a parallel combination

Energy density

Energy stored in a capacitor

Capacitance of a capacitor with dielectric

Energy stored in an isolated capacitor with


dielectric

Dielectric constant

Induced electrical field in a dielectric

Access for free at openstax.org.


8 • Chapter Review 365

Summary
8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance capacitor plates. It depends on the amount of
electrical charge on the plates and on the
• A capacitor is a device that stores an electrical
potential difference between the plates.
charge and electrical energy. The amount of
• The energy stored in a capacitor network is the
charge a vacuum capacitor can store depends
sum of the energies stored on individual
on two major factors: the voltage applied and
capacitors in the network. It can be computed as
the capacitor’s physical characteristics, such as
the energy stored in the equivalent capacitor of
its size and geometry.
the network.
• The capacitance of a capacitor is a parameter
that tells us how much charge can be stored in 8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric
the capacitor per unit potential difference
• The capacitance of an empty capacitor is
between its plates. Capacitance of a system of
increased by a factor of when the space
conductors depends only on the geometry of
between its plates is completely filled by a
their arrangement and physical properties of
dielectric with dielectric constant .
the insulating material that fills the space
• Each dielectric material has its specific
between the conductors. The unit of capacitance
dielectric constant.
is the farad, where
• The energy stored in an empty isolated
8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel capacitor is decreased by a factor of when the
space between its plates is completely filled with
• When several capacitors are connected in a
a dielectric with dielectric constant while
series combination, the reciprocal of the
disconnecting the battery and keeping the
equivalent capacitance is the sum of the
charge on the capacitor constant.
reciprocals of the individual capacitances.
• When several capacitors are connected in a 8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric
parallel combination, the equivalent
• When a dielectric is inserted between the plates
capacitance is the sum of the individual
of a capacitor, equal and opposite surface
capacitances.
charge is induced on the two faces of the
• When a network of capacitors contains a
dielectric. The induced surface charge produces
combination of series and parallel connections,
an induced electrical field that opposes the field
we identify the series and parallel networks, and
of the free charge on the capacitor plates.
compute their equivalent capacitances step by
• The dielectric constant of a material is the ratio
step until the entire network becomes reduced
of the electrical field in vacuum to the net
to one equivalent capacitance.
electrical field in the material. A capacitor filled
8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor with dielectric has a larger capacitance than an
empty capacitor.
• Capacitors are used to supply energy to a variety
• The dielectric strength of an insulator
of devices, including defibrillators,
represents a critical value of electrical field at
microelectronics such as calculators, and flash
which the molecules in an insulating material
lamps.
start to become ionized. When this happens, the
• The energy stored in a capacitor is the work
material can conduct and dielectric breakdown
required to charge the capacitor, beginning with
is observed.
no charge on its plates. The energy is stored in
the electrical field in the space between the

Conceptual Questions
8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance increase their capacitance?
3. The value of the capacitance is zero if the plates
1. Does the capacitance of a device depend on the
are not charged. True or false?
applied voltage? Does the capacitance of a device
4. If the plates of a capacitor have different areas,
depend on the charge residing on it?
will they acquire the same charge when the
2. Would you place the plates of a parallel-plate
capacitor is connected across a battery?
capacitor closer together or farther apart to
366 8 • Chapter Review

5. Does the capacitance of a spherical capacitor 8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric


depend on which sphere is charged positively or
11. Distinguish between dielectric strength and
negatively?
dielectric constant.
12. Water is a good solvent because it has a high
8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel
dielectric constant. Explain.
6. If you wish to store a large amount of charge in a 13. Water has a high dielectric constant. Explain
capacitor bank, would you connect capacitors in why it is then not used as a dielectric material in
series or in parallel? Explain. capacitors.
7. What is the maximum capacitance you can get by 14. Elaborate on why molecules in a dielectric
connecting three capacitors? What is the material experience net forces on them in a
minimum capacitance? non-uniform electrical field but not in a uniform
field.
8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor 15. Explain why the dielectric constant of a
substance containing permanent molecular
8. If you wish to store a large amount of energy in a
electric dipoles decreases with increasing
capacitor bank, would you connect capacitors in
temperature.
series or parallel? Explain.
16. Give a reason why a dielectric material
increases capacitance compared with what it
8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric would be with air between the plates of a
9. Discuss what would happen if a conducting slab capacitor. How does a dielectric material also
rather than a dielectric were inserted into the gap allow a greater voltage to be applied to a
between the capacitor plates. capacitor? (The dielectric thus increases C and
10. Discuss how the energy stored in an empty but permits a greater V.)
charged capacitor changes when a dielectric is 17. Elaborate on the way in which the polar
inserted if (a) the capacitor is isolated so that its character of water molecules helps to explain
charge does not change; (b) the capacitor water’s relatively large dielectric constant.
remains connected to a battery so that the 18. Sparks will occur between the plates of an air-
potential difference between its plates does not filled capacitor at a lower voltage when the air is
change. humid than when it is dry. Discuss why,
considering the polar character of water
molecules.

Problems
8.1 Capacitors and Capacitance . What is the separation between its
plates?
19. What charge is stored in a capacitor
27. A set of parallel plates has a capacitance of
when 120.0 V is applied to it?
. How much charge must be added to the
20. Find the charge stored when 5.50 V is applied to
plates to increase the potential difference
an 8.00-pF capacitor.
between them by 100 V?
21. Calculate the voltage applied to a
28. Consider Earth to be a spherical conductor of
capacitor when it holds of charge.
radius 6400 km and calculate its capacitance.
22. What voltage must be applied to an 8.00-nF
29. If the capacitance per unit length of a
capacitor to store 0.160 mC of charge?
cylindrical capacitor is 20 pF/m, what is the
23. What capacitance is needed to store of
ratio of the radii of the two cylinders?
charge at a voltage of 120 V?
30. An empty parallel-plate capacitor has a
24. What is the capacitance of a large Van de Graaff
capacitance of . How much charge must
generator’s terminal, given that it stores 8.00
leak off its plates before the voltage across them
mC of charge at a voltage of 12.0 MV?
is reduced by 100 V?
25. The plates of an empty parallel-plate capacitor
of capacitance 5.0 pF are 2.0 mm apart. What is
the area of each plate?
8.2 Capacitors in Series and in Parallel
26. A 60.0-pF vacuum capacitor has a plate area of 31. A 4.00-pF is connected in series with an

Access for free at openstax.org.


8 • Chapter Review 367

8.00-pF capacitor and a 400-V potential capacitor after the connection is made; and (c)
difference is applied across the pair. (a) What is the potential difference across the plates of
the charge on each capacitor? (b) What is the each capacitor after the connection.
voltage across each capacitor? 39. A capacitor and a capacitor are
32. Three capacitors, with capacitances of connected in series across a 1.0-kV potential.
, and The charged capacitors are then disconnected
respectively, are connected in parallel. A 500-V from the source and connected to each other
potential difference is applied across the with terminals of like sign together. Find the
combination. Determine the voltage across each charge on each capacitor and the voltage across
capacitor and the charge on each capacitor. each capacitor.
33. Find the total capacitance of this combination of
series and parallel capacitors shown below. 8.3 Energy Stored in a Capacitor
40. How much energy is stored in an
capacitor whose plates are at a potential
difference of 6.00 V?
41. A capacitor has a charge of when
connected to a 6.0-V battery. How much energy
is stored in this capacitor?
42. How much energy is stored in the electrical field
of a metal sphere of radius 2.0 m that is kept at
34. Suppose you need a capacitor bank with a total
a 10.0-V potential?
capacitance of 0.750 F but you have only
43. (a) What is the energy stored in the
1.50-mF capacitors at your disposal. What is the
capacitor of a heart defibrillator charged to
smallest number of capacitors you could
? (b) Find the amount of the
connect together to achieve your goal, and how
stored charge.
would you connect them?
44. In open-heart surgery, a much smaller amount
35. What total capacitances can you make by
of energy will defibrillate the heart. (a) What
connecting a and a capacitor?
voltage is applied to the capacitor of a
36. Find the equivalent capacitance of the
heart defibrillator that stores 40.0 J of energy?
combination of series and parallel capacitors
(b) Find the amount of the stored charge.
shown below.
45. A capacitor is used in conjunction with
a dc motor. How much energy is stored in it
when 119 V is applied?
46. Suppose you have a 9.00-V battery, a
capacitor, and a capacitor. (a) Find the
charge and energy stored if the capacitors are
connected to the battery in series. (b) Do the
same for a parallel connection.
37. Find the net capacitance of the combination of 47. An anxious physicist worries that the two metal
series and parallel capacitors shown below. shelves of a wood frame bookcase might obtain
a high voltage if charged by static electricity,
perhaps produced by friction. (a) What is the
capacitance of the empty shelves if they have
area and are 0.200 m apart? (b)
What is the voltage between them if opposite
charges of magnitude 2.00 nC are placed on
them? (c) To show that this voltage poses a
small hazard, calculate the energy stored. (d)
38. A 40-pF capacitor is charged to a potential
The actual shelves have an area 100 times
difference of 500 V. Its terminals are then
smaller than these hypothetical shelves with a
connected to those of an uncharged 10-pF
connection to the same voltage. Are his fears
capacitor. Calculate: (a) the original charge on
justified?
the 40-pF capacitor; (b) the charge on each
48. A parallel-plate capacitor is made of two square
368 8 • Chapter Review

plates 25 cm on a side and 1.0 mm apart. The Suppose that the surface charge densities are
capacitor is connected to a 50.0-V battery. With , the cell wall is
the battery still connected, the plates are pulled thick, and the cell wall material
apart to a separation of 2.00 mm. What are the has a dielectric constant of . (a) Find the
energies stored in the capacitor before and after magnitude of the electric field in the wall
the plates are pulled farther apart? Why does between two charge layers. (b) Find the
the energy decrease even though work is done potential difference between the inside and the
in separating the plates? outside of the cell. Which is at higher potential?
49. Suppose that the capacitance of a variable (c) A typical cell in the human body has volume
capacitor can be manually changed from 100 Estimate the total electrical field
pF to 800 pF by turning a dial, connected to one energy stored in the wall of a cell of this size
set of plates by a shaft, from to . With the when assuming that the cell is spherical. (Hint:
dial set at (corresponding to ), Calculate the volume of the cell wall.)
the capacitor is connected to a 500-V source. 55. A parallel-plate capacitor with only air between
After charging, the capacitor is disconnected its plates is charged by connecting the capacitor
from the source, and the dial is turned to . If to a battery. The capacitor is then disconnected
friction is negligible, how much work is from the battery, without any of the charge
required to turn the dial from to ? leaving the plates. (a) A voltmeter reads 45.0 V
when placed across the capacitor. When a
8.4 Capacitor with a Dielectric dielectric is inserted between the plates,
completely filling the space, the voltmeter reads
50. Show that for a given dielectric material, the
11.5 V. What is the dielectric constant of the
maximum energy a parallel-plate capacitor can
material? (b) What will the voltmeter read if the
store is directly proportional to the volume of
dielectric is now pulled away out so it fills only
dielectric.
one-third of the space between the plates?
51. An air-filled capacitor is made from two flat
parallel plates 1.0 mm apart. The inside area of
each plate is . (a) What is the
8.5 Molecular Model of a Dielectric
capacitance of this set of plates? (b) If the region 56. Two flat plates containing equal and opposite
between the plates is filled with a material charges are separated by material 4.0 mm thick
whose dielectric constant is 6.0, what is the new with a dielectric constant of 5.0. If the electrical
capacitance? field in the dielectric is 1.5 MV/m, what are (a)
52. A capacitor is made from two concentric the charge density on the capacitor plates, and
spheres, one with radius 5.00 cm, the other with (b) the induced charge density on the surfaces
radius 8.00 cm. (a) What is the capacitance of of the dielectric?
this set of conductors? (b) If the region between 57. For a Teflon™-filled, parallel-plate capacitor, the
the conductors is filled with a material whose area of the plate is and the spacing
dielectric constant is 6.00, what is the between the plates is 0.50 mm. If the capacitor
capacitance of the system? is connected to a 200-V battery, find (a) the free
53. A parallel-plate capacitor has charge of charge on the capacitor plates, (b) the electrical
magnitude on each plate and field in the dielectric, and (c) the induced charge
capacitance when there is air between on the dielectric surfaces.
the plates. The plates are separated by 2.00 58. Find the capacitance of a parallel-plate
mm. With the charge on the plates kept capacitor having plates with a surface area of
constant, a dielectric with is inserted and separated by 0.100 mm of Teflon™.
between the plates, completely filling the 59. (a) What is the capacitance of a parallel-plate
volume between the plates. (a) What is the capacitor with plates of area that are
potential difference between the plates of the separated by 0.0200 mm of neoprene rubber?
capacitor, before and after the dielectric has (b) What charge does it hold when 9.00 V is
been inserted? (b) What is the electrical field at applied to it?
the point midway between the plates before and 60. Two parallel plates have equal and opposite
after the dielectric is inserted? charges. When the space between the plates is
54. Some cell walls in the human body have a layer evacuated, the electrical field is
of negative charge on the inside surface.

Access for free at openstax.org.


8 • Chapter Review 369

. When the space is filled the power supply, a slab of dielectric is inserted
with dielectric, the electrical field is that completely fills the space between the
. (a) What is the surface plates. This increases the stored energy by
charge density on each surface of the dielectric? . (a) What is the potential difference
(b) What is the dielectric constant? between the capacitor plates? (b) What is the
61. The dielectric to be used in a parallel-plate dielectric constant of the slab?
capacitor has a dielectric constant of 3.60 and a 63. A parallel-plate capacitor has square plates that
dielectric strength of . The are 8.00 cm on each side and 3.80 mm apart.
capacitor has to have a capacitance of 1.25 nF The space between the plates is completely
and must be able to withstand a maximum filled with two square slabs of dielectric, each
potential difference 5.5 kV. What is the 8.00 cm on a side and 1.90 mm thick. One slab
minimum area the plates of the capacitor may is Pyrex glass and the other slab is polystyrene.
have? If the potential difference between the plates is
62. When a 360-nF air capacitor is connected to a 86.0 V, find how much electrical energy can be
power supply, the energy stored in the capacitor stored in this capacitor.
is . While the capacitor is connected to

Additional Problems
64. A capacitor is made from two flat parallel plates 67. Earth can be considered as a spherical
placed 0.40 mm apart. When a charge of capacitor with two plates, where the negative
is placed on the plates the potential plate is the surface of Earth and the positive
difference between them is 250 V. (a) What is plate is the bottom of the ionosphere, which is
the capacitance of the plates? (b) What is the located at an altitude of approximately 70 km.
area of each plate? (c) What is the charge on the The potential difference between Earth’s
plates when the potential difference between surface and the ionosphere is about 350,000 V.
them is 500 V? (d) What maximum potential (a) Calculate the capacitance of this system. (b)
difference can be applied between the plates so Find the total charge on this capacitor. (c) Find
that the magnitude of electrical fields between the energy stored in this system.
the plates does not exceed 3.0 MV/m? 68. A capacitor and a capacitor are
65. An air-filled (empty) parallel-plate capacitor is connected in parallel across a 600-V supply
made from two square plates that are 25 cm on line. (a) Find the charge on each capacitor and
each side and 1.0 mm apart. The capacitor is voltage across each. (b) The charged capacitors
connected to a 50-V battery and fully charged. It are disconnected from the line and from each
is then disconnected from the battery and its other. They are then reconnected to each other
plates are pulled apart to a separation of 2.00 with terminals of unlike sign together. Find the
mm. (a) What is the capacitance of this new final charge on each capacitor and the voltage
capacitor? (b) What is the charge on each plate? across each.
(c) What is the electrical field between the 69. Three capacitors having capacitances of 8.40,
plates? 8.40, and 4.20 , respectively, are connected in
66. Suppose that the capacitance of a variable series across a 36.0-V potential difference. (a)
capacitor can be manually changed from 100 to What is the charge on the capacitor? (b)
800 pF by turning a dial connected to one set of The capacitors are disconnected from the
plates by a shaft, from to . With the dial potential difference without allowing them to
set at (corresponding to ), the discharge. They are then reconnected in
capacitor is connected to a 500-V source. After parallel with each other with the positively
charging, the capacitor is disconnected from charged plates connected together. What is the
the source, and the dial is turned to . (a) What voltage across each capacitor in the parallel
is the charge on the capacitor? (b) What is the combination?
voltage across the capacitor when the dial is set 70. A parallel-plate capacitor with capacitance
to is charged with a 12.0-V battery, after
which the battery is disconnected. Determine
the minimum work required to increase the
separation between the plates by a factor of 3.
370 8 • Chapter Review

71. (a) How much energy is stored in the electrical 73. (a) An capacitor is connected in parallel
fields in the capacitors (in total) shown below? to another capacitor, producing a total
(b) Is this energy equal to the work done by the capacitance of . What is the capacitance
400-V source in charging the capacitors? of the second capacitor? (b) What is
unreasonable about this result? (c) Which
assumptions are unreasonable or inconsistent?
74. (a) On a particular day, it takes of
electrical energy to start a truck’s engine.
Calculate the capacitance of a capacitor that
could store that amount of energy at 12.0 V. (b)
What is unreasonable about this result? (c)
Which assumptions are responsible?
75. (a) A certain parallel-plate capacitor has plates
of area , separated by 0.0100 mm of
nylon, and stores 0.170 C of charge. What is the
applied voltage? (b) What is unreasonable about
Figure 8.23 this result? (c) Which assumptions are
responsible or inconsistent?
72. Three capacitors having capacitances 8.4, 8.4,
76. A prankster applies 450 V to an
and 4.2 are connected in series across a
capacitor and then tosses it to an unsuspecting
36.0-V potential difference. (a) What is the total
victim. The victim’s finger is burned by the
energy stored in all three capacitors? (b) The
discharge of the capacitor through 0.200 g of
capacitors are disconnected from the potential
flesh. Estimate, what is the temperature
difference without allowing them to discharge.
increase of the flesh? Is it reasonable to assume
They are then reconnected in parallel with each
that no thermodynamic phase change
other with the positively charged plates
happened?
connected together. What is the total energy
now stored in the capacitors?

Challenge Problems
77. A spherical capacitor is formed from two
concentric spherical conducting spheres
separated by vacuum. The inner sphere has
radius 12.5 cm and the outer sphere has radius
14.8 cm. A potential difference of 120 V is
applied to the capacitor. (a) What is the
capacitance of the capacitor? (b) What is the
magnitude of the electrical field at ,
just outside the inner sphere? (c) What is the
magnitude of the electrical field at ,
just inside the outer sphere? (d) For a parallel-
plate capacitor the electrical field is uniform in
the region between the plates, except near the
edges of the plates. Is this also true for a
spherical capacitor?

Access for free at openstax.org.


8 • Chapter Review 371

78. The network of capacitors shown below are all 81. A metal plate of thickness t is held in place
uncharged when a 300-V potential is applied between two capacitor plates by plastic pegs, as
between points A and B with the switch S open. shown below. The effect of the pegs on the
(a) What is the potential difference ? capacitance is negligible. The area of each
(b) What is the potential at point E after the capacitor plate and the area of the top and
switch is closed? (c) How much charge flows bottom surfaces of the inserted plate are all A.
through the switch after it is closed? What is the capacitance of this system?

82. A parallel-plate capacitor is filled with two


dielectrics, as shown below. When the plate area
is A and separation between plates is d, show
that the capacitance is given by

79. Electronic flash units for cameras contain a


capacitor for storing the energy used to produce
the flash. In one such unit the flash lasts for 1/
675 fraction of a second with an average light
power output of 270 kW. (a) If the conversion of
electrical energy to light is 95% efficient
(because the rest of the energy goes to thermal
energy), how much energy must be stored in the
capacitor for one flash? (b) The capacitor has a
potential difference between its plates of 125 V
when the stored energy equals the value stored
in part (a). What is the capacitance?
80. A spherical capacitor is formed from two
83. A parallel-plate capacitor is filled with two
concentric spherical conducting shells
dielectrics, as shown below. Show that the
separated by a vacuum. The inner sphere has
capacitance is given by
radius 12.5 cm and the outer sphere has radius
14.8 cm. A potential difference of 120 V is
applied to the capacitor. (a) What is the energy
density at , just outside the inner
sphere? (b) What is the energy density at
, just inside the outer sphere? (c)
For the parallel-plate capacitor the energy
density is uniform in the region between the
plates, except near the edges of the plates. Is
this also true for the spherical capacitor?
372 8 • Chapter Review

84. A capacitor has parallel plates of area


separated by 2.0 mm. The space between the
plates is filled with polystyrene. (a) Find the
maximum permissible voltage across the
capacitor to avoid dielectric breakdown. (b)
When the voltage equals the value found in part
(a), find the surface charge density on the
surface of the dielectric.

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 9
Current and Resistance

Figure 9.1 Magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) uses superconducting magnets and produces high-resolution
images without the danger of radiation. The image on the left shows the spacing of vertebrae along a human spinal
column, with the circle indicating where the vertebrae are too close due to a ruptured disc. On the right is a picture
of the MRI instrument, which surrounds the patient on all sides. A large amount of electrical current is required to
operate the electromagnets (credit right: modification of work by “digital cat”/Flickr).

Chapter Outline

9.1 Electrical Current

9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals

9.3 Resistivity and Resistance

9.4 Ohm's Law

9.5 Electrical Energy and Power

9.6 Superconductors

INTRODUCTION In this chapter, we study the electrical current through a material, where the electrical
current is the rate of flow of charge. We also examine a characteristic of materials known as the resistance.
Resistance is a measure of how much a material impedes the flow of charge, and it will be shown that the
resistance depends on temperature. In general, a good conductor, such as copper, gold, or silver, has very low
resistance. Some materials, called superconductors, have zero resistance at very low temperatures.
374 9 • Current and Resistance

High currents are required for the operation of electromagnets. Superconductors can be used to make
electromagnets that are 10 times stronger than the strongest conventional electromagnets. These
superconducting magnets are used in the construction of magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) devices that can
be used to make high-resolution images of the human body. The chapter-opening picture shows an MRI image
of the vertebrae of a human subject and the MRI device itself. Superconducting magnets have many other uses.
For example, superconducting magnets are used in the Large Hadron Collider (LHC) to curve the path of
protons in the ring.

9.1 Electrical Current


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe an electrical current
• Define the unit of electrical current
• Explain the direction of current flow

Up to now, we have considered primarily static charges. When charges did move, they were accelerated in
response to an electrical field created by a voltage difference. The charges lost potential energy and gained
kinetic energy as they traveled through a potential difference where the electrical field did work on the charge.

Although charges do not require a material to flow through, the majority of this chapter deals with
understanding the movement of charges through a material. The rate at which the charges flow past a
location—that is, the amount of charge per unit time—is known as the electrical current. When charges flow
through a medium, the current depends on the voltage applied, the material through which the charges flow,
and the state of the material. Of particular interest is the motion of charges in a conducting wire. In previous
chapters, charges were accelerated due to the force provided by an electrical field, losing potential energy and
gaining kinetic energy. In this chapter, we discuss the situation of the force provided by an electrical field in a
conductor, where charges lose kinetic energy to the material reaching a constant velocity, known as the “drift
velocity.” This is analogous to an object falling through the atmosphere and losing kinetic energy to the air,
reaching a constant terminal velocity.

If you have ever taken a course in first aid or safety, you may have heard that in the event of electric shock, it is
the current, not the voltage, which is the important factor on the severity of the shock and the amount of
damage to the human body. Current is measured in units called amperes; you may have noticed that circuit
breakers in your home and fuses in your car are rated in amps (or amperes). But what is the ampere and what
does it measure?

Defining Current and the Ampere


Electrical current is defined to be the rate at which charge flows. When there is a large current present, such as
that used to run a refrigerator, a large amount of charge moves through the wire in a small amount of time. If
the current is small, such as that used to operate a handheld calculator, a small amount of charge moves
through the circuit over a long period of time.

Electrical Current
The average electrical current I is the rate at which charge flows,

9.1

where is the amount of net charge passing through a given cross-sectional area in time (Figure 9.2).
The SI unit for current is the ampere (A), named for the French physicist André-Marie Ampère
(1775–1836). Since , we see that an ampere is defined as one coulomb of charge passing through a
given area per second:

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.1 • Electrical Current 375

9.2

The instantaneous electrical current, or simply the electrical current, is the time derivative of the charge
that flows and is found by taking the limit of the average electrical current as :

9.3

Most electrical appliances are rated in amperes (or amps) required for proper operation, as are fuses and
circuit breakers.

Figure 9.2 The rate of flow of charge is current. An ampere is the flow of one coulomb of charge through an area in one second. A current
of one amp would result from electrons flowing through the area A each second.

EXAMPLE 9.1

Calculating the Average Current


The main purpose of a battery in a car or truck is to run the electric starter motor, which starts the engine. The
operation of starting the vehicle requires a large current to be supplied by the battery. Once the engine starts, a
device called an alternator takes over supplying the electric power required for running the vehicle and for
charging the battery.

(a) What is the average current involved when a truck battery sets in motion 720 C of charge in 4.00 s while
starting an engine? (b) How long does it take 1.00 C of charge to flow from the battery?

Strategy
We can use the definition of the average current in the equation to find the average current in part (a),
since charge and time are given. For part (b), once we know the average current, we can its definition
to find the time required for 1.00 C of charge to flow from the battery.

Solution
a. Entering the given values for charge and time into the definition of current gives

b. Solving the relationship for time and entering the known values for charge and current gives

Significance
a. This large value for current illustrates the fact that a large charge is moved in a small amount of time. The
currents in these “starter motors” are fairly large to overcome the inertia of the engine. b. A high current
requires a short time to supply a large amount of charge. This large current is needed to supply the large
amount of energy needed to start the engine.
376 9 • Current and Resistance

EXAMPLE 9.2

Calculating Instantaneous Currents


Consider a charge moving through a cross-section of a wire where the charge is modeled as
. Here, is the charge after a long period of time, as time approaches infinity, with
units of coulombs, and is a time constant with units of seconds (see Figure 9.3). What is the current through
the wire?

Figure 9.3 A graph of the charge moving through a cross-section of a wire over time.

Strategy
The current through the cross-section can be found from . Notice from the figure that the charge
increases to and the derivative decreases, approaching zero, as time increases (Figure 9.4).

Solution
The derivative can be found using .

Figure 9.4 A graph of the current flowing through the wire over time.

Significance
The current through the wire in question decreases exponentially, as shown in Figure 9.4. In later chapters, it
will be shown that a time-dependent current appears when a capacitor charges or discharges through a
resistor. Recall that a capacitor is a device that stores charge. You will learn about the resistor in Model of
Conduction in Metals.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.1

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.1 • Electrical Current 377

Handheld calculators often use small solar cells to supply the energy required to complete the calculations
needed to complete your next physics exam. The current needed to run your calculator can be as small as 0.30
mA. How long would it take for 1.00 C of charge to flow from the solar cells? Can solar cells be used, instead of
batteries, to start traditional internal combustion engines presently used in most cars and trucks?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.2


Circuit breakers in a home are rated in amperes, normally in a range from 10 amps to 30 amps, and are used
to protect the residents from harm and their appliances from damage due to large currents. A single 15-amp
circuit breaker may be used to protect several outlets in the living room, whereas a single 20-amp circuit
breaker may be used to protect the refrigerator in the kitchen. What can you deduce from this about current
used by the various appliances?

Current in a Circuit
In the previous paragraphs, we defined the current as the charge that flows through a cross-sectional area per
unit time. In order for charge to flow through an appliance, such as the headlight shown in Figure 9.5, there
must be a complete path (or circuit) from the positive terminal to the negative terminal. Consider a simple
circuit of a car battery, a switch, a headlight lamp, and wires that provide a current path between the
components. In order for the lamp to light, there must be a complete path for current flow. In other words, a
charge must be able to leave the positive terminal of the battery, travel through the component, and back to the
negative terminal of the battery. The switch is there to control the circuit. Part (a) of the figure shows the
simple circuit of a car battery, a switch, a conducting path, and a headlight lamp. Also shown is the schematic
of the circuit [part (b)]. A schematic is a graphical representation of a circuit and is very useful in visualizing
the main features of a circuit. Schematics use standardized symbols to represent the components in a circuits
and solid lines to represent the wires connecting the components. The battery is shown as a series of long and
short lines, representing the historic voltaic pile. The lamp is shown as a circle with a loop inside, representing
the filament of an incandescent bulb. The switch is shown as two points with a conducting bar to connect the
two points and the wires connecting the components are shown as solid lines. The schematic in part (c) shows
the direction of current flow when the switch is closed.

Figure 9.5 (a) A simple electric circuit of a headlight (lamp), a battery, and a switch. When the switch is closed, an uninterrupted path for
current to flow through is supplied by conducting wires connecting a load to the terminals of a battery. (b) In this schematic, the battery is
represented by parallel lines, which resemble plates in the original design of a battery. The longer lines indicate the positive terminal. The
conducting wires are shown as solid lines. The switch is shown, in the open position, as two terminals with a line representing a conducting
bar that can make contact between the two terminals. The lamp is represented by a circle encompassing a filament, as would be seen in an
incandescent light bulb. (c) When the switch is closed, the circuit is complete and current flows from the positive terminal to the negative
terminal of the battery.
378 9 • Current and Resistance

When the switch is closed in Figure 9.5(c), there is a complete path for charges to flow, from the positive
terminal of the battery, through the switch, then through the headlight and back to the negative terminal of the
battery. Note that the direction of current flow is from positive to negative. The direction of conventional
current is always represented in the direction that positive charge would flow, from the positive terminal to
the negative terminal.

The conventional current flows from the positive terminal to the negative terminal, but depending on the
actual situation, positive charges, negative charges, or both may move. In metal wires, for example, current is
carried by electrons—that is, negative charges move. In ionic solutions, such as salt water, both positive and
negative charges move. This is also true in nerve cells. A Van de Graaff generator, used for nuclear research,
can produce a current of pure positive charges, such as protons. In the Tevatron Accelerator at Fermilab,
before it was shut down in 2011, beams of protons and antiprotons traveling in opposite directions were
collided. The protons are positive and therefore their current is in the same direction as they travel. The
antiprotons are negativity charged and thus their current is in the opposite direction that the actual particles
travel.

A closer look at the current flowing through a wire is shown in Figure 9.6. The figure illustrates the movement
of charged particles that compose a current. The fact that conventional current is taken to be in the direction
that positive charge would flow can be traced back to American scientist and statesman Benjamin Franklin in
the 1700s. Having no knowledge of the particles that make up the atom (namely the proton, electron, and
neutron), Franklin believed that electrical current flowed from a material that had more of an “electrical fluid”
and to a material that had less of this “electrical fluid.” He coined the term positive for the material that had
more of this electrical fluid and negative for the material that lacked the electrical fluid. He surmised that
current would flow from the material with more electrical fluid—the positive material—to the negative material,
which has less electrical fluid. Franklin called this direction of current a positive current flow. This was pretty
advanced thinking for a man who knew nothing about the atom.

Figure 9.6 Current I is the rate at which charge moves through an area A, such as the cross-section of a wire. Conventional current is
defined to move in the direction of the electrical field. (a) Positive charges move in the direction of the electrical field, which is the same
direction as conventional current. (b) Negative charges move in the direction opposite to the electrical field. Conventional current is in the
direction opposite to the movement of negative charge. The flow of electrons is sometimes referred to as electronic flow.

We now know that a material is positive if it has a greater number of protons than electrons, and it is negative if
it has a greater number of electrons than protons. In a conducting metal, the current flow is due primarily to
electrons flowing from the negative material to the positive material, but for historical reasons, we consider the
positive current flow and the current is shown to flow from the positive terminal of the battery to the negative
terminal.

It is important to realize that an electrical field is present in conductors and is responsible for producing the
current (Figure 9.6). In previous chapters, we considered the static electrical case, where charges in a
conductor quickly redistribute themselves on the surface of the conductor in order to cancel out the external
electrical field and restore equilibrium. In the case of an electrical circuit, the charges are prevented from ever
reaching equilibrium by an external source of electric potential, such as a battery. The energy needed to move
the charge is supplied by the electric potential from the battery.

Although the electrical field is responsible for the motion of the charges in the conductor, the work done on the
charges by the electrical field does not increase the kinetic energy of the charges. We will show that the

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.2 • Model of Conduction in Metals 379

electrical field is responsible for keeping the electric charges moving at a “drift velocity.”

9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define the drift velocity of charges moving through a metal
• Define the vector current density
• Describe the operation of an incandescent lamp

When electrons move through a conducting wire, they do not move at a constant velocity, that is, the electrons
do not move in a straight line at a constant speed. Rather, they interact with and collide with atoms and other
free electrons in the conductor. Thus, the electrons move in a zig-zag fashion and drift through the wire. We
should also note that even though it is convenient to discuss the direction of current, current is a scalar
quantity. When discussing the velocity of charges in a current, it is more appropriate to discuss the current
density. We will come back to this idea at the end of this section.

Drift Velocity
Electrical signals move very rapidly. Telephone conversations carried by currents in wires cover large
distances without noticeable delays. Lights come on as soon as a light switch is moved to the ‘on’ position. Most
electrical signals carried by currents travel at speeds on the order of , a significant fraction of the speed
of light. Interestingly, the individual charges that make up the current move much slower on average, typically
drifting at speeds on the order of . How do we reconcile these two speeds, and what does it tell us
about standard conductors?

The high speed of electrical signals results from the fact that the force between charges acts rapidly at a
distance. Thus, when a free charge is forced into a wire, as in Figure 9.7, the incoming charge pushes other
charges ahead of it due to the repulsive force between like charges. These moving charges push on charges
farther down the line. The density of charge in a system cannot easily be increased, so the signal is passed on
rapidly. The resulting electrical shock wave moves through the system at nearly the speed of light. To be
precise, this fast-moving signal, or shock wave, is a rapidly propagating change in the electrical field.

Figure 9.7 When charged particles are forced into this volume of a conductor, an equal number are quickly forced to leave. The repulsion
between like charges makes it difficult to increase the number of charges in a volume. Thus, as one charge enters, another leaves almost
immediately, carrying the signal rapidly forward.

Good conductors have large numbers of free charges. In metals, the free charges are free electrons. (In fact,
good electrical conductors are often good heat conductors too, because large numbers of free electrons can
transport thermal energy as well as carry electrical current.) Figure 9.8 shows how free electrons move
through an ordinary conductor. The distance that an individual electron can move between collisions with
atoms or other electrons is quite small. The electron paths thus appear nearly random, like the motion of
atoms in a gas. But there is an electrical field in the conductor that causes the electrons to drift in the direction
shown (opposite to the field, since they are negative). The drift velocity is the average velocity of the free
charges. Drift velocity is quite small, since there are so many free charges. If we have an estimate of the density
of free electrons in a conductor, we can calculate the drift velocity for a given current. The larger the density,
the lower the velocity required for a given current.
380 9 • Current and Resistance

Figure 9.8 Free electrons moving in a conductor make many collisions with other electrons and other particles. A typical path of one
electron is shown. The average velocity of the free charges is called the drift velocity and for electrons, it is in the direction opposite to
the electrical field. The collisions normally transfer energy to the conductor, requiring a constant supply of energy to maintain a steady
current.

Free-electron collisions transfer energy to the atoms of the conductor. The electrical field does work in moving
the electrons through a distance, but that work does not increase the kinetic energy (nor speed) of the
electrons. The work is transferred to the conductor’s atoms, often increasing temperature. Thus, a continuous
power input is required to keep a current flowing. (An exception is superconductors, for reasons we shall
explore in a later chapter. Superconductors can have a steady current without a continual supply of energy—a
great energy savings.) For a conductor that is not a superconductor, the supply of energy can be useful, as in an
incandescent light bulb filament (Figure 9.9). The supply of energy is necessary to increase the temperature of
the tungsten filament, so that the filament glows.

Figure 9.9 The incandescent lamp is a simple design. A tungsten filament is placed in a partially evacuated glass envelope. One end of the
filament is attached to the screw base, which is made out of a conducting material. The second end of the filament is attached to a second
contact in the base of the bulb. The two contacts are separated by an insulating material. Current flows through the filament, and the
temperature of the filament becomes large enough to cause the filament to glow and produce light. However, these bulbs are not very
energy efficient, as evident from the heat coming from the bulb. In the year 2012, the United States, along with many other countries,
began to phase out incandescent lamps in favor of more energy-efficient lamps, such as light-emitting diode (LED) lamps and compact
fluorescent lamps (CFL) (credit right: modification of work by Serge Saint).

We can obtain an expression for the relationship between current and drift velocity by considering the number
of free charges in a segment of wire, as illustrated in Figure 9.10. The number of free charges per unit volume,
or the number density of free charges, is given the symbol n where . The value of n
depends on the material. The shaded segment has a volume , so that the number of free charges in the
volume is . The charge dQ in this segment is thus , where q is the amount of charge on each
carrier. (The magnitude of the charge of electrons is .) Current is charge moved per unit

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.2 • Model of Conduction in Metals 381

time; thus, if all the original charges move out of this segment in time dt, the current is

Rearranging terms gives

9.4

where is the drift velocity, n is the free charge density, A is the cross-sectional area of the wire, and I is the
current through the wire. The carriers of the current each have charge q and move with a drift velocity of
magnitude .

Figure 9.10 All the charges in the shaded volume of this wire move out in a time dt, having a drift velocity of magnitude .

Note that simple drift velocity is not the entire story. The speed of an electron is sometimes much greater than
its drift velocity. In addition, not all of the electrons in a conductor can move freely, and those that do move
might move somewhat faster or slower than the drift velocity. So what do we mean by free electrons?

Atoms in a metallic conductor are packed in the form of a lattice structure. Some electrons are far enough
away from the atomic nuclei that they do not experience the attraction of the nuclei as strongly as the inner
electrons do. These are the free electrons. They are not bound to a single atom but can instead move freely
among the atoms in a “sea” of electrons. When an electrical field is applied, these free electrons respond by
accelerating. As they move, they collide with the atoms in the lattice and with other electrons, generating
thermal energy, and the conductor gets warmer. In an insulator, the organization of the atoms and the
structure do not allow for such free electrons.

As you know, electric power is usually supplied to equipment and appliances through round wires made of a
conducting material (copper, aluminum, silver, or gold) that are stranded or solid. The diameter of the wire
determines the current-carrying capacity—the larger the diameter, the greater the current-carrying capacity.
Even though the current-carrying capacity is determined by the diameter, wire is not normally characterized
by the diameter directly. Instead, wire is commonly sold in a unit known as “gauge.” Wires are manufactured
by passing the material through circular forms called “drawing dies.” In order to make thinner wires,
manufacturers draw the wires through multiple dies of successively thinner diameter. Historically, the gauge
of the wire was related to the number of drawing processes required to manufacture the wire. For this reason,
the larger the gauge, the smaller the diameter. In the United States, the American Wire Gauge (AWG) was
developed to standardize the system. Household wiring commonly consists of 10-gauge (2.588-mm diameter)
to 14-gauge (1.628-mm diameter) wire. A device used to measure the gauge of wire is shown in Figure 9.11.
382 9 • Current and Resistance

Figure 9.11 A device for measuring the gauge of electrical wire. As you can see, higher gauge numbers indicate thinner wires. (credit:
Joseph J. Trout)

EXAMPLE 9.3

Calculating Drift Velocity in a Common Wire


Calculate the drift velocity of electrons in a copper wire with a diameter of 2.053 mm (12-gauge) carrying a
20.0-A current, given that there is one free electron per copper atom. (Household wiring often contains
12-gauge copper wire, and the maximum current allowed in such wire is usually 20.0 A.) The density of copper
is and the atomic mass of copper is 63.54 g/mol.

Strategy
We can calculate the drift velocity using the equation . The current is and
is the charge of an electron. We can calculate the area of a cross-section of the wire using
the formula , where r is one-half the diameter. The given diameter is 2.053 mm, so r is 1.0265 mm. We
are given the density of copper, , and the atomic mass of copper is . We can use
these two quantities along with Avogadro’s number, , to determine n, the number of
free electrons per cubic meter.

Solution
First, we calculate the density of free electrons in copper. There is one free electron per copper atom.
Therefore, the number of free electrons is the same as the number of copper atoms per . We can now find n
as follows:

The cross-sectional area of the wire is

Rearranging to isolate drift velocity gives

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.2 • Model of Conduction in Metals 383

Significance
The minus sign indicates that the negative charges are moving in the direction opposite to conventional
current. The small value for drift velocity (on the order of confirms that the signal moves on the
order of times faster (about than the charges that carry it.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.3


In Example 9.4, the drift velocity was calculated for a 2.053-mm diameter (12-gauge) copper wire carrying a
20-amp current. Would the drift velocity change for a 1.628-mm diameter (14-gauge) wire carrying the same
20-amp current?

Current Density
Although it is often convenient to attach a negative or positive sign to indicate the overall direction of motion of
the charges, current is a scalar quantity, . It is often necessary to discuss the details of the motion of the
charge, instead of discussing the overall motion of the charges. In such cases, it is necessary to discuss the
current density, , a vector quantity. The current density is the flow of charge through an infinitesimal area,
divided by the area. The current density must take into account the local magnitude and direction of the
charge flow, which varies from point to point. The unit of current density is ampere per meter squared, and the
direction is defined as the direction of net flow of positive charges through the area.

The relationship between the current and the current density can be seen in Figure 9.12. The differential
current flow through the area is found as

where is the angle between the area and the current density. The total current passing through area can
be found by integrating over the area,

9.5

Consider the magnitude of the current density, which is the current divided by the area:

Thus, the current density is . If q is positive, is in the same direction as the electrical field . If q is
negative, is in the opposite direction of . Either way, the direction of the current density is in the
direction of the electrical field .

Figure 9.12 The current density is defined as the current passing through an infinitesimal cross-sectional area divided by the area. The
direction of the current density is the direction of the net flow of positive charges and the magnitude is equal to the current divided by the
infinitesimal area.
384 9 • Current and Resistance

EXAMPLE 9.4

Calculating the Current Density in a Wire


The current supplied to a lamp with a 100-W light bulb is 0.87 amps. The lamp is wired using a copper wire
with diameter 2.588 mm (10-gauge). Find the magnitude of the current density.

Strategy
The current density is the current moving through an infinitesimal cross-sectional area divided by the area.
We can calculate the magnitude of the current density using . The current is given as 0.87 A. The cross-
sectional area can be calculated to be .

Solution
Calculate the current density using the given current and the area, found to be .

Significance
The current density in a conducting wire depends on the current through the conducting wire and the cross-
sectional area of the wire. For a given current, as the diameter of the wire increases, the charge density
decreases.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.4


The current density is proportional to the current and inversely proportional to the area. If the current density
in a conducting wire increases, what would happen to the drift velocity of the charges in the wire?

What is the significance of the current density? The current density is proportional to the current, and the
current is the number of charges that pass through a cross-sectional area per second. The charges move
through the conductor, accelerated by the electric force provided by the electrical field. The electrical field is
created when a voltage is applied across the conductor. In Ohm’s Law, we will use this relationship between the
current density and the electrical field to examine the relationship between the current through a conductor
and the voltage applied.

9.3 Resistivity and Resistance


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Differentiate between resistance and resistivity
• Define the term conductivity
• Describe the electrical component known as a resistor
• State the relationship between resistance of a resistor and its length, cross-sectional area, and resistivity
• State the relationship between resistivity and temperature

What drives current? We can think of various devices—such as batteries, generators, wall outlets, and so
on—that are necessary to maintain a current. All such devices create a potential difference and are referred to
as voltage sources. When a voltage source is connected to a conductor, it applies a potential difference V that
creates an electrical field. The electrical field, in turn, exerts force on free charges, causing current. The
amount of current depends not only on the magnitude of the voltage, but also on the characteristics of the
material that the current is flowing through. The material can resist the flow of the charges, and the measure of
how much a material resists the flow of charges is known as the resistivity. This resistivity is crudely analogous
to the friction between two materials that resists motion.

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.3 • Resistivity and Resistance 385

Resistivity
When a voltage is applied to a conductor, an electrical field is created, and charges in the conductor feel a
force due to the electrical field. The current density that results depends on the electrical field and the
properties of the material. This dependence can be very complex. In some materials, including metals at a
given temperature, the current density is approximately proportional to the electrical field. In these cases, the
current density can be modeled as

where is the electrical conductivity. The electrical conductivity is analogous to thermal conductivity and is a
measure of a material’s ability to conduct or transmit electricity. Conductors have a higher electrical
conductivity than insulators. Since the electrical conductivity is , the units are

Here, we define a unit named the ohm with the Greek symbol uppercase omega, . The unit is named after
Georg Simon Ohm, whom we will discuss later in this chapter. The is used to avoid confusion with the
number 0. One ohm equals one volt per amp: . The units of electrical conductivity are therefore
.

Conductivity is an intrinsic property of a material. Another intrinsic property of a material is the resistivity, or
electrical resistivity. The resistivity of a material is a measure of how strongly a material opposes the flow of
electrical current. The symbol for resistivity is the lowercase Greek letter rho, , and resistivity is the
reciprocal of electrical conductivity:

The unit of resistivity in SI units is the ohm-meter . We can define the resistivity in terms of the
electrical field and the current density,

9.6

The greater the resistivity, the larger the field needed to produce a given current density. The lower the
resistivity, the larger the current density produced by a given electrical field. Good conductors have a high
conductivity and low resistivity. Good insulators have a low conductivity and a high resistivity. Table 9.1 lists
resistivity and conductivity values for various materials.

Temperature
Conductivity, Resistivity,
Material Coefficient,

Conductors

Silver 0.0038

Copper 0.0039

Gold 0.0034

Aluminum 0.0039

Tungsten 0.0045
386 9 • Current and Resistance

Temperature
Conductivity, Resistivity,
Material Coefficient,

Iron 0.0065

Platinum 0.0039

Steel

Lead

Manganin (Cu, Mn, Ni alloy) 0.000002

Constantan (Cu, Ni alloy) 0.00003

Mercury 0.0009

Nichrome (Ni, Fe, Cr alloy) 0.0004

Semiconductors[1]

Carbon (pure) −0.0005

Carbon −0.0005

Germanium (pure) −0.048

Germanium −0.050

Silicon (pure) 2300 −0.075

Silicon −0.07

Insulators

Amber

Glass

Lucite

Mica

Quartz (fused)

Rubber (hard)

Sulfur

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.3 • Resistivity and Resistance 387

Temperature
Conductivity, Resistivity,
Material Coefficient,

TeflonTM

Wood

Table 9.1 Resistivities and Conductivities of Various Materials at 20 °C [1] Values depend strongly on amounts
and types of impurities.

The materials listed in the table are separated into categories of conductors, semiconductors, and insulators,
based on broad groupings of resistivity. Conductors have the smallest resistivity, and insulators have the
largest; semiconductors have intermediate resistivity. Conductors have varying but large, free charge
densities, whereas most charges in insulators are bound to atoms and are not free to move. Semiconductors
are intermediate, having far fewer free charges than conductors, but having properties that make the number
of free charges depend strongly on the type and amount of impurities in the semiconductor. These unique
properties of semiconductors are put to use in modern electronics, as we will explore in later chapters.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.5


Copper wires use routinely used for extension cords and house wiring for several reasons. Copper has the
highest electrical conductivity rating, and therefore the lowest resistivity rating, of all nonprecious metals. Also
important is the tensile strength, where the tensile strength is a measure of the force required to pull an object
to the point where it breaks. The tensile strength of a material is the maximum amount of tensile stress it can
take before breaking. Copper has a high tensile strength, . A third important characteristic is
ductility. Ductility is a measure of a material’s ability to be drawn into wires and a measure of the flexibility of
the material, and copper has a high ductility. Summarizing, for a conductor to be a suitable candidate for
making wire, there are at least three important characteristics: low resistivity, high tensile strength, and high
ductility. What other materials are used for wiring and what are the advantages and disadvantages?

INTERACTIVE
View this interactive simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21resistwire) to see what the effects of the cross-
sectional area, the length, and the resistivity of a wire are on the resistance of a conductor. Adjust the variables
using slide bars and see if the resistance becomes smaller or larger.

Temperature Dependence of Resistivity


Looking back at Table 9.1, you will see a column labeled “Temperature Coefficient.” The resistivity of some
materials has a strong temperature dependence. In some materials, such as copper, the resistivity increases
with increasing temperature. In fact, in most conducting metals, the resistivity increases with increasing
temperature. The increasing temperature causes increased vibrations of the atoms in the lattice structure of
the metals, which impede the motion of the electrons. In other materials, such as carbon, the resistivity
decreases with increasing temperature. In many materials, the dependence is approximately linear and can be
modeled using a linear equation:

9.7

where is the resistivity of the material at temperature T, is the temperature coefficient of the material, and
is the resistivity at , usually taken as .

Note also that the temperature coefficient is negative for the semiconductors listed in Table 9.1, meaning
388 9 • Current and Resistance

that their resistivity decreases with increasing temperature. They become better conductors at higher
temperature, because increased thermal agitation increases the number of free charges available to carry
current. This property of decreasing with temperature is also related to the type and amount of impurities
present in the semiconductors.

Resistance
We now consider the resistance of a wire or component. The resistance is a measure of how difficult it is to
pass current through a wire or component. Resistance depends on the resistivity. The resistivity is a
characteristic of the material used to fabricate a wire or other electrical component, whereas the resistance is
a characteristic of the wire or component.

To calculate the resistance, consider a section of conducting wire with cross-sectional area A, length L, and
resistivity A battery is connected across the conductor, providing a potential difference across it (Figure
9.13). The potential difference produces an electrical field that is proportional to the current density, according
to .

Figure 9.13 A potential provided by a battery is applied to a segment of a conductor with a cross-sectional area A and a length L.

The magnitude of the electrical field across the segment of the conductor is equal to the voltage divided by the
length, , and the magnitude of the current density is equal to the current divided by the cross-
sectional area, Using this information and recalling that the electrical field is proportional to the
resistivity and the current density, we can see that the voltage is proportional to the current:

Resistance
The ratio of the voltage to the current is defined as the resistance R:

9.8

The resistance of a cylindrical segment of a conductor is equal to the resistivity of the material times the
length divided by the area:

9.9

The unit of resistance is the ohm, . For a given voltage, the higher the resistance, the lower the current.

Resistors
A common component in electronic circuits is the resistor. The resistor can be used to reduce current flow or

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.3 • Resistivity and Resistance 389

provide a voltage drop. Figure 9.14 shows the symbols used for a resistor in schematic diagrams of a circuit.
Two commonly used standards for circuit diagrams are provided by the American National Standard Institute
(ANSI, pronounced “AN-see”) and the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC). Both systems are
commonly used. We use the ANSI standard in this text for its visual recognition, but we note that for larger,
more complex circuits, the IEC standard may have a cleaner presentation, making it easier to read.

Figure 9.14 Symbols for a resistor used in circuit diagrams. (a) The ANSI symbol; (b) the IEC symbol.

Material and shape dependence of resistance


A resistor can be modeled as a cylinder with a cross-sectional area A and a length L, made of a material with a
resistivity (Figure 9.15). The resistance of the resistor is .

Figure 9.15 A model of a resistor as a uniform cylinder of length L and cross-sectional area A. Its resistance to the flow of current is
analogous to the resistance posed by a pipe to fluid flow. The longer the cylinder, the greater its resistance. The larger its cross-sectional
area A, the smaller its resistance.

The most common material used to make a resistor is carbon. A carbon track is wrapped around a ceramic
core, and two copper leads are attached. A second type of resistor is the metal film resistor, which also has a
ceramic core. The track is made from a metal oxide material, which has semiconductive properties similar to
carbon. Again, copper leads are inserted into the ends of the resistor. The resistor is then painted and marked
for identification. A resistor has four colored bands, as shown in Figure 9.16.

Figure 9.16 Many resistors resemble the figure shown above. The four bands are used to identify the resistor. The first two colored bands
represent the first two digits of the resistance of the resistor. The third color is the multiplier. The fourth color represents the tolerance of
390 9 • Current and Resistance

the resistor. The resistor shown has a resistance of .

Resistances range over many orders of magnitude. Some ceramic insulators, such as those used to support
power lines, have resistances of or more. A dry person may have a hand-to-foot resistance of ,
whereas the resistance of the human heart is about . A meter-long piece of large-diameter copper wire
may have a resistance of , and superconductors have no resistance at all at low temperatures. As we
have seen, resistance is related to the shape of an object and the material of which it is composed.

EXAMPLE 9.5

Current Density, Resistance, and Electrical field for a Current-Carrying Wire


Calculate the current density, resistance, and electrical field of a 5-m length of copper wire with a diameter of
2.053 mm (12-gauge) carrying a current of .

Strategy
We can calculate the current density by first finding the cross-sectional area of the wire, which is
and the definition of current density . The resistance can be found using the length of
the wire , the area, and the resistivity of copper , where . The
resistivity and current density can be used to find the electrical field.

Solution
First, we calculate the current density:

The resistance of the wire is

Finally, we can find the electrical field:

Significance
From these results, it is not surprising that copper is used for wires for carrying current because the resistance
is quite small. Note that the current density and electrical field are independent of the length of the wire, but
the voltage depends on the length.

The resistance of an object also depends on temperature, since is directly proportional to For a cylinder,
we know , so if L and A do not change greatly with temperature, R has the same temperature
dependence as (Examination of the coefficients of linear expansion shows them to be about two orders of
magnitude less than typical temperature coefficients of resistivity, so the effect of temperature on L and A is
about two orders of magnitude less than on Thus,

9.10

is the temperature dependence of the resistance of an object, where is the original resistance (usually
taken to be and R is the resistance after a temperature change The color code gives the
resistance of the resistor at a temperature of .

Numerous thermometers are based on the effect of temperature on resistance (Figure 9.17). One of the most
common thermometers is based on the thermistor, a semiconductor crystal with a strong temperature
dependence, the resistance of which is measured to obtain its temperature. The device is small, so that it

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.3 • Resistivity and Resistance 391

quickly comes into thermal equilibrium with the part of a person it touches.

Figure 9.17 These familiar thermometers are based on the automated measurement of a thermistor’s temperature-dependent
resistance.

EXAMPLE 9.6

Calculating Resistance
Although caution must be used in applying and for temperature changes
greater than , for tungsten, the equations work reasonably well for very large temperature changes. A
tungsten filament at has a resistance of . What would the resistance be if the temperature is
increased to ?

Strategy
This is a straightforward application of , since the original resistance of the filament is given
as and the temperature change is .

Solution
The resistance of the hotter filament R is obtained by entering known values into the above equation:

Significance
Notice that the resistance changes by more than a factor of 10 as the filament warms to the high temperature
and the current through the filament depends on the resistance of the filament and the voltage applied. If the
filament is used in an incandescent light bulb, the initial current through the filament when the bulb is first
energized will be higher than the current after the filament reaches the operating temperature.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.6


A strain gauge is an electrical device to measure strain, as shown below. It consists of a flexible, insulating
backing that supports a conduction foil pattern. The resistance of the foil changes as the backing is stretched.
How does the strain gauge resistance change? Is the strain gauge affected by temperature changes?
392 9 • Current and Resistance

EXAMPLE 9.7

The Resistance of Coaxial Cable


Long cables can sometimes act like antennas, picking up electronic noise, which are signals from other
equipment and appliances. Coaxial cables are used for many applications that require this noise to be
eliminated. For example, they can be found in the home in cable TV connections or other audiovisual
connections. Coaxial cables consist of an inner conductor of radius surrounded by a second, outer
concentric conductor with radius (Figure 9.18). The space between the two is normally filled with an
insulator such as polyethylene plastic. A small amount of radial leakage current occurs between the two
conductors. Determine the resistance of a coaxial cable of length L.

Figure 9.18 Coaxial cables consist of two concentric conductors separated by insulation. They are often used in cable TV or other
audiovisual connections.

Strategy
We cannot use the equation directly. Instead, we look at concentric cylindrical shells, with thickness
dr, and integrate.

Solution
We first find an expression for dR and then integrate from to ,

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.4 • Ohm's Law 393

Significance
The resistance of a coaxial cable depends on its length, the inner and outer radii, and the resistivity of the
material separating the two conductors. Since this resistance is not infinite, a small leakage current occurs
between the two conductors. This leakage current leads to the attenuation (or weakening) of the signal being
sent through the cable.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.7


The resistance between the two conductors of a coaxial cable depends on the resistivity of the material
separating the two conductors, the length of the cable and the inner and outer radius of the two conductor. If
you are designing a coaxial cable, how does the resistance between the two conductors depend on these
variables?

INTERACTIVE
View this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21batteryresist) to see how the voltage applied and the resistance
of the material the current flows through affects the current through the material. You can visualize the
collisions of the electrons and the atoms of the material effect the temperature of the material.

9.4 Ohm's Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe Ohm’s law
• Recognize when Ohm’s law applies and when it does not

We have been discussing three electrical properties so far in this chapter: current, voltage, and resistance. It
turns out that many materials exhibit a simple relationship among the values for these properties, known as
Ohm’s law. Many other materials do not show this relationship, so despite being called Ohm’s law, it is not
considered a law of nature, like Newton’s laws or the laws of thermodynamics. But it is very useful for
calculations involving materials that do obey Ohm’s law.

Description of Ohm’s Law


The current that flows through most substances is directly proportional to the voltage V applied to it. The
German physicist Georg Simon Ohm (1787–1854) was the first to demonstrate experimentally that the current
in a metal wire is directly proportional to the voltage applied:

This important relationship is the basis for Ohm’s law. It can be viewed as a cause-and-effect relationship,
with voltage the cause and current the effect. This is an empirical law, which is to say that it is an
experimentally observed phenomenon, like friction. Such a linear relationship doesn’t always occur. Any
material, component, or device that obeys Ohm’s law, where the current through the device is proportional to
the voltage applied, is known as an ohmic material or ohmic component. Any material or component that does
not obey Ohm’s law is known as a nonohmic material or nonohmic component.
394 9 • Current and Resistance

Ohm’s Experiment
In a paper published in 1827, Georg Ohm described an experiment in which he measured voltage across and
current through various simple electrical circuits containing various lengths of wire. A similar experiment is
shown in Figure 9.19. This experiment is used to observe the current through a resistor that results from an
applied voltage. In this simple circuit, a resistor is connected in series with a battery. The voltage is measured
with a voltmeter, which must be placed across the resistor (in parallel with the resistor). The current is
measured with an ammeter, which must be in line with the resistor (in series with the resistor).

Figure 9.19 The experimental set-up used to determine if a resistor is an ohmic or nonohmic device. (a) When the battery is attached, the
current flows in the clockwise direction and the voltmeter and ammeter have positive readings. (b) When the leads of the battery are
switched, the current flows in the counterclockwise direction and the voltmeter and ammeter have negative readings.

In this updated version of Ohm’s original experiment, several measurements of the current were made for
several different voltages. When the battery was hooked up as in Figure 9.19(a), the current flowed in the
clockwise direction and the readings of the voltmeter and ammeter were positive. Does the behavior of the
current change if the current flowed in the opposite direction? To get the current to flow in the opposite
direction, the leads of the battery can be switched. When the leads of the battery were switched, the readings
of the voltmeter and ammeter readings were negative because the current flowed in the opposite direction, in
this case, counterclockwise. Results of a similar experiment are shown in Figure 9.20.

Figure 9.20 A resistor is placed in a circuit with a battery. The voltage applied varies from −10.00 V to +10.00 V, increased by 1.00-V

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.4 • Ohm's Law 395

increments. A plot shows values of the voltage versus the current typical of what a casual experimenter might find.

In this experiment, the voltage applied across the resistor varies from −10.00 to +10.00 V, by increments of
1.00 V. The current through the resistor and the voltage across the resistor are measured. A plot is made of the
voltage versus the current, and the result is approximately linear. The slope of the line is the resistance, or the
voltage divided by the current. This result is known as Ohm’s law:

9.11

where V is the voltage measured in volts across the object in question, I is the current measured through the
object in amps, and R is the resistance in units of ohms. As stated previously, any device that shows a linear
relationship between the voltage and the current is known as an ohmic device. A resistor is therefore an ohmic
device.

EXAMPLE 9.8

Measuring Resistance
A carbon resistor at room temperature is attached to a 9.00-V battery and the current measured
through the resistor is 3.00 mA. (a) What is the resistance of the resistor measured in ohms? (b) If the
temperature of the resistor is increased to by heating the resistor, what is the current through the
resistor?

Strategy
(a) The resistance can be found using Ohm’s law. Ohm’s law states that , so the resistance can be found
using .

(b) First, the resistance is temperature dependent so the new resistance after the resistor has been heated can
be found using . The current can be found using Ohm’s law in the form .

Solution

a. Using Ohm’s law and solving for the resistance yields the resistance at room temperature:

b. The resistance at can be found using where the temperature coefficient for
carbon is . .
The current through the heated resistor is

Significance
A change in temperature of resulted in a 2.00% change in current. This may not seem like a very great
change, but changing electrical characteristics can have a strong effect on the circuits. For this reason, many
electronic appliances, such as computers, contain fans to remove the heat dissipated by components in the
electric circuits.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.8


The voltage supplied to your house varies as . If a resistor is connected across this
voltage, will Ohm’s law still be valid?

INTERACTIVE
See how the equation form of Ohm’s law (https://openstax.org/l/21ohmslaw) relates to a simple circuit. Adjust
396 9 • Current and Resistance

the voltage and resistance, and see the current change according to Ohm’s law. The sizes of the symbols in the
equation change to match the circuit diagram.

Nonohmic devices do not exhibit a linear relationship between the voltage and the current. One such device is
the semiconducting circuit element known as a diode. A diode is a circuit device that allows current flow in
only one direction. A diagram of a simple circuit consisting of a battery, a diode, and a resistor is shown in
Figure 9.21. Although we do not cover the theory of the diode in this section, the diode can be tested to see if it
is an ohmic or a nonohmic device.

Figure 9.21 A diode is a semiconducting device that allows current flow only if the diode is forward biased, which means that the anode is
positive and the cathode is negative.

A plot of current versus voltage is shown in Figure 9.22. Note that the behavior of the diode is shown as current
versus voltage, whereas the resistor operation was shown as voltage versus current. A diode consists of an
anode and a cathode. When the anode is at a negative potential and the cathode is at a positive potential, as
shown in part (a), the diode is said to have reverse bias. With reverse bias, the diode has an extremely large
resistance and there is very little current flow—essentially zero current—through the diode and the resistor. As
the voltage applied to the circuit increases, the current remains essentially zero, until the voltage reaches the
breakdown voltage and the diode conducts current, as shown in Figure 9.22. When the battery and the
potential across the diode are reversed, making the anode positive and the cathode negative, the diode
conducts and current flows through the diode if the voltage is greater than 0.7 V. The resistance of the diode is
close to zero. (This is the reason for the resistor in the circuit; if it were not there, the current would become
very large.) You can see from the graph in Figure 9.22 that the voltage and the current do not have a linear
relationship. Thus, the diode is an example of a nonohmic device.

Figure 9.22 When the voltage across the diode is negative and small, there is very little current flow through the diode. As the voltage
reaches the breakdown voltage, the diode conducts. When the voltage across the diode is positive and greater than 0.7 V (the actual
voltage value depends on the diode), the diode conducts. As the voltage applied increases, the current through the diode increases, but the
voltage across the diode remains approximately 0.7 V.

Ohm’s law is commonly stated as , but originally it was stated as a microscopic view, in terms of the

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.5 • Electrical Energy and Power 397

current density, the conductivity, and the electrical field. This microscopic view suggests the proportionality
comes from the drift velocity of the free electrons in the metal that results from an applied electrical
field. As stated earlier, the current density is proportional to the applied electrical field. The reformulation of
Ohm’s law is credited to Gustav Kirchhoff, whose name we will see again in the next chapter.

9.5 Electrical Energy and Power


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Express electrical power in terms of the voltage and the current
• Describe the power dissipated by a resistor in an electric circuit
• Calculate the energy efficiency and cost effectiveness of appliances and equipment

In an electric circuit, electrical energy is continuously converted into other forms of energy. For example, when
a current flows in a conductor, electrical energy is converted into thermal energy within the conductor. The
electrical field, supplied by the voltage source, accelerates the free electrons, increasing their kinetic energy
for a short time. This increased kinetic energy is converted into thermal energy through collisions with the
ions of the lattice structure of the conductor. In Work and Kinetic Energy, we defined power as the rate at which
work is done by a force measured in watts. Power can also be defined as the rate at which energy is transferred.
In this section, we discuss the time rate of energy transfer, or power, in an electric circuit.

Power in Electric Circuits


Power is associated by many people with electricity. Power transmission lines might come to mind. We also
think of light bulbs in terms of their power ratings in watts. What is the expression for electric power?

Let us compare a 25-W bulb with a 60-W bulb (Figure 9.23(a)). The 60-W bulb glows brighter than the 25-W
bulb. Although it is not shown, a 60-W light bulb is also warmer than the 25-W bulb. The heat and light is
produced by from the conversion of electrical energy. The kinetic energy lost by the electrons in collisions is
converted into the internal energy of the conductor and radiation. How are voltage, current, and resistance
related to electric power?

Figure 9.23 (a) Pictured above are two incandescent bulbs: a 25-W bulb (left) and a 60-W bulb (right). The 60-W bulb provides a higher
intensity light than the 25-W bulb. The electrical energy supplied to the light bulbs is converted into heat and light. (b) This compact
fluorescent light (CFL) bulb puts out the same intensity of light as the 60-W bulb, but at 1/4 to 1/10 the input power. (credit a: modification
of works by “Dickbauch”/Wikimedia Commons and Greg Westfall; credit b: modification of work by “dbgg1979”/Flickr)

To calculate electric power, consider a voltage difference existing across a material (Figure 9.24). The electric
potential is higher than the electric potential at , and the voltage difference is negative . As
discussed in Electric Potential, an electrical field exists between the two potentials, which points from the
398 9 • Current and Resistance

higher potential to the lower potential. Recall that the electrical potential is defined as the potential energy per
charge, , and the charge loses potential energy moving through the potential difference.

Figure 9.24 When there is a potential difference across a conductor, an electrical field is present that points in the direction from the
higher potential to the lower potential.

If the charge is positive, the charge experiences a force due to the electrical field . This force is
necessary to keep the charge moving. This force does not act to accelerate the charge through the entire
distance because of the interactions of the charge with atoms and free electrons in the material. The
speed, and therefore the kinetic energy, of the charge do not increase during the entire trip across , and
charge passing through area has the same drift velocity as the charge that passes through area .
However, work is done on the charge, by the electrical field, which changes the potential energy. Since the
change in the electrical potential difference is negative, the electrical field is found to be

The work done on the charge is equal to the electric force times the length at which the force is applied,

The charge moves at a drift velocity so the work done on the charge results in a loss of potential energy, but
the average kinetic energy remains constant. The lost electrical potential energy appears as thermal energy in
the material. On a microscopic scale, the energy transfer is due to collisions between the charge and the
molecules of the material, which leads to an increase in temperature in the material. The loss of potential
energy results in an increase in the temperature of the material, which is dissipated as radiation. In a resistor,
it is dissipated as heat, and in a light bulb, it is dissipated as heat and light.

The power dissipated by the material as heat and light is equal to the time rate of change of the work:

With a resistor, the voltage drop across the resistor is dissipated as heat. Ohm’s law states that the voltage
across the resistor is equal to the current times the resistance, . The power dissipated by the resistor is
therefore

If a resistor is connected to a battery, the power dissipated as radiant energy by the wires and the resistor is
equal to . The power supplied from the battery is equal to current times the voltage,
.

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.5 • Electrical Energy and Power 399

Electric Power
The electric power gained or lost by any device has the form
9.12
The power dissipated by a resistor has the form

9.13

Different insights can be gained from the three different expressions for electric power. For example,
implies that the lower the resistance connected to a given voltage source, the greater the power
delivered. Furthermore, since voltage is squared in , the effect of applying a higher voltage is
perhaps greater than expected. Thus, when the voltage is doubled to a 25-W bulb, its power nearly quadruples
to about 100 W, burning it out. If the bulb’s resistance remained constant, its power would be exactly 100 W,
but at the higher temperature, its resistance is higher, too.

EXAMPLE 9.9

Calculating Power in Electric Devices


A DC winch motor is rated at 20.00 A with a voltage of 115 V. When the motor is running at its maximum
power, it can lift an object with a weight of 4900.00 N a distance of 10.00 m, in 30.00 s, at a constant speed. (a)
What is the power consumed by the motor? (b) What is the power used in lifting the object? Ignore air
resistance. (c) Assuming that the difference in the power consumed by the motor and the power used lifting the
object are dissipated as heat by the resistance of the motor, estimate the resistance of the motor?

Strategy
(a) The power consumed by the motor can be found using . (b) The power used in lifting the object at a
constant speed can be found using , where the speed is the distance divided by the time. The upward
force supplied by the motor is equal to the weight of the object because the acceleration is zero. (c) The
resistance of the motor can be found using .

Solution

a. The power consumed by the motor is equal to and the current is given as 20.00 A and the voltage
is 115.00 V:

b. The power used lifting the object is equal to where the force is equal to the weight of the object
(1960 N) and the magnitude of the velocity is ,

c. The difference in the power equals and the resistance can be found
using :

Significance
The resistance of the motor is quite small. The resistance of the motor is due to many windings of copper wire.
The power dissipated by the motor can be significant since the thermal power dissipated by the motor is
proportional to the square of the current .

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.9


400 9 • Current and Resistance

Electric motors have a reasonably high efficiency. A 100-hp motor can have an efficiency of 90% and a 1-hp
motor can have an efficiency of 80%. Why is it important to use high-performance motors?

A fuse (Figure 9.25) is a device that protects a circuit from currents that are too high. A fuse is basically a short
piece of wire between two contacts. As we have seen, when a current is running through a conductor, the
kinetic energy of the charge carriers is converted into thermal energy in the conductor. The piece of wire in the
fuse is under tension and has a low melting point. The wire is designed to heat up and break at the rated
current. The fuse is destroyed and must be replaced, but it protects the rest of the circuit. Fuses act quickly,
but there is a small time delay while the wire heats up and breaks.

Figure 9.25 A fuse consists of a piece of wire between two contacts. When a current passes through the wire that is greater than the rated
current, the wire melts, breaking the connection. Pictured is a “blown” fuse where the wire broke protecting a circuit (credit: modification of
work by “Shardayyy”/Flickr).

Circuit breakers are also rated for a maximum current, and open to protect the circuit, but can be reset. Circuit
breakers react much faster. The operation of circuit breakers is not within the scope of this chapter and will be
discussed in later chapters. Another method of protecting equipment and people is the ground fault circuit
interrupter (GFCI), which is common in bathrooms and kitchens. The GFCI outlets respond very quickly to
changes in current. These outlets open when there is a change in magnetic field produced by current-carrying
conductors, which is also beyond the scope of this chapter and is covered in a later chapter.

The Cost of Electricity


The more electric appliances you use and the longer they are left on, the higher your electric bill. This familiar
fact is based on the relationship between energy and power. You pay for the energy used. Since , we see
that

is the energy used by a device using power P for a time interval t. If power is delivered at a constant rate, then
then the energy can be found by . For example, the more light bulbs burning, the greater P used; the
longer they are on, the greater t is.

The energy unit on electric bills is the kilowatt-hour , consistent with the relationship . It is easy
to estimate the cost of operating electrical appliances if you have some idea of their power consumption rate in
watts or kilowatts, the time they are on in hours, and the cost per kilowatt-hour for your electric utility.
Kilowatt-hours, like all other specialized energy units such as food calories, can be converted into joules. You
can prove to yourself that .

The electrical energy (E) used can be reduced either by reducing the time of use or by reducing the power
consumption of that appliance or fixture. This not only reduces the cost but also results in a reduced impact on
the environment. Improvements to lighting are some of the fastest ways to reduce the electrical energy used in
a home or business. About 20% of a home’s use of energy goes to lighting, and the number for commercial
establishments is closer to 40%. Fluorescent lights are about four times more efficient than incandescent
lights—this is true for both the long tubes and the compact fluorescent lights (CFLs). (See Figure 9.23(b).) Thus,

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.5 • Electrical Energy and Power 401

a 60-W incandescent bulb can be replaced by a 15-W CFL, which has the same brightness and color. CFLs have
a bent tube inside a globe or a spiral-shaped tube, all connected to a standard screw-in base that fits standard
incandescent light sockets. (Original problems with color, flicker, shape, and high initial investment for CFLs
have been addressed in recent years.)

The heat transfer from these CFLs is less, and they last up to 10 times longer than incandescent bulbs. The
significance of an investment in such bulbs is addressed in the next example. New white LED lights (which are
clusters of small LED bulbs) are even more efficient (twice that of CFLs) and last five times longer than CFLs.

EXAMPLE 9.10

Calculating the Cost Effectiveness of LED Bulb


The typical replacement for a 100-W incandescent bulb is a 20-W LED bulb. The 20-W LED bulb can provide
the same amount of light output as the 100-W incandescent light bulb. What is the cost savings for using the
LED bulb in place of the incandescent bulb for one year, assuming $0.10 per kilowatt-hour is the average
energy rate charged by the power company? Assume that the bulb is turned on for three hours a day.

Strategy
(a) Calculate the energy used during the year for each bulb, using .

(b) Multiply the energy by the cost.

Solution

a. Calculate the power for each bulb.

b. Calculate the cost for each.

Significance
A LED bulb uses 80% less energy than the incandescent bulb, saving $8.76 over the incandescent bulb for one
year. The LED bulb can cost $20.00 and the 100-W incandescent bulb can cost $0.75, which should be
calculated into the computation. A typical lifespan of an incandescent bulb is 1200 hours and is 50,000 hours
for the LED bulb. The incandescent bulb would last 1.08 years at 3 hours a day and the LED bulb would last
45.66 years. The initial cost of the LED bulb is high, but the cost to the home owner will be $0.69 for the
incandescent bulbs versus $0.44 for the LED bulbs per year. (Note that the LED bulbs are coming down in
price.) The cost savings per year is approximately $8.50, and that is just for one bulb.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 9.10


Is the efficiency of the various light bulbs the only consideration when comparing the various light bulbs?

Changing light bulbs from incandescent bulbs to CFL or LED bulbs is a simple way to reduce energy
consumption in homes and commercial sites. CFL bulbs operate with a much different mechanism than do
incandescent lights. The mechanism is complex and beyond the scope of this chapter, but here is a very
general description of the mechanism. CFL bulbs contain argon and mercury vapor housed within a spiral-
shaped tube. The CFL bulbs use a “ballast” that increases the voltage used by the CFL bulb. The ballast produce
an electrical current, which passes through the gas mixture and excites the gas molecules. The excited gas
molecules produce ultraviolet (UV) light, which in turn stimulates the fluorescent coating on the inside of the
402 9 • Current and Resistance

tube. This coating fluoresces in the visible spectrum, emitting visible light. Traditional fluorescent tubes and
CFL bulbs had a short time delay of up to a few seconds while the mixture was being “warmed up” and the
molecules reached an excited state. It should be noted that these bulbs do contain mercury, which is
poisonous, but if the bulb is broken, the mercury is never released. Even if the bulb is broken, the mercury
tends to remain in the fluorescent coating. The amount is also quite small and the advantage of the energy
saving may outweigh the disadvantage of using mercury.

The CFL light bulbs are being replaced with LED light bulbs, where LED stands for “light-emitting diode.” The
diode was briefly discussed as a nonohmic device, made of semiconducting material, which essentially
permits current flow in one direction. LEDs are a special type of diode made of semiconducting materials
infused with impurities in combinations and concentrations that enable the extra energy from the movement
of the electrons during electrical excitation to be converted into visible light. Semiconducting devices will be
explained in greater detail in Condensed Matter Physics.

Commercial LEDs are quickly becoming the standard for commercial and residential lighting, replacing
incandescent and CFL bulbs. They are designed for the visible spectrum and are constructed from gallium
doped with arsenic and phosphorous atoms. The color emitted from an LED depends on the materials used in
the semiconductor and the current. In the early years of LED development, small LEDs found on circuit boards
were red, green, and yellow, but LED light bulbs can now be programmed to produce millions of colors of light
as well as many different hues of white light.

Comparison of Incandescent, CFL, and LED Light Bulbs


The energy savings can be significant when replacing an incandescent light bulb or a CFL light bulb with an
LED light. Light bulbs are rated by the amount of power that the bulb consumes, and the amount of light output
is measured in lumens. The lumen (lm) is the SI -derived unit of luminous flux and is a measure of the total
quantity of visible light emitted by a source. A 60-W incandescent light bulb can be replaced with a 13- to 15-W
CFL bulb or a 6- to 8-W LED bulb, all three of which have a light output of approximately 800 lm. A table of light
output for some commonly used light bulbs appears in Table 9.2.

The life spans of the three types of bulbs are significantly different. An LED bulb has a life span of 50,000
hours, whereas the CFL has a lifespan of 8000 hours and the incandescent lasts a mere 1200 hours. The LED
bulb is the most durable, easily withstanding rough treatment such as jarring and bumping. The incandescent
light bulb has little tolerance to the same treatment since the filament and glass can easily break. The CFL bulb
is also less durable than the LED bulb because of its glass construction. The amount of heat emitted is 3.4 btu/h
for the 8-W LED bulb, 85 btu/h for the 60-W incandescent bulb, and 30 btu/h for the CFL bulb. As mentioned
earlier, a major drawback of the CFL bulb is that it contains mercury, a neurotoxin, and must be disposed of as
hazardous waste. From these data, it is easy to understand why the LED light bulb is quickly becoming the
standard in lighting.

Light Output LED Light Bulbs Incandescent Light Bulbs CFL Light Bulbs
(lumens) (watts) (watts) (watts)

450 4−5 40 9−13

800 6−8 60 13−15

1100 9−13 75 18−25

1600 16−20 100 23−30

2600 25−28 150 30−55

Table 9.2 Light Output of LED, Incandescent, and CFL Light Bulbs

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.6 • Superconductors 403

Summary of Relationships
In this chapter, we have discussed relationships between voltages, current, resistance, and power. Figure 9.26
shows a summary of the relationships between these measurable quantities for ohmic devices. (Recall that
ohmic devices follow Ohm’s law .) For example, if you need to calculate the power, use the pink section,
which shows that , , and .

Figure 9.26 This circle shows a summary of the equations for the relationships between power, current, voltage, and resistance.

Which equation you use depends on what values you are given, or you measure. For example if you are given
the current and the resistance, use . Although all the possible combinations may seem overwhelming,
don’t forget that they all are combinations of just two equations, Ohm’s law and power .

9.6 Superconductors
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the phenomenon of superconductivity
• List applications of superconductivity

Touch the power supply of your laptop computer or some other device. It probably feels slightly warm. That
heat is an unwanted byproduct of the process of converting household electric power into a current that can be
used by your device. Although electric power is reasonably efficient, other losses are associated with it. As
discussed in the section on power and energy, transmission of electric power produces line losses. These
line losses exist whether the power is generated from conventional power plants (using coal, oil, or gas),
nuclear plants, solar plants, hydroelectric plants, or wind farms. These losses can be reduced, but not
eliminated, by transmitting using a higher voltage. It would be wonderful if these line losses could be
eliminated, but that would require transmission lines that have zero resistance. In a world that has a global
interest in not wasting energy, the reduction or elimination of this unwanted thermal energy would be a
significant achievement. Is this possible?

The Resistance of Mercury


In 1911, Heike Kamerlingh Onnes of Leiden University, a Dutch physicist, was looking at the temperature
dependence of the resistance of the element mercury. He cooled the sample of mercury and noticed the
familiar behavior of a linear dependence of resistance on temperature; as the temperature decreased, the
resistance decreased. Kamerlingh Onnes continued to cool the sample of mercury, using liquid helium. As the
temperature approached , the resistance abruptly went to zero (Figure 9.27). This
temperature is known as the critical temperature for mercury. The sample of mercury entered into a
phase where the resistance was absolutely zero. This phenomenon is known as superconductivity. (Note: If
you connect the leads of a three-digit ohmmeter across a conductor, the reading commonly shows up as
404 9 • Current and Resistance

. The resistance of the conductor is not actually zero, it is less than .) There are various methods
to measure very small resistances, such as the four-point method, but an ohmmeter is not an acceptable
method to use for testing resistance in superconductivity.

Figure 9.27 The resistance of a sample of mercury is zero at very low temperatures—it is a superconductor up to the temperature of
about 4.2 K. Above that critical temperature, its resistance makes a sudden jump and then increases nearly linearly with temperature.

Other Superconducting Materials


As research continued, several other materials were found to enter a superconducting phase, when the
temperature reached near absolute zero. In 1941, an alloy of niobium-nitride was found that could become
superconducting at and in 1953, vanadium-silicon was found to become
superconductive at The temperatures for the transition into superconductivity were
slowly creeping higher. Strangely, many materials that make good conductors, such as copper, silver, and gold,
do not exhibit superconductivity. Imagine the energy savings if transmission lines for electric power-
generating stations could be made to be superconducting at temperatures near room temperature! A
resistance of zero ohms means no losses and a great boost to reducing energy consumption. The problem
is that is still very cold and in the range of liquid helium temperatures. At this temperature, it is
not cost effective to transmit electrical energy because of the cooling requirements.

A large jump was seen in 1986, when a team of researchers, headed by Dr. Ching Wu Chu of Houston
University, fabricated a brittle, ceramic compound with a transition temperature of . The
ceramic material, composed of yttrium barium copper oxide (YBCO), was an insulator at room temperature.
Although this temperature still seems quite cold, it is near the boiling point of liquid nitrogen, a liquid
commonly used in refrigeration. You may have noticed refrigerated trucks traveling down the highway labeled
as “Liquid Nitrogen Cooled.”

YBCO ceramic is a material that could be useful for transmitting electrical energy because the cost saving of
reducing the losses are larger than the cost of cooling the superconducting cable, making it financially
feasible. There were and are many engineering problems to overcome. For example, unlike traditional
electrical cables, which are flexible and have a decent tensile strength, ceramics are brittle and would break
rather than stretch under pressure. Processes that are rather simple with traditional cables, such as making
connections, become difficult when working with ceramics. The problems are difficult and complex, and
material scientists and engineers are coming up with innovative solutions.

An interesting consequence of the resistance going to zero is that once a current is established in a
superconductor, it persists without an applied voltage source. Current loops in a superconductor have been set
up and the current loops have been observed to persist for years without decaying.

Zero resistance is not the only interesting phenomenon that occurs as the materials reach their transition
temperatures. A second effect is the exclusion of magnetic fields. This is known as the Meissner effect (Figure
9.28). A light, permanent magnet placed over a superconducting sample will levitate in a stable position above
the superconductor. High-speed trains have been developed that levitate on strong superconducting magnets,

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.6 • Superconductors 405

eliminating the friction normally experienced between the train and the tracks. In Japan, the Yamanashi
Maglev test line opened on April 3, 1997. In April 2015, the MLX01 test vehicle attained a speed of 374 mph
(603 km/h).

Figure 9.28 A small, strong magnet levitates over a superconductor cooled to liquid nitrogen temperature. The magnet levitates because
the superconductor excludes magnetic fields. (credit: Joseph J. Trout)

Table 9.3 shows a select list of elements, compounds, and high-temperature superconductors, along with the
critical temperatures for which they become superconducting. Each section is sorted from the highest critical
temperature to the lowest. Also listed is the critical magnetic field for some of the materials. This is the
strength of the magnetic field that destroys superconductivity. Finally, the type of the superconductor is listed.

There are two types of superconductors. There are 30 pure metals that exhibit zero resistivity below their
critical temperature and exhibit the Meissner effect, the property of excluding magnetic fields from the
interior of the superconductor while the superconductor is at a temperature below the critical temperature.
These metals are called Type I superconductors. The superconductivity exists only below their critical
temperatures and below a critical magnetic field strength. Type I superconductors are well described by the
BCS theory (described next). Type I superconductors have limited practical applications because the strength
of the critical magnetic field needed to destroy the superconductivity is quite low.

Type II superconductors are found to have much higher critical magnetic fields and therefore can carry much
higher current densities while remaining in the superconducting state. A collection of various ceramics
containing barium-copper-oxide have much higher critical temperatures for the transition into a
superconducting state. Superconducting materials that belong to this subcategory of the Type II
superconductors are often categorized as high-temperature superconductors.

Introduction to BCS Theory


Type I superconductors, along with some Type II superconductors can be modeled using the BCS theory,
proposed by John Bardeen, Leon Cooper, and Robert Schrieffer. Although the theory is beyond the scope of
this chapter, a short summary of the theory is provided here. (More detail is provided in Condensed Matter
Physics.) The theory considers pairs of electrons and how they are coupled together through lattice-vibration
interactions. Through the interactions with the crystalline lattice, electrons near the Fermi energy level feel a
small attractive force and form pairs (Cooper pairs), and the coupling is known as a phonon interaction. Single
electrons are fermions, which are particles that obey the Pauli exclusion principle. The Pauli exclusion
principle in quantum mechanics states that two identical fermions (particles with half-integer spin) cannot
occupy the same quantum state simultaneously. Each electron has four quantum numbers . The
principal quantum number (n) describes the energy of the electron, the orbital angular momentum quantum
number (l) indicates the most probable distance from the nucleus, the magnetic quantum number
describes the energy levels in the subshell, and the electron spin quantum number describes the
orientation of the spin of the electron, either up or down. As the material enters a superconducting state, pairs
of electrons act more like bosons, which can condense into the same energy level and need not obey the Pauli
exclusion principle. The electron pairs have a slightly lower energy and leave an energy gap above them on the
order of 0.001 eV. This energy gap inhibits collision interactions that lead to ordinary resistivity. When the
material is below the critical temperature, the thermal energy is less than the band gap and the material
406 9 • Current and Resistance

exhibits zero resistivity.

Critical
Critical Temperature
Material Symbol or Formula Magnetic Field Type
Tc (K)
Hc (T)

Elements

Lead Pb 7.19 0.08 I

Lanthanum La ( ) 4.90 − ( ) 6.30 I

Tantalum Ta 4.48 0.09 I

Mercury Hg ( ) 4.15 − ( ) 3.95 0.04 I

Tin Sn 3.72 0.03 I

Indium In 3.40 0.03 I

Thallium Tl 2.39 0.03 I

Rhenium Re 2.40 0.03 I

Thorium Th 1.37 0.013 I

Protactinium Pa 1.40 I

Aluminum Al 1.20 0.01 I

Gallium Ga 1.10 0.005 I

Zinc Zn 0.86 0.014 I

Titanium Ti 0.39 0.01 I

Uranium U ( ) 0.68 − ( ) 1.80 I

Cadmium Cd 11.4 4.00 I

Compounds

Niobium-germanium Nb3Ge 23.20 37.00 II

Niobium-tin Nb3Sn 18.30 30.00 II

Niobium-nitrite NbN 16.00 II

Niobium-titanium NbTi 10.00 15.00 II

High-Temperature Oxides

Access for free at openstax.org.


9.6 • Superconductors 407

Critical
Critical Temperature
Material Symbol or Formula Magnetic Field Type
Tc (K)
Hc (T)

HgBa2CaCu2O8 134.00 II

Tl2Ba2Ca2Cu3O10 125.00 II

YBa2Cu3O7 92.00 120.00 II

Table 9.3 Superconductor Critical Temperatures

Applications of Superconductors
Superconductors can be used to make superconducting magnets. These magnets are 10 times stronger than
the strongest electromagnets. These magnets are currently in use in magnetic resonance imaging (MRI), which
produces high-quality images of the body interior without dangerous radiation.

Another interesting application of superconductivity is the SQUID (superconducting quantum interference


device). A SQUID is a very sensitive magnetometer used to measure extremely subtle magnetic fields. The
operation of the SQUID is based on superconducting loops containing Josephson junctions. A Josephson
junction is the result of a theoretical prediction made by B. D. Josephson in an article published in 1962. In the
article, Josephson described how a supercurrent can flow between two pieces of superconductor separated by
a thin layer of insulator. This phenomenon is now called the Josephson effect. The SQUID consists of a
superconducting current loop containing two Josephson junctions, as shown in Figure 9.29. When the loop is
placed in even a very weak magnetic field, there is an interference effect that depends on the strength of the
magnetic field.

Figure 9.29 The SQUID (superconducting quantum interference device) uses a superconducting current loop and two Josephson
junctions to detect magnetic fields as low as (Earth’s magnet field is on the order of ).

Superconductivity is a fascinating and useful phenomenon. At critical temperatures near the boiling point of
liquid nitrogen, superconductivity has special applications in MRIs, particle accelerators, and high-speed
trains. Will we reach a state where we can have materials enter the superconducting phase at near room
temperatures? It seems a long way off, but if scientists in 1911 were asked if we would reach liquid-nitrogen
temperatures with a ceramic, they might have thought it implausible.
408 9 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
ampere (amp) SI unit for current; fields are expelled
circuit complete path that an electrical current nonohmic type of a material for which Ohm’s law is
travels along not valid
conventional current current that flows through a ohm unit of electrical resistance,
circuit from the positive terminal of a battery
through the circuit to the negative terminal of the Ohm’s law empirical relation stating that the
battery current I is proportional to the potential
critical temperature temperature at which a difference V; it is often written as , where
material reaches superconductivity R is the resistance
current density flow of charge through a cross- ohmic type of a material for which Ohm’s law is
sectional area divided by the area valid, that is, the voltage drop across the device is
diode nonohmic circuit device that allows current equal to the current times the resistance
flow in only one direction resistance electric property that impedes current;
drift velocity velocity of a charge as it moves for ohmic materials, it is the ratio of voltage to
nearly randomly through a conductor, current,
experiencing multiple collisions, averaged over a resistivity intrinsic property of a material,
length of a conductor, whose magnitude is the independent of its shape or size, directly
length of conductor traveled divided by the time it proportional to the resistance, denoted by
takes for the charges to travel the length schematic graphical representation of a circuit
electrical conductivity measure of a material’s using standardized symbols for components and
ability to conduct or transmit electricity solid lines for the wire connecting the
electrical current rate at which charge flows, components
SQUID (Superconducting Quantum Interference
electrical power time rate of change of energy in Device) device that is a very sensitive
an electric circuit magnetometer, used to measure extremely subtle
Josephson junction junction of two pieces of magnetic fields
superconducting material separated by a thin superconductivity phenomenon that occurs in
layer of insulating material, which can carry a some materials where the resistance goes to
supercurrent exactly zero and all magnetic fields are expelled,
Meissner effect phenomenon that occurs in a which occurs dramatically at some low critical
superconducting material where all magnetic temperature

Key Equations

Average electrical current

Definition of an ampere

Electrical current

Drift velocity

Current density

Resistivity

Access for free at openstax.org.


9 • Chapter Review 409

Common expression of Ohm’s law

Resistivity as a function of temperature

Definition of resistance

Resistance of a cylinder of material

Temperature dependence of resistance

Electric power

Power dissipated by a resistor

Summary
9.1 Electrical Current • The current density is a vector quantity defined
as the current through an infinitesimal area
• The average electrical current is the rate at
divided by the area.
which charge flows, given by , where • The current can be found from the current
is the amount of charge passing through an
density, .
area in time .
• The instantaneous electrical current, or simply
the current I, is the rate at which charge flows. • An incandescent light bulb is a filament of wire
Taking the limit as the change in time enclosed in a glass bulb that is partially
evacuated. Current runs through the filament,
approaches zero, we have , where is
where the electrical energy is converted to light
the time derivative of the charge.
and heat.
• The direction of conventional current is taken as
the direction in which positive charge moves. In 9.3 Resistivity and Resistance
a simple direct-current (DC) circuit, this will be
• Resistance has units of ohms , related to
from the positive terminal of the battery to the
volts and amperes by .
negative terminal.
• The resistance R of a cylinder of length L and
• The SI unit for current is the ampere, or simply
the amp (A), where . cross-sectional area A is , where is the
• Current consists of the flow of free charges, such resistivity of the material.
as electrons, protons, and ions. • Values of in Table 9.1 show that materials fall
into three groups—conductors, semiconductors,
9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals and insulators.
• The current through a conductor depends • Temperature affects resistivity; for relatively
mainly on the motion of free electrons. small temperature changes , resistivity is
• When an electrical field is applied to a , where is the original
conductor, the free electrons in a conductor do resistivity and is the temperature coefficient of
not move through a conductor at a constant resistivity.
speed and direction; instead, the motion is • The resistance R of an object also varies with
almost random due to collisions with atoms and temperature: , where is
other free electrons. the original resistance, and R is the resistance
• Even though the electrons move in a nearly after the temperature change.
random fashion, when an electrical field is 9.4 Ohm's Law
applied to the conductor, the overall velocity of
the electrons can be defined in terms of a drift • Ohm’s law is an empirical relationship for
velocity. current, voltage, and resistance for some
410 9 • Chapter Review

common types of circuit elements, including


be found by .
resistors. It does not apply to other devices, such
as diodes.
9.6 Superconductors
• One statement of Ohm’s law gives the
relationship among current I, voltage V, and • Superconductivity is a phenomenon that occurs
resistance R in a simple circuit as . in some materials when cooled to very low
• Another statement of Ohm’s law, on a critical temperatures, resulting in a resistance
microscopic level, is . of exactly zero and the expulsion of all magnetic
fields.
9.5 Electrical Energy and Power
• Materials that are normally good conductors
• Electric power is the rate at which electric (such as copper, gold, and silver) do not
energy is supplied to a circuit or consumed by a experience superconductivity.
load. • Superconductivity was first observed in
• Power dissipated by a resistor depends on the mercury by Heike Kamerlingh Onnes in 1911. In
square of the current through the resistor and is 1986, Dr. Ching Wu Chu of Houston University
equal to . fabricated a brittle, ceramic compound with a
critical temperature close to the temperature of
• The SI unit for electric power is the watt and the
liquid nitrogen.
SI unit for electric energy is the joule. Another
• Superconductivity can be used in the
common unit for electric energy, used by power
manufacture of superconducting magnets for
companies, is the kilowatt-hour (kW h).
use in MRIs and high-speed, levitated trains.
• The total energy used over a time interval can

Conceptual Questions
9.1 Electrical Current through pipes and the pipes connect components
in the circuit. Is a conceptual model of water
1. Can a wire carry a current and still be
flowing through a pipe an adequate
neutral—that is, have a total charge of zero?
representation of the circuit? How are electrons
Explain.
and wires similar to water molecules and pipes?
2. Car batteries are rated in ampere-hours .
How are they different?
To what physical quantity do ampere-hours
7. An incandescent light bulb is partially evacuated.
correspond (voltage, current, charge, energy,
Why do you suppose that is?
power,…)?
3. When working with high-power electric circuits,
9.3 Resistivity and Resistance
it is advised that whenever possible, you work
“one-handed” or “keep one hand in your pocket.” 8. The IR drop across a resistor means that there is
Why is this a sensible suggestion? a change in potential or voltage across the
resistor. Is there any change in current as it
9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals passes through a resistor? Explain.
9. Do impurities in semiconducting materials listed
4. Incandescent light bulbs are being replaced with
in Table 9.1 supply free charges? (Hint: Examine
more efficient LED and CFL light bulbs. Is there
the range of resistivity for each and determine
any obvious evidence that incandescent light
whether the pure semiconductor has the higher
bulbs might not be that energy efficient? Is
or lower conductivity.)
energy converted into anything but visible light?
10. Does the resistance of an object depend on the path
5. It was stated that the motion of an electron
current takes through it? Consider, for example, a
appears nearly random when an electrical field is
rectangular bar—is its resistance the same along its
applied to the conductor. What makes the motion
length as across its width?
nearly random and differentiates it from the
random motion of molecules in a gas?
6. Electric circuits are sometimes explained using a
conceptual model of water flowing through a
pipe. In this conceptual model, the voltage source
is represented as a pump that pumps water

Access for free at openstax.org.


9 • Chapter Review 411

the temperature of the material increases


significantly?

9.5 Electrical Energy and Power


15. Common household appliances are rated at 110
V, but power companies deliver voltage in the
kilovolt range and then step the voltage down
11. If aluminum and copper wires of the same
using transformers to 110 V to be used in
length have the same resistance, which has the
homes. You will learn in later chapters that
larger diameter? Why?
transformers consist of many turns of wire,
which warm up as current flows through them,
9.4 Ohm's Law wasting some of the energy that is given off as
12. In Determining Field from Potential, resistance heat. This sounds inefficient. Why do the power
was defined as . In this section, we companies transport electric power using this
presented Ohm’s law, which is commonly method?
expressed as . The equations look 16. Your electric bill gives your consumption in
exactly alike. What is the difference between units of kilowatt-hour (kW h). Does this unit
Ohm’s law and the definition of resistance? represent the amount of charge, current,
13. Shown below are the results of an experiment voltage, power, or energy you buy?
where four devices were connected across a 17. Resistors are commonly rated at , , ,
variable voltage source. The voltage is increased 1 W and 2 W for use in electrical circuits. If a
and the current is measured. Which device, if current of is accidentally passed
any, is an ohmic device? through a resistor rated at 1 W,
what would be the most probable outcome? Is
there anything that can be done to prevent such
an accident?
18. An immersion heater is a small appliance used
to heat a cup of water for tea by passing current
through a resistor. If the voltage applied to the
appliance is doubled, will the time required to
heat the water change? By how much? Is this a
good idea?

9.6 Superconductors
14. The current I is measured through a sample of 19. What requirement for superconductivity makes
an ohmic material as a voltage V is applied. (a) current superconducting devices expensive to
What is the current when the voltage is doubled operate?
to 2V (assume the change in temperature of the 20. Name two applications for superconductivity
material is negligible)? (b) What is the voltage listed in this section and explain how
applied is the current measured is 0.2I (assume superconductivity is used in the application.
the change in temperature of the material is Can you think of a use for superconductivity
negligible)? What will happen to the current if that is not listed?
the material if the voltage remains constant, but

Problems
9.1 Electrical Current sparks. One application of the Van de Graaff
generator is to create X-rays by bombarding a
21. A Van de Graaff generator is one of the original
hard metal target with the beam. Consider a
particle accelerators and can be used to
beam of protons at 1.00 keV and a current of
accelerate charged particles like protons or
5.00 mA produced by the generator. (a) What is
electrons. You may have seen it used to make
the speed of the protons? (b) How many protons
human hair stand on end or produce large
412 9 • Chapter Review

are produced each second? of 1.00 mm. What is the magnitude of the
22. A cathode ray tube (CRT) is a device that current density of the beam?
produces a focused beam of electrons in a 30. A high-energy proton accelerator produces a
vacuum. The electrons strike a phosphor- proton beam with a radius of . The
coated glass screen at the end of the tube, which beam current is and is constant.
produces a bright spot of light. The position of The charge density of the beam is
the bright spot of light on the screen can be protons per cubic meter. (a)
adjusted by deflecting the electrons with What is the current density of the beam? (b)
electrical fields, magnetic fields, or both. What is the drift velocity of the beam? (c) How
Although the CRT tube was once commonly much time does it take for protons
found in televisions, computer displays, and to be emitted by the accelerator?
oscilloscopes, newer appliances use a liquid 31. Consider a wire of a circular cross-section with
crystal display (LCD) or plasma screen. You still a radius of . The magnitude of the
may come across a CRT in your study of science. current density is modeled as
Consider a CRT with an electron beam average . What is the
current of . How many electrons strike
current through the inner section of the wire
the screen every minute?
from the center to ?
23. How many electrons flow through a point in a
32. A cylindrical wire has a current density from
wire in 3.00 s if there is a constant current of
the center of the wire’s cross section as
?
where is in meters, is in amps
24. A conductor carries a current that is decreasing
exponentially with time. The current is modeled per square meter, and . This
as , where is the current current density continues to the end of the wire
at time and is the time at a radius of 1.0 mm. Calculate the current just
constant. How much charge flows through the outside of this wire.
conductor between and ? 33. The current supplied to an air conditioner unit
25. The quantity of charge through a conductor is is 4.00 amps. The air conditioner is wired using
a 10-gauge (diameter 2.588 mm) wire. The
modeled as .
charge density is . Find
What is the current at time ?
26. The current through a conductor is modeled as the magnitude of (a) current density and (b) the
. Write an equation drift velocity.
for the charge as a function of time.
27. The charge on a capacitor in a circuit is 9.3 Resistivity and Resistance
modeled as . What is 34. What current flows through the bulb of a 3.00-V
the current through the circuit as a function of flashlight when its hot resistance is ?
time? 35. Calculate the effective resistance of a pocket
calculator that has a 1.35-V battery and through
9.2 Model of Conduction in Metals which 0.200 mA flows.
28. An aluminum wire 1.628 mm in diameter 36. How many volts are supplied to operate an
(14-gauge) carries a current of 3.00 amps. (a) indicator light on a DVD player that has a
What is the absolute value of the charge density resistance of , given that 25.0 mA passes
in the wire? (b) What is the drift velocity of the through it?
electrons? (c) What would be the drift velocity if 37. What is the resistance of a 20.0-m-long piece of
the same gauge copper were used instead of 12-gauge copper wire having a 2.053-mm
diameter?
aluminum? The density of copper is
38. The diameter of 0-gauge copper wire is 8.252
and the density of aluminum is . The
mm. Find the resistance of a 1.00-km length of
molar mass of aluminum is 26.98 g/mol and the
such wire used for power transmission.
molar mass of copper is 63.5 g/mol. Assume
39. If the 0.100-mm-diameter tungsten filament in
each atom of metal contributes one free
a light bulb is to have a resistance of at
electron.
, how long should it be?
29. The current of an electron beam has a
40. A lead rod has a length of 30.00 cm and a
measured current of with a radius
resistance of . What is the radius of the

Access for free at openstax.org.


9 • Chapter Review 413

rod? A. What is the resistance of the resistor?


41. Find the ratio of the diameter of aluminum to 53. A resistor is placed in a circuit with an
copper wire, if they have the same resistance adjustable voltage source. The voltage across
per unit length (as they might in household and the current through the resistor and the
wiring). measurements are shown below. Estimate the
42. What current flows through a 2.54-cm-diameter resistance of the resistor.
rod of pure silicon that is 20.0 cm long, when
is applied to it? (Such a rod may
be used to make nuclear-particle detectors, for
example.)
43. (a) To what temperature must you raise a
copper wire, originally at , to double its
resistance, neglecting any changes in
dimensions? (b) Does this happen in household
wiring under ordinary circumstances?
44. A resistor made of nichrome wire is used in an
application where its resistance cannot change
more than 1.00% from its value at . Over
54. The following table show the measurements of a
what temperature range can it be used?
current through and the voltage across a sample
45. Of what material is a resistor made if its
of material. Plot the data, and assuming the
resistance is 40.0% greater at than at
object is an ohmic device, estimate the
?
resistance.
46. An electronic device designed to operate at any
temperature in the range from to I(A) V(V)
contains pure carbon resistors. By what
factor does their resistance increase over this 0 3
range?
47. (a) Of what material is a wire made, if it is 25.0 2 23
m long with a diameter of 0.100 mm and has a
resistance of at ? (b) What is its 4 39
resistance at
48. Assuming a constant temperature coefficient of 6 58
resistivity, what is the maximum percent
decrease in the resistance of a constantan wire 8 77
starting at ?
49. A copper wire has a resistance of at 10 100
and an iron wire has a resistance of
at the same temperature. At what 12 119
temperature are their resistances equal?
14 142
9.4 Ohm's Law
16 162
50. A resistor is connected across a D cell
battery (1.5 V). What is the current through the
resistor?
51. A resistor rated at is connected across
two D cell batteries (each 1.50 V) in series, with 9.5 Electrical Energy and Power
a total voltage of 3.00 V. The manufacturer 55. A battery is used to supply current to a
advertises that their resistors are within 5% of resistor. Assume the voltage drop across
the rated value. What are the possible minimum any wires used for connections is negligible. (a)
current and maximum current through the What is the current through the resistor? (b)
resistor? What is the power dissipated by the resistor? (c)
52. A resistor is connected in series with a power What is the power input from the battery,
supply of 20.00 V. The current measure is 0.50
414 9 • Chapter Review

assuming all the electrical power is dissipated company delivered the electric power at 110
by the resistor? (d) What happens to the energy kV?
dissipated by the resistor? 62. A 0.50-W, resistor carries the maximum
56. What is the maximum voltage that can be current possible without damaging the resistor.
applied to a resistor rated at ? If the current were reduced to half the value,
57. A heater is being designed that uses a coil of what would be the power consumed?
14-gauge nichrome wire to generate 300 W
using a voltage of . How long should 9.6 Superconductors
the engineer make the wire? 63. Consider a power plant is located 60 km away
58. An alternative to CFL bulbs and incandescent from a residential area uses 0-gauge
bulbs are light-emitting diode (LED) bulbs. A
wire of copper to transmit
100-W incandescent bulb can be replaced by a
power at a current of . How much
16-W LED bulb. Both produce 1600 lumens of
more power is dissipated in the copper wires
light. Assuming the cost of electricity is $0.10
than it would be in superconducting wires?
per kilowatt-hour, how much does it cost to run
64. A wire is drawn through a die, stretching it to
the bulb for one year if it runs for four hours a
four times its original length. By what factor
day?
does its resistance increase?
59. The power dissipated by a resistor with a
65. Digital medical thermometers determine
resistance of is . What are
temperature by measuring the resistance of a
the current through and the voltage drop across
semiconductor device called a thermistor
the resistor?
(which has ) when it is at the same
60. Running late to catch a plane, a driver
temperature as the patient. What is a patient’s
accidentally leaves the headlights on after
temperature if the thermistor’s resistance at
parking the car in the airport parking lot.
that temperature is 82.0% of its value at
During takeoff, the driver realizes the mistake.
(normal body temperature)?
Having just replaced the battery, the driver
66. Electrical power generators are sometimes
knows that the battery is a 12-V automobile
“load tested” by passing current through a large
battery, rated at 100 . The driver, knowing
vat of water. A similar method can be used to
there is nothing that can be done, estimates how
test the heat output of a resistor. A
long the lights will shine, assuming there are
resistor is connected to a 9.0-V battery and the
two 12-V headlights, each rated at 40 W. What
resistor leads are waterproofed and the resistor
did the driver conclude?
is placed in 1.0 kg of room temperature water
61. A physics student has a single-occupancy dorm
. Current runs through the resistor
room. The student has a small refrigerator that
for 20 minutes. Assuming all the electrical
runs with a current of 3.00 A and a voltage of
energy dissipated by the resistor is converted to
110 V, a lamp that contains a 100-W bulb, an
heat, what is the final temperature of the water?
overhead light with a 60-W bulb, and various
67. A 12-gauge gold wire has a length of 1 meter. (a)
other small devices adding up to 3.00 W. (a)
What would be the length of a silver 12-gauge
Assuming the power plant that supplies 110 V
wire with the same resistance? (b) What are
electricity to the dorm is 10 km away and the
their respective resistances at the temperature
two aluminum transmission cables use 0-gauge
of boiling water?
wire with a diameter of 8.252 mm, estimate the
68. What is the change in temperature required to
percentage of the total power supplied by the
decrease the resistance for a carbon resistor by
power company that is lost in the transmission.
10%?
(b) What would be the result is the power

Access for free at openstax.org.


9 • Chapter Review 415

Additional Problems
69. A coaxial cable consists of an inner conductor 75. What is the resistivity of a wire of 5-gauge wire
with radius and an outer radius of ), 5.00 m length, and
and has a length of 10 meters. resistance?
Plastic, with a resistivity of 76. Coils are often used in electrical and electronic
, separates the two circuits. Consider a coil which is formed by
conductors. What is the resistance of the cable? winding 1000 turns of insulated 20-gauge
70. A 10.00-meter long wire cable that is made of copper wire (area in a single layer on
copper has a resistance of 0.051 ohms. (a) What a cylindrical non-conducting core of radius 2.0
is the weight if the wire was made of copper? (b) mm. What is the resistance of the coil? Neglect
What is the weight of a 10.00-meter-long wire of the thickness of the insulation.
the same gauge made of aluminum? (c)What is 77. Currents of approximately 0.06 A can be
the resistance of the aluminum wire? The potentially fatal. Currents in that range can
density of copper is and the density make the heart fibrillate (beat in an
of aluminum is . uncontrolled manner). The resistance of a dry
71. A nichrome rod that is 3.00 mm long with a human body can be approximately . (a)
cross-sectional area of is used for a What voltage can cause 0.06 A through a dry
digital thermometer. (a) What is the resistance human body? (b) When a human body is wet,
at room temperature? (b) What is the resistance the resistance can fall to . What voltage
at body temperature? can cause harm to a wet body?
72. The temperature in Philadelphia, PA can vary 78. A 20.00-ohm, 5.00-watt resistor is placed in
between and in one summer series with a power supply. (a) What is the
day. By what percentage will an aluminum maximum voltage that can be applied to the
wire’s resistance change during the day? resistor without harming the resistor? (b) What
73. When 100.0 V is applied across a 5-gauge would be the current through the resistor?
(diameter 4.621 mm) wire that is 10 m long, the 79. A battery with an emf of 24.00 V delivers a
magnitude of the current density is constant current of 2.00 mA to an appliance.
. What is the resistivity of the How much work does the battery do in three
wire? minutes?
74. A wire with a resistance of is drawn out 80. A 12.00-V battery has an internal resistance of a
through a die so that its new length is twice tenth of an ohm. (a) What is the current if the
times its original length. Find the resistance of battery terminals are momentarily shorted
the longer wire. You may assume that the together? (b) What is the terminal voltage if the
resistivity and density of the material are battery delivers 0.25 amps to a circuit?
unchanged.

Challenge Problems
81. A 10-gauge copper wire has a cross-sectional 83. A particle accelerator produces a beam with a
area and carries a current of radius of 1.25 mm with a current of 2.00 mA.
. The density of copper is Each proton has a kinetic energy of 10.00 MeV.
. One mole of copper atoms (a) What is the velocity of the protons? (b) What
has a mass of is the number (n) of protons per unit volume?
approximately 63.50 g. What is the magnitude (b) How many electrons pass a cross sectional
of the drift velocity of the electrons, assuming area each second?
that each copper atom contributes one free
electron to the current?
82. The current through a 12-gauge wire is given as
. What is the
current density at time 15.00 ms?
416 9 • Chapter Review

84. In this chapter, most examples and problems 88. The charge that flows through a point in a wire
involved direct current (DC). DC circuits have as a function of time is modeled as
the current flowing in one direction, from . (a) What is the
positive to negative. When the current was initial current through the wire at time
changing, it was changed linearly from ? (b) Find the current at time .
to and the voltage (c) At what time t will the current be reduced by
changed linearly from to one-half ?
, where . Suppose a
89. Consider a resistor made from a hollow cylinder
voltage source is placed in series with a resistor
of carbon as shown below. The inner radius of
of that supplied a current that
the cylinder is and the outer
alternated as a sine wave, for example,
radius is . The length of the
. (a) What would a
resistor is . The resistivity of the
graph of the voltage drop across the resistor V(t) carbon is . (a) Prove that
versus time look like? (b) What would a plot of the resistance perpendicular from the axis is
V(t) versus I(t) for one period look like? (Hint: If
(b) What is the resistance?
you are not sure, try plotting V(t) versus I(t)
using a spreadsheet.)
85. A current of is drawn from a 100-V
battery for 30 seconds. By how much is the
chemical energy reduced?
86. Consider a square rod of material with sides of
length with a current density of

as shown below. Find the current that passes


through the face of the rod.
90. What is the current through a cylindrical wire of
radius if the current density is
, where
91. A student uses a 100.00-W, 115.00-V radiant
heater to heat the student’s dorm room, during
the hours between sunset and sunrise, 6:00
p.m. to 7:00 a.m. (a) What current does the
heater operate at? (b) How many electrons move
through the heater? (c) What is the resistance of
the heater? (d) How much heat was added to the
dorm room?
92. A 12-V car battery is used to power a 20.00-W,
12.00-V lamp during the physics club camping
trip/star party. The cable to the lamp is 2.00
meters long, 14-gauge copper wire with a
charge density of . (a)
What is the current draw by the lamp? (b) How
87. A resistor of an unknown resistance is placed in long would it take an electron to get from the
an insulated container filled with 0.75 kg of battery to the lamp?
water. A voltage source is connected in series
with the resistor and a current of 1.2 amps flows
through the resistor for 10 minutes. During this
time, the temperature of the water is measured
and the temperature change during this time is
. (a) What is the resistance of the
resistor? (b) What is the voltage supplied by the
power supply?

Access for free at openstax.org.


9 • Chapter Review 417

93. A physics student uses a 115.00-V immersion


heater to heat 400.00 grams (almost two cups)
of water for herbal tea. During the two minutes
it takes the water to heat, the physics student
becomes bored and decides to figure out the
resistance of the heater. The student starts with
the assumption that the water is initially at the
temperature of the room and
reaches . The specific heat of
the water is . What is the
resistance of the heater?
418 9 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 10
Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.1 This circuit shown is used to amplify small signals and power the earbud speakers attached to a
cellular phone. This circuit’s components include resistors, capacitors, and diodes, all of which have been covered in
previous chapters, as well as transistors, which are semi-conducting devices covered in Condensed Matter Physics.
Circuits using similar components are found in all types of equipment and appliances you encounter in everyday life,
such as alarm clocks, televisions, computers, and refrigerators.

Chapter Outline

10.1 Electromotive Force

10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel

10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules

10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments

10.5 RC Circuits

10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical Safety

INTRODUCTION In the preceding few chapters, we discussed electric components, including capacitors,
resistors, and diodes. In this chapter, we use these electric components in circuits. A circuit is a collection of
electrical components connected to accomplish a specific task. Figure 10.1 shows an amplifier circuit, which
420 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

takes a small-amplitude signal and amplifies it to power the speakers in earbuds. Although the circuit looks
complex, it actually consists of a set of series, parallel, and series-parallel circuits. The second section of this
chapter covers the analysis of series and parallel circuits that consist of resistors. Later in this chapter, we
introduce the basic equations and techniques to analyze any circuit, including those that are not reducible
through simplifying parallel and series elements. But first, we need to understand how to power a circuit.

10.1 Electromotive Force


Learning Objectives
By the end of the section, you will be able to:
• Describe the electromotive force (emf) and the internal resistance of a battery
• Explain the basic operation of a battery

If you forget to turn off your car lights, they slowly dim as the battery runs down. Why don’t they suddenly blink
off when the battery’s energy is gone? Their gradual dimming implies that the battery output voltage decreases
as the battery is depleted. The reason for the decrease in output voltage for depleted batteries is that all voltage
sources have two fundamental parts—a source of electrical energy and an internal resistance. In this section,
we examine the energy source and the internal resistance.

Introduction to Electromotive Force


Voltage has many sources, a few of which are shown in Figure 10.2. All such devices create a potential
difference and can supply current if connected to a circuit. A special type of potential difference is known as
electromotive force (emf). The emf is not a force at all, but the term ‘electromotive force’ is used for historical
reasons. It was coined by Alessandro Volta in the 1800s, when he invented the first battery, also known as the
voltaic pile. Because the electromotive force is not a force, it is common to refer to these sources simply as
sources of emf (pronounced as the letters “ee-em-eff”), instead of sources of electromotive force.

Figure 10.2 A variety of voltage sources. (a) The Brazos Wind Farm in Fluvanna, Texas; (b) the Krasnoyarsk Dam in Russia; (c) a solar

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.1 • Electromotive Force 421

farm; (d) a group of nickel metal hydride batteries. The voltage output of each device depends on its construction and load. The voltage
output equals emf only if there is no load. (credit a: modification of work by Stig Nygaard; credit b: modification of work by
"vadimpl"/Wikimedia Commons; credit c: modification of work by "The tdog"/Wikimedia Commons; credit d: modification of work by
"Itrados"/Wikimedia Commons)

If the electromotive force is not a force at all, then what is the emf and what is a source of emf? To answer these
questions, consider a simple circuit of a 12-V lamp attached to a 12-V battery, as shown in Figure 10.3. The
battery can be modeled as a two-terminal device that keeps one terminal at a higher electric potential than the
second terminal. The higher electric potential is sometimes called the positive terminal and is labeled with a
plus sign. The lower-potential terminal is sometimes called the negative terminal and labeled with a minus
sign. This is the source of the emf.

Figure 10.3 A source of emf maintains one terminal at a higher electric potential than the other terminal, acting as a source of current in a
circuit.

When the emf source is not connected to the lamp, there is no net flow of charge within the emf source. Once
the battery is connected to the lamp, charges flow from one terminal of the battery, through the lamp (causing
the lamp to light), and back to the other terminal of the battery. If we consider positive (conventional) current
flow, positive charges leave the positive terminal, travel through the lamp, and enter the negative terminal.

Positive current flow is useful for most of the circuit analysis in this chapter, but in metallic wires and resistors,
electrons contribute the most to current, flowing in the opposite direction of positive current flow. Therefore, it
is more realistic to consider the movement of electrons for the analysis of the circuit in Figure 10.3. The
electrons leave the negative terminal, travel through the lamp, and return to the positive terminal. In order for
the emf source to maintain the potential difference between the two terminals, negative charges (electrons)
must be moved from the positive terminal to the negative terminal. The emf source acts as a charge pump,
moving negative charges from the positive terminal to the negative terminal to maintain the potential
difference. This increases the potential energy of the charges and, therefore, the electric potential of the
charges.

The force on the negative charge from the electric field is in the opposite direction of the electric field, as
shown in Figure 10.3. In order for the negative charges to be moved to the negative terminal, work must be
done on the negative charges. This requires energy, which comes from chemical reactions in the battery. The
potential is kept high on the positive terminal and low on the negative terminal to maintain the potential
difference between the two terminals. The emf is equal to the work done on the charge per unit charge
when there is no current flowing. Since the unit for work is the joule and the unit for charge is the
coulomb, the unit for emf is the volt

The terminal voltage of a battery is voltage measured across the terminals of the battery. An ideal
battery is an emf source that maintains a constant terminal voltage, independent of the current between the
two terminals. An ideal battery has no internal resistance, and the terminal voltage is equal to the emf of the
battery. In the next section, we will show that a real battery does have internal resistance and the terminal
voltage is always less than the emf of the battery.
422 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

The Origin of Battery Potential


The combination of chemicals and the makeup of the terminals in a battery determine its emf. The lead acid
battery used in cars and other vehicles is one of the most common combinations of chemicals. Figure 10.4
shows a single cell (one of six) of this battery. The cathode (positive) terminal of the cell is connected to a lead
oxide plate, whereas the anode (negative) terminal is connected to a lead plate. Both plates are immersed in
sulfuric acid, the electrolyte for the system.

Figure 10.4 Chemical reactions in a lead-acid cell separate charge, sending negative charge to the anode, which is connected to the lead
plates. The lead oxide plates are connected to the positive or cathode terminal of the cell. Sulfuric acid conducts the charge, as well as
participates in the chemical reaction.

Knowing a little about how the chemicals in a lead-acid battery interact helps in understanding the potential
created by the battery. Figure 10.5 shows the result of a single chemical reaction. Two electrons are placed on
the anode, making it negative, provided that the cathode supplies two electrons. This leaves the cathode
positively charged, because it has lost two electrons. In short, a separation of charge has been driven by a
chemical reaction.

Note that the reaction does not take place unless there is a complete circuit to allow two electrons to be
supplied to the cathode. Under many circumstances, these electrons come from the anode, flow through a
resistance, and return to the cathode. Note also that since the chemical reactions involve substances with
resistance, it is not possible to create the emf without an internal resistance.

Figure 10.5 In a lead-acid battery, two electrons are forced onto the anode of a cell, and two electrons are removed from the cathode of
the cell. The chemical reaction in a lead-acid battery places two electrons on the anode and removes two from the cathode. It requires a

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.1 • Electromotive Force 423

closed circuit to proceed, since the two electrons must be supplied to the cathode.

Internal Resistance and Terminal Voltage


The amount of resistance to the flow of current within the voltage source is called the internal resistance. The
internal resistance r of a battery can behave in complex ways. It generally increases as a battery is depleted,
due to the oxidation of the plates or the reduction of the acidity of the electrolyte. However, internal resistance
may also depend on the magnitude and direction of the current through a voltage source, its temperature, and
even its history. The internal resistance of rechargeable nickel-cadmium cells, for example, depends on how
many times and how deeply they have been depleted. A simple model for a battery consists of an idealized emf
source and an internal resistance r (Figure 10.6).

Figure 10.6 A battery can be modeled as an idealized emf with an internal resistance (r). The terminal voltage of the battery is
.

Suppose an external resistor, known as the load resistance R, is connected to a voltage source such as a battery,
as in Figure 10.7. The figure shows a model of a battery with an emf , an internal resistance r, and a load
resistor R connected across its terminals. Using conventional current flow, positive charges leave the positive
terminal of the battery, travel through the resistor, and return to the negative terminal of the battery. The
terminal voltage of the battery depends on the emf, the internal resistance, and the current, and is equal to

10.1

For a given emf and internal resistance, the terminal voltage decreases as the current increases due to the
potential drop Ir of the internal resistance.
424 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.7 Schematic of a voltage source and its load resistor R. Since the internal resistance r is in series with the load, it can
significantly affect the terminal voltage and the current delivered to the load.

A graph of the potential difference across each element the circuit is shown in Figure 10.8. A current I runs
through the circuit, and the potential drop across the internal resistor is equal to Ir. The terminal voltage is
equal to , which is equal to the potential drop across the load resistor . As with potential
energy, it is the change in voltage that is important. When the term “voltage” is used, we assume that it is
actually the change in the potential, or . However, is often omitted for convenience.

Figure 10.8 A graph of the voltage through the circuit of a battery and a load resistance. The electric potential increases the emf of the
battery due to the chemical reactions doing work on the charges. There is a decrease in the electric potential in the battery due to the
internal resistance. The potential decreases due to the internal resistance , making the terminal voltage of the battery equal to
. The voltage then decreases by (IR). The current is equal to

The current through the load resistor is . We see from this expression that the smaller the internal
resistance r, the greater the current the voltage source supplies to its load R. As batteries are depleted, r
increases. If r becomes a significant fraction of the load resistance, then the current is significantly reduced, as
the following example illustrates.

EXAMPLE 10.1

Analyzing a Circuit with a Battery and a Load


A given battery has a 12.00-V emf and an internal resistance of . (a) Calculate its terminal voltage when
connected to a load. (b) What is the terminal voltage when connected to a load? (c) What
power does the load dissipate? (d) If the internal resistance grows to , find the current,
terminal voltage, and power dissipated by a load.

Strategy
The analysis above gave an expression for current when internal resistance is taken into account. Once the

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.1 • Electromotive Force 425

current is found, the terminal voltage can be calculated by using the equation . Once current
is found, we can also find the power dissipated by the resistor.

Solution

a. Entering the given values for the emf, load resistance, and internal resistance into the expression above
yields

Enter the known values into the equation to get the terminal voltage:

The terminal voltage here is only slightly lower than the emf, implying that the current drawn by this light
load is not significant.
b. Similarly, with , the current is

The terminal voltage is no

The terminal voltage exhibits a more significant reduction compared with emf, implying is a
heavy load for this battery. A “heavy load” signifies a larger draw of current from the source but not a
larger resistance.
c. The power dissipated by the load can be found using the formula . Entering the known
values gives

Note that this power can also be obtained using the expression , where V is the terminal voltage
(10.0 V in this case).
d. Here, the internal resistance has increased, perhaps due to the depletion of the battery, to the point where
it is as great as the load resistance. As before, we first find the current by entering the known values into
the expression, yielding

Now the terminal voltage is

and the power dissipated by the load is

We see that the increased internal resistance has significantly decreased the terminal voltage, current,
and power delivered to a load.

Significance
The internal resistance of a battery can increase for many reasons. For example, the internal resistance of a
rechargeable battery increases as the number of times the battery is recharged increases. The increased
internal resistance may have two effects on the battery. First, the terminal voltage will decrease. Second, the
battery may overheat due to the increased power dissipated by the internal resistance.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.1


If you place a wire directly across the two terminal of a battery, effectively shorting out the terminals, the
battery will begin to get hot. Why do you suppose this happens?
426 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Battery Testers
Battery testers, such as those in Figure 10.9, use small load resistors to intentionally draw current to
determine whether the terminal potential drops below an acceptable level. Although it is difficult to measure
the internal resistance of a battery, battery testers can provide a measurement of the internal resistance of the
battery. If internal resistance is high, the battery is weak, as evidenced by its low terminal voltage.

Figure 10.9 Battery testers measure terminal voltage under a load to determine the condition of a battery. (a) A US Navy electronics
technician uses a battery tester to test large batteries aboard the aircraft carrier USS Nimitz. The battery tester she uses has a small
resistance that can dissipate large amounts of power. (b) The small device shown is used on small batteries and has a digital display to
indicate the acceptability of the terminal voltage. (credit a: modification of work by Jason A. Johnston; credit b: modification of work by
Keith Williamson)

Some batteries can be recharged by passing a current through them in the direction opposite to the current
they supply to an appliance. This is done routinely in cars and in batteries for small electrical appliances and
electronic devices (Figure 10.10). The voltage output of the battery charger must be greater than the emf of the
battery to reverse the current through it. This causes the terminal voltage of the battery to be greater than the
emf, since and I is now negative.

Figure 10.10 A car battery charger reverses the normal direction of current through a battery, reversing its chemical reaction and
replenishing its chemical potential.

It is important to understand the consequences of the internal resistance of emf sources, such as batteries and
solar cells, but often, the analysis of circuits is done with the terminal voltage of the battery, as we have done in
the previous sections. The terminal voltage is referred to as simply as V, dropping the subscript “terminal.”
This is because the internal resistance of the battery is difficult to measure directly and can change over time.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 427

10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define the term equivalent resistance
• Calculate the equivalent resistance of resistors connected in series
• Calculate the equivalent resistance of resistors connected in parallel

In Current and Resistance, we described the term ‘resistance’ and explained the basic design of a resistor.
Basically, a resistor limits the flow of charge in a circuit and is an ohmic device where Most circuits
have more than one resistor. If several resistors are connected together and connected to a battery, the current
supplied by the battery depends on the equivalent resistance of the circuit.

The equivalent resistance of a combination of resistors depends on both their individual values and how they
are connected. The simplest combinations of resistors are series and parallel connections (Figure 10.11). In a
series circuit, the output current of the first resistor flows into the input of the second resistor; therefore, the
current is the same in each resistor. In a parallel circuit, all of the resistor leads on one side of the resistors are
connected together and all the leads on the other side are connected together. In the case of a parallel
configuration, each resistor has the same potential drop across it, and the currents through each resistor may
be different, depending on the resistor. The sum of the individual currents equals the current that flows into
the parallel connections.

Figure 10.11 (a) For a series connection of resistors, the current is the same in each resistor. (b) For a parallel connection of resistors, the
voltage is the same across each resistor.

Resistors in Series
Resistors are said to be in series whenever the current flows through the resistors sequentially. Consider
Figure 10.12, which shows three resistors in series with an applied voltage equal to Since there is only one
path for the charges to flow through, the current is the same through each resistor. The equivalent resistance
of a set of resistors in a series connection is equal to the algebraic sum of the individual resistances.
428 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.12 (a) Three resistors connected in series to a voltage source. (b) The original circuit is reduced to an equivalent resistance and
a voltage source.

In Figure 10.12, the current coming from the voltage source flows through each resistor, so the current through
each resistor is the same. The current through the circuit depends on the voltage supplied by the voltage
source and the resistance of the resistors. For each resistor, a potential drop occurs that is equal to the loss of
electric potential energy as a current travels through each resistor. According to Ohm’s law, the potential drop
V across a resistor when a current flows through it is calculated using the equation where I is the
current in amps (A) and R is the resistance in ohms Since energy is conserved, and the voltage is equal to
the potential energy per charge, the sum of the voltage applied to the circuit by the source and the potential
drops across the individual resistors around a loop should be equal to zero:

This equation is often referred to as Kirchhoff’s loop law, which we will look at in more detail later in this
chapter. For Figure 10.12, the sum of the potential drop of each resistor and the voltage supplied by the voltage
source should equal zero:

Since the current through each component is the same, the equality can be simplified to an equivalent
resistance, which is just the sum of the resistances of the individual resistors.

Any number of resistors can be connected in series. If N resistors are connected in series, the equivalent
resistance is

10.2

One result of components connected in a series circuit is that if something happens to one component, it
affects all the other components. For example, if several lamps are connected in series and one bulb burns out,
all the other lamps go dark.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 429

EXAMPLE 10.2

Equivalent Resistance, Current, and Power in a Series Circuit


A battery with a terminal voltage of 9 V is connected to a circuit consisting of four and one resistors
all in series (Figure 10.13). Assume the battery has negligible internal resistance. (a) Calculate the equivalent
resistance of the circuit. (b) Calculate the current through each resistor. (c) Calculate the potential drop across
each resistor. (d) Determine the total power dissipated by the resistors and the power supplied by the battery.

Figure 10.13 A simple series circuit with five resistors.

Strategy
In a series circuit, the equivalent resistance is the algebraic sum of the resistances. The current through the
circuit can be found from Ohm’s law and is equal to the voltage divided by the equivalent resistance. The
potential drop across each resistor can be found using Ohm’s law. The power dissipated by each resistor can be
found using , and the total power dissipated by the resistors is equal to the sum of the power
dissipated by each resistor. The power supplied by the battery can be found using .

Solution

a. The equivalent resistance is the algebraic sum of the resistances:

b. The current through the circuit is the same for each resistor in a series circuit and is equal to the applied
voltage divided by the equivalent resistance:

c. The potential drop across each resistor can be found using Ohm’s law:

Note that the sum of the potential drops across each resistor is equal to the voltage supplied by the battery.
d. The power dissipated by a resistor is equal to , and the power supplied by the battery is equal to
:

Significance
There are several reasons why we would use multiple resistors instead of just one resistor with a resistance
equal to the equivalent resistance of the circuit. Perhaps a resistor of the required size is not available, or we
need to dissipate the heat generated, or we want to minimize the cost of resistors. Each resistor may cost a few
cents to a few dollars, but when multiplied by thousands of units, the cost saving may be appreciable.
430 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.2


Some strings of miniature holiday lights are made to short out when a bulb burns out. The device that causes
the short is called a shunt, which allows current to flow around the open circuit. A “short” is like putting a
piece of wire across the component. The bulbs are usually grouped in series of nine bulbs. If too many bulbs
burn out, the shunts eventually open. What causes this?

Let’s briefly summarize the major features of resistors in series:

1. Series resistances add together to get the equivalent resistance:

2. The same current flows through each resistor in series.


3. Individual resistors in series do not get the total source voltage, but divide it. The total potential drop across a
series configuration of resistors is equal to the sum of the potential drops across each resistor.

Resistors in Parallel
Figure 10.14 shows resistors in parallel, wired to a voltage source. Resistors are in parallel when one end of all
the resistors are connected by a continuous wire of negligible resistance and the other end of all the resistors
are also connected to one another through a continuous wire of negligible resistance. The potential drop
across each resistor is the same. Current through each resistor can be found using Ohm’s law where
the voltage is constant across each resistor. For example, an automobile’s headlights, radio, and other systems
are wired in parallel, so that each subsystem utilizes the full voltage of the source and can operate completely
independently. The same is true of the wiring in your house or any building.

Figure 10.14 (a) Two resistors connected in parallel to a voltage source. (b) The original circuit is reduced to an equivalent resistance and
a voltage source.

The current flowing from the voltage source in Figure 10.14 depends on the voltage supplied by the voltage
source and the equivalent resistance of the circuit. In this case, the current flows from the voltage source and
enters a junction, or node, where the circuit splits flowing through resistors and . As the charges flow
from the battery, some go through resistor and some flow through resistor The sum of the currents
flowing into a junction must be equal to the sum of the currents flowing out of the junction:

This equation is referred to as Kirchhoff’s junction rule and will be discussed in detail in the next section. In
Figure 10.14, the junction rule gives . There are two loops in this circuit, which leads to the
equations and . Note the voltage across the resistors in parallel are the same
and the current is additive:

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 431

Generalizing to any number of N resistors, the equivalent resistance of a parallel connection is related to
the individual resistances by

10.3

This relationship results in an equivalent resistance that is less than the smallest of the individual
resistances. When resistors are connected in parallel, more current flows from the source than would flow for
any of them individually, so the total resistance is lower.

EXAMPLE 10.3

Analysis of a Parallel Circuit


Three resistors and are connected in parallel. The parallel
connection is attached to a voltage source. (a) What is the equivalent resistance? (b) Find the
current supplied by the source to the parallel circuit. (c) Calculate the currents in each resistor and show that
these add together to equal the current output of the source. (d) Calculate the power dissipated by each
resistor. (e) Find the power output of the source and show that it equals the total power dissipated by the
resistors.

Strategy

(a) The total resistance for a parallel combination of resistors is found using .

(Note that in these calculations, each intermediate answer is shown with an extra digit.)

(b) The current supplied by the source can be found from Ohm’s law, substituting for the total resistance

(c) The individual currents are easily calculated from Ohm’s law , since each resistor gets the full

voltage. The total current is the sum of the individual currents:

(d) The power dissipated by each resistor can be found using any of the equations relating power to current,
voltage, and resistance, since all three are known. Let us use since each resistor gets full voltage.

(e) The total power can also be calculated in several ways, use .

Solution

a. The total resistance for a parallel combination of resistors is found using Equation 10.3. Entering known
values gives
432 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

The total resistance with the correct number of significant digits is As predicted, is less
than the smallest individual resistance.
b. The total current can be found from Ohm’s law, substituting for the total resistance. This gives

Current I for each device is much larger than for the same devices connected in series (see the previous
example). A circuit with parallel connections has a smaller total resistance than the resistors connected in
series.
c. The individual currents are easily calculated from Ohm’s law, since each resistor gets the full voltage.
Thus,

Similarly,

and

The total current is the sum of the individual currents:

d. The power dissipated by each resistor can be found using any of the equations relating power to current,
voltage, and resistance, since all three are known. Let us use since each resistor gets full
voltage. Thus,

Similarly,

and

e. The total power can also be calculated in several ways. Choosing and entering the total current
yields

Significance
Total power dissipated by the resistors is also 18.00 W:

Notice that the total power dissipated by the resistors equals the power supplied by the source.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.3


Consider the same potential difference applied to the same three resistors connected in series.
Would the equivalent resistance of the series circuit be higher, lower, or equal to the three resistor in parallel?
Would the current through the series circuit be higher, lower, or equal to the current provided by the same
voltage applied to the parallel circuit? How would the power dissipated by the resistor in series compare to the
power dissipated by the resistors in parallel?

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 433

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.4


How would you use a river and two waterfalls to model a parallel configuration of two resistors? How does this
analogy break down?

Let us summarize the major features of resistors in parallel:

1. Equivalent resistance is found from

and is smaller than any individual resistance in the combination.


2. The potential drop across each resistor in parallel is the same.
3. Parallel resistors do not each get the total current; they divide it. The current entering a parallel combination
of resistors is equal to the sum of the current through each resistor in parallel.

In this chapter, we introduced the equivalent resistance of resistors connect in series and resistors connected
in parallel. You may recall that in Capacitance, we introduced the equivalent capacitance of capacitors
connected in series and parallel. Circuits often contain both capacitors and resistors. Table 10.1 summarizes
the equations used for the equivalent resistance and equivalent capacitance for series and parallel
connections.

Series combination Parallel combination

Equivalent capacitance

Equivalent resistance

Table 10.1 Summary for Equivalent Resistance and Capacitance in Series and Parallel Combinations

Combinations of Series and Parallel


More complex connections of resistors are often just combinations of series and parallel connections. Such
combinations are common, especially when wire resistance is considered. In that case, wire resistance is in
series with other resistances that are in parallel.

Combinations of series and parallel can be reduced to a single equivalent resistance using the technique
illustrated in Figure 10.15. Various parts can be identified as either series or parallel connections, reduced to
their equivalent resistances, and then further reduced until a single equivalent resistance is left. The process
is more time consuming than difficult. Here, we note the equivalent resistance as
434 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.15 (a) The original circuit of four resistors. (b) Step 1: The resistors and are in series and the equivalent resistance is
(c) Step 2: The reduced circuit shows resistors and are in parallel, with an equivalent resistance of (d)
Step 3: The reduced circuit shows that and are in series with an equivalent resistance of which is the equivalent
resistance (e) The reduced circuit with a voltage source of with an equivalent resistance of This results in a
current of from the voltage source.

Notice that resistors and are in series. They can be combined into a single equivalent resistance. One
method of keeping track of the process is to include the resistors as subscripts. Here the equivalent resistance
of and is

The circuit now reduces to three resistors, shown in Figure 10.15(c). Redrawing, we now see that resistors
and constitute a parallel circuit. Those two resistors can be reduced to an equivalent resistance:

This step of the process reduces the circuit to two resistors, shown in in Figure 10.15(d). Here, the circuit
reduces to two resistors, which in this case are in series. These two resistors can be reduced to an equivalent
resistance, which is the equivalent resistance of the circuit:

The main goal of this circuit analysis is reached, and the circuit is now reduced to a single resistor and single

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 435

voltage source.

Now we can analyze the circuit. The current provided by the voltage source is This
current runs through resistor and is designated as The potential drop across can be found using
Ohm’s law:

Looking at Figure 10.15(c), this leaves to be dropped across the parallel combination of
and The current through can be found using Ohm’s law:

The resistors and are in series so the currents and are equal to

Using Ohm’s law, we can find the potential drop across the last two resistors. The potential drops are
and The final analysis is to look at the power supplied by the voltage
source and the power dissipated by the resistors. The power dissipated by the resistors is

The total energy is constant in any process. Therefore, the power supplied by the voltage source is
Analyzing the power supplied to the circuit and the power dissipated by the
resistors is a good check for the validity of the analysis; they should be equal.

EXAMPLE 10.4

Combining Series and Parallel Circuits


Figure 10.16 shows resistors wired in a combination of series and parallel. We can consider to be the
resistance of wires leading to and (a) Find the equivalent resistance of the circuit. (b) What is the
potential drop across resistor ? (c) Find the current through resistor . (d) What power is dissipated
by ?

Figure 10.16 These three resistors are connected to a voltage source so that and are in parallel with one another and that
combination is in series with
436 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Strategy
(a) To find the equivalent resistance, first find the equivalent resistance of the parallel connection of and
Then use this result to find the equivalent resistance of the series connection with

(b) The current through can be found using Ohm’s law and the voltage applied. The current through is
equal to the current from the battery. The potential drop across the resistor (which represents the
resistance in the connecting wires) can be found using Ohm’s law.

(c) The current through can be found using Ohm’s law The voltage across can be found using

(d) Using Ohm’s law , the power dissipated by the resistor can also be found

using .

Solution

a. To find the equivalent resistance of the circuit, notice that the parallel connection of and is in series
with , so the equivalent resistance is

The total resistance of this combination is intermediate between the pure series and pure parallel values (
and , respectively).
b. The current through is equal to the current supplied by the battery:

The voltage across is

The voltage applied to and is less than the voltage supplied by the battery by an amount When
wire resistance is large, it can significantly affect the operation of the devices represented by and .
c. To find the current through , we must first find the voltage applied to it. The voltage across the two
resistors in parallel is the same:

Now we can find the current through resistance using Ohm’s law:

The current is less than the 2.00 A that flowed through when it was connected in parallel to the battery
in the previous parallel circuit example.
d. The power dissipated by is given by

Significance
The analysis of complex circuits can often be simplified by reducing the circuit to a voltage source and an
equivalent resistance. Even if the entire circuit cannot be reduced to a single voltage source and a single
equivalent resistance, portions of the circuit may be reduced, greatly simplifying the analysis.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.5


Consider the electrical circuits in your home. Give at least two examples of circuits that must use a
combination of series and parallel circuits to operate efficiently.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.2 • Resistors in Series and Parallel 437

Practical Implications
One implication of this last example is that resistance in wires reduces the current and power delivered to a
resistor. If wire resistance is relatively large, as in a worn (or a very long) extension cord, then this loss can be
significant. If a large current is drawn, the IR drop in the wires can also be significant and may become
apparent from the heat generated in the cord.

For example, when you are rummaging in the refrigerator and the motor comes on, the refrigerator light dims
momentarily. Similarly, you can see the passenger compartment light dim when you start the engine of your
car (although this may be due to resistance inside the battery itself).

What is happening in these high-current situations is illustrated in Figure 10.17. The device represented by
has a very low resistance, so when it is switched on, a large current flows. This increased current causes a
larger IR drop in the wires represented by , reducing the voltage across the light bulb (which is ), which
then dims noticeably.

Figure 10.17 Why do lights dim when a large appliance is switched on? The answer is that the large current the appliance motor draws
causes a significant IR drop in the wires and reduces the voltage across the light.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Series and Parallel Resistors


1. Draw a clear circuit diagram, labeling all resistors and voltage sources. This step includes a list of the
known values for the problem, since they are labeled in your circuit diagram.
2. Identify exactly what needs to be determined in the problem (identify the unknowns). A written list is
useful.
3. Determine whether resistors are in series, parallel, or a combination of both series and parallel. Examine
the circuit diagram to make this assessment. Resistors are in series if the same current must pass
sequentially through them.
4. Use the appropriate list of major features for series or parallel connections to solve for the unknowns.
There is one list for series and another for parallel.
438 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

5. Check to see whether the answers are reasonable and consistent.

EXAMPLE 10.5

Combining Series and Parallel Circuits


Two resistors connected in series are connected to two resistors that are connected in parallel
. The series-parallel combination is connected to a battery. Each resistor has a resistance of 10.00
Ohms. The wires connecting the resistors and battery have negligible resistance. A current of 2.00 Amps runs
through resistor What is the voltage supplied by the voltage source?

Strategy
Use the steps in the preceding problem-solving strategy to find the solution for this example.

Solution

1. Draw a clear circuit diagram (Figure 10.18).

Figure 10.18 To find the unknown voltage, we must first find the equivalent resistance of the circuit.

2. The unknown is the voltage of the battery. In order to find the voltage supplied by the battery, the
equivalent resistance must be found.
3. In this circuit, we already know that the resistors and are in series and the resistors and are
in parallel. The equivalent resistance of the parallel configuration of the resistors and is in series
with the series configuration of resistors and .
4. The voltage supplied by the battery can be found by multiplying the current from the battery and the
equivalent resistance of the circuit. The current from the battery is equal to the current through and is
equal to 2.00 A. We need to find the equivalent resistance by reducing the circuit. To reduce the circuit,
first consider the two resistors in parallel. The equivalent resistance is
This parallel combination is in series with the other two resistors,
so the equivalent resistance of the circuit is The voltage supplied by the
battery is therefore
5. One way to check the consistency of your results is to calculate the power supplied by the battery and the
power dissipated by the resistors. The power supplied by the battery is
Since they are in series, the current through equals the current through Since , the
current through each will be 1.00 Amps. The power dissipated by the resistors is equal to the sum of the
power dissipated by each resistor:

Since the power dissipated by the resistors equals the power supplied by the battery, our solution seems
consistent.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 439

Significance
If a problem has a combination of series and parallel, as in this example, it can be reduced in steps by using
the preceding problem-solving strategy and by considering individual groups of series or parallel connections.
When finding for a parallel connection, the reciprocal must be taken with care. In addition, units and
numerical results must be reasonable. Equivalent series resistance should be greater, whereas equivalent
parallel resistance should be smaller, for example. Power should be greater for the same devices in parallel
compared with series, and so on.

10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• State Kirchhoff’s junction rule
• State Kirchhoff’s loop rule
• Analyze complex circuits using Kirchhoff’s rules

We have just seen that some circuits may be analyzed by reducing a circuit to a single voltage source and an
equivalent resistance. Many complex circuits cannot be analyzed with the series-parallel techniques
developed in the preceding sections. In this section, we elaborate on the use of Kirchhoff’s rules to analyze
more complex circuits. For example, the circuit in Figure 10.19 is known as a multi-loop circuit, which
consists of junctions. A junction, also known as a node, is a connection of three or more wires. In this circuit,
the previous methods cannot be used, because not all the resistors are in clear series or parallel configurations
that can be reduced. Give it a try. The resistors and are in series and can be reduced to an equivalent
resistance. The same is true of resistors and . But what do you do then?

Even though this circuit cannot be analyzed using the methods already learned, two circuit analysis rules can
be used to analyze any circuit, simple or complex. The rules are known as Kirchhoff’s rules, after their
inventor Gustav Kirchhoff (1824–1887).

Figure 10.19 This circuit cannot be reduced to a combination of series and parallel connections. However, we can use Kirchhoff’s rules to
analyze it.

Kirchhoff’s Rules
• Kirchhoff’s first rule—the junction rule. The sum of all currents entering a junction must equal the sum
of all currents leaving the junction:
10.4

• Kirchhoff’s second rule—the loop rule. The algebraic sum of changes in potential around any closed
circuit path (loop) must be zero:
10.5
440 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

We now provide explanations of these two rules, followed by problem-solving hints for applying them and a
worked example that uses them.

Kirchhoff’s First Rule


Kirchhoff’s first rule (the junction rule) applies to the charge entering and leaving a junction (Figure 10.20). As
stated earlier, a junction, or node, is a connection of three or more wires. Current is the flow of charge, and
charge is conserved; thus, whatever charge flows into the junction must flow out.

Figure 10.20 Charge must be conserved, so the sum of currents into a junction must be equal to the sum of currents out of the junction.

Although it is an over-simplification, an analogy can be made with water pipes connected in a plumbing
junction. If the wires in Figure 10.20 were replaced by water pipes, and the water was assumed to be
incompressible, the volume of water flowing into the junction must equal the volume of water flowing out of
the junction.

Kirchhoff’s Second Rule


Kirchhoff’s second rule (the loop rule) applies to potential differences. The loop rule is stated in terms of
potential V rather than potential energy, but the two are related since In a closed loop, whatever
energy is supplied by a voltage source, the energy must be transferred into other forms by the devices in the
loop, since there are no other ways in which energy can be transferred into or out of the circuit. Kirchhoff’s
loop rule states that the algebraic sum of potential differences, including voltage supplied by the voltage
sources and resistive elements, in any loop must be equal to zero. For example, consider a simple loop with no
junctions, as in Figure 10.21.

Figure 10.21 A simple loop with no junctions. Kirchhoff’s loop rule states that the algebraic sum of the voltage differences is equal to
zero.

The circuit consists of a voltage source and three external load resistors. The labels a, b, c, and d serve as
references, and have no other significance. The usefulness of these labels will become apparent soon. The loop
is designated as Loop abcda, and the labels help keep track of the voltage differences as we travel around the
circuit. Start at point a and travel to point b. The voltage of the voltage source is added to the equation and the
potential drop of the resistor is subtracted. From point b to c, the potential drop across is subtracted.
From c to d, the potential drop across is subtracted. From points d to a, nothing is done because there are
no components.

Figure 10.22 shows a graph of the voltage as we travel around the loop. Voltage increases as we cross the

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 441

battery, whereas voltage decreases as we travel across a resistor. The potential drop, or change in the electric
potential, is equal to the current through the resistor times the resistance of the resistor. Since the wires have
negligible resistance, the voltage remains constant as we cross the wires connecting the components.

Figure 10.22 A voltage graph as we travel around the circuit. The voltage increases as we cross the battery and decreases as we cross
each resistor. Since the resistance of the wire is quite small, we assume that the voltage remains constant as we cross the wires connecting
the components.

Then Kirchhoff’s loop rule states

The loop equation can be used to find the current through the loop:

This loop could have been analyzed using the previous methods, but we will demonstrate the power of
Kirchhoff’s method in the next section.

Applying Kirchhoff’s Rules


By applying Kirchhoff’s rules, we generate a set of linear equations that allow us to find the unknown values in
circuits. These may be currents, voltages, or resistances. Each time a rule is applied, it produces an equation. If
there are as many independent equations as unknowns, then the problem can be solved.

Using Kirchhoff’s method of analysis requires several steps, as listed in the following procedure.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Kirchhoff’s Rules
1. Label points in the circuit diagram using lowercase letters a, b, c, …. These labels simply help with
orientation.
2. Locate the junctions in the circuit. The junctions are points where three or more wires connect. Label each
junction with the currents and directions into and out of it. Make sure at least one current points into the
junction and at least one current points out of the junction.
3. Choose the loops in the circuit. Every component must be contained in at least one loop, but a component
may be contained in more than one loop.
4. Apply the junction rule. Again, some junctions should not be included in the analysis. You need only use
enough nodes to include every current.
5. Apply the loop rule. Use the map in Figure 10.23.
442 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.23 Each of these resistors and voltage sources is traversed from a to b. (a) When moving across a resistor in the same direction
as the current flow, subtract the potential drop. (b) When moving across a resistor in the opposite direction as the current flow, add the
potential drop. (c) When moving across a voltage source from the negative terminal to the positive terminal, add the potential drop. (d)
When moving across a voltage source from the positive terminal to the negative terminal, subtract the potential drop.

Let’s examine some steps in this procedure more closely. When locating the junctions in the circuit, do not be
concerned about the direction of the currents. If the direction of current flow is not obvious, choosing any
direction is sufficient as long as at least one current points into the junction and at least one current points out
of the junction. If the arrow is in the opposite direction of the conventional current flow, the result for the
current in question will be negative but the answer will still be correct.

The number of nodes depends on the circuit. Each current should be included in a node and thus included in
at least one junction equation. Do not include nodes that are not linearly independent, meaning nodes that
contain the same information.

Consider Figure 10.24. There are two junctions in this circuit: Junction b and Junction e. Points a, c, d, and f
are not junctions, because a junction must have three or more connections. The equation for Junction b is
, and the equation for Junction e is . These are equivalent equations, so it is
necessary to keep only one of them.

Figure 10.24 At first glance, this circuit contains two junctions, Junction b and Junction e, but only one should be considered because
their junction equations are equivalent.

When choosing the loops in the circuit, you need enough loops so that each component is covered once,
without repeating loops. Figure 10.25 shows four choices for loops to solve a sample circuit; choices (a), (b),
and (c) have a sufficient amount of loops to solve the circuit completely. Option (d) reflects more loops than

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 443

necessary to solve the circuit.

Figure 10.25 Panels (a)–(c) are sufficient for the analysis of the circuit. In each case, the two loops shown contain all the circuit elements
necessary to solve the circuit completely. Panel (d) shows three loops used, which is more than necessary. Any two loops in the system will
contain all information needed to solve the circuit. Adding the third loop provides redundant information.

Consider the circuit in Figure 10.26(a). Let us analyze this circuit to find the current through each resistor.
First, label the circuit as shown in part (b).

Figure 10.26 (a) A multi-loop circuit. (b) Label the circuit to help with orientation.

Next, determine the junctions. In this circuit, points b and e each have three wires connected, making them
junctions. Start to apply Kirchhoff’s junction rule by drawing arrows representing the
currents and labeling each arrow, as shown in Figure 10.27(b). Junction b shows that and
Junction e shows that . Since Junction e gives the same information of Junction b, it can be
disregarded. This circuit has three unknowns, so we need three linearly independent equations to analyze it.
444 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.27 (a) This circuit has two junctions, labeled b and e, but only node b is used in the analysis. (b) Labeled arrows represent the
currents into and out of the junctions.

Next we need to choose the loops. In Figure 10.28, Loop abefa includes the voltage source and resistors
and . The loop starts at point a, then travels through points b, e, and f, and then back to point a. The second
loop, Loop ebcde, starts at point e and includes resistors and , and the voltage source .

Figure 10.28 Choose the loops in the circuit.

Now we can apply Kirchhoff’s loop rule, using the map in Figure 10.23. Starting at point a and moving to point
b, the resistor is crossed in the same direction as the current flow , so the potential drop is
subtracted. Moving from point b to point e, the resistor is crossed in the same direction as the current flow
so the potential drop is subtracted. Moving from point e to point f, the voltage source is crossed
from the negative terminal to the positive terminal, so is added. There are no components between points f
and a. The sum of the voltage differences must equal zero:

Finally, we check loop ebcde. We start at point e and move to point b, crossing in the opposite direction as
the current flow . The potential drop is added. Next, we cross and in the same direction as the
current flow and subtract the potential drops and Note that the current is the same through
resistors and , because they are connected in series. Finally, the voltage source is crossed from the
positive terminal to the negative terminal, and the voltage source is subtracted. The sum of these voltage
differences equals zero and yields the loop equation

We now have three equations, which we can solve for the three unknowns.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 445

To solve the three equations for the three unknown currents, start by eliminating current . First add Eq. (1)
times to Eq. (2). The result is labeled as Eq. (4):

Next, subtract Eq. (3) from Eq. (2). The result is labeled as Eq. (5):

We can solve Eqs. (4) and (5) for current . Adding seven times Eq. (4) and three times Eq. (5) results in
or Using Eq. (4) results in Finally, Eq. (1) yields
One way to check that the solutions are consistent is to check the power supplied by
the voltage sources and the power dissipated by the resistors:

Note that the solution for the current is negative. This is the correct answer, but suggests that the arrow
originally drawn in the junction analysis is the direction opposite of conventional current flow. The power
supplied by the second voltage source is 58 W and not −58 W.

EXAMPLE 10.6

Calculating Current by Using Kirchhoff’s Rules


Find the currents flowing in the circuit in Figure 10.29.
446 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.29 This circuit is combination of series and parallel configurations of resistors and voltage sources. This circuit cannot be
analyzed using the techniques discussed in Electromotive Force but can be analyzed using Kirchhoff’s rules.

Strategy
This circuit is sufficiently complex that the currents cannot be found using Ohm’s law and the series-parallel
techniques—it is necessary to use Kirchhoff’s rules. Currents have been labeled and in the figure, and
assumptions have been made about their directions. Locations on the diagram have been labeled with letters a
through h. In the solution, we apply the junction and loop rules, seeking three independent equations to allow
us to solve for the three unknown currents.

Solution
Applying the junction and loop rules yields the following three equations. We have three unknowns, so three
equations are required.

Simplify the equations by placing the unknowns on one side of the equations.

Simplify the equations. The first loop equation can be simplified by dividing both sides by 3.00. The second
loop equation can be simplified by dividing both sides by 6.00.

The results are

Significance
A method to check the calculations is to compute the power dissipated by the resistors and the power supplied
by the voltage sources:

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 447

The power supplied equals the power dissipated by the resistors.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.6


In considering the following schematic and the power supplied and consumed by a circuit, will a voltage
source always provide power to the circuit, or can a voltage source consume power?

EXAMPLE 10.7

Calculating Current by Using Kirchhoff’s Rules


Find the current flowing in the circuit in Figure 10.30.

Figure 10.30 This circuit consists of three resistors and two batteries connected in series. Note that the batteries are connected with
opposite polarities.

Strategy
This circuit can be analyzed using Kirchhoff’s rules. There is only one loop and no nodes. Choose the direction
448 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

of current flow. For this example, we will use the clockwise direction from point a to point b. Consider Loop
abcda and use Figure 10.23 to write the loop equation. Note that according to Figure 10.23, battery will be
added and battery will be subtracted.

Solution
Applying the junction rule yields the following three equations. We have one unknown, so one equation is
required:

Simplify the equations by placing the unknowns on one side of the equations. Use the values given in the
figure.

Significance
The power dissipated or consumed by the circuit equals the power supplied to the circuit, but notice that the
current in the battery is flowing through the battery from the positive terminal to the negative terminal and
consumes power.

The power supplied equals the power dissipated by the resistors and consumed by the battery

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.7


When using Kirchhoff’s laws, you need to decide which loops to use and the direction of current flow through
each loop. In analyzing the circuit in Example 10.7, the direction of current flow was chosen to be clockwise,
from point a to point b. How would the results change if the direction of the current was chosen to be
counterclockwise, from point b to point a?

Multiple Voltage Sources


Many devices require more than one battery. Multiple voltage sources, such as batteries, can be connected in
series configurations, parallel configurations, or a combination of the two.

In series, the positive terminal of one battery is connected to the negative terminal of another battery. Any
number of voltage sources, including batteries, can be connected in series. Two batteries connected in series
are shown in Figure 10.31. Using Kirchhoff’s loop rule for the circuit in part (b) gives the result

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.3 • Kirchhoff's Rules 449

Figure 10.31 (a) Two batteries connected in series with a load resistor. (b) The circuit diagram of the two batteries and the load resistor,
with each battery modeled as an idealized emf source and an internal resistance.

When voltage sources are in series, their internal resistances can be added together and their emfs can be
added together to get the total values. Series connections of voltage sources are common—for example, in
flashlights, toys, and other appliances. Usually, the cells are in series in order to produce a larger total emf. In
Figure 10.31, the terminal voltage is

Note that the same current I is found in each battery because they are connected in series. The disadvantage of
series connections of cells is that their internal resistances are additive.

Batteries are connected in series to increase the voltage supplied to the circuit. For instance, an LED flashlight
may have two AAA cell batteries, each with a terminal voltage of 1.5 V, to provide 3.0 V to the flashlight.

Any number of batteries can be connected in series. For N batteries in series, the terminal voltage is equal to

10.6

where the equivalent resistance is .

When a load is placed across voltage sources in series, as in Figure 10.32, we can find the current:

As expected, the internal resistances increase the equivalent resistance.


450 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.32 Two batteries connect in series to an LED bulb, as found in a flashlight.

Voltage sources, such as batteries, can also be connected in parallel. Figure 10.33 shows two batteries with
identical emfs in parallel and connected to a load resistance. When the batteries are connect in parallel, the
positive terminals are connected together and the negative terminals are connected together, and the load
resistance is connected to the positive and negative terminals. Normally, voltage sources in parallel have
identical emfs. In this simple case, since the voltage sources are in parallel, the total emf is the same as the
individual emfs of each battery.

Figure 10.33 (a) Two batteries connect in parallel to a load resistor. (b) The circuit diagram shows the shows battery as an emf source and
an internal resistor. The two emf sources have identical emfs (each labeled by ) connected in parallel that produce the same emf.

Consider the Kirchhoff analysis of the circuit in Figure 10.33(b). There are two loops and a node at point b and
.

Node b: .

Loop abcfa:

Loop fcdef:

Solving for the current through the load resistor results in , where . The

terminal voltage is equal to the potential drop across the load resistor . The parallel connection
reduces the internal resistance and thus can produce a larger current.

Any number of batteries can be connected in parallel. For N batteries in parallel, the terminal voltage is equal
to

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.4 • Electrical Measuring Instruments 451

10.7

where the equivalent resistance is .

As an example, some diesel trucks use two 12-V batteries in parallel; they produce a total emf of 12 V but can
deliver the larger current needed to start a diesel engine.

In summary, the terminal voltage of batteries in series is equal to the sum of the individual emfs minus the
sum of the internal resistances times the current. When batteries are connected in parallel, they usually have
equal emfs and the terminal voltage is equal to the emf minus the equivalent internal resistance times the
current, where the equivalent internal resistance is smaller than the individual internal resistances. Batteries
are connected in series to increase the terminal voltage to the load. Batteries are connected in parallel to
increase the current to the load.

Solar Cell Arrays


Another example dealing with multiple voltage sources is that of combinations of solar cells—wired in both
series and parallel combinations to yield a desired voltage and current. Photovoltaic generation, which is the
conversion of sunlight directly into electricity, is based upon the photoelectric effect. The photoelectric effect
is beyond the scope of this chapter and is covered in Photons and Matter Waves, but in general, photons hitting
the surface of a solar cell create an electric current in the cell.

Most solar cells are made from pure silicon. Most single cells have a voltage output of about 0.5 V, while the
current output is a function of the amount of sunlight falling on the cell (the incident solar radiation known as
the insolation). Under bright noon sunlight, a current per unit area of about of cell surface area is
produced by typical single-crystal cells.

Individual solar cells are connected electrically in modules to meet electrical energy needs. They can be wired
together in series or in parallel—connected like the batteries discussed earlier. A solar-cell array or module
usually consists of between 36 and 72 cells, with a power output of 50 W to 140 W.

Solar cells, like batteries, provide a direct current (dc) voltage. Current from a dc voltage source is
unidirectional. Most household appliances need an alternating current (ac) voltage.

10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe how to connect a voltmeter in a circuit to measure voltage
• Describe how to connect an ammeter in a circuit to measure current
• Describe the use of an ohmmeter

Ohm’s law and Kirchhoff’s method are useful to analyze and design electrical circuits, providing you with the
voltages across, the current through, and the resistance of the components that compose the circuit. To
measure these parameters require instruments, and these instruments are described in this section.

DC Voltmeters and Ammeters


Whereas voltmeters measure voltage, ammeters measure current. Some of the meters in automobile
dashboards, digital cameras, cell phones, and tuner-amplifiers are actually voltmeters or ammeters (Figure
10.34). The internal construction of the simplest of these meters and how they are connected to the system
they monitor give further insight into applications of series and parallel connections.
452 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Figure 10.34 The fuel and temperature gauges (far right and far left, respectively) in this 1996 Volkswagen are voltmeters that register
the voltage output of “sender” units. These units are proportional to the amount of gasoline in the tank and to the engine temperature.
(credit: Christian Giersing)

Measuring Current with an Ammeter


To measure the current through a device or component, the ammeter is placed in series with the device or
component. A series connection is used because objects in series have the same current passing through
them. (See Figure 10.35, where the ammeter is represented by the symbol A.)

Figure 10.35 (a) When an ammeter is used to measure the current through two resistors connected in series to a battery, a single
ammeter is placed in series with the two resistors because the current is the same through the two resistors in series. (b) When two
resistors are connected in parallel with a battery, three meters, or three separate ammeter readings, are necessary to measure the current
from the battery and through each resistor. The ammeter is connected in series with the component in question.

Ammeters need to have a very low resistance, a fraction of a milliohm. If the resistance is not negligible,
placing the ammeter in the circuit would change the equivalent resistance of the circuit and modify the
current that is being measured. Since the current in the circuit travels through the meter, ammeters normally
contain a fuse to protect the meter from damage from currents which are too high.

Measuring Voltage with a Voltmeter


A voltmeter is connected in parallel with whatever device it is measuring. A parallel connection is used
because objects in parallel experience the same potential difference. (See Figure 10.36, where the voltmeter is
represented by the symbol V.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.4 • Electrical Measuring Instruments 453

Figure 10.36 To measure potential differences in this series circuit, the voltmeter (V) is placed in parallel with the voltage source or either
of the resistors. Note that terminal voltage is measured between the positive terminal and the negative terminal of the battery or voltage
source. It is not possible to connect a voltmeter directly across the emf without including the internal resistance r of the battery.

Since voltmeters are connected in parallel, the voltmeter must have a very large resistance. Digital voltmeters
convert the analog voltage into a digital value to display on a digital readout (Figure 10.37). Inexpensive
voltmeters have resistances on the order of whereas high-precision voltmeters have
resistances on the order of . The value of the resistance may vary, depending on which scale is
used on the meter.

Figure 10.37 (a) An analog voltmeter uses a galvanometer to measure the voltage. (b) Digital meters use an analog-to-digital converter to
measure the voltage. (credit: modification of works by Joseph J. Trout)

Analog and Digital Meters


You may encounter two types of meters in the physics lab: analog and digital. The term ‘analog’ refers to
signals or information represented by a continuously variable physical quantity, such as voltage or current. An
analog meter uses a galvanometer, which is essentially a coil of wire with a small resistance, in a magnetic
field, with a pointer attached that points to a scale. Current flows through the coil, causing the coil to rotate. To
use the galvanometer as an ammeter, a small resistance is placed in parallel with the coil. For a voltmeter, a
large resistance is placed in series with the coil. A digital meter uses a component called an analog-to-digital
(A to D) converter and expresses the current or voltage as a series of the digits 0 and 1, which are used to run a
digital display. Most analog meters have been replaced by digital meters.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 10.8


Digital meters are able to detect smaller currents than analog meters employing galvanometers. How does this
explain their ability to measure voltage and current more accurately than analog meters?
454 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

INTERACTIVE
In this virtual lab (https://openstax.org/l/21cirreslabsim) simulation, you may construct circuits with resistors,
voltage sources, ammeters and voltmeters to test your knowledge of circuit design.

Ohmmeters
An ohmmeter is an instrument used to measure the resistance of a component or device. The operation of the
ohmmeter is based on Ohm’s law. Traditional ohmmeters contained an internal voltage source (such as a
battery) that would be connected across the component to be tested, producing a current through the
component. A galvanometer was then used to measure the current and the resistance was deduced using
Ohm’s law. Modern digital meters use a constant current source to pass current through the component, and
the voltage difference across the component is measured. In either case, the resistance is measured using
Ohm’s law where the voltage is known and the current is measured, or the current is known and
the voltage is measured.

The component of interest should be isolated from the circuit; otherwise, you will be measuring the equivalent
resistance of the circuit. An ohmmeter should never be connected to a “live” circuit, one with a voltage source
connected to it and current running through it. Doing so can damage the meter.

10.5 RC Circuits
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the charging process of a capacitor
• Describe the discharging process of a capacitor
• List some applications of RC circuits

When you use a flash camera, it takes a few seconds to charge the capacitor that powers the flash. The light
flash discharges the capacitor in a tiny fraction of a second. Why does charging take longer than discharging?
This question and several other phenomena that involve charging and discharging capacitors are discussed in
this module.

Circuits with Resistance and Capacitance


An RC circuit is a circuit containing resistance and capacitance. As presented in Capacitance, the capacitor is
an electrical component that stores electric charge, storing energy in an electric field.

Figure 10.38(a) shows a simple RC circuit that employs a dc (direct current) voltage source , a resistor R, a
capacitor C, and a two-position switch. The circuit allows the capacitor to be charged or discharged, depending
on the position of the switch. When the switch is moved to position A, the capacitor charges, resulting in the
circuit in part (b). When the switch is moved to position B, the capacitor discharges through the resistor.

Figure 10.38 (a) An RC circuit with a two-pole switch that can be used to charge and discharge a capacitor. (b) When the switch is moved
to position A, the circuit reduces to a simple series connection of the voltage source, the resistor, the capacitor, and the switch. (c) When the
switch is moved to position B, the circuit reduces to a simple series connection of the resistor, the capacitor, and the switch. The voltage
source is removed from the circuit.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.5 • RC Circuits 455

Charging a Capacitor
We can use Kirchhoff’s loop rule to understand the charging of the capacitor. This results in the equation
This equation can be used to model the charge as a function of time as the capacitor charges.
Capacitance is defined as so the voltage across the capacitor is . Using Ohm’s law, the
potential drop across the resistor is , and the current is defined as

This differential equation can be integrated to find an equation for the charge on the capacitor as a function of
time.

Let , then The result is

Simplifying results in an equation for the charge on the charging capacitor as a function of time:

10.8

A graph of the charge on the capacitor versus time is shown in Figure 10.39(a). First note that as time
approaches infinity, the exponential goes to zero, so the charge approaches the maximum charge and
has units of coulombs. The units of RC are seconds, units of time. This quantity is known as the time constant:

10.9

At time , the charge is equal to of the maximum charge .


Notice that the time rate change of the charge is the slope at a point of the charge versus time plot. The slope of
the graph is large at time and approaches zero as time increases.

As the charge on the capacitor increases, the current through the resistor decreases, as shown in Figure
456 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

10.39(b). The current through the resistor can be found by taking the time derivative of the charge.

10.10

At time the current through the resistor is . As time approaches infinity, the current
approaches zero. At time , the current through the resistor is

Figure 10.39 (a) Charge on the capacitor versus time as the capacitor charges. (b) Current through the resistor versus time. (c) Voltage
difference across the capacitor. (d) Voltage difference across the resistor.

Figure 10.39(c) and Figure 10.39(d) show the voltage differences across the capacitor and the resistor,
respectively. As the charge on the capacitor increases, the current decreases, as does the voltage difference
across the resistor The voltage difference across the capacitor increases
as

Discharging a Capacitor
When the switch in Figure 10.38(a) is moved to position B, the circuit reduces to the circuit in part (c), and the
charged capacitor is allowed to discharge through the resistor. A graph of the charge on the capacitor as a
function of time is shown in Figure 10.40(a). Using Kirchhoff’s loop rule to analyze the circuit as the capacitor
discharges results in the equation , which simplifies to . Using the definition of
current and integrating the loop equation yields an equation for the charge on the capacitor as a
function of time:

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.5 • RC Circuits 457

10.11

Here, Q is the initial charge on the capacitor and is the time constant of the circuit. As shown in the
graph, the charge decreases exponentially from the initial charge, approaching zero as time approaches
infinity.

The current as a function of time can be found by taking the time derivative of the charge:

10.12

The negative sign shows that the current flows in the opposite direction of the current found when the
capacitor is charging. Figure 10.40(b) shows an example of a plot of charge versus time and current versus
time. A plot of the voltage difference across the capacitor and the voltage difference across the resistor as a
function of time are shown in parts (c) and (d) of the figure. Note that the magnitudes of the charge, current,
and voltage all decrease exponentially, approaching zero as time increases.

Figure 10.40 (a) Charge on the capacitor versus time as the capacitor discharges. (b) Current through the resistor versus time. (c) Voltage
difference across the capacitor. (d) Voltage difference across the resistor.

Now we can explain why the flash camera mentioned at the beginning of this section takes so much longer to
charge than discharge: The resistance while charging is significantly greater than while discharging. The
internal resistance of the battery accounts for most of the resistance while charging. As the battery ages, the
increasing internal resistance makes the charging process even slower.

EXAMPLE 10.8

The Relaxation Oscillator


One application of an RC circuit is the relaxation oscillator, as shown below. The relaxation oscillator consists
458 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

of a voltage source, a resistor, a capacitor, and a neon lamp. The neon lamp acts like an open circuit (infinite
resistance) until the potential difference across the neon lamp reaches a specific voltage. At that voltage, the
lamp acts like a short circuit (zero resistance), and the capacitor discharges through the neon lamp and
produces light. In the relaxation oscillator shown, the voltage source charges the capacitor until the voltage
across the capacitor is 80 V. When this happens, the neon in the lamp breaks down and allows the capacitor to
discharge through the lamp, producing a bright flash. After the capacitor fully discharges through the neon
lamp, it begins to charge again, and the process repeats. Assuming that the time it takes the capacitor to
discharge is negligible, what is the time interval between flashes?

Strategy
The time period can be found from considering the equation where

Solution
The neon lamp flashes when the voltage across the capacitor reaches 80 V. The RC time constant is equal to
We can solve the voltage equation for the time it takes the
capacitor to reach 80 V:

Significance
One application of the relaxation oscillator is for controlling indicator lights that flash at a frequency
determined by the values for R and C. In this example, the neon lamp will flash every 8.13 seconds, a frequency
of The relaxation oscillator has many other practical uses. It is often used in
electronic circuits, where the neon lamp is replaced by a transistor or a device known as a tunnel diode. The
description of the transistor and tunnel diode is beyond the scope of this chapter, but you can think of them as
voltage controlled switches. They are normally open switches, but when the right voltage is applied, the switch
closes and conducts. The “switch” can be used to turn on another circuit, turn on a light, or run a small motor.
A relaxation oscillator can be used to make the turn signals of your car blink or your cell phone to vibrate.

RC circuits have many applications. They can be used effectively as timers for applications such as
intermittent windshield wipers, pace makers, and strobe lights. Some models of intermittent windshield
wipers use a variable resistor to adjust the interval between sweeps of the wiper. Increasing the resistance
increases the RC time constant, which increases the time between the operation of the wipers.

Another application is the pacemaker. The heart rate is normally controlled by electrical signals, which cause
the muscles of the heart to contract and pump blood. When the heart rhythm is abnormal (the heartbeat is too

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.5 • RC Circuits 459

high or too low), pace makers can be used to correct this abnormality. Pacemakers have sensors that detect
body motion and breathing to increase the heart rate during physical activities, thus meeting the increased
need for blood and oxygen, and an RC timing circuit can be used to control the time between voltage signals to
the heart.

Looking ahead to the study of ac circuits (Alternating-Current Circuits), ac voltages vary as sine functions with
specific frequencies. Periodic variations in voltage, or electric signals, are often recorded by scientists. These
voltage signals could come from music recorded by a microphone or atmospheric data collected by radar.
Occasionally, these signals can contain unwanted frequencies known as “noise.” RC filters can be used to filter
out the unwanted frequencies.

In the study of electronics, a popular device known as a 555 timer provides timed voltage pulses. The time
between pulses is controlled by an RC circuit. These are just a few of the countless applications of RC circuits.

EXAMPLE 10.9

Intermittent Windshield Wipers


A relaxation oscillator is used to control a pair of windshield wipers. The relaxation oscillator consists of a
10.00-mF capacitor and a variable resistor known as a rheostat. A knob connected to the variable
resistor allows the resistance to be adjusted from to The output of the capacitor is used to
control a voltage-controlled switch. The switch is normally open, but when the output voltage reaches 10.00 V,
the switch closes, energizing an electric motor and discharging the capacitor. The motor causes the windshield
wipers to sweep once across the windshield and the capacitor begins to charge again. To what resistance
should the rheostat be adjusted for the period of the wiper blades be 10.00 seconds?

Strategy
The resistance considers the equation where The capacitance, output
voltage, and voltage of the battery are given. We need to solve this equation for the resistance.

Solution
The output voltage will be 10.00 V and the voltage of the battery is 12.00 V. The capacitance is given as 10.00
mF. Solving for the resistance yields
460 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

Significance
Increasing the resistance increases the time delay between operations of the windshield wipers. When the
resistance is zero, the windshield wipers run continuously. At the maximum resistance, the period of the
operation of the wipers is:

The RC circuit has thousands of uses and is a very important circuit to study. Not only can it be used to time
circuits, it can also be used to filter out unwanted frequencies in a circuit and used in power supplies, like the
one for your computer, to help turn ac voltage to dc voltage.

10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical Safety


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• List the basic concepts involved in house wiring
• Define the terms thermal hazard and shock hazard
• Describe the effects of electrical shock on human physiology and their relationship to the amount of current
through the body
• Explain the function of fuses and circuit breakers

Electricity presents two known hazards: thermal and shock. A thermal hazard is one in which an excessive
electric current causes undesired thermal effects, such as starting a fire in the wall of a house. A shock hazard
occurs when an electric current passes through a person. Shocks range in severity from painful, but otherwise
harmless, to heart-stopping lethality. In this section, we consider these hazards and the various factors
affecting them in a quantitative manner. We also examine systems and devices for preventing electrical
hazards.

Thermal Hazards
Electric power causes undesired heating effects whenever electric energy is converted into thermal energy at a
rate faster than it can be safely dissipated. A classic example of this is the short circuit, a low-resistance path
between terminals of a voltage source. An example of a short circuit is shown in Figure 10.41. A toaster is
plugged into a common household electrical outlet. Insulation on wires leading to an appliance has worn
through, allowing the two wires to come into contact, or “short.” As a result, thermal energy can quickly raise
the temperature of surrounding materials, melting the insulation and perhaps causing a fire.

The circuit diagram shows a symbol that consists of a sine wave enclosed in a circle. This symbol represents
an alternating current (ac) voltage source. In an ac voltage source, the voltage oscillates between a positive and
negative maximum amplitude. Up to now, we have been considering direct current (dc) voltage sources, but
many of the same concepts are applicable to ac circuits.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.6 • Household Wiring and Electrical Safety 461

Figure 10.41 A short circuit is an undesired low-resistance path across a voltage source. (a) Worn insulation on the wires of a toaster
allow them to come into contact with a low resistance r. Since , thermal power is created so rapidly that the cord melts or burns.
(b) A schematic of the short circuit.

Another serious thermal hazard occurs when wires supplying power to an appliance are overloaded. Electrical
wires and appliances are often rated for the maximum current they can safely handle. The term “overloaded”
refers to a condition where the current exceeds the rated maximum current. As current flows through a wire,
the power dissipated in the supply wires is where is the resistance of the wires and I is the
current flowing through the wires. If either I or is too large, the wires overheat. Fuses and circuit breakers
are used to limit excessive currents.

Shock Hazards
Electric shock is the physiological reaction or injury caused by an external electric current passing through the
body. The effect of an electric shock can be negative or positive. When a current with a magnitude above 300
mA passes through the heart, death may occur. Most electrical shock fatalities occur because a current causes
ventricular fibrillation, a massively irregular and often fatal, beating of the heart. On the other hand, a heart
attack victim, whose heart is in fibrillation, can be saved by an electric shock from a defibrillator.

The effects of an undesirable electric shock can vary in severity: a slight sensation at the point of contact, pain,
loss of voluntary muscle control, difficulty breathing, heart fibrillation, and possibly death. The loss of
voluntary muscle control can cause the victim to not be able to let go of the source of the current.

The major factors upon which the severity of the effects of electrical shock depend are

1. The amount of current I


2. The path taken by the current
3. The duration of the shock
4. The frequency f of the current ( for dc)

Our bodies are relatively good electric conductors due to the body’s water content. A dangerous condition
occurs when the body is in contact with a voltage source and “ground.” The term “ground” refers to a large sink
or source of electrons, for example, the earth (thus, the name). When there is a direct path to ground, large
currents will pass through the parts of the body with the lowest resistance and a direct path to ground. A safety
precaution used by many professions is the wearing of insulated shoes. Insulated shoes prohibit a pathway to
ground for electrons through the feet by providing a large resistance. Whenever working with high-power
tools, or any electric circuit, ensure that you do not provide a pathway for current flow (especially across the
heart). A common safety precaution is to work with one hand, reducing the possibility of providing a current
path through the heart.

Very small currents pass harmlessly and unfelt through the body. This happens to you regularly without your
knowledge. The threshold of sensation is only 1 mA and, although unpleasant, shocks are apparently harmless
for currents less than 5 mA. A great number of safety rules take the 5-mA value for the maximum allowed
shock. At 5–30 mA and above, the current can stimulate sustained muscular contractions, much as regular
nerve impulses do (Figure 10.42). Very large currents (above 300 mA) cause the heart and diaphragm of the
462 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

lung to contract for the duration of the shock. Both the heart and respiration stop. Both often return to normal
following the shock.

Figure 10.42 An electric current can cause muscular contractions with varying effects. (a) The victim is “thrown” backward by involuntary
muscle contractions that extend the legs and torso. (b) The victim can’t let go of the wire that is stimulating all the muscles in the hand.
Those that close the fingers are stronger than those that open them.

Current is the major factor determining shock severity. A larger voltage is more hazardous, but since
the severity of the shock depends on the combination of voltage and resistance. For example, a person with dry
skin has a resistance of about . If he comes into contact with 120-V ac, a current

passes harmlessly through him. The same person soaking wet may have a resistance of and the same
120 V will produce a current of 12 mA—above the “can’t let go” threshold and potentially dangerous.

Electrical Safety: Systems and Devices


Figure 10.43(a) shows the schematic for a simple ac circuit with no safety features. This is not how power is
distributed in practice. Modern household and industrial wiring requires the three-wire system, shown
schematically in part (b), which has several safety features, with live, neutral, and ground wires. First is the
familiar circuit breaker (or fuse) to prevent thermal overload. Second is a protective case around the appliance,
such as a toaster or refrigerator. The case’s safety feature is that it prevents a person from touching exposed
wires and coming into electrical contact with the circuit, helping prevent shocks.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10.6 • Household Wiring and Electrical Safety 463

Figure 10.43 (a) Schematic of a simple ac circuit with a voltage source and a single appliance represented by the resistance R. There are
no safety features in this circuit. (b) The three-wire system connects the neutral wire to ground at the voltage source and user location,
forcing it to be at zero volts and supplying an alternative return path for the current through ground. Also grounded to zero volts is the case
of the appliance. A circuit breaker or fuse protects against thermal overload and is in series on the active (live/hot) wire.

There are three connections to ground shown in Figure 10.43(b). Recall that a ground connection is a low-
resistance path directly to ground. The two ground connections on the neutral wire force it to be at zero volts
relative to ground, giving the wire its name. This wire is therefore safe to touch even if its insulation, usually
white, is missing. The neutral wire is the return path for the current to follow to complete the circuit.
Furthermore, the two ground connections supply an alternative path through ground (a good conductor) to
complete the circuit. The ground connection closest to the power source could be at the generating plant,
whereas the other is at the user’s location. The third ground is to the case of the appliance, through the green
ground wire, forcing the case, too, to be at zero volts. The live or hot wire (hereafter referred to as “live/hot”)
supplies voltage and current to operate the appliance. Figure 10.44 shows a more pictorial version of how the
three-wire system is connected through a three-prong plug to an appliance.

Figure 10.44 The standard three-prong plug can only be inserted in one way, to ensure proper function of the three-wire system.

Insulating plastic is color-coded to identify live/hot, neutral, and ground wires, but these codes vary around the
world. It is essential to determine the color code in your region. Striped coatings are sometimes used for the
benefit of those who are colorblind.

Grounding the case solves more than one problem. The simplest problem is worn insulation on the live/hot
464 10 • Direct-Current Circuits

wire that allows it to contact the case, as shown in Figure 10.45. Lacking a ground connection, a severe shock is
possible. This is particularly dangerous in the kitchen, where a good connection to ground is available through
water on the floor or a water faucet. With the ground connection intact, the circuit breaker will trip, forcing
repair of the appliance.

Figure 10.45 Worn insulation allows the live/hot wire to come into direct contact with the metal case of this appliance. (a) The ground
connection being broken, the person is severely shocked. The appliance may operate normally in this situation. (b) With a proper ground,
the circuit breaker trips, forcing repair of the appliance.

A ground fault circuit interrupter (GFCI) is a safety device found in updated kitchen and bathroom wiring that
works based on electromagnetic induction. GFCIs compare the currents in the live/hot and neutral wires.
When live/hot and neutral currents are not equal, it is almost always because current in the neutral is less than
in the live/hot wire. Then some of the current, called a leakage current, is returning to the voltage source by a
path other than through the neutral wire. It is assumed that this path presents a hazard. GFCIs are usually set
to interrupt the circuit if the leakage current is greater than 5 mA, the accepted maximum harmless shock.
Even if the leakage current goes safely to ground through an intact ground wire, the GFCI will trip, forcing
repair of the leakage.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 465

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
ammeter instrument that measures current potential difference difference in electric
electromotive force (emf) energy produced per potential between two points in an electric
unit charge, drawn from a source that produces circuit, measured in volts
an electrical current potential drop loss of electric potential energy as a
equivalent resistance resistance of a combination current travels across a resistor, wire, or other
of resistors; it can be thought of as the resistance component
of a single resistor that can replace a combination RC circuit circuit that contains both a resistor and
of resistors in a series and/or parallel circuit a capacitor
internal resistance amount of resistance to the shock hazard hazard in which an electric current
flow of current within the voltage source passes through a person
junction rule sum of all currents entering a terminal voltage potential difference measured
junction must equal the sum of all currents across the terminals of a source when there is no
leaving the junction load attached
Kirchhoff’s rules set of two rules governing thermal hazard hazard in which an excessive
current and changes in potential in an electric electric current causes undesired thermal effects
circuit three-wire system wiring system used at present
loop rule algebraic sum of changes in potential for safety reasons, with live, neutral, and ground
around any closed circuit path (loop) must be wires
zero voltmeter instrument that measures voltage

Key Equations

Terminal voltage of a single voltage source

Equivalent resistance of a series circuit

Equivalent resistance of a parallel circuit

Junction rule

Loop rule

Terminal voltage of N voltage sources in series

Terminal voltage of N voltage sources in parallel

Charge on a charging capacitor

Time constant
466 10 • Chapter Review

Current during charging of a capacitor

Charge on a discharging capacitor

Current during discharging of a capacitor

Summary
10.1 Electromotive Force resistance.
• If a more complex connection of resistors is a
• All voltage sources have two fundamental parts:
combination of series and parallel, it can be
a source of electrical energy that has a
reduced to a single equivalent resistance by
characteristic electromotive force (emf), and an
identifying its various parts as series or parallel,
internal resistance r. The emf is the work done
reducing each to its equivalent, and continuing
per charge to keep the potential difference of a
until a single resistance is eventually reached.
source constant. The emf is equal to the
potential difference across the terminals when 10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules
no current is flowing. The internal resistance r
• Kirchhoff’s rules can be used to analyze any
of a voltage source affects the output voltage
circuit, simple or complex. The simpler series
when a current flows.
and parallel connection rules are special cases
• The voltage output of a device is called its
of Kirchhoff’s rules.
terminal voltage and is given by
• Kirchhoff’s first rule, also known as the junction
, where I is the electric current
rule, applies to the charge to a junction. Current
and is positive when flowing away from the
is the flow of charge; thus, whatever charge
positive terminal of the voltage source and r is
flows into the junction must flow out.
the internal resistance.
• Kirchhoff’s second rule, also known as the loop
10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel rule, states that the voltage drop around a loop is
zero.
• The equivalent resistance of an electrical circuit
• When calculating potential and current using
with resistors wired in a series is the sum of the
Kirchhoff’s rules, a set of conventions must be
individual resistances:
followed for determining the correct signs of
. various terms.
• When multiple voltage sources are in series,
• Each resistor in a series circuit has the same their internal resistances add together and their
amount of current flowing through it. emfs add together to get the total values.
• The potential drop, or power dissipation, across • When multiple voltage sources are in parallel,
each individual resistor in a series is different, their internal resistances combine to an
and their combined total is the power source equivalent resistance that is less than the
input. individual resistance and provides a higher
• The equivalent resistance of an electrical circuit current than a single cell.
with resistors wired in parallel is less than the • Solar cells can be wired in series or parallel to
lowest resistance of any of the components and provide increased voltage or current,
can be determined using the formula respectively.

10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments


• Voltmeters measure voltage, and ammeters
measure current. Analog meters are based on
• Each resistor in a parallel circuit has the same
the combination of a resistor and a
full voltage of the source applied to it.
galvanometer, a device that gives an analog
• The current flowing through each resistor in a
reading of current or voltage. Digital meters are
parallel circuit is different, depending on the
based on analog-to-digital converters and

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 467

provide a discrete or digital measurement of the current:


current or voltage. • If a capacitor with an initial charge Q is
• A voltmeter is placed in parallel with the voltage discharged through a resistor starting at ,
source to receive full voltage and must have a then its charge decreases exponentially. The
large resistance to limit its effect on the circuit. current flows in the opposite direction,
• An ammeter is placed in series to get the full compared to when it charges, and the
current flowing through a branch and must have magnitude of the charge decreases with time.
a small resistance to limit its effect on the
circuit.
10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical
• Standard voltmeters and ammeters alter the Safety
circuit they are connected to and are thus • The two types of electric hazards are thermal
limited in accuracy. (excessive power) and shock (current through a
• Ohmmeters are used to measure resistance. The person). Electrical safety systems and devices
component in which the resistance is to be are employed to prevent thermal and shock
measured should be isolated (removed) from hazards.
the circuit. • Shock severity is determined by current, path,
duration, and ac frequency.
10.5 RC Circuits
• Circuit breakers and fuses interrupt excessive
• An RC circuit is one that has both a resistor and currents to prevent thermal hazards.
a capacitor. • The three-wire system guards against thermal
• The time constant for an RC circuit is and shock hazards, utilizing live/hot, neutral,
• When an initially uncharged and ground wires, and grounding the neutral
capacitor in series with a resistor is charged by wire and case of the appliance.
a dc voltage source, the capacitor asymptotically • A ground fault circuit interrupter (GFCI)
approaches the maximum charge. prevents shock by detecting the loss of current
• As the charge on the capacitor increases, the to unintentional paths.
current exponentially decreases from the initial

Conceptual Questions
10.1 Electromotive Force 6. Suppose you are doing a physics lab that asks you
to put a resistor into a circuit, but all the resistors
1. What effect will the internal resistance of a
supplied have a larger resistance than the
rechargeable battery have on the energy being
requested value. How would you connect the
used to recharge the battery?
available resistances to attempt to get the smaller
2. A battery with an internal resistance of r and an
value asked for?
emf of 10.00 V is connected to a load resistor
7. Some light bulbs have three power settings (not
. As the battery ages, the internal resistance
including zero), obtained from multiple filaments
triples. How much is the current through the load
that are individually switched and wired in
resistor reduced?
parallel. What is the minimum number of
3. Show that the power dissipated by the load
filaments needed for three power settings?
resistor is maximum when the resistance of the
load resistor is equal to the internal resistance of
10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules
the battery.
8. Can all of the currents going into the junction
10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel shown below be positive? Explain.

4. A voltage occurs across an open switch. What is


the power dissipated by the open switch?
5. The severity of a shock depends on the
magnitude of the current through your body.
Would you prefer to be in series or in parallel
with a resistance, such as the heating element of
a toaster, if you were shocked by it? Explain.
9. Consider the circuit shown below. Does the
468 10 • Chapter Review

analysis of the circuit require Kirchhoff’s below?


method, or can it be redrawn to simplify the
circuit? If it is a circuit of series and parallel
connections, what is the equivalent resistance?

10.5 RC Circuits
10. Do batteries in a circuit always supply power to
16. A battery, switch, capacitor, and lamp are
a circuit, or can they absorb power in a circuit?
connected in series. Describe what happens to
Give an example.
the lamp when the switch is closed.
11. What are the advantages and disadvantages of
17. When making an ECG measurement, it is
connecting batteries in series? In parallel?
important to measure voltage variations over
12. Semi-tractor trucks use four large 12-V
small time intervals. The time is limited by the
batteries. The starter system requires 24 V,
RC constant of the circuit—it is not possible to
while normal operation of the truck’s other
measure time variations shorter than RC. How
electrical components utilizes 12 V. How could
would you manipulate R and C in the circuit to
the four batteries be connected to produce 24
allow the necessary measurements?
V? To produce 12 V? Why is 24 V better than 12
V for starting the truck’s engine (a very heavy
load)?
10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical
Safety
10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments 18. Why isn’t a short circuit necessarily a shock
hazard?
13. What would happen if you placed a voltmeter in
19. We are often advised to not flick electric
series with a component to be tested?
switches with wet hands, dry your hand first. We
14. What is the basic operation of an ohmmeter as
are also advised to never throw water on an
it measures a resistor?
electric fire. Why?
15. Why should you not connect an ammeter
directly across a voltage source as shown

Problems
10.1 Electromotive Force circuit diagram of the radio and its battery. Now,
calculate the power delivered to the radio (b)
20. A car battery with a 12-V emf and an internal
when using a nicad cells, each having an
resistance of is being charged with a
internal resistance of , and (c) when
current of 60 A. Note that in this process, the
using an alkaline cell, having an internal
battery is being charged. (a) What is the
resistance of . (d) Does this difference
potential difference across its terminals? (b) At
seem significant, considering that the radio’s
what rate is thermal energy being dissipated in
effective resistance is lowered when its volume
the battery? (c) At what rate is electric energy
is turned up?
being converted into chemical energy?
22. An automobile starter motor has an equivalent
21. The label on a battery-powered radio
resistance of and is supplied by a
recommends the use of a rechargeable nickel-
12.0-V battery with a internal
cadmium cell (nicads), although it has a 1.25-V
resistance. (a) What is the current to the motor?
emf, whereas an alkaline cell has a 1.58-V emf.
(b) What voltage is applied to it? (c) What power
The radio has a resistance. (a) Draw a
is supplied to the motor? (d) Repeat these

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 469

calculations for when the battery connections the circuit and any change in resistance in the
are corroded and add to the circuit. two devices.)
(Significant problems are caused by even small 30. (a) Given a 48.0-V battery and and
amounts of unwanted resistance in low-voltage, resistors, find the current and power for
high-current applications.) each when connected in series. (b) Repeat when
23. (a) What is the internal resistance of a voltage the resistances are in parallel.
source if its terminal potential drops by 2.00 V 31. Referring to the example combining series and
when the current supplied increases by 5.00 A? parallel circuits and Figure 10.16, calculate
(b) Can the emf of the voltage source be found in the following two different ways: (a) from the
with the information supplied? known values of and ; (b) using Ohm’s law
24. A person with body resistance between his for . In both parts, explicitly show how you
hands of accidentally grasps the follow the steps in the Figure 10.17.
terminals of a 20.0-kV power supply. (Do NOT 32. Referring to Figure 10.16, (a) Calculate and
do this!) (a) Draw a circuit diagram to represent note how it compares with found in the first
the situation. (b) If the internal resistance of the two example problems in this module. (b) Find
power supply is , what is the current the total power supplied by the source and
through his body? (c) What is the power compare it with the sum of the powers
dissipated in his body? (d) If the power supply is dissipated by the resistors.
to be made safe by increasing its internal 33. Refer to Figure 10.17 and the discussion of
resistance, what should the internal resistance lights dimming when a heavy appliance comes
be for the maximum current in this situation to on. (a) Given the voltage source is 120 V, the
be 1.00 mA or less? (e) Will this modification wire resistance is and the bulb is
compromise the effectiveness of the power nominally 75.0 W, what power will the bulb
supply for driving low-resistance devices? dissipate if a total of 15.0 A passes through the
Explain your reasoning. wires when the motor comes on? Assume
25. A 12.0-V emf automobile battery has a terminal negligible change in bulb resistance. (b) What
voltage of 16.0 V when being charged by a power is consumed by the motor?
current of 10.0 A. (a) What is the battery’s 34. Show that if two resistors and are
internal resistance? (b) What power is combined and one is much greater than the
dissipated inside the battery? (c) At what rate (in other , (a) their series resistance is
) will its temperature increase if its mass very nearly equal to the greater resistance
is 20.0 kg and it has a specific heat of and (b) their parallel resistance is very nearly
, assuming no heat escapes? equal to the smaller resistance .
35. Consider the circuit shown below. The terminal
10.2 Resistors in Series and Parallel voltage of the battery is (a) Find
the equivalent resistance of the circuit. (b) Find
26. (a) What is the resistance of a ,a
the current through each resistor. (c) Find the
, and a resistor connected in
potential drop across each resistor. (d) Find the
series? (b) In parallel?
power dissipated by each resistor. (e) Find the
27. What are the largest and smallest resistances
power supplied by the battery.
you can obtain by connecting a ,a
, and a resistor together?
28. An 1800-W toaster, a 1400-W speaker, and a
75-W lamp are plugged into the same outlet in a
15-A fuse and 120-V circuit. (The three devices
are in parallel when plugged into the same
socket.) (a) What current is drawn by each
device? (b) Will this combination blow the 15-A
fuse?
29. Your car’s 30.0-W headlight and 2.40-kW starter
are ordinarily connected in parallel in a 12.0-V 10.3 Kirchhoff's Rules
system. What power would one headlight and 36. Consider the circuit shown below. (a) Find the
the starter consume if connected in series to a voltage across each resistor. (b)What is the
12.0-V battery? (Neglect any other resistance in
470 10 • Chapter Review

power supplied to the circuit and the power


dissipated or consumed by the circuit?

40. Consider the circuit shown below. Find

37. Consider the circuits shown below. (a) What is


the current through each resistor in part (a)? (b)
What is the current through each resistor in
part (b)? (c) What is the power dissipated or
consumed by each circuit? (d) What is the
power supplied to each circuit?

41. Consider the circuit shown below. (a) Find


(b) Find the power supplied
by the voltage sources. (c) Find the power dissipated
by the resistors.

42. Consider the circuit shown below. Write the three


loop equations for the loops shown.
38. Consider the circuit shown below. Find

43. Consider the circuit shown below. Write equations


for the three currents in terms of R and V.

39. Consider the circuit shown below. Find

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 471

What current flows? (b) Find the terminal


voltage. (c) To see how close the measured
terminal voltage is to the emf, calculate their
ratio.

44. Consider the circuit shown in the preceding


problem. Write equations for the power
supplied by the voltage sources and the power
dissipated by the resistors in terms of R and V.
45. A child’s electronic toy is supplied by three
1.58-V alkaline cells having internal resistances
of in series with a 1.53-V carbon-zinc
10.5 RC Circuits
dry cell having a internal resistance. 49. The timing device in an automobile’s
The load resistance is . (a) Draw a circuit intermittent wiper system is based on an RC
diagram of the toy and its batteries. (b) What time constant and utilizes a capacitor
current flows? (c) How much power is supplied and a variable resistor. Over what range must R
to the load? (d) What is the internal resistance of be made to vary to achieve time constants from
the dry cell if it goes bad, resulting in only 0.500 2.00 to 15.0 s?
W being supplied to the load? 50. A heart pacemaker fires 72 times a minute,
46. Apply the junction rule to Junction b shown below. each time a 25.0-nF capacitor is charged (by a
Is any new information gained by applying the battery in series with a resistor) to 0.632 of its
junction rule at e? full voltage. What is the value of the resistance?
51. The duration of a photographic flash is related
to an RC time constant, which is for a
certain camera. (a) If the resistance of the flash
lamp is during discharge, what is the
size of the capacitor supplying its energy? (b)
What is the time constant for charging the
capacitor, if the charging resistance is ?
52. A 2.00- and a capacitor can be
connected in series or parallel, as can a 25.0-
and a resistor. Calculate the four RC
time constants possible from connecting the
resulting capacitance and resistance in series.
53. A resistor, an uncharged
capacitor, and a 6.16-V emf are connected in
series. (a) What is the initial current? (b) What is
the RC time constant? (c) What is the current
after one time constant? (d) What is the voltage
47. Apply the loop rule to Loop afedcba in the on the capacitor after one time constant?
preceding problem. 54. A heart defibrillator being used on a patient has
an RC time constant of 10.0 ms due to the
10.4 Electrical Measuring Instruments resistance of the patient and the capacitance of
48. Suppose you measure the terminal voltage of a the defibrillator. (a) If the defibrillator has a
1.585-V alkaline cell having an internal capacitance of what is the resistance of
resistance of by placing a the path through the patient? (You may neglect
voltmeter across its terminals (see below). (a) the capacitance of the patient and the
resistance of the defibrillator.) (b) If the initial
472 10 • Chapter Review

voltage is 12.0 kV, how long does it take to case of a radio. The path through the person to
decline to ? the drainpipe and ground has a resistance of
55. An ECG monitor must have an RC time constant . What is the smallest voltage on the case
less than to be able to measure of the radio that could cause ventricular
variations in voltage over small time intervals. fibrillation?
(a) If the resistance of the circuit (due mostly to 62. A man foolishly tries to fish a burning piece of
that of the patient’s chest) is , what is the bread from a toaster with a metal butter knife
maximum capacitance of the circuit? (b) Would and comes into contact with 120-V ac. He does
it be difficult in practice to limit the capacitance not even feel it since, luckily, he is wearing
to less than the value found in (a)? rubber-soled shoes. What is the minimum
56. Using the exact exponential treatment, resistance of the path the current follows
determine how much time is required to charge through the person?
an initially uncharged 100-pF capacitor through 63. (a) During surgery, a current as small as
a resistor to of its final voltage. applied directly to the heart may cause
57. If you wish to take a picture of a bullet traveling ventricular fibrillation. If the resistance of the
at 500 m/s, then a very brief flash of light exposed heart is what is the smallest
produced by an RC discharge through a flash voltage that poses this danger? (b) Does your
tube can limit blurring. Assuming 1.00 mm of answer imply that special electrical safety
motion during one RC constant is acceptable, precautions are needed?
and given that the flash is driven by a 64. (a) What is the resistance of a 220-V ac short
capacitor, what is the resistance in the flash circuit that generates a peak power of 96.8 kW?
tube? (b) What would the average power be if the
voltage were 120 V ac?
10.6 Household Wiring and Electrical 65. A heart defibrillator passes 10.0 A through a
Safety patient’s torso for 5.00 ms in an attempt to
restore normal beating. (a) How much charge
58. (a) How much power is dissipated in a short passed? (b) What voltage was applied if 500 J of
circuit of 240-V ac through a resistance of energy was dissipated? (c) What was the path’s
? (b) What current flows? resistance? (d) Find the temperature increase
59. What voltage is involved in a 1.44-kW short caused in the 8.00 kg of affected tissue.
circuit through a resistance? 66. A short circuit in a 120-V appliance cord has a
60. Find the current through a person and identify resistance. Calculate the temperature
the likely effect on her if she touches a 120-V ac rise of the 2.00 g of surrounding materials,
source: (a) if she is standing on a rubber mat assuming their specific heat capacity is
and offers a total resistance of ; (b) if she and that it takes 0.0500 s for a
is standing barefoot on wet grass and has a circuit breaker to interrupt the current. Is this
resistance of only . likely to be damaging?
61. While taking a bath, a person touches the metal

Additional Problems
67. A circuit contains a D cell battery, a switch, a 68. A circuit contains a D-cell battery, a switch, a
resistor, and four 20-mF capacitors resistor, and three 20-mF capacitors. The
connected in series. (a) What is the equivalent capacitors are connected in parallel, and the
capacitance of the circuit? (b) What is the RC parallel connection of capacitors are connected
time constant? (c) How long before the current in series with the switch, the resistor and the
decreases to of the initial value once the battery. (a) What is the equivalent capacitance
switch is closed? of the circuit? (b) What is the RC time constant?
(c) How long before the current decreases to
of the initial value once the switch is
closed?

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 473

69. Consider the circuit below. The battery has an emf 72. The rather simple circuit shown below is known as
of and an internal resistance of a voltage divider. The symbol consisting of three
(a) Find the equivalent resistance of the horizontal lines is represents “ground” and can be
circuit and the current out of the battery. (b) Find defined as the point where the potential is zero. The
the current through each resistor. (c) Find the voltage divider is widely used in circuits and a
potential drop across each resistor. (d) Find the single voltage source can be used to provide
power dissipated by each resistor. (e) Find the total reduced voltage to a load resistor as shown in the
power supplied by the batteries. second part of the figure. (a) What is the output
voltage of circuit (a) in terms of
(b) What is the output voltage
of circuit (b) in terms of

70. A homemade capacitor is constructed of 2


sheets of aluminum foil with an area of 2.00
73. Three resistors are connect in series with
square meters, separated by paper, 0.05 mm
an AAA battery with a rating of 3 AmpHours. (a)
thick, of the same area and a dielectric constant
How long can the battery supply the resistors
of 3.7. The homemade capacitor is connected in
with power? (b) If the resistors are connected in
series with a resistor, a switch, and a
parallel, how long can the battery last?
6.00-V voltage source. (a) What is the RC time
74. Consider a circuit that consists of a real battery
constant of the circuit? (b) What is the initial
with an emf and an internal resistance of r
current through the circuit, when the switch is
connected to a variable resistor R. (a) In order
closed? (c) How long does it take the current to
for the terminal voltage of the battery to be
reach one third of its initial value?
equal to the emf of the battery, what should the
71. A student makes a homemade resistor from a
resistance of the variable resistor be adjusted
graphite pencil 5.00 cm long, where the
to? (b) In order to get the maximum current
graphite is 0.05 mm in diameter. The resistivity
from the battery, what should the resistance of
of the graphite is . The
the variable resistor be adjusted to? (c) In order
homemade resistor is place in series with a
for the maximum power output of the battery to
switch, a 10.00-mF uncharged capacitor and a
be reached, what should the resistance of the
0.50-V power source. (a) What is the RC time
variable resistor be set to?
constant of the circuit? (b) What is the potential
75. Consider the circuit shown below. What is the energy
drop across the pencil 1.00 s after the switch is
stored in each capacitor after the switch has been
closed?
closed for a very long time?
474 10 • Chapter Review

76. Consider a circuit consisting of a battery with an 80. Two resistors, one having a resistance of ,
emf and an internal resistance of r connected are connected in parallel to produce a total
in series with a resistor R and a capacitor C. resistance of . (a) What is the value of the
Show that the total energy supplied by the second resistance? (b) What is unreasonable
battery while charging the battery is equal to about this result? (c) Which assumptions are
. unreasonable or inconsistent?
77. Consider the circuit shown below. The terminal 81. Two resistors, one having a resistance of
voltages of the batteries are shown. (a) Find the are connected in series to produce a
equivalent resistance of the circuit and the current total resistance of . (a) What is the
out of the battery. (b) Find the current through each value of the second resistance? (b) What is
resistor. (c) Find the potential drop across each unreasonable about this result? (c) Which
resistor. (d) Find the power dissipated by each assumptions are unreasonable or inconsistent?
resistor. (e) Find the total power supplied by the 82. Apply the junction rule at point a shown below.
batteries.

78. Consider the circuit shown below. (a) What is the


terminal voltage of the battery? (b) What is the
potential drop across resistor ?

83. Apply the loop rule to Loop akledcba in the


preceding problem.
84. Find the currents flowing in the circuit in the
preceding problem. Explicitly show how you
79. Consider the circuit shown below. (a)Determine the follow the steps in the Problem-Solving
equivalent resistance and the current from the Strategy: Series and Parallel Resistors.
battery with switch open. (b) Determine the 85. Consider the circuit shown below. (a) Find the
equivalent resistance and the current from the current through each resistor. (b) Check the
battery with switch closed. calculations by analyzing the power in the
circuit.

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 475

86. A flashing lamp in a Christmas earring is based 87. A capacitor charged to 450 V is
on an RC discharge of a capacitor through its discharged through a resistor. (a) Find
resistance. The effective duration of the flash is the time constant. (b) Calculate the temperature
0.250 s, during which it produces an average increase of the resistor, given that its mass is
0.500 W from an average 3.00 V. (a) What 2.50 g and its specific heat is
energy does it dissipate? (b) How much charge noting that most of the thermal energy is
moves through the lamp? (c) Find the retained in the short time of the discharge. (c)
capacitance. (d) What is the resistance of the Calculate the new resistance, assuming it is
lamp? (Since average values are given for some pure carbon. (d) Does this change in resistance
quantities, the shape of the pulse profile is not seem significant?
needed.)

Challenge Problems
88. Some camera flashes use flash tubes that 89. Consider the circuit shown below. Each battery
require a high voltage. They obtain a high has an emf of 1.50 V and an internal resistance
voltage by charging capacitors in parallel and of (a) What is the current through the
then internally changing the connections of the external resistor, which has a resistance of
capacitors to place them in series. Consider a 10.00 ohms? (b) What is the terminal voltage of
circuit that uses four AAA batteries connected each battery?
in series to charge six 10-mF capacitors
through an equivalent resistance of . The
connections are then switched internally to
place the capacitors in series. The capacitors
discharge through a lamp with a resistance of
. (a) What is the RC time constant and the
initial current out of the batteries while they are
connected in parallel? (b) How long does it take
for the capacitors to charge to of the
terminal voltages of the batteries? (c) What is
the RC time constant and the initial current of
the capacitors connected in series assuming it
discharges at of full charge? (d) How long
does it take the current to decrease to of
the initial value?
476 10 • Chapter Review

90. Analog meters use a galvanometer, which essentially 91. Analog meters use a galvanometer, which essentially
consists of a coil of wire with a small resistance and consists of a coil of wire with a small resistance and
a pointer with a scale attached. When current runs a pointer with a scale attached. When current runs
through the coil, the pointer turns; the amount the through the coil, the point turns; the amount the
pointer turns is proportional to the amount of pointer turns is proportional to the amount of
current running through the coil. Galvanometers current running through the coil. Galvanometers
can be used to make an ammeter if a resistor is can be used to make a voltmeter if a resistor is
placed in parallel with the galvanometer. Consider a placed in series with the galvanometer. Consider a
galvanometer that has a resistance of and galvanometer that has a resistance of and
gives a full scale reading when a current runs gives a full scale reading when a current runs
through it. The galvanometer is to be used to make through it. The galvanometer is to be used to make
an ammeter that has a full scale reading of 10.00 A, an voltmeter that has a full scale reading of 10.00 V,
as shown below. Recall that an ammeter is as shown below. Recall that a voltmeter is connected
connected in series with the circuit of interest, so all in parallel with the component of interest, so the
10 A must run through the meter. (a) What is the meter must have a high resistance or it will change
current through the parallel resistor in the meter? the current running through the component. (a)
(b) What is the voltage across the parallel resistor? What is the potential drop across the series resistor
(c) What is the resistance of the series resistor? in the meter? (b) What is the resistance of the
parallel resistor?

92. Consider the circuit shown below. Find

Access for free at openstax.org.


10 • Chapter Review 477

93. Consider the circuit below. (a) What is the RC time 96. Consider the circuit below. The capacitor has a
constant of the circuit? (b) What is the initial current capacitance of 10 mF. The switch is closed and
in the circuit once the switch is closed? (c) How after a long time the capacitor is fully charged.
much time passes between the instant the switch is (a) What is the current through each resistor a
closed and the time the current has reached half of long time after the switch is closed? (b) What is
the initial current? the voltage across each resistor a long time after
the switch is closed? (c) What is the voltage
across the capacitor a long time after the switch
is closed? (d) What is the charge on the
capacitor a long time after the switch is closed?
(e) The switch is then opened. The capacitor
discharges through the resistors. How long from
the time before the current drops to one fifth of
the initial value?

94. Consider the circuit below. (a) What is the initial


current through resistor when the switch is
closed? (b) What is the current through resistor
when the capacitor is fully charged, long after the
switch is closed? (c) What happens if the switch is
opened after it has been closed for some time? (d) If
the switch has been closed for a time period long
enough for the capacitor to become fully charged,
and then the switch is opened, how long before the
current through resistor reaches half of its initial
97. A 120-V immersion heater consists of a coil of
value?
wire that is placed in a cup to boil the water. The
heater can boil one cup of water in
180.00 seconds. You buy one to use in your
dorm room, but you are worried that you will
overload the circuit and trip the 15.00-A, 120-V
circuit breaker, which supplies your dorm
room. In your dorm room, you have four
100.00-W incandescent lamps and a 1500.00-W
space heater. (a) What is the power rating of the
immersion heater? (b) Will it trip the breaker
when everything is turned on? (c) If it you
replace the incandescent bulbs with 18.00-W
95. Consider the infinitely long chain of resistors shown LED, will the breaker trip when everything is
below. What is the resistance between terminals a turned on?
and b? 98. Find the resistance that must be placed in
series with a galvanometer having a
sensitivity (the same as the one
discussed in the text) to allow it to be used as a
voltmeter with a 3000-V full-scale reading.
Include a circuit diagram with your solution.
478 10 • Chapter Review

99. Find the resistance that must be placed in


parallel with a galvanometer having a
1.00-mA sensitivity (the same as the one
discussed in the text) to allow it to be used as an
ammeter with a 25.0-A full-scale reading.
Include a circuit diagram with your solution.

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 11
Magnetic Forces and Fields

Figure 11.1 An industrial electromagnet is capable of lifting thousands of pounds of metallic waste. (credit:
modification of work by “BedfordAl”/Flickr)

Chapter Outline

11.1 Magnetism and Its Historical Discoveries

11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines

11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a Magnetic Field

11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor

11.5 Force and Torque on a Current Loop

11.6 The Hall Effect

11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and Fields

INTRODUCTION For the past few chapters, we have been studying electrostatic forces and fields, which are
caused by electric charges at rest. These electric fields can move other free charges, such as producing a
current in a circuit; however, the electrostatic forces and fields themselves come from other static charges. In
this chapter, we see that when an electric charge moves, it generates other forces and fields. These additional
forces and fields are what we commonly call magnetism.

Before we examine the origins of magnetism, we first describe what it is and how magnetic fields behave. Once
we are more familiar with magnetic effects, we can explain how they arise from the behavior of atoms and
480 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

molecules, and how magnetism is related to electricity. The connection between electricity and magnetism is
fascinating from a theoretical point of view, but it is also immensely practical, as shown by an industrial
electromagnet that can lift thousands of pounds of metal.

11.1 Magnetism and Its Historical Discoveries


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain attraction and repulsion by magnets
• Describe the historical and contemporary applications of magnetism

Magnetism has been known since the time of the ancient Greeks, but it has always been a bit mysterious. You
can see electricity in the flash of a lightning bolt, but when a compass needle points to magnetic north, you
can’t see any force causing it to rotate. People learned about magnetic properties gradually, over many years,
before several physicists of the nineteenth century connected magnetism with electricity. In this section, we
review the basic ideas of magnetism and describe how they fit into the picture of a magnetic field.

Brief History of Magnetism


Magnets are commonly found in everyday objects, such as toys, hangers, elevators, doorbells, and computer
devices. Experimentation on these magnets shows that all magnets have two poles: One is labeled north (N)
and the other is labeled south (S). Magnetic poles repel if they are alike (both N or both S), they attract if they
are opposite (one N and the other S), and both poles of a magnet attract unmagnetized pieces of iron. An
important point to note here is that you cannot isolate an individual magnetic pole. Every piece of a magnet, no
matter how small, which contains a north pole must also contain a south pole.

INTERACTIVE
Visit this website (https://openstax.org/l/21magnetcompass) for an interactive demonstration of magnetic
north and south poles.

An example of a magnet is a compass needle. It is simply a thin bar magnet suspended at its center, so it is free
to rotate in a horizontal plane. Earth itself also acts like a very large bar magnet, with its south-seeking pole
near the geographic North Pole (Figure 11.2). The north pole of a compass is attracted toward Earth’s
geographic North Pole because the magnetic pole that is near the geographic North Pole is actually a south
magnetic pole. Confusion arises because the geographic term “North Pole” has come to be used (incorrectly)
for the magnetic pole that is near the North Pole. Thus, “north magnetic pole” is actually a misnomer—it
should be called the south magnetic pole. [Note that the orientation of Earth’s magnetic field is not permanent
but changes (“flips”) after long time intervals. Eventually, Earth’s north magnetic pole may be located near its
geographic North Pole.]

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.1 • Magnetism and Its Historical Discoveries 481

Figure 11.2 The north pole of a compass needle points toward the south pole of a magnet, which is how today’s magnetic field is oriented
from inside Earth. It also points toward Earth’s geographic North Pole because the geographic North Pole is near the magnetic south pole.

Back in 1819, the Danish physicist Hans Oersted was performing a lecture demonstration for some students
and noticed that a compass needle moved whenever current flowed in a nearby wire. Further investigation of
this phenomenon convinced Oersted that an electric current could somehow cause a magnetic force. He
reported this finding to an 1820 meeting of the French Academy of Science.

Soon after this report, Oersted’s investigations were repeated and expanded upon by other scientists. Among
those whose work was especially important were Jean-Baptiste Biot and Felix Savart, who investigated the
forces exerted on magnets by currents; André Marie Ampère, who studied the forces exerted by one current on
another; François Arago, who found that iron could be magnetized by a current; and Humphry Davy, who
discovered that a magnet exerts a force on a wire carrying an electric current. Within 10 years of Oersted’s
discovery, Michael Faraday found that the relative motion of a magnet and a metallic wire induced current in
the wire. This finding showed not only that a current has a magnetic effect, but that a magnet can generate
electric current. You will see later that the names of Biot, Savart, Ampère, and Faraday are linked to some of
the fundamental laws of electromagnetism.

The evidence from these various experiments led Ampère to propose that electric current is the source of all
magnetic phenomena. To explain permanent magnets, he suggested that matter contains microscopic current
loops that are somehow aligned when a material is magnetized. Today, we know that permanent magnets are
actually created by the alignment of spinning electrons, a situation quite similar to that proposed by Ampère.
This model of permanent magnets was developed by Ampère almost a century before the atomic nature of
matter was understood. (For a full quantum mechanical treatment of magnetic spins, see Quantum Mechanics
and Atomic Structure.)

Contemporary Applications of Magnetism


Today, magnetism plays many important roles in our lives. Physicists’ understanding of magnetism has
enabled the development of technologies that affect both individuals and society. The electronic tablet in your
purse or backpack, for example, wouldn’t have been possible without the applications of magnetism and
electricity on a small scale (Figure 11.3). Weak changes in a magnetic field in a thin film of iron and chromium
were discovered to bring about much larger changes in resistance, called giant magnetoresistance.
Information can then be recorded magnetically based on the direction in which the iron layer is magnetized.
As a result of the discovery of giant magnetoresistance and its applications to digital storage, the 2007 Nobel
Prize in Physics was awarded to Albert Fert from France and Peter Grunberg from Germany.
482 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

Figure 11.3 Engineering technology like computer storage would not be possible without a deep understanding of magnetism. (credit:
Klaus Eifert)

All electric motors—with uses as diverse as powering refrigerators, starting cars, and moving
elevators—contain magnets. Generators, whether producing hydroelectric power or running bicycle lights, use
magnetic fields. Recycling facilities employ magnets to separate iron from other refuse. Research into using
magnetic containment of fusion as a future energy source has been continuing for several years. Magnetic
resonance imaging (MRI) has become an important diagnostic tool in the field of medicine, and the use of
magnetism to explore brain activity is a subject of contemporary research and development. The list of
applications also includes computer hard drives, tape recording, detection of inhaled asbestos, and levitation
of high-speed trains. Magnetism is involved in the structure of atomic energy levels, as well as the motion of
cosmic rays and charged particles trapped in the Van Allen belts around Earth. Once again, we see that all
these disparate phenomena are linked by a small number of underlying physical principles.

11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Define the magnetic field based on a moving charge experiencing a force
• Apply the right-hand rule to determine the direction of a magnetic force based on the motion of a charge in a
magnetic field
• Sketch magnetic field lines to understand which way the magnetic field points and how strong it is in a
region of space

We have outlined the properties of magnets, described how they behave, and listed some of the applications of
magnetic properties. Even though there are no such things as isolated magnetic charges, we can still define the
attraction and repulsion of magnets as based on a field. In this section, we define the magnetic field, determine
its direction based on the right-hand rule, and discuss how to draw magnetic field lines.

Defining the Magnetic Field


A magnetic field is defined by the force that a charged particle experiences moving in this field, after we
account for the gravitational and any additional electric forces possible on the charge. The magnitude of this
force is proportional to the amount of charge q, the speed of the charged particle v, and the magnitude of the
applied magnetic field. The direction of this force is perpendicular to both the direction of the moving charged
particle and the direction of the applied magnetic field. Based on these observations, we define the magnetic
field strength B based on the magnetic force on a charge q moving at velocity as the cross product of the
velocity and magnetic field, that is,

11.1

In fact, this is how we define the magnetic field —in terms of the force on a charged particle moving in a

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.2 • Magnetic Fields and Lines 483

magnetic field. The magnitude of the force is determined from the definition of the cross product as it relates
to the magnitudes of each of the vectors. In other words, the magnitude of the force satisfies

11.2

where θ is the angle between the velocity and the magnetic field.

The SI unit for magnetic field strength B is called the tesla (T) after the eccentric but brilliant inventor Nikola
Tesla (1856–1943), where

11.3

A smaller unit, called the gauss (G), where is sometimes used. The strongest permanent
magnets have fields near 2 T; superconducting electromagnets may attain 10 T or more. Earth’s magnetic field
on its surface is only about or 0.5 G.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Direction of the Magnetic Field by the Right-Hand Rule


The direction of the magnetic force is perpendicular to the plane formed by and as determined by the
right-hand rule-1 (or RHR-1), which is illustrated in Figure 11.4.

1. Orient your right hand so that your fingers curl in the plane defined by the velocity and magnetic field
vectors.
2. Using your right hand, sweep from the velocity toward the magnetic field with your fingers through the
smallest angle possible.
3. The magnetic force is directed where your thumb is pointing.
4. If the charge was negative, reverse the direction found by these steps.

Figure 11.4 Magnetic fields exert forces on moving charges. The direction of the magnetic force on a moving charge is perpendicular to
the plane formed by and and follows the right-hand rule-1 (RHR-1) as shown. The magnitude of the force is proportional to and
the sine of the angle between and

INTERACTIVE
Visit this website (https://openstax.org/l/21magfields) for additional practice with the direction of magnetic
fields.

There is no magnetic force on static charges. However, there is a magnetic force on charges moving at an angle
to a magnetic field. When charges are stationary, their electric fields do not affect magnets. However, when
charges move, they produce magnetic fields that exert forces on other magnets. When there is relative motion,
484 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

a connection between electric and magnetic forces emerges—each affects the other.

EXAMPLE 11.1

An Alpha-Particle Moving in a Magnetic Field


An alpha-particle moves through a uniform magnetic field whose magnitude is 1.5 T. The
field is directly parallel to the positive z-axis of the rectangular coordinate system of Figure 11.5. What is the
magnetic force on the alpha-particle when it is moving (a) in the positive x-direction with a speed of
(b) in the negative y-direction with a speed of (c) in the positive z-direction with
a speed of (d) with a velocity

Figure 11.5 The magnetic forces on an alpha-particle moving in a uniform magnetic field. The field is the same in each drawing, but the
velocity is different.

Strategy
We are given the charge, its velocity, and the magnetic field strength and direction. We can thus use the
equation or to calculate the force. The direction of the force is determined by
RHR-1.

Solution

a. First, to determine the direction, start with your fingers pointing in the positive x-direction. Sweep your
fingers upward in the direction of magnetic field. Your thumb should point in the negative y-direction.
This should match the mathematical answer. To calculate the force, we use the given charge, velocity, and
magnetic field and the definition of the magnetic force in cross-product form to calculate:

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.2 • Magnetic Fields and Lines 485

b. First, to determine the directionality, start with your fingers pointing in the negative y-direction. Sweep
your fingers upward in the direction of magnetic field as in the previous problem. Your thumb should be
open in the negative x-direction. This should match the mathematical answer. To calculate the force, we
use the given charge, velocity, and magnetic field and the definition of the magnetic force in cross-product
form to calculate:

An alternative approach is to use Equation 11.2 to find the magnitude of the force. This applies for both
parts (a) and (b). Since the velocity is perpendicular to the magnetic field, the angle between them is 90
degrees. Therefore, the magnitude of the force is:

c. Since the velocity and magnetic field are parallel to each other, there is no orientation of your hand that
will result in a force direction. Therefore, the force on this moving charge is zero. This is confirmed by the
cross product. When you cross two vectors pointing in the same direction, the result is equal to zero.
d. First, to determine the direction, your fingers could point in any orientation; however, you must sweep
your fingers upward in the direction of the magnetic field. As you rotate your hand, notice that the thumb
can point in any x- or y-direction possible, but not in the z-direction. This should match the mathematical
answer. To calculate the force, we use the given charge, velocity, and magnetic field and the definition of
the magnetic force in cross-product form to calculate:

This solution can be rewritten in terms of a magnitude and angle in the xy-plane:

The magnitude of the force can also be calculated using Equation 11.2. The velocity in this question,
however, has three components. The z-component of the velocity can be neglected, because it is parallel to
the magnetic field and therefore generates no force. The magnitude of the velocity is calculated from the x-
and y-components. The angle between the velocity in the xy-plane and the magnetic field in the z-plane is
90 degrees. Therefore, the force is calculated to be:

This is the same magnitude of force calculated by unit vectors.

Significance
The cross product in this formula results in a third vector that must be perpendicular to the other two. Other
physical quantities, such as angular momentum, also have three vectors that are related by the cross product.
Note that typical force values in magnetic force problems are much larger than the gravitational force.
Therefore, for an isolated charge, the magnetic force is the dominant force governing the charge’s motion.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.1


Repeat the previous problem with the magnetic field in the x-direction rather than in the z-direction. Check
your answers with RHR-1.
486 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

Representing Magnetic Fields


The representation of magnetic fields by magnetic field lines is very useful in visualizing the strength and
direction of the magnetic field. As shown in Figure 11.6, each of these lines forms a closed loop, even if not
shown by the constraints of the space available for the figure. The field lines emerge from the north pole (N),
loop around to the south pole (S), and continue through the bar magnet back to the north pole.

Magnetic field lines have several hard-and-fast rules:

1. The direction of the magnetic field is tangent to the field line at any point in space. A small compass will point
in the direction of the field line.
2. The strength of the field is proportional to the closeness of the lines. It is exactly proportional to the number of
lines per unit area perpendicular to the lines (called the areal density).
3. Magnetic field lines can never cross, meaning that the field is unique at any point in space.
4. Magnetic field lines are continuous, forming closed loops without a beginning or end. They are directed from
the north pole to the south pole.

The last property is related to the fact that the north and south poles cannot be separated. It is a distinct
difference from electric field lines, which generally begin on positive charges and end on negative charges or at
infinity. If isolated magnetic charges (referred to as magnetic monopoles) existed, then magnetic field lines
would begin and end on them.

Figure 11.6 Magnetic field lines are defined to have the direction in which a small compass points when placed at a location in the field.
The strength of the field is proportional to the closeness (or density) of the lines. If the interior of the magnet could be probed, the field
lines would be found to form continuous, closed loops. To fit in a reasonable space, some of these drawings may not show the closing of the
loops; however, if enough space were provided, the loops would be closed.

11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a Magnetic Field


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how a charged particle in an external magnetic field undergoes circular motion
• Describe how to determine the radius of the circular motion of a charged particle in a magnetic field

A charged particle experiences a force when moving through a magnetic field. What happens if this field is
uniform over the motion of the charged particle? What path does the particle follow? In this section, we discuss
the circular motion of the charged particle as well as other motion that results from a charged particle entering
a magnetic field.

The simplest case occurs when a charged particle moves perpendicular to a uniform B-field (Figure 11.7). If
the field is in a vacuum, the magnetic field is the dominant factor determining the motion. Since the magnetic
force is perpendicular to the direction of travel, a charged particle follows a curved path in a magnetic field.
The particle continues to follow this curved path until it forms a complete circle. Another way to look at this is

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.3 • Motion of a Charged Particle in a Magnetic Field 487

that the magnetic force is always perpendicular to velocity, so that it does no work on the charged particle. The
particle’s kinetic energy and speed thus remain constant. The direction of motion is affected but not the speed.

Figure 11.7 A negatively charged particle moves in the plane of the paper in a region where the magnetic field is perpendicular to the
paper (represented by the small ’s—like the tails of arrows). The magnetic force is perpendicular to the velocity, so velocity changes in
direction but not magnitude. The result is uniform circular motion. (Note that because the charge is negative, the force is opposite in
direction to the prediction of the right-hand rule.)

In this situation, the magnetic force supplies the centripetal force Noting that the velocity is
perpendicular to the magnetic field, the magnitude of the magnetic force is reduced to Because the
magnetic force F supplies the centripetal force we have

11.4

Solving for r yields

11.5

Here, r is the radius of curvature of the path of a charged particle with mass m and charge q, moving at a speed
v that is perpendicular to a magnetic field of strength B. The time for the charged particle to go around the
circular path is defined as the period, which is the same as the distance traveled (the circumference) divided
by the speed. Based on this and Equation 11.4, we can derive the period of motion as

11.6

If the velocity is not perpendicular to the magnetic field, then we can compare each component of the velocity
separately with the magnetic field. The component of the velocity perpendicular to the magnetic field
produces a magnetic force perpendicular to both this velocity and the field:

11.7

where is the angle between v and B. The component parallel to the magnetic field creates constant motion
along the same direction as the magnetic field, also shown in Equation 11.7. The parallel motion determines
the pitch p of the helix, which is the distance between adjacent turns. This distance equals the parallel
component of the velocity times the period:
488 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

11.8

The result is a helical motion, as shown in the following figure.

Figure 11.8 A charged particle moving with a velocity not in the same direction as the magnetic field. The velocity component
perpendicular to the magnetic field creates circular motion, whereas the component of the velocity parallel to the field moves the particle
along a straight line. The pitch is the horizontal distance between two consecutive circles. The resulting motion is helical.

While the charged particle travels in a helical path, it may enter a region where the magnetic field is not
uniform. In particular, suppose a particle travels from a region of strong magnetic field to a region of weaker
field, then back to a region of stronger field. The particle may reflect back before entering the stronger
magnetic field region. This is similar to a wave on a string traveling from a very light, thin string to a hard wall
and reflecting backward. If the reflection happens at both ends, the particle is trapped in a so-called magnetic
bottle.

Trapped particles in magnetic fields are found in the Van Allen radiation belts around Earth, which are part of
Earth’s magnetic field. These belts were discovered by James Van Allen while trying to measure the flux of
cosmic rays on Earth (high-energy particles that come from outside the solar system) to see whether this was
similar to the flux measured on Earth. Van Allen found that due to the contribution of particles trapped in
Earth’s magnetic field, the flux was much higher on Earth than in outer space. Aurorae, like the famous aurora
borealis (northern lights) in the Northern Hemisphere (Figure 11.9), are beautiful displays of light emitted as
ions recombine with electrons entering the atmosphere as they spiral along magnetic field lines. (The ions are
primarily oxygen and nitrogen atoms that are initially ionized by collisions with energetic particles in Earth’s
atmosphere.) Aurorae have also been observed on other planets, such as Jupiter and Saturn.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.3 • Motion of a Charged Particle in a Magnetic Field 489

Figure 11.9 (a) The Van Allen radiation belts around Earth trap ions produced by cosmic rays striking Earth’s atmosphere. (b) The
magnificent spectacle of the aurora borealis, or northern lights, glows in the northern sky above Bear Lake near Eielson Air Force Base,
Alaska. Shaped by Earth’s magnetic field, this light is produced by glowing molecules and ions of oxygen and nitrogen. (credit b:
modification of work by USAF Senior Airman Joshua Strang)

EXAMPLE 11.2

Beam Deflector
A research group is investigating short-lived radioactive isotopes. They need to design a way to transport
alpha-particles (helium nuclei) from where they are made to a place where they will collide with another
material to form an isotope. The beam of alpha-particles bends
through a 90-degree region with a uniform magnetic field of 0.050 T (Figure 11.10). (a) In what direction
should the magnetic field be applied? (b) How much time does it take the alpha-particles to traverse the
uniform magnetic field region?

Figure 11.10 Top view of the beam deflector setup.

Strategy

a. The direction of the magnetic field is shown by the RHR-1. Your fingers point in the direction of v, and your
thumb needs to point in the direction of the force, to the left. Therefore, since the alpha-particles are
positively charged, the magnetic field must point down.
490 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

b. The period of the alpha-particle going around the circle is

11.9

Because the particle is only going around a quarter of a circle, we can take 0.25 times the period to find the
time it takes to go around this path.

Solution

a. Let’s start by focusing on the alpha-particle entering the field near the bottom of the picture. First, point
your thumb up the page. In order for your palm to open to the left where the centripetal force (and hence
the magnetic force) points, your fingers need to change orientation until they point into the page. This is
the direction of the applied magnetic field.
b. The period of the charged particle going around a circle is calculated by using the given mass, charge, and
magnetic field in the problem. This works out to be

However, for the given problem, the alpha-particle goes around a quarter of the circle, so the time it takes
would be

Significance
This time may be quick enough to get to the material we would like to bombard, depending on how short-lived
the radioactive isotope is and continues to emit alpha-particles. If we could increase the magnetic field applied
in the region, this would shorten the time even more. The path the particles need to take could be shortened,
but this may not be economical given the experimental setup.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.2


A uniform magnetic field of magnitude 1.5 T is directed horizontally from west to east. (a) What is the magnetic
force on a proton at the instant when it is moving vertically downward in the field with a speed of
(b) Compare this force with the weight w of a proton.

EXAMPLE 11.3

Helical Motion in a Magnetic Field


A proton enters a uniform magnetic field of with a speed of At what angle must the
magnetic field be from the velocity so that the pitch of the resulting helical motion is equal to the radius of the
helix?

Strategy
The pitch of the motion relates to the parallel velocity times the period of the circular motion, whereas the
radius relates to the perpendicular velocity component. After setting the radius and the pitch equal to each
other, solve for the angle between the magnetic field and velocity or

Solution
The pitch is given by Equation 11.8, the period is given by Equation 11.6, and the radius of circular motion is
given by Equation 11.5. Note that the velocity in the radius equation is related to only the perpendicular
velocity, which is where the circular motion occurs. Therefore, we substitute the sine component of the overall
velocity into the radius equation to equate the pitch and radius:

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.4 • Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor 491

Significance
If this angle were only parallel velocity would occur and the helix would not form, because there would be
no circular motion in the perpendicular plane. If this angle were only circular motion would occur and
there would be no movement of the circles perpendicular to the motion. That is what creates the helical
motion.

11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Determine the direction in which a current-carrying wire experiences a force in an external magnetic field
• Calculate the force on a current-carrying wire in an external magnetic field

Moving charges experience a force in a magnetic field. If these moving charges are in a wire—that is, if the wire
is carrying a current—the wire should also experience a force. However, before we discuss the force exerted on
a current by a magnetic field, we first examine the magnetic field generated by an electric current. We are
studying two separate effects here that interact closely: A current-carrying wire generates a magnetic field and
the magnetic field exerts a force on the current-carrying wire.

Magnetic Fields Produced by Electrical Currents


When discussing historical discoveries in magnetism, we mentioned Oersted’s finding that a wire carrying an
electrical current caused a nearby compass to deflect. A connection was established that electrical currents
produce magnetic fields. (This connection between electricity and magnetism is discussed in more detail in
Sources of Magnetic Fields.)

The compass needle near the wire experiences a force that aligns the needle tangent to a circle around the
wire. Therefore, a current-carrying wire produces circular loops of magnetic field. To determine the direction
of the magnetic field generated from a wire, we use a second right-hand rule. In RHR-2, your thumb points in
the direction of the current while your fingers wrap around the wire, pointing in the direction of the magnetic
field produced (Figure 11.11). If the magnetic field were coming at you or out of the page, we represent this
with a dot. If the magnetic field were going into the page, we represent this with an These symbols come
from considering a vector arrow: An arrow pointed toward you, from your perspective, would look like a dot or
the tip of an arrow. An arrow pointed away from you, from your perspective, would look like a cross or an A
composite sketch of the magnetic circles is shown in Figure 11.11, where the field strength is shown to
decrease as you get farther from the wire by loops that are farther separated.
492 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

Figure 11.11 (a) When the wire is in the plane of the paper, the field is perpendicular to the paper. Note the symbols used for the field
pointing inward (like the tail of an arrow) and the field pointing outward (like the tip of an arrow). (b) A long and straight wire creates a field
with magnetic field lines forming circular loops.

Calculating the Magnetic Force


Electric current is an ordered movement of charge. A current-carrying wire in a magnetic field must therefore
experience a force due to the field. To investigate this force, let’s consider the infinitesimal section of wire as
shown in Figure 11.12. The length and cross-sectional area of the section are dl and A, respectively, so its
volume is The wire is formed from material that contains n charge carriers per unit volume, so the
number of charge carriers in the section is If the charge carriers move with drift velocity the
current I in the wire is (from Current and Resistance)

The magnetic force on any single charge carrier is so the total magnetic force on the
charge carriers in the section of wire is

11.10

We can define dl to be a vector of length dl pointing along which allows us to rewrite this equation as

11.11

or

11.12

This is the magnetic force on the section of wire. Note that it is actually the net force exerted by the field on the
charge carriers themselves. The direction of this force is given by RHR-1, where you point your fingers in the
direction of the current and curl them toward the field. Your thumb then points in the direction of the force.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.4 • Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor 493

Figure 11.12 An infinitesimal section of current-carrying wire in a magnetic field.

To determine the magnetic force on a wire of arbitrary length and shape, we must integrate Equation 11.12
over the entire wire. If the wire section happens to be straight and B is uniform, the equation differentials
become absolute quantities, giving us

11.13

This is the force on a straight, current-carrying wire in a uniform magnetic field.

EXAMPLE 11.4

Balancing the Gravitational and Magnetic Forces on a Current-Carrying Wire


A wire of length 50 cm and mass 10 g is suspended in a horizontal plane by a pair of flexible leads (Figure
11.13). The wire is then subjected to a constant magnetic field of magnitude 0.50 T, which is directed as shown.
What are the magnitude and direction of the current in the wire needed to remove the tension in the
supporting leads?

Figure 11.13 (a) A wire suspended in a magnetic field. (b) The free-body diagram for the wire.

Strategy
From the free-body diagram in the figure, the tensions in the supporting leads go to zero when the
gravitational and magnetic forces balance each other. Using the RHR-1, we find that the magnetic force points
up. We can then determine the current I by equating the two forces.
494 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

Solution
Equate the two forces of weight and magnetic force on the wire:

Thus,

Significance
This large magnetic field creates a significant force on a length of wire to counteract the weight of the wire.

EXAMPLE 11.5

Calculating Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Wire


A long, rigid wire lying along the y-axis carries a 5.0-A current flowing in the positive y-direction. (a) If a
constant magnetic field of magnitude 0.30 T is directed along the positive x-axis, what is the magnetic force
per unit length on the wire? (b) If a constant magnetic field of 0.30 T is directed 30 degrees from the +x-axis
towards the +y-axis, what is the magnetic force per unit length on the wire?

Strategy
The magnetic force on a current-carrying wire in a magnetic field is given by For part a, since
the current and magnetic field are perpendicular in this problem, we can simplify the formula to give us the
magnitude and find the direction through the RHR-1. The angle θ is 90 degrees, which means Also,
the length can be divided over to the left-hand side to find the force per unit length. For part b, the current
times length is written in unit vector notation, as well as the magnetic field. After the cross product is taken,
the directionality is evident by the resulting unit vector.

Solution

a. We start with the general formula for the magnetic force on a wire. We are looking for the force per unit
length, so we divide by the length to bring it to the left-hand side. We also set The solution
therefore is

Directionality: Point your fingers in the positive y-direction and curl your fingers in the positive
x-direction. Your thumb will point in the direction. Therefore, with directionality, the solution is

b. The current times length and the magnetic field are written in unit vector notation. Then, we take the cross
product to find the force:

Significance
This large magnetic field creates a significant force on a small length of wire. As the angle of the magnetic field
becomes more closely aligned to the current in the wire, there is less of a force on it, as seen from comparing
parts a and b.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.4 • Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying Conductor 495

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.3


A straight, flexible length of copper wire is immersed in a magnetic field that is directed into the page. (a) If the
wire’s current runs in the +x-direction, which way will the wire bend? (b) Which way will the wire bend if the
current runs in the –x-direction?

EXAMPLE 11.6

Force on a Circular Wire


A circular current loop of radius R carrying a current I is placed in the xy-plane. A constant uniform magnetic
field cuts through the loop parallel to the y-axis (Figure 11.14). Find the magnetic force on the upper half of the
loop, the lower half of the loop, and the total force on the loop.

Figure 11.14 A loop of wire carrying a current in a magnetic field.

Strategy
The magnetic force on the upper loop should be written in terms of the differential force acting on each
segment of the loop. If we integrate over each differential piece, we solve for the overall force on that section of
the loop. The force on the lower loop is found in a similar manner, and the total force is the addition of these
two forces.

Solution
A differential force on an arbitrary piece of wire located on the upper ring is:

where is the angle between the magnetic field direction (+y) and the segment of wire. A differential segment
is located at the same radius, so using an arc-length formula, we have:

In order to find the force on a segment, we integrate over the upper half of the circle, from 0 to This results
in:

The lower half of the loop is integrated from to zero, giving us:

The net force is the sum of these forces, which is zero.


496 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

Significance
The total force on any closed loop in a uniform magnetic field is zero. Even though each piece of the loop has a
force acting on it, the net force on the system is zero. (Note that there is a net torque on the loop, which we
consider in the next section.)

11.5 Force and Torque on a Current Loop


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Evaluate the net force on a current loop in an external magnetic field
• Evaluate the net torque on a current loop in an external magnetic field
• Define the magnetic dipole moment of a current loop

Motors are the most common application of magnetic force on current-carrying wires. Motors contain loops of
wire in a magnetic field. When current is passed through the loops, the magnetic field exerts torque on the
loops, which rotates a shaft. Electrical energy is converted into mechanical work in the process. Once the loop’s
surface area is aligned with the magnetic field, the direction of current is reversed, so there is a continual
torque on the loop (Figure 11.15). This reversal of the current is done with commutators and brushes. The
commutator is set to reverse the current flow at set points to keep continual motion in the motor. A basic
commutator has three contact areas to avoid and dead spots where the loop would have zero instantaneous
torque at that point. The brushes press against the commutator, creating electrical contact between parts of
the commutator during the spinning motion.

Figure 11.15 A simplified version of a dc electric motor. (a) The rectangular wire loop is placed in a magnetic field. The forces on the wires
closest to the magnetic poles (N and S) are opposite in direction as determined by the right-hand rule-1. Therefore, the loop has a net
torque and rotates to the position shown in (b). (b) The brushes now touch the commutator segments so that no current flows through the
loop. No torque acts on the loop, but the loop continues to spin from the initial velocity given to it in part (a). By the time the loop flips over,
current flows through the wires again but now in the opposite direction, and the process repeats as in part (a). This causes continual
rotation of the loop.

In a uniform magnetic field, a current-carrying loop of wire, such as a loop in a motor, experiences both forces
and torques on the loop. Figure 11.16 shows a rectangular loop of wire that carries a current I and has sides of
lengths a and b. The loop is in a uniform magnetic field: The magnetic force on a straight current-
carrying wire of length l is given by To find the net force on the loop, we have to apply this equation to
each of the four sides. The force on side 1 is

11.14

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.5 • Force and Torque on a Current Loop 497

where the direction has been determined with the RHR-1. The current in side 3 flows in the opposite direction
to that of side 1, so

11.15

The currents in sides 2 and 4 are perpendicular to and the forces on these sides are

11.16

We can now find the net force on the loop:

11.17

Although this result has been obtained for a rectangular loop, it is far more general and holds for
current-carrying loops of arbitrary shapes; that is, there is no net force on a current loop in a uniform
magnetic field.

Figure 11.16 (a) A rectangular current loop in a uniform magnetic field is subjected to a net torque but not a net force. (b) A side view of
the coil.

To find the net torque on the current loop shown in Figure 11.16, we first consider and Since they have
the same line of action and are equal and opposite, the sum of their torques about any axis is zero (see Fixed-
Axis Rotation). Thus, if there is any torque on the loop, it must be furnished by and Let’s calculate the
torques around the axis that passes through point O of Figure 11.16 (a side view of the coil) and is
perpendicular to the plane of the page. The point O is a distance x from side 2 and a distance from side
4 of the loop. The moment arms of and are and respectively, so the net torque on the
loop is

11.18

This simplifies to

11.19

where is the area of the loop.

Notice that this torque is independent of x; it is therefore independent of where point O is located in the plane
of the current loop. Consequently, the loop experiences the same torque from the magnetic field about any axis
in the plane of the loop and parallel to the x-axis.

A closed-current loop is commonly referred to as a magnetic dipole and the term IA is known as its magnetic
dipole moment Actually, the magnetic dipole moment is a vector that is defined as

11.20
498 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

where is a unit vector directed perpendicular to the plane of the loop (see Figure 11.16). The direction of is
obtained with the RHR-2—if you curl the fingers of your right hand in the direction of current flow in the loop,
then your thumb points along If the loop contains N turns of wire, then its magnetic dipole moment is given
by

11.21

In terms of the magnetic dipole moment, the torque on a current loop due to a uniform magnetic field can be
written simply as

11.22

This equation holds for a current loop in a two-dimensional plane of arbitrary shape.

Using a calculation analogous to that found in Capacitance for an electric dipole, the potential energy of a
magnetic dipole is

11.23

EXAMPLE 11.7

Forces and Torques on Current-Carrying Loops


A circular current loop of radius 2.0 cm carries a current of 2.0 mA. (a) What is the magnitude of its magnetic
dipole moment? (b) If the dipole is oriented at 30 degrees to a uniform magnetic field of magnitude 0.50 T,
what is the magnitude of the torque it experiences and what is its potential energy?

Strategy
The dipole moment is defined by the current times the area of the loop. The area of the loop can be calculated
from the area of the circle. The torque on the loop and potential energy are calculated from identifying the
magnetic moment, magnetic field, and angle oriented in the field.

Solution

a. The magnetic moment μ is calculated by the current times the area of the loop or

b. The torque and potential energy are calculated by identifying the magnetic moment, magnetic field, and
the angle between these two vectors. The calculations of these quantities are:

Significance
The concept of magnetic moment at the atomic level is discussed in the next chapter. The concept of aligning
the magnetic moment with the magnetic field is the functionality of devices like magnetic motors, whereby
switching the external magnetic field results in a constant spinning of the loop as it tries to align with the field
to minimize its potential energy.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.4


In what orientation would a magnetic dipole have to be to produce (a) a maximum torque in a magnetic field?
(b) A maximum energy of the dipole?

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.6 • The Hall Effect 499

11.6 The Hall Effect


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain a scenario where the magnetic and electric fields are crossed and their forces balance each other as
a charged particle moves through a velocity selector
• Compare how charge carriers move in a conductive material and explain how this relates to the Hall effect

In 1879, E.H. Hall devised an experiment that can be used to identify the sign of the predominant charge
carriers in a conducting material. From a historical perspective, this experiment was the first to demonstrate
that the charge carriers in most metals are negative.

INTERACTIVE
Visit this website (https://openstax.org/l/21halleffect) to find more information about the Hall effect.

We investigate the Hall effect by studying the motion of the free electrons along a metallic strip of width l in a
constant magnetic field (Figure 11.17). The electrons are moving from left to right, so the magnetic force they
experience pushes them to the bottom edge of the strip. This leaves an excess of positive charge at the top edge
of the strip, resulting in an electric field E directed from top to bottom. The charge concentration at both edges
builds up until the electric force on the electrons in one direction is balanced by the magnetic force on them in
the opposite direction. Equilibrium is reached when:
11.24
where e is the magnitude of the electron charge, is the drift speed of the electrons, and E is the magnitude of
the electric field created by the separated charge. Solving this for the drift speed results in

11.25

Figure 11.17 In the Hall effect, a potential difference between the top and bottom edges of the metal strip is produced when moving
charge carriers are deflected by the magnetic field. (a) Hall effect for negative charge carriers; (b) Hall effect for positive charge carriers.

A scenario where the electric and magnetic fields are perpendicular to one another is called a crossed-field
situation. If these fields produce equal and opposite forces on a charged particle with the velocity that equates
the forces, these particles are able to pass through an apparatus, called a velocity selector, undeflected. This
velocity is represented in Equation 11.26. Any other velocity of a charged particle sent into the same fields
would be deflected by the magnetic force or electric force.

Going back to the Hall effect, if the current in the strip is I, then from Current and Resistance, we know that
11.26
where n is the number of charge carriers per volume and A is the cross-sectional area of the strip. Combining
the equations for and I results in
500 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

11.27

The field E is related to the potential difference V between the edges of the strip by

11.28

The quantity V is called the Hall potential and can be measured with a voltmeter. Finally, combining the
equations for I and E gives us

11.29

where the upper edge of the strip in Figure 11.17 is positive with respect to the lower edge.

We can also combine Equation 11.24 and Equation 11.28 to get an expression for the Hall voltage in terms of
the magnetic field:

11.30

What if the charge carriers are positive, as in Figure 11.17? For the same current I, the magnitude of V is still
given by Equation 11.29. However, the upper edge is now negative with respect to the lower edge. Therefore, by
simply measuring the sign of V, we can determine the sign of the majority charge carriers in a metal.

Hall potential measurements show that electrons are the dominant charge carriers in most metals. However,
Hall potentials indicate that for a few metals, such as tungsten, beryllium, and many semiconductors, the
majority of charge carriers are positive. It turns out that conduction by positive charge is caused by the
migration of missing electron sites (called holes) on ions. Conduction by holes is studied later in Condensed
Matter Physics.

The Hall effect can be used to measure magnetic fields. If a material with a known density of charge carriers n
is placed in a magnetic field and V is measured, then the field can be determined from Equation 11.29. In
research laboratories where the fields of electromagnets used for precise measurements have to be extremely
steady, a “Hall probe” is commonly used as part of an electronic circuit that regulates the field.

EXAMPLE 11.8

Velocity Selector
An electron beam enters a crossed-field velocity selector with magnetic and electric fields of 2.0 mT and
respectively. (a) What must the velocity of the electron beam be to traverse the crossed fields
undeflected? If the electric field is turned off, (b) what is the acceleration of the electron beam and (c) what is
the radius of the circular motion that results?

Strategy
The electron beam is not deflected by either of the magnetic or electric fields if these forces are balanced.
Based on these balanced forces, we calculate the velocity of the beam. Without the electric field, only the
magnetic force is used in Newton’s second law to find the acceleration. Lastly, the radius of the path is based on
the resulting circular motion from the magnetic force.

Solution

a. The velocity of the unperturbed beam of electrons with crossed fields is calculated by Equation 11.25:

b. The acceleration is calculated from the net force from the magnetic field, equal to mass times acceleration.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.6 • The Hall Effect 501

The magnitude of the acceleration is:

c. The radius of the path comes from a balance of the circular and magnetic forces, or Equation 11.25:

Significance
If electrons in the beam had velocities above or below the answer in part (a), those electrons would have a
stronger net force exerted by either the magnetic or electric field. Therefore, only those electrons at this
specific velocity would make it through.

EXAMPLE 11.9

The Hall Potential in a Silver Ribbon


Figure 11.18 shows a silver ribbon whose cross section is 1.0 cm by 0.20 cm. The ribbon carries a current of
100 A from left to right, and it lies in a uniform magnetic field of magnitude 1.5 T. Using a density value of
electrons per cubic meter for silver, find the Hall potential between the edges of the ribbon.

Figure 11.18 Finding the Hall potential in a silver ribbon in a magnetic field is shown.

Strategy
Since the majority of charge carriers are electrons, the polarity of the Hall voltage is that indicated in the figure.
The value of the Hall voltage is calculated using Equation 11.29:

Solution
When calculating the Hall voltage, we need to know the current through the material, the magnetic field, the
length, the number of charge carriers, and the area. Since all of these are given, the Hall voltage is calculated
as:

Significance
As in this example, the Hall potential is generally very small, and careful experimentation with sensitive
equipment is required for its measurement.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.5


A Hall probe consists of a copper strip, electrons per cubic meter, which is 2.0 cm wide and
502 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

0.10 cm thick. What is the magnetic field when I = 50 A and the Hall potential is (a) and (b)

11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and Fields


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how a mass spectrometer works to separate charges
• Explain how a cyclotron works

Being able to manipulate and sort charged particles allows deeper experimentation to understand what matter
is made of. We first look at a mass spectrometer to see how we can separate ions by their charge-to-mass ratio.
Then we discuss cyclotrons as a method to accelerate charges to very high energies.

Mass Spectrometer
The mass spectrometer is a device that separates ions according to their charge-to-mass ratios. One
particular version, the Bainbridge mass spectrometer, is illustrated in Figure 11.19. Ions produced at a source
are first sent through a velocity selector, where the magnetic force is equally balanced with the electric force.
These ions all emerge with the same speed since any ion with a different velocity is deflected
preferentially by either the electric or magnetic force, and ultimately blocked from the next stage. They then
enter a uniform magnetic field where they travel in a circular path whose radius R is given by Equation
11.3. The radius is measured by a particle detector located as shown in the figure.

Figure 11.19 A schematic of the Bainbridge mass spectrometer, showing charged particles leaving a source, followed by a velocity
selector where the electric and magnetic forces are balanced, followed by a region of uniform magnetic field where the particle is ultimately
detected.

The relationship between the charge-to-mass ratio q/m and the radius R is determined by combining Equation
11.3 and Equation 11.25:

11.31

Since most ions are singly charged measured values of R can be used with this equation

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.7 • Applications of Magnetic Forces and Fields 503

to determine the mass of ions. With modern instruments, masses can be determined to one part in

An interesting use of a spectrometer is as part of a system for detecting very small leaks in a research
apparatus. In low-temperature physics laboratories, a device known as a dilution refrigerator uses a mixture of
He-3, He-4, and other cryogens to reach temperatures well below 1 K. The performance of the refrigerator is
severely hampered if even a minute leak between its various components occurs. Consequently, before it is
cooled down to the desired temperature, the refrigerator is subjected to a leak test. A small quantity of gaseous
helium is injected into one of its compartments, while an adjacent, but supposedly isolated, compartment is
connected to a high-vacuum pump to which a mass spectrometer is attached. A heated filament ionizes any
helium atoms evacuated by the pump. The detection of these ions by the spectrometer then indicates a leak
between the two compartments of the dilution refrigerator.

In conjunction with gas chromatography, mass spectrometers are used widely to identify unknown
substances. While the gas chromatography portion breaks down the substance, the mass spectrometer
separates the resulting ionized molecules. This technique is used with fire debris to ascertain the cause, in law
enforcement to identify illegal drugs, in security to identify explosives, and in many medicinal applications.

Cyclotron
The cyclotron was developed by E.O. Lawrence to accelerate charged particles (usually protons, deuterons, or
alpha-particles) to large kinetic energies. These particles are then used for nuclear-collision experiments to
produce radioactive isotopes. A cyclotron is illustrated in Figure 11.20. The particles move between two flat,
semi-cylindrical metallic containers D1 and D2, called dees. The dees are enclosed in a larger metal container,
and the apparatus is placed between the poles of an electromagnet that provides a uniform magnetic field. Air
is removed from the large container so that the particles neither lose energy nor are deflected because of
collisions with air molecules. The dees are connected to a high-frequency voltage source that provides an
alternating electric field in the small region between them. Because the dees are made of metal, their interiors
are shielded from the electric field.

Figure 11.20 The inside of a cyclotron. A uniform magnetic field is applied as circulating protons travel through the dees, gaining energy
as they traverse through the gap between the dees.

Suppose a positively charged particle is injected into the gap between the dees when D2 is at a positive
potential relative to D1. The particle is then accelerated across the gap and enters D1 after gaining kinetic
energy qV, where V is the average potential difference the particle experiences between the dees. When the
particle is inside D1, only the uniform magnetic field of the electromagnet acts on it, so the particle moves in
a circle of radius

11.32

with a period of
504 11 • Magnetic Forces and Fields

11.33

The period of the alternating voltage course is set at T, so while the particle is inside D1, moving along its
semicircular orbit in a time T/2, the polarity of the dees is reversed. When the particle reenters the gap, D1 is
positive with respect to D2, and the particle is again accelerated across the gap, thereby gaining a kinetic
energy qV. The particle then enters D2, circulates in a slightly larger circle, and emerges from D2 after
spending a time T/2 in this dee. This process repeats until the orbit of the particle reaches the boundary of the
dees. At that point, the particle (actually, a beam of particles) is extracted from the cyclotron and used for some
experimental purpose.

The operation of the cyclotron depends on the fact that, in a uniform magnetic field, a particle’s orbital period
is independent of its radius and its kinetic energy. Consequently, the period of the alternating voltage source
need only be set at the one value given by Equation 11.33. With that setting, the electric field accelerates
particles every time they are between the dees.

If the maximum orbital radius in the cyclotron is R, then from Equation 11.32, the maximum speed of a
circulating particle of mass m and charge q is

11.34

Thus, its kinetic energy when ejected from the cyclotron is

11.35

The maximum kinetic energy attainable with this type of cyclotron is approximately 30 MeV. Above this
energy, relativistic effects become important, which causes the orbital period to increase with the radius. Up to
energies of several hundred MeV, the relativistic effects can be compensated for by making the magnetic field
gradually increase with the radius of the orbit. However, for higher energies, much more elaborate methods
must be used to accelerate particles.

Particles are accelerated to very high energies with either linear accelerators or synchrotrons. The linear
accelerator accelerates particles continuously with the electric field of an electromagnetic wave that travels
down a long evacuated tube. The Stanford Linear Accelerator (SLAC) is about 3.3 km long and accelerates
electrons and positrons (positively charged electrons) to energies of 50 GeV. The synchrotron is constructed so
that its bending magnetic field increases with particle speed in such a way that the particles stay in an orbit of
fixed radius. The world’s highest-energy synchrotron is located at CERN, which is on the Swiss-French border
near Geneva. CERN has been of recent interest with the verified discovery of the Higgs Boson (see Particle
Physics and Cosmology). This synchrotron can accelerate beams of approximately protons to energies of
about GeV.

EXAMPLE 11.10

Accelerating Alpha-Particles in a Cyclotron


A cyclotron used to accelerate alpha-particles ( ) has a radius of 0.50
m and a magnetic field of 1.8 T. (a) What is the period of revolution of the alpha-particles? (b) What is their
maximum kinetic energy?

Strategy

a. The period of revolution is approximately the distance traveled in a circle divided by the speed. Identifying
that the magnetic force applied is the centripetal force, we can derive the period formula.
b. The kinetic energy can be found from the maximum speed of the beam, corresponding to the maximum
radius within the cyclotron.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11.7 • Applications of Magnetic Forces and Fields 505

Solution

a. By identifying the mass, charge, and magnetic field in the problem, we can calculate the period:

b. By identifying the charge, magnetic field, radius of path, and the mass, we can calculate the maximum
kinetic energy:

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 11.6


A cyclotron is to be designed to accelerate protons to kinetic energies of 20 MeV using a magnetic field of 2.0 T.
What is the required radius of the cyclotron?
506 11 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
cosmic rays comprised of particles that originate current is passed through the loops, the magnetic
mainly from outside the solar system and reach field exerts torque on the loops, which rotates a
Earth shaft; electrical energy is converted into
cyclotron device used to accelerate charged mechanical work in the process
particles to large kinetic energies north magnetic pole currently where a compass
dees large metal containers used in cyclotrons that points to north, near the geographic North Pole;
serve contain a stream of charged particles as this is the effective south pole of a bar magnet but
their speed is increased has flipped between the effective north and south
gauss G, unit of the magnetic field strength; poles of a bar magnet multiple times over the age
of Earth
Hall effect creation of voltage across a current- right-hand rule-1 using your right hand to
carrying conductor by a magnetic field determine the direction of either the magnetic
helical motion superposition of circular motion force, velocity of a charged particle, or magnetic
with a straight-line motion that is followed by a field
charged particle moving in a region of magnetic south magnetic pole currently where a compass
field at an angle to the field points to the south, near the geographic South
magnetic dipole closed-current loop Pole; this is the effective north pole of a bar
magnetic dipole moment term IA of the magnetic magnet but has flipped just like the north
dipole, also called magnetic pole
magnetic field lines continuous curves that show tesla SI unit for magnetic field: 1 T = 1 N/A-m
the direction of a magnetic field; these lines point velocity selector apparatus where the crossed
in the same direction as a compass points, toward electric and magnetic fields produce equal and
the magnetic south pole of a bar magnet opposite forces on a charged particle moving with
magnetic force force applied to a charged particle a specific velocity; this particle moves through
moving through a magnetic field the velocity selector not affected by either field
mass spectrometer device that separates ions while particles moving with different velocities
according to their charge-to-mass ratios are deflected by the apparatus
motor (dc) loop of wire in a magnetic field; when

Key Equations

Force on a charge in a magnetic field

Magnitude of magnetic force

Radius of a particle’s path in a magnetic field

Period of a particle’s motion in a magnetic field

Force on a current-carrying wire in a uniform magnetic field

Magnetic dipole moment

Torque on a current loop

Energy of a magnetic dipole

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 507

Drift velocity in crossed electric and magnetic fields

Hall potential

Hall potential in terms of drift velocity

Charge-to-mass ratio in a mass spectrometer

Maximum speed of a particle in a cyclotron

Summary
11.1 Magnetism and Its Historical 11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a
Discoveries Magnetic Field
• Magnets have two types of magnetic poles, • A magnetic force can supply centripetal force
called the north magnetic pole and the south and cause a charged particle to move in a
magnetic pole. North magnetic poles are those circular path of radius
that are attracted toward Earth’s geographic • The period of circular motion for a charged
North Pole. particle moving in a magnetic field
• Like poles repel and unlike poles attract. perpendicular to the plane of motion is
• Discoveries of how magnets respond to currents
by Oersted and others created a framework that
• Helical motion results if the velocity of the
led to the invention of modern electronic
charged particle has a component parallel to the
devices, electric motors, and magnetic imaging
magnetic field as well as a component
technology.
perpendicular to the magnetic field.
11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines
11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying
• Charges moving across a magnetic field Conductor
experience a force determined by
• An electrical current produces a magnetic field
The force is perpendicular to the plane formed
around the wire.
by and
• The directionality of the magnetic field
• The direction of the force on a moving charge is
produced is determined by the right hand
given by the right hand rule 1 (RHR-1): Sweep
rule-2, where your thumb points in the direction
your fingers in a velocity, magnetic field plane.
of the current and your fingers wrap around the
Start by pointing them in the direction of
wire in the direction of the magnetic field.
velocity and sweep towards the magnetic field.
• The magnetic force on current-carrying
Your thumb points in the direction of the
conductors is given by where I is
magnetic force for positive charges.
the current and l is the length of a wire in a
• Magnetic fields can be pictorially represented by
uniform magnetic field B.
magnetic field lines, which have the following
properties: 11.5 Force and Torque on a Current Loop
1. The field is tangent to the magnetic field line.
2. Field strength is proportional to the line • The net force on a current-carrying loop of any
density. plane shape in a uniform magnetic field is zero.
3. Field lines cannot cross. • The net torque τ on a current-carrying loop of
4. Field lines form continuous, closed loops. any shape in a uniform magnetic field is
calculated using where is the
• Magnetic poles always occur in pairs of north
magnetic dipole moment and is the magnetic
and south—it is not possible to isolate north and
field strength.
south poles.
• The magnetic dipole moment is the product of
508 11 • Chapter Review

the number of turns of wire N, the current in the can also be used to measure a magnetic field.
loop I, and the area of the loop A or
11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and
11.6 The Hall Effect Fields
• Perpendicular electric and magnetic fields exert • A mass spectrometer is a device that separates
equal and opposite forces for a specific velocity ions according to their charge-to-mass ratios by
of entering particles, thereby acting as a velocity first sending them through a velocity selector,
selector. The velocity that passes through then a uniform magnetic field.
undeflected is calculated by • Cyclotrons are used to accelerate charged
• The Hall effect can be used to measure the sign particles to large kinetic energies through
of the majority of charge carriers for metals. It applied electric and magnetic fields.

Conceptual Questions
11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines electromagnet is north and which pole is south?

1. Discuss the similarities and differences between


11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying
the electrical force on a charge and the magnetic
force on a charge.
Conductor
2. (a) Is it possible for the magnetic force on a 8. Describe the error that results from accidently
charge moving in a magnetic field to be zero? (b) using your left rather than your right hand when
Is it possible for the electric force on a charge determining the direction of a magnetic force.
moving in an electric field to be zero? (c) Is it 9. Considering the magnetic force law, are the
possible for the resultant of the electric and velocity and magnetic field always
magnetic forces on a charge moving perpendicular? Are the force and velocity always
simultaneously through both fields to be zero? perpendicular? What about the force and
magnetic field?
11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a 10. Why can a nearby magnet distort a cathode ray
Magnetic Field tube television picture?
11. A magnetic field exerts a force on the moving
3. At a given instant, an electron and a proton are
electrons in a current carrying wire. What
moving with the same velocity in a constant
exerts the force on a wire?
magnetic field. Compare the magnetic forces on
12. There are regions where the magnetic field of
these particles. Compare their accelerations.
earth is almost perpendicular to the surface of
4. Does increasing the magnitude of a uniform
Earth. What difficulty does this cause in the use
magnetic field through which a charge is
of a compass?
traveling necessarily mean increasing the
magnetic force on the charge? Does changing the
11.6 The Hall Effect
direction of the field necessarily mean a change
in the force on the charge? 13. Hall potentials are much larger for poor
5. An electron passes through a magnetic field conductors than for good conductors. Why?
without being deflected. What do you conclude
about the magnetic field? 11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and
6. If a charged particle moves in a straight line, can Fields
you conclude that there is no magnetic field
14. Describe the primary function of the electric
present?
field and the magnetic field in a cyclotron.
7. How could you determine which pole of an

Problems
11.2 Magnetic Fields and Lines
15. What is the direction of the magnetic force on a
positive charge that moves as shown in each of
the six cases?

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 509

18. Repeat previous exercise for a positive charge.


19. What is the direction of the magnetic field that
produces the magnetic force on a positive
charge as shown in each of the three cases,
assuming is perpendicular to ?

16. Repeat previous exercise for a negative charge.


17. What is the direction of the velocity of a negative
charge that experiences the magnetic force
shown in each of the three cases, assuming it
moves perpendicular to B?

20. Repeat previous exercise for a negative charge.


21. (a) Aircraft sometimes acquire small static
charges. Suppose a supersonic jet has a
0.500-μC charge and flies due west at a speed of
660. m/s over Earth’s south magnetic pole,
where the magnetic field
points straight down into the ground. What are
the direction and the magnitude of the magnetic
510 11 • Chapter Review

force on the plane? (b) Discuss whether the radius. What positive charge is on the ion? (b)
value obtained in part (a) implies this is a What is the ratio of this charge to the charge of
significant or negligible effect. an electron? (c) Discuss why the ratio found in
22. (a) A cosmic ray proton moving toward Earth at (b) should be an integer.
experiences a magnetic force of 28. An electron in a TV CRT moves with a speed of
What is the strength of the in a direction perpendicular to
magnetic field if there is a 45º angle between it Earth’s field, which has a strength of
and the proton’s velocity? (b) Is the value (a) What strength electric field
obtained in part a. consistent with the known must be applied perpendicular to the Earth’s
strength of Earth’s magnetic field on its surface? field to make the electron moves in a straight
Discuss. line? (b) If this is done between plates separated
23. An electron moving at in a by 1.00 cm, what is the voltage applied? (Note
1.25-T magnetic field experiences a magnetic that TVs are usually surrounded by a
force of What angle does the ferromagnetic material to shield against
velocity of the electron make with the magnetic external magnetic fields and avoid the need for
field? There are two answers. such a correction.)
24. (a) A physicist performing a sensitive 29. (a) At what speed will a proton move in a
measurement wants to limit the magnetic force circular path of the same radius as the electron
on a moving charge in her equipment to less in the previous exercise? (b) What would the
than What is the greatest the radius of the path be if the proton had the same
charge can be if it moves at a maximum speed speed as the electron? (c) What would the radius
of 30.0 m/s in Earth’s field? (b) Discuss whether be if the proton had the same kinetic energy as
it would be difficult to limit the charge to less the electron? (d) The same momentum?
than the value found in (a) by comparing it with 30. (a) What voltage will accelerate electrons to a
typical static electricity and noting that static is speed of (b) Find the radius
often absent. of curvature of the path of a proton accelerated
through this potential in a 0.500-T field and
11.3 Motion of a Charged Particle in a compare this with the radius of curvature of an
Magnetic Field electron accelerated through the same
potential.
25. A cosmic-ray electron moves at 31. An alpha-particle
perpendicular to Earth’s magnetic field at an
travels in a circular path of
altitude where the field strength is
radius 25 cm in a uniform magnetic field of
What is the radius of the circular
magnitude 1.5 T. (a) What is the speed of the
path the electron follows?
particle? (b) What is the kinetic energy in
26. (a) Viewers of Star Trek have heard of an
electron-volts? (c) Through what potential
antimatter drive on the Starship Enterprise.
difference must the particle be accelerated in
One possibility for such a futuristic energy
order to give it this kinetic energy?
source is to store antimatter charged particles
32. A particle of charge q and mass m is accelerated
in a vacuum chamber, circulating in a magnetic
from rest through a potential difference V, after
field, and then extract them as needed.
which it encounters a uniform magnetic field B.
Antimatter annihilates normal matter,
If the particle moves in a plane perpendicular to
producing pure energy. What strength magnetic
B, what is the radius of its circular orbit?
field is needed to hold antiprotons, moving at
in a circular path 2.00 m in
radius? Antiprotons have the same mass as
11.4 Magnetic Force on a Current-Carrying
protons but the opposite (negative) charge. (b) Is Conductor
this field strength obtainable with today’s 33. What is the direction of the magnetic force on
technology or is it a futuristic possibility? the current in each of the six cases?
27. (a) An oxygen-16 ion with a mass of
travels at
perpendicular to a 1.20-T magnetic field, which
makes it move in a circular arc with a 0.231-m

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 511

35. What is the direction of the magnetic field that


produces the magnetic force shown on the
currents in each of the three cases, assuming
is perpendicular to I?

34. What is the direction of a current that


experiences the magnetic force shown in each
of the three cases, assuming the current runs
perpendicular to ?

36. (a) What is the force per meter on a lightning


bolt at the equator that carries 20,000 A
perpendicular to Earth’s field? (b)
What is the direction of the force if the current
is straight up and Earth’s field direction is due
north, parallel to the ground?
512 11 • Chapter Review

37. (a) A dc power line for a light-rail system carries


1000 A at an angle of 30.0º to Earth’s
field. What is the force on a 100-m
section of this line? (b) Discuss practical
concerns this presents, if any.
38. A wire carrying a 30.0-A current passes
between the poles of a strong magnet that is
perpendicular to its field and experiences a
47. Repeat the previous problem, but with the loop
2.16-N force on the 4.00 cm of wire in the field.
lying flat on the ground with its current
What is the average field strength?
circulating counterclockwise (when viewed
from above) in a location where Earth’s field is
11.5 Force and Torque on a Current Loop
north, but at an angle 45.0° below the horizontal
39. (a) By how many percent is the torque of a and with a strength of
motor decreased if its permanent magnets lose
5.0% of their strength? (b) How many percent
would the current need to be increased to
return the torque to original values?
40. (a) What is the maximum torque on a 150-turn
square loop of wire 18.0 cm on a side that
carries a 50.0-A current in a 1.60-T field? (b)
What is the torque when θ is 10.9º? 11.6 The Hall Effect
41. Find the current through a loop needed to
create a maximum torque of The loop 48. A strip of copper is placed in a uniform
has 50 square turns that are 15.0 cm on a side magnetic field of magnitude 2.5 T. The Hall
and is in a uniform 0.800-T magnetic field. electric field is measured to be
42. Calculate the magnetic field strength needed on (a) What is the drift speed of the conduction
a 200-turn square loop 20.0 cm on a side to electrons? (b) Assuming that n =
create a maximum torque of 300 N ⋅ m if the electrons per cubic meter and that the cross-
loop is carrying 25.0 A. sectional area of the strip is
43. Since the equation for torque on a current- calculate the current in the strip. (c) What is the
carrying loop is τ = NIAB sin θ, the units of N ⋅ Hall coefficient 1/nq?
m must equal units of A ⋅ m2 T. Verify this. 49. The cross-sectional dimensions of the copper
44. (a) At what angle θ is the torque on a current strip shown are 2.0 cm by 2.0 mm. The strip
loop 90.0% of maximum? (b) 50.0% of carries a current of 100 A, and it is placed in a
maximum? (c) 10.0% of maximum? magnetic field of magnitude B = 1.5 T. What are
45. A proton has a magnetic field due to its spin. the value and polarity of the Hall potential in the
The field is similar to that created by a circular copper strip?
current loop in radius with a
current of Find the maximum
torque on a proton in a 2.50-T field. (This is a
significant torque on a small particle.)
46. (a) A 200-turn circular loop of radius 50.0 cm is
vertical, with its axis on an east-west line. A
current of 100 A circulates clockwise in the loop
when viewed from the east. Earth’s field here is 50. The magnitudes of the electric and magnetic
due north, parallel to the ground, with a fields in a velocity selector are
strength of What are the direction and 0.080 T, respectively. (a) What speed must a
and magnitude of the torque on the loop? (b) proton have to pass through the selector? (b)
Does this device have any practical applications Also calculate the speeds required for an alpha-
as a motor? particle and a singly ionized atom to pass
through the selector.
51. A charged particle moves through a velocity

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 513

selector at constant velocity. In the selector, E = cyclotron? (b) What is this energy in MeV? (c)
and B = 0.250 T. When the Through what potential difference would a
electric field is turned off, the charged particle proton have to be accelerated to acquire this
travels in a circular path of radius 3.33 mm. kinetic energy? (d) What is the period of the
Determine the charge-to-mass ratio of the voltage source used to accelerate the protons?
particle. (e) Repeat the calculations for alpha-particles.
52. A Hall probe gives a reading of for a 56. A mass spectrometer is being used to separate
current of 2 A when it is placed in a magnetic common oxygen-16 from the much rarer
field of 1 T. What is the magnetic field in a oxygen-18, taken from a sample of old glacial
region where the reading is for 1.7 A of ice. (The relative abundance of these oxygen
current? isotopes is related to climatic temperature at
the time the ice was deposited.) The ratio of the
11.7 Applications of Magnetic Forces and masses of these two ions is 16 to 18, the mass of
Fields oxygen-16 is and they are
singly charged and travel at in a
53. A physicist is designing a cyclotron to accelerate
1.20-T magnetic field. What is the separation
protons to one-tenth the speed of light. The
between their paths when they hit a target after
magnetic field will have a strength of 1.5 T.
traversing a semicircle?
Determine (a) the rotational period of the
57. (a) Triply charged uranium-235 and
circulating protons and (b) the maximum radius
uranium-238 ions are being separated in a
of the protons’ orbit.
mass spectrometer. (The much rarer
54. The strengths of the fields in the velocity
uranium-235 is used as reactor fuel.) The
selector of a Bainbridge mass spectrometer are
masses of the ions are and
B = 0.500 T and E = and the
respectively, and they travel at
strength of the magnetic field that separates the
in a 0.250-T field. What is the
ions is A stream of singly charged
separation between their paths when they hit a
Li ions is found to bend in a circular arc of
target after traversing a semicircle? (b) Discuss
radius 2.32 cm. What is the mass of the Li ions?
whether this distance between their paths
55. The magnetic field in a cyclotron is 1.25 T, and
seems to be big enough to be practical in the
the maximum orbital radius of the circulating
separation of uranium-235 from uranium-238.
protons is 0.40 m. (a) What is the kinetic energy
of the protons when they are ejected from the

Additional Problems
58. Calculate the magnetic force on a hypothetical 62. Four different proton velocities are given. For
particle of charge moving with a each case, determine the magnetic force on the
velocity of in a magnetic field of proton in terms of e, and

59. Repeat the previous problem with a new


magnetic field of
60. An electron is projected into a uniform
magnetic field with a velocity of
What is the magnetic
force on the electron?
61. The mass and charge of a water droplet are
and respectively. If
the droplet is given an initial horizontal velocity
of what magnetic field will keep
it moving in this direction? Why must gravity be
considered here?
514 11 • Chapter Review

63. An electron of kinetic energy 2000 eV passes 72. A particle moving downward at a speed of
between parallel plates that are 1.0 cm apart enters a uniform magnetic field
and kept at a potential difference of 300 V. What that is horizontal and directed from east to west.
is the strength of the uniform magnetic field B (a) If the particle is deflected initially to the
that will allow the electron to travel undeflected north in a circular arc, is its charge positive or
through the plates? Assume E and B are negative? (b) If B = 0.25 T and the charge-to-
perpendicular. mass ratio (q/m) of the particle is
64. An alpha-particle what is the radius of the path?
moving with a velocity (c) What is the speed of the particle after it has
enters a region moved in the field for for 2.0 s?
73. A proton, deuteron, and an alpha-particle are all
where and
accelerated from rest through the same
What is the initial
potential difference. They then enter the same
force on it?
magnetic field, moving perpendicular to it.
65. An electron moving with a velocity
Compute the ratios of the radii of their circular
enters a paths. Assume that and
region where there is a uniform electric field 74. A singly charged ion is moving in a uniform
and a uniform magnetic field. The magnetic magnetic field of completes 10
field is given by revolutions in Identify the ion.
If the 75. Two particles have the same linear momentum,
electron travels through a region without being but particle A has four times the charge of
deflected, what is the electric field? particle B. If both particles move in a plane
66. At a particular instant, an electron is traveling perpendicular to a uniform magnetic field, what
west to east with a kinetic energy of 10 keV. is the ratio of the radii of their circular
Earth’s magnetic field has a horizontal orbits?
component of north and a vertical 76. A uniform magnetic field of magnitude is
component of down. (a) What is directed parallel to the z-axis. A proton enters
the path of the electron? (b) What is the radius the field with a velocity
of curvature of the path? and travels in a helical
67. What is the (a) path of a proton and (b) the path with a radius of 5.0 cm. (a) What is the
magnetic force on the proton that is traveling value of ? (b) What is the time required for one
west to east with a kinetic energy of 10 keV in trip around the helix? (c) Where is the proton
Earth’s magnetic field that has a horizontal after entering the field?
component of 1.8 x 10–5 T north and a vertical 77. An electron moving along the +x -axis at
component of 5.0 x 10–5 T down? enters a magnetic field that
68. What magnetic field is required in order to makes a angle with the x-axis of magnitude
confine a proton moving with a speed of 0.20 T. Calculate the (a) pitch and (b) radius of
to a circular orbit of radius 10 the trajectory.
cm? 78. (a) A 0.750-m-long section of cable carrying
69. An electron and a proton move with the same current to a car starter motor makes an angle of
speed in a plane perpendicular to a uniform 60º with Earth’s field. What is the
magnetic field. Compare the radii and periods current when the wire experiences a force of
of their orbits. (b) If you run the wire between
70. A proton and an alpha-particle have the same the poles of a strong horseshoe magnet,
kinetic energy and both move in a plane subjecting 5.00 cm of it to a 1.75-T field, what
perpendicular to a uniform magnetic field. force is exerted on this segment of wire?
Compare the periods of their orbits. 79. (a) What is the angle between a wire carrying an
71. A singly charged ion takes to 8.00-A current and the 1.20-T field it is in if 50.0
complete eight revolutions in a uniform cm of the wire experiences a magnetic force of
magnetic field of magnitude 2.40 N? (b) What is the force on the wire if it is
What is the mass of the ion? rotated to make an angle of 90º with the field?

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 515

80. A 1.0-m-long segment of wire lies along the 85. A circular coil of wire of radius 5.0 cm has 20
x-axis and carries a current of 2.0 A in the turns and carries a current of 2.0 A. The coil lies
positive x-direction. Around the wire is the in a magnetic field of magnitude 0.50 T that is
magnetic field of Find directed parallel to the plane of the coil. (a)
the magnetic force on this segment. What is the magnetic dipole moment of the coil?
81. A 5.0-m section of a long, straight wire carries a (b) What is the torque on the coil?
current of 10 A while in a uniform magnetic 86. A current-carrying coil in a magnetic field
field of magnitude Calculate the experiences a torque that is 75% of the
magnitude of the force on the section if the maximum possible torque. What is the angle
angle between the field and the direction of the between the magnetic field and the normal to
current is (a) 45°; (b) 90°; (c) 0°; or (d) 180°. the plane of the coil?
82. An electromagnet produces a magnetic field of 87. A 4.0-cm by 6.0-cm rectangular current loop
magnitude 1.5 T throughout a cylindrical region carries a current of 10 A. What is the magnetic
of radius 6.0 cm. A straight wire carrying a dipole moment of the loop?
current of 25 A passes through the field as 88. A circular coil with 200 turns has a radius of 2.0
shown in the accompanying figure. What is the cm. (a) What current through the coil results in
magnetic force on the wire? a magnetic dipole moment of 3.0 Am2? (b) What
is the maximum torque that the coil will
experience in a uniform field of strength
(c) If the angle between μ and B
is 45°, what is the magnitude of the torque on
the coil? (d) What is the magnetic potential
energy of coil for this orientation?
89. The current through a circular wire loop of
radius 10 cm is 5.0 A. (a) Calculate the magnetic
dipole moment of the loop. (b) What is the
torque on the loop if it is in a uniform 0.20-T
magnetic field such that and B are directed at
to each other? (c) For this position, what is
the potential energy of the dipole?
90. A wire of length 1.0 m is wound into a single-
83. The current loop shown in the accompanying turn planar loop. The loop carries a current of
figure lies in the plane of the page, as does the 5.0 A, and it is placed in a uniform magnetic
magnetic field. Determine the net force and the field of strength 0.25 T. (a) What is the
net torque on the loop if I = 10 A and B = 1.5 T. maximum torque that the loop will experience if
it is square? (b) If it is circular? (c) At what angle
relative to B would the normal to the circular
coil have to be oriented so that the torque on it
would be the same as the maximum torque on
the square coil?
91. Consider an electron rotating in a circular orbit
of radius r. Show that the magnitudes of the
magnetic dipole moment μ and the angular
momentum L of the electron are related by:
84. A circular coil of radius 5.0 cm is wound with
five turns and carries a current of 5.0 A. If the
coil is placed in a uniform magnetic field of
strength 5.0 T, what is the maximum torque on
it?
516 11 • Chapter Review

92. The Hall effect is to be used to find the sign of 97. Find the radius of curvature of the path of a
charge carriers in a semiconductor sample. The 25.0-MeV proton moving perpendicularly to the
probe is placed between the poles of a magnet 1.20-T field of a cyclotron.
so that magnetic field is pointed up. A current is 98. Unreasonable results To construct a non-
passed through a rectangular sample placed mechanical water meter, a 0.500-T magnetic
horizontally. As current is passed through the field is placed across the supply water pipe to a
sample in the east direction, the north side of home and the Hall voltage is recorded. (a) Find
the sample is found to be at a higher potential the flow rate through a 3.00-cm-diameter pipe
than the south side. Decide if the number if the Hall voltage is 60.0 mV. (b) What would the
density of charge carriers is positively or Hall voltage be for the same flow rate through a
negatively charged. 10.0-cm-diameter pipe with the same field
93. The density of charge carriers for copper is applied?
electrons per cubic meter. What 99. Unreasonable results A charged particle
will be the Hall voltage reading from a probe having mass (that of a helium
made up of atom) moving at perpendicular
copper to a 1.50-T magnetic field travels in a circular
plate when a current of 1.5 A is passed through path of radius 16.0 mm. (a) What is the charge
it in a magnetic field of 2.5 T perpendicular to of the particle? (b) What is unreasonable about
the this result? (c) Which assumptions are
94. The Hall effect is to be used to find the density responsible?
of charge carriers in an unknown material. A 100. Unreasonable results An inventor wants to
Hall voltage 40 for 3-A current is observed generate 120-V power by moving a 1.00-m-
in a 3-T magnetic field for a rectangular sample long wire perpendicular to Earth’s
with length 2 cm, width 1.5 cm, and height 0.4 field. (a) Find the speed with
cm. Determine the density of the charge which the wire must move. (b) What is
carriers. unreasonable about this result? (c) Which
95. Show that the Hall voltage across wires made of assumption is responsible?
the same material, carrying identical currents, 101. Unreasonable results Frustrated by the small
and subjected to the same magnetic field is Hall voltage obtained in blood flow
inversely proportional to their diameters. (Hint: measurements, a medical physicist decides to
Consider how drift velocity depends on wire increase the applied magnetic field strength to
diameter.) get a 0.500-V output for blood moving at 30.0
96. A velocity selector in a mass spectrometer uses cm/s in a 1.50-cm-diameter vessel. (a) What
a 0.100-T magnetic field. (a) What electric field magnetic field strength is needed? (b) What is
strength is needed to select a speed of unreasonable about this result? (c) Which
(b) What is the voltage between premise is responsible?
the plates if they are separated by 1.00 cm?

Challenge Problems
102. A particle of charge +q and mass m moves with 103. A proton of speed v = enters a
velocity pointed in the +y-direction as it region of uniform magnetic field of B = 0.5 T at
crosses the x-axis at x = R at a particular time. an angle of to the magnetic field. In the
There is a negative charge –Q fixed at the region of magnetic field proton describes a
origin, and there exists a uniform magnetic helical path with radius R and pitch p (distance
field pointed in the +z-direction. It is found between loops). Find R and p.
that the particle describes a circle of radius R
about –Q. Find in terms of the given
quantities.

Access for free at openstax.org.


11 • Chapter Review 517

104. A particle’s path is bent when it passes through 107. The accompanied figure shows an
a region of non-zero magnetic field although arrangement for measuring mass of ions by an
its speed remains unchanged. This is very instrument called the mass spectrometer. An
useful for “beam steering” in particle ion of mass m and charge +q is produced
accelerators. Consider a proton of speed essentially at rest in source S, a chamber in
entering a region of uniform which a gas discharge is taking place. The ion
magnetic field 0.2 T over a 5-cm-wide region. is accelerated by a potential difference
Magnetic field is perpendicular to the velocity and allowed to enter a region of constant
of the particle. By how much angle will the path magnetic field In the uniform magnetic
of the proton be bent? (Hint: The particle field region, the ion moves in a semicircular
comes out tangent to a circle.) path striking a photographic plate at a distance
x from the entry point. Derive a formula for
mass m in terms of q, and x.

105. In a region a non-uniform magnetic field exists


such that
where a is a constant. At some time t, a wire of
length L is carrying a current I is located along
the x-axis from origin to x = L. Find the
magnetic force on the wire at this instant in
time. 108. A wire is made into a circular shape of radius R
106. A copper rod of mass m and length L is hung from and pivoted along a central support. The two ends
the ceiling using two springs of spring constant k. A of the wire are touching a brush that is connected
uniform magnetic field of magnitude pointing to a dc power source. The structure is between the
perpendicular to the rod and spring (coming into poles of a magnet such that we can assume there is
the page in the figure) exists in a region of space a uniform magnetic field on the wire. In terms of a
covering a length w of the copper rod. The ends of coordinate system with origin at the center of the
the rod are then connected by flexible copper wire ring, magnetic field is and
across the terminals of a battery of voltage V. the ring rotates about the z-axis. Find the torque
Determine the change in the length of the springs on the ring when it is not in the xz-plane.
when a current I runs through the copper rod in the
direction shown in figure. (Ignore any force by the
flexible wire.)

109. A long-rigid wire lies along the x-axis and


carries a current of 2.5 A in the positive
x-direction. Around the wire is the magnetic
field with x in meters and B
in millitesla. Calculate the magnetic force on
the segment of wire between x = 2.0 m and x =
4.0 m.
518 11 • Chapter Review

110. A circular loop of wire of area 10 cm2 carries a


current of 25 A. At a particular instant, the
loop lies in the xy-plane and is subjected to a
magnetic field
As
viewed from above the xy-plane, the current is
circulating clockwise. (a) What is the magnetic
dipole moment of the current loop? (b) At this
instant, what is the magnetic torque on the
loop?

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 12
Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.1 An external hard drive attached to a computer works by magnetically encoding information that can be
stored or retrieved quickly. A key idea in the development of digital devices is the ability to produce and use
magnetic fields in this way. (credit: modification of work by “Miss Karen”/Flickr)

Chapter Outline

12.1 The Biot-Savart Law

12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight Wire

12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel Currents

12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop

12.5 Ampère’s Law

12.6 Solenoids and Toroids

12.7 Magnetism in Matter

INTRODUCTION In the preceding chapter, we saw that a moving charged particle produces a magnetic field.
This connection between electricity and magnetism is exploited in electromagnetic devices, such as a
computer hard drive. In fact, it is the underlying principle behind most of the technology in modern society,
including telephones, television, computers, and the internet.

In this chapter, we examine how magnetic fields are created by arbitrary distributions of electric current, using
the Biot-Savart law. Then we look at how current-carrying wires create magnetic fields and deduce the forces
520 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

that arise between two current-carrying wires due to these magnetic fields. We also study the torques
produced by the magnetic fields of current loops. We then generalize these results to an important law of
electromagnetism, called Ampère’s law.

We examine some devices that produce magnetic fields from currents in geometries based on loops, known as
solenoids and toroids. Finally, we look at how materials behave in magnetic fields and categorize materials
based on their responses to magnetic fields.

12.1 The Biot-Savart Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how to derive a magnetic field from an arbitrary current in a line segment
• Calculate magnetic field from the Biot-Savart law in specific geometries, such as a current in a line and a
current in a circular arc

We have seen that mass produces a gravitational field and also interacts with that field. Charge produces an
electric field and also interacts with that field. Since moving charge (that is, current) interacts with a magnetic
field, we might expect that it also creates that field—and it does.

The equation used to calculate the magnetic field produced by a current is known as the Biot-Savart law. It is
an empirical law named in honor of two scientists who investigated the interaction between a straight,
current-carrying wire and a permanent magnet. This law enables us to calculate the magnitude and direction
of the magnetic field produced by a current in a wire. The Biot-Savart law states that at any point P (Figure
12.2), the magnetic field due to an element of a current-carrying wire is given by

12.1

Figure 12.2 A current element produces a magnetic field at point P given by the Biot-Savart law.

The constant is known as the permeability of free space and is exactly

12.2

in the SI system. The infinitesimal wire segment is in the same direction as the current I (assumed positive),
r is the distance from to P and is a unit vector that points from to P, as shown in the figure.

The direction of is determined by applying the right-hand rule to the vector product The
magnitude of is

12.3

where is the angle between and Notice that if then The field produced by a current
element has no component parallel to

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.1 • The Biot-Savart Law 521

The magnetic field due to a finite length of current-carrying wire is found by integrating Equation 12.3 along
the wire, giving us the usual form of the Biot-Savart law.

Biot-Savart law
The magnetic field due to an element of a current-carrying wire is given by

12.4

Since this is a vector integral, contributions from different current elements may not point in the same
direction. Consequently, the integral is often difficult to evaluate, even for fairly simple geometries. The
following strategy may be helpful.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Solving Biot-Savart Problems


To solve Biot-Savart law problems, the following steps are helpful:

1. Identify that the Biot-Savart law is the chosen method to solve the given problem. If there is symmetry in
the problem comparing and Ampère’s law may be the preferred method to solve the question.
2. Draw the current element length and the unit vector noting that points in the direction of the
current and points from the current element toward the point where the field is desired.
3. Calculate the cross product The resultant vector gives the direction of the magnetic field
according to the Biot-Savart law.
4. Use Equation 12.4 and substitute all given quantities into the expression to solve for the magnetic field.
Note all variables that remain constant over the entire length of the wire may be factored out of the
integration.
5. Use the right-hand rule to verify the direction of the magnetic field produced from the current or to write
down the direction of the magnetic field if only the magnitude was solved for in the previous part.

EXAMPLE 12.1

Calculating Magnetic Fields of Short Current Segments


A short wire of length 1.0 cm carries a current of 2.0 A in the vertical direction (Figure 12.3). The rest of the
wire is shielded so it does not add to the magnetic field produced by the wire. Calculate the magnetic field at
point P, which is 1 meter from the wire in the x-direction.

Figure 12.3 A small line segment carries a current I in the vertical direction. What is the magnetic field at a distance x from the segment?
522 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Strategy
We can determine the magnetic field at point P using the Biot-Savart law. Since the current segment is much
smaller than the distance x, we can drop the integral from the expression. The integration is converted back
into a summation, but only for small dl, which we now write as Another way to think about it is that each of
the radius values is nearly the same, no matter where the current element is on the line segment, if is small
compared to x. The angle is calculated using a tangent function. Using the numbers given, we can calculate
the magnetic field at P.

Solution
The angle between and is calculated from trigonometry, knowing the distances l and x from the problem:

The magnetic field at point P is calculated by the Biot-Savart law:

From the right-hand rule and the Biot-Savart law, the field is directed into the page.

Significance
This approximation is only good if the length of the line segment is very small compared to the distance from
the current element to the point. If not, the integral form of the Biot-Savart law must be used over the entire
line segment to calculate the magnetic field.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.1


Using Example 12.1, at what distance would P have to be to measure a magnetic field half of the given answer?

EXAMPLE 12.2

Calculating Magnetic Field of a Circular Arc of Wire


A wire carries a current I in a circular arc with radius R swept through an arbitrary angle (Figure 12.4).
Calculate the magnetic field at the center of this arc at point P.

Figure 12.4 A wire segment carrying a current I. The path and radial direction are indicated.

Strategy
We can determine the magnetic field at point P using the Biot-Savart law. The radial and path length directions
are always at a right angle, so the cross product turns into multiplication. We also know that the distance along
the path dl is related to the radius times the angle (in radians). Then we can pull all constants out of the
integration and solve for the magnetic field.

Solution
The Biot-Savart law starts with the following equation:

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.2 • Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight Wire 523

As we integrate along the arc, all the contributions to the magnetic field are in the same direction (out of the
page), so we can work with the magnitude of the field. The cross product turns into multiplication because the
path dl and the radial direction are perpendicular. We can also substitute the arc length formula, :

The current and radius can be pulled out of the integral because they are the same regardless of where we are
on the path. This leaves only the integral over the angle,

The angle varies on the wire from 0 to ; hence, the result is

Significance
The direction of the magnetic field at point P is determined by the right-hand rule, as shown in the previous
chapter. If there are other wires in the diagram along with the arc, and you are asked to find the net magnetic
field, find each contribution from a wire or arc and add the results by superposition of vectors. Make sure to
pay attention to the direction of each contribution. Also note that in a symmetric situation, like a straight or
circular wire, contributions from opposite sides of point P cancel each other.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.2


The wire loop forms a full circle of radius R and current I. What is the magnitude of the magnetic field at the
center?

12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight Wire


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how the Biot-Savart law is used to determine the magnetic field due to a thin, straight wire.
• Determine the dependence of the magnetic field from a thin, straight wire based on the distance from it and
the current flowing in the wire.
• Sketch the magnetic field created from a thin, straight wire by using the second right-hand rule.

How much current is needed to produce a significant magnetic field, perhaps as strong as Earth’s field?
Surveyors will tell you that overhead electric power lines create magnetic fields that interfere with their
compass readings. Indeed, when Oersted discovered in 1820 that a current in a wire affected a compass
needle, he was not dealing with extremely large currents. How does the shape of wires carrying current affect
the shape of the magnetic field created? We noted in Chapter 28 that a current loop created a magnetic field
similar to that of a bar magnet, but what about a straight wire? We can use the Biot-Savart law to answer all of
these questions, including determining the magnetic field of a long straight wire.

Figure 12.5 shows a section of an infinitely long, straight wire that carries a current I. What is the magnetic
field at a point P, located a distance R from the wire?
524 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.5 A section of a thin, straight current-carrying wire. The independent variable has the limits and

Let’s begin by considering the magnetic field due to the current element located at the position x. Using
the right-hand rule 1 from the previous chapter, points out of the page for any element along the wire.
At point P, therefore, the magnetic fields due to all current elements have the same direction. This means that
we can calculate the net field there by evaluating the scalar sum of the contributions of the elements. With
we have from the Biot-Savart law

12.5

The wire is symmetrical about point O, so we can set the limits of the integration from zero to infinity and
double the answer, rather than integrate from negative infinity to positive infinity. Based on the picture and
geometry, we can write expressions for r and in terms of x and R, namely:

Substituting these expressions into Equation 12.5, the magnetic field integration becomes


12.6

Evaluating the integral yields


12.7

Substituting the limits gives us the solution

12.8

The magnetic field lines of the infinite wire are circular and centered at the wire (Figure 12.6), and they are
identical in every plane perpendicular to the wire. Since the field decreases with distance from the wire, the
spacing of the field lines must increase correspondingly with distance. The direction of this magnetic field may
be found with a second form of the right-hand rule (illustrated in Figure 12.6). If you hold the wire with your
right hand so that your thumb points along the current, then your fingers wrap around the wire in the same
sense as

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.2 • Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight Wire 525

Figure 12.6 Some magnetic field lines of an infinite wire. The direction of can be found with a form of the right-hand rule.

The direction of the field lines can be observed experimentally by placing several small compass needles on a
circle near the wire, as illustrated in Figure 12.7. When there is no current in the wire, the needles align with
Earth’s magnetic field. However, when a large current is sent through the wire, the compass needles all point
tangent to the circle. Iron filings sprinkled on a horizontal surface also delineate the field lines, as shown in
Figure 12.7.

Figure 12.7 The shape of the magnetic field lines of a long wire can be seen using (a) small compass needles and (b) iron filings.

EXAMPLE 12.3

Calculating Magnetic Field Due to Three Wires


Three wires sit at the corners of a square, all carrying currents of 2 amps into the page as shown in Figure 12.8.
Calculate the magnitude of the magnetic field at the other corner of the square, point P, if the length of each
side of the square is 1 cm.

Figure 12.8 Three wires have current flowing into the page. The magnetic field is determined at the fourth corner of the square.
526 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Strategy
The magnetic field due to each wire at the desired point is calculated. The diagonal distance is calculated using
the Pythagorean theorem. Next, the direction of each magnetic field’s contribution is determined by drawing a
circle centered at the point of the wire and out toward the desired point. The direction of the magnetic field
contribution from that wire is tangential to the curve. Lastly, working with these vectors, the resultant is
calculated.

Solution
Wires 1 and 3 both have the same magnitude of magnetic field contribution at point P:

Wire 2 has a longer distance and a magnetic field contribution at point P of:

The vectors for each of these magnetic field contributions are shown.

The magnetic field in the x-direction has contributions from wire 3 and the x-component of wire 2:

The y-component is similarly the contributions from wire 1 and the y-component of wire 2:

Therefore, the net magnetic field is the resultant of these two components:

Significance
The geometry in this problem results in the magnetic field contributions in the x- and y-directions having the
same magnitude. This is not necessarily the case if the currents were different values or if the wires were
located in different positions. Regardless of the numerical results, working on the components of the vectors
will yield the resulting magnetic field at the point in need.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.3


Using Example 12.3, keeping the currents the same in wires 1 and 3, what should the current be in wire 2 to
counteract the magnetic fields from wires 1 and 3 so that there is no net magnetic field at point P?

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.3 • Magnetic Force between Two Parallel Currents 527

12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel Currents


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how parallel wires carrying currents can attract or repel each other
• Define the ampere and describe how it is related to current-carrying wires
• Calculate the force of attraction or repulsion between two current-carrying wires

You might expect that two current-carrying wires generate significant forces between them, since ordinary
currents produce magnetic fields and these fields exert significant forces on ordinary currents. But you might
not expect that the force between wires is used to define the ampere. It might also surprise you to learn that
this force has something to do with why large circuit breakers burn up when they attempt to interrupt large
currents.

The force between two long, straight, and parallel conductors separated by a distance r can be found by
applying what we have developed in the preceding sections. Figure 12.9 shows the wires, their currents, the
field created by one wire, and the consequent force the other wire experiences from the created field. Let us
consider the field produced by wire 1 and the force it exerts on wire 2 (call the force ). The field due to at a
distance r is

12.9

Figure 12.9 (a) The magnetic field produced by a long straight conductor is perpendicular to a parallel conductor, as indicated by right-
hand rule (RHR)-2. (b) A view from above of the two wires shown in (a), with one magnetic field line shown for wire 1. RHR-1 shows that the
force between the parallel conductors is attractive when the currents are in the same direction. A similar analysis shows that the force is
repulsive between currents in opposite directions.

This field is uniform from the wire 1 and perpendicular to it, so the force it exerts on a length l of wire 2 is
given by with
12.10
The forces on the wires are equal in magnitude, so we just write F for the magnitude of (Note that
) Since the wires are very long, it is convenient to think in terms of F/l, the force per unit length.
Substituting the expression for into Equation 12.10 and rearranging terms gives

12.11

The ratio F/l is the force per unit length between two parallel currents and separated by a distance r. The
force is attractive if the currents are in the same direction and repulsive if they are in opposite directions.

This force is responsible for the pinch effect in electric arcs and other plasmas. The force exists whether the
528 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

currents are in wires or not. It is only apparent if the overall charge density is zero; otherwise, the Coulomb
repulsion overwhelms the magnetic attraction. In an electric arc, where charges are moving parallel to one
another, an attractive force squeezes currents into a smaller tube. In large circuit breakers, such as those used
in neighborhood power distribution systems, the pinch effect can concentrate an arc between plates of a
switch trying to break a large current, burn holes, and even ignite the equipment. Another example of the
pinch effect is found in the solar plasma, where jets of ionized material, such as solar flares, are shaped by
magnetic forces.

The definition of the ampere is based on the force between current-carrying wires. Note that for long, parallel
wires separated by 1 meter with each carrying 1 ampere, the force per meter is

12.12

Since is exactly by definition, and because the force per meter is


exactly This is the basis of the definition of the ampere.

Infinite-length wires are impractical, so in practice, a current balance is constructed with coils of wire
separated by a few centimeters. Force is measured to determine current. This also provides us with a method
for measuring the coulomb. We measure the charge that flows for a current of one ampere in one second. That
is, For both the ampere and the coulomb, the method of measuring force between conductors is
the most accurate in practice.

EXAMPLE 12.4

Calculating Forces on Wires


Two wires, both carrying current out of the page, have a current of magnitude 5.0 mA. The first wire is located
at (0.0 cm, 3.0 cm) while the other wire is located at (4.0 cm, 0.0 cm) as shown in Figure 12.10. What is the
magnetic force per unit length of the first wire on the second and the second wire on the first?

Figure 12.10 Two current-carrying wires at given locations with currents out of the page.

Strategy
Each wire produces a magnetic field felt by the other wire. The distance along the hypotenuse of the triangle
between the wires is the radial distance used in the calculation to determine the force per unit length. Since
both wires have currents flowing in the same direction, the direction of the force is toward each other.

Solution
The distance between the wires results from finding the hypotenuse of a triangle:

The force per unit length can then be calculated using the known currents in the wires:

The force from the first wire pulls the second wire. The angle between the radius and the x-axis is

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.4 • Magnetic Field of a Current Loop 529

The unit vector for this is calculated by

Therefore, the force per unit length from wire one on wire 2 is

The force per unit length from wire 2 on wire 1 is the negative of the previous answer:

Significance
These wires produced magnetic fields of equal magnitude but opposite directions at each other’s locations.
Whether the fields are identical or not, the forces that the wires exert on each other are always equal in
magnitude and opposite in direction (Newton’s third law).

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.4


Two wires, both carrying current out of the page, have a current of magnitude 2.0 mA and 3.0 mA, respectively.
The first wire is located at (0.0 cm, 5.0 cm) while the other wire is located at (12.0 cm, 0.0 cm). What is the
magnitude of the magnetic force per unit length of the first wire on the second and the second wire on the first?

12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how the Biot-Savart law is used to determine the magnetic field due to a current in a loop of wire at
a point along a line perpendicular to the plane of the loop.
• Determine the magnetic field of an arc of current.

The circular loop of Figure 12.11 has a radius R, carries a current I, and lies in the xz-plane. What is the
magnetic field due to the current at an arbitrary point P along the axis of the loop?
530 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.11 Determining the magnetic field at point P along the axis of a current-carrying loop of wire.

We can use the Biot-Savart law to find the magnetic field due to a current. We first consider arbitrary segments
on opposite sides of the loop to qualitatively show by the vector results that the net magnetic field direction is
along the central axis from the loop. From there, we can use the Biot-Savart law to derive the expression for
magnetic field.

Let P be a distance y from the center of the loop. From the right-hand rule, the magnetic field at P, produced
by the current element is directed at an angle above the y-axis as shown. Since is parallel along the
x-axis and is in the yz-plane, the two vectors are perpendicular, so we have

12.13

where we have used

Now consider the magnetic field due to the current element which is directly opposite on the
loop. The magnitude of is also given by Equation 12.13, but it is directed at an angle below the y-axis. The
components of and perpendicular to the y-axis therefore cancel, and in calculating the net magnetic
field, only the components along the y-axis need to be considered. The components perpendicular to the axis
of the loop sum to zero in pairs. Hence at point P:

12.14

For all elements on the wire, y, R, and are constant and are related by

Now from Equation 12.14, the magnetic field at P is

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.4 • Magnetic Field of a Current Loop 531

12.15

where we have used As discussed in the previous chapter, the closed current loop is a magnetic

dipole of moment For this example, and so the magnetic field at P can also be
written as

12.16

By setting in Equation 12.16, we obtain the magnetic field at the center of the loop:

12.17

This equation becomes for a flat coil of n loops per length. It can also be expressed as

12.18

If we consider in Equation 12.16, the expression reduces to an expression known as the magnetic field
from a dipole:

12.19

The calculation of the magnetic field due to the circular current loop at points off-axis requires rather complex
mathematics, so we’ll just look at the results. The magnetic field lines are shaped as shown in Figure 12.12.
Notice that one field line follows the axis of the loop. This is the field line we just found. Also, very close to the
wire, the field lines are almost circular, like the lines of a long straight wire.

Figure 12.12 Sketch of the magnetic field lines of a circular current loop.

EXAMPLE 12.5

Magnetic Field between Two Loops


Two loops of wire carry the same current of 10 mA, but flow in opposite directions as seen in Figure 12.13. One
loop is measured to have a radius of while the other loop has a radius of The distance
from the first loop to the point where the magnetic field is measured is 0.25 m, and the distance from that
point to the second loop is 0.75 m. What is the magnitude of the net magnetic field at point P?
532 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.13 Two loops of different radii have the same current but flowing in opposite directions. The magnetic field at point P is
measured to be zero.

Strategy
The magnetic field at point P has been determined in Equation 12.15. Since the currents are flowing in
opposite directions, the net magnetic field is the difference between the two fields generated by the coils. Using
the given quantities in the problem, the net magnetic field is then calculated.

Solution
Solving for the net magnetic field using Equation 12.15 and the given quantities in the problem yields

Significance
Helmholtz coils typically have loops with equal radii with current flowing in the same direction to have a
strong uniform field at the midpoint between the loops. A similar application of the magnetic field distribution
created by Helmholtz coils is found in a magnetic bottle that can temporarily trap charged particles. See
Magnetic Forces and Fields for a discussion on this.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.5


Using Example 12.5, at what distance would you have to move the first coil to have zero measurable magnetic
field at point P?

12.5 Ampère’s Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how Ampère’s law relates the magnetic field produced by a current to the value of the current
• Calculate the magnetic field from a long straight wire, either thin or thick, by Ampère’s law

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.5 • Ampère’s Law 533

A fundamental property of a static magnetic field is that, unlike an electrostatic field, it is not conservative. A
conservative vector field is one whose line integral between two end points is the same regardless of the path
chosen. Magnetic fields do not have such a property. Instead, there is a relationship between the magnetic field
and its source, electric current. It is expressed in terms of the line integral of and is known as Ampère’s law.
This law can also be derived directly from the Biot-Savart law. We now consider that derivation for the special
case of an infinite, straight wire.

Figure 12.14 shows an arbitrary plane perpendicular to an infinite, straight wire whose current I is directed
out of the page. The magnetic field lines are circles directed counterclockwise and centered on the wire. To
begin, let’s consider over the closed paths M and N. Notice that one path (M) encloses the wire,

whereas the other (N) does not. Since the field lines are circular, is the product of B and the projection of
dl onto the circle passing through If the radius of this particular circle is r, the projection is and

Figure 12.14 The current I of a long, straight wire is directed out of the page. The integral equals and 0, respectively, for paths M

and N.

With given by Equation 12.9,

12.20

For path M, which circulates around the wire, and

12.21

Path N, on the other hand, circulates through both positive (counterclockwise) and negative (clockwise) (see
Figure 12.14), and since it is closed, Thus for path N,

12.22
534 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

The extension of this result to the general case is Ampère’s law.

Ampère’s law
Over an arbitrary closed path,

12.23

where I is the total current passing through any open surface S whose perimeter is the path of integration.
Only currents inside the path of integration need be considered.

To determine whether a specific current I is positive or negative, curl the fingers of your right hand in the
direction of the path of integration, as shown in Figure 12.14. If I passes through S in the same direction as
your extended thumb, I is positive; if I passes through S in the direction opposite to your extended thumb, it is
negative.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Ampère’s Law
To calculate the magnetic field created from current in wire(s), use the following steps:

1. Identify the symmetry of the current in the wire(s). If there is no symmetry, use the Biot-Savart law to
determine the magnetic field.
2. Determine the direction of the magnetic field created by the wire(s) by right-hand rule 2.
3. Chose a path loop where the magnetic field is either constant or zero.
4. Calculate the current inside the loop.
5. Calculate the line integral around the closed loop.

6. Equate with and solve for

EXAMPLE 12.6

Using Ampère’s Law to Calculate the Magnetic Field Due to a Wire


Use Ampère’s law to calculate the magnetic field due to a steady current I in an infinitely long, thin, straight
wire as shown in Figure 12.15.

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.5 • Ampère’s Law 535

Figure 12.15 The possible components of the magnetic field B due to a current I, which is directed out of the page. The radial component
is zero because the angle between the magnetic field and the path is at a right angle.

Strategy
Consider an arbitrary plane perpendicular to the wire, with the current directed out of the page. The possible
magnetic field components in this plane, and are shown at arbitrary points on a circle of radius r
centered on the wire. Since the field is cylindrically symmetric, neither nor varies with the position on
this circle. Also from symmetry, the radial lines, if they exist, must be directed either all inward or all outward
from the wire. This means, however, that there must be a net magnetic flux across an arbitrary cylinder
concentric with the wire. The radial component of the magnetic field must be zero because
Therefore, we can apply Ampère’s law to the circular path as shown.

Solution
Over this path is constant and parallel to so

Thus Ampère’s law reduces to

Finally, since is the only component of we can drop the subscript and write

This agrees with the Biot-Savart calculation above.

Significance
Ampère’s law works well if you have a path to integrate over which has results that are easy to simplify.
For the infinite wire, this works easily with a path that is circular around the wire so that the magnetic field
factors out of the integration. If the path dependence looks complicated, you can always go back to the Biot-
Savart law and use that to find the magnetic field.
536 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

EXAMPLE 12.7

Calculating the Magnetic Field of a Thick Wire with Ampère’s Law


The radius of the long, straight wire of Figure 12.16 is a, and the wire carries a current that is distributed
uniformly over its cross-section. Find the magnetic field both inside and outside the wire.

Figure 12.16 (a) A model of a current-carrying wire of radius a and current (b) A cross-section of the same wire showing the radius a
and the Ampère’s loop of radius r.

Strategy
This problem has the same geometry as Example 12.6, but the enclosed current changes as we move the
integration path from outside the wire to inside the wire, where it doesn’t capture the entire current enclosed
(see Figure 12.16).

Solution
For any circular path of radius r that is centered on the wire,

From Ampère’s law, this equals the total current passing through any surface bounded by the path of
integration.

Consider first a circular path that is inside the wire such as that shown in part (a) of Figure 12.16. We
need the current I passing through the area enclosed by the path. It’s equal to the current density J times the
area enclosed. Since the current is uniform, the current density inside the path equals the current density in
the whole wire, which is Therefore the current I passing through the area enclosed by the path is

We can consider this ratio because the current density J is constant over the area of the wire. Therefore, the
current density of a part of the wire is equal to the current density in the whole area. Using Ampère’s law, we
obtain

and the magnetic field inside the wire is

Outside the wire, the situation is identical to that of the infinite thin wire of the previous example; that is,

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.5 • Ampère’s Law 537

The variation of B with r is shown in Figure 12.17.

Figure 12.17 Variation of the magnetic field produced by a current in a long, straight wire of radius a.

Significance
The results show that as the radial distance increases inside the thick wire, the magnetic field increases from
zero to a familiar value of the magnetic field of a thin wire. Outside the wire, the field drops off regardless of
whether it was a thick or thin wire.

This result is similar to how Gauss’s law for electrical charges behaves inside a uniform charge distribution,
except that Gauss’s law for electrical charges has a uniform volume distribution of charge, whereas Ampère’s
law here has a uniform area of current distribution. Also, the drop-off outside the thick wire is similar to how
an electric field drops off outside of a linear charge distribution, since the two cases have the same geometry
and neither case depends on the configuration of charges or currents once the loop is outside the distribution.

EXAMPLE 12.8

Using Ampère’s Law with Arbitrary Paths


Use Ampère’s law to evaluate for the current configurations and paths in Figure 12.18.
538 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.18 Current configurations and paths for Example 12.8.

Strategy

Ampère’s law states that where I is the total current passing through the enclosed loop. The

quickest way to evaluate the integral is to calculate by finding the net current through the loop. Positive
currents flow with your right-hand thumb if your fingers wrap around in the direction of the loop. This will tell
us the sign of the answer.

Solution
(a) The current going downward through the loop equals the current going out of the loop, so the net current is
zero. Thus,

(b) The only current to consider in this problem is 2A because it is the only current inside the loop. The right-
hand rule shows us the current going downward through the loop is in the positive direction. Therefore, the
answer is

(c) The right-hand rule shows us the current going downward through the loop is in the positive direction.
There are of current going downward and –3 A going upward. Therefore, the total current is 9
A and

Significance
If the currents all wrapped around so that the same current went into the loop and out of the loop, the net
current would be zero and no magnetic field would be present. This is why wires are very close to each other in
an electrical cord. The currents flowing toward a device and away from a device in a wire equal zero total
current flow through an Ampère loop around these wires. Therefore, no stray magnetic fields can be present
from cords carrying current.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.6


Consider using Ampère’s law to calculate the magnetic fields of a finite straight wire and of a circular loop of
wire. Why is it not useful for these calculations?

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.6 • Solenoids and Toroids 539

12.6 Solenoids and Toroids


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Establish a relationship for how the magnetic field of a solenoid varies with distance and current by using
both the Biot-Savart law and Ampère’s law
• Establish a relationship for how the magnetic field of a toroid varies with distance and current by using
Ampère’s law

Two of the most common and useful electromagnetic devices are called solenoids and toroids. In one form or
another, they are part of numerous instruments, both large and small. In this section, we examine the
magnetic field typical of these devices.

Solenoids
A long wire wound in the form of a helical coil is known as a solenoid. Solenoids are commonly used in
experimental research requiring magnetic fields. A solenoid is generally easy to wind, and near its center, its
magnetic field is quite uniform and directly proportional to the current in the wire.

Figure 12.19 shows a solenoid consisting of N turns of wire tightly wound over a length L. A current I is flowing
along the wire of the solenoid. The number of turns per unit length is N/L; therefore, the number of turns in an
infinitesimal length dy are (N/L)dy turns. This produces a current

12.24

We first calculate the magnetic field at the point P of Figure 12.19. This point is on the central axis of the
solenoid. We are basically cutting the solenoid into thin slices that are dy thick and treating each as a current
loop. Thus, dI is the current through each slice. The magnetic field due to the current dI in dy can be found
with the help of Equation 12.15 and Equation 12.24:

12.25

where we used Equation 12.24 to replace dI. The resultant field at P is found by integrating along the entire
length of the solenoid. It’s easiest to evaluate this integral by changing the independent variable from y to
From inspection of Figure 12.19, we have:

12.26
540 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.19 (a) A solenoid is a long wire wound in the shape of a helix. (b) The magnetic field at the point P on the axis of the solenoid is
the net field due to all of the current loops.

Taking the differential of both sides of this equation, we obtain

When this is substituted into the equation for we have

12.27

which is the magnetic field along the central axis of a finite solenoid.

Of special interest is the infinitely long solenoid, for which ∞ From a practical point of view, the infinite
solenoid is one whose length is much larger than its radius In this case, and Then
from Equation 12.27, the magnetic field along the central axis of an infinite solenoid is

or

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.6 • Solenoids and Toroids 541

12.28

where n is the number of turns per unit length. You can find the direction of with a right-hand rule: Curl your
fingers in the direction of the current, and your thumb points along the magnetic field in the interior of the
solenoid.

We now use these properties, along with Ampère’s law, to calculate the magnitude of the magnetic field at any
location inside the infinite solenoid. Consider the closed path of Figure 12.20. Along segment 1, is uniform
and parallel to the path. Along segments 2 and 4, is perpendicular to part of the path and vanishes over the
rest of it. Therefore, segments 2 and 4 do not contribute to the line integral in Ampère’s law. Along segment 3,
because the magnetic field is zero outside the solenoid. If you consider an Ampère’s law loop outside of
the solenoid, the current flows in opposite directions on different segments of wire. Therefore, there is no
enclosed current and no magnetic field according to Ampère’s law. Thus, there is no contribution to the line
integral from segment 3. As a result, we find

12.29

Figure 12.20 The path of integration used in Ampère’s law to evaluate the magnetic field of an infinite solenoid.

The solenoid has n turns per unit length, so the current that passes through the surface enclosed by the path is
nlI. Therefore, from Ampère’s law,

and

12.30

within the solenoid. This agrees with what we found earlier for B on the central axis of the solenoid. Here,
however, the location of segment 1 is arbitrary, so we have found that this equation gives the magnetic field
everywhere inside the infinite solenoid.

When a patient undergoes a magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) scan, the person lies down on a table that is
moved into the center of a large solenoid that can generate very large magnetic fields. The solenoid is capable
of these high fields from high currents flowing through superconducting wires. The large magnetic field is
used to change the spin of protons in the patient’s body. The time it takes for the spins to align or relax (return
to original orientation) is a signature of different tissues that can be analyzed to see if the structures of the
tissues is normal (Figure 12.21).
542 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.21 In an MRI machine, a large magnetic field is generated by the cylindrical solenoid surrounding the patient. (credit: Liz West)

EXAMPLE 12.9

Magnetic Field Inside a Solenoid


A solenoid has 300 turns wound around a cylinder of diameter 1.20 cm and length 14.0 cm. If the current
through the coils is 0.410 A, what is the magnitude of the magnetic field inside and near the middle of the
solenoid?

Strategy
We are given the number of turns and the length of the solenoid so we can find the number of turns per unit
length. Therefore, the magnetic field inside and near the middle of the solenoid is given by Equation 12.30.
Outside the solenoid, the magnetic field is zero.

Solution
The number of turns per unit length is

The magnetic field produced inside the solenoid is

Significance
This solution is valid only if the length of the solenoid is reasonably large compared with its diameter. This
example is a case where this is valid.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.7


What is the ratio of the magnetic field produced from using a finite formula over the infinite approximation for
an angle of (a) (b) The solenoid has 1000 turns in 50 cm with a current of 1.0 A flowing through the
coils

Toroids
A toroid is a donut-shaped coil closely wound with one continuous wire, as illustrated in part (a) of Figure
12.22. If the toroid has N windings and the current in the wire is I, what is the magnetic field both inside and

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.6 • Solenoids and Toroids 543

outside the toroid?

Figure 12.22 (a) A toroid is a coil wound into a donut-shaped object. (b) A loosely wound toroid does not have cylindrical symmetry. (c) In
a tightly wound toroid, cylindrical symmetry is a very good approximation. (d) Several paths of integration for Ampère’s law.

We begin by assuming cylindrical symmetry around the axis OO’. Actually, this assumption is not precisely
correct, for as part (b) of Figure 12.22 shows, the view of the toroidal coil varies from point to point (for
example, and ) on a circular path centered around OO’. However, if the toroid is tightly wound, all
points on the circle become essentially equivalent [part (c) of Figure 12.22], and cylindrical symmetry is an
accurate approximation.

With this symmetry, the magnetic field must be tangent to and constant in magnitude along any circular path
centered on OO’. This allows us to write for each of the paths and shown in part (d) of Figure 12.22,

12.31

Ampère’s law relates this integral to the net current passing through any surface bounded by the path of
integration. For a path that is external to the toroid, either no current passes through the enclosing surface
(path ), or the current passing through the surface in one direction is exactly balanced by the current
passing through it in the opposite direction In either case, there is no net current passing through
the surface, so

and
12.32
The turns of a toroid form a helix, rather than circular loops. As a result, there is a small field external to the
coil; however, the derivation above holds if the coils were circular.

For a circular path within the toroid (path ), the current in the wire cuts the surface N times, resulting in a
net current NI through the surface. We now find with Ampère’s law,
544 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

and

12.33

The magnetic field is directed in the counterclockwise direction for the windings shown. When the current in
the coils is reversed, the direction of the magnetic field also reverses.

The magnetic field inside a toroid is not uniform, as it varies inversely with the distance r from the axis OO’.
However, if the central radius R (the radius midway between the inner and outer radii of the toroid) is much
larger than the cross-sectional diameter of the coils r, the variation is fairly small, and the magnitude of the
magnetic field may be calculated by Equation 12.33 where

12.7 Magnetism in Matter


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Classify magnetic materials as paramagnetic, diamagnetic, or ferromagnetic, based on their response to a
magnetic field
• Sketch how magnetic dipoles align with the magnetic field in each type of substance
• Define hysteresis and magnetic susceptibility, which determines the type of magnetic material

Why are certain materials magnetic and others not? And why do certain substances become magnetized by a
field, whereas others are unaffected? To answer such questions, we need an understanding of magnetism on a
microscopic level.

Within an atom, every electron travels in an orbit and spins on an internal axis. Both types of motion produce
current loops and therefore magnetic dipoles. For a particular atom, the net magnetic dipole moment is the
vector sum of the magnetic dipole moments. Values of for several types of atoms are given in Table 12.1.
Notice that some atoms have a zero net dipole moment and that the magnitudes of the nonvanishing moments
are typically

Atom Magnetic Moment

H 9.27

He 0

Li 9.27

O 13.9

Na 9.27

S 13.9

Table 12.1 Magnetic Moments of Some Atoms

A handful of matter has approximately atoms and ions, each with its magnetic dipole moment. If no
external magnetic field is present, the magnetic dipoles are randomly oriented—as many are pointed up as
down, as many are pointed east as west, and so on. Consequently, the net magnetic dipole moment of the
sample is zero. However, if the sample is placed in a magnetic field, these dipoles tend to align with the field
(see Equation 12.14), and this alignment determines how the sample responds to the field. On the basis of this
response, a material is said to be either paramagnetic, ferromagnetic, or diamagnetic.

In a paramagnetic material, only a small fraction (roughly one-third) of the magnetic dipoles are aligned with

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.7 • Magnetism in Matter 545

the applied field. Since each dipole produces its own magnetic field, this alignment contributes an extra
magnetic field, which enhances the applied field. When a ferromagnetic material is placed in a magnetic
field, its magnetic dipoles also become aligned; furthermore, they become locked together so that a permanent
magnetization results, even when the field is turned off or reversed. This permanent magnetization happens in
ferromagnetic materials but not paramagnetic materials. Diamagnetic materials are composed of atoms that
have no net magnetic dipole moment. However, when a diamagnetic material is placed in a magnetic field, a
magnetic dipole moment is directed opposite to the applied field and therefore produces a magnetic field that
opposes the applied field. We now consider each type of material in greater detail.

Paramagnetic Materials
For simplicity, we assume our sample is a long, cylindrical piece that completely fills the interior of a long,
tightly wound solenoid. When there is no current in the solenoid, the magnetic dipoles in the sample are
randomly oriented and produce no net magnetic field. With a solenoid current, the magnetic field due to the
solenoid exerts a torque on the dipoles that tends to align them with the field. In competition with the aligning
torque are thermal collisions that tend to randomize the orientations of the dipoles. The relative importance of
these two competing processes can be estimated by comparing the energies involved. From Equation 12.14,
the energy difference between a magnetic dipole aligned with and against a magnetic field is If
(the value of atomic hydrogen) and B = 1.0 T, then

At a room temperature of the thermal energy per atom is

which is about 220 times greater than Clearly, energy exchanges in thermal collisions can seriously
interfere with the alignment of the magnetic dipoles. As a result, only a small fraction of the dipoles is aligned
at any instant.

The four sketches of Figure 12.23 furnish a simple model of this alignment process. In part (a), before the field
of the solenoid (not shown) containing the paramagnetic sample is applied, the magnetic dipoles are randomly
oriented and there is no net magnetic dipole moment associated with the material. With the introduction of
the field, a partial alignment of the dipoles takes place, as depicted in part (b). The component of the net
magnetic dipole moment that is perpendicular to the field vanishes. We may then represent the sample by part
(c), which shows a collection of magnetic dipoles completely aligned with the field. By treating these dipoles as
current loops, we can picture the dipole alignment as equivalent to a current around the surface of the
material, as in part (d). This fictitious surface current produces its own magnetic field, which enhances the
field of the solenoid.
546 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.23 The alignment process in a paramagnetic material filling a solenoid (not shown). (a) Without an applied field, the magnetic
dipoles are randomly oriented. (b) With a field, partial alignment occurs. (c) An equivalent representation of part (b). (d) The internal
currents cancel, leaving an effective surface current that produces a magnetic field similar to that of a finite solenoid.

We can express the total magnetic field in the material as

12.34

where is the field due to the current in the solenoid and is the field due to the surface current
around the sample. Now is usually proportional to a fact we express by

12.35

where is a dimensionless quantity called the magnetic susceptibility. Values of for some paramagnetic
materials are given in Table 12.2. Since the alignment of magnetic dipoles is so weak, is very small for
paramagnetic materials. By combining Equation 12.34 and Equation 12.35, we obtain:

12.36

For a sample within an infinite solenoid, this becomes


12.37
This expression tells us that the insertion of a paramagnetic material into a solenoid increases the field by a
factor of However, since is so small, the field isn’t enhanced very much.

The quantity

12.38

is called the magnetic permeability of a material. In terms of Equation 12.37 can be written as

12.39

for the filled solenoid.

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.7 • Magnetism in Matter 547

Paramagnetic Materials Diamagnetic Materials

Aluminum Bismuth

Calcium Carbon (diamond)

Chromium Copper

Magnesium Lead

Oxygen gas (1 atm) Mercury

Oxygen liquid (90 K) Hydrogen gas (1 atm)

Tungsten Nitrogen gas (1 atm)

Air (1 atm) Water

Table 12.2 Magnetic Susceptibilities *Note: Unless otherwise specified, values given are for room
temperature.

Diamagnetic Materials
A magnetic field always induces a magnetic dipole in an atom. This induced dipole points opposite to the
applied field, so its magnetic field is also directed opposite to the applied field. In paramagnetic and
ferromagnetic materials, the induced magnetic dipole is masked by much stronger permanent magnetic
dipoles of the atoms. However, in diamagnetic materials, whose atoms have no permanent magnetic dipole
moments, the effect of the induced dipole is observable.

We can now describe the magnetic effects of diamagnetic materials with the same model developed for
paramagnetic materials. In this case, however, the fictitious surface current flows opposite to the solenoid
current, and the magnetic susceptibility is negative. Values of for some diamagnetic materials are also
given in Table 12.2.

INTERACTIVE
Water is a common diamagnetic material. Animals are mostly composed of water. Experiments have been
performed on frogs (https://openstax.org/l/21frogs) and mice (https://openstax.org/l/21mice) in diverging
magnetic fields. The water molecules are repelled from the applied magnetic field against gravity until the
animal reaches an equilibrium. The result is that the animal is levitated by the magnetic field.

Ferromagnetic Materials
Common magnets are made of a ferromagnetic material such as iron or one of its alloys. Experiments reveal
that a ferromagnetic material consists of tiny regions known as magnetic domains. Their volumes typically
range from to and they contain about to atoms. Within a domain, the magnetic
dipoles are rigidly aligned in the same direction by coupling among the atoms. This coupling, which is due to
quantum mechanical effects, is so strong that even thermal agitation at room temperature cannot break it. The
result is that each domain has a net dipole moment. Some materials have weaker coupling and are
ferromagnetic only at lower temperatures.

If the domains in a ferromagnetic sample are randomly oriented, as shown in Figure 12.24, the sample has no
net magnetic dipole moment and is said to be unmagnetized. Suppose that we fill the volume of a solenoid with
an unmagnetized ferromagnetic sample. When the magnetic field of the solenoid is turned on, the dipole
548 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

moments of the domains rotate so that they align somewhat with the field, as depicted in Figure 12.24. In
addition, the aligned domains tend to increase in size at the expense of unaligned ones. The net effect of these
two processes is the creation of a net magnetic dipole moment for the ferromagnet that is directed along the
applied magnetic field. This net magnetic dipole moment is much larger than that of a paramagnetic sample,
and the domains, with their large numbers of atoms, do not become misaligned by thermal agitation.
Consequently, the field due to the alignment of the domains is quite large.

Figure 12.24 (a) Domains are randomly oriented in an unmagnetized ferromagnetic sample such as iron. The arrows represent the
orientations of the magnetic dipoles within the domains. (b) In an applied magnetic field, the domains align somewhat with the field. (c)
The domains of a single crystal of nickel. The white lines show the boundaries of the domains. These lines are produced by iron oxide
powder sprinkled on the crystal.

Besides iron, only four elements contain the magnetic domains needed to exhibit ferromagnetic behavior:
cobalt, nickel, gadolinium, and dysprosium. Many alloys of these elements are also ferromagnetic.
Ferromagnetic materials can be described using Equation 12.34 through Equation 12.39, the paramagnetic
equations. However, the value of for ferromagnetic material is usually on the order of to and it also
depends on the history of the magnetic field to which the material has been subject. A typical plot of B (the
total field in the material) versus (the applied field) for an initially unmagnetized piece of iron is shown in
Figure 12.25. Some sample numbers are (1) for and
; (2) for and

Figure 12.25 (a) The magnetic field B in annealed iron as a function of the applied field

When is varied over a range of positive and negative values, B is found to behave as shown in Figure 12.26.
Note that the same (corresponding to the same current in the solenoid) can produce different values of B in
the material. The magnetic field B produced in a ferromagnetic material by an applied field depends on the
magnetic history of the material. This effect is called hysteresis, and the curve of Figure 12.26 is called a
hysteresis loop. Notice that B does not disappear when (i.e., when the current in the solenoid is turned
off). The iron stays magnetized, which means that it has become a permanent magnet.

Access for free at openstax.org.


12.7 • Magnetism in Matter 549

Figure 12.26 A typical hysteresis loop for a ferromagnet. When the material is first magnetized, it follows a curve from 0 to a. When is
reversed, it takes the path shown from a to b. If is reversed again, the material follows the curve from b to a.

Like the paramagnetic sample of Figure 12.23, the partial alignment of the domains in a ferromagnet is
equivalent to a current flowing around the surface. A bar magnet can therefore be pictured as a tightly wound
solenoid with a large current circulating through its coils (the surface current). You can see in Figure 12.27 that
this model fits quite well. The fields of the bar magnet and the finite solenoid are strikingly similar. The figure
also shows how the poles of the bar magnet are identified. To form closed loops, the field lines outside the
magnet leave the north (N) pole and enter the south (S) pole, whereas inside the magnet, they leave S and enter
N.

Figure 12.27 Comparison of the magnetic fields of a finite solenoid and a bar magnet.

Ferromagnetic materials are found in computer hard disk drives and permanent data storage devices (Figure
12.28). A material used in your hard disk drives is called a spin valve, which has alternating layers of
ferromagnetic (aligning with the external magnetic field) and antiferromagnetic (each atom is aligned opposite
to the next) metals. It was observed that a significant change in resistance was discovered based on whether an
applied magnetic field was on the spin valve or not. This large change in resistance creates a quick and
consistent way for recording or reading information by an applied current.
550 12 • Sources of Magnetic Fields

Figure 12.28 The inside of a hard disk drive. The silver disk contains the information, whereas the thin stylus on top of the disk reads and
writes information to the disk.

EXAMPLE 12.10

Iron Core in a Coil


A long coil is tightly wound around an iron cylinder whose magnetization curve is shown in Figure 12.25. (a) If
turns per centimeter, what is the applied field when (b) What is the net magnetic field
for this same current? (c) What is the magnetic susceptibility in this case?

Strategy
(a) The magnetic field of a solenoid is calculated using Equation 12.28. (b) The graph is read to determine the
net magnetic field for this same current. (c) The magnetic susceptibility is calculated using Equation 12.37.

Solution

a. The applied field of the coil is

b. From inspection of the magnetization curve of Figure 12.25, we see that, for this value of
Notice that the internal field of the aligned atoms is much larger than the externally applied field.
c. The magnetic susceptibility is calculated to be

Significance
Ferromagnetic materials have susceptibilities in the range of which compares well to our results here.
Paramagnetic materials have fractional susceptibilities, so their applied field of the coil is much greater than
the magnetic field generated by the material.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 12.8


Repeat the calculations from the previous example for

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 551

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
Ampère’s law physical law that states that the line are all aligned in the same direction and are
integral of the magnetic field around an electric coupled together quantum mechanically
current is proportional to the current magnetic susceptibility ratio of the magnetic field
Biot-Savart law an equation giving the magnetic in the material over the applied field at that time;
field at a point produced by a current-carrying positive susceptibilities are either paramagnetic
wire or ferromagnetic (aligned with the field) and
diamagnetic materials their magnetic dipoles negative susceptibilities are diamagnetic (aligned
align oppositely to an applied magnetic field; oppositely with the field)
when the field is removed, the material is paramagnetic materials their magnetic dipoles
unmagnetized align partially in the same direction as the
ferromagnetic materials contain groups of applied magnetic field; when this field is
dipoles, called domains, that align with the removed, the material is unmagnetized
applied magnetic field; when this field is permeability of free space measure of the
removed, the material is still magnetized ability of a material, in this case free space, to
hysteresis property of ferromagnets that is seen support a magnetic field
when a material’s magnetic field is examined solenoid thin wire wound into a coil that produces
versus the applied magnetic field; a loop is a magnetic field when an electric current is
created resulting from sweeping the applied field passed through it
forward and reverse toroid donut-shaped coil closely wound around
magnetic domains groups of magnetic dipoles that that is one continuous wire

Key Equations
Permeability of free space

Contribution to magnetic field


from a current element

Biot–Savart law

Magnetic field due to a


long straight wire

Force between two parallel currents

Magnetic field of a current loop

Ampère’s law

Magnetic field strength


inside a solenoid

Magnetic field strength inside a toroid


552 12 • Chapter Review

Magnetic permeability

Magnetic field of a solenoid


filled with paramagnetic material

Summary
12.1 The Biot-Savart Law direction as for a straight wire), resulting in a
general relationship between current and field
• The magnetic field created by a current-
known as Ampère’s law.
carrying wire is found by the Biot-Savart law.
• Ampère’s law can be used to determine the
• The current element produces a magnetic magnetic field from a thin wire or thick wire by a
field a distance r away. geometrically convenient path of integration.
12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight The results are consistent with the Biot-Savart
law.
Wire
• The strength of the magnetic field created by 12.6 Solenoids and Toroids
current in a long straight wire is given by • The magnetic field strength inside a solenoid is
(long straight wire) where I is the
current, R is the shortest distance to the wire, where n is the number of loops per unit length
and the constant is the of the solenoid. The field inside is very uniform
permeability of free space. in magnitude and direction.
• The direction of the magnetic field created by a • The magnetic field strength inside a toroid is
long straight wire is given by right-hand rule 2
(RHR-2): Point the thumb of the right hand in
the direction of current, and the fingers curl in
where N is the number of windings. The field
the direction of the magnetic field loops created
inside a toroid is not uniform and varies with
by it.
the distance as 1/r.
12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel 12.7 Magnetism in Matter
Currents
• Materials are classified as paramagnetic,
• The force between two parallel currents and diamagnetic, or ferromagnetic, depending on
separated by a distance r, has a magnitude how they behave in an applied magnetic field.
per unit length given by • Paramagnetic materials have partial alignment
• The force is attractive if the currents are in the of their magnetic dipoles with an applied
same direction, repulsive if they are in opposite magnetic field. This is a positive magnetic
directions. susceptibility. Only a surface current remains,
creating a solenoid-like magnetic field.
12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop • Diamagnetic materials exhibit induced dipoles
• The magnetic field strength at the center of a opposite to an applied magnetic field. This is a
circular loop is given by negative magnetic susceptibility.
• Ferromagnetic materials have groups of dipoles,
where R is the
called domains, which align with the applied
radius of the loop. RHR-2 gives the direction of
magnetic field. However, when the field is
the field about the loop.
removed, the ferromagnetic material remains
12.5 Ampère’s Law magnetized, unlike paramagnetic materials.
This magnetization of the material versus the
• The magnetic field created by current following
applied field effect is called hysteresis.
any path is the sum (or integral) of the fields due
to segments along the path (magnitude and

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 553

Conceptual Questions
12.1 The Biot-Savart Law 12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop
1. For calculating magnetic fields, what are the 8. Is the magnetic field of a current loop uniform?
advantages and disadvantages of the Biot-Savart 9. What happens to the length of a suspended
law? spring when a current passes through it?
2. Describe the magnetic field due to the current in 10. Two concentric circular wires with different
two wires connected to the two terminals of a diameters carry currents in the same direction.
source of emf and twisted tightly around each Describe the force on the inner wire.
other.
3. How can you decide if a wire is infinite? 12.5 Ampère’s Law
4. Identical currents are carried in two circular
11. Is Ampère’s law valid for all closed paths? Why
loops; however, one loop has twice the diameter
isn’t it normally useful for calculating a
as the other loop. Compare the magnetic fields
magnetic field?
created by the loops at the center of each loop.

12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight 12.6 Solenoids and Toroids
Wire 12. Is the magnetic field inside a toroid completely
uniform? Almost uniform?
5. How would you orient two long, straight, current-
carrying wires so that there is no net magnetic 13. Explain why inside a long, hollow copper
force between them? (Hint: What orientation pipe that is carrying an electric current parallel
would lead to one wire not experiencing a to the axis. Is outside the pipe?
magnetic field from the other?)
12.7 Magnetism in Matter
12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel 14. A diamagnetic material is brought close to a
Currents permanent magnet. What happens to the
6. Compare and contrast the electric field of an material?
infinite line of charge and the magnetic field of 15. If you cut a bar magnet into two pieces, will you
an infinite line of current. end up with one magnet with an isolated north
pole and another magnet with an isolated south
7. Is constant in magnitude for points that lie on a
pole? Explain your answer.
magnetic field line?

Problems
12.1 The Biot-Savart Law
16. A 10-A current flows through the wire shown. What
is the magnitude of the magnetic field due to a
0.5-mm segment of wire as measured at (a) point A
and (b) point B?

17. Ten amps flow through a square loop where


18. What is the magnetic field at P due to the
each side is 20 cm in length. At each corner of
current I in the wire shown?
the loop is a 0.01-cm segment that connects the
longer wires as shown. Calculate the magnitude
of the magnetic field at the center of the loop.
554 12 • Chapter Review

19. The accompanying figure shows a current loop


consisting of two concentric circular arcs and
two perpendicular radial lines. Determine the
magnetic field at point P.

12.2 Magnetic Field Due to a Thin Straight


Wire
20. Find the magnetic field at the center C of the
22. A typical current in a lightning bolt is A.
rectangular loop of wire shown in the
Estimate the magnetic field 1 m from the bolt.
accompanying figure.
23. The magnitude of the magnetic field 50 cm from
a long, thin, straight wire is What is the
current through the long wire?
24. A transmission line strung 7.0 m above the
ground carries a current of 500 A. What is the
magnetic field on the ground directly below the
wire? Compare your answer with the magnetic
field of Earth.
25. A long, straight, horizontal wire carries a left-to-
right current of 20 A. If the wire is placed in a
21. Two long wires, one of which has a semicircular uniform magnetic field of magnitude
bend of radius R, are positioned as shown in the that is directed vertically
accompanying figure. If both wires carry a downward, what is the resultant magnitude of
current I, how far apart must their parallel the magnetic field 20 cm above the wire? 20 cm
sections be so that the net magnetic field at P is below the wire?
zero? Does the current in the straight wire flow 26. The two long, parallel wires shown in the
up or down? accompanying figure carry currents in the same
direction. If and what is
the magnetic field at point P?
27. The accompanying figure shows two long, straight,
horizontal wires that are parallel and a distance 2a
apart. If both wires carry current I in the same
direction, (a) what is the magnetic field at (b)

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 555

33. A circuit with current I has two long parallel


wire sections that carry current in opposite
directions. Find magnetic field at a point P near
these wires that is a distance a from one wire
and b from the other wire as shown in the
28. Repeat the calculations of the preceding figure.
problem with the direction of the current in the
lower wire reversed.
29. Consider the area between the wires of the
preceding problem. At what distance from the
top wire is the net magnetic field a minimum?
Assume that the currents are equal and flow in
opposite directions.
34. The infinite, straight wire shown in the
accompanying figure carries a current The
12.3 Magnetic Force between Two Parallel rectangular loop, whose long sides are parallel
Currents to the wire, carries a current What are the
30. Two long, straight wires are parallel and 25 cm magnitude and direction of the force on the
apart. (a) If each wire carries a current of 50 A in rectangular loop due to the magnetic field of the
the same direction, what is the magnetic force wire?
per meter exerted on each wire? (b) Does the
force pull the wires together or push them
apart? (c) What happens if the currents flow in
opposite directions?
31. Two long, straight wires are parallel and 10 cm
apart. One carries a current of 2.0 A, the other a
current of 5.0 A. (a) If the two currents flow in
opposite directions, what is the magnitude and
direction of the force per unit length of one wire
on the other? (b) What is the magnitude and
direction of the force per unit length if the
currents flow in the same direction?
32. Two long, parallel wires are hung by cords of
length 5.0 cm, as shown in the accompanying
figure. Each wire has a mass per unit length of 30
g/m, and they carry the same current in opposite 12.4 Magnetic Field of a Current Loop
directions. What is the current if the cords hang at 35. When the current through a circular loop is 6.0
with respect to the vertical? A, the magnetic field at its center is
What is the radius of the loop?
36. How many turns must be wound on a flat,
circular coil of radius 20 cm in order to produce
a magnetic field of magnitude at
556 12 • Chapter Review

the center of the coil when the current through


it is 0.85 A?
37. A flat, circular loop has 20 turns. The radius of
the loop is 10.0 cm and the current through the
wire is 0.50 A. Determine the magnitude of the
magnetic field at the center of the loop.
38. A circular loop of radius R carries a current I. At
what distance along the axis of the loop is the
magnetic field one-half its value at the center of
the loop?
39. Two flat, circular coils, each with a radius R and
wound with N turns, are mounted along the
same axis so that they are parallel a distance d
apart. What is the magnetic field at the
midpoint of the common axis if a current I flows
in the same direction through each coil?
40. For the coils in the preceding problem, what is
the magnetic field at the center of either coil?

12.5 Ampère’s Law


41. A current I flows around the rectangular loop
shown in the accompanying figure. Evaluate
for the paths A, B, C, and D.

42. Evaluate for each of the cases shown in the


43. The coil whose lengthwise cross section is shown in
accompanying figure.
the accompanying figure carries a current I and has
N evenly spaced turns distributed along the length
l. Evaluate for the paths indicated.

44. A superconducting wire of diameter 0.25 cm


carries a current of 1000 A. What is the
magnetic field just outside the wire?
45. A long, straight wire of radius R carries a
current I that is distributed uniformly over the

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 557

cross-section of the wire. At what distance from When the current is 5.2 A, what is the magnetic
the axis of the wire is the magnitude of the field within the solenoid?
magnetic field a maximum? 50. A solenoid has 12 turns per centimeter. What
46. The accompanying figure shows a cross-section current will produce a magnetic field of
of a long, hollow, cylindrical conductor of inner within the solenoid?
radius and outer radius 51. If a current is 2.0 A, how many turns per
A 50-A current distributed centimeter must be wound on a solenoid in
uniformly over the cross-section flows into the order to produce a magnetic field of
page. Calculate the magnetic field at within it?
52. A solenoid is 40 cm long, has a diameter of 3.0
cm, and is wound with 500 turns. If the current
through the windings is 4.0 A, what is the
magnetic field at a point on the axis of the
solenoid that is (a) at the center of the solenoid,
(b) 10.0 cm from one end of the solenoid, and (c)
5.0 cm from one end of the solenoid? (d)
Compare these answers with the infinite-
solenoid case.

47. A long, solid, cylindrical conductor of radius 3.0


cm carries a current of 50 A distributed
uniformly over its cross-section. Plot the
magnetic field as a function of the radial
distance r from the center of the conductor.
48. A portion of a long, cylindrical coaxial cable is
shown in the accompanying figure. A current I
flows down the center conductor, and this current
is returned in the outer conductor. Determine the
magnetic field in the regions (a) (b)
(c) and (d)
Assume that the current is distributed uniformly
over the cross sections of the two parts of the cable.

12.6 Solenoids and Toroids


49. A solenoid is wound with 2000 turns per meter.
558 12 • Chapter Review

n turns per meter, and carries a current I?


55. A solenoid with 25 turns per centimeter carries
a current I. An electron moves within the
solenoid in a circle that has a radius of 2.0 cm
and is perpendicular to the axis of the solenoid.
If the speed of the electron is
what is I?
56. A toroid has 250 turns of wire and carries a
current of 20 A. Its inner and outer radii are 8.0
and 9.0 cm. What are the values of its magnetic
field at and
57. A toroid with a square cross section 3.0 cm
3.0 cm has an inner radius of 25.0 cm. It is
wound with 500 turns of wire, and it carries a
current of 2.0 A. What is the strength of the
magnetic field at the center of the square cross
section?

12.7 Magnetism in Matter


58. The magnetic field in the core of an air-filled
solenoid is 1.50 T. By how much will this
magnetic field decrease if the air is pumped out
of the core while the current is held constant?
59. A solenoid has a ferromagnetic core, n = 1000
turns per meter, and I = 5.0 A. If B inside the
solenoid is 2.0 T, what is for the core material?
60. A 20-A current flows through a solenoid with
2000 turns per meter. What is the magnetic field
inside the solenoid if its core is (a) a vacuum
and (b) filled with liquid oxygen at 90 K?
61. The magnetic dipole moment of the iron atom is
about (a) Calculate the
maximum magnetic dipole moment of a
domain consisting of iron atoms. (b) What
current would have to flow through a single
circular loop of wire of diameter 1.0 cm to
produce this magnetic dipole moment?
62. Suppose you wish to produce a 1.2-T magnetic
field in a toroid with an iron core for which
The toroid has a mean radius of
15 cm and is wound with 500 turns. What
current is required?
63. A current of 1.5 A flows through the windings of
a large, thin toroid with 200 turns per meter and
a radius of 1 meter. If the toroid is filled with
53. Determine the magnetic field on the central axis
iron for which what is the
at the opening of a semi-infinite solenoid. (That
magnetic field within it?
is, take the opening to be at and the other
64. A solenoid with an iron core is 25 cm long and is
end to be at
wrapped with 100 turns of wire. When the
∞ ) current through the solenoid is 10 A, the
54. By how much is the approximation in magnetic field inside it is 2.0 T. For this current,
error at the center of a solenoid that is 15.0 cm what is the permeability of the iron? If the
long, has a diameter of 4.0 cm, is wrapped with

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 559

current is turned off and then restored to 10 A, T?


will the magnetic field necessarily return to 2.0

Additional Problems
65. Three long, straight, parallel wires, all carrying 20 68. Current flows along a thin, infinite sheet as
A, are positioned as shown in the accompanying shown in the accompanying figure. The current
figure. What is the magnitude of the magnetic field per unit length along the sheet is J in amperes
at the point P? per meter. (a) Use the Biot-Savart law to show
that on either side of the sheet. What
is the direction of on each side? (b) Now use
Ampère’s law to calculate the field.

69. (a) Use the result of the previous problem to


calculate the magnetic field between, above, and
below the pair of infinite sheets shown in the
accompanying figure. (b) Repeat your
calculations if the direction of the current in the
lower sheet is reversed.
66. A current I flows around a wire bent into the
shape of a square of side a. What is the
magnetic field at the point P that is a distance z
above the center of the square (see the
accompanying figure)?

70. We often assume that the magnetic field is


uniform in a region and zero everywhere else.
Show that in reality it is impossible for a
magnetic field to drop abruptly to zero, as
illustrated in the accompanying figure. (Hint:
Apply Ampère’s law over the path shown.)
67. The accompanying figure shows a long, straight wire
carrying a current of 10 A. What is the magnetic
force on an electron at the instant it is 20 cm from
the wire, traveling parallel to the wire with a speed of
Describe qualitatively the
subsequent motion of the electron.
560 12 • Chapter Review

71. How is the fractional change in the strength of 77. A thin, nonconducting disk of radius R is free to
the magnetic field across the face of the toroid rotate around the axis that passes through its
related to the fractional change in the radial center and is perpendicular to the face of the
distance from the axis of the toroid? disk. The disk is charged uniformly with a total
72. Show that the expression for the magnetic field charge q. If the disk rotates at a constant
of a toroid reduces to that for the field of an angular velocity what is the magnetic field at
infinite solenoid in the limit that the central its center?
radius goes to infinity. 78. Consider the disk in the previous problem.
73. A toroid with an inner radius of 20 cm and an Calculate the magnetic field at a point on its
outer radius of 22 cm is tightly wound with one central axis that is a distance y above the disk.
layer of wire that has a diameter of 0.25 mm. (a) 79. Consider the axial magnetic field
How many turns are there on the toroid? (b) If of the circular
the current through the toroid windings is 2.0 A, current loop shown below. (a) Evaluate
what is the strength of the magnetic field at the
Also show that
center of the toroid?
74. A wire element has
(b) Can you deduce this
where A and dv are the cross-sectional area and ∞
volume of the element, respectively. Use this,
limit without evaluating the integral? (Hint: See
the Biot-Savart law, and to show that
the accompanying figure.)
the magnetic field of a moving point charge q is
given by:

75. A reasonably uniform magnetic field over a


limited region of space can be produced with
the Helmholtz coil, which consists of two
parallel coils centered on the same axis. The
coils are connected so that they carry the same
current I. Each coil has N turns and radius R,
which is also the distance between the coils. (a)
Find the magnetic field at any point on the
z-axis shown in the accompanying figure. (b)
Show that dB/dz and are both zero at z
= 0. (These vanishing derivatives demonstrate 80. The current density in the long, cylindrical wire
that the magnetic field varies only slightly near shown in the accompanying figure varies with
z = 0.) distance r from the center of the wire according
to where c is a constant. (a) What is the
current through the wire? (b) What is the
magnetic field produced by this current for
For

76. A charge of is distributed uniformly


around a thin ring of insulating material. The
ring has a radius of 0.20 m and rotates at
around the axis that passes
through its center and is perpendicular to the
plane of the ring. What is the magnetic field at
the center of the ring?

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 561

81. A long, straight, cylindrical conductor contains 83. Show that the magnetic field of a thin wire and
a cylindrical cavity whose axis is displaced by a that of a current loop are zero if you are
from the axis of the conductor, as shown in the infinitely far away.
accompanying figure. The current density in the 84. An Ampère loop is chosen as shown by dashed
conductor is given by where is a lines for a parallel constant magnetic field as
constant and is along the axis of the shown by solid arrows. Calculate for each
conductor. Calculate the magnetic field at an side of the loop then find the entire
arbitrary point P in the cavity by superimposing
the field of a solid cylindrical conductor with Can you think of an Ampère loop that would
radius and current density onto the field of make the problem easier? Do those results
a solid cylindrical conductor with radius and match these?
current density Then use the fact that the
appropriate azimuthal unit vectors can be
expressed as and to
show that everywhere inside the cavity the
magnetic field is given by the constant
where and
is the position of P relative to the
center of the conductor and is the
position of P relative to the center of the cavity. 85. A very long, thick cylindrical wire of radius R
carries a current density J that varies across its
cross-section. The magnitude of the current
density at a point a distance r from the center of
the wire is given by where is a
constant. Find the magnetic field (a) at a point
outside the wire and (b) at a point inside the
wire. Write your answer in terms of the net
current I through the wire.
86. A very long, cylindrical wire of radius a has a
circular hole of radius b in it at a distance d
from the center. The wire carries a uniform
current of magnitude I through it. The direction
of the current in the figure is out of the paper.
Find the magnetic field (a) at a point at the edge
82. Between the two ends of a horseshoe magnet of the hole closest to the center of the thick wire,
the field is uniform as shown in the diagram. As (b) at an arbitrary point inside the hole, and (c)
you move out to outside edges, the field bends. at an arbitrary point outside the wire. (Hint:
Show by Ampère’s law that the field must bend Think of the hole as a sum of two wires carrying
and thereby the field weakens due to these current in the opposite directions.)
bends.
562 12 • Chapter Review

87. Magnetic field inside a torus. Consider a torus of 88. Two long coaxial copper tubes, each of length L,
rectangular cross-section with inner radius a are connected to a battery of voltage V. The
and outer radius b. N turns of an insulated thin inner tube has inner radius a and outer radius
wire are wound evenly on the torus tightly all b, and the outer tube has inner radius c and
around the torus and connected to a battery outer radius d. The tubes are then disconnected
producing a steady current I in the wire. from the battery and rotated in the same
Assume that the current on the top and bottom direction at angular speed of radians per
surfaces in the figure is radial, and the current second about their common axis. Find the
on the inner and outer radii surfaces is vertical. magnetic field (a) at a point inside the space
Find the magnetic field inside the torus as a enclosed by the inner tube and (b) at a
function of radial distance r from the axis. point between the tubes and (c) at a
point outside the tubes (Hint: Think of
copper tubes as a capacitor and find the charge
density based on the voltage applied,

Challenge Problems
89. The accompanying figure shows a flat, infinitely 90. A hypothetical current flowing in the z-direction
long sheet of width a that carries a current I creates the field in
uniformly distributed across it. Find the magnetic the rectangular region of the xy-plane shown in
field at the point P, which is in the plane of the the accompanying figure. Use Ampère’s law to
sheet and at a distance x from one edge. Test your find the current through the rectangle.
result for the limit

Access for free at openstax.org.


12 • Chapter Review 563

91. A nonconducting hard rubber circular disk of


radius R is painted with a uniform surface
charge density It is rotated about its axis with
angular speed (a) Find the magnetic field
produced at a point on the axis a distance h
meters from the center of the disk. (b) Find the
numerical value of magnitude of the magnetic
field when
and and compare it with the
magnitude of magnetic field of Earth, which is
about 1/2 Gauss.
564 12 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 13
Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.1 The black strip found on the back of credit cards and driver’s licenses is a very thin layer of magnetic
material with information stored on it. Reading and writing the information on the credit card is done with a swiping
motion. The physical reason why this is necessary is called electromagnetic induction and is discussed in this
chapter. (credit: modification of work by Jane Whitney)

Chapter Outline

13.1 Faraday’s Law

13.2 Lenz's Law

13.3 Motional Emf

13.4 Induced Electric Fields

13.5 Eddy Currents

13.6 Electric Generators and Back Emf

13.7 Applications of Electromagnetic Induction

INTRODUCTION We have been considering electric fields created by fixed charge distributions and magnetic
fields produced by constant currents, but electromagnetic phenomena are not restricted to these stationary
situations. Most of the interesting applications of electromagnetism are, in fact, time-dependent. To
investigate some of these applications, we now remove the time-independent assumption that we have been
making and allow the fields to vary with time. In this and the next several chapters, you will see a wonderful
566 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

symmetry in the behavior exhibited by time-varying electric and magnetic fields. Mathematically, this
symmetry is expressed by an additional term in Ampère’s law and by another key equation of
electromagnetism called Faraday’s law. We also discuss how moving a wire through a magnetic field produces
an emf or voltage. Lastly, we describe applications of these principles, such as the card reader shown above.

13.1 Faraday’s Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Determine the magnetic flux through a surface, knowing the strength of the magnetic field, the surface area,
and the angle between the normal to the surface and the magnetic field
• Use Faraday’s law to determine the magnitude of induced emf in a closed loop due to changing magnetic
flux through the loop

The first productive experiments concerning the effects of time-varying magnetic fields were performed by
Michael Faraday in 1831. One of his early experiments is represented in Figure 13.2. An emf is induced when
the magnetic field in the coil is changed by pushing a bar magnet into or out of the coil. Emfs of opposite signs
are produced by motion in opposite directions, and the directions of emfs are also reversed by reversing poles.
The same results are produced if the coil is moved rather than the magnet—it is the relative motion that is
important. The faster the motion, the greater the emf, and there is no emf when the magnet is stationary
relative to the coil.

Figure 13.2 Movement of a magnet relative to a coil produces emfs as shown (a–d). The same emfs are produced if the coil is moved
relative to the magnet. This short-lived emf is only present during the motion. The greater the speed, the greater the magnitude of the emf,
and the emf is zero when there is no motion, as shown in (e).

Faraday also discovered that a similar effect can be produced using two circuits—a changing current in one
circuit induces a current in a second, nearby circuit. For example, when the switch is closed in circuit 1 of
Figure 13.3(a), the ammeter needle of circuit 2 momentarily deflects, indicating that a short-lived current
surge has been induced in that circuit. The ammeter needle quickly returns to its original position, where it
remains. However, if the switch of circuit 1 is now suddenly opened, another short-lived current surge in the
direction opposite from before is observed in circuit 2.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.1 • Faraday’s Law 567

Figure 13.3 (a) Closing the switch of circuit 1 produces a short-lived current surge in circuit 2. (b) If the switch remains closed, no current
is observed in circuit 2. (c) Opening the switch again produces a short-lived current in circuit 2 but in the opposite direction from before.

Faraday realized that in both experiments, a current flowed in the circuit containing the ammeter only when
the magnetic field in the region occupied by that circuit was changing. As the magnet of the figure was moved,
the strength of its magnetic field at the loop changed; and when the current in circuit 1 was turned on or off,
the strength of its magnetic field at circuit 2 changed. Faraday was eventually able to interpret these and all
other experiments involving magnetic fields that vary with time in terms of the following law:

Faraday’s Law
The emf induced is the negative change in the magnetic flux per unit time. Any change in the
magnetic field or change in orientation of the area of the coil with respect to the magnetic field induces a
voltage (emf).

The magnetic flux is a measurement of the amount of magnetic field lines through a given surface area, as
seen in Figure 13.4. This definition is similar to the electric flux studied earlier. This means that if we have

13.1

then the induced emf or the voltage generated by a conductor or coil moving in a magnetic field is

13.2

The negative sign describes the direction in which the induced emf drives current around a circuit. However,
that direction is most easily determined with a rule known as Lenz’s law, which we will discuss shortly.

Figure 13.4 The magnetic flux is the amount of magnetic field lines cutting through a surface area A defined by the unit area vector If
568 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

the angle between the unit area and magnetic field vector are parallel or antiparallel, as shown in the diagram, the magnetic flux is the
highest possible value given the values of area and magnetic field.

Part (a) of Figure 13.5 depicts a circuit and an arbitrary surface S that it bounds. Notice that S is an open
surface. It can be shown that any open surface bounded by the circuit in question can be used to evaluate
For example, is the same for the various surfaces of part (b) of the figure.

Figure 13.5 (a) A circuit bounding an arbitrary open surface S. The planar area bounded by the circuit is not part of S. (b) Three arbitrary
open surfaces bounded by the same circuit. The value of is the same for all these surfaces.

The SI unit for magnetic flux is the weber (Wb),

Occasionally, the magnetic field unit is expressed as webers per square meter ( ) instead of teslas, based
on this definition. In many practical applications, the circuit of interest consists of a number N of tightly wound
turns (see Figure 13.6). Each turn experiences the same magnetic flux. Therefore, the net magnetic flux
through the circuits is N times the flux through one turn, and Faraday’s law is written as

13.3

EXAMPLE 13.1

A Square Coil in a Changing Magnetic Field


The square coil of Figure 13.6 has sides long and is tightly wound with turns of wire. The
resistance of the coil is The coil is placed in a spatially uniform magnetic field that is directed
perpendicular to the face of the coil and whose magnitude is decreasing at a rate (a) What
is the magnitude of the emf induced in the coil? (b) What is the magnitude of the current circulating through
the coil?

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.1 • Faraday’s Law 569

Figure 13.6 A square coil with N turns of wire with uniform magnetic field directed in the downward direction, perpendicular to the coil.

Strategy
The area vector, or direction, is perpendicular to area covering the loop. We will choose this to be pointing
downward so that is parallel to and that the flux turns into multiplication of magnetic field times area. The
area of the loop is not changing in time, so it can be factored out of the time derivative, leaving the magnetic
field as the only quantity varying in time. Lastly, we can apply Ohm’s law once we know the induced emf to find
the current in the loop.

Solution

a. The flux through one turn is

so we can calculate the magnitude of the emf from Faraday’s law. The sign of the emf will be discussed in
the next section, on Lenz’s law:

b. The magnitude of the current induced in the coil is

Significance
If the area of the loop were changing in time, we would not be able to pull it out of the time derivative. Since the
loop is a closed path, the result of this current would be a small amount of heating of the wires until the
magnetic field stops changing. This may increase the area of the loop slightly as the wires are heated.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.1


A closely wound coil has a radius of 4.0 cm, 50 turns, and a total resistance of . At what rate must a
magnetic field perpendicular to the face of the coil change in order to produce Joule heating in the coil at a rate
of 2.0 mW?
570 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

13.2 Lenz's Law


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Use Lenz’s law to determine the direction of induced emf whenever a magnetic flux changes
• Use Faraday’s law with Lenz’s law to determine the induced emf in a coil and in a solenoid

The direction in which the induced emf drives current around a wire loop can be found through the negative
sign. However, it is usually easier to determine this direction with Lenz’s law, named in honor of its discoverer,
Heinrich Lenz (1804–1865). (Faraday also discovered this law, independently of Lenz.) We state Lenz’s law as
follows:

Lenz’s Law
The direction of the induced emf drives current around a wire loop to always oppose the change in
magnetic flux that causes the emf.

Lenz’s law can also be considered in terms of conservation of energy. If pushing a magnet into a coil causes
current, the energy in that current must have come from somewhere. If the induced current causes a magnetic
field opposing the increase in field of the magnet we pushed in, then the situation is clear. We pushed a magnet
against a field and did work on the system, and that showed up as current. If it were not the case that the
induced field opposes the change in the flux, the magnet would be pulled in produce a current without
anything having done work. Electric potential energy would have been created, violating the conservation of
energy.

To determine an induced emf , you first calculate the magnetic flux and then obtain The
magnitude of is given by Finally, you can apply Lenz’s law to determine the sense of . This
will be developed through examples that illustrate the following problem-solving strategy.

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Lenz’s Law
To use Lenz’s law to determine the directions of induced magnetic fields, currents, and emfs:

1. Make a sketch of the situation for use in visualizing and recording directions.
2. Determine the direction of the applied magnetic field
3. Determine whether its magnetic flux is increasing or decreasing.
4. Now determine the direction of the induced magnetic field The induced magnetic field tries to reinforce
a magnetic flux that is decreasing or opposes a magnetic flux that is increasing. Therefore, the induced
magnetic field adds or subtracts to the applied magnetic field, depending on the change in magnetic flux.
5. Use right-hand rule 2 (RHR-2; see Magnetic Forces and Fields) to determine the direction of the induced
current I that is responsible for the induced magnetic field
6. The direction (or polarity) of the induced emf can now drive a conventional current in this direction.

Let’s apply Lenz’s law to the system of Figure 13.7(a). We designate the “front” of the closed conducting loop as
the region containing the approaching bar magnet, and the “back” of the loop as the other region. As the north
pole of the magnet moves toward the loop, the flux through the loop due to the field of the magnet increases
because the strength of field lines directed from the front to the back of the loop is increasing. A current is
therefore induced in the loop. By Lenz’s law, the direction of the induced current must be such that its own
magnetic field is directed in a way to oppose the changing flux caused by the field of the approaching magnet.
Hence, the induced current circulates so that its magnetic field lines through the loop are directed from the
back to the front of the loop. By RHR-2, place your thumb pointing against the magnetic field lines, which is
toward the bar magnet. Your fingers wrap in a counterclockwise direction as viewed from the bar magnet.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.2 • Lenz's Law 571

Alternatively, we can determine the direction of the induced current by treating the current loop as an
electromagnet that opposes the approach of the north pole of the bar magnet. This occurs when the induced
current flows as shown, for then the face of the loop nearer the approaching magnet is also a north pole.

Figure 13.7 The change in magnetic flux caused by the approaching magnet induces a current in the loop. (a) An approaching north pole
induces a counterclockwise current with respect to the bar magnet. (b) An approaching south pole induces a clockwise current with respect
to the bar magnet.

Part (b) of the figure shows the south pole of a magnet moving toward a conducting loop. In this case, the flux
through the loop due to the field of the magnet increases because the number of field lines directed from the
back to the front of the loop is increasing. To oppose this change, a current is induced in the loop whose field
lines through the loop are directed from the front to the back. Equivalently, we can say that the current flows in
a direction so that the face of the loop nearer the approaching magnet is a south pole, which then repels the
approaching south pole of the magnet. By RHR-2, your thumb points away from the bar magnet. Your fingers
wrap in a clockwise fashion, which is the direction of the induced current.

Another example illustrating the use of Lenz’s law is shown in Figure 13.8. When the switch is opened, the
decrease in current through the solenoid causes a decrease in magnetic flux through its coils, which induces
an emf in the solenoid. This emf must oppose the change (the termination of the current) causing it.
Consequently, the induced emf has the polarity shown and drives in the direction of the original current. This
may generate an arc across the terminals of the switch as it is opened.

Figure 13.8 (a) A solenoid connected to a source of emf. (b) Opening switch S terminates the current, which in turn induces an emf in the
solenoid. (c) A potential difference between the ends of the sharply pointed rods is produced by inducing an emf in a coil. This potential
difference is large enough to produce an arc between the sharp points.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.2


Find the direction of the induced current in the wire loop shown below as the magnet enters, passes through,
and leaves the loop.
572 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.3


Verify the directions of the induced currents in Figure 13.3.

EXAMPLE 13.2

A Circular Coil in a Changing Magnetic Field


A magnetic field is directed outward perpendicular to the plane of a circular coil of radius (Figure
13.9). The field is cylindrically symmetrical with respect to the center of the coil, and its magnitude decays
exponentially according to where B is in teslas and t is in seconds. (a) Calculate the emf
induced in the coil at the times and (b) Determine the current in the coil
at these three times if its resistance is

Figure 13.9 A circular coil in a decreasing magnetic field.

Strategy
Since the magnetic field is perpendicular to the plane of the coil and constant over each spot in the coil, the dot
product of the magnetic field and normal to the area unit vector turns into a multiplication. The magnetic
field can be pulled out of the integration, leaving the flux as the product of the magnetic field times area. We
need to take the time derivative of the exponential function to calculate the emf using Faraday’s law. Then we
use Ohm’s law to calculate the current.

Solution

a. Since is perpendicular to the plane of the coil, the magnetic flux is given by

From Faraday’s law, the magnitude of the induced emf is

Since is directed out of the page and is decreasing, the induced current must flow counterclockwise

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.2 • Lenz's Law 573

when viewed from above so that the magnetic field it produces through the coil also points out of the page.
For all three times, the sense of ε is counterclockwise; its magnitudes are

b. From Ohm’s law, the respective currents are

and

Significance
An emf voltage is created by a changing magnetic flux over time. If we know how the magnetic field varies with
time over a constant area, we can take its time derivative to calculate the induced emf.

EXAMPLE 13.3

Changing Magnetic Field Inside a Solenoid


The current through the windings of a solenoid with turns per meter is changing at a rate
(See Sources of Magnetic Fields for a discussion of solenoids.) The solenoid is 50-cm long and
has a cross-sectional diameter of 3.0 cm. A small coil consisting of closely wound turns wrapped in a
circle of diameter 1.0 cm is placed in the middle of the solenoid such that the plane of the coil is perpendicular
to the central axis of the solenoid. Assuming that the infinite-solenoid approximation is valid at the location of
the small coil, determine the magnitude of the emf induced in the coil.

Strategy
The magnetic field in the middle of the solenoid is a uniform value of This field is producing a maximum
magnetic flux through the coil as it is directed along the length of the solenoid. Therefore, the magnetic flux
through the coil is the product of the solenoid’s magnetic field times the area of the coil. Faraday’s law involves
a time derivative of the magnetic flux. The only quantity varying in time is the current, the rest can be pulled
out of the time derivative. Lastly, we include the number of turns in the coil to determine the induced emf in
the coil.

Solution
Since the field of the solenoid is given by the flux through each turn of the small coil is

where d is the diameter of the coil. Now from Faraday’s law, the magnitude of the emf induced in the coil is

Significance
When the current is turned on in a vertical solenoid, as shown in Figure 13.10, the ring has an induced emf
from the solenoid’s changing magnetic flux that opposes the change. The result is that the ring is fired
vertically into the air.
574 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.10 The jumping ring. When a current is turned on in the vertical solenoid, a current is induced in the metal ring. The stray field
produced by the solenoid causes the ring to jump off the solenoid.

INTERACTIVE
Visit this website (https://openstax.org/l/21mitjumpring) for a demonstration of the jumping ring from MIT.

13.3 Motional Emf


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Determine the magnitude of an induced emf in a wire moving at a constant speed through a magnetic field
• Discuss examples that use motional emf, such as a rail gun and a tethered satellite

Magnetic flux depends on three factors: the strength of the magnetic field, the area through which the field
lines pass, and the orientation of the field with the surface area. If any of these quantities varies, a
corresponding variation in magnetic flux occurs. So far, we’ve only considered flux changes due to a changing
field. Now we look at another possibility: a changing area through which the field lines pass including a change
in the orientation of the area.

Two examples of this type of flux change are represented in Figure 13.11. In part (a), the flux through the
rectangular loop increases as it moves into the magnetic field, and in part (b), the flux through the rotating coil
varies with the angle .

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.3 • Motional Emf 575

Figure 13.11 (a) Magnetic flux changes as a loop moves into a magnetic field; (b) magnetic flux changes as a loop rotates in a magnetic
field.

It’s interesting to note that what we perceive as the cause of a particular flux change actually depends on the
frame of reference we choose. For example, if you are at rest relative to the moving coils of Figure 13.11, you
would see the flux vary because of a changing magnetic field—in part (a), the field moves from left to right in
your reference frame, and in part (b), the field is rotating. It is often possible to describe a flux change through
a coil that is moving in one particular reference frame in terms of a changing magnetic field in a second frame,
where the coil is stationary. However, reference-frame questions related to magnetic flux are beyond the level
of this textbook. We’ll avoid such complexities by always working in a frame at rest relative to the laboratory
and explain flux variations as due to either a changing field or a changing area.

Now let’s look at a conducting rod pulled in a circuit, changing magnetic flux. The area enclosed by the circuit
‘MNOP’ of Figure 13.12 is lx and is perpendicular to the magnetic field, so we can simplify the integration of
Equation 13.1 into a multiplication of magnetic field and area. The magnetic flux through the open surface is
therefore
13.4
Since B and l are constant and the velocity of the rod is we can now restate Faraday’s law, Equation
13.2, for the magnitude of the emf in terms of the moving conducting rod as

13.5

The current induced in the circuit is the emf divided by the resistance or

Furthermore, the direction of the induced emf satisfies Lenz’s law, as you can verify by inspection of the figure.

This calculation of motionally induced emf is not restricted to a rod moving on conducting rails. With
as the starting point, it can be shown that holds for any change in flux caused by the
motion of a conductor. We saw in Faraday’s Law that the emf induced by a time-varying magnetic field obeys
this same relationship, which is Faraday’s law. Thus Faraday’s law holds for all flux changes, whether they are
produced by a changing magnetic field, by motion, or by a combination of the two.
576 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.12 A conducting rod is pushed to the right at constant velocity. The resulting change in the magnetic flux induces a current in
the circuit.

From an energy perspective, produces power and the resistor dissipates power . Since the rod is
moving at constant velocity, the applied force must balance the magnetic force on the rod when
it is carrying the induced current I. Thus the power produced is

13.6

The power dissipated is

13.7

In satisfying the principle of energy conservation, the produced and dissipated powers are equal.

This principle can be seen in the operation of a rail gun. A rail gun is an electromagnetic projectile launcher
that uses an apparatus similar to Figure 13.12 and is shown in schematic form in Figure 13.13. The conducting
rod is replaced with a projectile or weapon to be fired. So far, we’ve only heard about how motion causes an
emf. In a rail gun, the optimal shutting off/ramping down of a magnetic field decreases the flux in between the
rails, causing a current to flow in the rod (armature) that holds the projectile. This current through the
armature experiences a magnetic force and is propelled forward. Rail guns, however, are not used widely in the
military due to the high cost of production and high currents: Nearly one million amps is required to produce
enough energy for a rail gun to be an effective weapon.

Figure 13.13 Current through two rails drives a conductive projectile forward by the magnetic force created.

We can calculate a motionally induced emf with Faraday’s law even when an actual closed circuit is not
present. We simply imagine an enclosed area whose boundary includes the moving conductor, calculate ,

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.3 • Motional Emf 577

and then find the emf from Faraday’s law. For example, we can let the moving rod of Figure 13.14 be one side
of the imaginary rectangular area represented by the dashed lines. The area of the rectangle is lx, so the
magnetic flux through it is Differentiating this equation, we obtain

13.8

which is identical to the potential difference between the ends of the rod that we determined earlier.

Figure 13.14 With the imaginary rectangle shown, we can use Faraday’s law to calculate the induced emf in the moving rod.

Motional emfs in Earth’s weak magnetic field are not ordinarily very large, or we would notice voltage along
metal rods, such as a screwdriver, during ordinary motions. For example, a simple calculation of the motional
emf of a 1.0-m rod moving at 3.0 m/s perpendicular to the Earth’s field gives

This small value is consistent with experience. There is a spectacular exception, however. In 1992 and 1996,
attempts were made with the space shuttle to create large motional emfs. The tethered satellite was to be let
out on a 20-km length of wire, as shown in Figure 13.15, to create a 5-kV emf by moving at orbital speed
through Earth’s field. This emf could be used to convert some of the shuttle’s kinetic and potential energy into
electrical energy if a complete circuit could be made. To complete the circuit, the stationary ionosphere was to
supply a return path through which current could flow. (The ionosphere is the rarefied and partially ionized
atmosphere at orbital altitudes. It conducts because of the ionization. The ionosphere serves the same function
as the stationary rails and connecting resistor in Figure 13.13, without which there would not be a complete
circuit.) Drag on the current in the cable due to the magnetic force does the work that reduces
the shuttle’s kinetic and potential energy, and allows it to be converted into electrical energy. Both tests were
unsuccessful. In the first, the cable hung up and could only be extended a couple of hundred meters; in the
second, the cable broke when almost fully extended. Example 13.4 indicates feasibility in principle.
578 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.15 Motional emf as electrical power conversion for the space shuttle was the motivation for the tethered satellite experiment.
A 5-kV emf was predicted to be induced in the 20-km tether while moving at orbital speed in Earth’s magnetic field. The circuit is
completed by a return path through the stationary ionosphere.

EXAMPLE 13.4

Calculating the Large Motional Emf of an Object in Orbit


Calculate the motional emf induced along a 20.0-km conductor moving at an orbital speed of 7.80 km/s
perpendicular to Earth’s magnetic field.

Strategy
This is a great example of using the equation motional

Solution
Entering the given values into gives

Significance
The value obtained is greater than the 5-kV measured voltage for the shuttle experiment, since the actual
orbital motion of the tether is not perpendicular to Earth’s field. The 7.80-kV value is the maximum emf
obtained when and so

EXAMPLE 13.5

A Metal Rod Rotating in a Magnetic Field


Part (a) of Figure 13.16 shows a metal rod OS that is rotating in a horizontal plane around point O. The rod
slides along a wire that forms a circular arc PST of radius r. The system is in a constant magnetic field that is
directed out of the page. (a) If you rotate the rod at a constant angular velocity , what is the current I in the
closed loop OPSO? Assume that the resistor R furnishes all of the resistance in the closed loop. (b) Calculate the
work per unit time that you do while rotating the rod and show that it is equal to the power dissipated in the
resistor.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.3 • Motional Emf 579

Figure 13.16 (a) The end of a rotating metal rod slides along a circular wire in a horizontal plane. (b) The induced current in the rod. (c)
The magnetic force on an infinitesimal current segment.

Strategy
The magnetic flux is the magnetic field times the area of the quarter circle or When finding the emf
through Faraday’s law, all variables are constant in time but , with To calculate the work per unit
time, we know this is related to the torque times the angular velocity. The torque is calculated by knowing the
force on a rod and integrating it over the length of the rod.

Solution

a. From geometry, the area of the loop OPSO is Hence, the magnetic flux through the loop is

Differentiating with respect to time and using we have

When divided by the resistance R of the loop, this yields for the magnitude of the induced current

As increases, so does the flux through the loop due to To counteract this increase, the magnetic field
due to the induced current must be directed into the page in the region enclosed by the loop. Therefore, as
part (b) of Figure 13.16 illustrates, the current circulates clockwise.
b. You rotate the rod by exerting a torque on it. Since the rod rotates at constant angular velocity, this torque
is equal and opposite to the torque exerted on the current in the rod by the original magnetic field. The
magnetic force on the infinitesimal segment of length dx shown in part (c) of Figure 13.16 is
so the magnetic torque on this segment is

The net magnetic torque on the rod is then

The torque that you exert on the rod is equal and opposite to and the work that you do when the rod
rotates through an angle is Hence, the work per unit time that you do on the rod is

where we have substituted for I. The power dissipated in the resister is , which can be written as
580 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Therefore, we see that

Hence, the power dissipated in the resistor is equal to the work per unit time done in rotating the rod.

Significance
An alternative way of looking at the induced emf from Faraday’s law is to integrate in space instead of time.
The solution, however, would be the same. The motional emf is

The velocity can be written as the angular velocity times the radius and the differential length written as dr.
Therefore,

which is the same solution as before.

EXAMPLE 13.6

A Rectangular Coil Rotating in a Magnetic Field


A rectangular coil of area A and N turns is placed in a uniform magnetic field as shown in Figure
13.17. The coil is rotated about the z-axis through its center at a constant angular velocity Obtain an
expression for the induced emf in the coil.

Figure 13.17 A rectangular coil rotating in a uniform magnetic field.

Strategy
According to the diagram, the angle between the perpendicular to the surface ( ) and the magnetic field is
. The dot product of simplifies to only the component of the magnetic field, namely where the
magnetic field projects onto the unit area vector . The magnitude of the magnetic field and the area of the

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.3 • Motional Emf 581

loop are fixed over time, which makes the integration simplify quickly. The induced emf is written out using
Faraday’s law.

Solution
When the coil is in a position such that its normal vector makes an angle with the magnetic field the
magnetic flux through a single turn of the coil is

From Faraday’s law, the emf induced in the coil is

The constant angular velocity is The angle represents the time evolution of the angular velocity or
. This is changes the function to time space rather than . The induced emf therefore varies sinusoidally
with time according to

where

Significance
If the magnetic field strength or area of the loop were also changing over time, these variables wouldn’t be able
to be pulled out of the time derivative to simply the solution as shown. This example is the basis for an electric
generator, as we will give a full discussion in Applications of Newton’s Law.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.4


Shown below is a rod of length l that is rotated counterclockwise around the axis through O by the torque due
to Assuming that the rod is in a uniform magnetic field , what is the emf induced between the ends of the
rod when its angular velocity is ? Which end of the rod is at a higher potential?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.5


A rod of length 10 cm moves at a speed of 10 m/s perpendicularly through a 1.5-T magnetic field. What is the
potential difference between the ends of the rod?
582 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

13.4 Induced Electric Fields


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Connect the relationship between an induced emf from Faraday’s law to an electric field, thereby showing
that a changing magnetic flux creates an electric field
• Solve for the electric field based on a changing magnetic flux in time

The fact that emfs are induced in circuits implies that work is being done on the conduction electrons in the
wires. What can possibly be the source of this work? We know that it’s neither a battery nor a magnetic field,
for a battery does not have to be present in a circuit where current is induced, and magnetic fields never do
work on moving charges. The answer is that the source of the work is an electric field that is induced in the
wires. The work done by in moving a unit charge completely around a circuit is the induced emf ε; that is,

13.9

where represents the line integral around the circuit. Faraday’s law can be written in terms of the induced

electric field as

13.10

There is an important distinction between the electric field induced by a changing magnetic field and the
electrostatic field produced by a fixed charge distribution. Specifically, the induced electric field is
nonconservative because it does net work in moving a charge over a closed path, whereas the electrostatic
field is conservative and does no net work over a closed path. Hence, electric potential can be associated with
the electrostatic field, but not with the induced field. The following equations represent the distinction
between the two types of electric field:

13.11

Our results can be summarized by combining these equations:

13.12

EXAMPLE 13.7

Induced Electric Field in a Circular Coil


What is the induced electric field in the circular coil of Example 13.2 (and Figure 13.9) at the three times
indicated?

Strategy
Using cylindrical symmetry, the electric field integral simplifies into the electric field times the circumference
of a circle. Since we already know the induced emf, we can connect these two expressions by Faraday’s law to
solve for the induced electric field.

Solution
The induced electric field in the coil is constant in magnitude over the cylindrical surface, similar to how
Ampere’s law problems with cylinders are solved. Since is tangent to the coil,

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.4 • Induced Electric Fields 583

When combined with Equation 13.12, this gives

The direction of is counterclockwise, and circulates in the same direction around the coil. The values of E
are

Significance
When the magnetic flux through a circuit changes, a nonconservative electric field is induced, which drives
current through the circuit. But what happens if in free space where there isn’t a conducting path?
The answer is that this case can be treated as if a conducting path were present; that is, nonconservative
electric fields are induced wherever whether or not there is a conducting path present.

These nonconservative electric fields always satisfy Equation 13.12. For example, if the circular coil of Figure
13.9 were removed, an electric field in free space at would still be directed counterclockwise, and
its magnitude would still be 1.9 V/m at , 1.5 V/m at etc. The existence of induced electric
fields is certainly not restricted to wires in circuits.

EXAMPLE 13.8

Electric Field Induced by the Changing Magnetic Field of a Solenoid


Part (a) of Figure 13.18 shows a long solenoid with radius R and n turns per unit length; its current decreases
with time according to What is the magnitude of the induced electric field at a point a distance r
from the central axis of the solenoid (a) when and (b) when [see part (b) of Figure 13.18]. (c) What
is the direction of the induced field at both locations? Assume that the infinite-solenoid approximation is valid
throughout the regions of interest.
584 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.18 (a) The current in a long solenoid is decreasing exponentially. (b) A cross-sectional view of the solenoid from its left end. The
cross-section shown is near the middle of the solenoid. An electric field is induced both inside and outside the solenoid.

Strategy
Using the formula for the magnetic field inside an infinite solenoid and Faraday’s law, we calculate the induced
emf. Since we have cylindrical symmetry, the electric field integral reduces to the electric field times the
circumference of the integration path. Then we solve for the electric field.

Solution

a. The magnetic field is confined to the interior of the solenoid where

Thus, the magnetic flux through a circular path whose radius r is greater than R, the solenoid radius, is

The induced field is tangent to this path, and because of the cylindrical symmetry of the system, its
magnitude is constant on the path. Hence, we have

b. For a path of radius r inside the solenoid, so

and the induced field is

c. The magnetic field points into the page as shown in part (b) and is decreasing. If either of the circular
paths were occupied by conducting rings, the currents induced in them would circulate as shown, in

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.4 • Induced Electric Fields 585

conformity with Lenz’s law. The induced electric field must be so directed as well.

Significance
In part (b), note that increases with r inside and decreases as 1/r outside the solenoid, as shown in Figure
13.19.

Figure 13.19 The electric field vs. distance r. When the electric field rises linearly, whereas when the electric field falls of
proportional to 1/r.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.6


Suppose that the coil of Example 13.2 is a square rather than circular. Can Equation 13.12 be used to calculate
(a) the induced emf and (b) the induced electric field?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.7


What is the magnitude of the induced electric field in Example 13.8 at if
turns per meter, and

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.8


The magnetic field shown below is confined to the cylindrical region shown and is changing with time. Identify
those paths for which
586 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 13.9


A long solenoid of cross-sectional area is wound with 25 turns of wire per centimeter. It is placed in the
middle of a closely wrapped coil of 10 turns and radius 25 cm, as shown below. (a) What is the emf induced in
the coil when the current through the solenoid is decreasing at a rate (b) What is the
electric field induced in the coil?

13.5 Eddy Currents


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how eddy currents are created in metals
• Describe situations where eddy currents are beneficial and where they are not helpful

As discussed two sections earlier, a motional emf is induced when a conductor moves in a magnetic field or
when a magnetic field moves relative to a conductor. If motional emf can cause a current in the conductor, we
refer to that current as an eddy current.

Magnetic Damping
Eddy currents can produce significant drag, called magnetic damping, on the motion involved. Consider the
apparatus shown in Figure 13.20, which swings a pendulum bob between the poles of a strong magnet. (This is
another favorite physics demonstration.) If the bob is metal, significant drag acts on the bob as it enters and
leaves the field, quickly damping the motion. If, however, the bob is a slotted metal plate, as shown in part (b) of
the figure, the magnet produces a much smaller effect. There is no discernible effect on a bob made of an
insulator. Why does drag occur in both directions, and are there any uses for magnetic drag?

Figure 13.20 A common physics demonstration device for exploring eddy currents and magnetic damping. (a) The motion of a metal
pendulum bob swinging between the poles of a magnet is quickly damped by the action of eddy currents. (b) There is little effect on the
motion of a slotted metal bob, implying that eddy currents are made less effective. (c) There is also no magnetic damping on a
nonconducting bob, since the eddy currents are extremely small.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.5 • Eddy Currents 587

Figure 13.21 shows what happens to the metal plate as it enters and leaves the magnetic field. In both cases, it
experiences a force opposing its motion. As it enters from the left, flux increases, setting up an eddy current
(Faraday’s law) in the counterclockwise direction (Lenz’s law), as shown. Only the right-hand side of the
current loop is in the field, so an unopposed force acts on it to the left (RHR-1). When the metal plate is
completely inside the field, there is no eddy current if the field is uniform, since the flux remains constant in
this region. But when the plate leaves the field on the right, flux decreases, causing an eddy current in the
clockwise direction that, again, experiences a force to the left, further slowing the motion. A similar analysis of
what happens when the plate swings from the right toward the left shows that its motion is also damped when
entering and leaving the field.

Figure 13.21 A more detailed look at the conducting plate passing between the poles of a magnet. As it enters and leaves the field, the
change in flux produces an eddy current. Magnetic force on the current loop opposes the motion. There is no current and no magnetic drag
when the plate is completely inside the uniform field.

When a slotted metal plate enters the field (Figure 13.22), an emf is induced by the change in flux, but it is less
effective because the slots limit the size of the current loops. Moreover, adjacent loops have currents in
opposite directions, and their effects cancel. When an insulating material is used, the eddy current is
extremely small, so magnetic damping on insulators is negligible. If eddy currents are to be avoided in
conductors, then they must be slotted or constructed of thin layers of conducting material separated by
insulating sheets.

Figure 13.22 Eddy currents induced in a slotted metal plate entering a magnetic field form small loops, and the forces on them tend to
588 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

cancel, thereby making magnetic drag almost zero.

Applications of Magnetic Damping


One use of magnetic damping is found in sensitive laboratory balances. To have maximum sensitivity and
accuracy, the balance must be as friction-free as possible. But if it is friction-free, then it will oscillate for a very
long time. Magnetic damping is a simple and ideal solution. With magnetic damping, drag is proportional to
speed and becomes zero at zero velocity. Thus, the oscillations are quickly damped, after which the damping
force disappears, allowing the balance to be very sensitive (Figure 13.23). In most balances, magnetic damping
is accomplished with a conducting disc that rotates in a fixed field.

Figure 13.23 Magnetic damping of this sensitive balance slows its oscillations. Since Faraday’s law of induction gives the greatest effect
for the most rapid change, damping is greatest for large oscillations and goes to zero as the motion stops.

Since eddy currents and magnetic damping occur only in conductors, recycling centers can use magnets to
separate metals from other materials. Trash is dumped in batches down a ramp, beneath which lies a powerful
magnet. Conductors in the trash are slowed by magnetic damping while nonmetals in the trash move on,
separating from the metals (Figure 13.24). This works for all metals, not just ferromagnetic ones. A magnet can
separate out the ferromagnetic materials alone by acting on stationary trash.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.5 • Eddy Currents 589

Figure 13.24 Metals can be separated from other trash by magnetic drag. Eddy currents and magnetic drag are created in the metals sent
down this ramp by the powerful magnet beneath it. Nonmetals move on.

Other major applications of eddy currents appear in metal detectors and braking systems in trains and roller
coasters. Portable metal detectors (Figure 13.25) consist of a primary coil carrying an alternating current and a
secondary coil in which a current is induced. An eddy current is induced in a piece of metal close to the
detector, causing a change in the induced current within the secondary coil. This can trigger some sort of
signal, such as a shrill noise.

Figure 13.25 A soldier in Iraq uses a metal detector to search for explosives and weapons. (credit: U.S. Army)

Braking using eddy currents is safer because factors such as rain do not affect the braking and the braking is
smoother. However, eddy currents cannot bring the motion to a complete stop, since the braking force
produced decreases as speed is reduced. Thus, speed can be reduced from say 20 m/s to 5 m/s, but another
form of braking is needed to completely stop the vehicle. Generally, powerful rare-earth magnets such as
neodymium magnets are used in roller coasters. Figure 13.26 shows rows of magnets in such an application.
The vehicle has metal fins (normally containing copper) that pass through the magnetic field, slowing the
vehicle down in much the same way as with the pendulum bob shown in Figure 13.20.
590 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.26 The rows of rare-earth magnets (protruding horizontally) are used for magnetic braking in roller coasters. (credit: Stefan
Scheer)

Induction cooktops have electromagnets under their surface. The magnetic field is varied rapidly, producing
eddy currents in the base of the pot, causing the pot and its contents to increase in temperature. Induction
cooktops have high efficiencies and good response times when the base of the pot is a conductor, such as iron
or steel.

13.6 Electric Generators and Back Emf


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how an electric generator works
• Determine the induced emf in a loop at any time interval, rotating at a constant rate in a magnetic field
• Show that rotating coils have an induced emf; in motors this is called back emf because it opposes the emf
input to the motor

A variety of important phenomena and devices can be understood with Faraday’s law. In this section, we
examine two of these.

Electric Generators
Electric generators induce an emf by rotating a coil in a magnetic field, as briefly discussed in Motional Emf.
We now explore generators in more detail. Consider the following example.

EXAMPLE 13.9

Calculating the Emf Induced in a Generator Coil


The generator coil shown in Figure 13.27 is rotated through one-fourth of a revolution (from to
in 15.0 ms. The 200-turn circular coil has a 5.00-cm radius and is in a uniform 0.80-T magnetic field. What is
the emf induced?

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.6 • Electric Generators and Back Emf 591

Figure 13.27 When this generator coil is rotated through one-fourth of a revolution, the magnetic flux changes from its maximum to
zero, inducing an emf.

Strategy
Faraday’s law of induction is used to find the emf induced:

We recognize this situation as the same one in Example 13.6. According to the diagram, the projection of the
surface normal vector to the magnetic field is initially and this is inserted by the definition of the dot
product. The magnitude of the magnetic field and area of the loop are fixed over time, which makes the
integration simplify quickly. The induced emf is written out using Faraday’s law:

Solution
We are given that , , and The area of the loop is

Entering this value gives


592 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Significance
This is a practical average value, similar to the 120 V used in household power.

The emf calculated in Example 13.9 is the average over one-fourth of a revolution. What is the emf at any given
instant? It varies with the angle between the magnetic field and a perpendicular to the coil. We can get an
expression for emf as a function of time by considering the motional emf on a rotating rectangular coil of width
w and height l in a uniform magnetic field, as illustrated in Figure 13.28.

Figure 13.28 A generator with a single rectangular coil rotated at constant angular velocity in a uniform magnetic field produces an emf
that varies sinusoidally in time. Note the generator is similar to a motor, except the shaft is rotated to produce a current rather than the
other way around.

Charges in the wires of the loop experience the magnetic force, because they are moving in a magnetic field.
Charges in the vertical wires experience forces parallel to the wire, causing currents. But those in the top and
bottom segments feel a force perpendicular to the wire, which does not cause a current. We can thus find the
induced emf by considering only the side wires. Motional emf is given to be , where the velocity v is
perpendicular to the magnetic field B. Here the velocity is at an angle with B, so that its component
perpendicular to B is v sin (see Figure 13.28). Thus, in this case, the emf induced on each side is
, and they are in the same direction. The total emf around the loop is then
13.13
This expression is valid, but it does not give emf as a function of time. To find the time dependence of emf, we
assume the coil rotates at a constant angular velocity . The angle is related to angular velocity by so
that
13.14
Now, linear velocity v is related to angular velocity by Here, so that and

13.15

Noting that the area of the loop is and allowing for N loops, we find that

13.16

This is the emf induced in a generator coil of N turns and area A rotating at a constant angular velocity in a
uniform magnetic field B. This can also be expressed as
13.17
where
13.18
is the peak emf, since the maximum value of . Note that the frequency of the oscillation is

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.6 • Electric Generators and Back Emf 593

and the period is Figure 13.29 shows a graph of emf as a function of time, and it now seems
reasonable that ac voltage is sinusoidal.

Figure 13.29 The emf of a generator is sent to a light bulb with the system of rings and brushes shown. The graph gives the emf of the
generator as a function of time, where is the peak emf. The period is where f is the frequency.

The fact that the peak emf is makes good sense. The greater the number of coils, the larger their
area, and the stronger the field, the greater the output voltage. It is interesting that the faster the generator is
spun (greater ), the greater the emf. This is noticeable on bicycle generators—at least the cheaper varieties.

Figure 13.30 shows a scheme by which a generator can be made to produce pulsed dc. More elaborate
arrangements of multiple coils and split rings can produce smoother dc, although electronic rather than
mechanical means are usually used to make ripple-free dc.

Figure 13.30 Split rings, called commutators, produce a pulsed dc emf output in this configuration.

In real life, electric generators look a lot different from the figures in this section, but the principles are the
same. The source of mechanical energy that turns the coil can be falling water (hydropower), steam produced
by the burning of fossil fuels, or the kinetic energy of wind. Figure 13.31 shows a cutaway view of a steam
turbine; steam moves over the blades connected to the shaft, which rotates the coil within the generator. The
generation of electrical energy from mechanical energy is the basic principle of all power that is sent through
our electrical grids to our homes.
594 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

Figure 13.31 Steam turbine/generator. The steam produced by burning coal impacts the turbine blades, turning the shaft, which is
connected to the generator.

Generators illustrated in this section look very much like the motors illustrated previously. This is not
coincidental. In fact, a motor becomes a generator when its shaft rotates. Certain early automobiles used their
starter motor as a generator. In the next section, we further explore the action of a motor as a generator.

Back Emf
Generators convert mechanical energy into electrical energy, whereas motors convert electrical energy into
mechanical energy. Thus, it is not surprising that motors and generators have the same general construction.
A motor works by sending a current through a loop of wire located in a magnetic field. As a result, the magnetic
field exerts torque on the loop. This rotates a shaft, thereby extracting mechanical work out of the electrical
current sent in initially. (Refer to Force and Torque on a Current Loop for a discussion on motors that will help
you understand more about them before proceeding.)

When the coil of a motor is turned, magnetic flux changes through the coil, and an emf (consistent with
Faraday’s law) is induced. The motor thus acts as a generator whenever its coil rotates. This happens whether
the shaft is turned by an external input, like a belt drive, or by the action of the motor itself. That is, when a
motor is doing work and its shaft is turning, an emf is generated. Lenz’s law tells us the emf opposes any
change, so that the input emf that powers the motor is opposed by the motor’s self-generated emf, called the
back emf of the motor (Figure 13.32).

Figure 13.32 The coil of a dc motor is represented as a resistor in this schematic. The back emf is represented as a variable emf that
opposes the emf driving the motor. Back emf is zero when the motor is not turning and increases proportionally to the motor’s angular
velocity.

The generator output of a motor is the difference between the supply voltage and the back emf. The back emf is

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.6 • Electric Generators and Back Emf 595

zero when the motor is first turned on, meaning that the coil receives the full driving voltage and the motor
draws maximum current when it is on but not turning. As the motor turns faster, the back emf grows, always
opposing the driving emf, and reduces both the voltage across the coil and the amount of current it draws. This
effect is noticeable in many common situations. When a vacuum cleaner, refrigerator, or washing machine is
first turned on, lights in the same circuit dim briefly due to the IR drop produced in feeder lines by the large
current drawn by the motor.

When a motor first comes on, it draws more current than when it runs at its normal operating speed. When a
mechanical load is placed on the motor, like an electric wheelchair going up a hill, the motor slows, the back
emf drops, more current flows, and more work can be done. If the motor runs at too low a speed, the larger
current can overheat it (via resistive power in the coil, perhaps even burning it out. On the other
hand, if there is no mechanical load on the motor, it increases its angular velocity until the back emf is
nearly equal to the driving emf. Then the motor uses only enough energy to overcome friction.

Eddy currents in iron cores of motors can cause troublesome energy losses. These are usually minimized by
constructing the cores out of thin, electrically insulated sheets of iron. The magnetic properties of the core are
hardly affected by the lamination of the insulating sheet, while the resistive heating is reduced considerably.
Consider, for example, the motor coils represented in Figure 13.32. The coils have an equivalent resistance of
and are driven by an emf of 48.0 V. Shortly after being turned on, they draw a current

and thus dissipate of energy as heat transfer. Under normal operating conditions for this
motor, suppose the back emf is 40.0 V. Then at operating speed, the total voltage across the coils is 8.0 V (48.0
V minus the 40.0 V back emf), and the current drawn is

Under normal load, then, the power dissipated is This does not cause a
problem for this motor, whereas the former 5.76 kW would burn out the coils if sustained.

EXAMPLE 13.10

A Series-Wound Motor in Operation


The total resistance of a series-wound dc motor is (Figure 13.33). When connected to a 120-V
source ( ), the motor draws 10 A while running at constant angular velocity. (a) What is the back emf induced
in the rotating coil, (b) What is the mechanical power output of the motor? (c) How much power is
dissipated in the resistance of the coils? (d) What is the power output of the 120-V source? (e) Suppose the load
on the motor increases, causing it to slow down to the point where it draws 20 A. Answer parts (a) through (d)
for this situation.

Figure 13.33 Circuit representation of a series-wound direct current motor.

Strategy
The back emf is calculated based on the difference between the supplied voltage and the loss from the current
596 13 • Electromagnetic Induction

through the resistance. The power from each device is calculated from one of the power formulas based on the
given information.

Solution

a. The back emf is

b. Since the potential across the armature is 100 V when the current through it is 10 A, the power output of
the motor is

c. A 10-A current flows through coils whose combined resistance is , so the power dissipated in the
coils is

d. Since 10 A is drawn from the 120-V source, its power output is

e. Repeating the same calculations with , we find

The motor is turning more slowly in this case, so its power output and the power of the source are larger.

Significance
Notice that we have an energy balance in part (d):

13.7 Applications of Electromagnetic Induction


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how computer hard drives and graphic tablets operate using magnetic induction
• Explain how hybrid/electric vehicles and transcranial magnetic stimulation use magnetic induction to their
advantage

Modern society has numerous applications of Faraday’s law of induction, as we will explore in this chapter and
others. At this juncture, let us mention several that involve recording information using magnetic fields.

Some computer hard drives apply the principle of magnetic induction. Recorded data are made on a coated,
spinning disk. Historically, reading these data was made to work on the principle of induction. However, most
input information today is carried in digital rather than analog form—a series of 0s or 1s are written upon the
spinning hard drive. Therefore, most hard drive readout devices do not work on the principle of induction, but
use a technique known as giant magnetoresistance. Giant magnetoresistance is the effect of a large change of
electrical resistance induced by an applied magnetic field to thin films of alternating ferromagnetic and
nonmagnetic layers. This is one of the first large successes of nanotechnology.

Graphics tablets, or tablet computers where a specially designed pen is used to draw digital images, also
applies induction principles. The tablets discussed here are labeled as passive tablets, since there are other
designs that use either a battery-operated pen or optical signals to write with. The passive tablets are different
than the touch tablets and phones many of us use regularly, but may still be found when signing your signature
at a cash register. Underneath the screen, shown in Figure 13.34, are tiny wires running across the length and
width of the screen. The pen has a tiny magnetic field coming from the tip. As the tip brushes across the
screen, a changing magnetic field is felt in the wires which translates into an induced emf that is converted
into the line you just drew.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13.7 • Applications of Electromagnetic Induction 597

Figure 13.34 A tablet with a specially designed pen to write with is another application of magnetic induction. (credit: Jane Whitney)

Another application of induction is the magnetic stripe on the back of your personal credit card as used at the
grocery store or the ATM machine. This works on the same principle as the audio or video tape, in which a
playback head reads personal information from your card.

INTERACTIVE
Check out this video (https://openstax.org/l/21flashmagind) to see how flashlights can use magnetic induction.
A magnet moves by your mechanical work through a wire. The induced current charges a capacitor that stores
the charge that will light the lightbulb even while you are not doing this mechanical work.

Electric and hybrid vehicles also take advantage of electromagnetic induction. One limiting factor that inhibits
widespread acceptance of 100% electric vehicles is that the lifetime of the battery is not as long as the time you
get to drive on a full tank of gas. To increase the amount of charge in the battery during driving, the motor can
act as a generator whenever the car is braking, taking advantage of the back emf produced. This extra emf can
be newly acquired stored energy in the car’s battery, prolonging the life of the battery.

Another contemporary area of research in which electromagnetic induction is being successfully


implemented is transcranial magnetic stimulation (TMS). A host of disorders, including depression and
hallucinations, can be traced to irregular localized electrical activity in the brain. In transcranial magnetic
stimulation, a rapidly varying and very localized magnetic field is placed close to certain sites identified in the
brain. The usage of TMS as a diagnostic technique is well established.

INTERACTIVE
Check out this Youtube video (https://openstax.org/l/21randrelectro) to see how rock-and-roll instruments like
electric guitars use electromagnetic induction to get those strong beats.
598 13 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
back emf emf generated by a running motor, induced emf short-lived voltage generated by a
because it consists of a coil turning in a magnetic conductor or coil moving in a magnetic field
field; it opposes the voltage powering the motor Lenz’s law direction of an induced emf opposes
eddy current current loop in a conductor caused the change in magnetic flux that produced it; this
by motional emf is the negative sign in Faraday’s law
electric generator device for converting magnetic damping drag produced by eddy
mechanical work into electric energy; it induces currents
an emf by rotating a coil in a magnetic field magnetic flux measurement of the amount of
Faraday’s law induced emf is created in a closed magnetic field lines through a given area
loop due to a change in magnetic flux through the motionally induced emf voltage produced by the
loop movement of a conducting wire in a magnetic
induced electric field created based on the field
changing magnetic flux with time peak emf maximum emf produced by a generator

Key Equations

Magnetic flux

Faraday’s law

Motionally induced emf

Motional emf around a circuit

Emf produced by an electric generator

Summary
13.1 Faraday’s Law a result known as Lenz’s law.

• The magnetic flux through an enclosed area is 13.3 Motional Emf


defined as the amount of field lines cutting
• The relationship between an induced emf in a
through a surface area A defined by the unit
wire moving at a constant speed v through a
area vector.
magnetic field B is given by
• The units for magnetic flux are webers, where
• An induced emf from Faraday’s law is created
from a motional emf that opposes the change in
• The induced emf in a closed loop due to a
flux.
change in magnetic flux through the loop is
known as Faraday’s law. If there is no change in 13.4 Induced Electric Fields
magnetic flux, no induced emf is created.
• A changing magnetic flux induces an electric
13.2 Lenz's Law field.
• Both the changing magnetic flux and the
• We can use Lenz’s law to determine the
induced electric field are related to the induced
directions of induced magnetic fields, currents,
emf from Faraday’s law.
and emfs.
• The direction of an induced emf always opposes
the change in magnetic flux that causes the emf,

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 599

13.5 Eddy Currents • The peak emf of a generator is .


• Any rotating coil produces an induced emf. In
• Current loops induced in moving conductors are
motors, this is called back emf because it
called eddy currents. They can create significant
opposes the emf input to the motor.
drag, called magnetic damping.
• Manipulation of eddy currents has resulted in 13.7 Applications of Electromagnetic
applications such as metal detectors, braking in Induction
trains or roller coasters, and induction cooktops.
• Hard drives utilize magnetic induction to read/
13.6 Electric Generators and Back Emf write information.
• Other applications of magnetic induction can be
• An electric generator rotates a coil in a magnetic
found in graphics tablets, electric and hybrid
field, inducing an emf given as a function of
vehicles, and in transcranial magnetic
time by where A is the area
stimulation.
of an N-turn coil rotated at a constant angular
velocity in a uniform magnetic field

Conceptual Questions
13.1 Faraday’s Law 10. The normal to the plane of a single-turn
conducting loop is directed at an angle to a
1. A stationary coil is in a magnetic field that is
spatially uniform magnetic field It has a fixed
changing with time. Does the emf induced in the
area and orientation relative to the magnetic
coil depend on the actual values of the magnetic
field. Show that the emf induced in the loop is
field?
given by where A is the
2. In Faraday’s experiments, what would be the
area of the loop.
advantage of using coils with many turns?
3. A copper ring and a wooden ring of the same
dimensions are placed in magnetic fields so that 13.2 Lenz's Law
there is the same change in magnetic flux 11. The circular conducting loops shown in the
through them. Compare the induced electric accompanying figure are parallel,
fields and currents in the rings. perpendicular to the plane of the page, and
4. Discuss the factors determining the induced emf coaxial. (a) When the switch S is closed, what is
in a closed loop of wire. the direction of the current induced in D? (b)
5. (a) Does the induced emf in a circuit depend on When the switch is opened, what is the
the resistance of the circuit? (b) Does the induced direction of the current induced in loop D?
current depend on the resistance of the circuit?
6. How would changing the radius of loop D shown
below affect its emf, assuming C and D are much
closer together compared to their radii?

12. The north pole of a magnet is moved toward a


copper loop, as shown below. If you are looking
at the loop from above the magnet, will you say
the induced current is circulating clockwise or
7. Can there be an induced emf in a circuit at an counterclockwise?
instant when the magnetic flux through the
circuit is zero?
8. Does the induced emf always act to decrease the
magnetic flux through a circuit?
9. How would you position a flat loop of wire in a
changing magnetic field so that there is no
induced emf in the loop?
600 13 • Chapter Review

13.3 Motional Emf


16. A bar magnet falls under the influence of gravity
along the axis of a long copper tube. If air
resistance is negligible, will there be a force to
oppose the descent of the magnet? If so, will the
magnet reach a terminal velocity?
17. Around the geographic North Pole (or magnetic
South Pole), Earth’s magnetic field is almost
vertical. If an airplane is flying northward in
this region, which side of the wing is positively
charged and which is negatively charged?
18. A wire loop moves translationally (no rotation)
in a uniform magnetic field. Is there an emf
induced in the loop?
13. The accompanying figure shows a conducting ring
at various positions as it moves through a magnetic 13.4 Induced Electric Fields
field. What is the sense of the induced emf for each 19. Is the work required to accelerate a rod from
of those positions? rest to a speed v in a magnetic field greater than
the final kinetic energy of the rod? Why?
20. The copper sheet shown below is partially in a
magnetic field. When it is pulled to the right, a
resisting force pulls it to the left. Explain. What
happen if the sheet is pushed to the left?
14. Show that and have the same units.
15. State the direction of the induced current for each
case shown below, observing from the side of the
magnet.

13.5 Eddy Currents


21. A conducting sheet lies in a plane
perpendicular to a magnetic field that is
below the sheet. If oscillates at a high
frequency and the conductor is made of a
material of low resistivity, the region above the
sheet is effectively shielded from . Explain
why. Will the conductor shield this region from
static magnetic fields?
22. Electromagnetic braking can be achieved by
applying a strong magnetic field to a spinning
metal disk attached to a shaft. (a) How can a
magnetic field slow the spinning of a disk? (b)
Would the brakes work if the disk was made of
plastic instead of metal?
23. A coil is moved through a magnetic field as shown
below. The field is uniform inside the rectangle and
zero outside. What is the direction of the induced
current and what is the direction of the magnetic
force on the coil at each position shown?

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 601

Problems
13.1 Faraday’s Law
24. A 50-turn coil has a diameter of 15 cm. The coil
is placed in a spatially uniform magnetic field of
magnitude 0.50 T so that the face of the coil and
the magnetic field are perpendicular. Find the
magnitude of the emf induced in the coil if the
magnetic field is reduced to zero uniformly in
(a) 0.10 s, (b) 1.0 s, and (c) 60 s.
25. Repeat your calculations of the preceding
problem’s time of 0.1 s with the plane of the coil 29. How would the answers to the preceding
making an angle of (a) (b) and (c) problem change if the coil consisted of 20
with the magnetic field. closely spaced turns?
26. A square loop whose sides are 6.0-cm long is 30. A long solenoid with turns per
made with copper wire of radius 1.0 mm. If a centimeter has a cross-sectional area of
magnetic field perpendicular to the loop is and carries a current of 0.25 A. A coil with five
changing at a rate of 5.0 mT/s, what is the turns encircles the solenoid. When the current
current in the loop? through the solenoid is turned off, it decreases
27. The magnetic field through a circular loop of to zero in 0.050 s. What is the average emf
radius 10.0 cm varies with time as shown below. induced in the coil?
The field is perpendicular to the loop. Plot the 31. A rectangular wire loop with length a and width
magnitude of the induced emf in the loop as a b lies in the xy-plane, as shown below. Within
function of time. the loop there is a time-dependent magnetic
field given by
, with
in tesla. Determine the emf induced in the loop
as a function of time.

28. The accompanying figure shows a single-turn


rectangular coil that has a resistance of
The magnetic field at all points inside the coil
varies according to where
and What is the
current induced in the coil at (a) , (b)
0.002 s, (c) 2.0 s?

32. The magnetic field perpendicular to a single


wire loop of diameter 10.0 cm decreases from
0.50 T to zero. The wire is made of copper and
602 13 • Chapter Review

has a diameter of 2.0 mm and length 1.0 cm.


How much charge moves through the wire while
the field is changing?

13.2 Lenz's Law


33. A single-turn circular loop of wire of radius 50
mm lies in a plane perpendicular to a spatially
uniform magnetic field. During a 0.10-s time
interval, the magnitude of the field increases
uniformly from 200 to 300 mT. (a) Determine
the emf induced in the loop. (b) If the magnetic
field is directed out of the page, what is the
direction of the current induced in the loop?
34. When a magnetic field is first turned on, the flux
through a 20-turn loop varies with time
according to where is in
milliwebers, t is in seconds, and the loop is in
the plane of the page with the unit normal
pointing outward. (a) What is the emf induced in
the loop as a function of time? What is the
direction of the induced current at (b) t = 0, (c)
13.3 Motional Emf
0.10, (d) 1.0, and (e) 2.0 s?
35. The magnetic flux through the loop shown in 37. An automobile with a radio antenna 1.0 m long
the accompanying figure varies with time travels at 100.0 km/h in a location where the
according to where Earth’s horizontal magnetic field is
is in milliwebers. What are the direction What is the maximum possible
and magnitude of the current through the emf induced in the antenna due to this motion?
resistor at (a) ; (b) 38. The rectangular loop of N turns shown below
and (c) moves to the right with a constant velocity
while leaving the poles of a large electromagnet.
(a) Assuming that the magnetic field is uniform
between the pole faces and negligible
elsewhere, determine the induced emf in the
loop. (b) What is the source of work that
produces this emf?

36. Use Lenz’s law to determine the direction of


induced current in each case.

39. Suppose the magnetic field of the preceding


problem oscillates with time according to
What then is the emf induced in
the loop when its trailing side is a distance d
from the right edge of the magnetic field region?
40. A coil of 1000 turns encloses an area of .
It is rotated in 0.010 s from a position where its
plane is perpendicular to Earth’s magnetic field
to one where its plane is parallel to the field. If
the strength of the field is what is

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 603

the average emf induced in the coil? Specify also the sense of the
41. In the circuit shown in the accompanying current flow.
figure, the rod slides along the conducting rails
at a constant velocity The velocity is in the
same plane as the rails and directed at an angle
to them. A uniform magnetic field is
directed out of the page. What is the emf
induced in the rod?

45. The rod shown below moves to the right on


essentially zero-resistance rails at a speed of
If everywhere in the
region, what is the current through the
resistor? Does the current circulate clockwise or
counterclockwise?

42. The rod shown in the accompanying figure is


moving through a uniform magnetic field of
strength with a constant velocity of
magnitude What is the potential
difference between the ends of the rod? Which
end of the rod is at a higher potential? 46. Shown below is a conducting rod that slides
along metal rails. The apparatus is in a uniform
magnetic field of strength 0.25 T, which is
directly into the page. The rod is pulled to the
right at a constant speed of 5.0 m/s by a force
The only significant resistance in the circuit
comes from the resistor shown. (a) What
is the emf induced in the circuit? (b) What is the
43. A 25-cm rod moves at 5.0 m/s in a plane
induced current? Does it circulate clockwise or
perpendicular to a magnetic field of strength
counter clockwise? (c) What is the magnitude of
0.25 T. The rod, velocity vector, and magnetic
? (d) What are the power output of and the
field vector are mutually perpendicular, as
power dissipated in the resistor?
indicated in the accompanying figure. Calculate
(a) the magnetic force on an electron in the rod,
(b) the electric field in the rod, and (c) the
potential difference between the ends of the
rod. (d) What is the speed of the rod if the
potential difference is 1.0 V?

13.4 Induced Electric Fields


47. Calculate the induced electric field in a 50-turn
coil with a diameter of 15 cm that is placed in a
spatially uniform magnetic field of magnitude
44. In the accompanying figure, the rails, 0.50 T so that the face of the coil and the
connecting end piece, and rod all have a magnetic field are perpendicular. This magnetic
resistance per unit length of The rod field is reduced to zero in 0.10 seconds. Assume
moves to the left at If that the magnetic field is cylindrically
everywhere in the region, what is the current in symmetric with respect to the central axis of the
the circuit (a) when (b) when coil.
604 13 • Chapter Review

48. The magnetic field through a circular loop of


radius 10.0 cm varies with time as shown in the
accompanying figure. The field is perpendicular
to the loop. Assuming cylindrical symmetry
with respect to the central axis of the loop, plot
the induced electric field in the loop as a
function of time.

49. The current I through a long solenoid with n 52. The magnetic field at all points within the
turns per meter and radius R is changing with cylindrical region whose cross-section is
time as given by dI/dt. Calculate the induced indicated in the accompanying figure starts at
electric field as a function of distance r from the 1.0 T and decreases uniformly to zero in 20 s.
central axis of the solenoid. What is the electric field (both magnitude and
50. Calculate the electric field induced both inside direction) as a function of r, the distance from
and outside the solenoid of the preceding the geometric center of the region?
problem if
51. Over a region of radius R, there is a spatially
uniform magnetic field (See below.) At ,
after which it decreases at a constant
rate to zero in 30 s. (a) What is the electric field
in the regions where and during
that 30-s interval? (b) Assume that
. How much work is done by the
electric field on a proton that is carried once
clock wise around a circular path of radius 5.0
cm? (c) How much work is done by the electric
field on a proton that is carried once
counterclockwise around a circular path of any
radius ? (d) At the instant when
, a proton enters the magnetic field
at A, moving a velocity 53. The current in a long solenoid with 20 turns per
as shown. What are the electric and magnetic centimeter of radius 3 cm is varied with time at
forces on the proton at that instant? a rate of 2 A/s. A circular loop of wire of radius 5
cm and resistance surrounds the solenoid.
Find the electrical current induced in the loop.
54. The current in a long solenoid of radius 3 cm
and 20 turns/cm is varied with time at a rate of
2 A/s. Find the electric field at a distance of 4 cm
from the center of the solenoid.

13.6 Electric Generators and Back Emf


55. Design a current loop that, when rotated in a
uniform magnetic field of strength 0.10 T, will
produce an emf where

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 605

and R, what is the relationship between B and Q?


56. A flat, square coil of 20 turns that has sides of Because the coil is very small, you can assume
length 15.0 cm is rotating in a magnetic field of that is uniform over it. (b) How can you
strength 0.050 T. If the maximum emf produced determine whether or not the magnetic field is
in the coil is 30.0 mV, what is the angular perpendicular to the face of the coil?
velocity of the coil? 60. The flip coil of the preceding problem has a
57. A 50-turn rectangular coil with dimensions radius of 3.0 cm and is wound with 40 turns of
rotates in a uniform magnetic copper wire. The total resistance of the coil and
field of magnitude 0.75 T at 3600 rev/min. (a) ballistic galvanometer is When the coil
Determine the emf induced in the coil as a is flipped through in a magnetic field a
function of time. (b) If the coil is connected to a change of 0.090 C flows through the ballistic
resistor, what is the power as a function
galvanometer. (a) Assuming that and the face
of time required to keep the coil turning at 3600
of the coil are initially perpendicular, what is the
rpm? (c) Answer part (b) if the coil is connected
magnetic field? (b) If the coil is flipped through
to a 2000- resistor.
what is the reading of the galvanometer?
58. The square armature coil of an alternating
61. A 120-V, series-wound motor has a field
current generator has 200 turns and is 20.0 cm
resistance of 80 and an armature resistance
on side. When it rotates at 3600 rpm, its peak
of 10 . When it is operating at full speed, a
output voltage is 120 V. (a) What is the
back emf of 75 V is generated. (a) What is the
frequency of the output voltage? (b) What is the
initial current drawn by the motor? When the
strength of the magnetic field in which the coil
motor is operating at full speed, where are (b)
is turning?
the current drawn by the motor, (c) the power
59. A flip coil is a relatively simple device used to
output of the source, (d) the power output of the
measure a magnetic field. It consists of a
motor, and (e) the power dissipated in the two
circular coil of N turns wound with fine
resistances?
conducting wire. The coil is attached to a
62. A small series-wound dc motor is operated from
ballistic galvanometer, a device that measures
a 12-V car battery. Under a normal load, the
the total charge that passes through it. The coil
motor draws 4.0 A, and when the armature is
is placed in a magnetic field such that its face clamped so that it cannot turn, the motor draws
is perpendicular to the field. It is then flipped 24 A. What is the back emf when the motor is
through and the total charge Q that flows operating normally?
through the galvanometer is measured. (a) If the
total resistance of the coil and galvanometer is

Additional Problems
63. Shown in the following figure is a long, straight 64. A metal bar of mass 500 g slides outward at a
wire and a single-turn rectangular loop, both of constant speed of 1.5 cm/s over two parallel
which lie in the plane of the page. The wire is rails separated by a distance of 30 cm which are
parallel to the long sides of the loop and is 0.50 part of a U-shaped conductor. There is a
m away from the closer side. At an instant when uniform magnetic field of magnitude 2 T
the emf induced in the loop is 2.0 V, what is the pointing out of the page over the entire area.
time rate of change of the current in the wire? The railings and metal bar have an equivalent
resistance of (a) Determine the induced
current, both magnitude and direction. (b) Find
the direction of the induced current if the
magnetic field is pointing into the page. (c) Find
the direction of the induced current if the
magnetic field is pointed into the page and the
bar moves inwards.
606 13 • Chapter Review

65. A current is induced in a circular loop of radius 70. A circular loop of wire of radius 10 cm is mounted
1.5 cm between two poles of a horseshoe on a vertical shaft and rotated at a frequency of 5
electromagnet when the current in the cycles per second in a region of uniform magnetic
electromagnet is varied. The magnetic field in field of 2 Gauss perpendicular to the axis of rotation.
the area of the loop is perpendicular to the area (a) Find an expression for the time-dependent flux
and has a uniform magnitude. If the rate of through the ring. (b) Determine the time-dependent
change of magnetic field is 10 T/s, find the current through the ring if it has a resistance of 10
magnitude and direction of the induced current
if resistance of the loop is .
66. A metal bar of length 25 cm is placed
perpendicular to a uniform magnetic field of
strength 3 T. (a) Determine the induced emf
between the ends of the rod when it is not
moving. (b) Determine the emf when the rod is
moving perpendicular to its length and
magnetic field with a speed of 50 cm/s.
71. The magnetic field between the poles of a
67. A coil with 50 turns and area 10 is oriented
horseshoe electromagnet is uniform and has a
with its plane perpendicular to a 0.75-T
cylindrical symmetry about an axis from the
magnetic field. If the coil is flipped over (rotated
middle of the South Pole to the middle of the
through ) in 0.20 s, what is the average emf
North Pole. The magnitude of the magnetic field
induced in it?
changes as a rate of dB/dt due to the changing
68. A 2-turn planer loop of flexible wire is placed
current through the electromagnet. Determine
inside a long solenoid of n turns per meter that
the electric field at a distance r from the center.
carries a constant current . The area A of the
72. A long solenoid of radius a with n turns per unit
loop is changed by pulling on its sides while
length is carrying a time-dependent current
ensuring that the plane of the loop always
, where and are constants.
remains perpendicular to the axis of the
The solenoid is surrounded by a wire of
solenoid. If per meter,
resistance R that has two circular loops of
and what is the emf induced in the
radius b with (see the following figure).
loop when
Find the magnitude and direction of current
69. The conducting rod shown in the accompanying
induced in the outer loops at time .
figure moves along parallel metal rails that are
25-cm apart. The system is in a uniform
magnetic field of strength 0.75 T, which is
directed into the page. The resistances of the
rod and the rails are negligible, but the section
PQ has a resistance of . (a) What is the
emf (including its sense) induced in the rod
when it is moving to the right with a speed of 5.0
m/s? (b) What force is required to keep the rod
moving at this speed? (c) What is the rate at
which work is done by this force? (d) What is the
power dissipated in the resistor?

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 607

73. A 120-V, series-wound dc motor draws 0.50 A 74. The armature and field coils of a series-wound
from its power source when operating at full motor have a total resistance of . When
speed, and it draws 2.0 A when it starts. The connected to a 120-V source and running at
resistance of the armature coils is . (a) normal speed, the motor draws 4.0 A. (a) How
What is the resistance of the field coils? (b) What large is the back emf? (b) What current will the
is the back emf of the motor when it is running motor draw just after it is turned on? Can you
at full speed? (c) The motor operates at a suggest a way to avoid this large initial current?
different speed and draws 1.0 A from the
source. What is the back emf in this case?

Challenge Problems
75. A copper wire of length L is fashioned into a 79. A rectangular circuit containing a resistance R
circular coil with N turns. When the magnetic is pulled at a constant velocity away from a
field through the coil changes with time, for long, straight wire carrying a current (see
what value of N is the induced emf a maximum? below). Derive an equation that gives the
76. A 0.50-kg copper sheet drops through a uniform current induced in the circuit as a function of
horizontal magnetic field of 1.5 T, and it reaches the distance x between the near side of the
a terminal velocity of 2.0 m/s. (a) What is the net circuit and the wire.
magnetic force on the sheet after it reaches
terminal velocity? (b) Describe the mechanism
responsible for this force. (c) How much power
is dissipated as Joule heating while the sheet
moves at terminal velocity?
77. A circular copper disk of radius 7.5 cm rotates
at 2400 rpm around the axis through its center
and perpendicular to its face. The disk is in a
uniform magnetic field of strength 1.2 T that
is directed along the axis. What is the potential
difference between the rim and the axis of the
disk?
78. A short rod of length a moves with its velocity
parallel to an infinite wire carrying a current I
(see below). If the end of the rod nearer the wire
is a distance b from the wire, what is the emf
induced in the rod?
608 13 • Chapter Review

80. Two infinite solenoids cross the plane of the 81. An eight-turn coil is tightly wrapped around the
circuit as shown below. The radii of the outside of the long solenoid as shown below.
solenoids are 0.10 and 0.20 m, respectively, and The radius of the solenoid is 2.0 cm and it has
the current in each solenoid is changing such 10 turns per centimeter. The current through
that What are the currents in the solenoid increases according to
the resistors of the circuit? where and
What is the emf induced in
the coil when (a) , (b) and
(c) ∞

82. Shown below is a long rectangular loop of width w,


length l, mass m, and resistance R. The loop starts
from rest at the edge of a uniform magnetic field
and is pushed into the field by a constant force
Calculate the speed of the loop as a function of
time.

Access for free at openstax.org.


13 • Chapter Review 609

83. A square bar of mass m and resistance R is 85. A long solenoid with 10 turns per centimeter is
sliding without friction down very long, parallel placed inside a copper ring such that both
conducting rails of negligible resistance (see objects have the same central axis. The radius
below). The two rails are a distance l apart and of the ring is 10.0 cm, and the radius of the
are connected to each other at the bottom of the solenoid is 5.0 cm. (a) What is the emf induced
incline by a zero-resistance wire. The rails are in the ring when the current I through the
inclined at an angle , and there is a uniform solenoid is 5.0 A and changing at a rate of 100
vertical magnetic field throughout the region. A/s? (b) What is the emf induced in the ring
(a) Show that the bar acquires a terminal when and (c) What
velocity given by (b) Calculate is the electric field inside the ring for these two
cases? (d) Suppose the ring is moved so that its
the work per unit time done by the force of central axis and the central axis of the solenoid
gravity. (c) Compare this with the power are still parallel but no longer coincide. (You
dissipated in the Joule heating of the bar. (d) should assume that the solenoid is still inside
What would happen if were reversed? the ring.) Now what is the emf induced in the
ring? (e) Can you calculate the electric field in
the ring as you did in part (c)?
86. The current in the long, straight wire shown in
the accompanying figure is given by
where and
What is the current induced in
the rectangular loop at (a) and (b)
The resistance of the loop is

84. The accompanying figure shows a metal disk of


inner radius and other radius rotating at an
angular velocity while in a uniform magnetic
field directed parallel to the rotational axis. The
brush leads of a voltmeter are connected to the
dark’s inner and outer surfaces as shown. What is
the reading of the voltmeter?
87. A 500-turn coil with a area is spun in
Earth’s magnetic field,
producing a 12.0-kV maximum emf. (a) At what
angular velocity must the coil be spun? (b) What
is unreasonable about this result? (c) Which
assumption or premise is responsible?
88. A circular loop of wire of radius 10 cm is
mounted on a vertical shaft and rotated at a
frequency of 5 cycles per second in a region of
uniform magnetic field of
perpendicular to the axis of rotation. (a) Find an
expression for the time-dependent flux through
the ring (b) Determine the time-dependent
current through the ring if it has a resistance of
.
610 13 • Chapter Review

89. A long solenoid of radius with turns per unit 91. A metal bar of mass m slides without friction over
length is carrying a time-dependent current two rails a distance D apart in the region that has
where and are constants. a uniform magnetic field of magnitude and
The solenoid is surrounded by a wire of direction perpendicular to the rails (see below).
resistance R that has two circular loops of The two rails are connected at one end to a
radius b with . Find the magnitude and resistor whose resistance is much larger than the
direction of current induced in the outer loops resistance of the rails and the bar. The bar is given
at time . an initial speed of . It is found to slow down.
90. A rectangular copper loop of mass 100 g and How far does the bar go before coming to rest?
resistance is in a region of uniform Assume that the magnetic field of the induced
magnetic field that is perpendicular to the area current is negligible compared to .
enclosed by the ring and horizontal to Earth’s
surface (see below). The loop is let go from rest
when it is at the edge of the nonzero magnetic
field region. (a) Find an expression for the speed
when the loop just exits the region of uniform
magnetic field. (b) If it was let go at , what is
the time when it exits the region of magnetic
field for the following values: 92. A time-dependent uniform magnetic field of
, ? magnitude B(t) is confined in a cylindrical
region of radius R. A conducting rod of length
2D is placed in the region, as shown below.
Show that the emf between the ends of the rod
is given by . (Hint: To find the
emf between the ends, we need to integrate the
electric field from one end to the other. To find
the electric field, use Faraday’s law as “Ampère’s
law for E.”)

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 14
Inductance

Figure 14.1 A smartphone charging mat contains a coil that receives alternating current, or current that is
constantly increasing and decreasing. The varying current induces an emf in the smartphone, which charges its
battery. Note that the black box containing the electrical plug also contains a transformer (discussed in Alternating-
Current Circuits) that modifies the current from the outlet to suit the needs of the smartphone. (credit: modification
of work by “LG”/Flickr)

Chapter Outline

14.1 Mutual Inductance

14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors

14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field

14.4 RL Circuits
612 14 • Inductance

14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit

14.6 RLC Series Circuits

INTRODUCTION In Electromagnetic Induction, we discussed how a time-varying magnetic flux induces an


emf in a circuit. In many of our calculations, this flux was due to an applied time-dependent magnetic field.
The reverse of this phenomenon also occurs: The current flowing in a circuit produces its own magnetic field.

In Electric Charges and Fields, we saw that induction is the process by which an emf is induced by changing
electric flux and separation of a dipole. So far, we have discussed some examples of induction, although some
of these applications are more effective than others. The smartphone charging mat in the chapter opener
photo also works by induction. Is there a useful physical quantity related to how “effective” a given device is?
The answer is yes, and that physical quantity is inductance. In this chapter, we look at the applications of
inductance in electronic devices and how inductors are used in circuits.

14.1 Mutual Inductance


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Correlate two nearby circuits that carry time-varying currents with the emf induced in each circuit
• Describe examples in which mutual inductance may or may not be desirable

Inductance is the property of a device that tells us how effectively it induces an emf in another device. In other
words, it is a physical quantity that expresses the effectiveness of a given device.

When two circuits carrying time-varying currents are close to one another, the magnetic flux through each
circuit varies because of the changing current I in the other circuit. Consequently, an emf is induced in each
circuit by the changing current in the other. This type of emf is therefore called a mutually induced emf, and
the phenomenon that occurs is known as mutual inductance (M). As an example, let’s consider two tightly
wound coils (Figure 14.2). Coils 1 and 2 have and turns and carry currents and respectively. The
flux through a single turn of coil 2 produced by the magnetic field of the current in coil 1 is whereas the
flux through a single turn of coil 1 due to the magnetic field of is

Figure 14.2 Some of the magnetic field lines produced by the current in coil 1 pass through coil 2.

The mutual inductance of coil 2 with respect to coil 1 is the ratio of the flux through the turns of coil 2
produced by the magnetic field of the current in coil 1, divided by that current, that is,

14.1

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.1 • Mutual Inductance 613

Similarly, the mutual inductance of coil 1 with respect to coil 2 is

14.2

Like capacitance, mutual inductance is a geometric quantity. It depends on the shapes and relative positions of
the two coils, and it is independent of the currents in the coils. The SI unit for mutual inductance M is called
the henry (H) in honor of Joseph Henry (1799–1878), an American scientist who discovered induced emf
independently of Faraday. Thus, we have . From Equation 14.1 and Equation 14.2, we can show
that so we usually drop the subscripts associated with mutual inductance and write

14.3

The emf developed in either coil is found by combining Faraday’s law and the definition of mutual inductance.
Since is the total flux through coil 2 due to , we obtain

14.4

where we have used the fact that M is a time-independent constant because the geometry is time-independent.
Similarly, we have

14.5

In Equation 14.5, we can see the significance of the earlier description of mutual inductance (M) as a geometric
quantity. The value of M neatly encapsulates the physical properties of circuit elements and allows us to
separate the physical layout of the circuit from the dynamic quantities, such as the emf and the current.
Equation 14.5 defines the mutual inductance in terms of properties in the circuit, whereas the previous
definition of mutual inductance in Equation 14.1 is defined in terms of the magnetic flux experienced,
regardless of circuit elements. You should be careful when using Equation 14.4 and Equation 14.5 because
do not necessarily represent the total emfs in the respective coils. Each coil can also have an emf
induced in it because of its self-inductance (self-inductance will be discussed in more detail in a later section).

A large mutual inductance M may or may not be desirable. We want a transformer to have a large mutual
inductance. But an appliance, such as an electric clothes dryer, can induce a dangerous emf on its metal case if
the mutual inductance between its coils and the case is large. One way to reduce mutual inductance is to
counter-wind coils to cancel the magnetic field produced (Figure 14.3).
614 14 • Inductance

Figure 14.3 The heating coils of an electric clothes dryer can be counter-wound so that their magnetic fields cancel one another, greatly
reducing the mutual inductance with the case of the dryer.

Digital signal processing is another example in which mutual inductance is reduced by counter-winding coils.
The rapid on/off emf representing 1s and 0s in a digital circuit creates a complex time-dependent magnetic
field. An emf can be generated in neighboring conductors. If that conductor is also carrying a digital signal, the
induced emf may be large enough to switch 1s and 0s, with consequences ranging from inconvenient to
disastrous.

EXAMPLE 14.1

Mutual Inductance
Figure 14.4 shows a coil of turns and radius surrounding a long solenoid of length radius and
turns. (a) What is the mutual inductance of the two coils? (b) If , ,
, , and the current in the solenoid is changing at a rate of 200 A/s, what is the emf
induced in the surrounding coil?

Figure 14.4 A solenoid surrounded by a coil.

Strategy
There is no magnetic field outside the solenoid, and the field inside has magnitude and is

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.2 • Self-Inductance and Inductors 615

directed parallel to the solenoid’s axis. We can use this magnetic field to find the magnetic flux through the
surrounding coil and then use this flux to calculate the mutual inductance for part (a), using Equation 14.3. We
solve part (b) by calculating the mutual inductance from the given quantities and using Equation 14.4 to
calculate the induced emf.

Solution

a. The magnetic flux through the surrounding coil is

Now from Equation 14.3, the mutual inductance is

b. Using the previous expression and the given values, the mutual inductance is

Thus, from Equation 14.4, the emf induced in the surrounding coil is

Significance
Notice that M in part (a) is independent of the radius of the surrounding coil because the solenoid’s
magnetic field is confined to its interior. In principle, we can also calculate M by finding the magnetic flux
through the solenoid produced by the current in the surrounding coil. This approach is much more difficult
because is so complicated. However, since we do know the result of this calculation.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.1


A current flows through the solenoid of part (b) of Example 14.1. What is the
maximum emf induced in the surrounding coil?

14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Correlate the rate of change of current to the induced emf created by that current in the same circuit
• Derive the self-inductance for a cylindrical solenoid
• Derive the self-inductance for a rectangular toroid

Mutual inductance arises when a current in one circuit produces a changing magnetic field that induces an
emf in another circuit. But can the magnetic field affect the current in the original circuit that produced the
field? The answer is yes, and this is the phenomenon called self-inductance.

Inductors
Figure 14.5 shows some of the magnetic field lines due to the current in a circular loop of wire. If the current is
constant, the magnetic flux through the loop is also constant. However, if the current I were to vary with
time—say, immediately after switch S is closed—then the magnetic flux would correspondingly change.
Then Faraday’s law tells us that an emf would be induced in the circuit, where

14.6
616 14 • Inductance

Since the magnetic field due to a current-carrying wire is directly proportional to the current, the flux due to
this field is also proportional to the current; that is,
14.7

Figure 14.5 A magnetic field is produced by the current I in the loop. If I were to vary with time, the magnetic flux through the loop would
also vary and an emf would be induced in the loop.

This can also be written as


14.8
where the constant of proportionality L is known as the self-inductance of the wire loop. If the loop has N
turns, this equation becomes

14.9

By convention, the positive sense of the normal to the loop is related to the current by the right-hand rule, so in
Figure 14.5, the normal points downward. With this convention, is positive in Equation 14.9, so L always
has a positive value.

For a loop with N turns, so the induced emf may be written in terms of the self-inductance as

14.10

When using this equation to determine L, it is easiest to ignore the signs of and calculate L as

Since self-inductance is associated with the magnetic field produced by a current, any configuration of
conductors possesses self-inductance. For example, besides the wire loop, a long, straight wire has self-
inductance, as does a coaxial cable. A coaxial cable is most commonly used by the cable television industry
and may also be found connecting to your cable modem. Coaxial cables are used due to their ability to transmit
electrical signals with minimal distortions. Coaxial cables have two long cylindrical conductors that possess
current and a self-inductance that may have undesirable effects.

A circuit element used to provide self-inductance is known as an inductor. It is represented by the symbol
shown in Figure 14.6, which resembles a coil of wire, the basic form of the inductor. Figure 14.7 shows several
types of inductors commonly used in circuits.

Figure 14.6 Symbol used to represent an inductor in a circuit.

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.2 • Self-Inductance and Inductors 617

Figure 14.7 A variety of inductors. Whether they are encapsulated like the top three shown or wound around in a coil like the bottom-
most one, each is simply a relatively long coil of wire. (credit: Windell Oskay)

In accordance with Lenz’s law, the negative sign in Equation 14.10 indicates that the induced emf across an
inductor always has a polarity that opposes the change in the current. For example, if the current flowing from
A to B in Figure 14.8(a) were increasing, the induced emf (represented by the imaginary battery) would have
the polarity shown in order to oppose the increase. If the current from A to B were decreasing, then the
induced emf would have the opposite polarity, again to oppose the change in current (Figure 14.8(b)). Finally, if
the current through the inductor were constant, no emf would be induced in the coil.

Figure 14.8 The induced emf across an inductor always acts to oppose the change in the current. This can be visualized as an imaginary
battery causing current to flow to oppose the change in (a) and reinforce the change in (b).

One common application of inductance is to allow traffic signals to sense when vehicles are waiting at a street
intersection. An electrical circuit with an inductor is placed in the road underneath the location where a
waiting car will stop. The body of the car increases the inductance and the circuit changes, sending a signal to
the traffic lights to change colors. Similarly, metal detectors used for airport security employ the same
technique. A coil or inductor in the metal detector frame acts as both a transmitter and a receiver. The pulsed
signal from the transmitter coil induces a signal in the receiver. The self-inductance of the circuit is affected by
any metal object in the path (Figure 14.9). Metal detectors can be adjusted for sensitivity and can also sense
the presence of metal on a person.
618 14 • Inductance

Figure 14.9 The familiar security gate at an airport not only detects metals, but can also indicate their approximate height above the floor.
(credit: “Alexbuirds”/Wikimedia Commons)

Large induced voltages are found in camera flashes. Camera flashes use a battery, two inductors that function
as a transformer, and a switching system or oscillator to induce large voltages. Recall from Oscillations on
oscillations that “oscillation” is defined as the fluctuation of a quantity, or repeated regular fluctuations of a
quantity, between two extreme values around an average value. Also recall (from Electromagnetic Induction on
electromagnetic induction) that we need a changing magnetic field, brought about by a changing current, to
induce a voltage in another coil. The oscillator system does this many times as the battery voltage is boosted to
over 1000 volts. (You may hear the high-pitched whine from the transformer as the capacitor is being
charged.) A capacitor stores the high voltage for later use in powering the flash.

EXAMPLE 14.2

Self-Inductance of a Coil
An induced emf of 20 mV is measured across a coil of 50 closely wound turns while the current through it
increases uniformly from 0.0 to 5.0 A in 0.10 s. (a) What is the self-inductance of the coil? (b) With the current
at 5.0 A, what is the flux through each turn of the coil?

Strategy
Both parts of this problem give all the information needed to solve for the self-inductance in part (a) or the flux
through each turn of the coil in part (b). The equations needed are Equation 14.10 for part (a) and Equation
14.9 for part (b).

Solution

a. Ignoring the negative sign and using magnitudes, we have, from Equation 14.10,

b. From Equation 14.9, the flux is given in terms of the current by so

Significance
The self-inductance and flux calculated in parts (a) and (b) are typical values for coils found in contemporary
devices. If the current is not changing over time, the flux is not changing in time, so no emf is induced.

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.2 • Self-Inductance and Inductors 619

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.2


Current flows through the inductor in Figure 14.8 from B to A instead of from A to B as shown. Is the current
increasing or decreasing in order to produce the emf given in diagram (a)? In diagram (b)?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.3


A changing current induces an emf of 10 V across a 0.25-H inductor. What is the rate at which the current is
changing?

A good approach for calculating the self-inductance of an inductor consists of the following steps:

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

Self-Inductance
1. Assume a current I is flowing through the inductor.
2. Determine the magnetic field produced by the current. If there is appropriate symmetry, you may be
able to do this with Ampère’s law.
3. Obtain the magnetic flux,
4. With the flux known, the self-inductance can be found from Equation 14.9, .

To demonstrate this procedure, we now calculate the self-inductances of two inductors.

Cylindrical Solenoid
Consider a long, cylindrical solenoid with length l, cross-sectional area A, and N turns of wire. We assume that
the length of the solenoid is so much larger than its diameter that we can take the magnetic field to be
throughout the interior of the solenoid, that is, we ignore end effects in the solenoid. With a current I
flowing through the coils, the magnetic field produced within the solenoid is

14.11

so the magnetic flux through one turn is

14.12

Using Equation 14.9, we find for the self-inductance of the solenoid,

14.13

If is the number of turns per unit length of the solenoid, we may write Equation 14.13 as

14.14

where is the volume of the solenoid. Notice that the self-inductance of a long solenoid depends only on
its physical properties (such as the number of turns of wire per unit length and the volume), and not on the
magnetic field or the current. This is true for inductors in general.

Rectangular Toroid
A toroid with a rectangular cross-section is shown in Figure 14.10. The inner and outer radii of the toroid are
is the height of the toroid. Applying Ampère’s law in the same manner as we did in Example
620 14 • Inductance

13.8 for a toroid with a circular cross-section, we find the magnetic field inside a rectangular toroid is also
given by

14.15

where r is the distance from the central axis of the toroid. Because the field changes within the toroid, we must
calculate the flux by integrating over the toroid’s cross-section. Using the infinitesimal cross-sectional area
element shown in Figure 14.10, we obtain

14.16

Figure 14.10 Calculating the self-inductance of a rectangular toroid.

Now from Equation 14.16, we obtain for the self-inductance of a rectangular toroid

14.17

As expected, the self-inductance is a constant determined by only the physical properties of the toroid.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.4


(a) Calculate the self-inductance of a solenoid that is tightly wound with wire of diameter 0.10 cm, has a cross-
sectional area of , and is 40 cm long. (b) If the current through the solenoid decreases uniformly from
10 to 0 A in 0.10 s, what is the emf induced between the ends of the solenoid?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.5


(a) What is the magnetic flux through one turn of a solenoid of self-inductance when a current of
3.0 A flows through it? Assume that the solenoid has 1000 turns and is wound from wire of diameter 1.0 mm.
(b) What is the cross-sectional area of the solenoid?

14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how energy can be stored in a magnetic field
• Derive the equation for energy stored in a coaxial cable given the magnetic energy density

The energy of a capacitor is stored in the electric field between its plates. Similarly, an inductor has the
capability to store energy, but in its magnetic field. This energy can be found by integrating the magnetic

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.3 • Energy in a Magnetic Field 621

energy density,

14.18

over the appropriate volume. To understand where this formula comes from, let’s consider the long, cylindrical
solenoid of the previous section. Again using the infinite solenoid approximation, we can assume that the
magnetic field is essentially constant and given by everywhere inside the solenoid. Thus, the energy
stored in a solenoid or the magnetic energy density times volume is equivalent to

14.19

With the substitution of Equation 14.14, this becomes

14.20

Although derived for a special case, this equation gives the energy stored in the magnetic field of any inductor.
We can see this by considering an arbitrary inductor through which a changing current is passing. At any
instant, the magnitude of the induced emf is where is the induced current at that instance.
Therefore, the power absorbed by the inductor is

14.21

The total energy stored in the magnetic field when the current increases from 0 to I in a time interval from 0 to
t can be determined by integrating this expression:

14.22

EXAMPLE 14.3

Self-Inductance of a Coaxial Cable


Figure 14.11 shows two long, concentric cylindrical shells of radii and As discussed in Capacitance on
capacitance, this configuration is a simplified representation of a coaxial cable. The capacitance per unit
length of the cable has already been calculated. Now (a) determine the magnetic energy stored per unit length
of the coaxial cable and (b) use this result to find the self-inductance per unit length of the cable.
622 14 • Inductance

Figure 14.11 (a) A coaxial cable is represented here by two hollow, concentric cylindrical conductors along which electric current flows in
opposite directions. (b) The magnetic field between the conductors can be found by applying Ampère’s law to the dashed path. (c) The
cylindrical shell is used to find the magnetic energy stored in a length l of the cable.

Strategy
The magnetic field both inside and outside the coaxial cable is determined by Ampère’s law. Based on this
magnetic field, we can use Equation 14.22 to calculate the energy density of the magnetic field. The magnetic
energy is calculated by an integral of the magnetic energy density times the differential volume over the
cylindrical shell. After the integration is carried out, we have a closed-form solution for part (a). The self-
inductance per unit length is determined based on this result and Equation 14.22.

Solution

a. We determine the magnetic field between the conductors by applying Ampère’s law to the dashed circular
path shown in Figure 14.11(b). Because of the cylindrical symmetry, is constant along the path, and

This gives us

In the region outside the cable, a similar application of Ampère’s law shows that , since no net
current crosses the area bounded by a circular path where This argument also holds when
that is, in the region within the inner cylinder. All the magnetic energy of the cable is therefore
stored between the two conductors. Since the energy density of the magnetic field is

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.4 • RL Circuits 623

the energy stored in a cylindrical shell of inner radius r, outer radius and length l (see part (c) of the
figure) is

Thus, the total energy of the magnetic field in a length l of the cable is

and the energy per unit length is .


b. From Equation 14.22,

where L is the self-inductance of a length l of the coaxial cable. Equating the previous two equations, we
find that the self-inductance per unit length of the cable is

Significance
The inductance per unit length depends only on the inner and outer radii as seen in the result. To increase the
inductance, we could either increase the outer radius or decrease the inner radius . In the limit as
the two radii become equal, the inductance goes to zero. In this limit, there is no coaxial cable. Also, the
magnetic energy per unit length from part (a) is proportional to the square of the current.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.6


How much energy is stored in the inductor of Example 14.2 after the current reaches its maximum value?

14.4 RL Circuits
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Analyze circuits that have an inductor and resistor in series
• Describe how current and voltage exponentially grow or decay based on the initial conditions

A circuit with resistance and self-inductance is known as an RL circuit. Figure 14.12(a) shows an RL circuit
consisting of a resistor, an inductor, a constant source of emf, and switches and When is closed, the
circuit is equivalent to a single-loop circuit consisting of a resistor and an inductor connected across a source
of emf (Figure 14.12(b)). When is opened and is closed, the circuit becomes a single-loop circuit with
only a resistor and an inductor (Figure 14.12(c)).

Figure 14.12 (a) An RL circuit with switches and (b) The equivalent circuit with closed and open. (c) The equivalent circuit
624 14 • Inductance

after is opened and is closed.

We first consider the RL circuit of Figure 14.12(b). Once is closed and is open, the source of emf
produces a current in the circuit. If there were no self-inductance in the circuit, the current would rise
immediately to a steady value of However, from Faraday’s law, the increasing current produces an emf
across the inductor. In accordance with Lenz’s law, the induced emf counteracts the increase
in the current and is directed as shown in the figure. As a result, I(t) starts at zero and increases asymptotically
to its final value.

Applying Kirchhoff’s loop rule to this circuit, we obtain

14.23

which is a first-order differential equation for I(t). Notice its similarity to the equation for a capacitor and
resistor in series (See RC Circuits). Similarly, the solution to Equation 14.23 can be found by making
substitutions in the equations relating the capacitor to the inductor. This gives

14.24

where

14.25

is the inductive time constant of the circuit.

The current I(t) is plotted in Figure 14.13(a). It starts at zero, and as ∞ , I(t) approaches asymptotically.
The induced emf is directly proportional to dI/dt, or the slope of the curve. Hence, while at its greatest
immediately after the switches are thrown, the induced emf decreases to zero with time as the current
approaches its final value of The circuit then becomes equivalent to a resistor connected across a source
of emf.

Figure 14.13 Time variation of (a) the electric current and (b) the magnitude of the induced voltage across the coil in the circuit of Figure
14.12(b).

The energy stored in the magnetic field of an inductor is

14.26

Thus, as the current approaches the maximum current , the stored energy in the inductor increases from
zero and asymptotically approaches a maximum of

The time constant tells us how rapidly the current increases to its final value. At the current in the
circuit is, from Equation 14.24,

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.4 • RL Circuits 625

14.27

which is of the final value . The smaller the inductive time constant the more rapidly the
current approaches .

We can find the time dependence of the induced voltage across the inductor in this circuit by using
and Equation 14.24:

14.28

The magnitude of this function is plotted in Figure 14.13(b). The greatest value of it occurs when
dI/dt is greatest, which is immediately after is closed and is opened. In the approach to steady state, dI/
dt decreases to zero. As a result, the voltage across the inductor also vanishes as ∞
The time constant also tells us how quickly the induced voltage decays. At the magnitude of the
induced voltage is

14.29

The voltage across the inductor therefore drops to about of its initial value after one time constant. The
shorter the time constant the more rapidly the voltage decreases.

After enough time has elapsed so that the current has essentially reached its final value, the positions of the
switches in Figure 14.12(a) are reversed, giving us the circuit in part (c). At the current in the circuit is
With Kirchhoff’s loop rule, we obtain

14.30

The solution to this equation is similar to the solution of the equation for a discharging capacitor, with similar
substitutions. The current at time t is then

14.31

The current starts at and decreases with time as the energy stored in the inductor is depleted
(Figure 14.14).

The time dependence of the voltage across the inductor can be determined from

14.32

This voltage is initially , and it decays to zero like the current. The energy stored in the magnetic
field of the inductor, also decreases exponentially with time, as it is dissipated by Joule heating in the
resistance of the circuit.

Figure 14.14 Time variation of electric current in the RL circuit of Figure 14.12(c). The induced voltage across the coil also decays
exponentially.

EXAMPLE 14.4

An RL Circuit with a Source of emf


In the circuit of Figure 14.12(a), let With closed and open (Figure
626 14 • Inductance

14.12(b)), (a) what is the time constant of the circuit? (b) What are the current in the circuit and the magnitude
of the induced emf across the inductor at , and as ∞?
Strategy
The time constant for an inductor and resistor in a series circuit is calculated using Equation 14.25. The
current through and voltage across the inductor are calculated by the scenarios detailed from Equation 14.24
and Equation 14.32.

Solution

a. The inductive time constant is

b. The current in the circuit of Figure 14.12(b) increases according to Equation 14.24:

At

At and ∞ we have, respectively,

and

From Equation 14.32, the magnitude of the induced emf decays as

∞ we obtain

Significance
If the time of the measurement were much larger than the time constant, we would not see the decay or growth
of the voltage across the inductor or resistor. The circuit would quickly reach the asymptotic values for both of
these. See Figure 14.15.

Figure 14.15 A generator in an RL circuit produces a square-pulse output in which the voltage oscillates between zero and some set
value. These oscilloscope traces show (a) the voltage across the source; (b) the voltage across the inductor; (c) the voltage across the
resistor.

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.4 • RL Circuits 627

EXAMPLE 14.5

An RL Circuit without a Source of emf


After the current in the RL circuit of Example 14.4 has reached its final value, the positions of the switches are
reversed so that the circuit becomes the one shown in Figure 14.12(c). (a) How long does it take the current to
drop to half its initial value? (b) How long does it take before the energy stored in the inductor is reduced to
of its maximum value?

Strategy
The current in the inductor will now decrease as the resistor dissipates this energy. Therefore, the current falls
as an exponential decay. We can also use that same relationship as a substitution for the energy in an inductor
formula to find how the energy decreases at different time intervals.

Solution

a. With the switches reversed, the current decreases according to

At a time t when the current is one-half its initial value, we have

and

where we have used the inductive time constant found in Example 14.4.
b. The energy stored in the inductor is given by

If the energy drops to of its initial value at a time t, we have

Upon canceling terms and taking the natural logarithm of both sides, we obtain

so

Since , the time it takes for the energy stored in the inductor to decrease to of its initial
value is

Significance
This calculation only works if the circuit is at maximum current in situation (b) prior to this new situation.
Otherwise, we start with a lower initial current, which will decay by the same relationship.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.7


Verify that RC and L/R have the dimensions of time.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.8


628 14 • Inductance

(a) If the current in the circuit of in Figure 14.12(b) increases to of its final value after 5.0 s, what is the
inductive time constant? (b) If , what is the value of the self-inductance? (c) If the resistor is
replaced with a resister, what is the time taken for the current to reach of its final value?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.9


For the circuit of in Figure 14.12(b), show that when steady state is reached, the difference in the total energies
produced by the battery and dissipated in the resistor is equal to the energy stored in the magnetic field of the
coil.

14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain why charge or current oscillates between a capacitor and inductor, respectively, when wired in series
• Describe the relationship between the charge and current oscillating between a capacitor and inductor
wired in series

It is worth noting that both capacitors and inductors store energy, in their electric and magnetic fields,
respectively. A circuit containing both an inductor (L) and a capacitor (C) can oscillate without a source of emf
by shifting the energy stored in the circuit between the electric and magnetic fields. Thus, the concepts we
develop in this section are directly applicable to the exchange of energy between the electric and magnetic
fields in electromagnetic waves, or light. We start with an idealized circuit of zero resistance that contains an
inductor and a capacitor, an LC circuit.

An LC circuit is shown in Figure 14.16. If the capacitor contains a charge before the switch is closed, then all
the energy of the circuit is initially stored in the electric field of the capacitor (Figure 14.16(a)). This energy is

14.33

When the switch is closed, the capacitor begins to discharge, producing a current in the circuit. The current, in
turn, creates a magnetic field in the inductor. The net effect of this process is a transfer of energy from the
capacitor, with its diminishing electric field, to the inductor, with its increasing magnetic field.

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.5 • Oscillations in an LC Circuit 629

Figure 14.16 (a–d) The oscillation of charge storage with changing directions of current in an LC circuit. (e) The graphs show the
distribution of charge and current between the capacitor and inductor.

In Figure 14.16(b), the capacitor is completely discharged and all the energy is stored in the magnetic field of
the inductor. At this instant, the current is at its maximum value and the energy in the inductor is

14.34

Since there is no resistance in the circuit, no energy is lost through Joule heating; thus, the maximum energy
stored in the capacitor is equal to the maximum energy stored at a later time in the inductor:

14.35

At an arbitrary time when the capacitor charge is q(t) and the current is i(t), the total energy U in the circuit is
given by

Because there is no energy dissipation,

14.36

After reaching its maximum the current i(t) continues to transport charge between the capacitor plates,
thereby recharging the capacitor. Since the inductor resists a change in current, current continues to flow,
even though the capacitor is discharged. This continued current causes the capacitor to charge with opposite
polarity. The electric field of the capacitor increases while the magnetic field of the inductor diminishes, and
the overall effect is a transfer of energy from the inductor back to the capacitor. From the law of energy
630 14 • Inductance

conservation, the maximum charge that the capacitor re-acquires is However, as Figure 14.16(c) shows, the
capacitor plates are charged opposite to what they were initially.

When fully charged, the capacitor once again transfers its energy to the inductor until it is again completely
discharged, as shown in Figure 14.16(d). Then, in the last part of this cyclic process, energy flows back to the
capacitor, and the initial state of the circuit is restored.

We have followed the circuit through one complete cycle. Its electromagnetic oscillations are analogous to the
mechanical oscillations of a mass at the end of a spring. In this latter case, energy is transferred back and forth
between the mass, which has kinetic energy , and the spring, which has potential energy . With the
absence of friction in the mass-spring system, the oscillations would continue indefinitely. Similarly, the
oscillations of an LC circuit with no resistance would continue forever if undisturbed; however, this ideal zero-
resistance LC circuit is not practical, and any LC circuit will have at least a small resistance, which will radiate
and lose energy over time.

The frequency of the oscillations in a resistance-free LC circuit may be found by analogy with the mass-spring
system. For the circuit, , the total electromagnetic energy U is

14.37

For the mass-spring system, , the total mechanical energy E is

14.38

The equivalence of the two systems is clear. To go from the mechanical to the electromagnetic system, we
simply replace m by L, v by i, k by 1/C, and x by q. Now x(t) is given by
14.39

where Hence, the charge on the capacitor in an LC circuit is given by

14.40

where the angular frequency of the oscillations in the circuit is

14.41

Finally, the current in the LC circuit is found by taking the time derivative of q(t):

14.42

The time variations of q and I are shown in Figure 14.16(e) for .

EXAMPLE 14.6

An LC Circuit
In an LC circuit, the self-inductance is H and the capacitance is F. At all of the
energy is stored in the capacitor, which has charge C. (a) What is the angular frequency of the
oscillations in the circuit? (b) What is the maximum current flowing through circuit? (c) How long does it take
the capacitor to become completely discharged? (d) Find an equation that represents q(t).

Strategy
The angular frequency of the LC circuit is given by Equation 14.41. To find the maximum current, the

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.6 • RLC Series Circuits 631

maximum energy in the capacitor is set equal to the maximum energy in the inductor. The time for the
capacitor to become discharged if it is initially charged is a quarter of the period of the cycle, so if we calculate
the period of the oscillation, we can find out what a quarter of that is to find this time. Lastly, knowing the
initial charge and angular frequency, we can set up a cosine equation to find q(t).

Solution

a. From Equation 14.41, the angular frequency of the oscillations is

b. The current is at its maximum when all the energy is stored in the inductor. From the law of energy
conservation,

so

This result can also be found by an analogy to simple harmonic motion, where current and charge are the
velocity and position of an oscillator.
c. The capacitor becomes completely discharged in one-fourth of a cycle, or during a time T/4, where T is the
period of the oscillations. Since

the time taken for the capacitor to become fully discharged is


d. The capacitor is completely charged at so Using Equation 14.20, we obtain

Thus, and

Significance
The energy relationship set up in part (b) is not the only way we can equate energies. At most times, some
energy is stored in the capacitor and some energy is stored in the inductor. We can put both terms on each side
of the equation. By examining the circuit only when there is no charge on the capacitor or no current in the
inductor, we simplify the energy equation.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.10


The angular frequency of the oscillations in an LC circuit is rad/s. (a) If , what is C? (b)
Suppose that at all the energy is stored in the inductor. What is the value of (c) A second identical
capacitor is connected in parallel with the original capacitor. What is the angular frequency of this circuit?

14.6 RLC Series Circuits


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Determine the angular frequency of oscillation for a resistor, inductor, capacitor series circuit
• Relate the circuit to a damped spring oscillation

When the switch is closed in the RLC circuit of Figure 14.17(a), the capacitor begins to discharge and
electromagnetic energy is dissipated by the resistor at a rate . With U given by Equation 14.19, we have
632 14 • Inductance

14.43

where i and q are time-dependent functions. This reduces to

14.44

Figure 14.17 (a) An RLC circuit. Electromagnetic oscillations begin when the switch is closed. The capacitor is fully charged initially. (b)
Damped oscillations of the capacitor charge are shown in this curve of charge versus time, or q versus t. The capacitor contains a charge
before the switch is closed.

This equation is analogous to

which is the equation of motion for a damped mass-spring system (you first encountered this equation in
Oscillations). As we saw in that chapter, it can be shown that the solution to this differential equation takes
three forms, depending on whether the angular frequency of the undamped spring is greater than, equal to, or
less than b/2m. Therefore, the result can be underdamped , critically damped ,
or overdamped . By analogy, the solution q(t) to the RLC differential equation has the same
feature. Here we look only at the case of under-damping. By replacing m by L, b by R, k by 1/C, and x by q in
Equation 14.44, and assuming , we obtain

14.45

where the angular frequency of the oscillations is given by

14.46

This underdamped solution is shown in Figure 14.17(b). Notice that the amplitude of the oscillations
decreases as energy is dissipated in the resistor. Equation 14.45 can be confirmed experimentally by
measuring the voltage across the capacitor as a function of time. This voltage, multiplied by the capacitance of
the capacitor, then gives q(t).

INTERACTIVE
Try an interactive circuit construction kit (https://openstax.org/l/21phetcirconstr) that allows you to graph
current and voltage as a function of time. You can add inductors and capacitors to work with any combination

Access for free at openstax.org.


14.6 • RLC Series Circuits 633

of R, L, and C circuits with both dc and ac sources.

INTERACTIVE
Try out a circuit-based java applet website (https://openstax.org/l/21cirphysbascur) that has many problems
with both dc and ac sources that will help you practice circuit problems.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 14.11


In an RLC circuit, (a) Is the circuit underdamped, critically damped,
or overdamped? (b) If the circuit starts oscillating with a charge of on the capacitor, how much
energy has been dissipated in the resistor by the time the oscillations cease?
634 14 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
henry (H) unit of inductance, ; it is inductor, and capacitor
also expressed as a volt second per ampere magnetic energy density energy stored per
inductance property of a device that tells how volume in a magnetic field
effectively it induces an emf in another device mutual inductance geometric quantity that
inductive time constant denoted by , the expresses how effective two devices are at
characteristic time given by quantity L/R of a inducing emfs in one another
particular series RL circuit RLC circuit circuit with an ac source, resistor,
inductor part of an electrical circuit to provide inductor, and capacitor all in series.
self-inductance, which is symbolized by a coil of self-inductance effect of the device inducing emf
wire in itself
LC circuit circuit composed of an ac source,

Key Equations

Mutual inductance by flux

Mutual inductance in circuits

Self-inductance in terms of magnetic flux

Self-inductance in terms of emf

Self-inductance of a solenoid

Self-inductance of a toroid

Energy stored in an inductor

Current as a function of time for a RL circuit

Time constant for a RL circuit

Charge oscillation in LC circuits

Angular frequency in LC circuits

Current oscillations in LC circuits

Charge as a function of time in RLC circuit

Angular frequency in RLC circuit

Access for free at openstax.org.


14 • Chapter Review 635

Summary
14.1 Mutual Inductance 14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field
• Inductance is the property of a device that • The energy stored in an inductor U is
expresses how effectively it induces an emf in
another device.
• Mutual inductance is the effect of two devices • The self-inductance per unit length of coaxial
inducing emfs in each other. cable is
• A change in current in one circuit
induces an emf in the second:

14.4 RL Circuits
where M is defined to be the mutual inductance • When a series connection of a resistor and an
between the two circuits and the minus sign is inductor—an RL circuit—is connected to a
due to Lenz’s law. voltage source, the time variation of the current
• Symmetrically, a change in current is
through the second circuit induces an emf (turning
in the first: on),
where the initial current is
• The characteristic time constant is
where M is the same mutual inductance as in where L is the inductance and R is the
the reverse process. resistance.
• In the first time constant the current rises
14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors from zero to and to 0.632 of the
• Current changes in a device induce an emf in remainder in every subsequent time interval
the device itself, called self-inductance, • When the inductor is shorted through a resistor,
current decreases as
(turning off).
where L is the self-inductance of the inductor Current falls to in the first time interval
and is the rate of change of current , and to 0.368 of the remainder toward zero in
through it. The minus sign indicates that emf each subsequent time
opposes the change in current, as required by 14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit
Lenz’s law. The unit of self-inductance and
inductance is the henry (H), where . • The energy transferred in an oscillatory manner
• The self-inductance of a solenoid is between the capacitor and inductor in an LC
circuit occurs at an angular frequency
.
where N is its number of turns in the solenoid, A • The charge and current in the circuit are given
is its cross-sectional area, l is its length, and by
is the permeability of
free space.
• The self-inductance of a toroid is
14.6 RLC Series Circuits
• The underdamped solution for the capacitor
charge in an RLC circuit is
where N is its number of turns in the toroid,
are the inner and outer radii of the
toroid, h is the height of the toroid, and • The angular frequency given in the
is the permeability of underdamped solution for the RLC circuit is
free space.
636 14 • Chapter Review

Conceptual Questions
14.1 Mutual Inductance internal resistance of the battery? Does the time
required for the current to reach its final value
1. Show that and which are both
depend on this resistance?
expressions for self-inductance, have the same
15. At what time is the voltage across the inductor
units.
of the RL circuit of Figure 14.12(b) a maximum?
2. A 10-H inductor carries a current of 20 A.
16. In the simple RL circuit of Figure 14.12(b), can
Describe how a 50-V emf can be induced across
the emf induced across the inductor ever be
it.
greater than the emf of the battery used to
3. The ignition circuit of an automobile is powered
produce the current?
by a 12-V battery. How are we able to generate
17. If the emf of the battery of Figure 14.12(b) is
large voltages with this power source?
reduced by a factor of 2, by how much does the
4. When the current through a large inductor is
steady-state energy stored in the magnetic field
interrupted with a switch, an arc appears across
of the inductor change?
the open terminals of the switch. Explain.
18. A steady current flows through a circuit with a
large inductive time constant. When a switch in
14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors the circuit is opened, a large spark occurs
5. Does self-inductance depend on the value of the across the terminals of the switch. Explain.
magnetic flux? Does it depend on the current 19. Describe how the currents through
through the wire? Correlate your answers with shown below vary with time after switch S is
the equation closed.
6. Would the self-inductance of a 1.0 m long, tightly
wound solenoid differ from the self-inductance
per meter of an infinite, but otherwise identical,
solenoid?
7. Discuss how you might determine the self-
inductance per unit length of a long, straight
wire.
8. The self-inductance of a coil is zero if there is no
current passing through the windings. True or
false? 20. Discuss possible practical applications of RL
9. How does the self-inductance per unit length circuits.
near the center of a solenoid (away from the
ends) compare with its value near the end of the 14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit
solenoid?
21. Do Kirchhoff’s rules apply to circuits that
contain inductors and capacitors?
14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field
22. Can a circuit element have both capacitance
10. Show that has units of energy. and inductance?
23. In an LC circuit, what determines the frequency
14.4 RL Circuits and the amplitude of the energy oscillations in
either the inductor or capacitor?
11. Use Lenz’s law to explain why the initial current
in the RL circuit of Figure 14.12(b) is zero.
14.6 RLC Series Circuits
12. When the current in the RL circuit of Figure
14.12(b) reaches its final value what is the 24. When a wire is connected between the two ends
voltage across the inductor? Across the resistor? of a solenoid, the resulting circuit can oscillate
13. Does the time required for the current in an RL like an RLC circuit. Describe what causes the
circuit to reach any fraction of its steady-state capacitance in this circuit.
value depend on the emf of the battery? 25. Describe what effect the resistance of the
14. An inductor is connected across the terminals connecting wires has on an oscillating LC
of a battery. Does the current that eventually circuit.
flows through the inductor depend on the 26. Suppose you wanted to design an LC circuit with

Access for free at openstax.org.


14 • Chapter Review 637

a frequency of 0.01 Hz. What problems might or car without hearing other unwanted
you encounter? frequencies. How would someone design such a
27. A radio receiver uses an RLC circuit to pick out circuit?
particular frequencies to listen to in your house

Problems
14.1 Mutual Inductance 14.2 Self-Inductance and Inductors
28. When the current in one coil changes at a rate of 35. An emf of 0.40 V is induced across a coil when
5.6 A/s, an emf of is induced in a the current through it changes uniformly from
second, nearby coil. What is the mutual 0.10 to 0.60 A in 0.30 s. What is the self-
inductance of the two coils? inductance of the coil?
29. An emf of is induced in a coil 36. The current shown in part (a) below is increasing,
while the current in a nearby coil is decreasing whereas that shown in part (b) is decreasing. In each
at a rate of 2.7 A/s. What is the mutual case, determine which end of the inductor is at the
inductance of the two coils? higher potential.
30. Two coils close to each other have a mutual
inductance of 32 mH. If the current in one coil
decays according to , where
and what is the
emf induced in the second coil immediately
after the current starts to decay? At

31. A coil of 40 turns is wrapped around a long 37. What is the rate at which the current though a
solenoid of cross-sectional area 0.30-H coil is changing if an emf of 0.12 V is
The solenoid is 0.50 m long and has 500 turns. induced across the coil?
(a) What is the mutual inductance of this 38. When a camera uses a flash, a fully charged
system? (b) The outer coil is replaced by a coil of capacitor discharges through an inductor. In
40 turns whose radius is three times that of the what time must the 0.100-A current through a
solenoid. What is the mutual inductance of this 2.00-mH inductor be switched on or off to
configuration? induce a 500-V emf?
32. A 600-turn solenoid is 0.55 m long and 4.2 cm 39. A coil with a self-inductance of 2.0 H carries a
in diameter. Inside the solenoid, a small current that varies with time according to
single-turn rectangular coil Find an expression for
is fixed in place with its face perpendicular to the emf induced in the coil.
the long axis of the solenoid. What is the mutual 40. A solenoid 50 cm long is wound with 500 turns
inductance of this system? of wire. The cross-sectional area of the coil is
33. A toroidal coil has a mean radius of 16 cm and a What is the self-inductance of the
cross-sectional area of ; it is wound solenoid?
uniformly with 1000 turns. A second toroidal 41. A coil with a self-inductance of 3.0 H carries a
coil of 750 turns is wound uniformly over the current that decreases at a uniform rate
first coil. Ignoring the variation of the magnetic . What is the emf induced in
field within a toroid, determine the mutual the coil? Describe the polarity of the induced
inductance of the two coils. emf.
34. A solenoid of turns has length and radius 42. The current I(t) through a 5.0-mH inductor
and a second smaller solenoid of turns varies with time, as shown below. The
has length and radius . The smaller resistance of the inductor is Calculate the
solenoid is placed completely inside the larger voltage across the inductor at
solenoid so that their long axes coincide. What .
is the mutual inductance of the two solenoids?
638 14 • Chapter Review

stored in the magnetic field of the inductor?


(Hint: Use the value for ice.)
50. A coil with a self-inductance of 3.0 H and a
resistance of carries a steady current of
2.0 A. (a) What is the energy stored in the
magnetic field of the coil? (b) What is the energy
per second dissipated in the resistance of the
coil?
51. A current of 1.2 A is flowing in a coaxial cable
43. A long, cylindrical solenoid with 100 turns per whose outer radius is five times its inner radius.
centimeter has a radius of 1.5 cm. (a) Neglecting What is the magnetic field energy stored in a
end effects, what is the self-inductance per unit 3.0-m length of the cable?
length of the solenoid? (b) If the current through
the solenoid changes at the rate 5.0 A/s, what is 14.4 RL Circuits
the emf induced per unit length?
52. In Figure 14.12, , , and
44. Suppose that a rectangular toroid has 2000
. Determine (a) the time constant of
windings and a self-inductance of 0.040 H. If
the circuit, (b) the initial current through the
, what is the ratio of its outer radius to its
resistor, (c) the final current through the
inner radius?
resistor, (d) the current through the resistor
when and (e) the voltages across the
inductor and the resistor when
53. For the circuit shown below, ,
and . After steady state is reached with
closed and open, is closed and immediately
thereafter is opened. Determine (a) the
current through L at , (b) the current through L
at , and (c) the voltages across L
and at . .

45. What is the self-inductance per meter of a


coaxial cable whose inner radius is 0.50 mm
and whose outer radius is 4.00 mm?

14.3 Energy in a Magnetic Field


46. At the instant a current of 0.20 A is flowing
through a coil of wire, the energy stored in its
magnetic field is What is the self-
inductance of the coil? 54. The current in the RL circuit shown here increases
47. Suppose that a rectangular toroid has 2000 to of its steady-state value in 2.0 s. What is the
windings and a self-inductance of 0.040 H. If time constant of the circuit?
, what is the current flowing through
a rectangular toroid when the energy in its
magnetic field is
48. Solenoid A is tightly wound while solenoid B has
windings that are evenly spaced with a gap
equal to the diameter of the wire. The solenoids
are otherwise identical. Determine the ratio of
the energies stored per unit length of these
solenoids when the same current flows through
each.
49. A 10-H inductor carries a current of 20 A. How
much ice at could be melted by the energy

Access for free at openstax.org.


14 • Chapter Review 639

the circuit if .

58. Consider the circuit shown below. Find


when (a) the switch S is first closed,
(b) after the currents have reached steady-state
values, and (c) at the instant the switch is reopened
(after being closed for a long time).

59. For the circuit shown below, , ,


, and . Find the
values of (a) immediately after switch S is
55. How long after switch is thrown does it take closed, (b) a long time after S is closed, (c)
the current in the circuit shown to reach half its immediately after S is reopened, and (d) a long time
maximum value? Express your answer in terms after S is reopened.
of the time constant of the circuit.

56. Examine the circuit shown below in part (a).


Determine dI/dt at the instant after the switch is
thrown in the circuit of (a), thereby producing the 60. For the circuit shown below, find the current
circuit of (b). Show that if I were to continue to through the inductor after the switch
increase at this initial rate, it would reach its is reopened.
maximum in one time constant.

57. The current in the RL circuit shown below 61. Show that for the circuit shown below, the initial
reaches half its maximum value in 1.75 ms after energy stored in the inductor, , is equal to
the switch is thrown. Determine (a) the time the total energy eventually dissipated in the resistor,
constant of the circuit and (b) the resistance of
640 14 • Chapter Review

∞ respectively. (a)
. What is the frequency of the oscillations? (b) If
the maximum potential difference between the
plates of the capacitor is 50 V, what is the
maximum current in the circuit?
67. In an oscillating LC circuit, the maximum
charge on the capacitor is . Determine the
charge on the capacitor and the current through
the inductor when energy is shared equally
between the electric and magnetic fields.
Express your answer in terms of , L, and C.
68. In the circuit shown below, is opened and
is closed simultaneously. Determine (a) the
frequency of the resulting oscillations, (b) the
maximum charge on the capacitor, (c) the
maximum current through the inductor, and (d)
the electromagnetic energy of the oscillating
circuit.

14.5 Oscillations in an LC Circuit


62. A 5000-pF capacitor is charged to 100 V and 69. An LC circuit in an AM tuner (in a car stereo)
then quickly connected to an 80-mH inductor. uses a coil with an inductance of 2.5 mH and a
Determine (a) the maximum energy stored in variable capacitor. If the natural frequency of
the magnetic field of the inductor, (b) the peak the circuit is to be adjustable over the range 540
value of the current, and (c) the frequency of to 1600 kHz (the AM broadcast band), what
oscillation of the circuit. range of capacitance is required?
63. The self-inductance and capacitance of an LC
circuit are 0.20 mH and 5.0 pF. What is the 14.6 RLC Series Circuits
angular frequency at which the circuit
oscillates? 70. In an oscillating RLC circuit,
64. What is the self-inductance of an LC circuit that What
oscillates at 60 Hz when the capacitance is is the angular frequency of the oscillations?
? 71. In an oscillating RLC circuit with
65. In an oscillating LC circuit, the maximum how
much time elapses before the amplitude of the
charge on the capacitor is and the
oscillations drops to half its initial value?
maximum current through the inductor is 8.0
72. What resistance R must be connected in series
mA. (a) What is the period of the oscillations? (b)
with a 200-mH inductor and a capacitor of
How much time elapses between an instant
the resulting RLC oscillating circuit is to decay
when the capacitor is uncharged and the next
to of its initial value of charge in 50 cycles?
instant when it is fully charged?
To of its initial value in 50 cycles?
66. The self-inductance and capacitance of an
oscillating LC circuit are

Access for free at openstax.org.


14 • Chapter Review 641

Additional Problems
73. Show that the self-inductance per unit length of 77. A solenoid with turns/m has an iron core
an infinite, straight, thin wire is infinite. placed in it whose magnetic susceptibility is
74. Two long, parallel wires carry equal currents in . (a) If a current of 2.0 A flows through
opposite directions. The radius of each wire is a, the solenoid, what is the magnetic field in the
and the distance between the centers of the iron core? (b) What is the effective surface
wires is d. Show that if the magnetic flux within current formed by the aligned atomic current
the wires themselves can be ignored, the self- loops in the iron core? (c) What is the self-
inductance of a length l of such a pair of wires is inductance of the filled solenoid?
78. A rectangular toroid with inner radius
(Hint: Calculate the magnetic flux through a outer radius , height
rectangle of length l between the wires and then , and turns is filled with an
use .) iron core of magnetic susceptibility .
75. A small, rectangular single loop of wire with (a) What is the self-inductance of the toroid? (b)
dimensions l, and a is placed, as shown below, If the current through the toroid is 2.0 A, what is
in the plane of a much larger, rectangular single the magnetic field at the center of the core? (c)
loop of wire. The two short sides of the larger For this same 2.0-A current, what is the
loop are so far from the smaller loop that their effective surface current formed by the aligned
magnetic fields over the smaller fields over the atomic current loops in the iron core?
smaller loop can be ignored. What is the mutual 79. The switch S of the circuit shown below is closed at
inductance of the two loops? . Determine (a) the initial current through the
battery and (b) the steady-state current through the
battery.

76. Suppose that a cylindrical solenoid is wrapped


around a core of iron whose magnetic
susceptibility is x. Using Equation 14.9, show 80. In an oscillating RLC circuit,
that the self-inductance of the solenoid is given .
by Initially, the capacitor has a charge of
and the current is zero. Calculate the charge on
the capacitor (a) five cycles later and (b) 50
where l is its length, A its cross-sectional area, cycles later.
and N its total number of turns. 81. A 25.0-H inductor has 100 A of current turned
off in 1.00 ms. (a) What voltage is induced to
oppose this? (b) What is unreasonable about
this result? (c) Which assumption or premise is
responsible?
642 14 • Chapter Review

Challenge Problems
82. A coaxial cable has an inner conductor of radius 84. The switch in the circuit shown below is closed
a, and outer thin cylindrical shell of radius b. A at . Find currents through (a) , (b) ,
current I flows in the inner conductor and and (c) the battery as function of time.
returns in the outer conductor. The self-
inductance of the structure will depend on how
the current in the inner cylinder tends to be
distributed. Investigate the following two
extreme cases. (a) Let current in the inner
conductor be distributed only on the surface
and find the self-inductance. (b) Let current in
the inner cylinder be distributed uniformly over
its cross-section and find the self-inductance.
Compare with your results in (a).
85. A square loop of side 2 cm is placed 1 cm from a
83. In a damped oscillating circuit the energy is
long wire carrying a current that varies with
dissipated in the resistor. The Q-factor is a
time at a constant rate of 3 A/s as shown below.
measure of the persistence of the oscillator
(a) Use Ampère’s law and find the magnetic
against the dissipative loss. (a) Prove that for a
field. (b) Determine the magnetic flux through
lightly damped circuit the energy, U, in the
the loop. (c) If the loop has a resistance of ,
circuit decreases according to the following
how much induced current flows in the loop?
equation.
where
(b) Using the definition of the Q-factor as energy
divided by the loss over the next cycle, prove
that Q-factor of a lightly damped oscillator as
defined in this problem is

(Hint: For (b), to obtain Q, divide E at the


beginning of one cycle by the change over
the next cycle.)

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 15
Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.1 The current we draw into our houses is an alternating current (ac). Power lines transmit ac to our
neighborhoods, where local power stations and transformers distribute it to our homes. In this chapter, we discuss
how a transformer works and how it allows us to transmit power at very high voltages and minimal heating losses
across the lines.

Chapter Outline

15.1 AC Sources

15.2 Simple AC Circuits

15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC

15.4 Power in an AC Circuit

15.5 Resonance in an AC Circuit

15.6 Transformers

INTRODUCTION Electric power is delivered to our homes by alternating current (ac) through high-voltage
transmission lines. As explained in Transformers, transformers can then change the amplitude of the
alternating potential difference to a more useful form. This lets us transmit power at very high voltages,
minimizing resistive heating losses in the lines, and then furnish that power to homes at lower, safer voltages.
Because constant potential differences are unaffected by transformers, this capability is more difficult to
achieve with direct-current transmission.
644 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

In this chapter, we use Kirchhoff’s laws to analyze four simple circuits in which ac flows. We have discussed the
use of the resistor, capacitor, and inductor in circuits with batteries. These components are also part of ac
circuits. However, because ac is required, the constant source of emf supplied by a battery is replaced by an ac
voltage source, which produces an oscillating emf.

15.1 AC Sources
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain the differences between direct current (dc) and alternating current (ac)
• Define characteristic features of alternating current and voltage, such as the amplitude or peak and the
frequency

Most examples dealt with so far in this book, particularly those using batteries, have constant-voltage sources.
Thus, once the current is established, it is constant. Direct current (dc) is the flow of electric charge in only
one direction. It is the steady state of a constant-voltage circuit.

Most well-known applications, however, use a time-varying voltage source. Alternating current (ac) is the flow
of electric charge that periodically reverses direction. An ac is produced by an alternating emf, which is
generated in a power plant, as described in Induced Electric Fields. If the ac source varies periodically,
particularly sinusoidally, the circuit is known as an ac circuit. Examples include the commercial and
residential power that serves so many of our needs.

The ac voltages and frequencies commonly used in businesses and homes vary around the world. In a typical
house, the potential difference between the two sides of an electrical outlet alternates sinusoidally with a
frequency of 60 or 50 Hz and an amplitude of 170 or 311 V, depending on whether you live in the United States
or Europe, respectively. Most people know the potential difference for electrical outlets is 120 V or 220 V in the
US or Europe, but as explained later in the chapter, these voltages are not the peak values given here but rather
are related to the common voltages we see in our electrical outlets. Figure 15.2 shows graphs of voltage and
current versus time for typical dc and ac power in the United States.

Figure 15.2 (a) The dc voltage and current are constant in time, once the current is established. (b) The voltage and current versus time
are quite different for ac power. In this example, which shows 60-Hz ac power and time t in milliseconds, voltage and current are sinusoidal
and are in phase for a simple resistance circuit. The frequencies and peak voltages of ac sources differ greatly.

Suppose we hook up a resistor to an ac voltage source and determine how the voltage and current vary in time
across the resistor. Figure 15.3 shows a schematic of a simple circuit with an ac voltage source. The voltage
fluctuates sinusoidally with time at a fixed frequency, as shown, on either the battery terminals or the resistor.
Therefore, the ac voltage, or the “voltage at a plug,” can be given by

15.1

where v is the voltage at time t, is the peak voltage, and is the angular frequency in radians per second.
For a typical house in the United States, and , whereas in Europe, and

For this simple resistance circuit, , so the ac current, meaning the current that fluctuates sinusoidally

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.2 • Simple AC Circuits 645

with time at a fixed frequency, is

15.2

where i is the current at time t and is the peak current and is equal to . For this example, the voltage
and current are said to be in phase, meaning that their sinusoidal functional forms have peaks, troughs, and
nodes in the same place. They oscillate in sync with each other, as shown in Figure 15.2(b). In these equations,
and throughout this chapter, we use lowercase letters (such as i) to indicate instantaneous values and capital
letters (such as I) to indicate maximum, or peak, values.

Figure 15.3 The potential difference V between the terminals of an ac voltage source fluctuates, so the source and the resistor have ac
sine waves on top of each other. The mathematical expression for v is given by

Current in the resistor alternates back and forth just like the driving voltage, since . If the resistor is a
fluorescent light bulb, for example, it brightens and dims 120 times per second as the current repeatedly goes
through zero. A 120-Hz flicker is too rapid for your eyes to detect, but if you wave your hand back and forth
between your face and a fluorescent light, you will see the stroboscopic effect of ac.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.1


If a European ac voltage source is considered, what is the time difference between the zero crossings on an ac
voltage-versus-time graph?

15.2 Simple AC Circuits


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Interpret phasor diagrams and apply them to ac circuits with resistors, capacitors, and inductors
• Define the reactance for a resistor, capacitor, and inductor to help understand how current in the circuit
behaves compared to each of these devices

In this section, we study simple models of ac voltage sources connected to three circuit components: (1) a
resistor, (2) a capacitor, and (3) an inductor. The power furnished by an ac voltage source has an emf given by

as shown in Figure 15.4. This sine function assumes we start recording the voltage when it is at a time
of A phase constant may be involved that shifts the function when we start measuring voltages, similar
to the phase constant in the waves we studied in Waves. However, because we are free to choose when we start
examining the voltage, we can ignore this phase constant for now. We can measure this voltage across the
circuit components using one of two methods: (1) a quantitative approach based on our knowledge of circuits,
or (2) a graphical approach that is explained in the coming sections.
646 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.4 (a) The output of an ac generator. (b) Symbol used to represent an ac voltage source in a circuit diagram.

Resistor
First, consider a resistor connected across an ac voltage source. From Kirchhoff’s loop rule, the instantaneous
voltage across the resistor of Figure 15.5(a) is

and the instantaneous current through the resistor is

Figure 15.5 (a) A resistor connected across an ac voltage source. (b) The current through the resistor and the voltage across
the resistor. The two quantities are in phase.

Here, is the amplitude of the time-varying current. Plots of and are shown in Figure
15.5(b). Both curves reach their maxima and minima at the same times, that is, the current through and the
voltage across the resistor are in phase.

Graphical representations of the phase relationships between current and voltage are often useful in the
analysis of ac circuits. Such representations are called phasor diagrams. The phasor diagram for is
shown in Figure 15.6(a), with the current on the vertical axis. The arrow (or phasor) is rotating

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.2 • Simple AC Circuits 647

counterclockwise at a constant angular frequency so we are viewing it at one instant in time. If the length of
the arrow corresponds to the current amplitude the projection of the rotating arrow onto the vertical axis is
which is the instantaneous current.

Figure 15.6 (a) The phasor diagram representing the current through the resistor of Figure 15.5. (b) The phasor diagram representing
both and .

The vertical axis on a phasor diagram could be either the voltage or the current, depending on the phasor that
is being examined. In addition, several quantities can be depicted on the same phasor diagram. For example,
both the current and the voltage are shown in the diagram of Figure 15.6(b). Since they have the
same frequency and are in phase, their phasors point in the same direction and rotate together. The relative
lengths of the two phasors are arbitrary because they represent different quantities; however, the ratio of the
lengths of the two phasors can be represented by the resistance, since one is a voltage phasor and the other is a
current phasor.

Capacitor
Now let’s consider a capacitor connected across an ac voltage source. From Kirchhoff’s loop rule, the
instantaneous voltage across the capacitor of Figure 15.7(a) is

Recall that the charge in a capacitor is given by This is true at any time measured in the ac cycle of
voltage. Consequently, the instantaneous charge on the capacitor is

Since the current in the circuit is the rate at which charge enters (or leaves) the capacitor,

where is the current amplitude. Using the trigonometric relationship we


may express the instantaneous current as

Dividing by , we obtain an equation that looks similar to Ohm’s law:

15.3

The quantity is analogous to resistance in a dc circuit in the sense that both quantities are a ratio of a
voltage to a current. As a result, they have the same unit, the ohm. Keep in mind, however, that a capacitor
stores and discharges electric energy, whereas a resistor dissipates it. The quantity is known as the
capacitive reactance of the capacitor, or the opposition of a capacitor to a change in current. It depends
inversely on the frequency of the ac source—high frequency leads to low capacitive reactance.
648 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.7 (a) A capacitor connected across an ac generator. (b) The current through the capacitor and the voltage across
the capacitor. Notice that leads by rad.

A comparison of the expressions for and shows that there is a phase difference of between
them. When these two quantities are plotted together, the current peaks a quarter cycle (or ) ahead of
the voltage, as illustrated in Figure 15.7(b). The current through a capacitor leads the voltage across a
capacitor by or a quarter of a cycle.

The corresponding phasor diagram is shown in Figure 15.8. Here, the relationship between and is
represented by having their phasors rotate at the same angular frequency, with the current phasor leading by

Figure 15.8 The phasor diagram for the capacitor of Figure 15.7. The current phasor leads the voltage phasor by rad as they both
rotate with the same angular frequency.

To this point, we have exclusively been using peak values of the current or voltage in our discussion, namely,
and However, if we average out the values of current or voltage, these values are zero. Therefore, we
often use a second convention called the root mean square value, or rms value, in discussions of current and
voltage. The rms operates in reverse of the terminology. First, you square the function, next, you take the
mean, and then, you find the square root. As a result, the rms values of current and voltage are not zero.
Appliances and devices are commonly quoted with rms values for their operations, rather than peak values.
We indicate rms values with a subscript attached to a capital letter (such as ).

Although a capacitor is basically an open circuit, an rms current, or the root mean square of the current,
appears in a circuit with an ac voltage applied to a capacitor. Consider that

15.4

where is the peak current in an ac system. The rms voltage, or the root mean square of the voltage, is

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.2 • Simple AC Circuits 649

15.5

where is the peak voltage in an ac system. The rms current appears because the voltage is continually
reversing, charging, and discharging the capacitor. If the frequency goes to zero, which would be a dc voltage,
tends to infinity, and the current is zero once the capacitor is charged. At very high frequencies, the
capacitor’s reactance tends to zero—it has a negligible reactance and does not impede the current (it acts like a
simple wire).

Inductor
Lastly, let’s consider an inductor connected to an ac voltage source. From Kirchhoff’s loop rule, the voltage
across the inductor L of Figure 15.9(a) is
15.6
The emf across an inductor is equal to however, the potential difference across the inductor
is , because if we consider that the voltage around the loop must equal zero, the voltage
gained from the ac source must dissipate through the inductor. Therefore, connecting this with the ac voltage
source, we have

Figure 15.9 (a) An inductor connected across an ac generator. (b) The current through the inductor and the voltage across
the inductor. Here lags by rad.

The current is found by integrating this equation. Since the circuit does not contain a source of constant
emf, there is no steady current in the circuit. Hence, we can set the constant of integration, which represents
the steady current in the circuit, equal to zero, and we have

15.7

where The relationship between and may also be written in a form analogous to Ohm’s law:

15.8

The quantity is known as the inductive reactance of the inductor, or the opposition of an inductor to a
change in current; its unit is also the ohm. Note that varies directly as the frequency of the ac source—high
frequency causes high inductive reactance.

A phase difference of rad occurs between the current through and the voltage across the inductor. From
Equation 15.6 and Equation 15.7, the current through an inductor lags the potential difference across an
inductor by , or a quarter of a cycle. The phasor diagram for this case is shown in Figure 15.10.
650 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.10 The phasor diagram for the inductor of Figure 15.9. The current phasor lags the voltage phasor by rad as they both
rotate with the same angular frequency.

INTERACTIVE
An animation from the University of New South Wales AC Circuits (https://openstax.org/l/21accircuits)
illustrates some of the concepts we discuss in this chapter. They also include wave and phasor diagrams that
evolve over time so that you can get a better picture of how each changes over time.

EXAMPLE 15.1

Simple AC Circuits
An ac generator produces an emf of amplitude 10 V at a frequency Determine the voltages across
and the currents through the circuit elements when the generator is connected to (a) a resistor, (b) a
capacitor, and (c) a 15-mH inductor.

Strategy
The entire AC voltage across each device is the same as the source voltage. We can find the currents by finding
the reactance X of each device and solving for the peak current using

Solution
The voltage across the terminals of the source is

where is the angular frequency. Since v(t) is also the voltage across each of the
elements, we have

a. When the amplitude of the current through the resistor is

so

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.3 • RLC Series Circuits with AC 651

b. From Equation 15.3, the capacitive reactance is

so the maximum value of the current is

and the instantaneous current is given by

c. From Equation 15.8, the inductive reactance is

The maximum current is therefore

and the instantaneous current is

Significance
Although the voltage across each device is the same, the peak current has different values, depending on the
reactance. The reactance for each device depends on the values of resistance, capacitance, or inductance.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.2


Repeat Example 15.1 for an ac source of amplitude 20 V and frequency 100 Hz.

15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe how the current varies in a resistor, a capacitor, and an inductor while in series with an ac power
source
• Use phasors to understand the phase angle of a resistor, capacitor, and inductor ac circuit and to
understand what that phase angle means
• Calculate the impedance of a circuit

The ac circuit shown in Figure 15.11, called an RLC series circuit, is a series combination of a resistor,
capacitor, and inductor connected across an ac source. It produces an emf of
652 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.11 (a) An RLC series circuit. (b) A comparison of the generator output voltage and the current. The value of the phase difference
depends on the values of R, C, and L.

Since the elements are in series, the same current flows through each element at all points in time. The
relative phase between the current and the emf is not obvious when all three elements are present.
Consequently, we represent the current by the general expression

where is the current amplitude and is the phase angle between the current and the applied voltage. The
phase angle is thus the amount by which the voltage and current are out of phase with each other in a circuit.
Our task is to find

A phasor diagram involving is helpful for analyzing the circuit. As shown in Figure
15.12, the phasor representing points in the same direction as the phasor for its amplitude is
The phasor lags the i(t) phasor by rad and has the amplitude The phasor for
leads the i(t) phasor by rad and has the amplitude

Figure 15.12 The phasor diagram for the RLC series circuit of Figure 15.11.

At any instant, the voltage across the RLC combination is the emf of the source.
Since a component of a sum of vectors is the sum of the components of the individual vectors—for example,
—the projection of the vector sum of phasors onto the vertical axis is the sum of the
vertical projections of the individual phasors. Hence, if we add vectorially the phasors representing
and then find the projection of the resultant onto the vertical axis, we obtain

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.3 • RLC Series Circuits with AC 653

The vector sum of the phasors is shown in Figure 15.13. The resultant phasor has an amplitude and is
directed at an angle with respect to the or i(t), phasor. The projection of this resultant phasor onto the
vertical axis is We can easily determine the unknown quantities and from the geometry
of the phasor diagram. For the phase angle,

and after cancellation of this becomes

15.9

Furthermore, from the Pythagorean theorem,

Figure 15.13 The resultant of the phasors for , , and is equal to the phasor for The i(t) phasor (not
shown) is aligned with the phasor.

The current amplitude is therefore the ac version of Ohm’s law:

15.10

where

15.11

is known as the impedance of the circuit. Its unit is the ohm, and it is the ac analog to resistance in a dc circuit,
which measures the combined effect of resistance, capacitive reactance, and inductive reactance (Figure
15.14).
654 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.14 Power capacitors are used to balance the impedance of the effective inductance in transmission lines.

The RLC circuit is analogous to the wheel of a car driven over a corrugated road (Figure 15.15). The regularly
spaced bumps in the road drive the wheel up and down; in the same way, a voltage source increases and
decreases. The shock absorber acts like the resistance of the RLC circuit, damping and limiting the amplitude
of the oscillation. Energy within the wheel system goes back and forth between kinetic and potential energy
stored in the car spring, analogous to the shift between a maximum current, with energy stored in an inductor,
and no current, with energy stored in the electric field of a capacitor. The amplitude of the wheel’s motion is at
a maximum if the bumps in the road are hit at the resonant frequency, which we describe in more detail in
Resonance in an AC Circuit.

Figure 15.15 On a car, the shock absorber damps motion and dissipates energy. This is much like the resistance in an RLC circuit. The
mass and spring determine the resonant frequency.

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.3 • RLC Series Circuits with AC 655

PROBLEM-SOLVING STRATEGY

AC Circuits
To analyze an ac circuit containing resistors, capacitors, and inductors, it is helpful to think of each device’s
reactance and find the equivalent reactance using the rules we used for equivalent resistance in the past.
Phasors are a great method to determine whether the emf of the circuit has positive or negative phase (namely,
leads or lags other values). A mnemonic device of “ELI the ICE man” is sometimes used to remember that the
emf (E) leads the current (I) in an inductor (L) and the current (I) leads the emf (E) in a capacitor (C).

Use the following steps to determine the emf of the circuit by phasors:

1. Draw the phasors for voltage across each device: resistor, capacitor, and inductor, including the phase
angle in the circuit.
2. If there is both a capacitor and an inductor, find the net voltage from these two phasors, since they are
antiparallel.
3. Find the equivalent phasor from the phasor in step 2 and the resistor’s phasor using trigonometry or
components of the phasors. The equivalent phasor found is the emf of the circuit.

EXAMPLE 15.2

An RLC Series Circuit


The output of an ac generator connected to an RLC series combination has a frequency of 200 Hz and an
amplitude of 0.100 V. If and what are (a) the capacitive
reactance, (b) the inductive reactance, (c) the impedance, (d) the current amplitude, and (e) the phase
difference between the current and the emf of the generator?

Strategy
The reactances and impedance in (a)–(c) are found by substitutions into Equation 15.3, Equation 15.8, and
Equation 15.11, respectively. The current amplitude is calculated from the peak voltage and the impedance.
The phase difference between the current and the emf is calculated by the inverse tangent of the difference
between the reactances divided by the resistance.

Solution

a. From Equation 15.3, the capacitive reactance is

b. From Equation 15.8, the inductive reactance is

c. Substituting the values of R, , and into Equation 15.11, we obtain for the impedance

d. The current amplitude is

e. From Equation 15.9, the phase difference between the current and the emf is

Significance
The phase angle is positive because the reactance of the inductor is larger than the reactance of the capacitor.
656 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.3


Find the voltages across the resistor, the capacitor, and the inductor in the circuit of Figure 15.11 using
as the output of the ac generator.

15.4 Power in an AC Circuit


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe how average power from an ac circuit can be written in terms of peak current and voltage and of
rms current and voltage
• Determine the relationship between the phase angle of the current and voltage and the average power,
known as the power factor

A circuit element dissipates or produces power according to where I is the current through the
element and V is the voltage across it. Since the current and the voltage both depend on time in an ac circuit,
the instantaneous power is also time dependent. A plot of p(t) for various circuit elements is
shown in Figure 15.16. For a resistor, i(t) and v(t) are in phase and therefore always have the same sign (see
Figure 15.5). For a capacitor or inductor, the relative signs of i(t) and v(t) vary over a cycle due to their phase
differences (see Figure 15.7 and Figure 15.9). Consequently, p(t) is positive at some times and negative at
others, indicating that capacitive and inductive elements produce power at some instants and absorb it at
others.

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.4 • Power in an AC Circuit 657

Figure 15.16 Graph of instantaneous power for various circuit elements. (a) For the resistor, whereas for (b) the capacitor
and (c) the inductor, (d) For the source, which may be positive, negative, or zero, depending on

Because instantaneous power varies in both magnitude and sign over a cycle, it seldom has any practical
importance. What we’re almost always concerned with is the power averaged over time, which we refer to as
the average power. It is defined by the time average of the instantaneous power over one cycle:

where is the period of the oscillations. With the substitutions and


this integral becomes
658 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Using the trigonometric relation we obtain

Evaluation of these two integrals yields

and

Hence, the average power associated with a circuit element is given by

15.12

In engineering applications, is known as the power factor, which is the amount by which the power
delivered in the circuit is less than the theoretical maximum of the circuit due to voltage and current being out
of phase. For a resistor, so the average power dissipated is

A comparison of p(t) and is shown in Figure 15.16(d). To make look like its dc
counterpart, we use the rms values of the current and the voltage. By definition, these are

where

With we obtain

We may then write for the average power dissipated by a resistor,

15.13

This equation further emphasizes why the rms value is chosen in discussion rather than peak values. Both
equations for average power are correct for Equation 15.13, but the rms values in the formula give a cleaner
representation, so the extra factor of 1/2 is not necessary.

Alternating voltages and currents are usually described in terms of their rms values. For example, the 110 V
from a household outlet is an rms value. The amplitude of this source is Because most ac
meters are calibrated in terms of rms values, a typical ac voltmeter placed across a household outlet will read
110 V.

For a capacitor and an inductor, respectively. Since we find

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.4 • Power in an AC Circuit 659

from Equation 15.12 that the average power dissipated by either of these elements is Capacitors and
inductors absorb energy from the circuit during one half-cycle and then discharge it back to the circuit during
the other half-cycle. This behavior is illustrated in the plots of Figure 15.16, (b) and (c), which show p(t)
oscillating sinusoidally about zero.

The phase angle for an ac generator may have any value. If the generator produces power; if
it absorbs power. In terms of rms values, the average power of an ac generator is written as

For the generator in an RLC circuit,

and

Hence the average power of the generator is

15.14

This can also be written as

which designates that the power produced by the generator is dissipated in the resistor. As we can see, Ohm’s
law for the rms ac is found by dividing the rms voltage by the impedance.

EXAMPLE 15.3

Power Output of a Generator


An ac generator whose emf is given by

is connected to an RLC circuit for which , , and . (a) What is


the rms voltage across the generator? (b) What is the impedance of the circuit? (c) What is the average power
output of the generator?

Strategy
The rms voltage is the amplitude of the voltage times . The impedance of the circuit involves the
resistance and the reactances of the capacitor and the inductor. The average power is calculated by Equation
15.14, or more specifically, the last part of the equation, because we have the impedance of the circuit Z, the
rms voltage , and the resistance R.

Solution

a. Since the rms voltage across the generator is

b. The impedance of the circuit is


660 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

c. From Equation 15.14, the average power transferred to the circuit is

Significance
If the resistance is much larger than the reactance of the capacitor or inductor, the average power is a dc
circuit equation of where V replaces the rms voltage.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.4


An ac voltmeter attached across the terminals of a 45-Hz ac generator reads 7.07 V. Write an expression for the
emf of the generator.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.5


Show that the rms voltages across a resistor, a capacitor, and an inductor in an ac circuit where the rms current
is are given by respectively. Determine these values for the components of
the RLC circuit of Equation 15.12.

15.5 Resonance in an AC Circuit


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Determine the peak ac resonant angular frequency for a RLC circuit
• Explain the width of the average power versus angular frequency curve and its significance using terms like
bandwidth and quality factor

In the RLC series circuit of Figure 15.11, the current amplitude is, from Equation 15.10,

15.15

If we can vary the frequency of the ac generator while keeping the amplitude of its output voltage constant,
then the current changes accordingly. A plot of versus is shown in Figure 15.17.

Figure 15.17 At an RLC circuit’s resonant frequency, the current amplitude is at its maximum value.

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.5 • Resonance in an AC Circuit 661

In Oscillations, we encountered a similar graph where the amplitude of a damped harmonic oscillator was
plotted against the angular frequency of a sinusoidal driving force (see Forced Oscillations). This similarity is
more than just a coincidence, as shown earlier by the application of Kirchhoff’s loop rule to the circuit of
Figure 15.11. This yields

15.16

or

where we substituted dq(t)/dt for i(t). A comparison of Equation 15.16 and, from Oscillations, Damped
Oscillations for damped harmonic motion clearly demonstrates that the driven RLC series circuit is the
electrical analog of the driven damped harmonic oscillator.

The resonant frequency of the RLC circuit is the frequency at which the amplitude of the current is a
maximum and the circuit would oscillate if not driven by a voltage source. By inspection, this corresponds to
the angular frequency at which the impedance Z in Equation 15.15 is a minimum, or when

and

15.17

This is the resonant angular frequency of the circuit. Substituting into Equation 15.9, Equation 15.10, and
Equation 15.11, we find that at resonance,

     
Therefore, at resonance, an RLC circuit is purely resistive, with the applied emf and current in phase.

What happens to the power at resonance? Equation 15.14 tells us how the average power transferred from an
ac generator to the RLC combination varies with frequency. In addition, reaches a maximum when Z,
which depends on the frequency, is a minimum, that is, when Thus, at resonance, the
average power output of the source in an RLC series circuit is a maximum. From Equation 15.14, this
maximum is

Figure 15.18 is a typical plot of versus in the region of maximum power output. The bandwidth of
the resonance peak is defined as the range of angular frequencies over which the average power is
greater than one-half the maximum value of The sharpness of the peak is described by a dimensionless
quantity known as the quality factor Q of the circuit. By definition,

15.18

where is the resonant angular frequency. A high Q indicates a sharp resonance peak. We can give Q in
terms of the circuit parameters as

15.19
662 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.18 Like the current, the average power transferred from an ac generator to an RLC circuit peaks at the resonant frequency.

Resonant circuits are commonly used to pass or reject selected frequency ranges. This is done by adjusting the
value of one of the elements and hence “tuning” the circuit to a particular resonant frequency. For example, in
radios, the receiver is tuned to the desired station by adjusting the resonant frequency of its circuitry to match
the frequency of the station. If the tuning circuit has a high Q, it will have a small bandwidth, so signals from
other stations at frequencies even slightly different from the resonant frequency encounter a high impedance
and are not passed by the circuit. Cell phones work in a similar fashion, communicating with signals of around
1 GHz that are tuned by an inductor-capacitor circuit. One of the most common applications of capacitors is
their use in ac-timing circuits, based on attaining a resonant frequency. A metal detector also uses a shift in
resonance frequency in detecting metals (Figure 15.19).

Figure 15.19 When a metal detector comes near a piece of metal, the self-inductance of one of its coils changes. This causes a shift in the
resonant frequency of a circuit containing the coil. That shift is detected by the circuitry and transmitted to the diver by means of the
headphones. (credit: modification of work by Eric Lippmann, U.S. Navy)

EXAMPLE 15.4

Resonance in an RLC Series Circuit


(a) What is the resonant frequency of a circuit using the voltage and LRC values all wired in series from

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.5 • Resonance in an AC Circuit 663

Example 15.1? (b) If the ac generator is set to this frequency without changing the amplitude of the output
voltage, what is the amplitude of the current?

Strategy
The resonant frequency for a RLC circuit is calculated from Equation 15.17, which comes from a balance
between the reactances of the capacitor and the inductor. Since the circuit is at resonance, the impedance is
equal to the resistor. Then, the peak current is calculated by the voltage divided by the resistance.

Solution

a. The resonant frequency is found from Equation 15.17:

b. At resonance, the impedance of the circuit is purely resistive, and the current amplitude is

Significance
If the circuit were not set to the resonant frequency, we would need the impedance of the entire circuit to
calculate the current.

EXAMPLE 15.5

Power Transfer in an RLC Series Circuit at Resonance


(a) What is the resonant angular frequency of an RLC circuit with and
(b) If an ac source of constant amplitude 4.00 V is set to this frequency, what is the
average power transferred to the circuit? (c) Determine Q and the bandwidth of this circuit.

Strategy
The resonant angular frequency is calculated from Equation 15.17. The average power is calculated from the
rms voltage and the resistance in the circuit. The quality factor is calculated from Equation 15.19 and by
knowing the resonant frequency. The bandwidth is calculated from Equation 15.18 and by knowing the quality
factor.

Solution

a. The resonant angular frequency is

b. At this frequency, the average power transferred to the circuit is a maximum. It is

c. The quality factor of the circuit is


664 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

We then find for the bandwidth

Significance
If a narrower bandwidth is desired, a lower resistance or higher inductance would help. However, a lower
resistance increases the power transferred to the circuit, which may not be desirable, depending on the
maximum power that could possibly be transferred.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.6


In the circuit of Figure 15.11, and (a) What is the resonant
frequency? (b) What is the impedance of the circuit at resonance? (c) If the voltage amplitude is 10 V, what is
i(t) at resonance? (d) The frequency of the AC generator is now changed to 200 Hz. Calculate the phase
difference between the current and the emf of the generator.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.7


What happens to the resonant frequency of an RLC series circuit when the following quantities are increased
by a factor of 4: (a) the capacitance, (b) the self-inductance, and (c) the resistance?

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.8


The resonant angular frequency of an RLC series circuit is An ac source operating at this
frequency transfers an average power of to the circuit. The resistance of the circuit is
Write an expression for the emf of the source.

15.6 Transformers
Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain why power plants transmit electricity at high voltages and low currents and how they do this
• Develop relationships among current, voltage, and the number of windings in step-up and step-down
transformers

Although ac electric power is produced at relatively low voltages, it is sent through transmission lines at very
high voltages (as high as 500 kV). The same power can be transmitted at different voltages because power is
the product (For simplicity, we ignore the phase factor A particular power requirement can
therefore be met with a low voltage and a high current or with a high voltage and a low current. The advantage
of the high-voltage/low-current choice is that it results in lower ohmic losses in the transmission lines,
which can be significant in lines that are many kilometers long (Figure 15.20).

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.6 • Transformers 665

Figure 15.20 The rms voltage from a power plant eventually needs to be stepped down from 12 kV to 240 V so that it can be safely
introduced into a home. A high-voltage transmission line allows a low current to be transmitted via a substation over long distances.

Typically, the alternating emfs produced at power plants are “stepped up” to very high voltages before being
transmitted through power lines; then, they must be “stepped down” to relatively safe values (110 or 220 V
rms) before they are introduced into homes. The device that transforms voltages from one value to another
using induction is the transformer (Figure 15.21).

Figure 15.21 Transformers are used to step down the high voltages in transmission lines to the 110 to 220 V used in homes. (credit:
modification of work by “Fortyseven”/Flickr)

As Figure 15.22 illustrates, a transformer basically consists of two separated coils, or windings, wrapped
around a soft iron core. The primary winding has loops, or turns, and is connected to an alternating voltage
The secondary winding has turns and is connected to a load resistor We assume the ideal case
for which all magnetic field lines are confined to the core so that the same magnetic flux permeates each turn
of both the primary and the secondary windings. We also neglect energy losses to magnetic hysteresis, to
ohmic heating in the windings, and to ohmic heating of the induced eddy currents in the core. A good
transformer can have losses as low as 1% of the transmitted power, so this is not a bad assumption.
666 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

Figure 15.22 A step-up transformer (more turns in the secondary winding than in the primary winding). The two windings are wrapped
around a soft iron core.

To analyze the transformer circuit, we first consider the primary winding. The input voltage is equal to
the potential difference induced across the primary winding. From Faraday’s law, the induced potential
difference is where is the flux through one turn of the primary winding. Thus,

Similarly, the output voltage delivered to the load resistor must equal the potential difference induced
across the secondary winding. Since the transformer is ideal, the flux through every turn of the secondary
winding is also and

Combining the last two equations, we have

15.20

Hence, with appropriate values for the input voltage may be “stepped up” or
“stepped down” ( ) to the output voltage. This is often abbreviated as the transformer
equation,

15.21

which shows that the ratio of the secondary to primary voltages in a transformer equals the ratio of the
number of turns in their windings. For a step-up transformer, which increases voltage and decreases current,
this ratio is greater than one; for a step-down transformer, which decreases voltage and increases current,
this ratio is less than one.

From the law of energy conservation, the power introduced at any instant by to the primary winding
must be equal to the power dissipated in the resistor of the secondary circuit; thus,

When combined with Equation 15.20, this gives

15.22

Access for free at openstax.org.


15.6 • Transformers 667

If the voltage is stepped up, the current is stepped down, and vice versa.

Finally, we can use , along with Equation 15.20 and Equation 15.22, to obtain

which tells us that the input voltage “sees” not a resistance but rather a resistance

Our analysis has been based on instantaneous values of voltage and current. However, the resulting equations
are not limited to instantaneous values; they hold also for maximum and rms values.

EXAMPLE 15.6

A Step-Down Transformer
A transformer on a utility pole steps the rms voltage down from 12 kV to 240 V. (a) What is the ratio of the
number of secondary turns to the number of primary turns? (b) If the input current to the transformer is 2.0 A,
what is the output current? (c) Determine the power loss in the transmission line.

Strategy
The number of turns related to the voltages is found from Equation 15.20. The output current is calculated
using Equation 15.22.

Solution

a. Using Equation 15.20 with rms values and we have

so the primary winding has 50 times the number of turns in the secondary winding.
b. From Equation 15.22, the output rms current is found using the transformer equation with current

15.23

such that

c. The power loss in the transmission line is calculated to be

d. If there were no transformer, the power would have to be sent at 240 V to work for these houses, and the
power loss would be

Therefore, when power needs to be transmitted, we want to avoid power loss. Thus, lines are sent with
high voltages and low currents and adjusted with a transformer before power is sent into homes.

Significance
This application of a step-down transformer allows a home that uses 240-V outlets to have 100 A available to
draw upon. This can power many devices in the home.
668 15 • Alternating-Current Circuits

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 15.9


A transformer steps the line voltage down from 110 to 9.0 V so that a current of 0.50 A can be delivered to a
doorbell. (a) What is the ratio of the number of turns in the primary and secondary windings? (b) What is the
current in the primary winding? (c) What is the resistance seen by the 110-V source?

Access for free at openstax.org.


15 • Chapter Review 669

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
ac current current that fluctuates sinusoidally with power factor amount by which the power
time at a fixed frequency delivered in the circuit is less than the theoretical
ac voltage voltage that fluctuates sinusoidally with maximum of the circuit due to voltage and
time at a fixed frequency current being out of phase
alternating current (ac) flow of electric charge quality factor dimensionless quantity that
that periodically reverses direction describes the sharpness of the peak of the
average power time average of the instantaneous bandwidth; a high quality factor is a sharp or
power over one cycle narrow resonance peak
bandwidth range of angular frequencies over resonant frequency frequency at which the
which the average power is greater than one-half amplitude of the current is a maximum and the
the maximum value of the average power circuit would oscillate if not driven by a voltage
capacitive reactance opposition of a capacitor to a source
change in current rms current root mean square of the current
direct current (dc) flow of electric charge in only rms voltage root mean square of the voltage
one direction step-down transformer transformer that
impedance ac analog to resistance in a dc circuit, decreases voltage and increases current
which measures the combined effect of step-up transformer transformer that increases
resistance, capacitive reactance, and inductive voltage and decreases current
reactance transformer device that transforms voltages from
inductive reactance opposition of an inductor to a one value to another using induction
change in current transformer equation equation showing that the
phase angle amount by which the voltage and ratio of the secondary to primary voltages in a
current are out of phase with each other in a transformer equals the ratio of the number of
circuit turns in their windings

Key Equations
AC voltage

AC current

capacitive reactance

rms voltage

rms current

inductive reactance

Phase angle of an RLC series circuit

AC version of Ohm’s law

Impedance of an RLC series circuit


670 15 • Chapter Review

Average power associated with a circuit element

Average power dissipated by a resistor

Resonant angular frequency of a circuit

Quality factor of a circuit

Quality factor of a circuit in terms of the circuit parameters

Transformer equation with voltage

Transformer equation with current

Summary
15.1 AC Sources ohms, varies with the frequency of the ac
source.
• Direct current (dc) refers to systems in which
the source voltage is constant. 15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC
• Alternating current (ac) refers to systems in
• An RLC series circuit is a resistor, capacitor, and
which the source voltage varies periodically,
inductor series combination across an ac
particularly sinusoidally.
source.
• The voltage source of an ac system puts out a
• The same current flows through each element of
voltage that is calculated from the time, the peak
an RLC series circuit at all points in time.
voltage, and the angular frequency.
• The counterpart of resistance in a dc circuit is
• In a simple circuit, the current is found by
impedance, which measures the combined
dividing the voltage by the resistance. An ac
effect of resistors, capacitors, and inductors.
current is calculated using the peak current
The maximum current is defined by the ac
(determined by dividing the peak voltage by the
version of Ohm’s law.
resistance), the angular frequency, and the time.
• Impedance has units of ohms and is found using
15.2 Simple AC Circuits the resistance, the capacitive reactance, and the
inductive reactance.
• For resistors, the current through and the
voltage across are in phase. 15.4 Power in an AC Circuit
• For capacitors, we find that when a sinusoidal
• The average ac power is found by multiplying
voltage is applied to a capacitor, the voltage
the rms values of current and voltage.
follows the current by one-fourth of a cycle.
• Ohm’s law for the rms ac is found by dividing the
Since a capacitor can stop current when fully
rms voltage by the impedance.
charged, it limits current and offers another
• In an ac circuit, there is a phase angle between
form of ac resistance, called capacitive
the source voltage and the current, which can be
reactance, which has units of ohms.
found by dividing the resistance by the
• For inductors in ac circuits, we find that when a
impedance.
sinusoidal voltage is applied to an inductor, the
• The average power delivered to an RLC circuit is
voltage leads the current by one-fourth of a
affected by the phase angle.
cycle.
• The power factor ranges from –1 to 1.
• The opposition of an inductor to a change in
current is expressed as a type of ac reactance.
This inductive reactance, which has units of

Access for free at openstax.org.


15 • Chapter Review 671

15.5 Resonance in an AC Circuit many kilometers of transmission lines.


• Transformers use induction to transform
• At the resonant frequency, inductive reactance
voltages from one value to another.
equals capacitive reactance.
• For a transformer, the voltages across the
• The average power versus angular frequency
primary and secondary coils, or windings, are
plot for a RLC circuit has a peak located at the
related by the transformer equation.
resonant frequency; the sharpness or width of
• The currents in the primary and secondary
the peak is known as the bandwidth.
windings are related by the number of primary
• The bandwidth is related to a dimensionless
and secondary loops, or turns, in the windings
quantity called the quality factor. A high quality
of the transformer.
factor value is a sharp or narrow peak.
• A step-up transformer increases voltage and
15.6 Transformers decreases current, whereas a step-down
transformer decreases voltage and increases
• Power plants transmit high voltages at low current.
currents to achieve lower ohmic losses in their

Conceptual Questions
15.1 AC Sources 7. Can the instantaneous power output of an ac
source ever be negative? Can the average power
1. What is the relationship between frequency and
output be negative?
angular frequency?
8. The power rating of a resistor used in ac circuits
refers to the maximum average power dissipated
15.2 Simple AC Circuits in the resistor. How does this compare with the
2. Explain why at high frequencies a capacitor acts maximum instantaneous power dissipated in the
as an ac short, whereas an inductor acts as an resistor?
open circuit.
15.6 Transformers
15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC 9. Why do transmission lines operate at very high
3. In an RLC series circuit, can the voltage voltages while household circuits operate at fairly
measured across the capacitor be greater than small voltages?
the voltage of the source? Answer the same 10. How can you distinguish the primary winding
question for the voltage across the inductor. from the secondary winding in a step-up
transformer?
15.4 Power in an AC Circuit 11. Battery packs in some electronic devices are
charged using an adapter connected to a wall
4. For what value of the phase angle between the socket. Speculate as to the purpose of the
voltage output of an ac source and the current is adapter.
the average power output of the source a 12. Will a transformer work if the input is a dc
maximum? voltage?
5. Discuss the differences between average power 13. Why are the primary and secondary coils of a
and instantaneous power. transformer wrapped around the same closed
6. The average ac current delivered to a circuit is loop of iron?
zero. Despite this, power is dissipated in the
circuit. Explain.

Problems
15.1 AC Sources 15.2 Simple AC Circuits
14. Write an expression for the output voltage of an 15. Calculate the reactance of a capacitor at
ac source that has an amplitude of 12 V and a (a) 60 Hz, (b) 600 Hz, and (c) 6000 Hz.
frequency of 200 Hz. 16. What is the capacitance of a capacitor whose
reactance is at 60 Hz?
17. Calculate the reactance of a 5.0-mH inductor at
672 15 • Chapter Review

(a) 60 Hz, (b) 600 Hz, and (c) 6000 Hz. calculations with C changed to
18. What is the self-inductance of a coil whose 28. An RLC series circuit with ,
reactance is at 60 Hz? and is driven by an ac
19. At what frequency is the reactance of a source whose frequency and voltage amplitude
capacitor equal to that of a 10-mH inductor? are 500 Hz and 50 V, respectively. (a) What is
20. At 1000 Hz, the reactance of a 5.0-mH inductor the impedance of the circuit? (b) What is the
is equal to the reactance of a particular amplitude of the current in the circuit? (c) What
capacitor. What is the capacitance of the is the phase angle between the emf of the
capacitor? source and the current?
21. A resistor is connected across the emf 29. For the circuit shown below, what are (a) the
. Write an expression total impedance and (b) the phase angle
for the current through the resistor. between the current and the emf? (c) Write an
22. A capacitor is connected to an emf given expression for
by . (a) What is the
reactance of the capacitor? (b) Write an
expression for the current output of the source.
23. A 100-mH inductor is connected across the emf
of the preceding problem. (a) What is the
reactance of the inductor? (b) Write an
expression for the current through the inductor.

15.3 RLC Series Circuits with AC


24. What is the impedance of a series combination
of a resistor, a capacitor, and a
capacitor at a frequency of 2.0 kHz?
25. A resistor and capacitor are connected in series
15.4 Power in an AC Circuit
across an ac generator. The emf of the generator
is given by where 30. The emf of an ac source is given by
, and . (a) where and
What is the impedance of the circuit? (b) What Calculate the average power
is the amplitude of the current through the output of the source if it is connected across (a)
resistor? (c) Write an expression for the current a capacitor, (b) a 20-mH inductor, and (c)
through the resistor. (d) Write expressions a resistor.
representing the voltages across the resistor 31. Calculate the rms currents for an ac source is
and across the capacitor. given by where
26. A resistor and inductor are connected in series and when connected across (a) a
across an ac generator. The emf of the generator capacitor, (b) a 20-mH inductor, and (c) a
is given by where resistor.
and also, and 32. A 40-mH inductor is connected to a 60-Hz AC
(a) What is the impedance of the source whose voltage amplitude is 50 V. If an AC
circuit? (b) What is the amplitude of the current voltmeter is placed across the inductor, what
through the resistor? (c) Write an expression for does it read?
the current through the resistor. (d) Write 33. For an RLC series circuit, the voltage amplitude
expressions representing the voltages across and frequency of the source are 100 V and 500
the resistor and across the inductor. Hz, respectively; ; and .
27. In an RLC series circuit, the voltage amplitude Find the average power dissipated in the
and frequency of the source are 100 V and 500 resistor for the following values for the
Hz, respectively, an capacitance: (a) and (b)
and (a) What is the impedance of the 34. An ac source of voltage amplitude 10 V delivers
circuit? (b) What is the amplitude of the current electric energy at a rate of 0.80 W when its
from the source? (c) If the emf of the source is current output is 2.5 A. What is the phase angle
given by , how does between the emf and the current?
the current vary with time? (d) Repeat the 35. An RLC series circuit has an impedance of

Access for free at openstax.org.


15 • Chapter Review 673

and a power factor of 0.50, with the voltage


lagging the current. (a) Should a capacitor or an
inductor be placed in series with the elements
to raise the power factor of the circuit? (b) What
is the value of the reactance across the inductor
that will raise the power factor to unity?

15.5 Resonance in an AC Circuit


36. (a) Calculate the resonant angular frequency of
an RLC series circuit for which ,
15.6 Transformers
, and (b) If R is changed
to what happens to the resonant angular 44. A step-up transformer is designed so that the
frequency? output of its secondary winding is 2000 V (rms)
37. The resonant frequency of an RLC series circuit when the primary winding is connected to a
is If the self-inductance in the 110-V (rms) line voltage. (a) If there are 100
circuit is 5.0 mH, what is the capacitance in the turns in the primary winding, how many turns
circuit? are there in the secondary winding? (b) If a
38. (a) What is the resonant frequency of an RLC resistor connected across the secondary
series circuit with , , and winding draws an rms current of 0.75 A, what is
? (b) What is the impedance of the the current in the primary winding?
circuit at resonance? 45. A step-up transformer connected to a 110-V
39. For an RLC series circuit, , line is used to supply a hydrogen-gas discharge
, and (a) If an ac tube with 5.0 kV (rms). The tube dissipates 75 W
source of variable frequency is connected to the of power. (a) What is the ratio of the number of
circuit, at what frequency is maximum power turns in the secondary winding to the number
dissipated in the resistor? (b) What is the quality of turns in the primary winding? (b) What are
factor of the circuit? the rms currents in the primary and secondary
40. An ac source of voltage amplitude 100 V and windings? (c) What is the effective resistance
variable frequency f drives an RLC series circuit seen by the 110-V source?
with , , and (a) 46. An ac source of emf delivers 5.0 mW of power at
Plot the current through the resistor as a an rms current of 2.0 mA when it is connected
function of the frequency f. (b) Use the plot to to the primary coil of a transformer. The rms
determine the resonant frequency of the circuit. voltage across the secondary coil is 20 V. (a)
41. (a) What is the resonant frequency of a resistor, What are the voltage across the primary coil and
capacitor, and inductor connected in series if the current through the secondary coil? (b)
, and ? (b) If What is the ratio of secondary to primary turns
this combination is connected to a 100-V source for the transformer?
operating at the resonant frequency, what is the 47. A transformer is used to step down 110 V from a
power output of the source? (c) What is the Q of wall socket to 9.0 V for a radio. (a) If the primary
the circuit? (d) What is the bandwidth of the winding has 500 turns, how many turns does
circuit? the secondary winding have? (b) If the radio
42. Suppose a coil has a self-inductance of 20.0 H operates at a current of 500 mA, what is the
and a resistance of . What (a) capacitance current through the primary winding?
and (b) resistance must be connected in series 48. A transformer is used to supply a 12-V model
with the coil to produce a circuit that has a train with power from a 110-V wall plug. The
resonant frequency of 100 Hz and a Q of 10? train operates at 50 W of power. (a) What is the
43. An ac generator is connected to a device whose rms current in the secondary coil of the
internal circuits are not known. We only know transformer? (b) What is the rms current in the
current and voltage outside the device, as primary coil? (c) What is the ratio of the number
shown below. Based on the information given, of primary to secondary turns? (d) What is the
what can you infer about the electrical nature of resistance of the train? (e) What is the
the device and its power usage? resistance seen by the 110-V source?
674 15 • Chapter Review

Additional Problems
49. The emf of an ac source is given by 55. What is the resistance R in the circuit shown
where and below if the amplitude of the ac through the
Find an expression that inductor is 4.24 A?
represents the output current of the source if it
is connected across (a) a capacitor, (b) a
20-mH inductor, and (c) a resistor.
50. A 700-pF capacitor is connected across an ac
source with a voltage amplitude of 160 V and a
frequency of 20 kHz. (a) Determine the
capacitive reactance of the capacitor and the
amplitude of the output current of the source.
(b) If the frequency is changed to 60 Hz while
keeping the voltage amplitude at 160 V, what
are the capacitive reactance and the current
amplitude?
51. A 20-mH inductor is connected across an AC
source with a variable frequency and a
constant-voltage amplitude of 9.0 V. (a)
Determine the reactance of the circuit and the
maximum current through the inductor when
the frequency is set at 20 kHz. (b) Do the same
calculations for a frequency of 60 Hz.
52. A capacitor is connected across a 60-Hz
ac source whose voltage amplitude is 50 V. (a)
What is the maximum charge on the capacitor? 56. An ac source of voltage amplitude 100 V and
(b) What is the maximum current into the frequency 1.0 kHz drives an RLC series circuit
capacitor? (c) What is the phase relationship with , , and . (a)
between the capacitor charge and the current in Determine the rms current through the circuit.
the circuit? (b) What are the rms voltages across the three
53. A 7.0-mH inductor is connected across a 60-Hz elements? (c) What is the phase angle between
ac source whose voltage amplitude is 50 V. (a) the emf and the current? (d) What is the power
What is the maximum current through the output of the source? (e) What is the power
inductor? (b) What is the phase relationship dissipated in the resistor?
between the current through and the potential 57. In an RLC series circuit, , ,
difference across the inductor? , and . What is
54. What is the impedance of an RLC series circuit the power output of the source?
at the resonant frequency? 58. A power plant generator produces 100 A at 15
kV (rms). A transformer is used to step up the
transmission line voltage to 150 kV (rms). (a)
What is rms current in the transmission line?
(b) If the resistance per unit length of the line is
what is the power loss per
meter in the line? (c) What would the power loss
per meter be if the line voltage were 15 kV
(rms)?
59. Consider a power plant located 25 km outside a
town delivering 50 MW of power to the town.
The transmission lines are made of aluminum
cables with a cross-sectional area. Find
the loss of power in the transmission lines if it is
transmitted at (a) 200 kV (rms) and (b) 120 V
(rms).

Access for free at openstax.org.


15 • Chapter Review 675

60. Neon signs require 12-kV for their operation. A


transformer is to be used to change the voltage
from 220-V (rms) ac to 12-kV (rms) ac. What
must the ratio be of turns in the secondary
winding to the turns in the primary winding? (b)
What is the maximum rms current the neon
lamps can draw if the fuse in the primary
winding goes off at 0.5 A? (c) How much power
is used by the neon sign when it is drawing the
maximum current allowed by the fuse in the
primary winding?

Challenge Problems
61. The 335-kV ac electricity from a power 64. A resistor, capacitor, and 2.5-H
transmission line is fed into the primary inductor are connected in series with an ac
winding of a transformer. The ratio of the source of amplitude 10 V and variable angular
number of turns in the secondary winding to frequency . (a) What is the value of the
the number in the primary winding is resonance frequency ? (b) What is the
. (a) What voltage is induced in amplitude of the current if ? (c) What is
the secondary winding? (b) What is the phase constant of the current when
unreasonable about this result? (c) Which ? Is it leading or lagging the source
assumption or premise is responsible? voltage, or is it in phase? (d) Write an equation
62. A resistor and 30-mH inductor are for the voltage drop across the resistor as a
connected in series, as shown below, across a function of time when . (e) What is the
120-V (rms) ac power source oscillating at power factor of the circuit when ? (f)
60-Hz frequency. (a) Find the current in the How much energy is used up by the resistor in
circuit. (b) Find the voltage drops across the 2.5 s when ?
resistor and inductor. (c) Find the impedance of 65. Find the reactances of the following capacitors
the circuit. (d) Find the power dissipated in the and inductors in ac circuits with the given
resistor. (e) Find the power dissipated in the frequencies in each case: (a) 2-mH inductor
inductor. (f) Find the power produced by the with a frequency 60-Hz of the ac circuit; (b)
source. 2-mH inductor with a frequency 600-Hz of the
ac circuit; (c) 20-mH inductor with a frequency
6-Hz of the ac circuit; (d) 20-mH inductor with a
frequency 60-Hz of the ac circuit; (e) 2-mF
capacitor with a frequency 60-Hz of the ac
circuit; and (f) 2-mF capacitor with a frequency
600-Hz of the AC circuit.

63. A resistor, capacitor, and 30-mH


inductor are connected in series with an ac
source of amplitude 10 V and frequency 125 Hz.
(a) What is the impedance of the circuit? (b)
What is the amplitude of the current in the
circuit? (c) What is the phase constant of the
current? Is it leading or lagging the source
voltage? (d) Write voltage drops across the
resistor, capacitor, and inductor and the source
voltage as a function of time. (e) What is the
power factor of the circuit? (f) How much
energy is used by the resistor in 2.5 s?
676 15 • Chapter Review

66. An output impedance of an audio amplifier has an 71. Shown below are two circuits that act as crude
impedance of and has a mismatch with a low- high-pass filters. The input voltage to the
impedance loudspeaker. You are asked to insert circuits is , and the output voltage is (a)
an appropriate transformer to match the Show that for the capacitor circuit,
impedances. What turns ratio will you use, and why?
Use the simplified circuit shown below.
and for the inductor circuit,

(b) Show that for high frequencies,


but for low frequencies,

67. Show that the SI unit for capacitive reactance is


the ohm. Show that the SI unit for inductive
reactance is also the ohm.
68. A coil with a self-inductance of 16 mH and a
resistance of is connected to an ac source
whose frequency can be varied. At what
frequency will the voltage across the coil lead
the current through the coil by
69. An RLC series circuit consists of a resistor,
a capacitor, and a 120-mH inductor
whose coil has a resistance of . The source
for the circuit has an rms emf of 240 V at a
frequency of 60 Hz. Calculate the rms voltages
across the (a) resistor, (b) capacitor, and (c)
inductor.
70. An RLC series circuit consists of a resistor,
an capacitor, and a 50-mH inductor. A
110-V (rms) source of variable frequency is
connected across the combination. What is the
power output of the source when its frequency
is set to one-half the resonant frequency of the
circuit?

Access for free at openstax.org.


15 • Chapter Review 677

72. The two circuits shown below act as crude low-


pass filters. The input voltage to the circuits is
, and the output voltage is (a) Show that
for the capacitor circuit,

and for the inductor circuit,

(b) Show that for low frequencies,


but for high frequencies,
678 15 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


CHAPTER 16
Electromagnetic Waves

Figure 16.1 The pressure from sunlight predicted by Maxwell’s equations helped produce the tail of Comet
McNaught. (credit: modification of work by Sebastian Deiries—ESO)

Chapter Outline

16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves

16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves

16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic Waves

16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure

16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum

INTRODUCTION Our view of objects in the sky at night, the warm radiance of sunshine, the sting of sunburn,
our cell phone conversations, and the X-rays revealing a broken bone—all are brought to us by electromagnetic
waves. It would be hard to overstate the practical importance of electromagnetic waves, through their role in
vision, through countless technological applications, and through their ability to transport the energy from the
Sun through space to sustain life and almost all of its activities on Earth.

Theory predicted the general phenomenon of electromagnetic waves before anyone realized that light is a
form of an electromagnetic wave. In the mid-nineteenth century, James Clerk Maxwell formulated a single
theory combining all the electric and magnetic effects known at that time. Maxwell’s equations, summarizing
this theory, predicted the existence of electromagnetic waves that travel at the speed of light. His theory also
predicted how these waves behave, and how they carry both energy and momentum. The tails of comets, such
680 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

as Comet McNaught in Figure 16.1, provide a spectacular example. Energy carried by light from the Sun
warms the comet to release dust and gas. The momentum carried by the light exerts a weak force that shapes
the dust into a tail of the kind seen here. The flux of particles emitted by the Sun, called the solar wind,
typically produces an additional, second tail, as described in detail in this chapter.

In this chapter, we explain Maxwell’s theory and show how it leads to his prediction of electromagnetic waves.
We use his theory to examine what electromagnetic waves are, how they are produced, and how they transport
energy and momentum. We conclude by summarizing some of the many practical applications of
electromagnetic waves.

16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain Maxwell’s correction of Ampère’s law by including the displacement current
• State and apply Maxwell’s equations in integral form
• Describe how the symmetry between changing electric and changing magnetic fields explains Maxwell’s
prediction of electromagnetic waves
• Describe how Hertz confirmed Maxwell’s prediction of electromagnetic waves

James Clerk Maxwell (1831–1879) was one of the major contributors to physics in the nineteenth century
(Figure 16.2). Although he died young, he made major contributions to the development of the kinetic theory of
gases, to the understanding of color vision, and to the nature of Saturn’s rings. He is probably best known for
having combined existing knowledge of the laws of electricity and of magnetism with insights of his own into a
complete overarching electromagnetic theory, represented by Maxwell’s equations.

Figure 16.2 James Clerk Maxwell, a nineteenth-century physicist, developed a theory that explained the relationship between electricity
and magnetism, and correctly predicted that visible light consists of electromagnetic waves.

Maxwell’s Correction to the Laws of Electricity and Magnetism


The four basic laws of electricity and magnetism had been discovered experimentally through the work of
physicists such as Oersted, Coulomb, Gauss, and Faraday. Maxwell discovered logical inconsistencies in these
earlier results and identified the incompleteness of Ampère’s law as their cause.

Recall that according to Ampère’s law, the integral of the magnetic field around a closed loop C is proportional
to the current I passing through any surface whose boundary is loop C itself:

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.1 • Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves 681

16.1

There are infinitely many surfaces that can be attached to any loop, and Ampère’s law stated in Equation 16.1
is independent of the choice of surface.

Consider the set-up in Figure 16.3. A source of emf is abruptly connected across a parallel-plate capacitor so
that a time-dependent current I develops in the wire. Suppose we apply Ampère’s law to loop C shown at a time
before the capacitor is fully charged, so that . Surface gives a nonzero value for the enclosed current I,
whereas surface gives zero for the enclosed current because no current passes through it:

Clearly, Ampère’s law in its usual form does not work here. This is an internal contradiction in the theory
which requires a modification to the theory, Ampère’s law, itself.

Figure 16.3 The currents through surface and surface are unequal, despite having the same boundary loop C.

How can Ampère’s law be modified so that it works in all situations? Maxwell suggested including an additional
contribution, called the displacement current , to the real current I,

16.2

where the displacement current is defined to be

16.3

Here is the permittivity of free space and is the electric flux, defined as

The displacement current is analogous to a real current in Ampère’s law, entering into Ampère’s law in the
same way. It is produced, however, by a changing electric field. It accounts for a changing electric field
producing a magnetic field, just as a real current does, but the displacement current can produce a magnetic
field even where no real current is present. When this extra term is included, the modified Ampère’s law
equation becomes
682 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

16.4

and is independent of the surface S through which the current I is measured.

We can now examine this modified version of Ampère’s law to confirm that it holds independent of whether the
surface or the surface in Figure 16.3 is chosen. The electric field corresponding to the flux in
Equation 16.3 is between the capacitor plates. Therefore, the field and the displacement current through the
surface are both zero, and Equation 16.2 takes the form

16.5

We must now show that for surface through which no actual current flows, the displacement current leads
to the same value for the right side of the Ampère’s law equation. For surface the equation becomes

16.6

Gauss’s law for electric charge requires a closed surface and cannot ordinarily be applied to a surface like
alone or alone. But the two surfaces and form a closed surface in Figure 16.3 and can be used in
Gauss’s law. Because the electric field is zero on , the flux contribution through is zero. This gives us

Therefore, we can replace the integral over in Equation 16.6 with the closed Gaussian surface and
apply Gauss’s law to obtain

16.7

Thus, the modified Ampère’s law equation is the same using surface where the right-hand side results
from the displacement current, as it is for the surface where the contribution comes from the actual flow of
electric charge.

EXAMPLE 16.1

Displacement current in a charging capacitor


A parallel-plate capacitor with capacitance C whose plates have area A and separation distance d is connected
to a resistor R and a battery of voltage V. The current starts to flow at . (a) Find the displacement current
between the capacitor plates at time t. (b) From the properties of the capacitor, find the corresponding real
current , and compare the answer to the expected current in the wires of the corresponding RC circuit.

Strategy
We can use the equations from the analysis of an RC circuit (Alternating-Current Circuits) plus Maxwell’s
version of Ampère’s law.

Solution

a. The voltage between the plates at time t is given by

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.1 • Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves 683

Let the z-axis point from the positive plate to the negative plate. Then the z-component of the electric field
between the plates as a function of time t is

Therefore, the z-component of the displacement current between the plates is

where we have used for the capacitance.


b. From the expression for the charge on the capacitor is

The current into the capacitor after the circuit is closed, is therefore

This current is the same as found in (a).

Maxwell’s Equations
With the correction for the displacement current, Maxwell’s equations take the form

16.8

16.9

16.10

16.11

Once the fields have been calculated using these four equations, the Lorentz force equation

16.12

gives the force that the fields exert on a particle with charge q moving with velocity . The Lorentz force
equation combines the force of the electric field and of the magnetic field on the moving charge. The magnetic
and electric forces have been examined in earlier modules. These four Maxwell’s equations are, respectively,

Maxwell’s Equations
1. Gauss’s law

The electric flux through any closed surface is equal to the electric charge enclosed by the surface.
Gauss’s law [Equation 16.7] describes the relation between an electric charge and the electric field it
produces. This is often pictured in terms of electric field lines originating from positive charges and
terminating on negative charges, and indicating the direction of the electric field at each point in space.

2. Gauss’s law for magnetism

The magnetic field flux through any closed surface is zero [Equation 16.8]. This is equivalent to the
statement that magnetic field lines are continuous, having no beginning or end. Any magnetic field line
entering the region enclosed by the surface must also leave it. No magnetic monopoles, where magnetic
684 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

field lines would terminate, are known to exist (see Magnetic Fields and Lines).

3. Faraday’s law

A changing magnetic field induces an electromotive force (emf) and, hence, an electric field. The direction
of the emf opposes the change. This third of Maxwell’s equations, Equation 16.9, is Faraday’s law of
induction and includes Lenz’s law. The electric field from a changing magnetic field has field lines that
form closed loops, without any beginning or end.

4. Ampère-Maxwell law

Magnetic fields are generated by moving charges or by changing electric fields. This fourth of Maxwell’s
equations, Equation 16.10, encompasses Ampère’s law and adds another source of magnetic fields, namely
changing electric fields.

Maxwell’s equations and the Lorentz force law together encompass all the laws of electricity and magnetism.
The symmetry that Maxwell introduced into his mathematical framework may not be immediately apparent.
Faraday’s law describes how changing magnetic fields produce electric fields. The displacement current
introduced by Maxwell results instead from a changing electric field and accounts for a changing electric field
producing a magnetic field. The equations for the effects of both changing electric fields and changing
magnetic fields differ in form only where the absence of magnetic monopoles leads to missing terms. This
symmetry between the effects of changing magnetic and electric fields is essential in explaining the nature of
electromagnetic waves.

Later application of Einstein’s theory of relativity to Maxwell’s complete and symmetric theory showed that
electric and magnetic forces are not separate but are different manifestations of the same thing—the
electromagnetic force. The electromagnetic force and weak nuclear force are similarly unified as the
electroweak force. This unification of forces has been one motivation for attempts to unify all of the four basic
forces in nature—the gravitational, electrical, strong, and weak nuclear forces (see Particle Physics and
Cosmology).

The Mechanism of Electromagnetic Wave Propagation


To see how the symmetry introduced by Maxwell accounts for the existence of combined electric and magnetic
waves that propagate through space, imagine a time-varying magnetic field produced by the high-
frequency alternating current seen in Figure 16.4. We represent in the diagram by one of its field lines.
From Faraday’s law, the changing magnetic field through a surface induces a time-varying electric field
at the boundary of that surface. The displacement current source for the electric field, like the Faraday’s law
source for the magnetic field, produces only closed loops of field lines, because of the mathematical symmetry
involved in the equations for the induced electric and induced magnetic fields. A field line representation of
is shown. In turn, the changing electric field creates a magnetic field according to the
modified Ampère’s law. This changing field induces which induces and so on. We then have a
self-continuing process that leads to the creation of time-varying electric and magnetic fields in regions
farther and farther away from O. This process may be visualized as the propagation of an electromagnetic
wave through space.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.1 • Maxwell’s Equations and Electromagnetic Waves 685

Figure 16.4 How changing and fields propagate through space.

In the next section, we show in more precise mathematical terms how Maxwell’s equations lead to the
prediction of electromagnetic waves that can travel through space without a material medium, implying a
speed of electromagnetic waves equal to the speed of light.

Prior to Maxwell’s work, experiments had already indicated that light was a wave phenomenon, although the
nature of the waves was yet unknown. In 1801, Thomas Young (1773–1829) showed that when a light beam
was separated by two narrow slits and then recombined, a pattern made up of bright and dark fringes was
formed on a screen. Young explained this behavior by assuming that light was composed of waves that added
constructively at some points and destructively at others (see Interference). Subsequently, Jean Foucault
(1819–1868), with measurements of the speed of light in various media, and Augustin Fresnel (1788–1827),
with detailed experiments involving interference and diffraction of light, provided further conclusive evidence
that light was a wave. So, light was known to be a wave, and Maxwell had predicted the existence of
electromagnetic waves that traveled at the speed of light. The conclusion seemed inescapable: Light must be a
form of electromagnetic radiation. But Maxwell’s theory showed that other wavelengths and frequencies than
those of light were possible for electromagnetic waves. He showed that electromagnetic radiation with the
same fundamental properties as visible light should exist at any frequency. It remained for others to test, and
confirm, this prediction.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.1


When the emf across a capacitor is turned on and the capacitor is allowed to charge, when does the magnetic
field induced by the displacement current have the greatest magnitude?

Hertz’s Observations
The German physicist Heinrich Hertz (1857–1894) was the first to generate and detect certain types of
electromagnetic waves in the laboratory. Starting in 1887, he performed a series of experiments that not only
confirmed the existence of electromagnetic waves but also verified that they travel at the speed of light.

Hertz used an alternating-current RLC (resistor-inductor-capacitor) circuit that resonates at a known


frequency and connected it to a loop of wire, as shown in Figure 16.5. High voltages induced

across the gap in the loop produced sparks that were visible evidence of the current in the circuit and helped
generate electromagnetic waves.

Across the laboratory, Hertz placed another loop attached to another RLC circuit, which could be tuned (as the
dial on a radio) to the same resonant frequency as the first and could thus be made to receive electromagnetic
waves. This loop also had a gap across which sparks were generated, giving solid evidence that
electromagnetic waves had been received.
686 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Figure 16.5 The apparatus used by Hertz in 1887 to generate and detect electromagnetic waves.

Hertz also studied the reflection, refraction, and interference patterns of the electromagnetic waves he
generated, confirming their wave character. He was able to determine the wavelengths from the interference
patterns, and knowing their frequencies, he could calculate the propagation speed using the equation ,
where v is the speed of a wave, f is its frequency, and is its wavelength. Hertz was thus able to prove that
electromagnetic waves travel at the speed of light. The SI unit for frequency, the hertz ( ), is
named in his honor.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.2


Could a purely electric field propagate as a wave through a vacuum without a magnetic field? Justify your
answer.

16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe how Maxwell’s equations predict the relative directions of the electric fields and magnetic fields,
and the direction of propagation of plane electromagnetic waves
• Explain how Maxwell’s equations predict that the speed of propagation of electromagnetic waves in free
space is exactly the speed of light
• Calculate the relative magnitude of the electric and magnetic fields in an electromagnetic plane wave
• Describe how electromagnetic waves are produced and detected

Mechanical waves travel through a medium such as a string, water, or air. Perhaps the most significant
prediction of Maxwell’s equations is the existence of combined electric and magnetic (or electromagnetic)
fields that propagate through space as electromagnetic waves. Because Maxwell’s equations hold in free space,
the predicted electromagnetic waves, unlike mechanical waves, do not require a medium for their
propagation.

A general treatment of the physics of electromagnetic waves is beyond the scope of this textbook. We can,
however, investigate the special case of an electromagnetic wave that propagates through free space along the
x-axis of a given coordinate system.

Electromagnetic Waves in One Direction


An electromagnetic wave consists of an electric field, defined as usual in terms of the force per charge on a
stationary charge, and a magnetic field, defined in terms of the force per charge on a moving charge. The
electromagnetic field is assumed to be a function of only the x-coordinate and time. The y-component of the
electric field is then written as the z-component of the magnetic field as , etc. Because we are
assuming free space, there are no free charges or currents, so we can set and in Maxwell’s
equations.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.2 • Plane Electromagnetic Waves 687

The transverse nature of electromagnetic waves


We examine first what Gauss’s law for electric fields implies about the relative directions of the electric field
and the propagation direction in an electromagnetic wave. Assume the Gaussian surface to be the surface of a
rectangular box whose cross-section is a square of side l and whose third side has length , as shown in
Figure 16.6. Because the electric field is a function only of x and t, the y-component of the electric field is the
same on both the top (labeled Side 2) and bottom (labeled Side 1) of the box, so that these two contributions to
the flux cancel. The corresponding argument also holds for the net flux from the z-component of the electric
field through Sides 3 and 4. Any net flux through the surface therefore comes entirely from the x-component of
the electric field. Because the electric field has no y- or z-dependence, is constant over the face of the
box with area A and has a possibly different value that is constant over the opposite face of the
box. Applying Gauss’s law gives

16.13

where is the area of the front and back faces of the rectangular surface. But the charge enclosed is
, so this component’s net flux is also zero, and Equation 16.13 implies for
any . Therefore, if there is an x-component of the electric field, it cannot vary with x. A uniform field of that
kind would merely be superposed artificially on the traveling wave, for example, by having a pair of parallel-
charged plates. Such a component would not be part of an electromagnetic wave propagating along
the x-axis; so for this wave. Therefore, the only nonzero components of the electric field are
and perpendicular to the direction of propagation of the wave.

Figure 16.6 The surface of a rectangular box of dimensions is our Gaussian surface. The electric field shown is from an
electromagnetic wave propagating along the x-axis.

A similar argument holds by substituting E for B and using Gauss’s law for magnetism instead of Gauss’s law
for electric fields. This shows that the B field is also perpendicular to the direction of propagation of the wave.
The electromagnetic wave is therefore a transverse wave, with its oscillating electric and magnetic fields
perpendicular to its direction of propagation.

The speed of propagation of electromagnetic waves


We can next apply Maxwell’s equations to the description given in connection with Figure 16.4 in the previous
section to obtain an equation for the E field from the changing B field, and for the B field from a changing E
field. We then combine the two equations to show how the changing E and B fields propagate through space at
688 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

a speed precisely equal to the speed of light.

First, we apply Faraday’s law over Side 3 of the Gaussian surface, using the path shown in Figure 16.7. Because
we have

Assuming is small and approximating by

we obtain

Figure 16.7 We apply Faraday’s law to the front of the rectangle by evaluating along the rectangular edge of Side 3 in the

direction indicated, taking the B field crossing the face to be approximately its value in the middle of the area traversed.

Because is small, the magnetic flux through the face can be approximated by its value in the center of the
area traversed, namely . The flux of the B field through Face 3 is then the B field times the area,

16.14

From Faraday’s law,

16.15

Therefore, from Equation 16.13 and Equation 16.14,

Canceling and taking the limit as , we are left with

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.2 • Plane Electromagnetic Waves 689

16.16

We could have applied Faraday’s law instead to the top surface (numbered 2) in Figure 16.7, to obtain the
resulting equation

16.17

This is the equation describing the spatially dependent E field produced by the time-dependent B field.

Next we apply the Ampère-Maxwell law (with ) over the same two faces (Surface 3 and then Surface 2) of
the rectangular box of Figure 16.7. Applying Equation 16.10,

to Surface 3, and then to Surface 2, yields the two equations

16.18

16.19

These equations describe the spatially dependent B field produced by the time-dependent E field.

We next combine the equations showing the changing B field producing an E field with the equation showing
the changing E field producing a B field. Taking the derivative of Equation 16.16 with respect to x and using
Equation 16.26 gives

16.20

This is the form taken by the general wave equation for our plane wave. Because the equations describe a wave
traveling at some as-yet-unspecified speed c, we can assume the field components are each functions of x – ct
for the wave traveling in the +x-direction, that is,

16.21

It is left as a mathematical exercise to show, using the chain rule for differentiation, that Equation 16.17 and
Equation 16.18 imply

The speed of the electromagnetic wave in free space is therefore given in terms of the permeability and the
permittivity of free space by

16.22

We could just as easily have assumed an electromagnetic wave with field components and .
The same type of analysis with Equation 16.25 and Equation 16.24 would also show that the speed of an
electromagnetic wave is .

The physics of traveling electromagnetic fields was worked out by Maxwell in 1873. He showed in a more
general way than our derivation that electromagnetic waves always travel in free space with a speed given by
690 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Equation 16.18. If we evaluate the speed we find that

which is the speed of light. Imagine the excitement that Maxwell must have felt when he discovered this
equation! He had found a fundamental connection between two seemingly unrelated phenomena:
electromagnetic fields and light.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.3


The wave equation was obtained by (1) finding the E field produced by the changing B field, (2) finding the B
field produced by the changing E field, and combining the two results. Which of Maxwell’s equations was the
basis of step (1) and which of step (2)?

How the E and B Fields Are Related


So far, we have seen that the rates of change of different components of the E and B fields are related, that the
electromagnetic wave is transverse, and that the wave propagates at speed c. We next show what Maxwell’s
equations imply about the ratio of the E and B field magnitudes and the relative directions of the E and B fields.

We now consider solutions to Equation 16.16 in the form of plane waves for the electric field:

16.23

We have arbitrarily taken the wave to be traveling in the +x-direction and chosen its phase so that the
maximum field strength occurs at the origin at time . We are justified in considering only sines and
cosines in this way, and generalizing the results, because Fourier’s theorem implies we can express any wave,
including even square step functions, as a superposition of sines and cosines.

At any one specific point in space, the E field oscillates sinusoidally at angular frequency between and
and similarly, the B field oscillates between and The amplitude of the wave is the maximum
value of The period of oscillation T is the time required for a complete oscillation. The frequency f is
the number of complete oscillations per unit of time, and is related to the angular frequency by .
The wavelength is the distance covered by one complete cycle of the wave, and the wavenumber k is the
number of wavelengths that fit into a distance of in the units being used. These quantities are related in the
same way as for a mechanical wave:

Given that the solution of has the form shown in Equation 16.20, we need to determine the B field that
accompanies it. From Equation 16.24, the magnetic field component must obey

16.24

Because the solution for the B-field pattern of the wave propagates in the +x-direction at the same speed c as
the E-field pattern, it must be a function of . Thus, we conclude from Equation 16.21 that
is

These results may be written as

16.25

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.2 • Plane Electromagnetic Waves 691

16.26

Therefore, the peaks of the E and B fields coincide, as do the troughs of the wave, and at each point, the E and B
fields are in the same ratio equal to the speed of light c. The plane wave has the form shown in Figure 16.8.

Figure 16.8 The plane wave solution of Maxwell’s equations has the B field directly proportional to the E field at each point, with the
relative directions shown.

EXAMPLE 16.2

Calculating B-Field Strength in an Electromagnetic Wave


What is the maximum strength of the B field in an electromagnetic wave that has a maximum E-field strength
of 1000 V/m?

Strategy
To find the B-field strength, we rearrange Equation 16.23 to solve for B, yielding

Solution
We are given E, and c is the speed of light. Entering these into the expression for B yields

Significance
The B-field strength is less than a tenth of Earth’s admittedly weak magnetic field. This means that a relatively
strong electric field of 1000 V/m is accompanied by a relatively weak magnetic field.

Changing electric fields create relatively weak magnetic fields. The combined electric and magnetic fields can
be detected in electromagnetic waves, however, by taking advantage of the phenomenon of resonance, as Hertz
did. A system with the same natural frequency as the electromagnetic wave can be made to oscillate. All radio
and TV receivers use this principle to pick up and then amplify weak electromagnetic waves, while rejecting all
others not at their resonant frequency.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.4


What conclusions did our analysis of Maxwell’s equations lead to about these properties of a plane
electromagnetic wave:
692 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

(a) the relative directions of wave propagation, of the E field, and of B field,
(b) the speed of travel of the wave and how the speed depends on frequency, and
(c) the relative magnitudes of the E and B fields.

Production and Detection of Electromagnetic Waves


A steady electric current produces a magnetic field that is constant in time and which does not propagate as a
wave. Accelerating charges, however, produce electromagnetic waves. An electric charge oscillating up and
down, or an alternating current or flow of charge in a conductor, emit radiation at the frequencies of their
oscillations. The electromagnetic field of a dipole antenna is shown in Figure 16.9. The positive and negative
charges on the two conductors are made to reverse at the desired frequency by the output of a transmitter as
the power source. The continually changing current accelerates charge in the antenna, and this results in an
oscillating electric field a distance away from the antenna. The changing electric fields produce changing
magnetic fields that in turn produce changing electric fields, which thereby propagate as electromagnetic
waves. The frequency of this radiation is the same as the frequency of the ac source that is accelerating the
electrons in the antenna. The two conducting elements of the dipole antenna are commonly straight wires. The
total length of the two wires is typically about one-half of the desired wavelength (hence, the alternative name
half-wave antenna), because this allows standing waves to be set up and enhances the effectiveness of the
radiation.

Figure 16.9 The oscillatory motion of the charges in a dipole antenna produces electromagnetic radiation.

The electric field lines in one plane are shown. The magnetic field is perpendicular to this plane. This radiation
field has cylindrical symmetry around the axis of the dipole. Field lines near the dipole are not shown. The
pattern is not at all uniform in all directions. The strongest signal is in directions perpendicular to the axis of
the antenna, which would be horizontal if the antenna is mounted vertically. There is zero intensity along the
axis of the antenna. The fields detected far from the antenna are from the changing electric and magnetic
fields inducing each other and traveling as electromagnetic waves. Far from the antenna, the wave fronts, or
surfaces of equal phase for the electromagnetic wave, are almost spherical. Even farther from the antenna, the
radiation propagates like electromagnetic plane waves.

The electromagnetic waves carry energy away from their source, similar to a sound wave carrying energy away
from a standing wave on a guitar string. An antenna for receiving electromagnetic signals works in reverse.
Incoming electromagnetic waves induce oscillating currents in the antenna, each at its own frequency. The
radio receiver includes a tuner circuit, whose resonant frequency can be adjusted. The tuner responds
strongly to the desired frequency but not others, allowing the user to tune to the desired broadcast. Electrical
components amplify the signal formed by the moving electrons. The signal is then converted into an audio
and/or video format.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.3 • Energy Carried by Electromagnetic Waves 693

INTERACTIVE
Use this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21radwavsim) to broadcast radio waves. Wiggle the transmitter
electron manually or have it oscillate automatically. Display the field as a curve or vectors. The strip chart
shows the electron positions at the transmitter and at the receiver.

16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic Waves


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Express the time-averaged energy density of electromagnetic waves in terms of their electric and magnetic
field amplitudes
• Calculate the Poynting vector and the energy intensity of electromagnetic waves
• Explain how the energy of an electromagnetic wave depends on its amplitude, whereas the energy of a
photon is proportional to its frequency

Anyone who has used a microwave oven knows there is energy in electromagnetic waves. Sometimes this
energy is obvious, such as in the warmth of the summer Sun. Other times, it is subtle, such as the unfelt energy
of gamma rays, which can destroy living cells.

Electromagnetic waves bring energy into a system by virtue of their electric and magnetic fields. These fields
can exert forces and move charges in the system and, thus, do work on them. However, there is energy in an
electromagnetic wave itself, whether it is absorbed or not. Once created, the fields carry energy away from a
source. If some energy is later absorbed, the field strengths are diminished and anything left travels on.

Clearly, the larger the strength of the electric and magnetic fields, the more work they can do and the greater
the energy the electromagnetic wave carries. In electromagnetic waves, the amplitude is the maximum field
strength of the electric and magnetic fields (Figure 16.10). The wave energy is determined by the wave
amplitude.

Figure 16.10 Energy carried by a wave depends on its amplitude. With electromagnetic waves, doubling the E fields and B fields
quadruples the energy density u and the energy flux uc.

For a plane wave traveling in the direction of the positive x-axis with the phase of the wave chosen so that the
wave maximum is at the origin at , the electric and magnetic fields obey the equations

The energy in any part of the electromagnetic wave is the sum of the energies of the electric and magnetic
fields. This energy per unit volume, or energy density u, is the sum of the energy density from the electric field
694 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

and the energy density from the magnetic field. Expressions for both field energy densities were discussed
earlier ( in Capacitance and in Inductance). Combining these the contributions, we obtain

The expression then shows that the magnetic energy density and electric energy

density are equal, despite the fact that changing electric fields generally produce only small magnetic
fields. The equality of the electric and magnetic energy densities leads to

16.27

The energy density moves with the electric and magnetic fields in a similar manner to the waves themselves.

We can find the rate of transport of energy by considering a small time interval . As shown in Figure 16.11,
the energy contained in a cylinder of length and cross-sectional area A passes through the cross-sectional
plane in the interval

Figure 16.11 The energy contained in the electric and magnetic fields of the electromagnetic wave in the volume passes
through the area A in time .

The energy passing through area A in time is

The energy per unit area per unit time passing through a plane perpendicular to the wave, called the energy
flux and denoted by S, can be calculated by dividing the energy by the area A and the time interval .

More generally, the flux of energy through any surface also depends on the orientation of the surface. To take
the direction into account, we introduce a vector , called the Poynting vector, with the following definition:

16.28

The cross-product of and points in the direction perpendicular to both vectors. To confirm that the
direction of is that of wave propagation, and not its negative, return to Figure 16.7. Note that Lenz’s and
Faraday’s laws imply that when the magnetic field shown is increasing in time, the electric field is greater at x
than at . The electric field is decreasing with increasing x at the given time and location. The
proportionality between electric and magnetic fields requires the electric field to increase in time along with
the magnetic field. This is possible only if the wave is propagating to the right in the diagram, in which case,
the relative orientations show that is specifically in the direction of propagation of the
electromagnetic wave.

The energy flux at any place also varies in time, as can be seen by substituting u from Equation 16.23 into
Equation 16.27.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.3 • Energy Carried by Electromagnetic Waves 695

16.29

Because the frequency of visible light is very high, of the order of the energy flux for visible light
through any area is an extremely rapidly varying quantity. Most measuring devices, including our eyes, detect
only an average over many cycles. The time average of the energy flux is the intensity I of the electromagnetic
wave and is the power per unit area. It can be expressed by averaging the cosine function in Equation 16.29
over one complete cycle, which is the same as time-averaging over many cycles (here, T is one period):

16.30

We can either evaluate the integral, or else note that because the sine and cosine differ merely in phase, the
average over a complete cycle for is the same as for , to obtain

where the angle brackets stand for the time-averaging operation. The intensity of light moving at speed c
in vacuum is then found to be

16.31

in terms of the maximum electric field strength which is also the electric field amplitude. Algebraic
manipulation produces the relationship

16.32

where is the magnetic field amplitude, which is the same as the maximum magnetic field strength. One
more expression for in terms of both electric and magnetic field strengths is useful. Substituting the fact
that the previous expression becomes

16.33

We can use whichever of the three preceding equations is most convenient, because the three equations are
really just different versions of the same result: The energy in a wave is related to amplitude squared.
Furthermore, because these equations are based on the assumption that the electromagnetic waves are
sinusoidal, the peak intensity is twice the average intensity; that is,

EXAMPLE 16.3

A Laser Beam
The beam from a small laboratory laser typically has an intensity of about . Assuming that
the beam is composed of plane waves, calculate the amplitudes of the electric and magnetic fields in the beam.

Strategy
Use the equation expressing intensity in terms of electric field to calculate the electric field from the intensity.

Solution
From Equation 16.31, the intensity of the laser beam is
696 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

The amplitude of the electric field is therefore

The amplitude of the magnetic field can be obtained from Equation 16.20:

EXAMPLE 16.4

Light Bulb Fields


A light bulb emits 5.00 W of power as visible light. What are the average electric and magnetic fields from the
light at a distance of 3.0 m?

Strategy
Assume the bulb’s power output P is distributed uniformly over a sphere of radius 3.0 m to calculate the
intensity, and from it, the electric field.

Solution
The power radiated as visible light is then

Significance
The intensity I falls off as the distance squared if the radiation is dispersed uniformly in all directions.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.4 • Momentum and Radiation Pressure 697

EXAMPLE 16.5

Radio Range
A 60-kW radio transmitter on Earth sends its signal to a satellite 100 km away (Figure 16.12). At what distance
in the same direction would the signal have the same maximum field strength if the transmitter’s output power
were increased to 90 kW?

Figure 16.12 In three dimensions, a signal spreads over a solid angle as it travels outward from its source.

Strategy
The area over which the power in a particular direction is dispersed increases as distance squared, as
illustrated in the figure. Change the power output P by a factor of (90 kW/60 kW) and change the area by the

same factor to keep the same. Then use the proportion of area A in the diagram to distance
squared to find the distance that produces the calculated change in area.

Solution
Using the proportionality of the areas to the squares of the distances, and solving, we obtain from the diagram

Significance
The range of a radio signal is the maximum distance between the transmitter and receiver that allows for
normal operation. In the absence of complications such as reflections from obstacles, the intensity follows an
inverse square law, and doubling the range would require multiplying the power by four.

16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Describe the relationship of the radiation pressure and the energy density of an electromagnetic wave
• Explain how the radiation pressure of light, while small, can produce observable astronomical effects
698 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Material objects consist of charged particles. An electromagnetic wave incident on the object exerts forces on
the charged particles, in accordance with the Lorentz force, Equation 16.11. These forces do work on the
particles of the object, increasing its energy, as discussed in the previous section. The energy that sunlight
carries is a familiar part of every warm sunny day. A much less familiar feature of electromagnetic radiation is
the extremely weak pressure that electromagnetic radiation produces by exerting a force in the direction of the
wave. This force occurs because electromagnetic waves contain and transport momentum.

To understand the direction of the force for a very specific case, consider a plane electromagnetic wave
incident on a metal in which electron motion, as part of a current, is damped by the resistance of the metal, so
that the average electron motion is in phase with the force causing it. This is comparable to an object moving
against friction and stopping as soon as the force pushing it stops (Figure 16.13). When the electric field is in
the direction of the positive y-axis, electrons move in the negative y-direction, with the magnetic field in the
direction of the positive z-axis. By applying the right-hand rule, and accounting for the negative charge of the
electron, we can see that the force on the electron from the magnetic field is in the direction of the positive
x-axis, which is the direction of wave propagation. When the E field reverses, the B field does too, and the force
is again in the same direction. Maxwell’s equations together with the Lorentz force equation imply the
existence of radiation pressure much more generally than this specific example, however.

Figure 16.13 Electric and magnetic fields of an electromagnetic wave can combine to produce a force in the direction of propagation, as
illustrated for the special case of electrons whose motion is highly damped by the resistance of a metal.

Maxwell predicted that an electromagnetic wave carries momentum. An object absorbing an electromagnetic
wave would experience a force in the direction of propagation of the wave. The force corresponds to radiation
pressure exerted on the object by the wave. The force would be twice as great if the radiation were reflected
rather than absorbed.

Maxwell’s prediction was confirmed in 1903 by Nichols and Hull by precisely measuring radiation pressures
with a torsion balance. The schematic arrangement is shown in Figure 16.14. The mirrors suspended from a
fiber were housed inside a glass container. Nichols and Hull were able to obtain a small measurable deflection
of the mirrors from shining light on one of them. From the measured deflection, they could calculate the
unbalanced force on the mirror, and obtained agreement with the predicted value of the force.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.4 • Momentum and Radiation Pressure 699

Figure 16.14 Simplified diagram of the central part of the apparatus Nichols and Hull used to precisely measure radiation pressure and
confirm Maxwell’s prediction.

The radiation pressure applied by an electromagnetic wave on a perfectly absorbing surface turns out to
be equal to the energy density of the wave:
16.34
If the material is perfectly reflecting, such as a metal surface, and if the incidence is along the normal to the
surface, then the pressure exerted is twice as much because the momentum direction reverses upon
reflection:
16.35
We can confirm that the units are right:

Equation 16.34 and Equation 16.35 give the instantaneous pressure, but because the energy density oscillates
rapidly, we are usually interested in the time-averaged radiation pressure, which can be written in terms of
intensity:

16.36

Radiation pressure plays a role in explaining many observed astronomical phenomena, including the
appearance of comets. Comets are basically chunks of icy material in which frozen gases and particles of rock
and dust are embedded. When a comet approaches the Sun, it warms up and its surface begins to evaporate.
The coma of the comet is the hazy area around it from the gases and dust. Some of the gases and dust form
tails when they leave the comet. Notice in Figure 16.15 that a comet has two tails. The ion tail (or gas tail in
Figure 16.15) is composed mainly of ionized gases. These ions interact electromagnetically with the solar
wind, which is a continuous stream of charged particles emitted by the Sun. The force of the solar wind on the
ionized gases is strong enough that the ion tail almost always points directly away from the Sun. The second
tail is composed of dust particles. Because the dust tail is electrically neutral, it does not interact with the solar
wind. However, this tail is affected by the radiation pressure produced by the light from the Sun. Although
quite small, this pressure is strong enough to cause the dust tail to be displaced from the path of the comet.
700 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Figure 16.15 Evaporation of material being warmed by the Sun forms two tails, as shown in this photo of Comet Ison. (credit:
modification of work by E. Slawik—ESO)

EXAMPLE 16.6

Halley’s Comet
On February 9, 1986, Comet Halley was at its closest point to the Sun, about from the center of
the Sun. The average power output of the Sun is

(a) Calculate the radiation pressure on the comet at this point in its orbit. Assume that the comet reflects all the
incident light.

(b) Suppose that a 10-kg chunk of material of cross-sectional area breaks loose from the
comet. Calculate the force on this chunk due to the solar radiation. Compare this force with the gravitational
force of the Sun.

Strategy
Calculate the intensity of solar radiation at the given distance from the Sun and use that to calculate the
radiation pressure. From the pressure and area, calculate the force.

Solution

a. The intensity of the solar radiation is the average solar power per unit area. Hence, at from
the center of the Sun, we have

Assuming the comet reflects all the incident radiation, we obtain from Equation 16.36

b. The force on the chunk due to the radiation is

whereas the gravitational force of the Sun is

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.4 • Momentum and Radiation Pressure 701

Significance
The gravitational force of the Sun on the chunk is therefore much greater than the force of the radiation.

After Maxwell showed that light carried momentum as well as energy, a novel idea eventually emerged,
initially only as science fiction. Perhaps a spacecraft with a large reflecting light sail could use radiation
pressure for propulsion. Such a vehicle would not have to carry fuel. It would experience a constant but small
force from solar radiation, instead of the short bursts from rocket propulsion. It would accelerate slowly, but by
being accelerated continuously, it would eventually reach great speeds. A spacecraft with small total mass and
a sail with a large area would be necessary to obtain a usable acceleration.

When the space program began in the 1960s, the idea started to receive serious attention from NASA. The
most recent development in light propelled spacecraft has come from a citizen-funded group, the Planetary
Society. It is currently testing the use of light sails to propel a small vehicle built from CubeSats, tiny satellites
that NASA places in orbit for various research projects during space launches intended mainly for other
purposes.

The LightSail spacecraft shown below (Figure 16.16) consists of three CubeSats bundled together. It has a total
mass of only about 5 kg and is about the size as a loaf of bread. Its sails are made of very thin Mylar and open
after launch to have a surface area of

Figure 16.16 Two small CubeSat satellites deployed from the International Space Station in May, 2016. The solar sails open out when the
CubeSats are far enough away from the Station. (credit: modification of work by NASA)

INTERACTIVE
The first LightSail spacecraft was launched in 2015 to test the sail deployment system. It was placed in low-
earth orbit in 2015 by hitching a ride on an Atlas 5 rocket launched for an unrelated mission. The test was
successful, but the low-earth orbit allowed too much drag on the spacecraft to accelerate it by sunlight.
Eventually, it burned in the atmosphere, as expected. The next Planetary Society’s LightSail solar sailing
spacecraft is scheduled for 2016. An illustration (https://openstax.org/l/21lightsail) of the spacecraft, as it is
expected to appear in flight, can be seen on the Planetary Society’s website.
702 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

EXAMPLE 16.7

LightSail Acceleration
The intensity of energy from sunlight at a distance of 1 AU from the Sun is . The LightSail
spacecraft has sails with total area of and a total mass of 5.0 kg. Calculate the maximum acceleration
LightSail spacecraft could achieve from radiation pressure when it is about 1 AU from the Sun.

Strategy
The maximum acceleration can be expected when the sail is opened directly facing the Sun. Use the light
intensity to calculate the radiation pressure and from it, the force on the sails. Then use Newton’s second law
to calculate the acceleration.

Solution
The radiation pressure is

The resulting acceleration is

Significance
If this small acceleration continued for a year, the craft would attain a speed of 1829 m/s, or 6600 km/h.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.5


How would the speed and acceleration of a radiation-propelled spacecraft be affected as it moved farther from
the Sun on an interplanetary space flight?

16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum


Learning Objectives
By the end of this section, you will be able to:
• Explain how electromagnetic waves are divided into different ranges, depending on wavelength and
corresponding frequency
• Describe how electromagnetic waves in different categories are produced
• Describe some of the many practical everyday applications of electromagnetic waves

Electromagnetic waves have a vast range of practical everyday applications that includes such diverse uses as
communication by cell phone and radio broadcasting, WiFi, cooking, vision, medical imaging, and treating
cancer. In this module, we discuss how electromagnetic waves are classified into categories such as radio,
infrared, ultraviolet, and so on. We also summarize some of the main applications for each range.

The different categories of electromagnetic waves differ in their wavelength range, or equivalently, in their
corresponding frequency ranges. Their properties change smoothly from one frequency range to the next,
with different applications in each range. A brief overview of the production and utilization of electromagnetic
waves is found in Table 16.1.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.5 • The Electromagnetic Spectrum 703

Type of
Production Applications Issues
wave

Communications
Requires control for band
Radio Accelerating charges Remote controls
use
MRI

Communications
Accelerating charges and thermal Ovens
Microwaves
agitation Radar
Cell phone use

Thermal agitation and electronic Thermal imaging Absorbed by atmosphere


Infrared
transitions Heating Greenhouse effect

Visible Thermal agitation and electronic Photosynthesis


light transitions Human vision

Sterilization
Thermal agitation and electronic Ozone depletion
Ultraviolet Vitamin D
transitions Cancer causing
production

Security
Inner electronic transitions and fast
X-rays Medical diagnosis Cancer causing
collisions
Cancer therapy

Nuclear medicine
Gamma Security Cancer causing
Nuclear decay
rays Medical diagnosis Radiation damage
Cancer therapy

Table 16.1 Electromagnetic Waves

The relationship between frequency f and wavelength applies to all waves and ensures that greater
frequency means smaller wavelength. Figure 16.17 shows how the various types of electromagnetic waves are
categorized according to their wavelengths and frequencies—that is, it shows the electromagnetic spectrum.
704 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Figure 16.17 The electromagnetic spectrum, showing the major categories of electromagnetic waves.

Radio Waves
The term radio waves refers to electromagnetic radiation with wavelengths greater than about 0.1 m. Radio
waves are commonly used for audio communications (i.e., for radios), but the term is used for electromagnetic
waves in this range regardless of their application. Radio waves typically result from an alternating current in
the wires of a broadcast antenna. They cover a very broad wavelength range and are divided into many
subranges, including microwaves, electromagnetic waves used for AM and FM radio, cellular telephones, and
TV signals.

There is no lowest frequency of radio waves, but ELF waves, or “extremely low frequency” are among the
lowest frequencies commonly encountered, from 3 Hz to 3 kHz. The accelerating charge in the ac currents of
electrical power lines produce electromagnetic waves in this range. ELF waves are able to penetrate sea water,
which strongly absorbs electromagnetic waves of higher frequency, and therefore are useful for submarine
communications.

In order to use an electromagnetic wave to transmit information, the amplitude, frequency, or phase of the
wave is modulated, or varied in a controlled way that encodes the intended information into the wave. In AM
radio transmission, the amplitude of the wave is modulated to mimic the vibrations of the sound being
conveyed. Fourier’s theorem implies that the modulated AM wave amounts to a superposition of waves
covering some narrow frequency range. Each AM station is assigned a specific carrier frequency that, by
international agreement, is allowed to vary by . In FM radio transmission, the frequency of the wave is
modulated to carry this information, as illustrated in Figure 16.18, and the frequency of each station is allowed
to use 100 kHz on each side of its carrier frequency. The electromagnetic wave produces a current in a
receiving antenna, and the radio or television processes the signal to produce the sound and any image. The
higher the frequency of the radio wave used to carry the data, the greater the detailed variation of the wave that
can be carried by modulating it over each time unit, and the more data that can be transmitted per unit of time.
The assigned frequencies for AM broadcasting are 540 to 1600 kHz, and for FM are 88 MHz to108 MHz.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.5 • The Electromagnetic Spectrum 705

Figure 16.18 Electromagnetic waves are used to carry communications signals by varying the wave’s amplitude (AM), its frequency (FM),
or its phase.

Cell phone conversations, and television voice and video images are commonly transmitted as digital data, by
converting the signal into a sequence of binary ones and zeros. This allows clearer data transmission when the
signal is weak, and allows using computer algorithms to compress the digital data to transmit more data in
each frequency range. Computer data as well is transmitted as a sequence of binary ones and zeros, each one
or zero constituting one bit of data.

Microwaves
Microwaves are the highest-frequency electromagnetic waves that can be produced by currents in
macroscopic circuits and devices. Microwave frequencies range from about to nearly . Their
high frequencies correspond to short wavelengths compared with other radio waves—hence the name
“microwave.” Microwaves also occur naturally as the cosmic background radiation left over from the origin of
the universe. Along with other ranges of electromagnetic waves, they are part of the radiation that any object
above absolute zero emits and absorbs because of thermal agitation, that is, from the thermal motion of its
atoms and molecules.

Most satellite-transmitted information is carried on microwaves. Radar is a common application of


microwaves. By detecting and timing microwave echoes, radar systems can determine the distance to objects
as diverse as clouds, aircraft, or even the surface of Venus.

Microwaves of 2.45 GHz are commonly used in microwave ovens. The electrons in a water molecule tend to
remain closer to the oxygen nucleus than the hydrogen nuclei (Figure 16.19). This creates two separated
centers of equal and opposite charges, giving the molecule a dipole moment (see Electric Field). The oscillating
electric field of the microwaves inside the oven exerts a torque that tends to align each molecule first in one
direction and then in the other, with the motion of each molecule coupled to others around it. This pumps
energy into the continual thermal motion of the water to heat the food. The plate under the food contains no
water, and remains relatively unheated.
706 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Figure 16.19 The oscillating electric field in a microwave oven exerts a torque on water molecules because of their dipole moment, and
the torque reverses direction times per second. Interactions between the molecules distributes the energy being pumped into
them. The and denote the charge distribution on the molecules.

The microwaves in a microwave oven reflect off the walls of the oven, so that the superposition of waves
produces standing waves, similar to the standing waves of a vibrating guitar or violin string (see Normal Modes
of a Standing Sound Wave). A rotating fan acts as a stirrer by reflecting the microwaves in different directions,
and food turntables, help spread out the hot spots.

EXAMPLE 16.8

Why Microwave Ovens Heat Unevenly


How far apart are the hotspots in a 2.45-GHz microwave oven?

Strategy
Consider the waves along one direction in the oven, being reflected at the opposite wall from where they are
generated.

Solution
The antinodes, where maximum intensity occurs, are half the wavelength apart, with separation

Significance
The distance between the hot spots in a microwave oven are determined by the wavelength of the microwaves.

A cell phone has a radio receiver and a weak radio transmitter, both of which can quickly tune to hundreds of
specifically assigned microwave frequencies. The low intensity of the transmitted signal gives it an
intentionally limited range. A ground-based system links the phone to only to the broadcast tower assigned to
the specific small area, or cell, and smoothly transitions its connection to the next cell when the signal
reception there is the stronger one. This enables a cell phone to be used while changing location.

Microwaves also provide the WiFi that enables owners of cell phones, laptop computers, and similar devices to
connect wirelessly to the Internet at home and at coffee shops and airports. A wireless WiFi router is a device
that exchanges data over the Internet through the cable or another connection, and uses microwaves to
exchange the data wirelessly with devices such as cell phones and computers. The term WiFi itself refers to the
standards followed in modulating and analyzing the microwaves so that wireless routers and devices from
different manufacturers work compatibly with one another. The computer data in each direction consist of
sequences of binary zeros and ones, each corresponding to a binary bit. The microwaves are in the range of 2.4
GHz to 5.0 GHz range.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.5 • The Electromagnetic Spectrum 707

Other wireless technologies also use microwaves to provide everyday communications between devices.
Bluetooth developed alongside WiFi as a standard for radio communication in the 2.4-GHz range between
nearby devices, for example, to link to headphones and audio earpieces to devices such as radios, or a driver’s
cell phone to a hands-free device to allow answering phone calls without fumbling directly with the cell phone.

Microwaves find use also in radio tagging, using RFID (radio frequency identification) technology. Examples
are RFID tags attached to store merchandize, transponder for toll booths use attached to the windshield of a
car, or even a chip embedded into a pet’s skin. The device responds to a microwave signal by emitting a signal
of its own with encoded information, allowing stores to quickly ring up items at their cash registers, drivers to
charge tolls to their account without stopping, and lost pets to be reunited with their owners. NFC (near field
communication) works similarly, except it is much shorter range. Its mechanism of interaction is the induced
magnetic field at microwave frequencies between two coils. Cell phones that have NFC capability and the right
software can supply information for purchases using the cell phone instead of a physical credit card. The very
short range of the data transfer is a desired security feature in this case.

Infrared Radiation
The boundary between the microwave and infrared regions of the electromagnetic spectrum is not well
defined (see Figure 16.17). Infrared radiation is generally produced by thermal motion, and the vibration and
rotation of atoms and molecules. Electronic transitions in atoms and molecules can also produce infrared
radiation. About half of the solar energy arriving at Earth is in the infrared region, with most of the rest in the
visible part of the spectrum. About 23% of the solar energy is absorbed in the atmosphere, about 48% is
1
absorbed at Earth’s surface, and about 29% is reflected back into space.

The range of infrared frequencies extends up to the lower limit of visible light, just below red. In fact, infrared
means “below red.” Water molecules rotate and vibrate particularly well at infrared frequencies.
Reconnaissance satellites can detect buildings, vehicles, and even individual humans by their infrared
emissions, whose power radiation is proportional to the fourth power of the absolute temperature. More
mundanely, we use infrared lamps, including those called quartz heaters, to preferentially warm us because
we absorb infrared better than our surroundings.

The familiar handheld “remotes” for changing channels and settings on television sets often transmit their
signal by modulating an infrared beam. If you try to use a TV remote without the infrared emitter being in
direct line of sight with the infrared detector, you may find the television not responding. Some remotes use
Bluetooth instead and reduce this annoyance.

Visible Light
Visible light is the narrow segment of the electromagnetic spectrum between about 400 nm and about 750 nm
to which the normal human eye responds. Visible light is produced by vibrations and rotations of atoms and
molecules, as well as by electronic transitions within atoms and molecules. The receivers or detectors of light
largely utilize electronic transitions.

Red light has the lowest frequencies and longest wavelengths, whereas violet has the highest frequencies and
shortest wavelengths (Figure 16.20). Blackbody radiation from the Sun peaks in the visible part of the
spectrum but is more intense in the red than in the violet, making the sun yellowish in appearance.

Figure 16.20 A small part of the electromagnetic spectrum that includes its visible components. The divisions between infrared, visible,
and ultraviolet are not perfectly distinct, nor are those between the seven rainbow colors.

1 http://earthobservatory.nasa.gov/Features/EnergyBalance/page4.php
708 16 • Electromagnetic Waves

Living things—plants and animals—have evolved to utilize and respond to parts of the electromagnetic
spectrum in which they are embedded. We enjoy the beauty of nature through visible light. Plants are more
selective. Photosynthesis uses parts of the visible spectrum to make sugars.

Ultraviolet Radiation
Ultraviolet means “above violet.” The electromagnetic frequencies of ultraviolet radiation (UV) extend
upward from violet, the highest-frequency visible light. The highest-frequency ultraviolet overlaps with the
lowest-frequency X-rays. The wavelengths of ultraviolet extend from 400 nm down to about 10 nm at its
highest frequencies. Ultraviolet is produced by atomic and molecular motions and electronic transitions.

UV radiation from the Sun is broadly subdivided into three wavelength ranges: UV-A (320–400 nm) is the
lowest frequency, then UV-B (290–320 nm) and UV-C (220–290 nm). Most UV-B and all UV-C are absorbed by
ozone ( ) molecules in the upper atmosphere. Consequently, 99% of the solar UV radiation reaching Earth’s
surface is UV-A.

Sunburn is caused by large exposures to UV-B and UV-C, and repeated exposure can increase the likelihood of
skin cancer. The tanning response is a defense mechanism in which the body produces pigments in inert skin
layers to reduce exposure of the living cells below.

As examined in a later chapter, the shorter the wavelength of light, the greater the energy change of an atom or
molecule that absorbs the light in an electronic transition. This makes short-wavelength ultraviolet light
damaging to living cells. It also explains why ultraviolet radiation is better able than visible light to cause some
materials to glow, or fluoresce.

Besides the adverse effects of ultraviolet radiation, there are also benefits of exposure in nature and uses in
technology. Vitamin D production in the skin results from exposure to UV-B radiation, generally from sunlight.
Several studies suggest vitamin D deficiency is associated with the development of a range of cancers
(prostate, breast, colon), as well as osteoporosis. Low-intensity ultraviolet has applications such as providing
the energy to cause certain dyes to fluoresce and emit visible light, for example, in printed money to display
hidden watermarks as counterfeit protection.

X-Rays
X-rays have wavelengths from about . They have shorter wavelengths, and higher
frequencies, than ultraviolet, so that the energy they transfer at an atomic level is greater. As a result, X-rays
have adverse effects on living cells similar to those of ultraviolet radiation, but they are more penetrating.
Cancer and genetic defects can be induced by X-rays. Because of their effect on rapidly dividing cells, X-rays
can also be used to treat and even cure cancer.

The widest use of X-rays is for imaging objects that are opaque to visible light, such as the human body or
aircraft parts. In humans, the risk of cell damage is weighed carefully against the benefit of the diagnostic
information obtained.

Gamma Rays
Soon after nuclear radioactivity was first detected in 1896, it was found that at least three distinct types of
radiation were being emitted, and these were designated as alpha, beta, and gamma rays. The most
penetrating nuclear radiation, the gamma ray ( ray), was later found to be an extremely high-frequency
electromagnetic wave.

The lower end of the ray frequency range overlaps the upper end of the X-ray range. Gamma rays have
characteristics identical to X-rays of the same frequency—they differ only in source. The name “gamma rays” is
generally used for electromagnetic radiation emitted by a nucleus, while X-rays are generally produced by
bombarding a target with energetic electrons in an X-ray tube. At higher frequencies, rays are more
penetrating and more damaging to living tissue. They have many of the same uses as X-rays, including cancer
therapy. Gamma radiation from radioactive materials is used in nuclear medicine.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16.5 • The Electromagnetic Spectrum 709

INTERACTIVE
Use this simulation (https://openstax.org/l/21simlightmol) to explore how light interacts with molecules in our
atmosphere.

Explore how light interacts with molecules in our atmosphere.

Identify that absorption of light depends on the molecule and the type of light.

Relate the energy of the light to the resulting motion.

Identify that energy increases from microwave to ultraviolet.

Predict the motion of a molecule based on the type of light it absorbs.

CHECK YOUR UNDERSTANDING 16.6


How do the electromagnetic waves for the different kinds of electromagnetic radiation differ?
710 16 • Chapter Review

CHAPTER REVIEW
Key Terms
displacement current extra term in Maxwell’s the flow of electromagnetic energy through a
equations that is analogous to a real current but surface
accounts for a changing electric field producing a radar common application of microwaves; radar
magnetic field, even when the real current is can determine the distance to objects as diverse
present as clouds and aircraft, as well as determine the
gamma ray ( ray) extremely high frequency speed of a car or the intensity of a rainstorm
electromagnetic radiation emitted by the nucleus radiation pressure force divided by area applied
of an atom, either from natural nuclear decay or by an electromagnetic wave on a surface
induced nuclear processes in nuclear reactors radio waves electromagnetic waves with
and weapons; the lower end of the -ray wavelengths in the range from 1 mm to 100 km;
frequency range overlaps the upper end of the X- they are produced by currents in wires and
ray range, but rays can have the highest circuits and by astronomical phenomena
frequency of any electromagnetic radiation thermal agitation thermal motion of atoms and
infrared radiation region of the electromagnetic molecules in any object at a temperature above
spectrum with a frequency range that extends absolute zero, which causes them to emit and
from just below the red region of the visible light absorb radiation
spectrum up to the microwave region, or from ultraviolet radiation electromagnetic radiation in
the range extending upward in frequency from
Maxwell’s equations set of four equations that violet light and overlapping with the lowest X-ray
comprise a complete, overarching theory of frequencies, with wavelengths from 400 nm down
electromagnetism to about 10 nm
microwaves electromagnetic waves with visible light narrow segment of the
wavelengths in the range from 1 mm to 1 m; they electromagnetic spectrum to which the normal
can be produced by currents in macroscopic human eye responds, from about 400 to 750 nm
circuits and devices X-ray invisible, penetrating form of very high
Poynting vector vector equal to the cross product frequency electromagnetic radiation, overlapping
of the electric-and magnetic fields, that describes both the ultraviolet range and the -ray range

Key Equations

Displacement current

Gauss’s law

Gauss’s law for magnetism

Faraday’s law

Ampère-Maxwell law

Wave equation for plane EM wave

Speed of EM waves

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 711

Ratio of E field to B field in electromagnetic wave

Energy flux (Poynting) vector

Average intensity of an electromagnetic wave

Radiation pressure

Summary
16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and relative to the electric field E.
Electromagnetic Waves • Accelerating charges create electromagnetic
waves (for example, an oscillating current in a
• Maxwell’s prediction of electromagnetic waves wire produces electromagnetic waves with the
resulted from his formulation of a complete and same frequency as the oscillation).
symmetric theory of electricity and magnetism,
known as Maxwell’s equations. 16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic
• The four Maxwell’s equations together with the Waves
Lorentz force law encompass the major laws of
• The energy carried by any wave is proportional
electricity and magnetism. The first of these is
to its amplitude squared. For electromagnetic
Gauss’s law for electricity; the second is Gauss’s
waves, this means intensity can be expressed as
law for magnetism; the third is Faraday’s law of
induction (including Lenz’s law); and the fourth
is Ampère’s law in a symmetric formulation that
adds another source of magnetism, namely
where I is the average intensity in and is
changing electric fields.
the maximum electric field strength of a continuous
• The symmetry introduced between electric and
sinusoidal wave. This can also be expressed in terms
magnetic fields through Maxwell’s displacement
of the maximum magnetic field strength as
current explains the mechanism of
electromagnetic wave propagation, in which
changing magnetic fields produce changing
electric fields and vice versa.
• Although light was already known to be a wave, and in terms of both electric and magnetic fields as
the nature of the wave was not understood
before Maxwell. Maxwell’s equations also
predicted electromagnetic waves with
wavelengths and frequencies outside the range The three expressions for are all equivalent.
of light. These theoretical predictions were first
16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure
confirmed experimentally by Heinrich Hertz.
• Electromagnetic waves carry momentum and
16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves exert radiation pressure.
• Maxwell’s equations predict that the directions • The radiation pressure of an electromagnetic
of the electric and magnetic fields of the wave, wave is directly proportional to its energy
and the wave’s direction of propagation, are all density.
mutually perpendicular. The electromagnetic • The pressure is equal to twice the
wave is a transverse wave. electromagnetic energy intensity if the wave is
• The strengths of the electric and magnetic parts reflected and equal to the incident energy
of the wave are related by which intensity if the wave is absorbed.
implies that the magnetic field B is very weak
712 16 • Chapter Review

16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum speed of light.


• The electromagnetic spectrum is separated into
• The relationship among the speed of
many categories and subcategories, based on
propagation, wavelength, and frequency for any
the frequency and wavelength, source, and uses
wave is given by so that for
of the electromagnetic waves.
electromagnetic waves, where f is the
frequency, is the wavelength, and c is the

Conceptual Questions
16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and
Electromagnetic Waves
1. Explain how the displacement current maintains
the continuity of current in a circuit containing a
capacitor.
2. Describe the field lines of the induced magnetic field
along the edge of the imaginary horizontal cylinder
shown below if the cylinder is in a spatially uniform
electric field that is horizontal, pointing to the right,
and increasing in magnitude.

3. Why is it much easier to demonstrate in a


student lab that a changing magnetic field
induces an electric field than it is to demonstrate 6. In which situation shown below will the
that a changing electric field produces a electromagnetic wave be more successful in
magnetic field? inducing a current in the loop? Explain.

16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves


4. If the electric field of an electromagnetic wave is
oscillating along the z-axis and the magnetic field
is oscillating along the x-axis, in what possible
direction is the wave traveling?
5. In which situation shown below will the
electromagnetic wave be more successful in
inducing a current in the wire? Explain.

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 713

16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic


Waves
9. When you stand outdoors in the sunlight, why
can you feel the energy that the sunlight carries,
but not the momentum it carries?
10. How does the intensity of an electromagnetic
wave depend on its electric field? How does it
depend on its magnetic field?
11. What is the physical significance of the Poynting
vector?
12. A 2.0-mW helium-neon laser transmits a
continuous beam of red light of cross-sectional
area . If the beam does not diverge
appreciably, how would its rms electric field
vary with distance from the laser? Explain.

16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure


13. Why is the radiation pressure of an
electromagnetic wave on a perfectly reflecting
surface twice as large as the pressure on a
perfectly absorbing surface?
14. Why did the early Hubble Telescope photos of
Comet Ison approaching Earth show it to have
7. Under what conditions might wires in a circuit merely a fuzzy coma around it, and not the
where the current flows in only one direction pronounced double tail that developed later (see
emit electromagnetic waves? below)?
8. Shown below is the interference pattern of two
radio antennas broadcasting the same signal.
Explain how this is analogous to the interference
pattern for sound produced by two speakers.
Could this be used to make a directional antenna
system that broadcasts preferentially in certain
directions? Explain.

Figure 16.21 (credit: modification of work by NASA, ESA,


J.-Y. Li (Planetary Science Institute), and the Hubble Comet
ISON Imaging Science Team)

15. (a) If the electric field and magnetic field in a


sinusoidal plane wave were interchanged, in
which direction relative to before would the
energy propagate?
(b) What if the electric and the magnetic fields
were both changed to their negatives?
714 16 • Chapter Review

16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum 25. Radio waves normally have their E and B fields
in specific directions, whereas visible light
16. Compare the speed, wavelength, and frequency
usually has its E and B fields in random and
of radio waves and X-rays traveling in a vacuum.
rapidly changing directions that are
17. Accelerating electric charge emits
perpendicular to each other and to the
electromagnetic radiation. How does this apply
propagation direction. Can you explain why?
in each case: (a) radio waves, (b) infrared
26. Give an example of resonance in the reception
radiation.
of electromagnetic waves.
18. Compare and contrast the meaning of the prefix
27. Illustrate that the size of details of an object that
“micro” in the names of SI units in the term
can be detected with electromagnetic waves is
microwaves.
related to their wavelength, by comparing
19. Part of the light passing through the air is
details observable with two different types (for
scattered in all directions by the molecules
example, radar and visible light).
comprising the atmosphere. The wavelengths of
28. In which part of the electromagnetic spectrum
visible light are larger than molecular sizes, and
are each of these waves:
the scattering is strongest for wavelengths of
(a) f = 10.0 kHz, (b) ,
light closest to sizes of molecules.
(c) , (d) 0.30 nm
(a) Which of the main colors of light is scattered
29. In what range of electromagnetic radiation are
the most? (b) Explain why this would give the
the electromagnetic waves emitted by power
sky its familiar background color at midday.
lines in a country that uses 50-Hz ac current?
20. When a bowl of soup is removed from a
30. If a microwave oven could be modified to
microwave oven, the soup is found to be
merely tune the waves generated to be in the
steaming hot, whereas the bowl is only warm to
infrared range instead of using microwaves,
the touch. Discuss the temperature changes
how would this affect the uneven heating of the
that have occurred in terms of energy transfer.
oven?
21. Certain orientations of a broadcast television
31. A leaky microwave oven in a home can
antenna give better reception than others for a
sometimes cause interference with the
particular station. Explain.
homeowner’s WiFi system. Why?
22. What property of light corresponds to loudness
32. When a television news anchor in a studio
in sound?
speaks to a reporter in a distant country, there
23. Is the visible region a major portion of the
is sometimes a noticeable lag between when the
electromagnetic spectrum?
anchor speaks in the studio and when the
24. Can the human body detect electromagnetic
remote reporter hears it and replies. Explain
radiation that is outside the visible region of the
what causes this delay.
spectrum?

Problems
16.1 Maxwell’s Equations and charging.
Electromagnetic Waves (a) Obtain expressions for the leakage current
in the thin wire. Use these results to
33. Show that the magnetic field at a distance r from obtain an expression for the current in
the axis of two circular parallel plates, produced the wires connected to the capacitor.
by placing charge Q(t) on the plates is (b) Find the displacement current in the space
. between the plates from the changing electric
34. Express the displacement current in a capacitor field between the plates.
in terms of the capacitance and the rate of (c) Compare with the sum of the
change of the voltage across the capacitor. displacement current and resistor current
35. A potential difference is between the plates, and explain why the
maintained across a parallel-plate capacitor relationship you observe would be expected.
with capacitance C consisting of two circular 36. Suppose the parallel-plate capacitor shown below
parallel plates. A thin wire with resistance R is accumulating charge at a rate of 0.010 C/s.
connects the centers of the two plates, allowing What is the induced magnetic field at a distance of
charge to leak between plates while they are 10 cm from the capacitator?

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 715

where k is the wavenumber in rad/m, x is in m, t is in s.


Find the following quantities:
(a) amplitude
(b) frequency
(c) wavelength
(d) the direction of the travel of the wave
(e) the associated magnetic field wave
46. A plane electromagnetic wave of frequency 20
37. The potential difference V(t) between parallel
GHz moves in the positive y-axis direction such
plates shown above is instantaneously
that its electric field is pointed along the z-axis.
increasing at a rate of What is the
The amplitude of the electric field is 10 V/m.
displacement current between the plates if the
The start of time is chosen so that at , the
separation of the plates is 1.00 cm and they
electric field has a value 10 V/m at the origin. (a)
have an area of ? Write the wave function that will describe the
38. A parallel-plate capacitor has a plate area of electric field wave. (b) Find the wave function
and a separation of 0.0100 m. that will describe the associated magnetic field
What must be must be the angular frequency wave.
for a voltage with 47. The following represents an electromagnetic
to produce a maximum displacement induced wave traveling in the direction of the positive
current of 1.00 A between the plates? y-axis:
39. The voltage across a parallel-plate capacitor
with area and separation .
varies sinusoidally as
The wave is passing through a wide tube of
, where t is in seconds.
circular cross-section of radius R whose axis is
Find the displacement current between the
along the y-axis. Find the expression for the
plates.
displacement current through the tube.
40. The voltage across a parallel-plate capacitor
with area A and separation d varies with time t
16.3 Energy Carried by Electromagnetic
as , where a is a constant. Find the
displacement current between the plates.
Waves
48. While outdoors on a sunny day, a student holds
16.2 Plane Electromagnetic Waves a large convex lens of radius 4.0 cm above a
sheet of paper to produce a bright spot on the
41. If the Sun suddenly turned off, we would not
paper that is 1.0 cm in radius, rather than a
know it until its light stopped coming. How long
sharp focus. By what factor is the electric field
would that be, given that the Sun is
in the bright spot of light related to the electric
away?
field of sunlight leaving the side of the lens
42. What is the maximum electric field strength in
facing the paper?
an electromagnetic wave that has a maximum
49. A plane electromagnetic wave travels
magnetic field strength of (about
northward. At one instant, its electric field has a
10 times Earth’s magnetic field)?
magnitude of 6.0 V/m and points eastward.
43. An electromagnetic wave has a frequency of 12
What are the magnitude and direction of the
MHz. What is its wavelength in vacuum?
magnetic field at this instant?
44. If electric and magnetic field strengths vary
50. The electric field of an electromagnetic wave is given
sinusoidally in time at frequency 1.00 GHz,
by E =
being zero at , then and
. (a) When are the field
strengths next equal to zero? (b) When do they Write the equations for the associated magnetic field
reach their most negative value? (c) How much and Poynting vector.
time is needed for them to complete one cycle? 51. A radio station broadcasts at a frequency of 760
45. The electric field of an electromagnetic wave traveling kHz. At a receiver some distance from the
in vacuum is described by the following wave function: antenna, the maximum magnetic field of the
716 16 • Chapter Review

electromagnetic wave detected is magnetic field strength. (c) Find the peak
. electric field strength.
(a) What is the maximum electric field? (b) What 61. An AM radio transmitter broadcasts 50.0 kW of
is the wavelength of the electromagnetic wave? power uniformly in all directions. (a) Assuming
52. The filament in a clear incandescent light bulb all of the radio waves that strike the ground are
radiates visible light at a power of 5.00 W. Model completely absorbed, and that there is no
the glass part of the bulb as a sphere of radius absorption by the atmosphere or other objects,
and calculate the amount of what is the intensity 30.0 km away? (Hint: Half
electromagnetic energy from visible light inside the power will be spread over the area of a
the bulb. hemisphere.) (b) What is the maximum electric
53. At what distance does a 100-W lightbulb field strength at this distance?
produce the same intensity of light as a 75-W 62. Suppose the maximum safe intensity of
lightbulb produces 10 m away? (Assume both microwaves for human exposure is taken to be
have the same efficiency for converting . (a) If a radar unit leaks 10.0 W of
electrical energy in the circuit into emitted microwaves (other than those sent by its
electromagnetic energy.) antenna) uniformly in all directions, how far
54. An incandescent light bulb emits only 2.6 W of away must you be to be exposed to an intensity
its power as visible light. What is the rms considered to be safe? Assume that the power
electric field of the emitted light at a distance of spreads uniformly over the area of a sphere
3.0 m from the bulb? with no complications from absorption or
55. A 150-W lightbulb emits 5% of its energy as reflection. (b) What is the maximum electric
electromagnetic radiation. What is the field strength at the safe intensity? (Note that
magnitude of the average Poynting vector 10 m early radar units leaked more than modern
from the bulb? ones do. This caused identifiable health
56. A small helium-neon laser has a power output problems, such as cataracts, for people who
of 2.5 mW. What is the electromagnetic energy worked near them.)
in a 1.0-m length of the beam? 63. A 2.50-m-diameter university communications
57. At the top of Earth’s atmosphere, the time- satellite dish receives TV signals that have a
averaged Poynting vector associated with maximum electric field strength (for one channel) of
sunlight has a magnitude of about (see below). (a) What is the intensity of
(a) What are the maximum values of the electric this wave? (b) What is the power received by the
and magnetic fields for a wave of this intensity? antenna? (c) If the orbiting satellite broadcasts
(b) What is the total power radiated by the sun? uniformly over an area of (a large
Assume that the Earth is from the fraction of North America), how much power does it
Sun and that sunlight is composed of radiate?
electromagnetic plane waves.
58. The magnetic field of a plane electromagnetic
wave moving along the z axis is given by
, where
and

(a) Write an expression for the electric field


associated with the wave. (b) What are the
frequency and the wavelength of the wave? (c)
What is its average Poynting vector?
59. What is the intensity of an electromagnetic
wave with a peak electric field strength of 125 V/
m?
60. Assume the helium-neon lasers commonly used
in student physics laboratories have power
outputs of 0.500 mW. (a) If such a laser beam is
projected onto a circular spot 1.00 mm in
diameter, what is its intensity? (b) Find the peak

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 717

completely absorbed the ball?


69. Suppose that for sunlight at a point on the
surface of Earth is . (a) If sunlight falls
perpendicularly on a kite with a reflecting
surface of area , what is the average
force on the kite due to radiation pressure? (b)
How is your answer affected if the kite material
is black and absorbs all sunlight?
70. Sunlight reaches the ground with an intensity of
about . A sunbather has a body
surface area of facing the sun while
reclining on a beach chair on a clear day. (a)
how much energy from direct sunlight reaches
the sunbather’s skin per second? (b) What
pressure does the sunlight exert if it is
absorbed?
71. Suppose a spherical particle of mass m and
radius R in space absorbs light of intensity I for
time t. (a) How much work does the radiation
pressure do to accelerate the particle from rest
64. Lasers can be constructed that produce an
in the given time it absorbs the light? (b) How
extremely high intensity electromagnetic wave
much energy carried by the electromagnetic
for a brief time—called pulsed lasers. They are
waves is absorbed by the particle over this time
used to initiate nuclear fusion, for example.
based on the radiant energy incident on the
Such a laser may produce an electromagnetic
particle?
wave with a maximum electric field strength of
for a time of 1.00 ns. (a) What
16.5 The Electromagnetic Spectrum
is the maximum magnetic field strength in the
wave? (b) What is the intensity of the beam? (c) 72. How many helium atoms, each with a radius of
What energy does it deliver on an about 31 pm, must be placed end to end to have
area? a length equal to one wavelength of 470 nm blue
light?
16.4 Momentum and Radiation Pressure 73. If you wish to detect details of the size of atoms
(about 0.2 nm) with electromagnetic radiation,
65. A 150-W lightbulb emits 5% of its energy as
it must have a wavelength of about this size. (a)
electromagnetic radiation. What is the radiation
What is its frequency? (b) What type of
pressure on an absorbing sphere of radius 10 m
electromagnetic radiation might this be?
that surrounds the bulb?
74. Find the frequency range of visible light, given
66. What pressure does light emitted uniformly in
that it encompasses wavelengths from 380 to
all directions from a 100-W incandescent light
760 nm.
bulb exert on a mirror at a distance of 3.0 m, if
75. (a) Calculate the wavelength range for AM radio
2.6 W of the power is emitted as visible light?
given its frequency range is 540 to 1600 kHz. (b)
67. A microscopic spherical dust particle of radius
Do the same for the FM frequency range of 88.0
and mass is moving in outer space
to 108 MHz.
at a constant speed of 30 cm/sec. A wave of light
76. Radio station WWVB, operated by the National
strikes it from the opposite direction of its
Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST)
motion and gets absorbed. Assuming the
from Fort Collins, Colorado, at a low frequency
particle accelerates opposite to the motion
of 60 kHz, broadcasts a time synchronization
uniformly to zero speed in one second, what is
signal whose range covers the entire
the average electric field amplitude in the light?
continental US. The timing of the
68. A Styrofoam spherical ball of radius 2 mm and
synchronization signal is controlled by a set of
mass is to be suspended by the radiation
atomic clocks to an accuracy of
pressure in a vacuum tube in a lab. How much
and repeats every 1 minute. The signal is used
intensity will be required if the light is
718 16 • Chapter Review

for devices, such as radio-controlled watches, frequency


that automatically synchronize with it at preset 82. For red light of , what are f, , and
local times. WWVB’s long wavelength signal k?
tends to propagate close to the ground. 83. A radio transmitter broadcasts plane
(a) Calculate the wavelength of the radio waves electromagnetic waves whose maximum
from WWVB. electric field at a particular location is
(b) Estimate the error that the travel time of the What is the maximum
signal causes in synchronizing a radio magnitude of the oscillating magnetic field at
controlled watch in Norfolk, Virginia, which is that location? How does it compare with Earth’s
1570 mi (2527 km) from Fort Collins, Colorado. magnetic field?
77. An outdoor WiFi unit for a picnic area has a 84. (a) Two microwave frequencies authorized for
100-mW output and a range of about 30 m. use in microwave ovens are: 915 and 2450 MHz.
What output power would reduce its range to 12 Calculate the wavelength of each. (b) Which
m for use with the same devices as before? frequency would produce smaller hot spots in
Assume there are no obstacles in the way and foods due to interference effects?
that microwaves into the ground are simply 85. During normal beating, the heart creates a
absorbed. maximum 4.00-mV potential across 0.300 m of
78. 7. The prefix “mega” (M) and “kilo” (k), when a person’s chest, creating a 1.00-Hz
referring to amounts of computer data, refer to electromagnetic wave. (a) What is the maximum
factors of 1024 or rather than 1000 for the electric field strength created? (b) What is the
prefix kilo, and rather than corresponding maximum magnetic field
1,000,000 for the prefix Mega (M). If a wireless strength in the electromagnetic wave? (c) What
(WiFi) router transfers 150 Mbps of data, how is the wavelength of the electromagnetic wave?
many bits per second is that in decimal 86. Distances in space are often quoted in units of
arithmetic? light-years, the distance light travels in 1 year.
79. A computer user finds that his wireless router (a) How many meters is a light-year? (b) How
transmits data at a rate of 75 Mbps (megabits many meters is it to Andromeda, the nearest
per second). Compare the average time to large galaxy, given that it is ly away?
transmit one bit of data with the time difference (c) The most distant galaxy yet discovered is
between the wifi signal reaching an observer’s ly away. How far is this in meters?
cell phone directly and by bouncing back to the 87. A certain 60.0-Hz ac power line radiates an
observer from a wall 8.00 m past the observer. electromagnetic wave having a maximum
80. (a) The ideal size (most efficient) for a broadcast electric field strength of 13.0 kV/m. (a) What is
antenna with one end on the ground is one- the wavelength of this very-low-frequency
fourth the wavelength ( ) of the electromagnetic wave? (b) What type of
electromagnetic radiation being sent out. If a electromagnetic radiation is this wave (b) What
new radio station has such an antenna that is is its maximum magnetic field strength?
50.0 m high, what frequency does it broadcast 88. (a) What is the frequency of the 193-nm
most efficiently? Is this in the AM or FM band? ultraviolet radiation used in laser eye surgery?
(b) Discuss the analogy of the fundamental (b) Assuming the accuracy with which this
resonant mode of an air column closed at one electromagnetic radiation can ablate (reshape)
end to the resonance of currents on an antenna the cornea is directly proportional to
that is one-fourth their wavelength. wavelength, how much more accurate can this
81. What are the wavelengths of (a) X-rays of UV radiation be than the shortest visible
frequency (b) Yellow light of wavelength of light?
frequency (c) Gamma rays of

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 719

Additional Problems
89. In a region of space, the electric field is pointed 95. Electromagnetic radiation from a 5.00-mW
along the x-axis, but its magnitude changes as laser is concentrated on a area. (a)
described by What is the intensity in ? (b) Suppose a
2.00-nC electric charge is in the beam. What is
the maximum electric force it experiences? (c) If
where t is in nanoseconds and x is in cm. Find the electric charge moves at 400 m/s, what
the displacement current through a circle of maximum magnetic force can it feel?
radius 3 cm in the plane at . 96. A 200-turn flat coil of wire 30.0 cm in diameter
90. A microwave oven uses electromagnetic waves acts as an antenna for FM radio at a frequency
of frequency to heat foods. of 100 MHz. The magnetic field of the incoming
The waves reflect from the inside walls of the electromagnetic wave is perpendicular to the
oven to produce an interference pattern of coil and has a maximum strength of
standing waves whose antinodes are hot spots . (a) What power is incident on
that can leave observable pit marks in some the coil? (b) What average emf is induced in the
foods. The pit marks are measured to be 6.0 cm coil over one-fourth of a cycle? (c) If the radio
apart. Use the method employed by Heinrich receiver has an inductance of , what
Hertz to calculate the speed of electromagnetic capacitance must it have to resonate at 100
waves this implies. MHz?
Use the Appendix D for the next two exercises 97. Suppose a source of electromagnetic waves
radiates uniformly in all directions in empty
91. Galileo proposed measuring the speed of light
space where there are no absorption or
by uncovering a lantern and having an assistant
interference effects. (a) Show that the intensity
a known distance away uncover his lantern
is inversely proportional to , the distance
when he saw the light from Galileo’s lantern,
from the source squared. (b) Show that the
and timing the delay. How far away must the
magnitudes of the electric and magnetic fields
assistant be for the delay to equal the human
are inversely proportional to r.
reaction time of about 0.25 s?
98. A radio station broadcasts its radio waves with a
92. Show that the wave equation in one dimension
power of 50,000 W. What would be the intensity
of this signal if it is received on a planet orbiting
is satisfied by any doubly differentiable function Proxima Centuri, the closest star to our Sun, at
of either the form or . 4.243 ly away?
93. On its highest power setting, a microwave oven 99. The Poynting vector describes a flow of energy
increases the temperature of 0.400 kg of whenever electric and magnetic fields are
spaghetti by in 120 s. (a) What was the present. Consider a long cylindrical wire of
rate of energy absorption by the spaghetti, given radius r with a current I in the wire, with
resistance R and voltage V. From the
that its specific heat is ?
expressions for the electric field along the wire
Assume the spaghetti is perfectly absorbing. (b)
and the magnetic field around the wire, obtain
Find the average intensity of the microwaves,
the magnitude and direction of the Poynting
given that they are absorbed over a circular area
vector at the surface. Show that it accounts for
20.0 cm in diameter. (c) What is the peak
an energy flow into the wire from the fields
electric field strength of the microwave? (d)
around it that accounts for the Ohmic heating of
What is its peak magnetic field strength?
the wire.
94. A certain microwave oven projects 1.00 kW of
microwaves onto a 30-cm-by-40-cm area. (a)
What is its intensity in ? (b) Calculate the
maximum electric field strength in these
waves. (c) What is the maximum magnetic field
strength ?
720 16 • Chapter Review

100. The Sun’s energy strikes Earth at an intensity 103. Radar is used to determine distances to
of . Assume as a model various objects by measuring the round-trip
approximation that all of the light is absorbed. time for an echo from the object. (a) How far
(Actually, about 30% of the light intensity is away is the planet Venus if the echo time is
reflected out into space.) 1000 s? (b) What is the echo time for a car 75.0
(a) Calculate the total force that the Sun’s m from a highway police radar unit? (c) How
radiation exerts on Earth. accurately (in nanoseconds) must you be able
(b) Compare this to the force of gravity to measure the echo time to an airplane 12.0
between the Sun and Earth. km away to determine its distance within 10.0
Earth’s mass is m?
101. If a Lightsail spacecraft were sent on a Mars 104. Calculate the ratio of the highest to lowest
mission, by what ratio of the final force to the frequencies of electromagnetic waves the eye
initial force would its propulsion be reduced can see, given the wavelength range of visible
when it reached Mars? light is from 380 to 760 nm. (Note that the
102. Lunar astronauts placed a reflector on the ratio of highest to lowest frequencies the ear
Moon’s surface, off which a laser beam is can hear is 1000.)
periodically reflected. The distance to the 105. How does the wavelength of radio waves for an
Moon is calculated from the round-trip time. AM radio station broadcasting at 1030 KHz
(a) To what accuracy in meters can the compare with the wavelength of the lowest
distance to the Moon be determined, if this audible sound waves (of 20 Hz). The speed of
time can be measured to 0.100 ns? (b) What sound in air at is about 343 m/s.
percent accuracy is this, given the average
distance to the Moon is 384,400 km?

Access for free at openstax.org.


16 • Chapter Review 721

Challenge Problems
106. A parallel-plate capacitor with plate separation d 107. A particle of cosmic dust has a density
is connected to a source of emf that places a time- (a) Assuming the dust particles
dependent voltage V(t) across its circular plates of are spherical and light absorbing, and are at
radius and area (see below). the same distance as Earth from the Sun,
determine the particle size for which radiation
pressure from sunlight is equal to the Sun’s
force of gravity on the dust particle. (b) Explain
how the forces compare if the particle radius is
smaller. (c) Explain what this implies about the
sizes of dust particle likely to be present in the
inner solar system compared with outside the
(a) Write an expression for the time rate of change
Oort cloud.
of energy inside the capacitor in terms of V(t) and
dV(t)/dt.
(b) Assuming that V(t) is increasing with time,
identify the directions of the electric field lines
inside the capacitor and of the magnetic field
lines at the edge of the region between the plates,
and then the direction of the Poynting vector at
this location.
(c) Obtain expressions for the time dependence of
E(t), for B(t) from the displacement current, and
for the magnitude of the Poynting vector at the
edge of the region between the plates.
(d) From , obtain an expression in terms of V(t)
and dV(t)/dt for the rate at which electromagnetic
field energy enters the region between the plates.
(e) Compare the results of parts (a) and (d) and
explain the relationship between them.
722 16 • Chapter Review

Access for free at openstax.org.


A • Units 723

APPENDIX A
Units
Quantity Common Symbol Unit Unit in Terms of Base SI Units

Acceleration m/s2 m/s2

Amount of substance n mole mol

Angle radian (rad)

Angular acceleration rad/s2 s−2

Angular frequency rad/s s−1

Angular momentum

Angular velocity rad/s s−1

Area A m2 m2

Atomic number Z

Capacitance C farad (F)

Charge q, Q, e coulomb (C)

Charge density:

Line C/m

Surface C/m2

Volume C/m3

Conductivity

Current I ampere A

Current density A/m2 A/m2

Density kg/m3 kg/m3

Dielectric constant

Electric dipole moment


724 A • Units

Quantity Common Symbol Unit Unit in Terms of Base SI Units

Electric field N/C

Electric flux

Electromotive force volt (V)

Energy E,U,K joule (J)

Entropy S J/K

Force newton (N)

Frequency f hertz (Hz) s−1

Heat Q joule (J)

Inductance L henry (H)

Length: meter m

Displacement

Distance d, h

Position

Magnetic dipole moment

Magnetic field tesla (T)

Magnetic flux weber (Wb)

Mass m, M kilogram kg

Molar specific heat C

Moment of inertia I

Momentum

Period T s s

Permeability of free space

Permittivity of free space

Potential V volt (V)

Access for free at openstax.org.


A • Units 725

Quantity Common Symbol Unit Unit in Terms of Base SI Units

Power P watt (W)

Pressure p pastcal (P)

Resistance R ohm (Ω)

Specific heat c

Speed m/s m/s

Temperature T kelvin K

Time t second s

Torque

Velocity m/s m/s

Volume V m3 m3

Wavelength m m

Work W joule (J)

Table A1 Units Used in Physics (Fundamental units in bold)


726 A • Units

Access for free at openstax.org.


B • Conversion Factors 727

APPENDIX B
Conversion Factors
m cm km

1 meter 1 102 10−3

1 centimeter 10−2 1 10−5

1 kilometer 103 105 1

1 inch 2.540

1 foot 0.3048 30.48

1 mile 1609 1.609

1 angstrom 10−10

1 fermi 10−15

1 light-year

in. ft mi

1 meter 39.37 3.281

1 centimeter 0.3937

1 kilometer 0.6214

1 inch 1

1 foot 12 1

1 mile 5280 1

Table B1 Length

Area

Volume
728 B • Conversion Factors

s min h day yr

1 second 1

1 minute 60 1

1 hour 3600 60 1

1 day 1440 24 1

1 year 365.25 1

Table B2 Time

m/s cm/s ft/s mi/h

1 meter/second 1 102 3.281 2.237

1 centimeter/second 10−2 1

1 foot/second 0.3048 30.48 1 0.6818

1 mile/hour 0.4470 44.70 1.467 1

Table B3 Speed

Acceleration

kg g slug u

1 kilogram 1 103

1 gram 10−3 1

1 slug 14.59 1

1 atomic mass unit 1

1 metric ton 1000

Table B4 Mass

Access for free at openstax.org.


B • Conversion Factors 729

N dyne lb

newton 1 105 0.2248

dyne 10−5 1

pound 4.448 1

Table B5 Force

Pa dyne/cm2 atm cmHg lb/in.2

1 pascal 1 10

1 dyne/centimeter2 10−1 1

1 atmosphere 1 76 14.70

1 centimeter mercury* 1 0.1934

1 pound/inch2 5.171 1

1 bar 105

1 torr 1 (mmHg)

*Where the acceleration due to gravity is and the temperature is

Table B6 Pressure

J erg ft.lb

1 joule 1 107 0.7376

1 erg 10−7 1

1 foot-pound 1.356 1

1 electron-volt

1 calorie 4.186 3.088

1 British thermal unit

1 kilowatt-hour

eV cal Btu

1 joule 0.2389

1 erg
730 B • Conversion Factors

J erg ft.lb

1 foot-pound 0.3239

1 electron-volt 1

1 calorie 1

1 British thermal unit 1

Table B7 Work, Energy, Heat

Power

Angle

Access for free at openstax.org.


C • Fundamental Constants 731

APPENDIX C
Fundamental Constants
Quantity Symbol Value

Atomic mass unit u

Avogadro’s number


Bohr magneton


Bohr radius

Boltzmann’s constant

Compton wavelength

Coulomb constant

Deuteron mass

Electron mass

Electron volt eV

Elementary charge e

Gas constant R

Gravitational constant G

Neutron mass
732 C • Fundamental Constants

Quantity Symbol Value


Nuclear magneton

Permeability of free space

Permittivity of free space

h
Planck’s constant

Proton mass

Rydberg constant

Speed of light in vacuum c

Table C1 Fundamental Constants Note: These constants are the values recommended in 2006 by CODATA,
based on a least-squares adjustment of data from different measurements. The numbers in parentheses for
the values represent the uncertainties of the last two digits.

Useful combinations of constants for calculations:

Access for free at openstax.org.


D • Astronomical Data 733

APPENDIX D
Astronomical Data
Celestial Mean Distance from Period of Revolution (d = Period of Rotation Eccentricity
Object Sun (million km) days) (y = years) at Equator of Orbit

Sun − − 27 d −

Mercury 57.9 88 d 59 d 0.206

Venus 108.2 224.7 d 243 d 0.007

Earth 149.6 365.25 d 23 h 56 min 4 s 0.017

Mars 227.9 687 d 24 h 37 min 23 s 0.093

Jupiter 778.4 11.9 y 9 h 50 min 30 s 0.048

Saturn 1426.7 29.5 y 10 h 14 min 0.054

Uranus 2871.0 84.0 y 17 h 14 min 0.047

Neptune 4498.3 164.8 y 16 h 0.009

Earth’s
149.6 (0.386 from Earth) 27.3 d 27.3 d 0.055
Moon

Celestial Equatorial Diameter


Mass (Earth = 1) Density (g/cm3)
Object (km)

Sun 1,392,000 333,000.00 1.4

Mercury 4879 0.06 5.4

Venus 12,104 0.82 5.2

Earth 12,756 1.00 5.5

Mars 6794 0.11 3.9

Jupiter 142,984 317.83 1.3

Saturn 120,536 95.16 0.7

Uranus 51,118 14.54 1.3

Neptune 49,528 17.15 1.6


734 D • Astronomical Data

Celestial Mean Distance from Period of Revolution (d = Period of Rotation Eccentricity


Object Sun (million km) days) (y = years) at Equator of Orbit

Earth’s
3476 0.01 3.3
Moon

Table D1 Astronomical Data

Other Data:

Mass of Earth:

Mass of the Moon:

Mass of the Sun:

Access for free at openstax.org.


E • Mathematical Formulas 735

APPENDIX E
Mathematical Formulas
Quadratic formula

If then

Triangle of base and height Area

Circle of radius Circumference Area

Sphere of radius Surface area Volume

Cylinder of radius and height Area of curved surface Volume

Table E1 Geometry

Trigonometry

Trigonometric Identities

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.

Triangles

1. Law of sines:
2. Law of cosines:
736 E • Mathematical Formulas

3. Pythagorean theorem:

Series expansions

1. Binomial theorem:

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.
8.

Derivatives

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.

Access for free at openstax.org.


E • Mathematical Formulas 737

13.
14.

15.

16.

Integrals

1.

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

9.

10.

11.

12.

13.

14.

15.

16.

17.

18.
738 E • Mathematical Formulas

Access for free at openstax.org.


F • Chemistry 739

APPENDIX F
Chemistry
740 F • Chemistry

Access for free at openstax.org.


G • The Greek Alphabet 741

APPENDIX G
The Greek Alphabet
Name Capital Lowercase Name Capital Lowercase

Alpha A Nu N

Beta B Xi

Gamma Omicron O

Delta Pi

Epsilon E Rho P

Zeta Z Sigma

Eta H Tau T

Theta Upsilon

lota I Phi

Kappa K Chi X

Lambda Psi

Mu M Omega

Table G1 The Greek Alphabet


742

ANSWER KEY
Chapter 1
Check Your Understanding
1.1 The actual amount (mass) of gasoline left in the tank when the gauge hits “empty” is less in the summer
than in the winter. The gasoline has the same volume as it does in the winter when the “add fuel” light
goes on, but because the gasoline has expanded, there is less mass.
1.2 Not necessarily, as the thermal stress is also proportional to Young’s modulus.
1.3 To a good approximation, the heat transfer depends only on the temperature difference. Since the
temperature differences are the same in both cases, the same 25 kJ is necessary in the second case. (As
we will see in the next section, the answer would have been different if the object had been made of some
substance that changes phase anywhere between and .)
1.4 The ice and liquid water are in thermal equilibrium, so that the temperature stays at the freezing
temperature as long as ice remains in the liquid. (Once all of the ice melts, the water temperature will start
to rise.)
1.5 Snow is formed from ice crystals and thus is the solid phase of water. Because enormous heat is necessary
for phase changes, it takes a certain amount of time for this heat to be transferred from the air, even if the
air is above .
1.6 Conduction: Heat transfers into your hands as you hold a hot cup of coffee. Convection: Heat transfers as
the barista “steams” cold milk to make hot cocoa. Radiation: Heat transfers from the Sun to a jar of water
with tea leaves in it to make “Sun tea.” A great many other answers are possible.
1.7 Because area is the product of two spatial dimensions, it increases by a factor of four when each
dimension is doubled . The distance, however, simply doubles. Because
the temperature difference and the coefficient of thermal conductivity are independent of the spatial
dimensions, the rate of heat transfer by conduction increases by a factor of four divided by two, or two:
.
1.8 Using a fan increases the flow of air: Warm air near your body is replaced by cooler air from elsewhere.
Convection increases the rate of heat transfer so that moving air “feels” cooler than still air.
1.9 The radiated heat is proportional to the fourth power of the absolute temperature. Because
and , the rate of heat transfer increases by about 30% of the original rate.

Conceptual Questions
1. They are at the same temperature, and if they are placed in contact, no net heat flows between them.
3. The reading will change.
5. The cold water cools part of the inner surface, making it contract, while the rest remains expanded. The
strain is too great for the strength of the material. Pyrex contracts less, so it experiences less strain.
7. In principle, the lid expands more than the jar because metals have higher coefficients of expansion than
glass. That should make unscrewing the lid easier. (In practice, getting the lid and jar wet may make
gripping them more difficult.)
9. After being heated, the length is ( )( ). After being cooled, the length is
. That answer is not 1 m, but it should be. The explanation is that even if is
exactly constant, the relation is strictly true only in the limit of small . Since values are
small, the discrepancy is unimportant in practice.
11. Temperature differences cause heat transfer.
13. No, it is stored as thermal energy. A thermodynamic system does not have a well-defined quantity of heat.
15. It raises the boiling point, so the water, which the food gains heat from, is at a higher temperature.
17. Yes, by raising the pressure above 56 atm.
19. work
21. (at or near atmospheric pressure)

Access for free at openstax.org.


743

23. Condensation releases heat, so it speeds up the melting.


25. Because of water’s high specific heat, it changes temperature less than land. Also, evaporation reduces
temperature rises. The air tends to stay close to equilibrium with the water, so its temperature does not
change much where there’s a lot of water around, as in San Francisco but not Sacramento.
27. The liquid is oxygen, whose boiling point is above that of nitrogen but whose melting point is below the
boiling point of liquid nitrogen. The crystals that sublime are carbon dioxide, which has no liquid phase at
atmospheric pressure. The crystals that melt are water, whose melting point is above carbon dioxide’s
sublimation point. The water came from the instructor’s breath.
29. Increasing circulation to the surface will warm the person, as the temperature of the water is warmer than
human body temperature. Sweating will cause no evaporative cooling under water or in the humid air
immediately above the tub.
31. It spread the heat over the area above the heating elements, evening the temperature there, but does not
spread the heat much beyond the heating elements.
33. Heat is conducted from the fire through the fire box to the circulating air and then convected by the air
into the room (forced convection).
35. The tent is heated by the Sun and transfers heat to you by all three processes, especially radiation.
37. If shielded, it measures the air temperature. If not, it measures the combined effect of air temperature and
net radiative heat gain from the Sun.
39. Turn the thermostat down. To have the house at the normal temperature, the heating system must replace
all the heat that was lost. For all three mechanisms of heat transfer, the greater the temperature difference
between inside and outside, the more heat is lost and must be replaced. So the house should be at the
lowest temperature that does not allow freezing damage.
41. Air is a good insulator, so there is little conduction, and the heated air rises, so there is little convection
downward.

Problems
43. That must be Celsius. Your Fahrenheit temperature is Yes, it is time to get treatment.
45. a. ; b. We know that . We also know that and
So, substituting, we have . Partially solving and
rearranging the equation, we have . Therefore, .
47. a. ; b. 575 K
49. Using Table 1.2 to find the coefficient of thermal expansion of marble:
.
(Answer rounded to five significant figures to show the slight difference in height.)
51. We use instead of since this is a volume expansion with constant surface area. Therefore:
.
53. On the warmer day, our tape measure will expand linearly. Therefore, each measured dimension will be
smaller than the actual dimension of the land. Calling these measured dimensions and , we will find a
new area, A. Let’s calculate these measured dimensions:
;
;
Cost change .
Because the area gets smaller, the price of the land decreases by about $17,000.
55. a. Use Table 1.2 to find the coefficients of thermal expansion of steel and aluminum. Then
.
b. By the same method with , we have .
57.
59. If we start with the freezing of water, then it would expand to
744

of ice.

61.
63. ; a. ; b. ; c. ; d.
65. . It is copper.
67. a. ;

; b. which is consistent with our results to part (a),


to one significant figure.
69.
71. It should be lower. The beaker will not make much difference:
73. a. ; b. ; c. The ice is much more effective in absorbing heat because it first must
be melted, which requires a lot of energy, and then it gains the same amount of heat as the bag that started
with water. The first of heat is used to melt the ice, then it absorbs the of heat as
water.
75. 58.1 g
77. Let M be the mass of pool water and m be the mass of pool water that evaporates.
;

(Note that for water at is used here as a better approximation than for water.)
79. a. ; b. ; c. 48.5 y
81. a. 9.35 L; b. Crude oil is less dense than water, so it floats on top of the water, thereby exposing it to the
oxygen in the air, which it uses to burn. Also, if the water is under the oil, it is less able to absorb the heat
generated by the oil.
83. a. 319 kcal; b.
85. First bring the ice up to and melt it with heat 4.74 kcal. This lowers the temperature of water by
. Now, the heat lost by the hot water equals that gained by the cold water ( is the final
temperature):
87. Let the subscripts r, e, v, and w represent rock, equilibrium, vapor, and water, respectively.
;

89. a. ; b. One 1-kilowatt room heater is needed.


91. 84.0 W
93. 2.59 kg
95. a. 39.7 W; b. 820 kcal
97. , so that

This gives 0.0288 wall: window, or 35:1 window: wall


99.

Access for free at openstax.org.


745

101. We found in the preceding problem that as baseline energy use. So the total heat loss
during this period is . At the
cost of $1/MJ, the cost is $1960. From an earlier problem, the savings is 12% or $235/y. We need
of insulation in the attic. At , this is a $500 cost. So the payback period is
(excluding labor costs).

Additional Problems
103.
105. .
107. a. cm; b. cm
109.
111. a. ; b. ; c.
113. . All of the ice melted.
115. , all the ice melted
117. a. 83 W; b. ; The single-pane window has a rate of heat conduction equal to 1969/83, or 24
times that of a double-pane window.
119. The rate of heat transfer by conduction is 20.0 W. On a daily basis, this is 1,728 kJ/day. Daily food intake
is . So only 17.2% of energy intake goes as heat transfer by
conduction to the environment at this .
121. 620 K

Challenge Problems
123. Denoting the period by P, we know When the temperature increases by dT, the length
increases by . Then the new length is a.

by the binomial expansion. b. The clock runs slower, as its new period is 1.00019 s. It loses 16.4 s per
day.
125. The amount of heat to melt the ice and raise it to is not enough to condense the steam, but it is
more than enough to lower the steam’s temperature by , so the final state will consist of steam and
liquid water in equilibrium, and the final temperature is ; 9.5 g of steam condenses, so the final
state contains 49.5 g of steam and 40.5 g of liquid water.
127. a. ; b. ; c. yes
129. a. ; b. ; c. ; d. ; e. ; f.

Chapter 2
Check Your Understanding
2.1 We first need to calculate the molar mass (the mass of one mole) of niacin. To do this, we must multiply
the number of atoms of each element in the molecule by the element’s molar mass.

Then we need to calculate the number of moles in 14 mg.

Then, we use Avogadro’s number to calculate the number of molecules:

2.2 The density of a gas is equal to a constant, the average molecular mass, times the number density N/V.
From the ideal gas law, we see that Therefore, at constant temperature, if the
density and, consequently, the number density are reduced by half, the pressure must also be reduced by
half, and
746

2.3 Density is mass per unit volume, and volume is proportional to the size of a body (such as the radius of a
sphere) cubed. So if the distance between molecules increases by a factor of 10, then the volume occupied
increases by a factor of 1000, and the density decreases by a factor of 1000. Since we assume molecules
are in contact in liquids and solids, the distance between their centers is on the order of their typical size,
so the distance in gases is on the order of 10 times as great.
2.4 Yes. Such fluctuations actually occur for a body of any size in a gas, but since the numbers of molecules
are immense for macroscopic bodies, the fluctuations are a tiny percentage of the number of collisions,
and the averages spoken of in this section vary imperceptibly. Roughly speaking, the fluctuations are
inversely proportional to the square root of the number of collisions, so for small bodies, they can become
significant. This was actually observed in the nineteenth century for pollen grains in water and is known
as Brownian motion.
2.5 In a liquid, the molecules are very close together, constantly colliding with one another. For a gas to be
nearly ideal, as air is under ordinary conditions, the molecules must be very far apart. Therefore the mean
free path is much longer in the air.
2.6 As the number of moles is equal and we know the molar heat capacities of the two gases are equal, the
temperature is halfway between the initial temperatures, 300 K.

Conceptual Questions
1. 2 moles, as that will contain twice as many molecules as the 1 mole of oxygen
3. pressure
5. The flame contains hot gas (heated by combustion). The pressure is still atmospheric pressure, in
mechanical equilibrium with the air around it (or roughly so). The density of the hot gas is proportional to
its number density N/V (neglecting the difference in composition between the gas in the flame and the
surrounding air). At higher temperature than the surrounding air, the ideal gas law says that
is less than that of the surrounding air. Therefore the hot air has lower density than the surrounding air and
is lifted by the buoyant force.
7. The mean free path is inversely proportional to the square of the radius, so it decreases by a factor of 4. The
mean free time is proportional to the mean free path and inversely proportional to the rms speed, which in
turn is inversely proportional to the square root of the mass. That gives a factor of in the numerator, so
the mean free time decreases by a factor of
9. Since they’re more massive, their gravity is stronger, so the escape velocity from them is higher. Since
they’re farther from the Sun, they’re colder, so the speeds of atmospheric molecules including hydrogen
and helium are lower. The combination of those facts means that relatively few hydrogen and helium
molecules have escaped from the outer planets.
11. One where nitrogen is stored, as excess will cause a feeling of suffocating, but excess nitrogen and
insufficient oxygen will not.
13. Less, because at lower temperatures their heat capacity was only 3RT/2.
15. a. false; b. true; c. true; d. true
17. 1200 K

Problems
19. a. 0.137 atm; b. Because of the expansion of the glass, .
Multiplying by that factor does not make any significant difference.
21. a. b. 0.227 mol; c. molecules for the nitrogen, molecules for
the carbon dioxide
23.
25.
27.
29. 6.86 atm
31. a. b. c. 2.15 K; d. no
33. 40.7 km

Access for free at openstax.org.


747

35. a. 0.61 N; b. 0.20 Pa


37. a. 5.88 m/s; b. 5.89 m/s
39. 177 m/s
41.
43. a. 0.0352 mol; b. c. 139 J
45. 21.1 kPa
47. 458 K
49.
51. a. 1.004; b. 764 K; c. This temperature is equivalent to , which is high but not impossible to achieve.
Thus, this process is feasible. At this temperature, however, there may be other considerations that make
the process difficult. (In general, uranium enrichment by gaseous diffusion is indeed difficult and requires
many passes.)
53. 65 mol
55. a. 0.76 atm; b. 0.29 atm; c. The pressure there is barely above the quickly fatal level.
57. ; Yes, that’s an impractically high temperature.
59. polyatomic
61.
63.
65.
67. 0.00157
69. About 0.072. Answers may vary slightly. A more accurate answer is 0.074.
71. a. 419 m/s; b. 472 m/s; c. 513 m/s
73. 541 K
75. 2400 K for all three parts

Additional Problems
77. a. ; b.
79. 7.9 m
81. a. supercritical fluid; b.
83.
85. a. b.
87. 8.2 mm
89. a. ; b.
91. or about 1.10
93. a. 411 m/s; b. According to Table 2.3, the of is significantly different from the theoretical value, so
the ideal gas model does not describe it very well at room temperature and pressure, and the Maxwell-
Boltzmann speed distribution for ideal gases may not hold very well, even less well at a lower
temperature.

Challenge Problems
95. 29.5 N/m

97. Substituting and gives


∞ ∞

99. Making the scaling transformation as in the previous problems, we find that
∞ ∞
748

As in the previous problem, we integrate by parts:


∞ ∞ ∞

Again, the first term is 0, and we were given in an earlier problem that the integral in the second term

equals . We now have

Taking the square root of both sides gives the desired result: .

Chapter 3
Check Your Understanding
3.1
3.2 Line 1, line 2, and line 3, and and line 4,
and
3.3 So that the process is represented by the curve on the pV plot for the evaluation of work.
3.4

Conceptual Questions
1. a. SE; b. ES; c. ES
3. Some of the energy goes into changing the phase of the liquid to gas.
5. Yes, as long as the work done equals the heat added there will be no change in internal energy and thereby
no change in temperature. When water freezes or when ice melts while removing or adding heat,
respectively, the temperature remains constant.
7. If more work is done on the system than heat added, the internal energy of the system will actually
decrease.
9. The system must be in contact with a heat source that allows heat to flow into the system.
11. Isothermal processes must be slow to make sure that as heat is transferred, the temperature does not
change. Even for isobaric and isochoric processes, the system must be in thermal equilibrium with slow
changes of thermodynamic variables.
13. Typically is greater than because when expansion occurs under constant pressure, it does work on
the surroundings. Therefore, heat can go into internal energy and work. Under constant volume, all heat
goes into internal energy. In this example, water contracts upon heating, so if we add heat at constant
pressure, work is done on the water by surroundings and therefore, is less than .
15. No, it is always greater than 1.
17. An adiabatic process has a change in temperature but no heat flow. The isothermal process has no change
in temperature but has heat flow.

Problems
19. is the temperature scale desired and mirrors the ideal gas if under constant volume.
21.
23. 74 K
25. 0.31
27. pVln(4)
29. a. 160 J; b. –160 J
31.

Access for free at openstax.org.


749

33.
35. a. 1:1; b. 10:1
37. a. 600 J; b. 0; c. 500 J; d. 200 J; e. 800 J; f. 500 J
39. 580 J
41. a. 600 J; b. 600 J; c. 800 J
43. a. 0; b. 160 J; c. –160 J
45. a. 20 J; b. 90 J
47. No work is done and they reach the same common temperature.
49. 54,500 J
51. a. ; b. ; c. the sum of parts (a) and (b);
d. and
53. a.

;
b.
55. a. 1660 J; b. −2730 J; c. It does not depend on the process.
57. a. 700 J; b. 500 J
59. a. −3 400 J; b. 3400 J enters the gas
61. 100 J
63. a. 370 J; b. 100 J; c. 500 J
65. 850 J
67. pressure decreased by 0.31 times the original pressure
69.
750

71. 84 K
73. An adiabatic expansion has less work done and no heat flow, thereby a lower internal energy comparing to
an isothermal expansion which has both heat flow and work done. Temperature decreases during
adiabatic expansion.
75. Isothermal has a greater final pressure and does not depend on the type of gas.
77.

Additional Problems
79. a. b. c.
d. e. No, because heat was added for both parts AD and DC. There is not
enough information to figure out how much is from each segment of the path.
81. 300 J
83. a. 59.5 J; b. 170 N
85.
87. a. 15,000 J; b. 10,000 J; c. 25,000 J
89. 78 J
91. A cylinder containing three moles of nitrogen gas is heated at a constant pressure of 2 atm. a. −1220 J; b.
+1220 J
93. a. 7.6 L, 61.6 K; b. 81.3 K; c. ; d. −367 J

Challenge Problems
95. a. 1700 J; b. 1200 J; c. 2400 J
97. a. 2.2 mol; b. , ; c. ; d. 30,500 J

Chapter 4
Check Your Understanding
4.1 A perfect heat engine would have , which would lead to A perfect refrigerator

Access for free at openstax.org.


751

would need zero work, that is, , which leads to ∞


4.2 From the engine on the right, we have From the refrigerator on the right, we have
Thus,
4.3 a. ; b. ; c. ; d. and
4.4 a. ; b. ; c.
4.5 When heat flows from the reservoir to the ice, the internal (mainly kinetic) energy of the ice goes up,
resulting in a higher average speed and thus an average greater position variance of the molecules in the
ice. The reservoir does become more ordered, but due to its much larger amount of molecules, it does not
offset the change in entropy in the system.
4.6 ; ; and
4.7 a. 4.71 J/K; b. −4.18 J/K; c. 0.53 J/K

Conceptual Questions
1. Some possible solutions are frictionless movement; restrained compression or expansion; energy transfer
as heat due to infinitesimal temperature nonuniformity; electric current flow through a zero resistance;
restrained chemical reaction; and mixing of two samples of the same substance at the same state.
3. The temperature increases since the heat output behind the refrigerator is greater than the cooling from
the inside of the refrigerator.
5. If we combine a perfect engine and a real refrigerator with the engine converting heat Q from the hot
reservoir into work to drive the refrigerator, then the heat dumped to the hot reservoir by the
refrigerator will be , resulting in a perfect refrigerator transferring heat from the cold
reservoir to hot reservoir without any other effect.
7. Heat pumps can efficiently extract heat from the ground to heat on cooler days or pull heat out of the house
on warmer days. The disadvantage of heat pumps are that they are more costly than alternatives, require
maintenance, and will not work efficiently when temperature differences between the inside and outside
are very large. Electric heating is much cheaper to purchase than a heat pump; however, it may be more
costly to run depending on the electric rates and amount of usage.
9. A nuclear reactor needs to have a lower temperature to operate, so its efficiency will not be as great as a
fossil-fuel plant. This argument does not take into consideration the amount of energy per reaction:
Nuclear power has a far greater energy output than fossil fuels.
11. In order to increase the efficiency, the temperature of the hot reservoir should be raised, and the cold
reservoir should be lowered as much as possible. This can be seen in Equation 4.3.
13. adiabatic and isothermal processes
15. Entropy will not change if it is a reversible transition but will change if the process is irreversible.
17. Entropy is a function of disorder, so all the answers apply here as well.

Problems
19.
21.
23. 0.667
25. a. 0.200; b. 25 J
27. a. 0.67; b. 75 J; c. 25 J
29. a. 600 J; b. 800 J
31. a. 69 J; b. 11 J
33. 2.0
35. 50 J
37.
752

39. a. 381 J; b. 619 J


41. a. 546 K; b. 137 K
43. –1 J/K
45. –13 J(K mole)
47.
49. a. –709 J/K; b. 1300 J/K; c. 591 J/K
51. a. ; b.
53.
55. 430 J/K
57. , , , 215 J/K, –190 J/K, 25 J/K
59. , ,
61. a. 1200 J; b. 600 J; c. 600 J; d. 0.50
63.
65. a. 0.33, 0.39; b. 0.91

Additional Problems
67.
69. a. b. 13,000 J; c. 13,000 J; d. –8,000 J; e. –8,000 J; f. 6200 J; g. –6200 J; h.
; with temperatures efficiency is , which is off likely by rounding errors.
71. –670 J/K
73. a. –570 J/K; b. 570 J/K
75. 82 J/K
77. a. 2000 J; b.
79.
81.

Challenge Problems
83. derive
85. derive
87. 18 J/K
89. proof
91.
93.

Access for free at openstax.org.


753

Chapter 5
Check Your Understanding
5.1 The force would point outward.
5.2 The net force would point below the −x-axis.
5.3
5.4 We will no longer be able to take advantage of symmetry. Instead, we will need to calculate each of the two
components of the electric field with their own integral.
5.5 The point charge would be where a and b are the sides of the rectangle but otherwise identical.
5.6 The electric field would be zero in between, and have magnitude everywhere else.

Conceptual Questions
1. There are mostly equal numbers of positive and negative charges present, making the object electrically
neutral.
3. a. no; b. yes
5. Take an object with a known charge, either positive or negative, and bring it close to the rod. If the known
charged object is positive and it is repelled from the rod, the rod is charged positive. If the positively
charged object is attracted to the rod, the rod is negatively charged.
7. No, the dust is attracted to both because the dust particle molecules become polarized in the direction of
the silk.
9. Yes, polarization charge is induced on the conductor so that the positive charge is nearest the charged rod,
causing an attractive force.
11. Charging by conduction is charging by contact where charge is transferred to the object. Charging by
induction first involves producing a polarization charge in the object and then connecting a wire to
ground to allow some of the charge to leave the object, leaving the object charged.
13. This is so that any excess charge is transferred to the ground, keeping the gasoline receptacles neutral. If
there is excess charge on the gasoline receptacle, a spark could ignite it.
15. The dryer charges the clothes. If they are damp, the presence of water molecules suppresses the charge.
17. There are only two types of charge, attractive and repulsive. If you bring a charged object near the quartz,
only one of these two effects will happen, proving there is not a third kind of charge.
19. a. No, since a polarization charge is induced. b. Yes, since the polarization charge would produce only an
attractive force.
21. The force holding the nucleus together must be greater than the electrostatic repulsive force on the
protons.
23. Either sign of the test charge could be used, but the convention is to use a positive test charge.
25. The charges are of the same sign.
27. At infinity, we would expect the field to go to zero, but because the sheet is infinite in extent, this is not the
case. Everywhere you are, you see an infinite plane in all directions.
29. The infinite charged plate would have everywhere. The field would point toward the plate if it
were negatively charged and point away from the plate if it were positively charged. The electric field of
the parallel plates would be zero between them if they had the same charge, and E would be
everywhere else. If the charges were opposite, the situation is reversed, zero outside the plates and
between them.
31. yes; no
33. At the surface of Earth, the gravitational field is always directed in toward Earth’s center. An electric field
could move a charged particle in a different direction than toward the center of Earth. This would indicate
an electric field is present.
35. 10
754

Problems
37. a. ;

b.

39.
41. a. ;

b.

43. ;

45. atomic mass of copper atom times ;


number of copper atoms ;
number of electrons equals 29 times number of atoms or ;

47. ;
;

49. a. charge 1 is ; charge 2 is , to the left,


to the right,
to the right;
b. to the right,
to the right,
to the right,

;
c. ,
,

51.
53.
55. The tension is . The horizontal component of the tension is
.
The charges can be positive or negative, but both have to be the same sign.
57. Let the charge on one of the spheres be nQ, where n is a fraction between 0 and 1. In the numerator of
Coulomb’s law, the term involving the charges is This is equal to . Finding the
maximum of this term gives
59. Define right to be the positive direction and hence left is the negative direction, then
61. The particles form triangle of sides 13, 13, and 24 cm. The x-components cancel, whereas there is a

Access for free at openstax.org.


755

contribution to the y-component from both charges 24 cm apart. The y-axis passing through the third
charge bisects the 24-cm line, creating two right triangles of sides 5, 12, and 13 cm.
in the negative y-direction since the force is attractive. The net force from both charges is
.
63. The diagonal is and the components of the force due to the diagonal charge has a factor ;

65. a. up;
b. down
67. a. ;
b. ;
c. on alpha particle;
on electron
69.
71. ,

73.
75. a. ;
b.
77. If the is to the right of the electric field vector from both charges point to the right. a.
;
b.
79. There is right triangle geometry. The x-components of the electric field at cancel. The
y-components give .
At the origin we have a a negative charge of magnitide
.
81.
83.

85.
87. At :

At Put the origin at the end of L.

89. a. ; b.

91. a. ,
;
b. ,

93. ,

95. ,
,
,
This is independent of the length of the string.
97. circular arc ,

,
756

y-axis: ;

x-axis: ,

99. a. , ; b. is

negative; therefore, , ∞
101.

103.

Access for free at openstax.org.


757

105.

107. The net dipole moment of the molecule is the vector sum of the individual dipole moments between the
two O-H. The separation O-H is 0.9578 angstroms:

Additional Problems
109. ,

111. Charges Q and q form a right triangle of sides 1 m and Charges 2Q and q form a right triangle
of sides 1 m and

113.

115. a. ; b. ; c.

117.

119. ,

121. Electric field of wire at x: ,

123.
758

Substituting z for a, we have:

125. There is a net force only in the y-direction. Let be the angle the vector from dx to q makes with the
x-axis. The components along the x-axis cancel due to symmetry, leaving the y-component of the force.
,

Chapter 6
Check Your Understanding
6.1 Place it so that its unit normal is perpendicular to
6.2
6.3 a. b. c. d. 0
6.4 In this case, there is only
6.5 ; This agrees with the calculation of Example 5.5 where we found the electric field by
integrating over the charged wire. Notice how much simpler the calculation of this electric field is with
Gauss’s law.
6.6 If there are other charged objects around, then the charges on the surface of the sphere will not
necessarily be spherically symmetrical; there will be more in certain direction than in other directions.

Conceptual Questions
1. a. If the planar surface is perpendicular to the electric field vector, the maximum flux would be obtained. b.
If the planar surface were parallel to the electric field vector, the minimum flux would be obtained.
3. False. The net electric flux crossing a closed surface is always zero if and only if the net charge enclosed is
zero.
5. Since the electric field vector has a dependence, the fluxes are the same since .
7. a. no; b. zero

Access for free at openstax.org.


759

9. Both fields vary as . Because the gravitational constant is so much smaller than , the gravitational
field is orders of magnitude weaker than the electric field. Also, the gravitational flux through a closed
surface is zero or positive; however, the electric flux is positive, negative, or zero, depending on the
definition of flux for the given situation.
11. No, it is produced by all charges both inside and outside the Gaussian surface.
13. No, since the situation does not have symmetry, making Gauss’s law challenging to simplify.
15. Any shape of the Gaussian surface can be used. The only restriction is that the Gaussian integral must be
calculable; therefore, a box or a cylinder are the most convenient geometrical shapes for the Gaussian
surface.
17. No. If a metal was in a region of zero electric field, all the conduction electrons would be distributed
uniformly throughout the metal.
19. Since the electric field is zero inside a conductor, a charge of is induced on the inside surface of
the cavity. This will put a charge of on the outside surface leaving a net charge of on the
surface.

Problems
21. electric field in direction of unit normal;
electric field opposite to unit normal
23.

25. a.
b. ; c.
27.
29.

31. a. ; b. ;
c. ;
d.
33.
35. Make a cube with q at the center, using the cube of side a. This would take four cubes of side a to make one
side of the large cube. The shaded side of the small cube would be 1/24th of the total area of the large
cube; therefore, the flux through the shaded area would be
.
37.
39. zero, also because flux in equals flux out
41.

43.

45. a. 0; b. 0; c.
47. a. 0; b.
49. a. Yes, the length of the rod is much greater than the distance to the point in question. b. No, The length of
the rod is of the same order of magnitude as the distance to the point in question. c. Yes, the length of the
rod is much greater than the distance to the point in question. d. No. The length of the rod is of the same
order of magnitude as the distance to the point in question.
51. a.
;
b.

53. ;
760

55.
57.

59. integrate by parts:

61.

63. a. Outside: ; Inside ; b.

65. a. E inside equals 0; b.

67.
69. , inside since

Access for free at openstax.org.


761

71. a. ; b. ; c. since r would be either inside the second shell or if


outside then q enclosed equals 0.

Additional Problems
73.

75. a. ; b. zero, since the flux through the upper half cancels the flux through the lower

half of the sphere


77. ; There are two contributions to the surface integral: one at the side of the rectangle at and
the other at the side at ;

where the minus sign indicates that at , the electric field is along positive x and the unit normal is
along negative x. At , the unit normal and the electric field vector are in the same direction:
.
79. didn’t keep consistent directions for the area vectors, or the electric fields
81. a. , on one and on the other; b.

83. Construct a Gaussian cylinder along the z-axis with cross-sectional area A.
,

85. a. ;

b. ;

c. ;

d. ; e. 0

87. Electric field due to plate without hole: .

Electric field of just hole filled with .

Thus, .

89. a. ; b. ; c. ; d.

Challenge Problems
4
91. Given the referenced link, using a distance to Vega of m and a diameter of 2.4 m for the
5
primary mirror, we find that at a wavelength of 555.6 nm, Vega is emitting at that
wavelength. Note that the flux through the mirror is essentially constant.

93. The symmetry of the system forces to be perpendicular to the sheet and constant over any plane
parallel to the sheet. To calculate the electric field, we choose the cylindrical Gaussian surface shown. The
cross-section area and the height of the cylinder are A and 2x, respectively, and the cylinder is positioned
so that it is bisected by the plane sheet. Since E is perpendicular to each end and parallel to the side of the

4 http://webviz.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR-5?-source=I/311&HIP=91262
5 http://ntrs.nasa.gov/archive/nasa/casi.ntrs.nasa.gov/19910003124.pdf
762

cylinder, we have EA as the flux through each end and there is no flux through the side. The charge
enclosed by the cylinder is so from Gauss’s law, and the electric field of an infinite sheet
of charge is
in agreement with the calculation of in the text.

95. There is Q/2 on each side of the plate since the net charge is Q: ,

Chapter 7
Check Your Understanding
7.1

7.2 It has kinetic energy of at point and potential energy of which means that
as Q approaches infinity, its kinetic energy totals three times the kinetic energy at since all of the
potential energy gets converted to kinetic.
7.3 positive, negative, and these quantities are the same as the work you would need to do to bring the charges
in from infinity
7.4
7.5 –2.00 C,
7.6 It would be going in the opposite direction, with no effect on the calculations as presented.
7.7 Given a fixed maximum electric field strength, the potential at which a strike occurs increases with
increasing height above the ground. Hence, each electron will carry more energy. Determining if there is
an effect on the total number of electrons lies in the future.
7.8 recall that the electric field inside a
conductor is zero. Hence, any path from a point on the surface to any point in the interior will have an
integrand of zero when calculating the change in potential, and thus the potential in the interior of the
sphere is identical to that on the surface.
7.9 The x-axis the potential is zero, due to the equal and opposite charges the same distance from it. On the
z-axis, we may superimpose the two potentials; we will find that for , again the potential goes to
zero due to cancellation.
7.10 It will be zero, as at all points on the axis, there are equal and opposite charges equidistant from the point
of interest. Note that this distribution will, in fact, have a dipole moment.
7.11 Any, but cylindrical is closest to the symmetry of a dipole.
7.12 infinite cylinders of constant radius, with the line charge as the axis

Conceptual Questions
1. No. We can only define potential energies for conservative fields.
3. No, though certain orderings may be simpler to compute.
5. The electric field strength is zero because electric potential differences are directly related to the field
strength. If the potential difference is zero, then the field strength must also be zero.
7. Potential difference is more descriptive because it indicates that it is the difference between the electric
potential of two points.
9. They are very similar, but potential difference is a feature of the system; when a charge is introduced to the
system, it will have a potential energy which may be calculated by multiplying the magnitude of the charge
by the potential difference.
11. An electron-volt is a volt multiplied by the charge of an electron. Volts measure potential difference,
electron-volts are a unit of energy.
13. The second has 1/4 the dipole moment of the first.
15. The region outside of the sphere will have a potential indistinguishable from a point charge; the interior of

Access for free at openstax.org.


763

the sphere will have a different potential.


17. No. It will be constant, but not necessarily zero.
19. no
21. No; it might not be at electrostatic equilibrium.
23. Yes. It depends on where the zero reference for potential is. (Though this might be unusual.)
25. So that lightning striking them goes into the ground instead of the television equipment.
27. They both make use of static electricity to stick small particles to another surface. However, the
precipitator has to charge a wide variety of particles, and is not designed to make sure they land in a
particular place.

Problems
29. a.
b.

31.

33.

35.
37. a. ; b.
39. a. ;
b.

41. a.

b.
43. One possibility is to stay at constant radius and go along the arc from to , which will have zero
potential due to the path being perpendicular to the electric field. Then integrate from a to b:

45.
47. ;
The charge is positive because the potential is positive.
49. a. ;
b. ;
c.
51. ; a. Relative to origin, find the potential at each point and then calculate the difference.
;
b. To double the potential difference, move the point from 20 cm to infinity; the potential at 20 cm is
halfway between zero and that at 10 cm.
53. a.
and ;
b. and
55. The problem is describing a uniform field, so in the –z-direction.
57. Apply with to the potential calculated earlier,

as expected.
59. a. increases; the constant (negative) electric field has this effect, the reference point only matters for
magnitude; b. they are planes parallel to the sheet; c. 0.006 m/V
61. a. from the previous chapter, the electric field has magnitude in the region between the plates and zero
outside; defining the negatively charged plate to be at the origin and zero potential, with the positively
charged plate located at in the z-direction, so the potential is 0 for
for for
764

b.
63.
65. In the region , and E is zero elsewhere; hence, the potential difference is

.
67. From previous results , note that b is a very convenient location to define the zero

level of potential:
69. a. ;
The electric field is towards the surface of Earth. b. The coulomb force is much stronger than gravity.
71. We know from the Gauss’s law chapter that the electric field for an infinite line charge is ,
and from earlier in this chapter that the potential of a wire-cylinder system of this sort is
by integration. We are not given , but we are given a fixed ; thus, we know that and

hence . We may substitute this back in to find a. ; b. ;

c.

73. a. ;

b.
75. a. ;
b.
77. a. ; b. ; c. ; d. ; e.

79. a. ;

b.

81.

83. a. ;

b. ;

c. The expansion of the steam upon boiling can literally blow the tree apart.
85. a. ; b. A 1-C charge is a very large amount of charge; a sphere of 1.80 km is
impractical.
87. The alpha particle approaches the gold nucleus until its original energy is converted to potential energy.
, so

(Size of gold nucleus is about ).

Additional Problems

89.

91.

93.
95. Recall from the previous chapter that the electric field is uniform throughout space, and that

Access for free at openstax.org.


765

for uniform fields we have for the relation. Thus, we get for the
distance between 25-V equipotentials.
97. a. Take the result from Example 7.13, divide both the numerator and the denominator by x, take the limit
of that, and then apply a Taylor expansion to the resulting log to get: ; b. which is the result we
expect, because at great distances, this should look like a point charge of
99. a. ; b.
101. a. ;

b. ;

c.
103. If the electric field is zero ¼ from the way of , then we know from
; the charge is 9 times larger than

.
105. a. The field is in the direction of the electron’s initial velocity.

b.

c.

d.

Challenge Problems
107. Answers will vary. This appears to be proprietary information, and ridiculously difficult to find. Speeds
will be 20 m/s or less, and there are claims of grams for the mass of a drop.
109. Apply with to the potential calculated earlier,

with and assume that the axis of the dipole is aligned with the z-axis of the coordinate system.
Thus, the potential is .

Chapter 8
Check Your Understanding
8.1
8.3 3.59 cm, 17.98 cm
8.4 a. 25.0 pF; b. 9.2
8.5 a. ;
b. ;
c.
8.6 a. ; b. 9 times
8.7 a. 3.0; b.
8.9 a. , ; b. , ; c. ; d. ,

Conceptual Questions
1. no; yes
3. false
766

5. no
7.
9. answers may vary
11. Dielectric strength is a critical value of an electrical field above which an insulator starts to conduct; a
dielectric constant is the ratio of the electrical field in vacuum to the net electrical field in a material.
13. Water is a good solvent.
15. When energy of thermal motion is large (high temperature), an electrical field must be large too in order to
keep electric dipoles aligned with it.
17. answers may vary

Problems
19. 21.6 mC
21. 1.55 V
23. 25.0 nF
25.
27. 500 µC
29. 1:16
31. a. 1.07 nC; b. 267 V, 133 V
33.
34. 500 capacitors; connected in parallel
35. (series) and (parallel)
37.
39. 0.89 mC; 1.78 mC; 444 V
41.
43. a. 405 J; b. 90.0 mC
45. 1.17 J
47. a. ; b. 0.453 V; c. ; d. no
49. 0.7 mJ
51. a. 7.1 pF; b. 42 pF
53. a. before 3.00 V; after 0.600 V; b. before 1500 V/m; after 300 V/m
55. a. 3.91; b. 22.8 V
57. a. 37 nC; b. 0.4 MV/m; c. 19 nC
59. a. ; b.
61.
63.

Additional Problems
65. a. 0.277 nF; b. 27.7 nC; c. 50 kV/m
67. a. 0.065 F; b. 23,000 C; c. 4.0 GJ
69. a. ; b. 10.8 V
71. a. 0.13 J; b. no, because of resistive heating in connecting wires that is always present, but the circuit
schematic does not indicate resistors

Access for free at openstax.org.


767

73. a. ; b. You cannot have a negative capacitance. c. The assumption that they were hooked up in
parallel, rather than in series, is incorrect. A parallel connection always produces a greater capacitance,
while here a smaller capacitance was assumed. This could only happen if the capacitors are connected in
series.
75. a. 14.2 kV; b. The voltage is unreasonably large, more than 100 times the breakdown voltage of nylon. c.
The assumed charge is unreasonably large and cannot be stored in a capacitor of these dimensions.

Challenge Problems
77. a. 89.6 pF; b. 6.09 kV/m; c. 4.47 kV/m; d. no
79. a. 421 J; b. 53.9 mF
81.
83. proof

Chapter 9
Check Your Understanding
9.1 The time for 1.00 C of charge to flow would be , slightly less
than an hour. This is quite different from the 5.55 ms for the truck battery. The calculator takes a very
small amount of energy to operate, unlike the truck’s starter motor. There are several reasons that
vehicles use batteries and not solar cells. Aside from the obvious fact that a light source to run the solar
cells for a car or truck is not always available, the large amount of current needed to start the engine
cannot easily be supplied by present-day solar cells. Solar cells can possibly be used to charge the
batteries. Charging the battery requires a small amount of energy when compared to the energy required
to run the engine and the other accessories such as the heater and air conditioner. Present day solar-
powered cars are powered by solar panels, which may power an electric motor, instead of an internal
combustion engine.
9.2 The total current needed by all the appliances in the living room (a few lamps, a television, and your
laptop) draw less current and require less power than the refrigerator.
9.3 The diameter of the 14-gauge wire is smaller than the diameter of the 12-gauge wire. Since the drift
velocity is inversely proportional to the cross-sectional area, the drift velocity in the 14-gauge wire is
larger than the drift velocity in the 12-gauge wire carrying the same current. The number of electrons per
cubic meter will remain constant.
9.4 The current density in a conducting wire increases due to an increase in current. The drift velocity is
inversely proportional to the current , so the drift velocity would decrease.
9.5 Silver, gold, and aluminum are all used for making wires. All four materials have a high conductivity, silver
having the highest. All four can easily be drawn into wires and have a high tensile strength, though not as
high as copper. The obvious disadvantage of gold and silver is the cost, but silver and gold wires are used
for special applications, such as speaker wires. Gold does not oxidize, making better connections between
components. Aluminum wires do have their drawbacks. Aluminum has a higher resistivity than copper, so
768

a larger diameter is needed to match the resistance per length of copper wires, but aluminum is cheaper
than copper, so this is not a major drawback. Aluminum wires do not have as high of a ductility and tensile
strength as copper, but the ductility and tensile strength is within acceptable levels. There are a few
concerns that must be addressed in using aluminum and care must be used when making connections.
Aluminum has a higher rate of thermal expansion than copper, which can lead to loose connections and a
possible fire hazard. The oxidation of aluminum does not conduct and can cause problems. Special
techniques must be used when using aluminum wires and components, such as electrical outlets, must be
designed to accept aluminum wires.
9.6 The foil pattern stretches as the backing stretches, and the foil tracks become longer and thinner. Since
the resistance is calculated as , the resistance increases as the foil tracks are stretched. When the
temperature changes, so does the resistivity of the foil tracks, changing the resistance. One way to combat
this is to use two strain gauges, one used as a reference and the other used to measure the strain. The two
strain gauges are kept at a constant temperature
9.7 The longer the length, the smaller the resistance. The greater the resistivity, the higher the resistance. The
larger the difference between the outer radius and the inner radius, that is, the greater the ratio between
the two, the greater the resistance. If you are attempting to maximize the resistance, the choice of the
values for these variables will depend on the application. For example, if the cable must be flexible, the
choice of materials may be limited.
9.8 Yes, Ohm’s law is still valid. At every point in time the current is equal to , so the current is
also a function of time, .
9.9 Even though electric motors are highly efficient 10–20% of the power consumed is wasted, not being used
for doing useful work. Most of the 10–20% of the power lost is transferred into heat dissipated by the
copper wires used to make the coils of the motor. This heat adds to the heat of the environment and adds
to the demand on power plants providing the power. The demand on the power plant can lead to increased
greenhouse gases, particularly if the power plant uses coal or gas as fuel.
9.10 No, the efficiency is a very important consideration of the light bulbs, but there are many other
considerations. As mentioned above, the cost of the bulbs and the life span of the bulbs are important
considerations. For example, CFL bulbs contain mercury, a neurotoxin, and must be disposed of as
hazardous waste. When replacing incandescent bulbs that are being controlled by a dimmer switch with
LED, the dimmer switch may need to be replaced. The dimmer switches for LED lights are comparably
priced to the incandescent light switches, but this is an initial cost which should be considered. The
spectrum of light should also be considered, but there is a broad range of color temperatures available,
so you should be able to find one that fits your needs. None of these considerations mentioned are meant
to discourage the use of LED or CFL light bulbs, but they are considerations.

Conceptual Questions
1. If a wire is carrying a current, charges enter the wire from the voltage source’s positive terminal and leave
at the negative terminal, so the total charge remains zero while the current flows through it.
3. Using one hand will reduce the possibility of “completing the circuit” and having current run through your
body, especially current running through your heart.
5. Even though the electrons collide with atoms and other electrons in the wire, they travel from the negative
terminal to the positive terminal, so they drift in one direction. Gas molecules travel in completely random
directions.
7. In the early years of light bulbs, the bulbs are partially evacuated to reduce the amount of heat conducted
through the air to the glass envelope. Dissipating the heat would cool the filament, increasing the amount of
energy needed to produce light from the filament. It also protects the glass from the heat produced from the
hot filament. If the glass heats, it expands, and as it cools, it contacts. This expansion and contraction could
cause the glass to become brittle and crack, reducing the life of the bulbs. Many bulbs are now partially
filled with an inert gas. It is also useful to remove the oxygen to reduce the possibility of the filament
actually burning. When the original filaments were replaced with more efficient tungsten filaments, atoms
from the tungsten would evaporate off the filament at such high temperatures. The atoms collide with the
atoms of the inert gas and land back on the filament.

Access for free at openstax.org.


769

9. In carbon, resistivity increases with the amount of impurities, meaning fewer free charges. In silicon and
germanium, impurities decrease resistivity, meaning more free electrons.
11. Copper has a lower resistivity than aluminum, so if length is the same, copper must have the smaller
diameter.
13. Device B shows a linear relationship and the device is ohmic.
15. Although the conductors have a low resistance, the lines from the power company can be kilometers long.
Using a high voltage reduces the current that is required to supply the power demand and that reduces
line losses.
17. The resistor would overheat, possibly to the point of causing the resistor to burn. Fuses are commonly
added to circuits to prevent such accidents.
19. Very low temperatures necessitate refrigeration. Some materials require liquid nitrogen to cool them
below their critical temperatures. Other materials may need liquid helium, which is even more costly.

Problems
21. a. ;
b.
23.
no. of electrons =

25.

27.
29.
31.
33. a. ; b.
35.
37.

39.

41.

43. a. ;
b. Under normal conditions, no it should not occur.

45. , iron

47. a. , gold;
770

b.

49.

51.

53.
55. a. ; b. ; c. ; d. It is converted into heat.

57. ,

59.

61. a.

b.

63.

65.

Access for free at openstax.org.


771

67. a. ;

b.

Additional Problems

69.

71. a.
; b.

73.
75.
77. a. ; b.
79.

Challenge Problems

81.

83. a. 4.38 x 107 m/s b. c.


85.

87. a. ; b.

89. a. ; b.
91. (a) 0.870 A
(b) #electrons = 2.54 × 1023 electrons
(c) 132 ohms
(d) q = 4.68 × 106 J
93.

Chapter 10
Check Your Understanding
10.1 If a wire is connected across the terminals, the load resistance is close to zero, or at least considerably
less than the internal resistance of the battery. Since the internal resistance is small, the current through
the circuit will be large, The large current causes a high power to be dissipated by
the internal resistance . The power is dissipated as heat.
10.2 The equivalent resistance of nine bulbs connected in series is 9R. The current is If one bulb
burns out, the equivalent resistance is 8R, and the voltage does not change, but the current increases
As more bulbs burn out, the current becomes even higher. Eventually, the current becomes
772

too high, burning out the shunt.


10.3 The equivalent of the series circuit would be which is higher
than the equivalent resistance of the parallel circuit The equivalent resistor of any
number of resistors is always higher than the equivalent resistance of the same resistors connected in
parallel. The current through for the series circuit would be which is lower than the
sum of the currents through each resistor in the parallel circuit, This is not surprising since
the equivalent resistance of the series circuit is higher. The current through a series connection of any
number of resistors will always be lower than the current into a parallel connection of the same resistors,
since the equivalent resistance of the series circuit will be higher than the parallel circuit. The power
dissipated by the resistors in series would be which is lower than the power dissipated in
the parallel circuit
10.4 A river, flowing horizontally at a constant rate, splits in two and flows over two waterfalls. The water
molecules are analogous to the electrons in the parallel circuits. The number of water molecules that
flow in the river and falls must be equal to the number of molecules that flow over each waterfall, just like
sum of the current through each resistor must be equal to the current flowing into the parallel circuit.
The water molecules in the river have energy due to their motion and height. The potential energy of the
water molecules in the river is constant due to their equal heights. This is analogous to the constant
change in voltage across a parallel circuit. Voltage is the potential energy across each resistor.
The analogy quickly breaks down when considering the energy. In the waterfall, the potential energy is
converted into kinetic energy of the water molecules. In the case of electrons flowing through a resistor,
the potential drop is converted into heat and light, not into the kinetic energy of the electrons.
10.5 1. All the overhead lighting circuits are in parallel and connected to the main supply line, so when one
bulb burns out, all the overhead lighting does not go dark. Each overhead light will have at least one
switch in series with the light, so you can turn it on and off. 2. A refrigerator has a compressor and a light
that goes on when the door opens. There is usually only one cord for the refrigerator to plug into the wall.
The circuit containing the compressor and the circuit containing the lighting circuit are in parallel, but
there is a switch in series with the light. A thermostat controls a switch that is in series with the
compressor to control the temperature of the refrigerator.
10.6 The circuit can be analyzed using Kirchhoff’s loop rule. The first voltage source supplies power:
The second voltage source consumes power:

10.7 The current calculated would be equal to instead of The sum of the power
dissipated and the power consumed would still equal the power supplied.
10.8 Since digital meters require less current than analog meters, they alter the circuit less than analog
meters. Their resistance as a voltmeter can be far greater than an analog meter, and their resistance as
an ammeter can be far less than an analog meter. Consult Figure 10.36 and Figure 10.35 and their
discussion in the text.

Conceptual Questions
1. Some of the energy being used to recharge the battery will be dissipated as heat by the internal resistance.

3.

5. It would probably be better to be in series because the current will be less than if it were in parallel.
7. two filaments, a low resistance and a high resistance, connected in parallel
9. It can be redrawn.

Access for free at openstax.org.


773

11. In series the voltages add, but so do the internal resistances, because the internal resistances are in series.
In parallel, the terminal voltage is the same, but the equivalent internal resistance is smaller than the
smallest individual internal resistance and a higher current can be provided.
13. The voltmeter would put a large resistance in series with the circuit, significantly changing the circuit. It
would probably give a reading, but it would be meaningless.
15. The ammeter has a small resistance; therefore, a large current will be produced and could damage the
meter and/or overheat the battery.
17. The time constant can be shortened by using a smaller resistor and/or a smaller capacitor. Care should be
taken when reducing the resistance because the initial current will increase as the resistance decreases.
19. Not only might water drip into the switch and cause a shock, but also the resistance of your body is lower
when you are wet.

Problems
21. a.

b. 0.476W; c. 0.691 W; d. As is lowered, the power difference decreases; therefore, at higher volumes,
there is no significant difference.
23. a. ; b. No, there is only one independent equation, so only r can be found.
25. a. ; b. 40.0 W; c.
27. largest, , smallest,
29. 29.6 W
31. a. 0.74 A; b. 0.742 A
33. a. 60.8 W; b. 1.56 kW
35. a. ; b. ;
c. ; d. ; e.
37. a. ;
b. ; c. ;
d.
39.
41. a. ; b. ;
c.
43.
45. a.
774

;
b. 0.617 A; c. 3.81 W; d.
47.
49.
51. a. ; b. 2.00 s
53. a. 12.3 mA; b. c. 4.53 mA; d. 3.89 V
55. a. b. No, in practice it would not be difficult to limit the capacitance to less than 100 nF,
since typical capacitors range from fractions of a picofarad (pF) to milifarad (mF).
57.
59. 12.0 V
61. 400 V
63. a. 6.00 mV; b. It would not be necessary to take extra precautions regarding the power coming from the
wall. However, it is possible to generate voltages of approximately this value from static charge built up on
gloves, for instance, so some precautions are necessary.
65. a. b. 10.0 kV; c. ; d.

Additional Problems
67. a. ; b. ; c. 0.069 s
69. a. ;
b. ;
c. ;
d. ;
e.

71. a. ; b.

Access for free at openstax.org.


775

73. a. ; b.

75.
77. a. ; b. ;
c. ;
d. ; e.
79. a. ; b.
81. a. ; b. You cannot have negative resistance. c. The assumption that is unreasonable.
Series resistance is always greater than any of the individual resistances.
83.
85. a. ;
b.
87. a. 4.99 s; b. ; c. ; d. No, this change does not seem significant. It probably would not
be noticed.

Challenge Problems
89. a. 0.273 A; b.
91. a. ; b.
93. a. ; b. 1.26 mA; c.
95.

97. a. ;
b. ; Yes, the breaker will trip.
c. ; Yes, the breaker will trip.
99.

Chapter 11
Check Your Understanding
11.1 a. 0 N; b. c. d.
11.2 a. toward the south; b.
11.3 a. bends upward; b. bends downward
11.4 a. aligned or anti-aligned; b. perpendicular
11.5 a. 1.1 T; b. 1.6 T
11.6 0.32 m

Conceptual Questions
1. Both are field dependent. Electrical force is dependent on charge, whereas magnetic force is dependent on
current or rate of charge flow.
776

3. The magnitude of the proton and electron magnetic forces are the same since they have the same amount
of charge. The direction of these forces however are opposite of each other. The accelerations are opposite
in direction and the electron has a larger acceleration than the proton due to its smaller mass.
5. The magnetic field must point parallel or anti-parallel to the velocity.
7. A compass points toward the north pole of an electromagnet.
9. Velocity and magnetic field can be set together in any direction. If there is a force, the velocity is
perpendicular to it. The magnetic field is also perpendicular to the force if it exists.
11. A force on a wire is exerted by an external magnetic field created by a wire or another magnet.
13. Poor conductors have a lower charge carrier density, n, which, based on the Hall effect formula, relates to
a higher Hall potential. Good conductors have a higher charge carrier density, thereby a lower Hall
potential.

Problems
15. a. left; b. into the page; c. up the page; d. no force; e. right; f. down
17. a. right; b. into the page; c. down
19. a. into the page; b. left; c. out of the page
21. a. north b. The force is very small, so this implies that the effect of static charges on
airplanes is negligible.
23.
25. 4.27 m
27. a. b. 3; c. This ratio must be an integer because charges must be integer numbers of the
basic charge of an electron. There are no free charges with values less than this basic charge, and all
charges are integer multiples of this basic charge.
29. (a) 3.27 x 104 m/s (b) 12,525 m (c) 292 m (d) 6.83 m.
31. a. b. c.
33. a. left; b. into the page; c. up; d. no force; e. right; f. down
35. a. into the page; b. left; c. out of the page
37. a. 2.50 N; b. This means that the light-rail power lines must be attached in order not to be moved by the
force caused by Earth’s magnetic field.
39. a. so decreases by 5.00% if B decreases by 5.00%; b. 5.26% increase
41. 10.0 A
43.
45.
47.
49.
51.
53. a. b. 0.21 m
55. a. b. 12 MeV; c. 12 MV; d. e. 12 MeV, 12 V,
57. a. b. Yes, this distance between their paths is clearly big enough to separate the U-235
from the U-238, since it is a distance of 2.5 cm.

Additional Problems
59.
61. the magnetic and gravitational forces must balance to maintain dynamic equilibrium
63.
65.
67. a. circular motion in a north, down plane; b.
69. The proton has more mass than the electron; therefore, its radius and period will be larger.
71.
73. 1:0.707:1
75. 1/4

Access for free at openstax.org.


777

77. a. b.
79. a. b. 4.80 N
81. a. 0.283 N; b. 0.4 N; c. 0 N; d. 0 N
83. 0 N and 0.012 Nm
85. a. b. 0.16 Nm
87.
89. a. b. 0.016 Nm; c. 0.028 J
91. (Proof)
93.
95. Since where the width is twice the radius,
so

The Hall voltage is inversely proportional to the diameter of the wire.


97. 0.602 m
99. a. b. not an integer multiple of e; c. need to assume all charges have multiples of e, could be
other forces not accounted for
101. a. B = 5 T; b. very large magnet; c. applying such a large voltage

Challenge Problems
103.
105.

107.
109. 0.23 N

Chapter 12
Check Your Understanding
12.1 1.41 meters
12.2
12.3 4 amps flowing out of the page
12.4 Both have a force per unit length of
12.5 0.608 meters
12.6 In these cases the integrals around the Ampèrian loop are very difficult because there is no symmetry, so
this method would not be useful.
12.7 a. 1.00382; b. 1.00015
12.8 a. ; b. 0.60 T; c.

Conceptual Questions
1. Biot-Savart law’s advantage is that it works with any magnetic field produced by a current loop. The
disadvantage is that it can take a long time.
3. If you were to go to the start of a line segment and calculate the angle to be approximately , the wire can
be considered infinite. This judgment is based also on the precision you need in the result.
5. You would make sure the currents flow perpendicular to one another.
7. A magnetic field line gives the direction of the magnetic field at any point in space. The density of magnetic
field lines indicates the strength of the magnetic field.
9. The spring reduces in length since each coil with have a north pole-produced magnetic field next to a south
pole of the next coil.
11. Ampère’s law is valid for all closed paths, but it is not useful for calculating fields when the magnetic field
produced lacks symmetry that can be exploited by a suitable choice of path.
13. If there is no current inside the loop, there is no magnetic field (see Ampère’s law). Outside the pipe, there
may be an enclosed current through the copper pipe, so the magnetic field may not be zero outside the
778

pipe.
15. The bar magnet will then become two magnets, each with their own north and south poles. There are no
magnetic monopoles or single pole magnets.

Problems
17.
19. out of the page
21. ; the current in the wire to the right must flow up the page.
23. 20 A
25. Both answers have the magnitude of magnetic field of
27. At P1, the net magnetic field is zero. At P2, into the page.
29. The magnetic field is at a minimum at distance a from the top wire, or half-way between the wires.
31. a. away from the other wire; b. toward the other wire
33.
35. 0.019 m
37.

39.

41. a. b. 0; c. d. 0
43. a. b. 0; c. d.
45. at the radius R
47.

49.
51. roughly eight turns per cm
53.
55. 0.0181 A
57. 0.0008 T
59. 317.31
61.

63. 0.18 T

Additional Problems
65.
67. in an arc away from the wire
69. a. above and below in the middle b. above and below in the middle

Access for free at openstax.org.


779

71.
73. a. 5026 turns; b. 0.00957 T

75.

77.
79. derivation
81. derivation
83. As the radial distance goes to infinity, the magnetic fields of each of these formulae go to zero.

85. a. ; b.
87.

Challenge Problems
89.

91. a. ; b. 82% of Earth’s magnetic field

Chapter 13
Check Your Understanding
13.1 1.1 T/s
13.2 To the observer shown, the current flows clockwise as the magnet approaches, decreases to zero when
the magnet is centered in the plane of the coil, and then flows counterclockwise as the magnet leaves the
coil.

13.4 with O at a higher potential than S


13.5 1.5 V
780

13.6 a. yes; b. Yes; however there is a lack of symmetry between the electric field and coil, making a

more complicated relationship that can’t be simplified as shown in the example.


13.7
13.8
13.9 a. b.

Conceptual Questions
1. The emf depends on the rate of change of the magnetic field.
3. Both have the same induced electric fields; however, the copper ring has a much higher induced emf
because it conducts electricity better than the wooden ring.
5. a. no; b. yes
7. As long as the magnetic flux is changing from positive to negative or negative to positive, there could be an
induced emf.
9. Position the loop so that the field lines run perpendicular to the area vector or parallel to the surface.
11. a. CW as viewed from the circuit; b. CCW as viewed from the circuit
13. As the loop enters, the induced emf creates a CCW current while as the loop leaves the induced emf
creates a CW current. While the loop is fully inside the magnetic field, there is no flux change and
therefore no induced current.
15. a. CCW viewed from the magnet; b. CW viewed from the magnet; c. CW viewed from the magnet; d. CCW
viewed from the magnet; e. CW viewed from the magnet; f. no current
17. Positive charges on the wings would be to the west, or to the left of the pilot while negative charges would
be pulled east or to the right of the pilot. Thus, the left hand tips of the wings would be positive and the
right hand tips would be negative.
19. The work is greater than the kinetic energy because it takes energy to counteract the induced emf.
21. The conducting sheet is shielded from the changing magnetic fields by creating an induced emf. This
induced emf creates an induced magnetic field that opposes any changes in magnetic fields from the field
underneath. Therefore, there is no net magnetic field in the region above this sheet. If the field were due to
a static magnetic field, no induced emf will be created since you need a changing magnetic flux to induce
an emf. Therefore, this static magnetic field will not be shielded.
23. a. zero induced current, zero force; b. clockwise induced current, force is to the left; c. zero induced
current, zero force; d. counterclockwise induced current, force is to the left; e. zero induced current, zero
force.

Problems
25. a. 3.8 V; b. 2.2 V; c. 0 V

27.

Access for free at openstax.org.


781

29. Each answer is 20 times the previously given answers.

31.

33. a. ; b. CCW from the same view as the magnetic field


35. a. 150 A downward through the resistor; b. 46 A upward through the resistor; c. 0.019 A downward
through the resistor
37. 0.0015 V
39.
41.
43. a. ; b. 1.25 V/m; c. 0.3125 V; d. 16 m/s
45. 0.018 A, CW as seen in the diagram
47. 9.375 V/m
49. Inside, so, (inside). Outside,

so, (outside)

51. a. , ; b. ; c. 0 J; d.

53.
55. three turns with an area of 1 m2

57. a.

b.
c.
59. a. B is proportional to Q; b. If the coin turns easily, the magnetic field is perpendicular. If the coin is at an
equilibrium position, it is parallel.
61. a. 1.33 A; b. 0.50 A; c. 60 W; d. 37.5 W; e. 22.5W

Additional Problems
63. 4.8 × 106 A/s
65. , the direction as follows for increasing magnetic field:
782

67. 0.375 V
69. a. 0.94 V; b. 0.70 N; c. 3.52 J/s; d. 3.52 W
71.
73. a. ;
b. ;
c.

Challenge Problems
75. N is a maximum number of turns allowed.
77. 0.848 V

79.

81. a. ; b. ; c. 0 V
83. a. b. ; c. ; d. current would reverse direction but bar would still slide at the
same speed
85. a.

b. ;
c. ; d. ;

e. no, because there is no cylindrical symmetry


87. a. ; b. This angular velocity is unreasonably high, higher than can be
obtained for any mechanical system. c. The assumption that a voltage as great as 12.0 kV could be
obtained is unreasonable.

89.
91.

Chapter 14
Check Your Understanding
14.1
14.2 a. decreasing; b. increasing; Since the current flows in the opposite direction of the diagram, in order to
get a positive emf on the left-hand side of diagram (a), we need to decrease the current to the left, which
creates a reinforced emf where the positive end is on the left-hand side. To get a positive emf on the
right-hand side of diagram (b), we need to increase the current to the left, which creates a reinforced emf
where the positive end is on the right-hand side.
14.3 40 A/s

Access for free at openstax.org.


783

14.4 a. ; b.
14.5 a. ; b.
14.6 0.50 J
14.8 a. 2.2 s; b. 43 H; c. 1.0 s
14.10 a. ; b. ; c.
14.11 a. overdamped; b. 0.75 J

Conceptual Questions
1.
3. The induced current from the 12-V battery goes through an inductor, generating a large voltage.
5. Self-inductance is proportional to the magnetic flux and inversely proportional to the current. However,
since the magnetic flux depends on the current I, these effects cancel out. This means that the self-
inductance does not depend on the current. If the emf is induced across an element, it does depend on how
the current changes with time.
7. Consider the ends of a wire a part of an RL circuit and determine the self-inductance from this circuit.
9. The magnetic field will flare out at the end of the solenoid so there is less flux through the last turn than
through the middle of the solenoid.
11. As current flows through the inductor, there is a back current by Lenz’s law that is created to keep the net
current at zero amps, the initial current.
13. no
15. At , or when the switch is first thrown.
17. 1/4
19. Initially, and , and after a long time has passed, and .
21. yes
23. The amplitude of energy oscillations depend on the initial energy of the system. The frequency in a LC
circuit depends on the values of inductance and capacitance.
25. This creates an RLC circuit that dissipates energy, causing oscillations to decrease in amplitude slowly or
quickly depending on the value of resistance.
27. You would have to pick out a resistance that is small enough so that only one station at a time is picked up,
but big enough so that the tuner doesn’t have to be set at exactly the correct frequency. The inductance or
capacitance would have to be varied to tune into the station however practically speaking, variable
capacitors are a lot easier to build in a circuit.

Problems
29.
31. a. ; b.
33.
35. 0.24 H
37. 0.4 A/s
39.
41. 0.15 V. This is the same polarity as the emf driving the current.
43. a. 0.089 H/m; b. 0.44 V/m
45.
47. 0.01 A
49. 6.0 g
51.
53. a. 4.0 A; b. 2.4 A; c. on R: ; on L:
55.
57. a. 2.52 ms; b.
59. a. ; b. ; c. ; d.
61. proof
784

63.
65. a. ; b.
67.

69.

71. 6.9 ms

Additional Problems
73. Let a equal the radius of the long, thin wire, r the location where the magnetic field is measured, and R the
upper limit of the problem where we will take R as it approaches infinity.

proof


75.
77. a. 100 T; b. 2 A; c. 0.50 H
79. a. 0 A; b. 2.4 A
81. a. ; (b) The voltage is so extremely high that arcing would occur and the current would not be
reduced so rapidly. (c) It is not reasonable to shut off such a large current in such a large inductor in such
an extremely short time.

Challenge Problems
83. proof
85. a. b. ; c. 4.4 nA

Chapter 15
Check Your Understanding
15.1 10 ms
15.2 a. ; b. ; c.

15.3

15.4
15.5 2.00 V; 10.01 V; 8.01 V
15.6 a. 160 Hz; b. ; c. ; d. 0.023 rad
15.7 a. halved; b. halved; c. same
15.8
15.9 a. 12:1; b. 0.042 A; c.

Conceptual Questions
1. Angular frequency is times frequency.
3. yes for both
5. The instantaneous power is the power at a given instant. The average power is the power averaged over a
cycle or number of cycles.
7. The instantaneous power can be negative, but the power output can’t be negative.

Access for free at openstax.org.


785

9. There is less thermal loss if the transmission lines operate at low currents and high voltages.
11. The adapter has a step-down transformer to have a lower voltage and possibly higher current at which the
device can operate.
13. so each loop can experience the same changing magnetic flux

Problems
15. a. ; b. ; c.
17. a. ; b. ; c.
19. 360 Hz
21.
23. a. ; b.
25. a. ; b. 0.16 A; c. ; d. ;
27. a. ; b. 0.15 A; c. ; d. , 0.092 A,

29. a. ; b. ; c.
31. a. 0.89 A; b. 5.6A; c. 1.4 A
33. a. 5.3 W; b. 2.1 W
35. a. inductor; b.
37.
39. a. 820 Hz; b. 7.8
41. a. 50 Hz; b. 50 W; c. 6.32; d. 50 rad/s
43. The reactance of the capacitor is larger than the reactance of the inductor because the current leads the
voltage. The power usage is 30 W.
45. a. 45:1; b. 0.68 A, 0.015 A; c.
47. a. 41 turns; b. 40.9 mA

Additional Problems
49. a. ; b. ; c.
51. a. ; b.
53. a. 19 A; b. inductor leads by
55.
57. 14 W
59. a. ; b.

Challenge Problems
61. a. 335 MV; b. the result is way too high, well beyond the breakdown voltage of air over reasonable
distances; c. the input voltage is too high
63. a. ; b. 0.5 A; c. , lagging;

d. e. 0.995; f. 6.25 J

65. a. ; b. ; c. ; d. ; e. ; f.
67. The units as written for inductive reactance Equation 15.8 are . Radians can be ignored in unit
analysis. The Henry can be defined as . Combining these together results in a unit of for
reactance.
69. a. 156 V; b. 42 V; c. 154 V
71. a. and ; b. and
786

Chapter 16
Check Your Understanding
16.1 It is greatest immediately after the current is switched on. The displacement current and the magnetic
field from it are proportional to the rate of change of electric field between the plates, which is greatest
when the plates first begin to charge.
16.2 No. The changing electric field according to the modified version of Ampère’s law would necessarily
induce a changing magnetic field.
16.3 (1) Faraday’s law, (2) the Ampère-Maxwell law
16.4 a. The directions of wave propagation, of the E field, and of B field are all mutually perpendicular. b. The
speed of the electromagnetic wave is the speed of light independent of frequency. c. The
ratio of electric and magnetic field amplitudes is
16.5 Its acceleration would decrease because the radiation force is proportional to the intensity of light from
the Sun, which decreases with distance. Its speed, however, would not change except for the effects of
gravity from the Sun and planets.
16.6 They fall into different ranges of wavelength, and therefore also different corresponding ranges of
frequency.

Conceptual Questions
1. The current into the capacitor to change the electric field between the plates is equal to the displacement
current between the plates.
3. The first demonstration requires simply observing the current produced in a wire that experiences a
changing magnetic field. The second demonstration requires moving electric charge from one location to
another, and therefore involves electric currents that generate a changing electric field. The magnetic fields
from these currents are not easily separated from the magnetic field that the displacement current
produces.
5. in (a), because the electric field is parallel to the wire, accelerating the electrons
7. A steady current in a dc circuit will not produce electromagnetic waves. If the magnitude of the current
varies while remaining in the same direction, the wires will emit electromagnetic waves, for example, if the
current is turned on or off.
9. The amount of energy (about ) is can quickly produce a considerable change in temperature, but
the light pressure (about ) is much too small to notice.
11. It has the magnitude of the energy flux and points in the direction of wave propagation. It gives the
direction of energy flow and the amount of energy per area transported per second.
13. The force on a surface acting over time is the momentum that the force would impart to the object. The
momentum change of the light is doubled if the light is reflected back compared with when it is absorbed,
so the force acting on the object is twice as great.
15. a. According to the right hand rule, the direction of energy propagation would reverse. b. This would leave
the vector , and therefore the propagation direction, the same.
17. a. Radio waves are generally produced by alternating current in a wire or an oscillating electric field
between two plates; b. Infrared radiation is commonly produced by heated bodies whose atoms and the
charges in them vibrate at about the right frequency.
19. a. blue; b. Light of longer wavelengths than blue passes through the air with less scattering, whereas more
of the blue light is scattered in different directions in the sky to give it is blue color.
21. A typical antenna has a stronger response when the wires forming it are orientated parallel to the electric
field of the radio wave.
23. No, it is very narrow and just a small portion of the overall electromagnetic spectrum.
25. Visible light is typically produced by changes of energies of electrons in randomly oriented atoms and
molecules. Radio waves are typically emitted by an ac current flowing along a wire, that has fixed
orientation and produces electric fields pointed in particular directions.
27. Radar can observe objects the size of an airplane and uses radio waves of about 0.5 cm in wavelength.
Visible light can be used to view single biological cells and has wavelengths of about .

Access for free at openstax.org.


787

29. ELF radio waves


31. The frequency of 2.45 GHz of a microwave oven is close to the specific frequencies in the 2.4 GHz band
used for WiFi.

Problems

33.

35. a. ; b. ;

c. ; which is the sum of and


consistent with how the displacement current maintaining the continuity of current.
37.
39.
41. 499 s
43. 25 m
45. a. 5.00 V/m; b. ; c. 31.4 cm; d. toward the +x-axis;
e.
47.
49. The magnetic field is downward, and it has magnitude .
51. a. b. 394 m
53. 11.5 m
55.
57.
59.
61. a. ; b.
63. a. ; b. ; c. 1.12 W
65.

67.

69. a. b. it is reduced to half the pressure,


71. a.
73. a. ; b. X-rays
75. a. The wavelength range is 187 m to 556 m. b. The wavelength range is 2.78 m to 3.41 m.
77.
79. time for difference in travel time is
81. a. b. c.
83. the non-oscillating geomagnetic field of 25–65 is much larger
85. a. ; b. ; c.
87. a. ; b. radio wave; c.

Additional Problems
89.
91. , which is much greater than Earth’s circumference
93. a. 564 W; b. ; c. ; d.
95. a. ; b. ; c.
788

97. a. ; b.

99.

101. 0.431
103. a. ; b. ; c. 33 ns

105.

Challenge Problems
107. a. ; b. The radiation pressure is greater than the Sun’s gravity if the particle size is smaller,
because the gravitational force varies as the radius cubed while the radiation pressure varies as the
radius squared. c. The radiation force outward implies that particles smaller than this are less likely to be
near the Sun than outside the range of the Sun’s radiation pressure.

Access for free at openstax.org.


Index 789

INDEX
A camera flashes 618 coulomb 182, 182, 528
absolute temperature scale 8 capacitance 337 Coulomb force 190
absolute zero 8 capacitive reactance 647 credit card 597
ac current 644 capacitor 336, 647 critical point 25
ac voltage 644 Carnot 152 Critical pressure 25
Adiabatic compressions 127 Carnot cycle 152 critical temperature 25, 76, 403
adiabatic expansion 127 Carnot engine 152 current density 383
adiabatic process 124 Carnot’s principle 155 cyclic process 125
Alternating current (ac) 644 cathode 422 cyclotron 503
amber 181 Cell membranes 344 cylindrical symmetry 253
ammeter 451 Cell phone 705
ampere 374, 528 Celsius scale 8 D
Ampère 374, 481 Chadwick 185 dalton 72, 85
Ampère’s law 533 charging by induction 188 Dalton’s law of partial
analog meter 453 Charles 69 pressures 85
anode 422 Charles’s law 69 Davy 481
Arago 481 circuit 377 Debye 24
area vector 232 Clausius 146 Debye temperature 24
Aurorae 488 Clausius statement of the second dees 503
average power 657 law of thermodynamics 146 defibrillator 353
Avogadro 72 closed system 110 degree Celsius 8
Avogadro’s number 72 coaxial cable 343, 557, 621 degree Fahrenheit 8
coefficient of linear degree of freedom 90
B expansion 11 density of water 15
back emf 594 coefficient of performance 149 Diamagnetic materials 545
bandwidth 661 coefficient of volume dielectric 336
Bardeen 405 expansion 14 dielectric breakdown 360
battery 421 cold reservoir 146 dielectric constant 355
Battery testers 426 Comet McNaught 680 dielectric strength 319, 360
BCS theory 405 comets 699 diesel cycle 177
Bernoulli 79 commutator 496 digital meter 453
Biot 481 compass needle 480 Digital signal processing 614
Biot-Savart law 520 condensation 25 diode 396
Bluetooth 707 conduction 33 dipole 188
Boltzmann 70 conduction electron 187 dipole antenna 692
Boltzmann constant 70 conductor 187 dipole moment 214
boundary 110 constant-volume gas Direct current (dc) 644
Boyle 69 thermometer 10 disorder 164
Boyle’s law 69 continuous charge displacement current 681
braking systems 589 distribution 202 drift velocity 379
convection 41 dry ice 26
C conventional current 378
calorie 18 Cooper 405 E
calorimeter 23 Cooper pairs 405 eddy current 586
calorimetry 23 cosmic rays 488 efficiency (e) 147
790 Index

electric charge 182 first law of induced dipole 214


electric dipole 300 thermodynamics 116 induced electric field 582
electric dipole moment 303 flash camera 457 induced electric-dipole
electric field 195 flux 230 moment 359
electric flux 231, 681 forced convection 41 induced electrical field 358
electric force 183 Franklin 182, 378 induced emf 567
electric potential 287 free electrons 258 induced surface charges 358
electric potential difference 287 freezing 25 Inductance 612
electric power 397 freezing of water 14 inductive reactance 649
electrical conductivity 385 inductive time constant 624
electrical current 375 G inductor 616, 649
electrical potential energy 280 gamma ray (γγ ray) 708 infinite plane 208
electrolytic capacitor 343 Gauss 230, 483 infinite straight wire 206
electromotive force (emf) 420 Gaussian surface 242 infrared radiation 707
electron 184 Gay-Lussac’s law 70 ink jet printer 322
electron-volt 290 generators 590 insulation 38
electrostatic attraction 183 giant magnetoresistance 481, insulator 187
electrostatic force 193 596 intensity 695
electrostatic precipitators 323 Gilbert 182 intensive variable 112
electrostatic repulsion 183 gradient 309 internal combustion engine 147
electrostatics 193 greenhouse effect 48 internal energy 17, 81, 115
emf 566 ground fault circuit internal resistance 423
emissivity 45 interrupter 464 ion 185
energy conservation 117 grounding 312 irreversibility 145
energy density 352, 693 irreversible process 145
energy flux 694 H isentropic 165
entropy 157 half-wave antenna 692 isobaric process 124
entropy statement of the second Hall 499 isochoric process 124
law of thermodynamics 160 Hall effect 499 isothermal expansion 113
environment 110 hard drives 596 isothermal process 123
equation of state 112 heat 17
equilibrium 111 heat engine 146 J
equipartition theorem 90 heat of fusion 29 Josephson junction 407
equipotential line 311 heat of sublimation 32 Joule 18
equipotential surface 311 heat of vaporization 29 junction rule 440
equivalent resistance 427 heat pump 148, 157
escape velocity 83 heat transfer 6 K
evaporation 25 helical motion 488 Kamerlingh Onnes 403
expansion joints 10 Henry 613 Kelvin scale 9
extensive variable 112 henry (H) 613 Kelvin statement of the second
Hertz 685 law of thermodynamics 150
F hot reservoir 146 kilocalorie 18
Fahrenheit scale 8 hybrid vehicles 597 kinetic theory of gases 78
farad 337 hysteresis 548 Kirchhoff 439
Faraday 337, 481, 566 Kirchhoff’s rules 439
Faraday’s law 613 I
ferromagnetic material 545 ideal gas 70 L
field line 210 ideal gas law 70 laser printer 321
field line density 212 impedance 653 latent heat coefficient 29

Access for free at openstax.org.


Index 791

law of conservation of mutual inductance (M) 612 Poynting vector 694


charge 184 principle of superposition 193
Law of Dulong and Petit 92 N proton 184
LC circuit 628 natural convection 41 pV diagram 75
lead acid battery 422 net rate of heat transfer by
Lenz 570 radiation 47 Q
Lenz’s law 570 neutron 185 quality factor 661
Leyden jar 182 non-quasi-static processes 123 quasi-static process 113, 123
light sail 701 nonohmic 393
lightning rod 319 normal vector 233 R
linear charge density 202 north magnetic pole 480 R factor 38
loop rule 440 nucleus 184 radar 705
Lorentz force equation 683 radiation 33
O radiation pressure 699
M Oersted 481 radio waves 704
magnetic damping 586, 588 ohm 385, 393 rail gun 576
magnetic dipole 497 Ohm’s law 393, 395 rate of conductive heat
magnetic dipole moment 497 ohmic 393 transfer 36
magnetic domains 547 ohmmeter 454 RC circuit 454
magnetic energy density 620 open system 110 refrigerator 148, 437
magnetic field lines 486 Otto cycle 176 relative humidity 86
magnetic flux 567 resistance 388
magnetic force 482 P resistivity 385
magnetic monopoles 486 pacemaker 458 resistor 646
magnetic resonance parallel circuit 427 resonant frequency 661
imaging 541 parallel combination 347 reversible process 125, 145
magnetic susceptibility 546 parallel-plate capacitor 336 right-hand rule 524
mass spectrometer 502 paramagnetic material 544 right-hand rule 2 570
Maxwell 90, 680 partial pressure 85 right-hand rule-1 483
Maxwell-Boltzmann peak speed 96 RLC circuit 631
distribution 93 perfect engine 150 RLC series circuit 651
Maxwell’s equations 680 perfect refrigerator 151 rms current 648
mean free path 87 permanent dipole 214 rms voltage 648
mean free time 87 permeability of free space 520 root-mean-square (rms)
mechanical equivalent of permittivity of free space 681 speed 82
heat 18 permittivity of vacuum 191 Rutherford 184
Meissner effect 404 phase angle 652
melting 25 phase diagram 25 S
metal detectors 589, 617 phase transition 76 Savart 481
microwaves 705 Phase transitions 25 scalar field 197
molar heat capacity at constant phasor diagrams 646 schematic 377
pressure 126 photoconductor 321 Schrieffer 405
molar heat capacity at constant pinch effect 527 self-inductance 616
volume 88, 126 planar symmetry 256 series circuit 427
mole 72 polarization 188, 258 series combination 346
most probable speed 96 potential difference 420 shock hazard 460
motionally induced emf 576 potential drop 424, 441 short circuit 460
Motors 496 power factor 658 smartphone 612
multi-loop circuit 439 Power plants 147 Snow 144
792 Index

solar cells 451 thermal conductivity 36 van der Waals equation of


solenoid 539, 571 thermal energy 17 state 75
south magnetic pole 480 thermal equilibrium 6, 111 van der Waals gas 114
spark chamber 295 thermal expansion 10 vapor 27
specific heat 19 thermal hazard 460 vapor pressure 27, 86
speed of light 690 thermal stress 16 variable air capacitor 343
spherical symmetry 246 thermodynamic process 122 vector field 197
SQUID 407 thermodynamic system 110 velocity selector 499
standard temperature and thermodynamic variables 122 Visible light 707
pressure (STP) 72 thermographs 46 volt (V) 287
starter motor 375 Thermometers 8 Volta 287
state functions 117 third law of voltage 287
state variable 19 thermodynamics 165 voltaic pile 420
static electricity 180 Thomson 184 voltmeter 451
Stefan-Boltzmann law of three-wire system 462 volume charge density 202
radiation 46 time constant 455
step-down transformer 666 traffic signals 617 W
step-up transformer 666 transcranial magnetic weber 568
Stirling engine 161 stimulation (TMS) 597 WiFi 706
sublimation 26 transformer 665 work 112
superconductivity 403 transformer equation 666 working substance 147
supercritical 77 transmission lines 664
supercritical fluid 25 triple point 10, 26 X
superposition 200 X-ray 708
surface charge density 202 U xerography 320
surroundings 110 ultraviolet radiation 708
unified atomic mass unit (u) 72 Y
T universal gas constant 73 Young 685
tablet computers 596
television 705 V Z
temperature 6 Van Allen radiation belts 488 zeroth law of
terminal voltage 421 Van de Graaff generator 299, thermodynamics 6, 111
tesla 483 320
thermal agitation 705 van der Waals 75

Access for free at openstax.org.


Index 793

You might also like